Yamaha PM5D, PM5D/PM5D-RH El manual del propietario

  • ¡Hola! Soy un chatbot de IA específicamente entrenado para ayudarte con el Yamaha PM5D El manual del propietario. He revisado el documento y puedo ayudarte a encontrar la información que necesitas o explicarla de manera clara y sencilla. ¡Pregunta lo que necesites!
DIGITAL MIXING CONSOLE
PM5D / PM5D-RHPM5D / PM5D-RH
PM5D / PM5D-RH
Owners ManualOwners Manual
Owner’s Manual
The above warning is located on the rear of the unit.
Explanation of Graphical Symbols
The lightning flash with arrowhead symbol
within an equilateral triangle is intended to alert
the user to the presence of uninsulated
“dangerous voltage” within the product’s
enclosure that may be of sufficient magnitude to
constitute a risk of electric shock to persons.
The exclamation point within an equilateral
triangle is intended to alert the user to the
presence of important operating and
maintenance (servicing) instructions in the
literature accompanying the product.
IMPORTANT SAFETY INSTRUCTIONS
1 Read these instructions.
2Keep these instructions.
3 Heed all warnings.
4 Follow all instructions.
5 Do not use this apparatus near water.
6 Clean only with dry cloth.
7 Do not block any ventilation openings. Install in
accordance with the manufacturer’s instructions.
8 Do not install near any heat sources such as radiators,
heat registers, stoves, or other apparatus (including
amplifiers) that produce heat.
9 Do not defeat the safety purpose of the polarized or
grounding-type plug. A polarized plug has two blades
with one wider than the other. A grounding type plug
has two blades and a third grounding prong. The wide
blade or the third prong are provided for your safety. If
the provided plug does not fit into your outlet, consult
an electrician for replacement of the obsolete outlet.
10 Protect the power cord from being walked on or pinched
particularly at plugs, convenience receptacles, and the
point where they exit from the apparatus.
11 Only use attachments/accessories specified by the
manufacturer.
12 Use only with the cart, stand,
tripod, bracket, or table specified
by the manufacturer, or sold with
the apparatus. When a cart is
used, use caution when moving
the cart/apparatus combination
to avoid injury from tip-over.
13 Unplug this apparatus during
lightning storms or when unused for long periods of
time.
14 Refer all servicing to qualified service personnel.
Servicing is required when the apparatus has been
damaged in any way, such as power-supply cord or plug
is damaged, liquid has been spilled or objects have
fallen into the apparatus, the apparatus has been
exposed to rain or moisture, does not operate normally,
or has been dropped.
(98-6500)
CAUTION: TO REDUCE THE RISK OF
ELECTRIC SHOCK, DO NOT REMOVE
COVER (OR BACK). NO USER-SERVICEABLE
PARTS INSIDE. REFER SERVICING TO
QUALIFIED SERVICE PERSONNEL.
CAUTION
RISK OF ELECTRIC SHOCK
DO NOT OPEN
WARNING
TO REDUCE THE RISK OF FIRE OR ELECTRIC SHOCK, DO NOT EXPOSE THIS APPARATUS TO RAIN OR MOISTURE.
1. IMPORTANT NOTICE: DO NOT MODIFY THIS UNIT!
This product, when installed as indicated in the instructions con-
tained in this manual, meets FCC requirements. Modifications not
expressly approved by Yamaha may void your authority, granted by
the FCC, to use the product.
2. IMPORTANT:
When connecting this product to accessories and/
or another product use only high quality shielded cables. Cable/s
supplied with this product MUST be used. Follow all installation
instructions. Failure to follow instructions could void your FCC
authorization to use this product in the USA.
3. NOTE:
This product has been tested and found to comply with the
requirements listed in FCC Regulations, Part 15 for Class “B” digital
devices. Compliance with these requirements provides a reason-
able level of assurance that your use of this product in a residential
environment will not result in harmful interference with other elec-
tronic devices. This equipment generates/uses radio frequencies
and, if not installed and used according to the instructions found in
the users manual, may cause interference harmful to the operation
of other electronic devices. Compliance with FCC regulations does
* This applies only to products distributed by YAMAHA CORPORATION OF AMERICA. (class B)
not guarantee that interference will not occur in all installations. If
this product is found to be the source of interference, which can be
determined by turning the unit “OFF” and “ON”, please try to elimi-
nate the problem by using one of the following measures:
Relocate either this product or the device that is being affected by
the interference.
Utilize power outlets that are on different branch (circuit breaker or
fuse) circuits or install AC line filter/s.
In the case of radio or TV interference, relocate/reorient the
antenna. If the antenna lead-in is 300 ohm ribbon lead, change the
lead-in to co-axial type cable.
If these corrective measures do not produce satisfactory results,
please contact the local retailer authorized to distribute this type of
product. If you can not locate the appropriate retailer, please con-
tact Yamaha Corporation of America, Electronic Service Division,
6600 Orangethorpe Ave, Buena Park, CA90620
The above statements apply ONLY to those products distributed by
Yamaha Corporation of America or its subsidiaries.
FCC INFORMATION (U.S.A.)
ADVARSEL!
Lithiumbatteri—Eksplosionsfare ved fejlagtig håndtering. Udskiftning
må kun ske med batteri af samme fabrikat og type. Levér det brugte
batteri tilbage til leverandoren.
VARNING
Explosionsfara vid felaktigt batteribyte. Använd samma batterityp eller
en ekvivalent typ som rekommenderas av apparattillverkaren.
Kassera använt batteri enligt fabrikantens instruktion.
VAROITUS
Paristo voi räjähtää, jos se on virheellisesti asennettu. Vaihda paristo
ainoastaan laitevalmistajan suosittelemaan tyyppiin. Hävitä käytetty
paristo valmistajan ohjeiden mukaisesti.
(lithium caution)
NEDERLAND / THE NETHERLANDS
Dit apparaat bevat een lithium batterij voor geheugen back-up.
This apparatus contains a lithium battery for memory back-up.
Raadpleeg uw leverancier over de verwijdering van de batterij op het
moment dat u het apparaat ann het einde van de levensduur afdankt
of de volgende Yamaha Service Afdeiing:
Yamaha Music Nederland Service Afdeiing
Kanaalweg 18-G, 3526 KL UTRECHT
Tel. 030-2828425
•For the removal of the battery at the moment of the disposal at the
end of the service life please consult your retailer or Yamaha Service
Center as follows:
Yamaha Music Nederland Service Center
Address : Kanaalweg 18-G, 3526 KL UTRECHT
Tel: 030-2828425
Gooi de batterij niet weg, maar lever hem in als KCA.
Do not throw away the battery. Instead, hand it in as small chemical
waste.
(lithium disposal)
This product contains a high intensity lamp that contains
a small amount of mercury. Disposal of this material
may be regulated due to environmental considerations.
For disposal information in the United States, refer to
the Electronic Industries Alliance web site:
www.eiae.org
(mercury)* This applies only to products distributed by
YAMAHA CORPORATION OF AMERICA.
(5)-1
1/2
PRECAUTIONS
PLEASE READ CAREFULLY BEFORE PROCEEDING
* Please keep this manual in a safe place for future reference.
WARNING
Always follow the basic precautions listed below to avoid the possibility of serious injury or even death from electrical
shock, short-circuiting, damages, fire or other hazards. These precautions include, but are not limited to, the following:
Use only the specified power supply (PW800W or an equivalent recommended
by Yamaha).
Only use the voltage specified as correct for the device. The required voltage is
printed on the name plate of the device.
Do not place the power cord near heat sources such as heaters or radiators, and
do not excessively bend or otherwise damage the cord, place heavy objects on
it, or place it in a position where anyone could walk on, trip over, or roll anything
over it.
Do not open the device or attempt to disassemble the internal parts or modify
them in any way. The device contains no user-serviceable parts. If it should
appear to be malfunctioning, discontinue use immediately and have it inspected
by qualified Yamaha service personnel.
Do not expose the device to rain, use it near water or in damp or wet conditions,
or place containers on it containing liquids which might spill into any openings.
Never insert or remove an electric plug with wet hands.
If the power cord or plug becomes frayed or damaged, or if there is a sudden
loss of sound during use of the device, or if any unusual smells or smoke
should appear to be caused by it, immediately turn off the power switch,
disconnect the electric plug from the outlet, and have the device inspected by
qualified Yamaha service personnel.
If this device or the power supply should be dropped or damaged, immediately
turn off the power switch, disconnect the electric plug from the outlet, and have
the device inspected by qualified Yamaha service personnel.
CAUTION
Always follow the basic precautions listed below to avoid the possibility of physical injury to you or others, or damage
to the device or other property. These precautions include, but are not limited to, the following:
Remove the electric plug from the outlet when the device is not to be used for
extended periods of time, or during electrical storms.
When removing the electric plug from the device or an outlet, always hold the
plug itself and not the cord. Pulling by the cord can damage it.
Do not turn the PW800W POWER switch OFF and ON in rapid succession.
Doing so can result in excessive current flow that can cause damage. Wait at
least 5 seconds before turning the POWER switch ON after it has been turned
OFF.
When transporting or moving the device, always use four or more people.
Before moving the device, remove all connected cables.
•Avoid setting all equalizer controls and faders to their maximum. Depending on
the condition of the connected devices, doing so may cause feedback and may
damage the speakers.
Do not expose the device to excessive dust or vibrations, or extreme cold or heat
(such as in direct sunlight, near a heater, or in a car during the day) to prevent
the possibility of panel disfiguration or damage to the internal components.
Do not place the device in an unstable position where it might accidentally fall
over.
Do not block the vents. This device has ventilation holes at the front and rear to
prevent the internal temperature from rising too high. In particular, do not place
the device on its side or upside down, or place it in any poorly-ventilated
location, such as a bookcase or closet.
Do not use the device in the vicinity of a TV, radio, stereo equipment, mobile
phone, or other electric devices. Otherwise, the device, TV, or radio may
generate noise.
Power supply/Power cord
Do not open
Water warning
If you notice any abnormality
Power supply/Power cord Location
(5)-1
2/2
Before connecting the device to other devices, turn off the power for all devices.
Before turning the power on or off for all devices, set all volume levels to
minimum.
Do not insert your fingers or hand in any gaps or openings on the device (vents
etc.).
•Avoid inserting or dropping foreign objects (paper, plastic, metal, etc.) into any
gaps or openings on the device (vents, etc.) If this happens, turn off the power
immediately and unplug the power cord from the AC outlet. Then have the
device inspected by qualified Yamaha service personnel.
Do not use the headphones for a long period of time at a high or uncomfortable
volume level, since this can cause permanent hearing loss. If you experience
any hearing loss or ringing in the ears, consult a physician.
Do not rest your weight on the device or place heavy objects on it, and avoid use
excessive force on the buttons, switches or connectors.
This device has a built-in backup battery. When you unplug the power cord from
the AC outlet, the internal data of current scene is retained. However, if the
backup battery fully discharges, this data will be lost. When the backup battery
is running low, the LCD display indicates “Low Battery!” during operation or
“No Battery!” when starting up the system. In this case, have qualified Yamaha
service personnel replace the backup battery.
XLR-type connectors are wired as follows (IEC60268 standard): pin 1: ground, pin 2: hot (+), and pin 3: cold (-).
Yamaha cannot be held responsible for damage caused by improper use or modifications to the device, or data that is lost or destroyed.
Always turn the power off when the device is not in use.
The performance of components with moving contacts, such as switches, volume controls, and connectors, deteriorates over time. Consult qualified Yamaha service
personnel about replacing defective components.
Connections
Handling caution
Backup battery
6
PM5D/PM5D-RH Owner’s Manual
Table of Contents
Table of Contents — Operating section
1
Introduction ........................................ 10
Thank you................................................................... 10
An overview of the PM5D........................................... 10
Differences between the PM5D model and the
PM5D-RH model ............................................. 11
About the channel structure of the PM5D.......................... 12
Regarding word clock synchronization ....................... 12
How this manual is organized..................................... 13
Conventions in this manual ................................................. 13
2
Top, front, and rear panels................. 14
Top panel ................................................................... 14
Rear panel................................................................... 16
Front panel ................................................................. 18
3
Basic operation on the PM5D............. 19
About the various types of user interface .................... 19
User interface in the display.................................................. 19
DISPLAY ACCESS section ................................................... 20
Data Entry section ................................................................. 20
External user interface........................................................... 21
Basic operation ........................................................... 22
Click........................................................................................ 22
Drag ........................................................................................ 22
Drag and drop........................................................................ 22
Accessing a desired screen..................................................... 23
Moving the cursor ................................................................. 23
Scrolling the screen................................................................ 24
Operating the buttons........................................................... 25
Adjusting the setting of a knob or fader .............................. 25
Assigning a name................................................................... 26
4
Connections and setup ....................... 27
Audio connections ...................................................... 27
Analog audio connections .................................................... 27
Analog output connections .................................................. 28
Digital input/output connections ........................................ 29
Installing an option card....................................................... 30
Word clock connections and settings.......................... 31
About word clock .................................................................. 31
Selecting the word clock master ........................................... 31
Restoring the current scene to the default state.......... 32
5
Input channel operations ................... 33
About the input channels ........................................... 33
AD IN section.............................................................. 35
Items in the AD IN section ................................................... 35
Controlling the input sensitivity and phantom power
(+48V) of the head amp.............................................. 36
INPUT channel strip.................................................... 37
Items in the INPUT channel strip........................................ 37
ST IN/FX RTN channel strip ........................................ 39
Items in the ST IN/FX RTN channel strip........................... 39
FADER FLIP/ENCODER MODE section ........................ 40
Items in the FADER FLIP/ENCODER MODE section...... 40
Various operations for input channels ......................... 41
Selecting the function of the encoders................................. 41
Exchanging the fader and encoder functions...................... 41
Sending a signal from an input channel to the STEREO
bus ................................................................................. 42
Sending the signal from the input channel to a MIX
bus ................................................................................. 43
Enabling/disabling pairing....................................................45
6
Output channel operations .................47
About the output channels..........................................47
MIX section .................................................................49
Items in the MIX section....................................................... 49
Operations in the MIX section ............................................. 49
STEREO A/B channel strip............................................53
Items in the STEREO A/B channel strip..............................53
Operations in the STEREO A/B channel strip ....................54
MATRIX section...........................................................55
Items in the MATRIX section............................................... 55
Operations in the MATRIX section ..................................... 55
7
Using the Selected Channel section ...57
About the SELECTED CHANNEL section......................57
Items in the SELECTED CHANNEL section ...................57
GROUP................................................................................... 57
CHANNEL SELECT.............................................................. 58
DELAY.................................................................................... 58
GAIN/ATTENUATION/ø (Gain / Attenuation / Phase)...59
NOISE GATE ......................................................................... 59
STEREO.................................................................................. 60
COMPRESSOR...................................................................... 60
HPF (High Pass Filter) .......................................................... 61
EQUALIZER .......................................................................... 61
Operations in the SELECTED CHANNEL section ..........62
Selecting a channel and editing its parameters.................... 62
Compressor operations.........................................................63
Gate operations......................................................................64
EQ/HPF operations ...............................................................65
8
Input Patch / Output Patch operations ..66
Changing the input patch settings..............................66
Changing the output patch settings ...........................67
Inserting an external device into a channel .................69
Connecting an external device for insertion........................ 69
Patching the insert-out and insert-in................................... 70
Directly outputting the signal of an input channel ......72
9
Grouping and linking ..........................73
About DCA Groups and Mute Groups.........................73
Items in the ASSIGN MODE section ............................73
Items in the DCA strip .................................................73
Using DCA Groups ......................................................74
Assigning channels to DCA groups...................................... 74
Controlling DCA groups.......................................................75
Using mute groups......................................................75
Assigning channels to mute groups......................................75
Controlling mute groups ......................................................76
Using the Mute Safe function............................................... 76
Using EQ Link and Compressor Link............................77
PM5D/PM5D-RH Owner’s Manual
Table of Contents
7
10
Scene memory..................................79
About scenes .............................................................. 79
Items in the SCENE MEMORY section......................... 80
Using scene memories................................................ 81
Storing a scene........................................................................81
Recalling a scene.....................................................................82
Using PREVIEW mode ................................................. 82
Using the Auto Store function .................................... 83
Using the Direct Recall function.................................. 83
Using the Selective Recall function ............................. 84
Using the Recall Safe function..................................... 86
Using the Fade function.............................................. 87
Using the Tracking Recall function.............................. 88
Using the Global Paste function.................................. 89
11
Monitor and Cue..............................91
About the MONITOR and CUE sections...................... 91
Using the Monitor function ........................................ 92
Items in the MONITOR section ...........................................92
Monitoring a signal................................................................93
Using the Cue/Solo functions ..................................... 94
Items in the CUE section.......................................................94
About CUE mode and SOLO mode.....................................94
Cue and Solo groups..............................................................95
Using the Cue function..........................................................96
Using the Solo function .........................................................96
12
Talkback and Oscillator....................97
About the TALKBACK/OSCILLATOR sections .............. 97
Items in the TALKBACK/OSCILLATOR sections..............97
Using talkback ............................................................ 98
Using the oscillator ..................................................... 99
13
Meters.............................................100
Items in the meter section ........................................ 100
Switching the meter display ..................................... 100
Switching the metering point................................... 101
Specifying the metering point for input channels ............ 101
Specifying the metering point for output channels.......... 101
Viewing the gain reduction of the internal gates and
compressors .................................................. 102
Viewing the gain reduction for input channels ................ 102
Viewing the gain reduction for output channels.............. 102
14
Effects .............................................103
About the internal effects ......................................... 103
Using an internal effect via a MIX bus....................... 104
Inserting an internal effect into a channel................. 105
Basic operations in the effect screen ......................... 106
Recalling settings from the effect library ........................... 106
Editing the effect parameters.............................................. 106
Storing settings in the effect library ................................... 107
Using the Tap Tempo function................................. 108
Using the Freeze effect ............................................. 109
Using optional Add-On Effects.................................. 109
15
Graphic EQ .....................................110
Patching the graphic EQ ...........................................110
Basic graphic EQ operations......................................111
Controlling the graphic EQ from the display ................... 111
Controlling the graphic EQ from the DCA section.......... 111
16
Remote control ..............................113
MIDI on the PM5D ...................................................113
Using program changes to control events.................113
Using control changes to control events ...................115
Using the MIDI Remote function...............................117
Assigning MIDI messages to controllers ........................... 117
Using MIDI remote channels............................................. 121
Transmitting MIDI events when you switch scenes ...122
Using GPI (General Purpose Interface) ......................123
Using GPI IN ....................................................................... 123
Calibrating the GPI IN ports .............................................. 125
Using GPI OUT................................................................... 126
17
Using memory cards......................128
Using memory cards with the PM5D ........................128
Saving files to a memory card ...................................128
Loading files from a memory card.............................130
18
Surround pan.................................132
About surround pan..................................................132
Bus configuration and operation in surround mode..133
About the surround buses .................................................. 133
How the MIX section will operate ..................................... 133
Basic settings for surround buses...............................134
Controlling surround pan..........................................135
Notes regarding surround pan..................................137
19
Other functions..............................138
Using the user defined keys.......................................138
Items in the USER DEFINED section................................ 138
Assigning functions to the User Defined keys................... 138
Executing functions assigned to the User Defined keys... 139
Using the Fader Assign function................................139
Items in the FADER MODE section.................................. 139
Assigning channels to DCA faders..................................... 139
Controlling the channels assigned to DCA faders ............ 140
Locking the PM5D (Security functions) .....................141
Setting the System Password or Console Password.......... 141
Using Parameter Lock or Console Lock............................ 142
Using cascade connections .......................................143
Making cascade connections .............................................. 143
Basic settings for cascade connection ................................ 143
Selecting the buses used for cascade connection .............. 144
Connecting the PM5D to a computer via USB ..........146
Caution when using the USB TO HOST connector ........ 146
Initializing the PM5D’s internal memory ...................147
Adjusting the faders and input/output gain
(Calibration) ..................................................147
Calibrating the faders.......................................................... 148
Adjusting the analog input gain (PM5D-RH model
only)............................................................................ 148
Adjusting the output gain................................................... 148
8
PM5D/PM5D-RH Owner’s Manual
Table of Contents
Table of Contents — Reference section
Information shown in the display.......... 149
Upper part of the display (always visible).................. 149
Main area of the display............................................ 150
Lower part of the display (always visible) .................. 150
Function menu........................................ 151
Global functions...................................... 152
EFFECT functions ...................................................... 152
EFFECT PARAM (Effect parameter) screen..................... 152
EFFECT ASSIGN screen ..................................................... 154
EFFECT LIBRARY screen................................................... 155
GEQ function............................................................ 156
GEQ PARAM (GEQ parameter) screen ............................ 156
GEQ ASSIGN screen ........................................................... 157
GEQ LIBRARY screen......................................................... 158
SCENE function ........................................................ 159
SCENE screen ...................................................................... 159
EVENT LIST screen ............................................................ 161
SELECTIVE RECALL screen.............................................. 164
RECALL SAFE screen.......................................................... 166
FADE TIME screen ............................................................. 167
TRACKING RECALL screen.............................................. 169
GLOBAL PASTE screen...................................................... 170
MIDI REMOTE function............................................. 171
MIDI SETUP screen............................................................ 171
MIDI PGM CHANGE (MIDI program change) screen .. 173
MIDI CTRL CHANGE (MIDI control change) screen ... 174
MIDI REMOTE screen ....................................................... 175
GPI screen ............................................................................ 177
FADER START screen ........................................................ 179
TRANSPORT screen........................................................... 181
DME CONTROL screen..................................................... 182
UTILITY function ....................................................... 186
PREFERENCE 1/2 screens.................................................. 186
USER DEFINE screen ......................................................... 189
SAVE screen ......................................................................... 192
LOAD screen........................................................................ 195
FADER ASSIGN screen....................................................... 197
SECURITY screen................................................................ 198
SYS/W.CLOCK function ............................................ 199
WORD CLOCK screen ....................................................... 199
MIXER SETUP screen......................................................... 200
CASCADE screen ................................................................ 204
HA (Head Amp) screen ...................................................... 206
OUTPUT PORT ATT (Output port attenuation) screen 207
DITHER screen.................................................................... 207
HA LIBRARY screen ........................................................... 208
METER function ........................................................ 209
INPUT METER screen........................................................ 209
OUTPUT METER screen ................................................... 210
INPUT GR (Input Gain Reduction) screen ...................... 211
OUTPUT GR (Output Gain Reduction) screen............... 211
MON/CUE function .................................................. 212
TALKBACK screen.............................................................. 212
OSCILLATOR screen.......................................................... 213
2TR I/O screen..................................................................... 215
MONITOR screen............................................................... 216
CUE/SOLO screen............................................................... 217
Output functions .................................... 220
OUTPUT PATCH function..........................................220
OUTPUT PATCH screen ...................................................220
INSERT PATCH screen ...................................................... 221
INSERT POINT screen .......................................................222
OUTPUT PATCH LIBRARY screen..................................223
OUTPUT INSERT function..........................................224
INSERT IN MIX 1-24 screen.............................................. 224
INSERT IN MATRIX/STEREO/MONITOR screen ........224
HA LIBRARY screen ...........................................................225
OUTPUT EQ function ................................................225
EQ PARAM (EQ Parameter) screen ..................................225
MIX 1-24 screen................................................................... 227
MATRIX/STEREO screen...................................................227
OUTPUT EQ LIBRARY screen..........................................228
OUTPUT COMP function ..........................................229
COMP PARAM (Compressor parameter) screen ............ 229
MIX 1-24 screen................................................................... 231
MATRIX/STEREO screen...................................................231
COMP LIBRARY (Compressor library) screen ................ 232
OUTPUT DELAY function...........................................233
MIX 1-24 screen................................................................... 233
MATRIX/STEREO screen...................................................233
OUTPUT DCA/GROUP function.................................234
DCA GROUP ASSIGN screen............................................ 234
MUTE GROUP ASSIGN screen.........................................235
EQ LINK ASSIGN screen....................................................236
COMP LINK ASSIGN (Compressor link assign) screen .237
MATRIX/ST function..................................................238
MATRIX/ST ROUTING screen .........................................238
MIX to MATRIX VIEW screen ..........................................240
LCR screen ...........................................................................242
SURR SETUP screen ...........................................................244
OUTPUT VIEW function.............................................245
CH VIEW (Channel view) screen ......................................245
SIGNAL FLOW screen........................................................247
FADER VIEW screen ..........................................................249
CH COPY (Channel copy) screen......................................249
OUTPUT CH LIBRARY screen .........................................251
PM5D/PM5D-RH Owner’s Manual Table of Contents 9
Input functions ........................................252
INPUT PATCH function............................................. 252
INPUT PATCH screen ....................................................... 252
DIRECT OUT PATCH screen ........................................... 253
INSERT PATCH screen...................................................... 254
INSERT/DIRECT OUT POINT screen............................. 256
NAME screen....................................................................... 257
INPUT PATCH LIBRARY screen ..................................... 257
INPUT HA/INSERT function ...................................... 258
CH 1-24 (Input channel 1-24) screen ............................... 258
STIN/FXRTN (ST IN/FXRTN channel) screen ............... 258
INSERT 1-24 screen............................................................ 259
INSERT 25-48 screen.......................................................... 259
INSERT STIN screen .......................................................... 259
HA LIBRARY screen........................................................... 260
INPUT ø/EQ function................................................ 260
EQ PARAM (EQ parameter) screen.................................. 260
EQ 1-24 screen..................................................................... 261
EQ 25-48 switch .................................................................. 261
EQ STIN/FXRTN screen .................................................... 261
ø/ATT 1-48 (Phase/Attenuation 1-48) screen .................. 262
ø/ATT STIN/FXRTN (Phase/Attenuation STIN/FXRTN)
screen .......................................................................... 262
INPUT EQ LIBRARY screen.............................................. 263
INPUT GATE/COMP function ................................... 264
GATE PARAM (Gate parameter) screen .......................... 264
COMP PARAM (Compressor parameter) screen............ 266
CH 1-12 (Input channel 1–12) screen............................... 267
CH 13-24 (Input channel 13–24) screen........................... 267
CH 25-36 (Input channel 25–36) screen........................... 267
CH 37-48 (Input channel 37–48) screen........................... 267
ST IN (ST IN channel) screen............................................ 267
GATE LIBRARY screen ...................................................... 268
COMP LIBRARY (Compressor library) screen................ 269
INPUT DELAY function.............................................. 270
CH 1-24 (Input channel 1–24) screen............................... 270
CH 25-48 (Input channel 25–48) screen........................... 270
ST IN (ST IN channel) screen............................................ 270
INPUT DCA/GROUP function ................................... 271
DCA GROUP ASSIGN screen ........................................... 271
MUTE GROUP ASSIGN screen ........................................ 272
EQ LINK ASSIGN screen ................................................... 272
COMP LINK ASSIGN (Compressor link assign) screen. 273
PAN/ROUTING function ........................................... 274
CH to MIX (Channel to mix) screen................................. 274
MIX SEND VIEW screen ................................................... 280
FIX ASSIGN VIEW screen ................................................. 282
LCR screen........................................................................... 283
SURR PARAM (Surround parameter) screen.................. 283
SURR VIEW (Surround view) screen ............................... 285
M/S screen............................................................................ 285
INPUT VIEW function................................................ 286
CH VIEW (Channel view) screen...................................... 286
SIGNAL FLOW screen ....................................................... 287
FADER VIEW screen.......................................................... 288
CH COPY screen................................................................. 289
INPUT CH LIBRARY (Input channel library) screen..... 289
Appendices..............................................290
EQ Library List ...........................................................290
GATE Library List .......................................................291
Compressor Library List.............................................292
Dynamics Parameters................................................294
GATE section....................................................................... 294
COMP section ..................................................................... 295
Effect Library List .......................................................297
Effects Parameters .....................................................298
Effects and tempo synchronization.................................... 307
Scene Memory/Effect Library to Program Change
Table .............................................................308
Parameters that can be assigned to control changes.312
Control change parameter assignments....................314
NRPN parameter assignments...................................331
Channel Library List ..................................................334
Channel parameter behavior when paired ................335
MIDI Data Format .....................................................336
Warning Messages ....................................................343
Error Messages..........................................................344
Troubleshooting........................................................345
General Specifications ...............................................346
Input/output characteristics ......................................348
Electrical characteristics.............................................352
Other Functions ........................................................354
Pin Assignment .........................................................355
Dimensions ...............................................................356
MIDI Implementation Chart......................................357
Index.........................................................................358
PM5D/PM5D-RH Block Diagram.............. End of Manual
PM5D Level Diagram ............................... End of Manual
PM5D-RH Level Diagram ......................... End of Manual
The illustrations and screen displays as shown in this
Owner’s Manual are for instructional purposes only,
and may be different from the ones on your device.
The company names and product names in this
Owner’s Manual are the trademarks or registered
trademarks of their respective companies.
10 PM5D/PM5D-RH Owner’s Manual Operating section
Operating section
Thank you
Thank you for purchasing the Yamaha PM5D digital mixing console. In order to take full advantage of the PM5D’s superior
functionality and enjoy years of trouble-free use, please read this manual before you begin using the product. After you have
read the manual, keep it in a safe place.
An overview of the PM5D
The PM5D is a digital mixing console with the following features.
Full digital SR mixing system
The PM5D is a full-digital SR mixing console that takes
advantage of cutting-edge digital audio processing technol-
ogy. 24-bit linear AD/DA converters are used to deliver up
to 110 dB of dynamic range and amazing sound quality. As
input channels, it provides 48 monaural channels, four ste-
reo channels, and four stereo channels for effect return. As
output channels, it provides 24 MIX channels, eight
MATRIX channels, and two STEREO channels. The PM5D
can be used in a wide range of applications. You can assign
desired channels to be controlled by the eight DCA faders
on the panel, and use them as group faders.
PM5D model and PM5D-RH model
In addition to the standard PM5D model that provides
manual control of the head amp for each input, the
PM5D-RH model is also available, providing programma-
ble control of head amp input sensitivity and phantom
power settings. You can choose the model appropriate for
your situation and budget.
Cutting-edge user interface
For the input channels and STEREO A/B channels, dedi-
cated channel strips are provided where you can operate
the fader, pan, cue, and on/off controls. For MIX channels
and MATRIX channels, encoders allow you to control the
send level and master level. The PM5D allows quick and
intuitive operation just as on an analog mixer. In addition,
you can use the SELECTED CHANNEL section to manu-
ally control the principal parameters (delay, EQ, gate,
compressor) of the desired channel.
Eight effect modules / Twelve graphic
EQ modules
Eight high-quality multi-effect modules are built in. Effects
such as reverb, delay, multiband compressor, and various
modulation effects can be routed via internal buses or
inserted into the desired channel. 31-band graphic EQ can
also be inserted into any channel or any output.
Scene memories and libraries
Mix parameters and internal effect settings can be stored in
memory as up to 500 scenes for immediate recall. Effects,
input/output patching, input channel/output channel set-
tings, internal head amp (PM5D-RH model only) or
external head amp settings can be stored in various librar-
ies, independently of scenes.
Digital cascade connection
Up to four PM5D units, or one PM5D and one Yamaha
DM2000/02R96 unit, can be cascade-connected to share
buses in the digital domain. In particular when PM5D
units are cascaded together, operations such as scene sav-
ing and recall can also be linked. Compatible external
devices can also be used as inserts or as extended signal
processors via a cascade connection.
Surround panning
Surround pan functionality allows multi-channel playback
systems to be used, letting you place the signal of an input
channel in two-dimensional space, or move the sound
image forward/backward and left/right. 3-1ch, 5.1ch, and
6.1ch surround modes are available.
I/O card expansion
The rear panel provides four slots in which separately sold
mini-YGDAI cards can be installed. AD cards, DA cards, or
digital I/O cards can be installed in these slots to add inputs
and outputs.
Add-On Effects provide additional effect
types
Separately sold Add-On Effects packages can be installed to
add new effect types for the internal effects. The REV-X
reverb effect sold as an Add-On Effect for the DM2000 or
02R96 is included as standard.
1 Introduction
PM5D/PM5D-RH Owner’s Manual Operating section 11
1
Introduction
Differences between the PM5D model and the PM5D-RH
model
The PM5D is available as the standard PM5D model or as the PM5D-RH model which allows internal head amp settings to be
programmed. These models differ as follows.
PM5D model
Head amp adjustments (input sensitivity settings,
phantom power (+48V) on/off) for the analog inputs
(INPUT jacks 1–48, ST IN jacks 1–4) are performed
manually, using the controls of the top panel.
Insert jacks (INSERT IN/OUT jacks) for the monaural
analog inputs (INPUT jacks 1–48) are provided on the
rear panel, allowing external effect processors to be
inserted in the analog domain.
ST IN jacks 1–4 are only for line level.
There is no +48V MASTER switch.
PM5D-RH model
Head amp adjustments (input sensitivity settings,
phantom power (+48V) on/off) for the analog inputs
are controlled from within the screen via software. For
this reason, the top panel does not have head amp con-
trols; instead, indicators showing the presence or
absence of a signal are provided. Head amp settings can
be saved in a library and recalled at any time.
Insert jacks for the analog inputs are not provided.
ST IN jacks 1–4 support mic levels through line levels.
Phantom power can also be supplied to ST IN jacks 1–
4.
The +48V MASTER switch turns all phantom power
(+48V) on/off.
INPUT jacks 1–48ST IN jacks 1–4
INSERT IN/OUT jacks 1–48
INPUT jacks 1–48
ST IN jacks 1–4
2 Introduction
12 PM5D/PM5D-RH Owner’s Manual Operating section
The PM5D provides the following input channels and out-
put channels.
Input channels
This section processes input signals and sends them to the
STEREO bus or MIX buses. There are three types of input
channel, as follows.
Input channels 1–48
These channels are used to process monaural signals.
By default, the input signals from the monaural analog
input jacks (INPUT jacks 1–48) are assigned to these
channels.
ST IN channels 1–4
These channels are used to process stereo signals. By
default, the input signals from the stereo analog input
jacks (ST IN jacks 1–4) are assigned to these channels.
FX RTN channels 1–4
These channels are used mainly to process the return
signals (stereo) from the internal effects. By default, the
left/right output channels of internal effects 1 through
4 are assigned to these channels.
Hint
Signal assignments to the input channels can be changed as
desired.
Output channels
This section mixes the signals sent from input channels
etc., and sends them to the corresponding output jacks or
output buses. There are three types of output channel, as
follows.
MIX channels 1–24
These process the signals sent from input channels to
MIX buses, and output them from MIX OUT jacks 1
through 24. These channels are used mainly for fold-
back or as sends to external effects. The signals of MIX
channels 1–24 can also be sent to the STEREO bus or
MATRIX buses.
MATRIX channels 1–8
These process the signals sent from MIX channels or
STEREO A/B channels to MATRIX buses, and output
them from the MATRIX OUT jacks. This allows MIX
channels or STEREO A/B channels to be mixed at the
desired balance for output.
STEREO A/B channels
These process the signals sent from input channels or
MIX channels, and output them to STEREO OUT
jacks A/B. These channels are used as the main stereo
outputs. Normally, the same signal is sent from the
STEREO A and B channels. However, it is also possible
to use the STEREO B channel as the center channel for
three-channel L/C/R playback.
Regarding word clock synchronization
The signal used to synchronize digital audio signal process-
ing is called “word clock.” Normally, one device transmits
a reference word clock signal, and the other devices receive
this word clock signal and synchronize to it.
In order to transmit or receive digital audio signals to or
from an external device via the PM5D’s digital input/out-
put jacks or via a digital I/O card installed in a slot, the
word clock must be synchronized between the devices. Be
aware that if the word clock is not synchronized, the sig-
nals will not be transmitted correctly, and unpleasant noise
will occur.
Hint
For details on synchronizing the word clock of the PM5D
and external devices, refer to the explanation of word clock
in Operating section “Chapter 4. Connections and setup”
(
p.31), and to the Reference Section “WORD CLOCK
screen” (
p.199).
As an exception, digital signals that are not synchronized
with the PM5D can be input via a digital I/O card that con-
tains a sampling rate converter, or via the 2TR IN/OUT
DIGITAL jacks.
About the channel structure of the
PM5D
PM5D/PM5D-RH Owner’s Manual Operating section 13
1
Introduction
How this manual is organized
This owner’s manual is divided into the following three
sections.
Operating section
This section explains the items on the front and rear pan-
els, connections and setup, and how to operate the PM5D’s
basic functionality. In particular if you have not operated a
digital console before, we recommend that you read chap-
ters 2 through 7 first.
Reference section
This section explains the functionality and operation for all
of the PM5D’s screens. Refer to this section when you want
to learn about the items in the screens.
Appendices
This contains various information such as library lists,
parameter lists for the internal effects, the MIDI data for-
mat, and lists of warning messages and error messages.
In this manual, non-locking panel switches that you press
are called “keys,” and those that change their on/off status
when you push them in (locking types) are called
“switches.” Of the control knobs on the panel, those that
turn from a minimum value to a maximum value are
called “knobs,” while those that turn endlessly are called
“encoders.”
Controls located on the panel are enclosed in square brack-
ets [ ] (e.g., [CUE] key, [PAD] switch) in order to
distinguish them from the buttons and knobs displayed in
the screen. For some controls, the section name is listed
before the [ ] (e.g., CH [ON] key, EQ [FREQUENCY]
encoder).
Unless otherwise specified, references to the PM5D apply
to both the PM5D model and the PM5D-RH model. If
specifications differ between the PM5D model and the
PM5D-RH model, such differences will be noted each time
they occur.
Conventions in this manual
2 Top, front, and rear panels
14 PM5D/PM5D-RH Owner’s Manual Operating section
This chapter explains the names and functions of each part of the PM5D. Details for each section of
the top panel are explained in subsequent chapters of this operating section; refer to the appropri-
ate chapter for more information.
Top panel
A AD IN section (PM5D model)
In this section you can adjust the sensitivity of the ana-
log signals being input from the rear panel INPUT
jacks 1–48 and ST IN jacks 1–4, and switch pad, insert,
and phantom power (+48 V) on/off ( p.35).
B AD IN section (PM5D-RH model)
This area indicates the presence, peak level, and phan-
tom power (+48V) on/off status of the input signal
from rear panel INPUT jacks 1–48 and ST IN jacks 1–
4.
Hint
For the PM5D-RH model, input sensitivity and phantom power
on/off are controlled by operations in the display (
p.36).
C INPUT channel strip section
This section controls the principal parameters for input
channels 1–48 ( p.37).
D FADER FLIP/ENCODER MODE section
Here you can select the parameters controlled by the
faders/encoders of the INPUT channel strip (
3)
( p.40).
E MIX section
This section controls the on/off status and send level of
the signals sent from input channels to MIX buses, and
adjusts the master level of the MIX channels ( p.49).
F MATRIX section
This section controls the send level of the signals sent
from MIX channels to MATRIX buses, and adjusts the
master level of the MATRIX channels ( p.55).
G SELECTED CHANNEL section
In this section you can view and control the mix
parameters for the currently selected input channel or
output channel ( p.57).
H Meter section
This section contains peak level meters that indicate
the input levels of input channels and the output levels
of output channels and cue monitoring, as selected by
key operations ( p.100).
2 Top, front, and rear panels
1
(PM5D model)
2
(PM5D-RH model)
4 5
3
6 8
7
PM5D/PM5D-RH Owner’s Manual Operating section 15
2
Top, front, and rear panels
I Display
This display shows the information you need to oper-
ate the PM5D, and lets you make system-wide settings
and control mix parameters for input and output
channels ( p.19).
Hint
You can adjust the angle of the display by moving the upper
part of the display frame forward or backward.
Note
Before moving the PM5D, you must lower the display all the
way back until it is fastened in place.
J FADER MODE section
Here you can select the combination of channels or
DCA groups that will be controlled by the faders of the
DCA strip section (
K) ( p.73).
K DCA strip section
From this section you can control the channels
assigned to DCA groups 1–8 ( p.73).
L ST IN/FX RTN (Stereo in / Effect return)
channel strip section
This section controls the principal parameters of ST IN
channels 1–4 or FX RTN channels 1–4 ( p.39).
M STEREO strip section
This section controls the principal parameters of the
STEREO A/B channels ( p.53).
N SCENE MEMORY section
This section stores/recalls mix parameters as scene
memories ( p.80). Mute operations for mute groups
1–8 are also performed in this section ( p.75).
O CUE/MONITOR section
This section selects the monitor source that is output
from the MONITOR OUT jacks, and adjusts the lev-
els. This section also determines the cue point and
monitoring method that will be used when you press a
[CUE] key for a channel ( p.91).
P OSCILLATOR/TALKBACK section
This section switches the oscillator or talkback on/off,
and adjusts the talkback level ( p.97).
Q DISPLAY ACCESS section
This section selects the functions or screen shown in
the display ( p.20).
R USER DEFINED KEYS sections
This section executes the functions that have been
assigned to the User Defined keys [1]–[25] ( p.138).
S Data entry section
This section lets you move the pointer (the arrow dis-
played in the screen) or cursor (the red frame
indicating a selection) in the display and edit the
parameter value ( p.20).
T ASSIGN MODE section
This section lets you assign mute groups and DCA
groups for control from the panel ( p.73).
R
9
Q
R
ST
N O P
8
J
K M L
2 Top, front, and rear panels
16 PM5D/PM5D-RH Owner’s Manual Operating section
Rear panel
A INPUT jacks 1–48 (PM5D model)
These are balanced XLR-3-31 type input jacks for
inputting analog audio signals from line level devices
or microphones. Nominal input level is
–60 dBu to +10 dBu.
B INSERT IN/OUT jacks 1–48 (PM5D model
only)
These are balanced TRS phone type input/output jacks
for inserting external effects or dynamics processors
etc. into INPUT jacks 1–48. Nominal input/output
level is +4 dBu.
C ST IN (Stereo input) jacks 1–4 (PM5D
model)
These are balanced XLR-3-31 type input jacks for
inputting analog audio signals from line level devices.
Nominal input level is –34 dBu to +10 dBu.
D +48V MASTER switch (PM5D-RH model
only)
This is the master phantom power (+48V) switch for
INPUT jacks 1–48 and ST IN jacks 1–4. If this switch is
off, the +48V buttons shown in the display are
unavailable.
E INPUT jacks 1–48 (PM5D-RH model)
These are balanced XLR-3-31 type input jacks for
inputting analog audio signals from line level devices
or microphones. Nominal input level is
–62 dBu to +10 dBu.
F ST IN (Stereo input) jacks 1–4 (PM5D-RH
model)
These are balanced XLR-3-31 type input jacks for
inputting analog audio signals from line level devices
or microphones. Nominal input level is
–62 dBu to +10 dBu.
3 1
2
(PM5D model)
Male XLR plug
1 (ground)
2 (hot)
3 (cold)
1/4" TRS
phone plug
Tip (hot)
Ring (cold)
Sleeve (ground)
Male XLR plug
1 (ground)
2 (hot)
3 (cold)
46
5
(PM5D-RH model)
Male XLR plug
1 (ground)
2 (hot)
3 (cold)
Male XLR plug
1 (ground)
2 (hot)
3 (cold)
PM5D/PM5D-RH Owner’s Manual Operating section 17
2
Top, front, and rear panels
G MIX OUT jacks
These are XLR-3-32 (balanced) jacks that output the
analog signals of MIX channels 1–24. Nominal output
level is +4 dBu.
H LAMP connector
This is a four-pin female XLR output jack for supply-
ing power to a gooseneck lamp. (These jacks are
provided at three locations). The location of these jacks
differs between the PM5D model and the PM5D-RH
model.
I MONITOR OUT jacks
These are XLR-3-32 (balanced) jacks that output the
monitor signal selected in the MONITOR section of
the top panel. Nominal output level is +4 dBu.
Note
Although the various output jacks and 2TR IN ANALOG jacks
have a nominal input/output level of +4 dBu (maximum level is
+24 dBu), an internal switch allows this to be changed to
–2 dBu (maximum level +18 dBu) if necessary. For details,
contact your Yamaha dealer.
J CUE OUT jacks
These are XLR-3-32 (balanced) jacks that output the
cue monitor signal from the channel selected by its
[CUE] key. Nominal output level is +4 dBu.
K STEREO OUT A/B jacks
These are XLR-3-32 (balanced) jacks that output the
analog signals of the STEREO A/B channels. Nominal
output level is +4 dBu.
L MATRIX OUT jacks
These are XLR-3-32 (balanced) jacks that output the
analog signals of MATRIX channels 1–8. Nominal out-
put level is +4 dBu.
M DC POWER INPUT connector
This is a connector for connecting the PW800W power
supply. Use the dedicated cable included with the
PM5D to make the connection.
N 2TR IN ANALOG jacks 1/2
These are XLR-3-31 (balanced) jacks that input stereo
analog signals from an external source. Nominal input
level is +4 dBu.
O TIME CODE INPUT jack
This is an XLR-3-31 (balanced) jack that receives
SMPTE time code (LTC) from an external source.
P TO HOST connector
This is a USB (type B) connector that allows communi-
cation with a computer.
Q GPI connector
This is a D-sub 25-pin female connector that allows
communication with a GPI-equipped external device.
7
8
Female XLR plug
2 (hot)
1 (ground)
3 (cold)
C
RLRL
RLRL
87654321
MJ9KL
Female XLR plug
2 (hot)
1 (ground)
3 (cold)
Female XLR plug
2 (hot)
1 (ground)
3 (cold)
Female XLR plug
2 (hot)
1 (ground)
3 (cold)
Female XLR plug
2 (hot)
1 (ground)
3 (cold)
IN
R
L
R
L
SMPTE
USB
OUT IN
75
ON OFF
21
COAXIAL COAXIALAES/EBU AES/EBU AES/EBU AES/EBU
3
21
3
THRU OUT IN
N X YVUT
Q R S Z aWPO
Male XLR plug
1 (ground)
2 (hot)
3 (cold)
Male XLR plug
1 (ground)
2 (hot)
3 (cold)
2 Top, front, and rear panels
18 PM5D/PM5D-RH Owner’s Manual Operating section
R RS422 REMOTE connector
This is a D-sub 9-pin female connector for remotely
controlling an external device that supports the RS422
protocol.
S HA REMOTE connector
This is a D-sub 9-pin male connector for remotely con-
trolling an external head amp device (e.g., Yamaha
AD8HR or AD824) that supports a special protocol.
T WORD CLOCK IN connector
This is a BNC connector for supplying a word clock
from an external device to the PM5D.
U 75 ON/OFF switch
This switch terminates the word clock connection.
Normally you will leave this ON. If a device made by
another manufacturer is connected and word clock
cannot be received correctly, try turning this OFF.
V WORD CLOCK OUT connector
This is a BNC connector for supplying a word clock
from the PM5D to an external device.
W MIDI IN/THRU/OUT connectors
These connectors are used to transmit and receive
MIDI messages to and from external MIDI devices.
The MIDI IN connector receives messages from an
external device, and the MIDI OUT connector trans-
mits messages from the PM5D. Messages received at
the MIDI IN connector are retransmitted without
change from the MIDI THRU connector.
X 2TR OUT DIGITAL (2 track out digital) jacks
1–3
These jacks digitally output the signals of the STEREO
A/B channels. Two types are provided; AES/EBU
(XLR-3-32) jacks (1/2) which output AES/EBU format
signals, and a COAXIAL (RCA phono) jack (3) which
outputs consumer format signals (IEC60958).
Y 2TR IN DIGITAL (2 track in digital) jacks 1–3
These jacks input digital audio from external devices
such as CD players. Two types are provided; AES/EBU
(XLR-3-31) jacks (1/2) which receive AES/EBU format
signals, and a COAXIAL (RCA phono) jack (3) which
receives consumer format signals (IEC60958).
Z CASCADE OUT connector
This is a D-sub half-pitch 68-pin female connector that
can be connected to another PM5D for transmission/
reception of control signals and transmission of audio
signals.
a CASCADE IN connector
This is a D-sub half-pitch 68-pin female connector that
can be connected to another PM5D for transmission/
reception of control signals and reception of audio
signals.
b Fan grille
This is an output grille for the fan that cools the inte-
rior of the console (two locations). Be careful not to
obstruct the fan exhaust.
c SLOT 1–4
These slots allow separately sold mini-YGDAI I/O
cards to be installed to expand the input/output ports.
Front panel
A MEMORY CARD slot
A memory card inserted in this slot can be used to
save/load scene memories or library data. You can use
PCMCIA Type II flash ATA cards, or CompactFlash
cards inserted into a PC card adaptor.
B MOUSE connector
A PS/2 mouse can be connected to this connector and
used to perform operations in the display.
C KEYBOARD connector
A PS/2 keyboard can be connected to this connector
and used to input text or perform operations in the
display.
D PHONES (Headphone) jack
This headphone jack lets you monitor the MONITOR
OUT or CUE signals.
cb
PHONES
KEYBOARD
MOUSE
MEMORY CARD
PHONES
KEYBOARD
MOUSE
MEMORY CARD
12
43
56
12
43
56
1 2 3 4
PM5D/PM5D-RH Owner’s Manual Operating section 19
3
Basic operation on the PM5D
This chapter explains the various types of user interface used to operate the PM5D.
About the various types of user interface
Basic parameters such as mixing and editing the sound of each channel can be controlled by the faders and encoders of the top
panel. However to make more detailed settings, you will need to access the appropriate “function” and edit the parameter val-
ues in the display. The section below explains the various user interface components shown in the display, and how to use
them.
The user interface in the PM5D’s display uses the follow-
ing components.
Pointer
The arrow shown in the display is called the “pointer.” Use
the pointer to select the parameter you want to control
next.
Cursor
The red frame shown in the display is called
the “cursor.” If the cursor encloses a parame-
ter on the screen, that parameter is selected
for operation.
Tabs
The screen names shown in
the upper left of the display
are called “tabs.” Tabs are
used to switch between
screens within the same
function.
Buttons
Buttons in the display are
used to switch parameters
on/off or to select one of
multiple choices. Buttons
that are currently on are dis-
played in green (some
buttons are displayed in red
or blue); buttons that are
turned off are displayed in
gray.
Knobs/Faders/Boxes
Knobs/faders in the display are used to edit parameter val-
ues. The current value is shown in the box. Boxes for which
/ buttons are displayed at left and right allow you to
edit the parameter by using these buttons. (If editing is not
possible, the buttons will be gray.)
If you want to assign a name to a channel or scene, input
characters, numerals, and symbols into the box.
Character palette
This is a “virtual” keyboard used to input characters,
numerals, and symbols into a text input box.
3 Basic operation on the PM5D
User interface in the display
Cursor
Ta b
Buttons turned
off (gray)
Buttons turned
on (green)
Fader
Box
Box
Knob
/ buttons for
editing the value
3 Basic operation on the PM5D
20 PM5D/PM5D-RH Owner’s Manual Operating section
Scroll bar
If the displayed items are too numerous to fit into a single
screen, you can use the scroll bar to view the portion that is
not currently displayed.
The DISPLAY ACCESS section contains keys that access
the desired function or screen in the display.
A Global functions
These keys access functions that affect the entire
PM5D.
B Output functions
These keys access functions that are related to output
channels.
C Input functions
These keys access functions that are related to input
channels.
When you press the key for the desired function, the screen
for that function will appear in the display. By repeatedly
pressing a key you can cycle through the screens included
in that function.
Hint
If you hold down the [SHIFT] key and press a key in the DIS-
PLAY ACCESS section, the screens included in that function
will appear in the reverse order (Page Back function). You can
also use the Page Back function by holding down a key in the
DISPLAY ACCESS section. If you rapidly press a key twice,
you will return to the first screen in that function.
Controllers used to edit settings and values in the display
are gathered into the data entry section.
A [DEC/CANCEL]/[INC/OK] keys
Use these keys to increase or decrease the value of the
parameter where the cursor is located. If the PM5D has
displayed a window asking you to confirm an opera-
tion such as recall or store, these buttons can be used
instead of the CANCEL button and OK button shown
in the window.
B CURSOR []/[®]/[π]/[] keys
These keys are used to move the cursor to the desired
parameter.
C [SHIFT] key
This key can be used in conjunction with the CUR-
SOR []/[®]/[π]/[] keys to move the cursor
rapidly, or in conjunction with the [DATA] encoder or
[DEC]/[INC] keys to change the parameter value
rapidly.
If you hold down the [SHIFT] key and press the
[ENTER] key, the JOB SELECT window will appear,
allowing you to set multiple parameters in a single
operation. (When you move the cursor to a parameter
for which there is a JOB SELECT window, an indica-
tion of “Job Select = [SHIFT] + [ENTER]” will
appear.)
D [ENTER] key
Use this key to switch a button at the cursor location
on/off, or to open a window.
E [DATA] encoder
Use this to increase or decrease the value of the param-
eter where the cursor is located. The parameter value
will change more rapidly if you turn the [DATA]
encoder while holding down the [SHIFT] key.
Scroll bar
DISPLAY ACCESS section
1
2
3
Data Entry section
2
1
6
3
7
4
5
PM5D/PM5D-RH Owner’s Manual Operating section 21
3
Basic operation on the PM5D
F Track pad and left/right buttons
These are used to move the pointer or select the desired
parameter. To adjust a knob-type parameter in the dis-
play, hold down the left button or right track pad
button while you operate the track pad.
G PHONES (Headphone) jack
This is a stereo phone jack for connecting a set of
headphones.
If desired, you can add the following external user inter-
face components.
Mouse
A PS/2 compatible mouse can be connected to the MOUSE
connector located on the front panel of the PM5D and
used in the same way as the track pad.
Keyboard
A PS/2 compatible keyboard can be connected to the KEY-
BOARD connector located on the front panel of the PM5D
and used in the same way as the character palette in the
display to input characters, numerals, and symbols. The
numeric key pad of the keyboard can be used to input
numerical values or to recall scenes.
Each key (or combination of keys) has the following
function.
Full keyboard
Numeric key pad
External user interface
Key Function
<PageUp>
Same function as the [INS/OK] key of the Data
Entry section
<PageDown>
Same function as the [DEC/CANCEL] key of
the Data Entry section
<>, <>,
<>, <>
Same function as the CURSOR []/[®]/[π]/
[] keys
<Alt> +
<PageUp>
Same function as moving the [DATA] encoder
clockwise
<Alt> +
<PageDown>
Same function as moving the [DATA] encoder
counterclockwise
<Enter> Same function as the [ENTER] key
<Shift> Same function as the [SHIFT] key
<Ctrl> + <>,
<Ctrl> + <>
Same function as the buttons of the
character palette
<Ctrl> + <x>
Copies the text string in the box and clears the
copy-source character string (Cut)
<Ctrl> + <c>
Same function as the COPY button of the
character palette
<Ctrl> + <v>
Same function as the PASTE button of the
character palette
<Insert>
Same function as the INS button of the char-
acter palette
<Delete>
Same function as the DEL button of the char-
acter palette
<Home>
Moves the input location in the box to the
beginning
<End>
Moves the input location in the box to after the
last-input character
<BackSpace>
Deletes the preceding character that was
input in the box (Backspace)
<Tab>
Switches to the next screen within the same
function
<Shift> + <Tab>
Switches to the previous screen within the
same function
<Esc>
Accesses the function menu (if the function
menu is already displayed, recalls the last-dis-
played screen)
<Alt> +
<0>–<9>
Switch screens within the same function
Key Function
<0>–<9>
Input a scene number (if the PREFERENCE 1
screen item USE NUMERIC-KEYPAD is on),
input numerical values (if off)
<.>
Returns the scene selection number to the
number of the scene that was last recalled or
stored
<+>
Same function as the [π] key of the SCENE
MEMORY section
<->
Same function as the [] key of the SCENE
MEMORY section
</>, <*> Not used
<Enter>
Same function as the [RECALL] key of the
SCENE MEMORY section (if the PREFER-
ENCE 1 screen item USE NUMERIC-KEY-
PAD is on), same function as the [ENTER] key
(when off)
Key Function
3 Basic operation on the PM5D
22 PM5D/PM5D-RH Owner’s Manual Operating section
Basic operation
This section explains the basic procedures you can perform in the PM5D’s display. In general, you will perform operations in
the PM5D’s display by combining the operations described here.
Moving the pointer to a specific parameter in the screen
and pressing the left/right track pad button (or the left/
right mouse button) is called “clicking.” Clicking is mainly
used to turn an on-screen button on/off, to move the cur-
sor, or to make fine adjustments to a value.
Using the CURSOR []/[®]/[π]/[] keys of the data
entry section to move the cursor to a desired parameter
and then pressing the [ENTER] key is equivalent to click-
ing. If you are using a PS/2 keyboard, you can perform the
same action using the arrow keys and the <Enter> key.
Subsequently in this manual, this operation will simply be
called “clicking.”
Hint
When using the track pad, you can
move the pointer to the desired param-
eter and then tap the track pad to
obtain the same result as if you
pressed the left button. (This is called
the Tapping function.) If you want to
use the tapping function, you must
enable it in the PREFERENCE 2
screen (UTILITY function) (
p.188).
Moving the pointer to a specific parameter in the screen
and then holding down the left/right track pad (or mouse)
button while moving up/down/left/right is called “drag-
ging.” Dragging is used mainly to adjust the value of a
knob or fader.
Using the CURSOR []/[®]/[π]/[] keys of the data
entry section to move the cursor to a desired parameter
and then turning the [DATA ] encoder (or pressing the
[DEC/CANCEL]/[INC/OK] keys) is equivalent to drag-
ging. If you are using a PS/2 keyboard, you can perform the
same action using the arrow keys and the <PageUp>/
<PageDown> keys (or keys that have the same function).
Subsequently in this manual, this operation will simply be
called “dragging.”
Moving the mouse pointer to a specific parameter in the
screen, dragging to another location in the screen, and then
releasing your finger is called “dragging and dropping.”
Dragging and dropping is used to copy EQ or compressor
settings to another channel. Dragging and dropping can-
not be performed using the CURSOR keys or keyboard.
Subsequently in this manual, this operation will be called
“dragging and dropping.”
Click
Click
Click
Track pad Mouse
Track pad
Tapping
Drag
Drag
Drag
While pressing
Track pad Mouse
Drag and drop
PM5D/PM5D-RH Owner’s Manual Operating section 23
3
Basic operation on the PM5D
A desired function/screen can be accessed in the display
using either of the following two methods.
Using the keys of the DISPLAY ACCESS
section
1
From the keys of the DISPLAY ACCESS section,
press the key corresponding to the desired
function.
The most recently operated screen for that function
will appear.
2
If you want to switch to another screen within
that function, press the same key you pressed
in step 1.
If you repeatedly press a key in the DISPLAY ACCESS
section, or hold down the [SHIFT] key of the data
entry section and press the same key as in step 1, you
will return to the preceding screen of the same
function.
Using buttons within the display
1
In any screen, click the function name area
located in the upper left of the screen.
When you click the function name area, the function
menu screen will appear. This screen is the starting
point from which you can access the desired screen via
operations in the display.
2
In the function menu screen, click the button
corresponding to the desired function.
The most recently operated screen for that function
will appear.
3
Click a tab in the screen to select the desired
screen.
Hint
By clicking the buttons located below
the function name area you can switch backward through the
screens that had been previously displayed for at least two
seconds (not including the function menu). Up to the eight
most recent screens are remembered.
To select a parameter, use the data entry section’s control-
lers or a PS/2 keyboard to move the cursor (the red frame).
Hint
If you are using a mouse or the track pad, the cursor will move
when you click on the button or knob of the desired
parameter.
1
Use the CURSOR []/[®]/[π]/[] keys to
move the cursor.
The cursor in the display will move in the direction of
the key you pressed. However, it will not move if there
is no parameter in the direction of that key.
Accessing a desired screen
Click the function name area
Click a tab
Moving the cursor
Move to the adjacent grid
3 Basic operation on the PM5D
24 PM5D/PM5D-RH Owner’s Manual Operating section
2
To move quickly to the outer edge of the cur-
rent window or to a different window, hold
down the [SHIFT] key and use the CURSOR
[]/[®]/[π]/[] keys.
You will move from the scroll window in which the
cursor is currently located, in the direction of the key
you pressed.
Hint
If the cursor is located on a grid such as in a PATCH screen,
turning the [DATA] encoder clockwise will move the cursor
toward the right, and turning it counterclockwise will move the
cursor toward the left. If you are holding down the [SHIFT]
key, turning the [DATA] encoder clockwise will move the cur-
sor downward, and turning it counterclockwise will move the
cursor upward.
A scroll bar is displayed if there are more items than can be
shown in a single screen. To scroll the screen, drag the box
shown in the bar.
You can also scroll the screen by clicking the vacant por-
tion of the scroll bar or the / buttons or /
buttons located at the ends of the scroll bar.
If you move the cursor to the scroll bar
and press the [DEC/CANCEL] key or
turn the [DATA] encoder counterclock-
wise, the screen will scroll toward the left
(or upward, in the case of vertical scroll-
ing). If you press the [INC/OK] key or
turn the [DATA] encoder clockwise, the screen will scroll
toward the right (or downward, in the case of vertical
scrolling).
Hint
If the cursor is located at the scroll bar box, holding down the
[SHIFT] key and turning the [DATA] encoder will have the
same result as clicking the button or button, depend-
ing on the direction in which you turn the encoder.
[SHIFT] key
+
CURSOR [®] key
Scrolling the screen
Drag
Click these buttons to move the
scroll bar box step-wise in the
direction indicated. Clicking the
/ buttons will move in larger
steps than clicking the /
buttons.
Click in these areas to
make the scroll bar box
move by a large step in the
corresponding direction;
the screen will scroll
accordingly.
PM5D/PM5D-RH Owner’s Manual Operating section 25
3
Basic operation on the PM5D
Buttons in the display are used to switch parameters on/off
or to select one of multiple choices.
1
Move the pointer to the desired button, and
use the left/right buttons of the track pad (or
mouse) to click the button.
The button will be switched on/off (or the correspond-
ing button will be selected).
Hint
You can use the CURSOR [
]/[
®
]/[
π
]/[
] keys and the
[ENTER] key (or the arrow keys and <Enter> key of a PS/2
keyboard) to perform the equivalent operation.
Hint
When using the track pad, you can also click by tapping the
track pad if you have enabled tapping in the PREFERENCE 2
screen (UTILITY function
p.188). In this case, the result will
be the same as if you pressed the left button of the track pad
(or mouse).
Knobs and faders in the display are used to adjust the value
of specific parameters.
1
Move the pointer to the desired knob/fader,
and use the left/right buttons of the track pad
(or mouse) to click the knob/fader.
The cursor will move to that location.
2
To increase or decrease the value in steps of 1,
click the right button or left button of the
track pad (or mouse).
Clicking the right button will raise the value by one
step, and clicking the left button will lower the value by
one step.
3
To raise or lower the value continuously, use
the track pad (or mouse) to drag the knob/
fader.
The value will change as you drag the knob or fader
left/right or up/down. For a parameter whose knob has
a wide range of adjustment, holding down the right
button of the track pad (or mouse) as you drag will
produce a larger range of change than when using the
left button.
Hint
You can also adjust the value by using the [DEC/CANCEL]/
[INC/OK] keys, the [DATA] encoder, or the <PageUp>/<Page-
Down> keys of a PS/2 keyboard. When adjusting a parameter
that has a wide range of adjustment, you can increase the rate
of change by holding down the [SHIFT] key while you press
the [DEC/CANCEL]/[INC/OK] keys (or turn the [DATA]
encoder).
Operating the buttons
Click
Off On
Adjusting the setting of a knob or
fader
Adjust the
knob value
Adjust the
fader value
3 Basic operation on the PM5D
26 PM5D/PM5D-RH Owner’s Manual Operating section
On the PM5D you can assign a four-character name to
each input channel or DCA group, and assign a title to
scene and library data when saving it.
For example, the screen shown below is the LIBRARY
STORE window that appears when you assign a name to
the INPUT EQ library. To input characters in this screen,
use the following procedure.
1
Use the character palette (or a PS/2 key-
board) to input a character.
When you click the character palette, a character will
be input in the box, and the highlighted area will move
to the right.
2
Input the subsequent characters in the same
way.
When inputting characters, you can use the following
buttons in the character palette.
Note
Copy/paste operations are not possible in some screens.
There are also cases in which the paste operation cannot be
performed due to the type of character string copied to the
buffer memory.
3
When you have finished inputting the name,
click the STORE button.
The name you input will be stored.
Hint
In general, the same procedure applies in screens where
you enter names for scenes or other library items.
If a PS/2 keyboard is connected, you can use it to enter
characters.
If you move the cursor to the text input box and press the
[ENTER] key (or click), the input position will move to that
point. If the cursor is located at the text input box, you can
step through the available characters by turning the [DATA]
encoder. If the cursor is located elsewhere, turning the
[DATA] encoder will move the selected position. The [INC]/
[DEC] keys move the selected position regardless of where
the cursor is located.
Note
The number of characters that can be input will depend on the
type of data (scene/library) you are saving. You cannot input
more than the specified number of characters, or move the
highlighted area beyond that range.
INS button
Inserts a space (blank) at the high-
lighted position. Pressing the
<Insert> key of a PS/2 keyboard will
produce the same result.
DEL button
Deletes the character at the high-
lighted position. Pressing the
<Delete> key of a PS/2 keyboard will
produce the same result.
CLEAR button
Deletes all characters that have been
input in the text input box.
buttons
Move the highlighted area to left or
right.
PASTE button
Pastes the character string that was
copied to buffer memory by the
COPY button. Holding down the
<Ctrl> key and pressing the <V> key
of a PS/2 keyboard will produce the
same result.
COPY button
Copies the character string in the box
to a temporary buffer memory. Hold-
ing down the <Ctrl> key and pressing
the <C> key of a PS/2 keyboard will
produce the same result.
CAPS LOCK button
Switches between uppercase and
lowercase alphabetical characters.
Uppercase characters can be input
while this button is on.
Assigning a name
PM5D/PM5D-RH Owner’s Manual Operating section 27
4
Connections and setup
This chapter explains how to make audio input/output connections, and how to perform the setup
required when starting the PM5D for the first time.
Audio connections
PM5D model
INPUT jacks 1–48 are used mainly to connect micro-
phones or monaural line-level devices. ST IN jacks 1–4 are
used mainly to connect stereo line-level devices.
Input signal sensitivity, pad on/off, and phantom power
(+48V) on/off are controlled from the top panel AD IN
section ( p.36).
PM5D-RH model
INPUT jacks 1–48 and ST IN jacks 1–4 can both be used to
connect microphones or line-level devices.
Input signal sensitivity and phantom power (+48V) on/off
are controlled from within the display ( p.36). However,
all phantom power can be switched on/off as a whole by
the rear panel [+48V MASTER] switch.
On either model, the default state is for the input signals
from INPUT jacks 1–48 to be patched to input channels 1–
48 and the input signals from ST IN jacks 1–4 to be
patched to the ST IN channels. However, this can be
changed if desired. (For details on returning the patching
to its default state p.32)
4 Connections and setup
Analog audio connections
Synthesizer Microphone
Effect processor
Synthesizer
MicrophoneMicrophone
4 Connections and setup
28 PM5D/PM5D-RH Owner’s Manual Operating section
MIX OUT jacks 1–24, MATRIX OUT jacks 1–8, and STE-
REO OUT A/B jacks respectively output the signal from
MIX channels 1–24, MATRIX channels 1–8, and the STE-
REO A/B channels.
The MONITOR OUT jacks output the monitor signal that
is selected in the top panel MONITOR section.
The CUE OUT jacks output the cue monitor signal of the
channel that is currently selected by its [CUE] key.
Analog output connections
L
A
C
RLRL
RLRL
87654321
MIX OUT MATRIX OUT
MONITOR OUT DC POWER INPUTCUE OUT
STEREO OUT
Monitor speakers Monitor speakers
PW800W power supply
Monitor speakers
(foldback)
Main speakers
Recorder, relay
vehicle, etc.
PM5D/PM5D-RH Owner’s Manual Operating section 29
4
Connections and setup
Use 2TR IN DIGITAL jacks 1–3 to connect digital sources
such as CD players or DAT recorders. (To input analog
output signals from a CD player or DAT recorder, use 2TR
IN ANALOG jacks 1/2.)
Use 2TR OUT DIGITAL jacks 1–3 to send the STEREO A/
B channel signals to a DAT recorder or other digital device.
By installing separately sold mini-YGDAI I/O cards in slots
1–4 you can add analog input/output jacks to the PM5D or
allow connection of digital devices such as digital MTR or
HDR units.
The following types of I/O card can be used.
Refer to the Yamaha Pro Audio global website for the most
recent information on I/O cards.
http://www.yamahaproaudio.com
Note
In order to send or receive digital audio via the 2TR IN DIGI-
TAL jacks, 2TR OUT DIGITAL jacks, or slots 1–4, the word
clock data of the respective signals must be synchronized
(
p.31).
In order to assign input signals from the 2TR IN DIGITAL
jacks, 2TR IN ANALOG jacks, or slots 1–4 to input channels
or ST IN channels, you will need to change the input patch-
ing (
p.66).
Digital input/output connections
N
R
L
R
L
SMPTE
USB
OUT IN
75
ON OFF
21
COAXIAL COAXIALAES/EBU AES/EBU AES/EBU AES/EBU
3
21
3
THRU OUT IN
DAT
00.00.00.00
2TR IN
ANALOG
2TR OUT
DIGITAL
2TR IN
DIGITAL
SLOT
CD player DAT recorder
Digital MTR/HDR
Digital I/O card
Card type Model
Number of
channels
Digital
format
Bit
depth
AD card
MY4-AD 4
24 bit
MY8-AD
8
20 bit
MY8-AD24
24 bit
MY8-AD96
DA card
MY4-DA 4
20 bit
MY8-DA96 8 24 bit
Digital I/O card
MY8-AE
8
AES/EBU
24 bit
MY8-AE96
MY8-AE96S
MY16-AE 16
MY8-AT 8
ADAT
MY16-AT 16
MY8-TD 8
TASCAM
MY16-TD 16
CobraNet card MY16-C 16 CobraNet 24 bit
4 Connections and setup
30 PM5D/PM5D-RH Owner’s Manual Operating section
Before installing a card, you must check the Yamaha web-
site to make sure that this device is compatible with this
card, and to verify the number of cards that can be
installed in conjunction with other Yamaha or third-party
cards.
Yamaha website: http:www.yamahaproaudio.com
To install an optional mini-YGDAI card, proceed as
follows.
1
Make sure that the power is turned off.
2
Loosen the screws that hold the slot cover in
place, and remove the slot cover.
Keep the removed slot cover in a safe place.
3
Align the edges of the card with the guard
rails inside the slot, and insert the card into
the slot.
Push the card all the way into the slot so that the con-
nector at the end of the card is correctly mated with the
connector inside the slot.
4
Use the screws included with the card to fas-
ten the card in place.
Malfunctions or incorrect operation may occur if the
card is not fastened.
Installing an option card
21
COAXIAL
U
AES/EBU
AES/EBU AES/EBU
21
3
2
1
COAXIAL
U
AES/EBU
AES/EBU
AES/EBU
21
3
PM5D/PM5D-RH Owner’s Manual Operating section 31
4
Connections and setup
Word clock connections and settings
This section explains the word clock settings required in order to send or receive digital audio between the PM5D and an
external digital device.
When digital audio signals are being sent or received
between multiple devices, the devices must process the
audio signals at the matching timing. For example if the
audio signal processing is not synchronized, the signals will
not be transmitted correctly and unpleasant noise will
occur even if both devices are set to the same sampling
frequency.
The signal used to synchronize digital audio signal process-
ing is called “word clock.” Normally, one device transmits
a reference word clock signal, and the other devices receive
this word clock signal and synchronize to it. (The transmit-
ting device is called the “word clock master” and the
receiving devices are called “word clock slaves.”)
The word clock can be synchronized between the PM5D
and external devices in either of two ways; you can send/
receive a word clock signal by itself, or use the clock data
that is included in a digital audio signal.
The WORD CLOCK IN/OUT connectors on the rear
panel of the PM5D are used to send/receive a word clock
signal by itself. In general, word clock connections can be
made in either of the following two ways.
Using daisy-chain connections
In this method, the signal is distributed sequentially; the
WORD CLOCK OUT connector of the first device is con-
nected to the WORD CLOCK IN connector of the second
device, and so on. Turn ON all of the 75 ON/OFF
switches. This method is not recommended for large
systems.
Using a word clock distribution box
In this method, a special word clock distribution box is
used to distribute the signal from the word clock master to
multiple word clock slaves. Turn ON all of the 75 ON/
OFF switches.
If an external device does not have WORD CLOCK IN/
OUT connectors, the clock data included in the digital
audio signal is used. In this case, both the digital audio sig-
nal and the clock data are sent from the DIGITAL OUT
jack of the word clock master to the DIGITAL IN jack of
the word clock slave.
When digitally connecting the PM5D to an external device,
you must select the source that will be the word clock mas-
ter for the system.
1
Repeatedly press the [SYS/W.CLOCK] key of
the DISPLAY ACCESS section until the WORD
CLOCK screen appears.
In this screen you can select the master clock, and
check the input signal synchronization status for each
slot or jack.
Note
When you switch the word clock source, noise may occur due
to loss of synchronization. You must lower the level of your
monitoring equipment before you perform the following
operation.
About word clock
WC IN
(BNC)
WC OUT
(BNC)
WC OUT (BNC)
WC IN
(BNC)
WC IN
(BNC)
WC OUT
(BNC)
75 ON/OFF= ON
75 ON/OFF= ON 75 ON/OFF= ON 75 ON/OFF= ON
Word clock
master
Device A
Word clock
slave
Device B
Word clock
slave
Device C
Word clock
slave
WC OUT
(BNC)
WC IN (BNC) WC IN (BNC) WC IN (BNC) WC IN (BNC)
75 ON/OFF= ON
75 ON/OFF= ON 75 ON/OFF= ON75 ON/OFF= ON 75 ON/OFF= ON
Word clock
master
Device A
Word clock
slave
Word clock
distribution box
Device B
Word clock
slave
Device C
Word clock
slave
Device D
Word clock
slave
DIGITAL
OUT
DIGITAL
IN
Digital audio signal
+
Clock data
Device A
Word clock
master
Device B
Word clock
slave
Selecting the word clock master
WORD CLOCK MASTER CLOCK SELECT area
4 Connections and setup
32 PM5D/PM5D-RH Owner’s Manual Operating section
Use the MASTER CLOCK SELECT area located in the
upper part of the screen to select the master clock
source. You can choose one of the following sources.
Note
Sources for which the symbol at the left of the button is red
(UNLOCK) or yellow (UNKNOWN) cannot be selected, since
a valid clock is not being input or the clock cannot be
detected.
2
In the MASTER CLOCK SELECT area located in
the upper part of the screen, click a button to
select the desired master clock source.
A window will appear, asking you to confirm that you
want to switch the master clock.
3
Click the OK button.
The selected word clock master will be enabled. The
selected word clock master is remembered even if you
turn off the power. As long as the connections have not
been changed, you don’t have to make this setting
again.
Note
If a digital I/O card (such as the MY8-AE96S) that contains a
built-in SRC (Sampling Rate Converter) is installed in slots
1–4, you can switch the SRC on/off in groups of two chan-
nels. The input signals from channels for which the SRC is
turned on do not need to be synchronized with the PM5D’s
word clock.
If transferring high sampling rate (88.2 kHz/96 kHz) signals
between the PM5D and an external device, you will need to
select the transmission method. (For details, refer to p.200)
Restoring the current scene to the default state
When the PM5D is in its default state, the input signals
from INPUT jacks 1–48 are patched to input channels 1–
48 and the input signals from ST IN jacks 1–4 are patched
to the ST IN channels, and can then be output via the STE-
REO bus or MIX buses.
However, if the PM5D’s internal mix parameter settings
(referred to as the “current scene”) have been modified,
the signal of a specific input may not be sent to an input
channel, or the EQ or dynamics processors may be set to
produce extreme effects.
To initialize the mix parameters from such a state, proceed
as follows.
1
Use the SCENE [π]/[] keys of the SCENE
MEMORY section to make the scene number
indicator show “000”.
Scene number “000” is a scene memory containing the
default settings.
2
Press the [RECALL] key of the SCENE MEM-
ORY section.
Scene number “000” will be loaded, and the current
scene will return to the default state.
Note
Be aware that when scene number “000” is loaded, the input
patch, output patch, internal effect, and HA (Head Amp) set-
tings will also return to their default state. (However, the word
clock master selection is not affected.)
INT 96, INT 88.2,
INT 48, INT 44.1
These settings select the PM5D’s inter-
nal clock. If you select one of these set-
tings, the PM5D will operate as the
word clock master. As necessary,
make settings within your external
devices so that they will operate as
word clock slaves.
W.CLOCK IN
The PM5D will follow the word clock
signal being input from the rear panel
WORD CLOCK IN connector.
CASCADE IN
The PM5D will follow the clock data
being sent from another PM5D con-
nected to the CASCADE IN connector.
2TR IN D1–D3
The PM5D will follow the clock data
included in the input signal from 2TR
IN DIGITAL jacks 1–3.
SLOT 1–4
The PM5D will follow the clock data
included in the input signal from a digi-
tal I/O card installed in slots 1–4. (You
can select a specific pair of adjacent
odd-numbered/even-numbered chan-
nels.)
Scene number
indicator
SCENE [π]/[]
keys
PM5D/PM5D-RH Owner’s Manual Operating section 33
5
Input channel operations
This chapter explains the functions and operation of each section related to input channels.
About the input channels
The input channel section processes the signals that are input via the input patch section, and outputs them to the STEREO
buses or MIX buses. There are three types of input channel, as follows.
Input channels 1–48
These channels are used to process monaural signals. When the input patching is in the default state, the input signals from
INPUT jacks 1–48 are assigned to these channels.
ST IN channels 1–4
These channels are used to process stereo signals. When the input patching is in the default state, the input signals from ST IN
jacks 1–4 are assigned to these channels.
5 Input channel operations
5 Input channel operations
34 PM5D/PM5D-RH Owner’s Manual Operating section
FX RTN channels 1–4
These channels are used mainly to process the return signals (stereo) from the internal effects. When the input patching is in
the default state, the left/right channels of internal effects 1–4 are assigned to these channels.
INPUT PATCH
This assigns an input signal to the input channel.
•ø (Phase)
Switches the phase of the input signal.
MS DECODE (Input channels / ST IN channels
only)
Switches MS decode processing on/off when an MS
mic is connected.
ATT (Attenuator)
Attenuates/boosts the level of the input signal.
HPF (High Pass Filter)
This is a high pass filter that cuts the region below the
specified frequency.
•4 BAND EQ (4 band equalizer)
A parametric EQ with four bands; HIGH, HIGH MID,
LOW MID, and LOW.
GATE (Input channels and ST IN channels only)
This is a dynamics processor that can be used for gat-
ing or ducking.
COMP (Compressor) (Input channels and ST IN
channels only)
This is a dynamics processor that can be used as a com-
pressor, expander, or limiter.
INPUT DELAY (Input channels and ST IN channels
only)
This delays the input signal. It can be used to make fine
adjustments in the relative timing between channels.
LEVEL/DCA 1-8
Adjusts the input level of the effect.
ON (On/off)
Turns the input channel on/off. If off, that channel is
muted.
PAN
Adjusts the panning of the signal sent from the input
channel to the STEREO bus. If necessary, this pan set-
ting can also be applied to signals sent to two paired
MIX buses.
LCR (Left/Center/Right)
Sends the three-channel signal (left/right channels and
a center channel) to the STEREO bus.
MIX 1-24 (Mix send level 1–24)
Adjusts the send level of the signal sent from the input
channel to MIX buses 1–24. As the position from
which the signal is sent to the MIX bus, you can choose
from the following; immediately before the 4-band EQ,
pre-fader, or post-fader.
INSERT (Input channels and ST IN channels only)
Here you can patch the desired output port and input
port to insert-out/insert-in, allowing an external effect
processor or other device to be inserted. You can
switch the insert-out and insert-in locations.
DIRECT OUT (Input channel and ST IN channels
only)
This can be patched to an output port, and the input
signal sent directly from that output port.
METER
This meters the level of the input channel. The level
detection point can be switched.
Note
The signal assignments from input patch to input channel can
be edited in the INPUT PATCH function INPUT PATCH
screen.
To edit the parameters of an input channel, you can either
use the panel controllers (e.g., INPUT channel strip, ST
IN/FX RTN channel strip, SELECTED CHANNEL sec-
tion), or access the appropriate screen in the display and
edit the parameters in the screen.
PM5D/PM5D-RH Owner’s Manual Operating section 35
5
Input channel operations
AD IN section
The AD IN section AD-converts the signals that are input from the rear panel INPUT jacks 1–48 and ST IN jacks 1–4, and
sends them to the input patch section. The structure of this section differs between the PM5D model and the PM5D-RH
model.
PM5D model
A [+48V ON/OFF] switch
If this switch is on, +48V is supplied to the condenser
mic or direct box connected to the INPUT jack 1–48.
B [PAD] switch
If this switch is on, the input level is attenuated by
26 dB.
C [GAIN] knob
Adjusts the input sensitivity of the input channel. The
range of adjustment is –34 dBu to +10 dBu (when the
PAD switch is on) or –60 dBu to –16 dBu (when the
PAD switch is off).
D [PEAK]/[SIGNAL] LED
The [SIGNAL] LED will light when the input level
reaches 14 dB below nominal level (i.e., 34 dB below
clipping level). The [PEAK] indicator will light when
the signal reaches 3 dB below clipping level.
E [INSERT ON/OFF] switch
This switch enables/disables the INSERT IN/OUT jack
located on the rear panel.
F ST IN [GAIN] knob
Adjusts the input sensitivity of the ST IN channel. The
range of adjustment is –34 dBu to +10 dBu.
G ST IN [PEAK]/ST IN [SIGNAL] LED
The ST IN [SIGNAL] LED will light when the input
level of the ST IN channel reaches 14 dB below nomi-
nal level (34 dB below clipping level). The ST IN
[PEAK] indicator will light when the signal reaches
3 dB below clipping level.
H [LAMP DIMMER] knob
This adjusts the brightness of the lamp connected to
the LAMP connector.
PM5D model
PM5D-RH model
Items in the AD IN section
5
3
2
1
4
7
8
6
5 Input channel operations
36 PM5D/PM5D-RH Owner’s Manual Operating section
PM5D-RH model
A [+48V ON/OFF] LED
This LED will light if phantom power (+48V) is being
supplied to the corresponding INPUT jacks 1–48 or ST
IN jacks 1–4. However, +48V will not be supplied
unless the rear panel [+48V MASTER] switch is on.
B [PEAK]/[SIGNAL] LED
The [SIGNAL] LED will light when the input level
reaches 14 dB below nominal level (i.e., 34 dB below
clipping level). The [PEAK] indicator will light when
the signal reaches 3 dB below clipping level.
C [LAMP DIMMER] knob
This adjusts the brightness of the lamp connected to
the LAMP connector.
On the PM5D-RH model, the AD IN input signal sensitiv-
ity and phantom power (+48V) on/off setting for each
channel are controlled from within the display. However,
the rear panel [+48V MASTER] switch is the phantom
power master switch.
You can adjust the input sensitivity and switch phantom
power (+48V) on/off for the signals being input from
INPUT jacks 1–48 and ST IN jacks 1–4. These operations
are performed differently on the PM5D model and PM5D-
RH model.
Hint
Even if input channels are paired, head amp settings must be
made individually.
PM5D model
For the PM5D model, head amp settings are made using
the controls of the AD IN section of the panel ( p.35).
The input sensitivity is adjusted by the combination of
the [GAIN] knob setting and [PAN] switch on/off set-
ting for that jack.
To supply phantom power (+48V) to an INPUT jack
1–48, turn on the [+48V] switch corresponding to that
jack.
To enable an external device that is inserted into the
INSERT IN/OUT jacks, turn on the [INSERT] switch
corresponding to that jack.
PM5D-RH model
On the PM5D-RH model, head amp settings are made by
operations within the display.
1
Repeatedly press the [SYS/W.CLOCK] key of
the DISPLAY ACCESS section until the HA
screen appears.
2
In the screen, click the INTERNAL HA button.
The internal head amp settings for INPUT jacks 1–48
and ST IN jacks 1–4 will be displayed.
3
Use the buttons and knobs in the screen to
edit the head amp settings.
A +48V button
Click this button to switch phantom power (+48V) on/
off for that jack.
B GAIN knob
Drag this knob to adjust the input sensitivity of that
jack in a range of +10 dB to –62 dB.
C GANG button
If this button is on, the input sensitivity of two adja-
cent odd-numbered/even-numbered channels will
change in tandem, maintaining the current offset value.
When making these settings, the LEDs of the AD IN
section of the panel will indicate the input signal level
and the phantom power (+48V) on/off status.
Note
On the PM5D-RH model, head amp settings can also be
made from the HA/INSERT function CH 1-24 screen, CH
25-48 screen, or ST IN/FX RTN screen (
p.258).
Settings for an external head amp device (AD8HR) can also
be made from the screen in the same way as for the inter-
nal head amps.
1
2
3
Controlling the input sensitivity and
phantom power (+48V) of the head amp
HA
1
2
3
PM5D/PM5D-RH Owner’s Manual Operating section 37
5
Input channel operations
INPUT channel strip
The INPUT channel strip is the section where you can control the principal parameters of the input channels.
This section is layered as shown in the following diagram; choose the CH 1-24 layer when you want to control input channels
1–24, or the CH 25-48 layer when you want to control input channels 25–48.
A [CH 1-24]/[CH 25-48] keys
These keys select the layer (CH 1-24 or CH 25-48) con-
trolled by the INPUT channel strip. The LED of the
currently selected layer will light.
B [PRE] key
This selects the output location of the signal when send
level to MIX bus 1–24 is selected as the encoder func-
tion. The pre-fader signal is sent to the corresponding
MIX bus if this key is on, and the post-fader signal is
sent if this key is off.
C ENCODER [ON] key
This switches the function currently assigned to the
encoder on/off. By default, this switches the signal sent
from the input channel to MIX buses 1–24 on/off.
D Encoder
According to the selection in the ENCODER MODE
section / FADER FLIP section ( p.40), this encoder
adjusts the send level from the input channel to MIX
buses 1–24, the panning of the input channel, or the
level of the input channel in the layer that is not cur-
rently selected. By default, this adjusts the send level to
MIX buses 1–24.
E [SEL] key
This selects the input channel that you will control
from the SELECTED CHANNEL section or from
within the display.
F Name indicator
This displays the name that has been assigned to the
input channel.
G CH [ON] key
Switches the input channel on/off. If this key is off
(LED dark), no signal will be sent from that input
channel to the STEREO bus or MIX buses.
H Fader
This 100 mm fader adjusts the input level of the input
channel.
I [CUE] key
This key lets you cue-monitor the signal of the input
channel.
CH 1-24 layer
CH 25-48 layer
Items in the INPUT channel strip
4
3
2
5
6
7
8
9
1
J
K
L
M
P
N
O
5 Input channel operations
38 PM5D/PM5D-RH Owner’s Manual Operating section
J [TO ST] LED
This LED will light when the signal sent from the input
channel to the STEREO bus is on.
K [COMP] LED
This indicates the operational status of the compressor
for the input channel. This will be dark when the gain
reduction amount is 0 dB, dimly lit when it is 0–10 dB,
and lit when it is greater than 10 dB.
L [GATE] LED
This indicates the operational status of the gate for the
input channel. This will be dark when the gain reduc-
tion amount is 0 dB, dimly lit when it is 0–30 dB (or 0–
10 dB when ducking), and lit when greater than this.
M Meter LEDs
This is a six-point LED meter that indicates the input
level of the input channel. OVER indicates clipping
level, and –6 to –60 indicate the level of the signal rela-
tive to clipping level (0 dB). The level detection point
can be switched.
N DCA assign LEDs
The LED of the DCA group to which that input chan-
nel is assigned will light.
O MUTE assign LEDs
The LED of the mute group to which that input chan-
nel is assigned will light.
P [RCL SAFE]/[MUTE SAFE] LEDs
The corresponding LED will light when recall safe or
mute safe is enabled for the input channel.
PM5D/PM5D-RH Owner’s Manual Operating section 39
5
Input channel operations
ST IN/FX RTN channel strip
In this section you can control the ST IN channels and FX RTN channels.
This section is layered as shown in the diagram below; choose the ST IN layer when you want to control the ST IN channels,
or the FX RTN layer when you want to control the FX RTN channels.
A [ST IN 1-4]/[FX RTN 1-4] keys
These keys select the layer that will be controlled by the
ST IN/FX RTN channel strip. Press the [ST IN 1-4] key
to control ST IN channels 1–4, or press the [FX RTN 1-
4] key to control FX RTN channels 1–4.
Items
2P below are the same as in the INPUT channel
strip ( p.37). However since FX RTN channels do not
have a gate or compressor, the [GATE] LED (
L) and
[COMP] LED (
K) are not used.
B [PRE] key
C ENCODER [ON] key
D Encoder
E [SEL] key
F Name indicator
G CH [ON] key
H Fader
I [CUE] key
J [TO ST] LED
K [COMP] LED
L [GATE] LED
M Meter LEDs
N DCA assign LEDs
O MUTE assign LEDs
P [RCL SAFE]/[MUTE SAFE] LEDs
FX RTN 1-4 layer
ST IN 1-4 layer
Items in the ST IN/FX RTN channel
strip
8
7
6
5
1
9
4
2
3
M
P
O
N
J
K
L
5 Input channel operations
40 PM5D/PM5D-RH Owner’s Manual Operating section
FADER FLIP/ENCODER MODE section
In the FADER FLIP/ENCODER MODE section you can change the parameter that is assigned to the encoders, and exchange
the parameters assigned to the faders and encoders.
A FADER [FLIP] key
If this key is on, the parameters controlled by the fad-
ers and encoders will be exchanged.
B Encoder mode indicator
This indicates the number of the MIX bus (1–24)
selected by the MIX SEND SELECT keys (
6) or the
encoder function selected by keys
35.
C [PAN] key
This key selects pan (balance) as the parameter con-
trolled by the encoders. The encoder mode indicator
will indicate “Pn” while this key is on.
D [GAIN/ATT] key
This key selects input sensitivity to the internal head
amp (PM5D-RH model only) or external head amp
device (AD8HR or AD824) or attenuation immedi-
ately after AD conversion as the parameter controlled
by the encoders. The encoder mode indicator will indi-
cate “HA” (if input sensitivity to the head amp is
selected) or “At” (if attenuator is selected) while this
key is on.
E [ALT LAYER] key
This key selects “input level of the channel not
included in the currently selected layer” as the parame-
ter controlled by the encoders. The encoder mode
indicator will indicate “AL” while this key is on.
F MIX SEND SELECT [1]–[24] keys
These keys select the MIX bus (1–24) whose send level
will be controlled by the encoders. When you press one
of these keys, the LED of that key will light, and the
encoder mode indicator will show the number of the
MIX bus.
Hint
If you turn on any key
3
6
, the remaining keys will automati-
cally turn off.
Items in the FADER FLIP/ENCODER
MODE section
6
1
5432
PM5D/PM5D-RH Owner’s Manual Operating section 41
5
Input channel operations
Various operations for input channels
When the PM5D is in the default state, the encoders of the
INPUT channel strip and ST IN/FX RTN channel strip are
assigned to control send levels to MIX buses 1–24. How-
ever you can use the various ENCODER MODE keys to
select one of the following as the function of the encoders.
The currently selected function is shown by the key that is
lit and by the encoder mode indicator.
Repeatedly pressing the [PAN] key or [ALT LAYER] key
will alternate between the function selected by that key and
the MIX bus send level. Repeatedly pressing the [GAIN/
ATT] key will alternate between the following three
choices; input sensitivity to the internal head amp atten-
uator MIX bus send level.
Hint
If the FADER section [FLIP] key is on, the functions controlled
by the encoders and faders will be exchanged.
You can use the FADER [FLIP] key to exchange the func-
tions assigned to the faders and encoders of the channel
strip.
For example with the default setting (FADER [FLIP] key
off), the faders control the input channel input levels, and
the encoders control the send levels to the MIX buses. If
you then press the FADER [FLIP] key to make the LED
light, the faders will control the send levels to the MIX
buses and the encoders will control the input channel
input levels.
The function assigned to the controls when the [FLIP] key is on (LED lit) will depend on the current encoder mode as follows.
Note
The DCA channel strip and STEREO A/B channel strip are not affected by the on/off status of the [FLIP] key.
The Flip function cannot be used if PAN or GAIN/ATT is selected as the encoder mode. If you turn on the [FLIP] key in these modes, MIX
SEND will automatically be selected as the encoder mode, and then the fader and encoder parameters will be exchanged.
Key Encoder function Display
MIX SEND SELECT
[1]–[24] keys
Send levels to MIX buses 1–24 1–24
[PAN] key Pan (balance) Pn
[GAIN/ATT] key Head amp input sensitivity HA
[GAIN/ATT] key Attenuator At
[ALT LAYER] key
Input level for the currently un-
selected layer
*1
*1. In the INPUT channel strip, the CH 1-24 layer and the CH
25-48 layer are in a “front/rear” relation. In the ST IN/FX
RTN channel strip, the ST IN 1-4 layer and the FX RTN 1-4
layer are in a “front/rear” relation.
AL
Selecting the function of the encoders
Exchanging the fader and encoder
functions
Control the channel input
level and on/off status
Control the channel input
level and on/off status
Control the send level and on/off
status of the signal sent from the
channel to the MIX buses
Control the send level and on/off
status of the signal sent from the
channel to the MIX buses
[FLIP]
key
Encoder
mode
Function of each control
Encoder ENCODER [ON] key Fader CH [ON] key
Off
MIX
SEND
Send level from channel to
MIX bus
On/off status of signal sent
from channel to MIX bus
Channel (currently
selected layer) input level
Channel (currently
selected layer) on/off
PA NPan (balance)
On/off status of signal sent
from channel to STEREO
bus
GAIN/ATT
Head amp input sensitivity
/ attenuator
No function
ALT
LAYER
Channel (currently un-
selected layer) input level
Channel (currently un-
selected layer) on/off
On
MIX
SEND
Channel (currently
selected layer) input level
Channel (currently
selected layer) on/off
Send level from channel
(currently selected layer) to
MIX bus
On/off status of signal sent
from channel (currently
selected layer) to MIX bus
PA N
————
GAIN/ATT
ALT
LAYER
Send level from channel
(currently un-selected
layer) to MIX bus
On/off status of signal sent
from channel (currently un-
selected layer) to MIX bus
Send level from channel
(currently selected layer) to
MIX bus
On/off status of signal sent
from channel (currently
selected layer) to MIX bus
5 Input channel operations
42 PM5D/PM5D-RH Owner’s Manual Operating section
Here’s how to use the INPUT channel strip or ST IN/FX
RTN channel strip to send an input channel signal to the
STEREO bus. The explanation here uses the example of an
input channel, but the procedure is essentially identical
when using a ST IN channel or FX RTN channel.
1
Make sure that an input source is correctly
assigned to the input channel, and that the
head amp gain is set appropriately.
2
Make sure that the appropriate CH [ON] key is
turned on in the INPUT channel strip, and
press the [SEL] key for that channel to make it
light.
The [SEL] keys are used to select the channel you want
to control.
3
In the SELECTED CHANNEL section, press the
[TO STEREO] key to make it light.
In the SELECTED CHANNEL section you can make
detailed parameters settings for the channel currently
selected by its [SEL] key. (For details on the
SELECTED CHANNEL section p.57.)
When you turn on the [TO STEREO] key, the signal
sent from that input channel to the STEREO bus will
be turned on. At this time, the [TO ST] LED of the
INPUT channel strip will light.
4
Raise the corresponding fader of the INPUT
channel strip.
The level of the input signal is shown by the level meter
located at the right of the CH [ON] key.
5
Turn on the [PAN] key in the ENCODER MODE
section.
6
Use the encoder in the INPUT channel strip to
adjust the pan of the input channel.
Note
If you are sending the signal from a ST IN channel / FX RTN
channel to the STEREO bus, you can repeatedly press the
[SEL] key to switch between L/R channels, and make pan set-
tings for each channel.
7
In the STEREO A/B channel strip, turn the STE-
REO A [ON] key and STEREO B [ON] key on
(LED lit).
8
In the STEREO A/B channel strip, raise the
[STEREO A]/[STEREO B] faders.
The signal sent to the stereo bus will be routed through
the STEREO A/B channels and output from the STE-
REO OUT A/B jacks.
Sending a signal from an input chan-
nel to the STEREO bus
CH [ON] key
[SEL] key
Level meter
STEREO [PAN] encoder
[TO STEREO] key
STEREO B
[ON] key
STEREO A
[ON] key
STEREO A
fader
STEREO B
fader
PM5D/PM5D-RH Owner’s Manual Operating section 43
5
Input channel operations
Signals from input channels or ST IN/FX RTN channels
can be sent to the desired MIX bus. This can be done either
by specifying the send level sent from all input channels to
a specific MIX bus, or by specifying the send level sent
from a specific input channel to all MIX buses.
The explanation here uses an input channel as the send-
source, but the procedure is the same when using a ST IN
channel or FX RTN channel.
To send signals from all input channels to
a specific MIX bus
1
Use MIX SEND SELECT [1]–[24] keys of the
ENCODER MODE section to select the destina-
tion MIX bus.
The selected key will light, and the encoder mode indi-
cator will show the number of the destination MIX
bus. In this state, the encoders of the channel strip
adjust the send level to the MIX bus. Make sure that
the FADER [FLIP] key is dark.
2
Turn the encoders of the INPUT channel strip.
When MIX SEND is selected as the encoder mode, you
can use the encoders of the INPUT channel strip to
adjust the level of the signal that is sent to the currently
selected MIX bus from the corresponding input
channel.
The LEDs around the periphery of the encoder indi-
cate the approximate send level.
3
To turn off the signal sent from a specific
channel to the MIX bus, press the ENCODER
[ON] key for that channel to turn it off.
Press the same key once again to turn it back on.
Note
If the send-destination MIX bus is set to FIXED mode
(
p.44), the encoders have no effect; the signal can only be
switched on/off by the ENCODER [ON] key.
4
In the same way, select a different send-desti-
nation MIX bus, and use the encoders of the
INPUT channel strip to adjust the send levels
to it.
To send signals from a specific input chan-
nel to all MIX buses
1
Press a [SEL] key of the INPUT channel strip to
select the send-source channel.
2
In the MIX section, press the [MIX SEND] key
to make it light.
The MIX section lets you control the signals sent to
MIX buses 1–24 and the signals output from MIX
channels 1–24. (For details, refer to p.49)
When the [MIX SEND] key is lit, you can use the
encoders of the MIX section to control the send levels
from the currently selected input channel to MIX buses
1–24.
Hint
When the [MIX MASTER] key of the MIX section is lit, you can
hold down the [SEL] key of an input channel to make the [MIX
SEND] key light (the [MIX MASTER] key will go dark). In this
state, you can use the encoders of the MIX section to adjust
the send levels from the selected channel to MIX buses 1–24.
3
Turn the MIX encoders to adjust the send lev-
els to the MIX buses.
The LEDs around the periphery of the encoder indi-
cate the approximate send level.
Sending the signal from the input
channel to a MIX bus
Switches the sig-
nal sent from the
input channel to
the MIX bus on/
off.
Adjusts the send
level of the signal
sent from the
input channel to
the MIX bus.
MIX bus
Input channels
[MIX SEND] key [MIX MASTER] key
MIX [ON] key
MIX encoder
5 Input channel operations
44 PM5D/PM5D-RH Owner’s Manual Operating section
4
To turn off the signal sent from that channel
to a MIX bus, press the MIX [ON] key to turn it
off.
Press the MIX [ON] key once again to turn it back on.
Note
MIX buses can be switched (in units of two adjacent odd-num-
bered/even-numbered MIX buses) between VARI type (send
levels are variable) and FIXED type (send levels are fixed).
(For details on switching the type
p.274)
If the send-destination MIX bus is set to FIXED mode, the MIX
encoders have no effect; the signal can only be switched on/
off by the MIX [ON] key.
MIX bus
Input channels
Switches the sig-
nal sent from the
input channel to
the MIX bus on/
off.
Adjusts the send
level of the signal
sent from the
input channel to
the MIX bus.
MIX1
MIX2
STEREO L
STEREO R
……
……
FADER
INPUT CHANNEL 1
ON
ON
ON
PAN
MIX1 (VARI)
LEVEL
MIX2 (VARI)
LEVEL
FADER
INPUT CHANNEL 2
ON
ON
ON
PAN
MIX1 (VARI)
LEVEL
MIX2 (VARI)
LEVEL
When sending a signal from an input channel to
a VARI type MIX bus
MIX1
MIX2
STEREO L
STEREO R
……
……
FADER
INPUT CHANNEL 1
ON
ON
ON
PAN
MIX1 (FIX)
MIX2 (FIX)
FADER
INPUT CHANNEL 2
ON
ON
ON
PAN
MIX1 (FIX)
MIX2 (FIX)
When sending a signal from an input channel to
a FIXED type MIX bus
PM5D/PM5D-RH Owner’s Manual Operating section 45
5
Input channel operations
Monaural input channels can be paired to link their princi-
pal parameters. There are two types of pairing; you can use
only one type.
Horizontal pair mode
This mode pairs adjacent odd-numbered/even-num-
bered channels (default setting).
Vertical pair mode
This mode pairs channels of different layers that share
the same fader.
Hint
Input channels that are paired will have their parameters
linked except for head amp, delay, pan, attenuation, and
phase.
Using horizontal pairing
Here’s how to enable or defeat pairing for adjacent odd-
numbered/even-numbered channels.
1
To enable pairing, hold down the [SEL] key of
one of the adjacent odd-numbered/even-num-
bered channels, and press the [SEL] key of the
other channel.
The parameters of the channel you pressed first will be
copied to the subsequently-pressed channel.
Hint
The copy-source channel is determined by the order in which
you press the [SEL] keys. For example if you hold down the
channel 1 [SEL] key and press the channel 2 [SEL] key, the
channel 1 parameters will be copied to channel 2.
2
To defeat pairing, hold down the [SEL] key of
one of the paired channels and press the [SEL]
key of the other channel.
Note
If you are unable to enable/defeat pairing by using the above
procedure, make sure that PAIR SHORTCUT is turned on in
the UTILITY function PREFERENCE 1 screen (
p.187).
Using vertical pairing
Here’s how to enable or disable pairing for channels of dif-
ferent layers that share the same fader.
1
Repeatedly press the [SYS/W.CLOCK] key of
the DISPLAY ACCESS section until the MIXER
SETUP screen appears.
2
Click the VERTICAL PAIR button in the PAIR
MODE area to turn it on.
A window will appear, asking you to confirm that you
want to change the pair mode.
3
Click the OK button.
Now you can use “vertical pair” mode.
When you switch to “vertical pair” mode, new num-
bers will be assigned to the input channels. For details,
refer to p.200.
You can return to “horizontal pair mode” by clicking
the HORIZONTAL PAIR button to turn it on.
Enabling/disabling pairing
Horizontal pair
Ver tical pair
PAIR MODE area
VERTICAL PAIR button
MIXER SETUP
5 Input channel operations
46 PM5D/PM5D-RH Owner’s Manual Operating section
Hint
When you switch between vertical pair mode and horizontal
pair mode, the input channel numbers will change, but the
channel names and parameter values will not change.
4
Hold down the [SHIFT] key of the data entry
section, and press the [SEL] key of one of the
channels you want to pair.
A window will appear, allowing you to select how pair-
ing will be handled.
5
Click the appropriate button to choose the
source/destination for the parameters that will
be copied.
The channels will be paired as you specify.
Hint
If you click the RESET BOTH button, the parameters of both
channels will be reset to their default value.
6
To defeat pairing, hold down the [SHIFT] key
and press the [SEL] key of one of the channels.
A window will ask you to confirm that you want to
defeat pairing. Click the OK button to defeat pairing.
PM5D/PM5D-RH Owner’s Manual Operating section 47
6
Output channel operations
This chapter explains the functions and operation of each section related to output channels.
About the output channels
Output channels mix the signals sent from input channels etc., and send them to the corresponding output jacks or output
buses.
There are three types of output channel, as follows.
MIX channels 1–24
The signals sent from input channels to MIX buses are sent via these channels to MIX OUT jacks 1–24 or the STEREO/
MATRIX buses.
STEREO A/B channels
The signals sent from input channels or MIX channels are sent via these channels to STEREO OUT jacks A/B.
6 Output channel operations
6 Output channel operations
48 PM5D/PM5D-RH Owner’s Manual Operating section
MATRIX channels 1–8
The signals sent from MIX channels or STEREO A/B channels to MATRIX buses are sent via these channels to the MATRIX
OUT jacks.
•8 BAND EQ (8 band equalizer) (MIX channels and
STEREO A/B channels)
This is an eight-band (four upper bands + four lower
bands) parametric EQ.
•4 BAND EQ (4 band equalizer) (MATRIX channels)
This is a four-band (HIGH, HIGH MID, LOW MID,
LOW) parametric EQ.
COMP (Compressor)
This is a dynamics processor that can be used as a com-
pressor, expander, or limiter.
LEVEL
This adjusts the output level of the channel.
ON (On/off)
This switches the channel on/off. If this is off, that
channel will be muted.
OUTPUT DELAY
This delays the output signal. It can be used to make
fine adjustments in the relative timing between
channels.
OUT ATT. (Output attenuator)
This attenuates or boosts the level of the channel’s out-
put signal.
METER
This meter indicates the output level of the output
channel. The level detection point can be switched.
MIX to STEREO (MIX channels)
This is an on/off switch for the signal sent from the
MIX channel to the STEREO bus.
to MATRIX (MIX channels and STEREO A/B
channels)
This is an on/off switch for the signal sent from the
MIX channel to the MATRIX bus.
PAN (MIX channels)
This adjusts the panning of the signal sent from the
MIX channel to the STEREO bus.
BAL (Balance) (STEREO channels)
This adjusts the L/R volume balance of the STEREO
channel.
LCR (Left/Center/Right) (MIX channels)
This sends the three-channel signal (left/right channels
and a center channel) to the STEREO bus.
INSERT
Here you can patch the desired output port and input
port to insert-out/insert-in, allowing an external effect
processor or other device to be inserted. You can
switch the insert-out and insert-in locations.
Hint
MIX channels 1–24, STEREO A/B channels, and MATRIX
channels 1–8 are always connected to MIX OUT jacks 1–24,
STEREO OUT jacks A/B, and MATRIX OUT jacks 1–8
respectively. However, you can also make output patch set-
tings to send the signals of these output channels to slots 1–4
or the 2TR OUT DIGITAL jacks.
PM5D/PM5D-RH Owner’s Manual Operating section 49
6
Output channel operations
MIX section
The MIX section adjusts the send level of the signals sent from input channels to MIX buses, and adjusts the output level of
the MIX channels.
A [TO ST] LED
This LED will light when the signal sent from the MIX
channel to the STEREO bus is on.
B [TO MTRX] LED
This LED will light when the signal sent from the MIX
channel to the MATRIX bus is on.
C DCA group LEDs
The LED of the DCA group to which this MIX channel
is assigned will light.
D MIX [PAIR] LED
This LED will light if adjacent odd-numbered/even-
numbered MIX channels are paired.
E MIX [ON] key
If the [MIX SEND] key (9) is on, this switches the sig-
nal sent from the input channel to the MIX bus on/off.
If the [MIX MASTER] key (
J) is on, this switches the
MIX channel on/off.
F MIX encoder
If the [MIX SEND] key (9) is on, this adjusts the send
level to the MIX bus. If the [MIX MASTER] key (
J) is
on, this adjusts the output level of the MIX channel.
G MIX [CUE] key
This is used to monitor a MIX channel via the Cue
Monitor/Solo function.
H MIX [SEL] key
This selects the MIX channel to which operations in
the SELECTED CHANNEL section or in the display
will apply.
I [MIX SEND] key
J [MIX MASTER] key
These keys switch the operation of the MIX section.
When the [MIX SEND] key is on, you can use the con-
trols of the MIX section to edit the send level and on/
off status of the signal being sent from the currently
selected input channel to the MIX buses. Controls
other than
46 will have no effect.
When the [MIX MASTER] key is on, you can use the
controls of the MIX section to edit the output level and
on/off status of the MIX channels.
Sending signals from MIX channels to
output jacks
Here’s how a signal sent from an input channel to a MIX
bus can be sent from the corresponding MIX OUT jack.
1
Make sure that an appropriate signal is being
sent from an input channel to the MIX bus.
2
Press the [MIX MASTER] key in the MIX
section.
When this key is on, you can use the MIX section to
control the signals being sent from the MIX channels
to the MIX OUT jacks.
3
Turn on the MIX [ON] key for the MIX chan-
nel whose signal you want to output.
4
Turn the MIX encoder to adjust the output
level of the corresponding MIX channel.
The signal of the corresponding MIX channel will be
sent from the corresponding MIX OUT jack.
5
If you want the meters of the panel to indi-
cate the output level of the MIX channels,
press the [MIX/MATRIX] key of the meter
section.
The output level of the MIX channels will be shown by
the [INPUT/MIX] meters.
Items in the MIX section
9
124
J
7
5
8
6
3
Operations in the MIX section
MIX
PEAK
HOLD
CH 1 -24
24
OVER
-3
-6
-9
-12
-15
-18
-24
-30
-40
-50
-60
OVER
-3
-6
-9
-12
-15
-18
-24
-30
-40
-50
-60
2322212019181716151413121110987654321
ST IN/
/ST IN
MATRIX
INPUT/MIX meters
[MIX/MATRIX] key
6 Output channel operations
50 PM5D/PM5D-RH Owner’s Manual Operating section
Hint
The detection point (metering point) of the signal levels shown
in the meters can be changed if desired. For details, refer to
p.101.
Sending signals from MIX channels to
MATRIX buses
Here’s how a signal sent from an input channel to a MIX
bus can be output to a MATRIX bus. This can be done
either by specifying the send level sent from all MIX chan-
nels to a specific MATRIX bus, or by specifying the send
level sent from a specific MIX channel to all MATRIX
buses.
To send signals from all MIX channels to a
specific MATRIX bus
1
Make sure that appropriate signals are being
sent from input channels to the MIX buses.
2
Repeatedly press the [MATRIX/ST] key of the
DISPLAY ACCESS section to access the
MATRIX/ST ROUTING screen shown below.
3
Use the left/right scroll bar to display the MIX
channel that you want to send to the MATRIX
bus, and click the MIX TO MATRIX ON/OFF
button to turn it on.
The signal of the corresponding MIX channel is now
sent to the MATRIX bus.
Hint
You can use the PRE FADER/POST FADER buttons in the
MIX TO MATRIX area to change the send point (pre-fader/
post-fader) of the signal sent from the MIX channel to the
MATRIX bus.
4
Press the [MIX MASTER] key in the MIX
section.
5
Press and hold the MATRIX [SEL] key for the
send-destination MATRIX bus.
All MIX [SEL] keys will blink. As long as you hold
down the MATRIX [SEL] key, the MIX encoders 1–24
will respectively adjust the send levels from the MIX
channels to the currently selected MATRIX bus.
6
Continuing to hold down the MATRIX [SEL]
key, turn MIX encoders 1–24 to adjust the level
of the signal sent from each MIX channel to
the currently selected MATRIX bus.
The LEDs around the periphery of the MIX encoder
indicate the approximate level. When you take your
hand off the MATRIX [SEL] key, the encoders will
revert to their previous function.
Hint
You can fix the encoders in the above state by rapidly press-
ing the MATRIX [SEL] key twice. To return to the previous
state, press any MIX [SEL] key or MATRIX [SEL] key.
To send from a specific MIX channel to all
MATRIX buses
1
Make settings so that a signal is sent from the
desired MIX channel to a MATRIX bus, as
described in steps 1–3 of “To send signals from
all MIX channels to a specific MATRIX bus.”
2
Press the [MIX MASTER] key in the MIX
section.
3
Press and hold the MIX [SEL] key for the send-
source MIX channel.
All MATRIX [SEL] keys will blink. As long as you con-
tinue to hold down the MIX [SEL] key, MATRIX
encoders 1–8 will adjust the send levels sent from the
selected MIX channel to each MATRIX bus.
4
Continuing to hold down the MIX [SEL] key,
turn MATRIX encoders 1–8 to adjust the level
of the signal sent from the currently selected
MIX channel to the MATRIX buses.
The LEDs around the periphery of the MATRIX
encoder indicate the approximate send level. When
you take your hand off the MIX [SEL] key, the encod-
ers will revert to their previous function.
MIX channelsMIX TO MATRIX
ON/OFF buttons
MATRIX/ST ROUTING
Use the encoders of the MIX section to
adjust the send levels
PM5D/PM5D-RH Owner’s Manual Operating section 51
6
Output channel operations
Hint
You can fix the encoders in the above state by rapidly press-
ing the MIX [SEL] key twice. To return to the previous state,
press any MIX [SEL] key or MATRIX [SEL] key.
5
If you want the meters of the panel to indi-
cate the output level of the MIX channels,
press the [MIX/MATRIX] key of the meter
section.
Hint
The send levels from MIX channels to MATRIX buses can
also be edited in the display. For details, refer to p.238.
Sending signals from MIX channels to
the STEREO bus
Here’s how signals sent from input channels to MIX buses
can be output to the STEREO bus.
1
Make sure that appropriate signals are being
sent from input channels to the MIX buses.
2
Press the [MIX MASTER] key in the MIX
section.
3
Turn on the MIX [ON] key for the MIX chan-
nels whose signals you want to send to the
STEREO bus.
4
Press the MIX [SEL] key of the channel whose
signal you want to send to the STEREO bus,
and turn on the [TO STEREO] key of the
SELECTED CHANNEL section.
5
To adjust the pan of the signal sent from the
MIX channel to the STEREO bus, press the MIX
[SEL] key of the desired MIX channel and turn
the STEREO [PAN] encoder of the SELECTED
CHANNEL section.
6
Turn the MIX encoder to adjust the signal level
that is sent to the STEREO bus.
Hint
You can also switch the output to the STEREO bus on/off and
adjust the pan from within the MATRIX/ST ROUTING screen
(MATRIX/ST function). If desired, the send position (post fader
or post ON key) for the signal sent from the MIX channel to
the STEREO bus can also be changed in this screen
(
p.239).
7
In the STEREO A/B channel strip, turn the STE-
REO A [ON] key and STEREO B [ON] key on
(LED lit).
8
In the STEREO A/B channel strip, raise the
[STEREO A]/[STEREO B] faders.
The signal sent from the MIX channel to the STEREO
bus will be sent from STEREO OUT jacks A/B.
The level of the signal output from the STEREO A/B
channels is shown by the [MASTER] meters in the
meter section.
Pairing MIX channels
Adjacent odd-numbered/even-numbered MIX channels
can be paired. If two MIX channels are paired, their
parameters (with the exception of pan and delay) will be
linked.
1
Turn on the [MIX MASTER] key in the MIX
section.
2
Of the desired two adjacent odd-numbered/
even-numbered MIX channels, hold down the
MIX [SEL] key of one, and press the MIX [SEL]
key of the other.
The [PAIR] LED will light, and the MIX channels will
be paired. At this time, the parameters of the channel
whose MIX [SEL] key you pressed first will be copied
to the channel whose MIX [SEL] key you pressed later.
For example if you pressed the keys in the order of
MIX channel 1 MIX channel 2, the parameters of
MIX channel 1 will be copied to MIX channel 2.
3
To defeat pairing, hold down the MIX [SEL]
key of one of the paired MIX channels and
press the MIX [SEL] key of the other channel.
When MIX channels are paired, the signal flow will
change as follows.
Use the encoders of the MATRIX section to
adjust the send level
STEREO [PAN] encoder
[TO STEREO] key
6 Output channel operations
52 PM5D/PM5D-RH Owner’s Manual Operating section
Signals sent from an input channel to a
VARI type MIX bus
If the VARI type MIX bus is not paired
When the [MIX SEND] key is on, the MIX encoders
will adjust the send level of the signals sent to the corre-
sponding MIX bus from the currently selected input
channel.
If the VARI type MIX bus is paired
When the [MIX SEND] key is on, MIX encoders of
odd-numbered channels will adjust the pan of the sig-
nal sent to the two MIX buses. MIX encoders of even-
numbered channels will adjust the shared send level for
the two MIX buses.
MIX channel output signals
If MIX channels are not paired
When the [MIX MASTER] key is on, the MIX encod-
ers will adjust the output level of the corresponding
MIX channels.
If MIX channels are paired
When the [MIX MASTER] key is on, the MIX encod-
ers of odd-numbered channels will adjust the volume
balance between paired MIX channels. The MIX
encoders of even-numbered channels will adjust the
shared level of the two paired channels.
Hint
MIX channel pairing status and output level/balance settings
can also be edited in the CH to MIX screen (
p.274) or
MATRIX/ST screen (
p.238).
MIX bus 1
SEND LEVEL
MIX bus 2
SEND LEVEL
MIX1
MIX2
STEREO L
STEREO R
……
……
FADER
INPUT CHANNEL
ON
ON
ON
PAN
MIX1 (VARI)
LEVEL
MIX2 (VARI)
LEVEL
LEVEL
MIX bus 1/2
SEND PAN
MIX bus 1/2
SEND LEVEL
MIX1
MIX2
STEREO L
STEREO R
……
……
FADER
INPUT CHANNEL
ON
ON
PAN
PAN
MIX1/2 (VARI)
LEVEL
MIX channel 1
OUTPUT
LEVEL
MIX channel 2
OUTPUT
LEVEL
OUTPUT LEVEL
MIX OUT 1
MIX 1
MIX CHANNEL
ON
OUTPUT LEVEL
MIX OUT 2
MIX 2
ON
MIX channel
1/2 BALANCE
MIX channel
1/2 OUTPUT
LEVEL
OUTPUT LEVEL
MIX OUT 1BALANCE
MIX 1
MIX CHANNEL
ON
MIX OUT 2
MIX 2
PM5D/PM5D-RH Owner’s Manual Operating section 53
6
Output channel operations
STEREO A/B channel strip
The STEREO A/B channel strip lets you send the signal of the STEREO A/B channels to the MATRIX bus, and adjust the out-
put level of the STEREO A/B channels.
A [TO MATRIX] LED
This LED will light when the signal sent from the STE-
REO channel to the MATRIX bus is on.
B [COMP] LED
This indicates the operating status of the compressor
for the STEREO channel. This will be dark when the
gain reduction amount is 0 dB, dimly lit when it is 0–
10 dB, and lit when it is greater than 10 dB.
C STEREO A/B [SEL] key
This selects the STEREO A or STEREO B L/R channels
for editing in the SELECTED CHANNEL section or
display. The L/R channels will alternate each time you
press the key.
D STEREO [MONO] key
This switches the STEREO B channel to monaural. The
status will alternate between monaural and stereo each
time you press the key.
E STEREO [ON] key
This switches the STEREO channel on/off. If this key is
off (LED dark), no signal will be output from that STE-
REO channel.
F STEREO fader
This 100 mm fader adjusts the output level of the STE-
REO channel.
G STEREO [CUE] key
This is used to monitor the STEREO A/B channel via
the Cue Monitor/Solo function.
Items in the STEREO A/B channel
strip
7
4
6
5
3
2
1
6 Output channel operations
54 PM5D/PM5D-RH Owner’s Manual Operating section
Sending signals from the STEREO A/B
channels to output jacks
Here’s how the signals sent from input channels or MIX
channels to the STEREO bus can be output from STEREO
OUT jacks A/B.
1
Make sure that appropriate signals are being
sent from the desired channels to the STEREO
bus.
2
Turn on the STEREO [ON] key of the STEREO
A/B channel strip.
3
Raise the [STEREO A]/[STEREO B] faders.
The signal of the STEREO A/B channels will be output
from STEREO OUT jacks A/B. The output level of the
STEREO A/B channels is shown by the [MASTER]
meters in the meter section.
Hint
Normally, the same signal is output from the STEREO A and
B channels. However you can also use the STEREO B chan-
nel as a Center channel for L/C/R three-channel playback
(
p.201, 242).
Sending signals from the STEREO A/B
channels to MATRIX buses
Here’s how the signal of the STEREO A/B channels can be
sent to the MATRIX buses.
1
Make sure that an appropriate signal is being
input to the STEREO bus.
2
Repeatedly press the [MATRIX/ST] key of the
DISPLAY ACCESS section to access the
MATRIX/ST ROUTING screen.
3
Use the left/right scroll bar to display the STE-
REO A/B channels, and click the MIX TO
MATRIX ON/OFF button to turn it on.
With these settings, the signal of the STEREO A/B
channels will be sent to the MATRIX channels.
4
Make sure that the STEREO A/B [ON] keys are
turned on in the STEREO A/B channel strip;
then hold down the STEREO A [SEL] key or
STEREO B [SEL] key.
While you continue holding down the key, all
MATRIX [SEL] keys will blink. In this condition, you
can use the MATRIX encoders to adjust the signal lev-
els sent from the STEREO A or B channel to the
MATRIX buses.
5
While continuing to hold down the STEREO A
[SEL] key or STEREO B [SEL] key, turn MATRIX
encoders 1–8 to adjust the signal level sent to
the MATRIX buses.
The LEDs around the periphery of the MATRIX
encoder indicate the approximate send level. When
you take your hand off the STEREO A [SEL] key or
STEREO B [SEL] key, the MATRIX encoders will
revert to their previous function.
Hint
You can also switch to the above state by rapidly pressing
the STEREO A [SEL] key or STEREO B [SEL] key twice. To
return to the previous state, press any [SEL] key.
Send levels from the STEREO A/B channels to the MATRIX
buses can also be adjusted from within the display
(
p.238).
Operations in the STEREO A/B chan-
nel strip
MASTER meters
MIX TO MATRIX
ON/OFF buttons
MATRIX/ST ROUTING
PM5D/PM5D-RH Owner’s Manual Operating section 55
6
Output channel operations
MATRIX section
In the MATRIX section you can adjust the send levels from MIX channels to MATRIX buses, and adjust the output level of
the MATRIX channels.
A DCA group LEDs
The LED of the DCA group to which this MATRIX
channel is assigned will light.
B MATRIX [PAIR] LED
This LED will light if adjacent odd-numbered/even-
numbered MATRIX channels are paired.
C MATRIX [ON] key
This switches the MATRIX channel on/off.
D MATRIX encoder
This adjusts the output level of the MATRIX channel.
E MATRIX [CUE] key
This is used to monitor a MATRIX channel via the Cue
Monitor/Solo function.
F MATRIX [SEL] key
This selects the MATRIX channel to which operations
in the SELECTED CHANNEL section or in the display
will apply.
Sending signals from the MATRIX sec-
tion to output jacks
Here’s how the signals sent from MIX channels or STE-
REO A/B channels to MATRIX buses can be sent to the
MATRIX OUT jacks.
1
Make sure that appropriate signals are being
sent from the MIX channels or STEREO A/B
channels to the MATRIX buses.
2
In the MATRIX section, press the MATRIX [ON]
buttons to turn the desired MATRIX chan-
nel(s) on.
3
Turn the encoders of the MATRIX section to
adjust the output level of the MATRIX
channels.
The signals sent to the MATRIX bus(es) will be sent
from the corresponding MATRIX OUT jack(s).
4
To check the output level of the MATRIX chan-
nels, press the [MIX/MATRIX] key in the meter
section.
The [ST IN/MATRIX] meters will show the output
levels.
Hint
The detection point (metering point) of the signal levels shown
in the meters can be changed if desired (
p.101).
Pairing the MATRIX section
Adjacent odd-numbered/even-numbered MATRIX chan-
nels can be paired if desired. If two channels are paired,
their parameters (with the exception of pan and delay) will
be linked.
1
In the MATRIX section, hold down the MATRIX
[SEL] key for one of two adjacent odd-num-
bered/even-numbered channels, and press the
MATRIX [SEL] key of the other channel.
The [PAIR] LED will light, and the MATRIX channels
will be paired. At this time, the parameters of the chan-
nel whose MATRIX [SEL] key you pressed first will be
copied to the channel whose MATRIX [SEL] key you
pressed later.
For example if you pressed the keys in the order of
MATRIX channel 1 MATRIX channel 2, the param-
eters of MATRIX channel 1 will be copied to MATRIX
channel 2.
2
To defeat pairing, hold down the [SEL] key of
one of the paired MATRIX channels and press
the [SEL] key of the other MATRIX channel.
When MATRIX channels are paired, the signal flow
will change as follows.
Items in the MATRIX section
5
3
6
4
12
Operations in the MATRIX section
OVER
-3
-6
-9
-12
-15
-18
-24
-30
-40
-50
-60
OVER
-3
-6
-9
-12
-15
-18
-24
-30
-40
-50
-60
1L 1R 2L 2R 3L 3R 4L 4R
MATRIX
ST IN / /
1 2 3 4 5 6 7 8
MIX
PEAK
HOLD
CH 1-24
ST IN/
/ST IN
MATRIX
ST/IN MATRIX meters
[MIX/MATRIX] key
6 Output channel operations
56 PM5D/PM5D-RH Owner’s Manual Operating section
Signals sent from MIX channels and STE-
REO A/B channels to MATRIX buses
If MATRIX channels are not paired
When you are holding down the [SEL] key of a spe-
cific MIX channel or STEREO A/B channel in order to
adjust the send levels from that channel to all MATRIX
buses, the MATRIX encoders will adjust the send level
to the corresponding MATRIX bus.
If MATRIX channels are paired
When you are holding down the [SEL] key of a spe-
cific MIX channel or STEREO A/B channel in order to
adjust the send levels from that channel to all MATRIX
buses, the MATRIX encoder of the odd-numbered
channel will adjust the pan of the signal sent to the two
MATRIX buses. The MATRIX encoder of the even-
numbered channel will adjust the send level shared by
the two MATRIX buses.
Hint
For details on how to send the signal of a specific MIX chan-
nel to all MATRIX buses, refer to p.50. For details on how to
send the signal from either the STEREO A or B channel to all
MATRIX buses, refer to p.54.
Output signals from MATRIX channels
If MATRIX channels are not paired
The MATRIX encoders adjust the output level of the
corresponding MATRIX channel.
If MATRIX channels are paired
MIX encoders of odd-numbered channels adjust the
volume balance between paired MATRIX channels.
MATRIX encoders of even-numbered channels will
adjust the shared level of the two paired channels.
Hint
You can access the MATRIX/ST ROUTING screen (MATRIX/
ST function) to see a list of the MATRIX channels in the dis-
play, and edit the pairing and other parameters. For details,
refer to p.238 of the Reference section.
……
MATRIX1
MATRIX2
FADER
MIX CHANNEL
ON
ON
ON
to
MATRIX1
LEVEL
to
MATRIX2
LEVEL
MATRIX 1
LEVEL
encoder
MATRIX 2
LEVEL
encoder
ON
ON
ON
PAN
to MATRIX 1/2
LEVEL
……
MATRIX1
MATRIX2
FADER
MIX CHANNEL
MATRIX 1/2
PA N encoder
MATRIX1/2
LEVEL
encoder
MATRIX chan-
nel 1 OUTPUT
LEVEL
encoder
MATRIX chan-
nel 2 OUTPUT
LEVEL
encoder
OUTPUT LEVEL
OUTPUT PATCH
MATRIX 1
MATRIX CHANNEL
ON
OUTPUT LEVEL
MATRIX 2
ON
MATRIX
channel 1/2
BALANCE
encoder
MATRIX
channel 1/2
OUTPUT
LEVEL
encoder
OUTPUT PATCH
MATRIX 1
MATRIX CHANNEL
MATRIX 2
OUTPUT LEVEL
BALANCE ON
PM5D/PM5D-RH Owner’s Manual Operating section 57
7
Using the Selected Channel section
This chapter explains how you can use the SELECTED CHANNEL section to control input chan-
nels and output channels.
About the SELECTED CHANNEL section
The SELECTED CHANNEL section lets you edit the mix parameters of the currently selected input channel or output chan-
nel; it corresponds to a channel module of a conventional analog mixer.
This section controls the channel that was last selected by pressing its [SEL] key. (In the case of an ST IN channel, FX TRN
channel, or STEREO A/B channel, you will select either the L or the R channel.) However, you will be able to edit essentially all
of the mix parameters (head amp settings, EQ/compressor/gate settings, output to the STEREO bus, DCA group and mute
group assignments, etc.) using panel controls.
Items in the SELECTED CHANNEL section
Here you can assign the currently selected channel to DCA
groups and mute groups. (For details on DCA groups and
mute groups p.74, 75)
A DCA [1]–[8] keys
These keys assign the selected channel to DCA groups
1–8. The key LED for the assigned DCA group(s) will
light.
Input channels can use DCA groups 1–8, and output
channels can use DCA groups 7/8. For DCA groups 7/
8, input channels and output channels can both exist in
the same-numbered group.
B MUTE [1]–[8] keys
These keys assign the selected channel to mute groups
1–8. The key LED for the assigned mute group(s) will
light.
Mute groups 1–8 allow you to mix input channels and
output channels.
C [RECALL SAFE] key
This key switches Recall Safe on/off for the selected
channel. If this key is on, the parameters of the corre-
sponding channel will not be affected when a scene is
recalled. The applicable parameters can be specified in
the RECALL SAFE screen (SCENE function)
( p.166).
D [MUTE SAFE] key
This key switches Mute Safe on/off for the selected
channel. If this key is on, the corresponding channel
will be temporarily excluded from mute groups.
E Level meter
This indicates the input/output level of the selected
channel.
7
Using the Selected Channel section
GROUP
3
4
5
1 2
7 Using the Selected Channel section
58 PM5D/PM5D-RH Owner’s Manual Operating section
Here you can select or copy channels.
A INPUT/OUTPUT indicators
These indicators show whether an input channel or
output channel is selected.
B Name indicator
This indicates the name of the selected channel.
C Number indicator
This is the number of the selected channel. For stereo
channels (ST IN, FX TRN, STEREO A/B), the number
and a character of “L” or “r” will appear, depending on
whether the L or R channel is selected. If a channel is
paired, the decimal point for the lowest place will light.
For a FX RTN channel, the LED for the highest place
will light.
D [PASTE] key
E [COPY] key
These keys are used to copy and paste channel data.
When you press the [COPY] key, the data of the cur-
rently selected channel will be copied into a memory
buffer; when you press the [PASTE] key, the data in the
memory buffer will be pasted into the currently
selected channel. You can specify the parameters that
will be copied in the INPUT VIEW function CH COPY
screen (for input channels) or the OUTPUT VIEW
function CH COPY screen (for output channels).
Note
If the buffer memory contains no data, or if the data in the
buffer memory is of a different type than the selected chan-
nel, a warning message will appear and the Paste operation
cannot be executed.
The data in the buffer memory is lost when the power is
turned off.
F CH [DEC] key
G CH [INC] key
The CH [DEC] key decrements the currently selected
channel number, and the CH [INC] key increments it.
Input channels 1–48
ST IN channels 1L/1R–4L/4R
FX RTN channels 1L/1R–4L/4R
MIX channels 1–24
MATRIX channels 1–8
STEREO A channel L/R
STEREO B channel L/R
Here you can edit delay-related parameters for the cur-
rently selected channel.
A DELAY [TIME] indicator
This indicates the currently specified delay time in
msec units. However in the case of one second, the
indicator will be “1...”.
B DELAY [TIME] encoder
This controls the delay time of the selected channel.
C DELAY [ON] key
This key switches delay on/off for the selected channel.
Channel Display
ST IN channel 1L./1r. – 4L./4r.
FX RTN channel 1.L./1.r. – 4.L./4.r.
STEREO A channel AL./Ar.
STEREO B channel BL./Br.
CHANNEL SELECT
4
5
7
6
1
2
3
DELAY
2
3
1
PM5D/PM5D-RH Owner’s Manual Operating section 59
7
Using the Selected Channel section
Here you can edit the head amp, post AD conversion
attenuator, and phase parameters for the currently selected
channel. This section is available only if an input channel is
selected.
A A[GAIN/ATT] key
This key selects the parameter that is controlled by the
[GAIN/ATT] encoder (
2).
[GAIN/ATT] key lit (Gain)
The encoder adjusts the input sensitivity of the inter-
nal head amp patched to the input channel (PM5D-
RH only) or of an external head amp that supports the
dedicated protocol (Yamaha AD8HR, AD824, etc.).
The range of adjustment is +10 to –62.
[GAIN/ATT] key dark (Attenuator)
The encoder controls the post AD conversion attenua-
tor of the input channel. The range of adjustment is
–96 to +24.
Note
Gain cannot be selected for channels to which an internal/
external head amp is not patched.
B [GAIN/ATT] encoder
According to the setting of the [GAIN/ATT] key (1),
this encoder controls either the input sensitivity of the
internal/external head amp patched to the input chan-
nel, or the attenuator following AD conversion.
The LEDs around the periphery will change as follows.
[GAIN/ATT] key lit (Gain)
[GAIN/ATT] key dark (Attenuator)
C [ø] key
This switches the phase of the selected input channel. If
this key is on, the phase will be reversed.
Here you can edit noise gate parameters for the selected
channel. This section is valid only if an input channel or ST
IN channel is selected.
A GATE GR meter
This meter indicates the amount of reduction pro-
duced by the gate of the selected channel.
B GATE [ON] key
Switches the gate on/off for the selected channel.
C GATE [ATTACK] indicator
Indicates the attack time of the gate in msec units.
D GATE [ATTACK] encoder
Specifies the attack time of the gate (the time from
when the signal exceeds the threshold until the gate
opens).
E GATE [HOLD] indicator
Indicates the hold time of the gate in msec units or sec
units (the indicator for the displayed unit will light).
F GATE [HOLD] encoder
Specifies the hold time of the gate (the time from when
the signal falls below the threshold until the gate
closes).
G GATE [DECAY] indicator
Indicates the decay time of the gate in msec units or sec
units.
H GATE [DECAY] encoder
Specifies the hold time of the gate (the time over which
the gate will close after the hold time has elapsed).
I GATE [THRESHOLD] encoder
Specifies the threshold level of the gate (the level at
which the gate will open or close). The gate will open
when the signal exceeds this level, and will close when
the signal falls below this level.
J GATE [RANGE] encoder
Specifies the amount of attenuation while the gate is
closed.
GAIN/ATTENUATION/ø (Gain /
Attenuation / Phase)
1
2
3
(attenuation)
+
(boost)
0
NOISE GATE
9
2
J
8
6
4
3
5
7
1
7 Using the Selected Channel section
60 PM5D/PM5D-RH Owner’s Manual Operating section
Here you can switch the on/off status of the signal sent
from the selected channel to the STEREO bus, and adjust
the pan.
A STEREO [PAN] encoder
The function of this encoder depends on the currently
selected channel, as follows.
B [TO STEREO] key
The function of this key depends on the currently
selected channel, as follows.
Here you can edit compressor parameters for the selected
channel. This section is available only if a channel other
than an FX RTN channel is selected.
A COMP GR meter
This meter indicates the amount of reduction pro-
duced by the compressor of the selected channel.
B COMP [ON] key
Switches the compressor on/off for the selected
channel.
C COMP [ATTACK] indicator
Indicates the attack time of the compressor in msec
units.
D COMP [ATTACK] encoder
Specifies the attack time of the compressor (the time
from when the signal exceeds the threshold level until
compression begins).
E COMP [RELEASE] indicator
Indicates the release time of the compressor in msec
units or sec units (the indicator for the displayed unit
will light).
F COMP [RELEASE] encoder
Specifies the release time of the compressor (the time
from when the signal falls below the threshold level
until compression is removed).
G COMP [RATIO] indicator
Indicates the compression ratio setting.
H COMP [RATIO] encoder
Specifies the compression ratio (the ratio at which the
input signal will be compressed when the signal
exceeds the threshold level).
I COMP [THRESHOLD] encoder
Specifies the threshold level of the compressor (the
level at which the compressor will operate). The input
signal will start being compressed when the signal
exceeds this level; compression will be removed when
the signal falls below this level.
Selected channel Function
Input channel
Adjusts the panning of the signal
sent from that channel to the STE-
REO bus.
ST IN channel
FX RTN channel
MIX channel
STEREO A/B channels
Adjusts the left/right balance of the
signal sent from the STEREO A/B
channels.
MATRIX channel No function.
Selected channel Function
Input channel
Functions as an on/off switch for
the signal sent from that channel
to the STEREO bus.
ST IN channel
FX RTN channel
MIX channel
STEREO A/B channels
No function.
MATRIX channel
STEREO
1
2
COMPRESSOR
9
2
J
8
6
4
3
5
7
1
PM5D/PM5D-RH Owner’s Manual Operating section 61
7
Using the Selected Channel section
J COMP [GAIN] encoder
Specifies the gain of the signal that has passed through
the compressor.
Here you can edit high pass filter parameters for the
selected channel. This section is available only if an input
channel is selected.
A HPF [FREQUENCY] encoder
Specifies the cutoff frequency of the high pass filter.
B HPF [FREQUENCY] indicator
Indicates the currently specified high pass filter cutoff
frequency, in units of Hz.
C HPF [ON] key
Switches the high pass filter on/off.
Here you can edit equalizer parameters for the selected
channel. The equalizer structure differs as follows between
input channels and output channels.
Input channels
You can use a four-band peak/dip type EQ (HIGH, HIGH
MID, LOW MID, LOW). The HIGH band can be switched
to an LPF or shelving type; the LOW band can be switched
to a shelving type.
Output channels
If a MIX channel or STEREO A/B is selected, you can use
an eight-band peak/dip type EQ. (Operation is divided into
UPPER and LOWER groups of four bands each.) For
MATRIX channels, you can use a four-band peak/dip type
EQ.
For any output channel, the HIGH band can be switched
to shelving or LPF. The LOW band can be switched to
shelving or HPF. For MIX channels and STEREO A/B
channels, this can be specified for UPPER and LOWER,
allowing you to apply shelving or filtering twice.
Hint
Input channels also provide an HPF that is independent of
the four-band EQ.
Output channels do not have an independent HPF, but
instead allow you to switch the LOW band type to HPF.
Switching the equalizer type to HPF or LPF can be done in
the EQ PARAM screen (
p.225)
A EQ [ON] key
Switches the equalizer on/off for the selected channel.
B EQ [UPPER] key
C EQ [LOWER] key
If a MIX channel or STEREO A/B channel is selected,
these keys select the four-band group (UPPER or
LOWER) that you will edit. (The LED of the currently
selected key will light.)
If any other channel is selected, the LEDs of both keys
will be dark.
Hint
By simultaneously holding down the EQ [UPPER] key and EQ
[LOWER] key, you can return the EQ GAIN settings of the
selected channel to a flat state.
D EQ [ ] key
If this key is on, the corresponding HIGH band EQ
type will be switched to shelving. In this case, the
HIGH band EQ [Q] knob will have no function.
HPF (High Pass Filter)
1
3
2
EQUALIZER
2
1
3
9
8
7
45 6
7 Using the Selected Channel section
62 PM5D/PM5D-RH Owner’s Manual Operating section
E EQ [Q] encoder
Adjusts the Q (steepness) of each band. This encoder
does nothing for bands whose EQ type is set to shelv-
ing, LPF, or HPF.
F EQ [FREQUENCY] encoder
Adjusts the center frequency (or cutoff frequency) at
which each band will be boosted or cut.
G EQ [FREQUENCY] indicator
Indicates the center frequency (or cutoff frequency) at
which boost/cut will occur, in units of kHz or Hz. (The
indicator for the displayed unit will light.)
H EQ [GAIN] encoder
Adjusts the amount of cut/boost for each band.
I [] key
If this key is on, the corresponding LOW band EQ will
be switched to shelving type. In this case, the LOW
band EQ [Q] knob will have no function.
Operations in the SELECTED CHANNEL section
The SELECTED CHANNEL section always controls the
channel that was last selected by its [SEL] key.
To select an input channel, press a [SEL] key in the INPUT
channel strip or ST IN/FX RTN channel strip. (If neces-
sary, switch the layer before pressing a [SEL] key.) To select
an output channel, press a [SEL] key in the MIX section,
MATRIX section, or STEREO A/B channel strip.
1
Press a [SEL] key to select the channel you
want to control.
The number and name of the currently selected chan-
nel is shown in the SELECTED CH area at the lower
left of the display, and by the name indicator and num-
ber indicator in the SELECTED CHANNEL section.
The number shown in the number indicator is as fol-
lows. If a channel is paired, the decimal point for the
lowest place will light. For a FX RTN channel, the deci-
mal point for the highest place will light.
Hint
In the case of stereo channels (ST IN/FX RTN channels,
STEREO A/B channels), you can switch between L/R by
pressing the same [SEL] key.
You can also switch the channel by using the CH [DEC] key
/ CH [INC] key of the SELECTED CHANNEL section.
2
Use the controls of the SELECTED CHANNEL
section to edit the parameters of the selected
channel.
When you select a channel in step 1, the parameter val-
ues of that channel will be shown by the LEDs and
indicators of the SELECTED CHANNEL section.
These parameters can be edited using the controls of
the SELECTED CHANNEL section.
Hint
Gate, compressor, and EQ/HPF operations are explained in
the second half of this chapter; refer to the appropriate sec-
tion for details.
For details on DCA group and mute group operations, refer
to p.74, 75.
If you operate a parameter that is selected for AUTO DIS-
PLAY in the PREFERENCE 1 screen, the screen associated
with that parameter will appear automatically.
3
In the same way, select other channels and
edit their parameters.
Selecting a channel and editing its
parameters
CH 1
Number of the selected channel
Name of the selected channel
Name
indicator
The name of
the selected
channel
Number
indicator
The number
of the
selected
channel
Selected channel Number indicator
Input channels 1–48 1–48
ST IN/FX RTN channels 1–4 (L/R) 1L./1r. – 4L./4r.
MIX channels 1–24 1–24
MATRIX channels 1–8 1–8
STEREO A/B channels (L/R) AL., Ar., BL., Br.
PM5D/PM5D-RH Owner’s Manual Operating section 63
7
Using the Selected Channel section
Here’s how you can use the SELECTED CHANNEL sec-
tion to operate the internal compressor.
Note
The PM5D provides four types of built-in compressor; COMP
(compressor), EXPANDER (expander), COMPANDER H
(hard compander), and COMPANDER S (soft compander).
These four operate in different ways. This means that if you
want to use a compressor, you must load compressor set-
tings of the desired type from the compressor library, and then
edit the parameters as desired.
1
Press a [SEL] key to select the channel you
want to control.
A compressor is available for all channels except for FX
RTN channels.
2
In the DISPLAY ACCESS section, press the
INPUT [GATE/COMP] key (for an input chan-
nel) or OUTPUT [COMP] key (for an output
channel) several times to access the COMP
LIBRARY screen.
In the COMP LIBRARY screen you can store compres-
sor settings in the library, or recall existing data from
the library. The operations described below are the
same for the COMP LIBRARY screen of both output
channels and input channels.
3
Move the cursor to the scroll bar of the library
list in the lower right of the screen, and turn
the [DATA] encoder to select the library item
that you want to load. (The library item
selected in the list is highlighted.)
Numbers 001–036 for which an “R” is shown at the
right of the list contain read-only preset library items.
Numbers 001–004 contain preset library items of dif-
ferent types. It is convenient to use these library items
when you want to select a specific type. Preset library
items 001–004 are respectively of the following types.
Hint
The type of the currently selected compressor is shown in
the COMP PARAM screen (
p.229, 266).
The COMP LIBRARY screen also provides other library set-
tings suitable for a wide variety of instruments or purposes.
Settings you edit can also be stored in the library.
For a detailed explanation of each type of compressor, refer
to the Appendices (
p.295).
4
After selecting a library item, click the RECALL
button located at the lower left of the library
list.
The library item you selected in step 3 will be recalled
to the channel you selected in step 1.
5
In the SELECTED CHANNEL section, press the
COMP [ON] key to make the LED light.
The compressor of the selected channel will be
activated.
6
You can use the compressor controls of the
SELECTED CHANNEL section to edit the com-
pressor parameters.
The amount of gain reduction produced by the com-
pressor is shown by the COMP GR meter in the
SELECTED CHANNEL section.
Hint
For details on the function of the compressor controls, refer
to p.60.
More detailed parameters for the compressor (selection of
the key-in signal, stereo link on/off, assignment to a com-
pressor link group) can be edited in the COMP PARAM
screen of the INPUT GATE/COMP function or the OUTPUT
COMP function (
p.229, 266).
You can also cause the COMP PARAM screen to appear
automatically when you operate a compressor-related con-
trol. This setting is made in the UTILITY function
PREFERENCE 1 screen (
p.186).
Number Name Type
001 Comp COMP (Compressor)
002 Expand EXPANDER
003 Compander (H)
COMPANDER H (Hard com-
pander)
004 Compander (S)
COMPANDER S (Soft com-
pander)
Compressor operations
COMP LIBRARY
Scroll barRECALL button
COMP [ON] key
COMP GR meter
7 Using the Selected Channel section
64 PM5D/PM5D-RH Owner’s Manual Operating section
Here’s how you can use the SELECTED CHANNEL sec-
tion to operate the internal gate.
Note
The PM5D provides two types of built-in gating; GATE and
DUCKING. These operate in different ways. This means that if
you want to use a gate, you must load gate settings of the
desired type from the gate library, and then edit the parame-
ters as desired.
1
Press a [SEL] key to select the channel you
want to control.
Gate is available only for input channels or ST IN
channels.
2
In the DISPLAY ACCESS section, press the
INPUT [GATE/COMP] key several times to
access the GATE LIBRARY screen.
In the GATE LIBRARY screen you can store gate set-
tings in the library, or recall existing data from the
library.
3
Move the cursor to the scroll bar of the library
list in the lower right of the screen, and turn
the [DATA] encoder to select the library item
that you want to load. (The library item
selected in the list is highlighted.)
Numbers 001–036 for which an “R” is shown at the
right of the list contain read-only preset library items.
Numbers 001–002 contain preset library items of dif-
ferent types. It is convenient to use these library items
when you want to select a specific type. These numbers
correspond to the different types as follows.
Hint
The type of the currently selected gate is shown in the
GATE PARAM screen (
p.264).
The GATE LIBRARY screen also provides other library set-
tings suitable for a wide variety of instruments or purposes.
You can also save your own settings in the library.
For a detailed explanation of each type of gate, refer to the
Appendices (
p.294).
4
After selecting a library item, click the RECALL
button located at the lower left of the library
list.
The library item you selected in step 3 will be recalled
to the channel you selected in step 1.
5
In the SELECTED CHANNEL section, press the
GATE [ON] key to make the LED light.
The gate of the selected channel will be activated.
6
You can use the gate controls of the SELECTED
CHANNEL section to edit the gate parameters.
The amount of gain reduction produced by the gate is
shown by the GATE GR meter in the SELECTED
CHANNEL section.
Hint
For details on the function of the gate controls, refer to p.59.
More detailed parameters for the gate (selection of key-in
signal, stereo link on/off) can be edited in the INPUT GATE/
COMP function GATE PARAM screen (
p.264).
You can also cause the GATE PARAM screen to appear
automatically when you operate a gate control. This setting
is made in the UTILITY function PREFERENCE 1 screen
(
p.186).
Number Name Type
001 Gate GATE
002 Ducking DUCKING
Gate operations
GATE LIBRARY
Scroll barRECALL button
GATE [ON] key
GATE GR meter
PM5D/PM5D-RH Owner’s Manual Operating section 65
7
Using the Selected Channel section
Here’s how you can use the SELECTED CHANNEL sec-
tion to edit the EQ (equalizer) and HPF (High Pass Filter).
EQ can be used on all input channels and all output chan-
nels. An HPF that is independent of the EQ is provided
only for input channels. However even on output chan-
nels, you can switch the LOW band type to HPF.
1
Press a [SEL] key to select the channel you
want to control.
Four-band EQ (HIGH, HIGH MID, LOW MID,
LOW) is provided on all input channels and on
MATRIX channels.
Eight-band EQ is provided on MIX channels and STE-
REO A/B channels. (Control is divided into UPPER
and LOWER sections of four bands each.)
2
In the SELECTED
CHANNEL section,
make sure that the
EQ [ON] key is on.
If you selected a MIX
channel or STEREO A/
B channel in step 1,
use the SELECTED
CHANNEL section EQ
[UPPER] key or EQ
[LOWER] key to select the UPPER or LOWER group
of four bands.
3
For each band, use the EQ [Q] encoder, EQ
[FREQUENCY] encoder, and [GAIN] encoder to
edit the steepness, center frequency, and gain
respectively.
Hint
If the input signal of an input channel clips because of EQ
boost, make the SELECTED CHANNEL section [GAIN/ATT]
key go dark and use the [GAIN/ATT] encoder to lower the
level.
4
If you want to restore the EQ of the currently
operated channel to a flat state, simulta-
neously hold down the EQ [UPPER] and EQ
[LOWER] keys of the SELECTED CHANNEL
section.
When you hold down these two keys simultaneously,
the boost/cut amount of all bands will be reset to 0 dB.
5
If you want to use the HIGH band or LOW
band as a shelving-type EQ, turn on the [ ]
key or [ ] key for the corresponding band.
6
If you want to use HPF on an input channel,
turn on the HPF [ON] key in the SELECTED
CHANNEL section.
Input channels provide an HPF that is independent of
the four-band EQ. Use the HPF [ON] key to switch the
HPF on/off, and use the HPF [FREQUENCY] encoder
to specify the cutoff frequency.
Hint
Output channels do not provide an HPF that is independent
of the EQ, but you can switch the LOW band type to HPF, or
the HIGH band type to LPF. This change is made in the
OUTPUT EQ function EQ PARAM screen (
p.225).
For input channels you can switch the HIGH band type to
LPF. This change is made in the INPUT ø/EQ function EQ
PARAM screen (
p.260).
Hint
You can cause the associated screen to appear automati-
cally when you operate equalizer or HPF parameters in the
SELECTED CHANNEL section. This setting is made in the
UTILITY function PREFERENCE 1 screen (
p.186).
In the same way as for compressor or noise gate settings,
EQ settings can also be stored to or recalled from a dedi-
cated EQ library. Preset library items suitable for a variety of
instruments or situations are also provided.
EQ/HPF operations
EQ [UPPER]
key
EQ [LOWER]
key
EQ [ON] key
EQ [FREQUENCY]
encoder
EQ [ ] key
EQ [Q] encoder
E
Q [GAIN] encoder
EQ [ ] key
HPF [FREQUENCY]
encoder
HPF [ON]
key
8 Input Patch / Output Patch operations
66 PM5D/PM5D-RH Owner’s Manual Operating section
This chapter explains how to edit the input patch and output patch settings, and how to use insert
connections and direct output.
Changing the input patch settings
The input patch section lets you assign input ports to input
channels. In the PM5D’s default state, the input patch set-
tings assign the following signals to input channels.
However, you will need to edit the input patch settings if
you want input signals from an I/O card installed in slots
1–4 or input signals from a 2TR IN DIGITAL jack to be
assigned to an input channel. Here’s how to do this.
1
In the DISPLAY ACCESS section, press the
INPUT [PATCH] key several times to access the
INPUT PATCH screen.
The INPUT PATCH screen is where you can patch
(assign) input ports (rear panel input jacks or input
channels of I/O cards) to input channels.
The horizontal direction of the screen shows the input
ports (i.e., patch sources), and the vertical direction of
the screen shows the input channels (i.e., patch
destinations).
If an input port is patched to an input channel, a
symbol is displayed at the intersecting grid.
2
Use the left/right scroll bar to display the
patch-source input port.
The horizontal direction of the screen shows the patch
source’s input port type, ID number, port number, and
the number of input channels that are assigned to it. To
view input ports that are not currently visible, use the
horizontal scroll bar or the [DATA] encoder.
You can select the following input ports.
3
Use the vertical scroll bar to display the patch-
destination input channel.
The vertical direction of the screen shows the patch-
destination input channels. To see channels that are
not currently visible, use the vertical scroll bar. Alterna-
tively, you can hold down the [SHIFT] key and turn
the [DATA] encoder.
The following input channels can be selected.
8 Input Patch / Output Patch
operations
Input channels 1–48 Input signals from INPUT jacks 1–48
ST IN channels 1–4
Input signals from ST IN jacks 1–4
(L/R)
FX RTN channels 1–4
Output signals of internal effects 1–4
(L/R)
INPUT PATCH
AD IN 1–48 INPUT jacks 1–48
AD ST IN 1–4 ST IN jacks 1–4 (L/R)
SLOT IN 1–4 Input channels (1–16) of slots 1–4
FX OUT 1–8 Outputs (L/R) of internal effects 1–8
2TR IN D1–D3 2TR IN DIGITAL jacks 1–3 (L/R)
2TR IN A1/A2 2TR IN ANALOG jacks 1/2
CH 1–48 Input channels 1–48
STIN1L/1R–STIN4L/4R ST IN channels 1–4 (L/R)
FXRTN1L/1R–FXRTN4L/4R FX RTN channels 1–4 (L/R)
Indicates the number of the input channel.
Indicates the name of the input channel.
Indicates the number of input ports
assigned to the input channel.
To patch an input port to an input
channel, click this grid to display a
symbol.
From the top, this shows the input port type
and ID number, the port number, and the
number of input channels currently assigned.
PM5D/PM5D-RH Owner’s Manual Operating section 67
8
Input Patch / Output Patch operations
4
Click the grid where the desired patch-source
and patch-destination intersect.
The vertical and horizontal red lines indicate the grid
position where the cursor is located. The SELECTED
PATCH area in the upper left of the screen shows the
input port and input channel for the grid at which the
cursor is located.
When you click a grid, a window will ask you to con-
firm that you want to change the patch setting.
5
Click the OK button in the window.
The new patch will be finalized, and a “ ” symbol will
appear at the corresponding grid.
To cancel the patch, click the “ ” symbol once again.
Hint
If you want to change the patch directly without having to
respond to the confirmation window, go to the UTILITY func-
tion PREFERENCE 1 screen and turn PATCH
CONFIRMATION off (
p.186).
To move the cursor location rapidly in or out of the grid, hold
down the [SHIFT] key and press the CURSOR [
]/[
®
]/[
π
]/
[
] keys.
Note
You can patch a single input port to multiple input channels,
but you cannot patch multiple input ports to a single input
channel.
Changing the output patch settings
In the output patch section you can assign output chan-
nels to output ports. The PM5D’s output channels are
always connected to the following output jacks.
However you can edit the output patch settings so that the
signals of these output channels are also sent from other
output ports in parallel. Here’s how to do this.
1
In the DISPLAY ACCESS section, press the
OUTPUT [PATCH] key several times to access
the OUTPUT PATCH screen.
In the OUTPUT PATCH screen you can patch (assign)
output channels to output ports. The horizontal direc-
tion of the screen shows the output ports (i.e., patch
destinations), and the vertical direction of the screen
shows the output channels (i.e., patch sources).
When the PM5D is in its default state, MIX channels
1–24, MATRIX channels 1–8, and the STEREO A
channel are patched to the output channels of slots 1–4
and the 2TR OUT DIGITAL jacks in addition to the
output jacks that are always connected. However, you
are free to change this patching.
2
Use the horizontal scroll bar to display the
patch-destination output port.
The horizontal direction of the screen shows the patch
destination’s output port type, ID number, port num-
ber, and the number of output channels that are
assigned to it.
You can select the following output ports.
3
Use the vertical scroll bar to display the patch-
source output channel.
The vertical direction of the screen shows the patch-
source output channels.
The following output channels can be selected.
Input port
Input channel
number
Input channel
name
MIX channels 1–24 MIX OUT jacks 1–24
STEREO A/B channels STEREO OUT jacks A/B
MATRIX channels 1–8 MATRIX OUT jacks 1–8
Monitor output L/C/R MONITOR OUT jacks L/R/C
OUTPUT PATCH
SLOT OUT 1–4
Output channels (1–16) of an I/O
card installed in slots 1–4
FX IN 1–8 Inputs (L/R) of internal effects 1–8
2TR OUT D1/D2 2TR OUT DIGITAL jacks 1–2 (L/R)
MIX 1–24 MIX channels 1–24
MATRIX 1–8 MATRIX channels 1–8
ST AL/AR STEREO A channel (L/R)
ST BL/BR STEREO B channel (L/R)
MONITOR L/R/C Monitor output (L/C/R)
TALKBACK OUT Talkback output
OSC OUT Oscillator output
Indicates the output channel number.
Indicates the number of output ports
assigned to the output channel.
To patch an output port to an output
channel, click this grid to display a
symbol.
From the top, this area shows the output
port type, ID number, port number, and
number of assigned output channels.
8 Input Patch / Output Patch operations
68 PM5D/PM5D-RH Owner’s Manual Operating section
4
Click the grid where the desired patch-source
and patch-destination intersect.
The SELECTED PATCH area in the upper left of the
screen shows the output port and output channel for
the grid at which the cursor is located.
When you click a grid, a window will ask you to con-
firm that you want to change the patch setting.
Hint
If you want to change the patch directly without having to
respond to the confirmation window, go to the UTILITY func-
tion PREFERENCE 1 screen and turn PATCH
CONFIRMATION off (
p.186).
5
Click the OK button in the window.
The new patch will be finalized, and a “ ” symbol will
appear at the corresponding grid. To cancel the patch,
click the “ ” symbol once again.
Note
You can patch an output channel to more than one output
port, but you cannot patch multiple output channels to a sin-
gle output port.
Output port
Output channel
number
PM5D/PM5D-RH Owner’s Manual Operating section 69
8
Input Patch / Output Patch operations
Inserting an external device into a channel
You can insert an effect processor or other external device into the signal route of an input channel or output channel. When
doing so, you can specify for each channel the input/output port and insert I/O point that you want to use for insertion.
When inserting an external device into a desired channel,
you can use the rear panel input/output jacks or the input/
output jacks of an I/O card installed in a slot as insert-out/
insert-in jacks.
The following diagrams show typical examples of insert
connections.
Insert connection example 1
Insert connection example 2
Insert connection example 3
If you are inserting an external digital device via a digital I/
O card as shown in “Insert connection example
3,” you
will need to synchronize the word clock of the PM5D and
the external device. Normally, we recommend that you set
the external device as a word clock slave, and make it fol-
low the PM5D’s word clock. (For details on how to set
your device as a word clock slave, refer to its manual.)
Hint
For the PM5D model, you can also use the rear panel
INSERT IN/OUT jacks to insert an external device into an
input signal, as an alternative to the method described above.
In this case, the insert I/O point is fixed at immediately before
AD conversion. Also, the steps described p.70 will not be
necessary.
Connecting an external device for
insertion
21
COAXIAL COAXIALAES/EBU AES/EBU AES/EBU AES/EBU
3
21
3
DIGITAL IN
(AES/EBU)
DIGITAL OUT
(AES/EBU)
Effect processor
MY8-DA96MY8-AD96
ANALOG OUT ANALOG IN
Effect processor
AES/EBU
MY8-AE
DIGITAL OUT
(AES/EBU)
INPUT 1/2 OUTPUT 1/2
DIGITAL IN
(AES/EBU)
Effect processor
(female) (male)
Special AES/EBU
cable for MY8-AE
8 Input Patch / Output Patch operations
70 PM5D/PM5D-RH Owner’s Manual Operating section
Here we will explain how to make insert connections,
using an example in which an external device connected to
an AD/DA card in a slot is inserted into an input channel.
However, the procedure is the same when inserting into an
output channel, the only difference being that you will be
working in a screen for output channels.
1
In the DISPLAY ACCESS section, press the
INPUT [PATCH] key several times to access the
INSERT PATCH screen (INPUT PATCH func-
tion) shown below.
In the left side of this screen you can select an output
port to use as insert-out, and in the right side of the
screen you can select an input port to use as insert-in.
If you want to insert into an output channel, press the
OUTPUT [PATCH] key several times to access the
OUTPUT PATCH function INSERT PATCH screen.
2
In the left side of the screen, click the grid at
which the output port connected to your
external device intersects the desired channel.
The procedure is the same as in the INPUT PATCH
screen or OUTPUT PATCH screen. You can select the
following output ports.
Hint
If you select GEQ IN at the left side of the screen, the identi-
cally-numbered GEQ OUT will be automatically selected at
the right side of the screen, inserting the correspondingly-
numbered GEQ module into that channel. (For details on
using the graphic EQ
p.110)
3
In the right side of the screen, click the grid at
which the input port connected to your exter-
nal device intersects the desired channel.
You can select the following input ports.
The SELECTED PATCH area shows the channel corre-
sponding to the grid at which the cursor is located. To
the right of this are shown the input/output ports
patched to insert-out/insert-in for this channel.
Hint
To move the cursor rapidly between the grids in the left and
right sides of the screen, you can hold down the [SHIFT] key
and press the CURSOR [
]/[
®
] keys.
Note
With the steps you have taken so far, the external device has
been patched to the insert-out/insert-in of the selected chan-
nel. However, please note that the insert connection is not
actually enabled until you turn on the INSERT I/O ON/OFF
button in the INSERT/DIRECT OUT screen as described
below. As an exception to this, the INSERT I/O ON/OFF but-
ton is automatically turned on if you patch a GEQ.
4
Press the INPUT [PATCH] key several times to
access the INSERT/DIRECT OUT POINT screen
(INPUT PATCH function) shown below.
In the INSERT/DIRECT OUT POINT screen (INPUT
PATCH function) you can switch insert on/off for each
input channel. In this screen you can also select the
insert I/O point (the location at which the external
device will be inserted).
If you want to insert into an output channel, press the
OUTPUT [PATCH] key several times to access the
OUTPUT PATCH function INSERT PATCH screen.
SLOT OUT 1–4
Output channels of an I/O card
installed in slots 1–4
FX IN 1–8 L/R inputs of internal effects 1–8
GEQ IN 1–12 Inputs of GEQ modules 1–12
2TR OUT 1–3 2TR OUT DIGITAL jacks 1–3 (L/R)
Patching the insert-out and insert-in
INSERT PATCH
AD IN 1–48 INPUT jacks 1–48
AD ST IN 1–4 ST IN jacks 1–4 (L/R)
SLOT IN 1–4
Input channels of an I/O card
installed in slots 1–4
FX OUT 1–8 Outputs (L/R) of internal effects 1–8
GEQ OUT 1–12 Outputs of GEQ modules 1–12
2TR IN D1–D3 2TR IN DIGITAL jacks 1–3 (L/R)
2TR IN A1/A2 2TR IN ANALOG jacks 1/2 (L/R)
Channel at which
the cursor is located
Port patched to
insert-out
Port patched to
insert-in
INSERT/DIRECT OUT POINT
PM5D/PM5D-RH Owner’s Manual Operating section 71
8
Input Patch / Output Patch operations
5
Select one of the following as the insert I/O
point for each channel, and turn on the corre-
sponding button.
The selected point is indicated by the graphic in the
upper part of the screen.
6
Click the INSERT I/O ON/OFF button for the
desired channel to turn it on.
This enables the insert connection for the correspond-
ing channel.
If you selected AD IN as the insert-in, or if you selected
a slot to which an external head amp supporting the
special protocol (Yamaha AD8HR, AD824) is con-
nected, make head amp settings as necessary ( p.36).
PRE EQ Immediately before the EQ
POST EQ Immediately after the EQ
PRE DELAY Immediately before the delay
POST FADER Immediately after the fader
Select the insert I/O point for
each channel.
The INS symbol indicates the insert I/O point
for the channel at which the cursor is located.
These are the INSERT I/O ON/OFF buttons
that switch insert on/off for each channel.
These indicate the channel numbers.
These indicate the names of the input channels.
8 Input Patch / Output Patch operations
72 PM5D/PM5D-RH Owner’s Manual Operating section
Directly outputting the signal of an input channel
Here’s how the signal being input to an input channel or ST IN channel can be output directly from the desired output jack.
1
In the DISPLAY ACCESS section, press the
INPUT [PATCH] key several times to access the
DIRECT OUT PATCH screen (INPUT PATCH
function) shown below.
In this screen you can select the output port that will
directly output the input signal of an input channel or
ST IN channel. You can select the following output
ports.
2
Click the grid at which the desired channel
and output port intersect.
The procedure is the same as in the INPUT PATCH
screen or OUTPUT PATCH screen. The SELECTED
PATCH area at the upper left of the screen shows the
channel and output port corresponding to the grid at
which the cursor is located.
Note
With the procedure up to this point, the selected channel and
output port are now patched. However, please note that direct
output is not actually enabled until you turn on the DIRECT
OUT ON/OFF button in the INSERT/DIRECT OUT screen
described below.
3
Press the INPUT [PATCH] key several times to
access the INSERT/DIRECT OUT POINT screen
(INPUT PATCH function) shown below.
In the INSERT/DIRECT OUT POINT screen (INPUT
PATCH function) you can switch direct output on/off,
and select the direct out point (the location from which
the signal is taken for direct output).
4
Choose the direct out point for each channel
from the following choices, and turn on the
appropriate button.
The selected point is indicated by the graphic in the
upper part of the screen.
5
Click the DIRECT OUT ON/OFF button for the
desired channel to turn it on.
This enables direct output for the corresponding
channel.
SLOT OUT 1–4
Output channels of an I/O card
installed in slots 1–4
2TR OUT D1–D3 2TR OUT DIGITAL jacks 1–3 (L/R)
DIRECT OUT PATCH
PRE HPF Immediately before the HPF
PRE EQ
Immediately before the EQ (immedi-
ately after the PRE EQ of the
INSERT I/O)
PRE FADER Immediately before the fader
POST ON Immediately after the [ON] key
INSERT/DIRECT OUT POINT
Select the direct out point
for each channel.
The “D” symbol indicates the direct out point
for the channel at which the cursor is located
Switch direct out on/off
for each channel.
These indicate the number of the input channels.
These indicate the name of the input channels.
PM5D/PM5D-RH Owner’s Manual Operating section 73
9
Grouping and linking
This chapter explains DCA Groups and Mute Groups which let you control the level or muting of
multiple channels simultaneously, and EQ Link and Compressor Link which let you link EQ or
compressor parameters of multiple channels.
About DCA Groups and Mute
Groups
You can use eight DCA groups and eight mute groups to
control multiple channels simultaneously.
DCA groups allow the level of multiple channels to be con-
trolled together by the DCA faders 1–8 of the top panel
DCA strip. A single DCA fader will control the level of
channels belonging to the same DCA group while main-
taining the level difference between the channels. This
provides a convenient way in which drum mics can be
grouped.
DCA groups 1–6 are for input channels only, but DCA
groups 7/8 can be used with both input channels and out-
put channels. Both types of channel can exist in an
identically-numbered group.
Mute groups allow multiple channels to be switched on/off
simultaneously by the SCENE MEMORY [1]–[8] keys in
the SCENE MEMORY section of the top panel. You can
use this to cut out multiple channels simultaneously.
Mute groups 1–8 can be used with both input channels
and output channels. Both types of channel can exist in an
identically-numbered group.
Items in the ASSIGN MODE
section
The ASSIGN MODE section lets you use the panel to
assign channels to DCA groups or mute groups.
A ASSIGN MODE [DCA] key
This key lets you assign channels to DCA groups 1–8.
While this key is blinking, you can use the [CUE] key
of each channel to assign that channel to the currently
selected DCA group.
B ASSIGN MODE [MUTE] key
This key lets you assign channels to mute groups 1–8.
While this key is blinking, you can use the [CUE] key
of each channel to assign that channel to the currently
selected mute group.
Items in the DCA strip
The DCA strip is where you control DCA groups 1–8.
A Name indicator
This indicates the name assigned to each DCA group.
B DCA [MUTE] key
This switches DCA group muting on/off. If you turn
this key on (LED lit), channels assigned to that DCA
group will be muted.
C DCA [NOMINAL] LED
This LED will light when the corresponding DCA fader
is at the 0 dB position.
D DCA fader
This fader adjusts the level of the DCA group.
E DCA [RCL SAFE] LED
If Recall Safe is enabled for a DCA group, the corre-
sponding LED will light.
9 Grouping and linking
1
2
1
2
4
6
5
3
9 Items in the DCA strip
74 PM5D/PM5D-RH Owner’s Manual Operating section
F DCA [CUE] key
This key is used to cue-monitor all channels assigned to
that DCA group.
Using DCA Groups
Here we explain how to assign channels to DCA groups and use the DCA faders to control them.
From the panel, you can assign channels to DCA groups
either by selecting a specific channel and specifying the
DCA group to which it will belong, or by selecting a spe-
cific DCA group and specifying the channels that will
belong to that DCA group.
To select the DCA groups to which a
specific channel will belong
1
Press a [SEL] key to select the channel for
which you want to make assignments.
2
In the SELECTED CHANNEL section, press a
DCA [1]–[8] key to select the DCA group to
which the channel will be assigned (you may
select more than one DCA group).
The LEDs will light for DCA [1]–[8] key(s) that are
turned on. If an input channel is selected, its corre-
sponding DCA assign LED(s) in the channel strip will
also light.
3
Select the DCA group(s) for other channels in
the same way.
To select the channels that will belong
to a specific DCA group
1
In the ASSIGN MODE section, press the
ASSIGN MODE [DCA] key.
The ASSIGN MODE [DCA] key will blink. The [DCA]
key of the FADER MODE section will also blink. While
this key is blinking, you can use the [CUE] key of each
channel to assign that channel to a DCA group.
2
Press a DCA [CUE] key in the DCA strip to
select the DCA group (1–8) to which you want
to assign channels.
3
Press the [CUE] key of input channels / output
channels (you may select more than one) to
assign them to the selected DCA group.
If a DCA group 1–6 is selected, you can select only
input channels. If a DCA group 7/8 is selected, you can
select input channels and output channels. If an input
channel is selected, its corresponding DCA assign
LED(s) in the channel strip will also light.
4
Assign channels to other DCA groups in the
same way.
5
When you have finished making assignments,
press the ASSIGN MODE section ASSIGN
MODE [DCA] key to make its LED go dark.
The FADER MODE section [DCA] key will also stop
blinking, and return to its previous state.
Hint
You can also assign channels to DCA groups from within the
display. Input channel DCA assignments are made in the
INPUT DCA/GROUP function DCA GROUP ASSIGN
screen (
p.271), and output channel DCA assignments are
made in the OUTPUT DCA/GROUP function DCA GROUP
ASSIGN screen (
p.265).
DCA group settings are saved as part of the scene.
Assigning channels to DCA groups
DCA [1]–[8] keys
DCA assign LEDs
PM5D/PM5D-RH Owner’s Manual Operating section 75
9
Grouping and linking
Here’s how you can use the DCA strip to control DCA
groups.
1
In the FADER MODE section, make sure that
the FADER MODE [DCA] key LED is lit.
The FADER MODE section selects the function of the
DCA strip faders. When the FADER MODE [DCA]
key LED is lit, you can use the faders of the DCA strip
to control DCA groups 1–8.
2
Use the faders of the channel strip to adjust
the relative levels between the channels
belonging to the DCA group you want to use.
3
Operate the DCA fader for the DCA group you
want to use.
The level of the channels assigned to that DCA fader
will change while preserving the level differences you
established in step 2.
4
If you want to mute a DCA group, press the
[MUTE] key for that DCA group in the DCA
strip.
The [MUTE] key will light, and muting will be turned
on for channels belonging to that DCA group (the
same state as if the faders were lowered to – dB). At
this time, the name indicator for that DCA group will
be dimmed.
Hint
If desired, you can cause the DCA assign LEDs of the corre-
sponding input channels to blink while the DCA group is
muted. To do so, turn on the DCA/MUTE FLASH INDICATE
setting in the PREFERENCE 1 screen (UTILITY screen).
5
To un-mute a DCA group, press the lit [MUTE]
key in the DCA strip.
Using mute groups
This section explains how to assign channels to mute groups and use the panel keys to control them.
From the panel, you can assign channels to mute groups
either by selecting a specific channel and specifying the
mute groups to which that channel will belong, or by
selecting a specific mute group and specifying the channels
that will belong to that mute group.
To select the mute groups to which a
specific channel will belong
1
Press a [SEL] key to select the channel for
which you want to make assignments.
2
In the SELECTED CHANNEL section, use the
MUTE [1]–[8] keys to select the mute group to
which the channel will be assigned (you may
select more than one mute group).
The LEDs will light for MUTE [1]–[8] key(s) that are
turned on. If an input channel is selected, its corre-
sponding mute assign LED(s) in the channel strip will
also light.
3
Select the mute group(s) for other channels in
the same way.
Controlling DCA groups
FADER MODE [DCA] key
Assigning channels to mute groups
MUTE [1]–[8] keys
Mute assign LEDs
9 Items in the DCA strip
76 PM5D/PM5D-RH Owner’s Manual Operating section
To select the channels that will belong
to a specific mute group
1
In the ASSIGN MODE section, press the
ASSIGN MODE [MUTE] key.
The ASSIGN MODE [MUTE] key will blink. In the
SCENE MEMORY section, the MUTE MASTER LED
will also blink. While this key is blinking, you can use
the [CUE] key of each channel to assign that channel to
a mute group.
2
In the SCENE MEMORY section, use the SCENE
MEMORY [1]–[8] keys to select the mute group
(1–8) for which you want to make
assignments.
While the ASSIGN MODE [MUTE] key is blinking,
you can use the SCENE MEMORY [1]–[8] keys to
select the mute group for which you will make assign-
ments. Press one of these keys; the LED of that key will
blink.
3
Press the [CUE] key of input channels / output
channels (you may select more than one) to
assign them to the selected mute group.
The [CUE] key will light, and that channel will be
assigned to the selected mute group.
Both input channels and output channels can be
assigned to mute groups 1–8.
4
Assign channels to other mute groups in the
same way.
5
When you have finished making assignments,
press the ASSIGN MODE section ASSIGN
MODE [MUTE] key to make its LED go dark.
The SCENE MEMORY section MUTE MASTER/
DIRECT RECALL LED will also return to its previous
state.
Hint
You can also assign channels to mute groups from within
the display. Input channel assignments are made in the
INPUT DCA/GROUP function MUTE GROUP ASSIGN
screen (
p.272), and output channel assignments are
made in the OUTPUT DCA/GROUP function MUTE
GROUP ASSIGN screen (
p.235).
Mute group assignments are saved as part of the scene.
Here’s how you can use the SCENE MEMORY [1]–[8]
keys of the SCENE MEMORY section to switch muting
on/off for mute groups 1–8.
1
Turn on the MUTE MASTER button located in
the lower right of the display.
The DIRECT RECALL button and MUTE MASTER
button located in the lower right of the display select
the function of the SCENE MEMORY [1]–[8] keys.
When the DIRECT RECALL button is on
The SCENE MEMORY [1]–[8] keys will directly recall
the scene that is assigned to each key.
When the MUTE MASTER button is on
The SCENE MEMORY [1]–[8] keys will switch mut-
ing on/off for mute groups 1–8.
2
Press the SCENE MEMORY [1]–[8] key for the
mute group you want to mute.
The key LED will light, and all channels belonging to
the selected mute group will be muted (the same state
as when the [ON] key is turned off). You can turn on
more than one key to mute multiple mute groups.
3
To un-mute a mute group, press a lit SCENE
MEMORY [1]–[8] key.
Hint
The mute group mute on/off status is saved in the scene.
However, you can also use the Recall Safe function to
exclude the mute group status from scene recall.
If desired, you can cause the MUTE assign LEDs of the cor-
responding input channels to blink while the mute group is
muted. To do so, turn on the DCA/MUTE FLASH INDICATE
setting in the PREFERENCE 1 screen (UTILITY screen).
If necessary, channels belonging to a mute group can be
temporarily excluded from mute group operations (Mute
Safe).
1
Press a [SEL] key to select the channel you
want to exclude from mute groups.
2
In the SELECTED CHANNEL section, press the
[MUTE SAFE] key to make the LED light.
Mute Safe will be enabled for the corresponding chan-
nel. (In the case of an input channel, the [MUTE
SAFE] LED in the channel strip will light.) In this state,
muting an applicable mute group will not affect that
channel.
3
To defeat Mute Safe, press the SELECTED
CHANNEL section [MUTE SAFE] key once again
to make the LED go dark.
Hint
Mute Safe settings are not saved in the scene. They will
remain effective until you manually defeat them.
Controlling mute groups
DIRECT RECALL button
MUTE MASTER button
Using the Mute Safe function
PM5D/PM5D-RH Owner’s Manual Operating section 77
9
Grouping and linking
Using EQ Link and Compressor Link
EQ Link and Compressor Link are functions that respectively link the EQ parameters or compressor parameters of multiple
channels. Editing the EQ or compressor parameters of any channel belonging to a link group will similarly edit the other
channels in that link group.
1
In the DISPLAY ACCESS section, press the
INPUT [DCA/GROUP] key (for an input chan-
nel) or OUTPUT [GROUP] key (for an output
channel) to access one of the following
screens.
INPUT DCA/GROUP function EQ LINK ASSIGN
screen
Assign EQ link groups (1–8) for input channels
INPUT DCA/GROUP function COMP LINK
ASSIGN screen
Assign compressor link groups (1–8) for input
channels
OUTPUT DCA/GROUP function EQ LINK ASSIGN
screen
Assign EQ link groups (A–F) for output channels
OUTPUT DCA/GROUP function COMP LINK
ASSIGN screen
Assign compressor link groups (A–F) for output
channels
In each screen, the channels (assignment source) are
listed horizontally, and the link group number or
alphabetical character (assignment destination) are
listed vertically.
Hint
The EQ link groups and compressor link groups are indepen-
dent for input channels and output channels.
EQ LINK ASSIGN
COMP LINK ASSIGN
EQ LINK ASSIGN
COMP LINK ASSIGN
9 Items in the DCA strip
78 PM5D/PM5D-RH Owner’s Manual Operating section
2
Click the grid at which the desired channel
(assignment source) intersects the desired link
group (assignment destination).
A “ ” symbol will appear at the corresponding grid.
To cancel the assignment, click the “ ” symbol once
again.
In the case of output channel EQ link groups, MIX
channels and STEREO A/B channels can be assigned
only to groups A–F, and MATRIX channels can be
assigned only to groups G/H. (Unavailable grids are
grayed-out.)
If another channel is already assigned to the assign-
ment-destination group, the EQ and compressor
parameters of the previously-assigned channel will be
copied to the channel that is added later, causing the
settings to be the same.
3
If you want to use the [CUE] key of each chan-
nel to assign it to a link group, click the SET BY
CUE button for the corresponding link group
in the screen to turn it on.
While the SET BY CUE button is on, you can use the
channel [CUE] keys to set or cancel link group
assignments.
Note
The SET BY CUE button can be turned on for only one link
group.
When you switch to a different screen, the SET BY CUE but-
ton that was turned on will automatically be defeated.
4
When you have finished making link group
assignments, operate the EQ or compressor
parameters of a channel belonging to a link
group.
The EQ or compressor parameters of channels belong-
ing to the same link group will follow your editing.
Hint
Link group settings are saved as part of the scene.
Note
The STEREO LINK button and KEY IN SOURCE settings are
not linked even for channels belonging to the same compres-
sor link group.
SET BY CUE button
PM5D/PM5D-RH Owner’s Manual Operating section 79
10
Scene memory
This chapter explains how to store and recall the PM5D’s mix parameters as “scenes.”
About scenes
The PM5D can store and recall the current state of its mix parameters as a “scene.” Scenes are assigned a scene number of
000–500. Scene 000 is read-only, and cannot be overwritten. Other scene numbers may be rewritten freely.
A scene contains the settings of the panel controls (except
for the TALKBACK section, CUE/MONITOR section, and
the AD IN section of the PM5D model) as well as the set-
tings of the functions and screens listed below.
INPUT function settings
OUTPUT function settings
EFFECT PARAM screen settings
GEQ PARAM screen settings
SELECTIVE RECALL screen (SCENE function)
settings
FADE TIME screen (SCENE function) settings
MIXER SETUP screen (SYS/W.CLOCK function)
settings
HA screen (SYS/W.CLOCK function) settings
However, input patch, output patch, and HA (head amp)
settings are saved in the corresponding library, and the
scene contains only a library number that links to these
saved settings.
For example if the input patch, output patch, and HA
(head amp) settings have been edited when you store a
scene, the changes will be stored in the corresponding
library, and the library number of these stored library
items will be stored in the scene.
Hint
You can choose how the changes will be stored in the library;
they can either be stored in a new unused library number, or
overwritten onto the existing library number (
p.81).
When you recall a scene, the input patch, output patch,
and HA (head amp) library numbers linked to that scene
will be recalled simultaneously.
For each scene, you can specify whether to enable linking
to these libraries ( p.159). For example if you turn off
linking to the HA library for a certain scene, recalling that
scene will not update the HA settings.
Note
By “head amp settings” we mean settings for the internal head
amps of the PM5D-RH model and for an external head amp
device that supports the special protocol (e.g., Yamaha
AD8HR or AD824). The settings of the AD IN section of the
PM5D model are not included.
10 Scene memory
00 Initial Data
10 InPatch #1
00 Initial Data
10 OutPatch #1
00 Initial Data
10 HA #1
000 Initial Data
010 Music #1
Current scene
Scene memory
Input patch
settings
Output patch
settings
Internal/external
head amp settings
Input patch library
Output patch library
HA library
Storing a scene
000 Initial Data
010 Music #1
00 Initial Data
10 InPatch #1
00 Initial Data
10 OutPatch #1
00 Initial Data
10 HA #1
Recalling a scene
Current scene
Scene memory
Input patch
settings
Output patch
settings
Internal/external
head amp settings
Input patch library
Output patch library
HA library
10 Scene memory
80 PM5D/PM5D-RH Owner’s Manual Operating section
Items in the SCENE MEMORY section
The SCENE MEMORY section lets you store and recall mix parameters as scene memories. Mute operations for mute groups
1–8 are also performed in this section.
A SCENE MEMORY [1]–[8] keys
The function of these keys will depend on the selection
of the DIRECT RECALL button and MUTE MASTER
button in the lower right of the display.
When the DIRECT RECALL button is on
SCENE MEMORY [1]–[8] keys operate as Direct
Recall keys that directly recall the eight scenes assigned
to these keys.
When the MUTE MASTER button is on
SCENE MEMORY [1]–[8] keys operate as Mute Mas-
ter keys that switch muting on/off for mute groups 1–8.
B [DIRECT RECALL]/[MUTE MASTER]
indicators
These indicators indicate the currently selected func-
tion of the SCENE MEMORY [1]–[8] keys (
1).
C SCENE MEMORY [PREVIEW] key
This key selects either NORMAL mode or PREVIEW
mode as the operation when you recall a scene. PRE-
VIEW mode is selected if this key LED is lit; NORMAL
mode is selected if it is dark. Operation will differ as
follows according to the selected mode.
NORMAL mode
This mode lets you store and recall scenes as usual.
When you recall a scene in this mode, the current scene
will be overwritten by the settings of the newly recalled
scene.
PREVIEW mode
This mode lets you preview the settings of a scene
stored in memory without affecting the signal process-
ing of the current scene. When you recall a scene in this
mode, the mix parameter values of that scene will be
shown in the PM5D’s panel, but the internal signal
processing will remain as it was before the recall.
When you operate the panel keys or encoders at this
time, the panel display will change but internal signal
processing will not be affected. If desired, you can save
the edited content in the desired scene number or
library number.
D Scene number indicator
This indicate shows the number (000–500) of the scene
that is selected for store or recall.
E SCENE MEMORY [UNDO] key
This key cancels the most recently-executed scene recall
operation. If you have accidentally recalled an
unwanted scene, you can press this key to return to the
state prior to recalling the scene.
F SCENE MEMORY [RECALL] key
This key recalls the scene whose number is shown in
the scene number indicator (
4).
G SCENE MEMORY [π]/[] keys
These keys increment or decrement the number dis-
played in the scene number indicator (
4). However if
the SCENE screen BLANK SKIP button is turned on,
you will only be able to select numbers in which a scene
is actually stored.
H SCENE MEMORY [STORE] key
This key stores the current scene into the number
shown by the scene number indicator (
4).
4
5
6
3
1
2
8
7
DIRECT RECALL button
MUTE MASTER button
PM5D/PM5D-RH Owner’s Manual Operating section 81
10
Scene memory
Using scene memories
Here’s how to store the current mix settings (the current
scene) into a scene memory.
Note
Before you continue with the following procedure, make sure
that the SCENE MEMORY section SCENE MEMORY [PRE-
VIEW] key is off (dark). (If it is on, turn it off.)
1
Use the PM5D’s panel controls to set the mix
parameters as desired.
2
Use the SCENE MEMORY [π]/[] keys to
select the store-destination scene number.
When you select a new scene number, the scene num-
ber and name shown at the top of the display and the
scene number shown in the scene number indicator of
the SCENE MEMORY section will blink. This blinking
indicates that the settings of the indicated scene differ
from the currently-set mix parameters.
3
Press the SCENE MEMORY [STORE] key.
The SCENE STORE window will appear, allowing you
to assign a title to the scene and store it. This window
shows the following information.
4
Use the SCENE TITLE area to assign a name to
the scene. (For details on how to input text
p.26)
5
As desired, specify the library numbers in
which the input patch, output patch, and HA
settings will be stored.
To specify a store-destination library number, scroll
the input patch, output patch, or HA library list, and
click the desired number. (The number currently
selected as the store-destination is highlighted.) The
library number you select here is saved as part of the
scene.
The default selection of store-destination will depend
on the setting in the DEFAULT EDIT LIBRARY NO.
area.
If the NEW button is on
The lowest of the unused library numbers will be
selected.
If the OVERWRITE button is on
The number from which the library was originally
recalled will be selected. (If this was a read-only library
item, the lowest-numbered unused library number will
be selected.)
6
Click the STORE button in the window.
A message will ask you to confirm the store operation.
7
Click the OK button.
The current settings will be stored to the scene number
you selected in step 2, and the upper part of the screen
and the scene number indicators will stop blinking. If
any changes have been made to the input patch, out-
put patch, and HA settings used by this scene, they will
be stored in the corresponding library number.
Storing a scene
Scene number and name will blink
Scene number
will blink
An “EDIT” indicator appears here if the library settings have
been modified from the state in which they were last stored.
SCENE TITLE area, where you can rename the scene.
As the default choice in which edited library
settings will be stored when you store a scene,
choose either NEW (select an unused library)
or OVERWRITE (select the original library).
HA library
list
Input Patch
library list
Output Patch
library list
10 Scene memory
82 PM5D/PM5D-RH Owner’s Manual Operating section
Here’s how to recall a stored scene from memory.
Note
Before you continue with the following procedure, make sure
that the SCENE MEMORY section SCENE MEMORY [PRE-
VIEW] key is off (dark). (If it is on, turn it off.)
1
Use the SCENE MEMORY [π]/[] keys to
select the scene number that you want to
recall.
When you select a new scene number, the scene num-
ber and name shown at the top of the display and the
scene number shown in the scene number indicator of
the SCENE MEMORY section will blink.
2
Press the SCENE MEMORY [RECALL] key.
A message in the display will ask you to confirm the
recall operation. When you click the OK button, the
scene number you selected in step 1 will be recalled.
If input patch, output patch, and HA libraries are
linked to that scene, the correspondingly numbered
libraries will also be recalled.
Hint
If desired, you can disable the link between the scene and
these libraries, so that specific libraries will not be updated
when you recall that scene.
Using PREVIEW mode
Preview mode lets you check or edit the settings of a scene stored in memory without affecting the signal processing of the
current scene. When you recall a scene in this mode, the settings of the newly recalled scene will appear on the PM5D’s panel,
but the internal signal processing will remain as it was prior to the recall.
During an actual performance, it can be convenient to use this to check the content of the scene you intend to recall next, or to
make minor changes to a scene and then store it.
1
In the SCENE MEMORY section, turn on the
SCENE MEMORY [PREVIEW] key.
The key LED will light, and the SCENE MEMORY sec-
tion will operate in PREVIEW mode. At this time, the
scene indicator at the top of the display will turn red,
and the “PREVIEW” indicator will appear.
While in PREVIEW mode, operating the knobs,
encoders, and other controls (except for the TALK-
BACK section, CUE/MONITOR section, and the AD
IN section of the PM5D model) will not affect the
audio signal processing.
2
Use the SCENE MEMORY [π]/[] keys to
select the scene number that you want to
recall.
The scene number will light in the scene number
indicator.
3
Press the SCENE MEMORY [RECALL] key.
Only the setting values of the scene you selected in step
2 will be loaded and shown in the PM5D’s panel LEDs
and display. However, the internal signal processing of
the system will remain unchanged as it was prior to the
Recall operation.
If desired, you can access a specific channel in the
SELECTED CHANNEL section, or access a specific
screen in the display to examine the values in detail.
4
If desired, use the controls of the console to
edit the settings.
Operating a panel control in PREVIEW mode will edit
the settings of the scene you recalled in step 3, but will
not affect the PM5D’s internal signal processing.
5
If you want to store the changes you made in
step 4, select the scene number in which you
want to store the scene, and press the SCENE
MEMORY [STORE] key.
The settings you edited in step 4 will be stored into
memory.
6
To return the SCENE MEMORY section to
NORMAL mode operation, press the SCENE
MEMORY [PREVIEW] key to make the key LED
go dark.
Note
PREVIEW mode applies to all parameters included in scene
memory, all parameters included in the INPUT PATCH and
OUTPUT PATCH functions, and HA parameters. PREVIEW
mode does not apply to parameters other than these.
Even while you are in PREVIEW mode, recall operations in
the EVENT LIST screen or via MIDI messages will apply to
the current scene. While in PREVIEW mode, operations of
parameters that can be edited in the USER DEFINED
screen will generally apply to PREVIEW mode, not to the
current scene.
Recalling a scene
“PREVIEW” indicator
PM5D/PM5D-RH Owner’s Manual Operating section 83
10
Scene memory
Using the Auto Store function
With the PM5D’s default settings, pressing the SCENE MEMORY [STORE] key will open the SCENE STORE window where
you can name the scene and store it. If you enable the Auto Store function, you can execute the Store operation simply by
pressing the SCENE MEMORY [STORE] key twice. Here’s the procedure.
1
In the DISPLAY ACCESS section, press the
[UTILITY] key several times to access the PREF-
ERENCE 1 screen shown below.
The PREFERENCE 1 screen is where you can make
various default settings for the PM5D.
2
In the STORE/RECALL area at the upper left of
the screen, turn on the AUTO STORE button.
The Auto Store function is now enabled. When you
press the SCENE MEMORY [STORE] key once, the
SCENE STORE window will appear as usual; press the
key once again to execute the Store operation. If you
rapidly press the key twice, the Store operation will be
executed before the SCENE STORE window appears.
Note
Note that if the STORE CONFIRMATION button is turned on
in the STORE/RECALL area of this PREFERENCE 1 screen,
a window will ask you to confirm the Store operation even if
Auto Store is enabled. If you don’t want any windows to
appear, turn off the STORE CONFIRMATION button as well.
Using the Direct Recall function
If you assign frequently-used scenes to the SCENE MEMORY [1]–[8] keys of the SCENE MEMORY section, you will be able
to recall these scenes with a single keystroke.
1
In the DISPLAY ACCESS section, press the
[SCENE] key several times to access the SCENE
screen shown below.
In the SCENE screen you can use the DIRECT
RECALL ASSIGN list shown in the lower middle of the
screen to assign scene numbers to the SCENE MEM-
ORY [1]–[8] keys.
2
Use the DIRECT RECALL ASSIGN list to assign a
scene number to a SCENE MEMORY [1]–[8]
key.
Move the cursor to the left-hand field of the DIRECT
RECALL ASSIGN list and turn the [DATA] encoder or
click the / buttons to select a scene number; the
scene name will appear in the field at right.
3
Assign scene numbers to other keys in the
same way.
4
In the KEY MODE area at the right side (or
lower right) of the screen, make sure that the
DIRECT RECALL button is turned on. (If it is
off, click the DIRECT RECALL button.)
When the DIRECT RECALL button is on, the SCENE
MEMORY section [DIRECT RECALL] LED will light,
and the SCENE MEMORY [1]–[8] keys will operate as
Direct Recall keys.
PREFERENCE 1 AUTO STORE button
SCENE
DIRECT RECALL
button
DIRECT RECALL ASSIGN list
Scene name is
displayed
10 Scene memory
84 PM5D/PM5D-RH Owner’s Manual Operating section
5
In the SCENE MEMORY section of the console,
press one of the SCENE MEMORY [1]–[8] keys.
The LED of the corresponding key will light, and the
scene assigned to that key will be recalled.
Using the Selective Recall function
“Selective Recall” is a function that lets you restrict the parameters or channels that will be updated when you recall a specific
scene, or, conversely, specify for each scene parameters or channels that will be excluded from recall operations.
Hint
As a function similar to Selective Recall, there is also a “Recall
Safe” function that lets you select channels and parameters to
be excluded from recall operations (
p.86). However it dif-
fers from Selective Recall in that Recall Safe settings apply to
all scenes.
1
In the DISPLAY ACCESS section, press the
[SCENE] key several times to access the SELEC-
TIVE RECALL screen shown below.
2
In the SELECTION MODE area in the upper
middle of the screen, choose one of the fol-
lowing two selection modes to specify how the
SELECTIVE RECALL screen will operate.
SAFE PARAMETER mode
Specify channels/parameters that will be excluded from
Recall operations.
RECALL PARAMETER mode
Specify channels/parameters that will be affected by
Recall operations.
When you click a button to change the mode, a confir-
mation window will appear. Immediately after you
switch modes, all channels/parameters will be subject
to recall.
3
Use the buttons in the screen to select the
parameters/channels that will be subject to
recall (or excluded from recall).
The SELECTIVE RECALL screen is divided into three
areas. From the left, these areas let you make settings
for input channels, output channels, and other param-
eters. The buttons in the screen correspond to
parameters and channels as follows.
Input channels / Output channels
A SAFE ON/OFF
RECALL ON/OFF
The functions and names of these buttons will depend
on the currently-chosen SELECTION MODE.
SAFE PARAMETER mode
The buttons will function as SAFE ON/OFF buttons to
select the channels that will be excluded from Recall.
RECALL PARAMETER mode
The buttons will function as RECALL ON/OFF but-
tons to select the channels that will be subject to Recall.
B Parameter matrix grid
Here you can select the parameters that will be
excluded from (or subject to) Recall. If the ALL button
is on, all parameters will be excluded from (or subject
to) Recall.
C SET ALL
Turns on all buttons for all input channels/output
channels or for the corresponding parameter.
D CLEAR ALL
Turns off all buttons for all input channels/output
channels or for the corresponding parameter.
SELECTIVE RECALL SELECTION MODE area
3
4
12
PM5D/PM5D-RH Owner’s Manual Operating section 85
10
Scene memory
Other parameters
A DCA/GEQ/EFFECT
These buttons specify whether DCA groups, GEQ
modules, and internal effects will be excluded from (or
subject to) Recall.
B MUTE MASTER
This button specifies whether the Mute Master key on/
off status will be excluded from (or subject to) Recall.
C MIDI REMOTE
These buttons specify whether MIDI remote layers A–
D will be excluded from (or subject to) Recall.
D SET ALL
This button turns on all buttons for parameters 13.
E CLEAR ALL
This button turns off all buttons for parameters 13.
4
In the upper left of the screen, switch the
SELECTIVE RECALL ENABLE/DISABLE button to
ENABLE.
When this button is set to ENABLE, the Selective Recall
function will apply to subsequently-stored scenes.
5
Store the current scene.
The settings of the SELECTIVE RECALL screen will be
saved as part of the scene. When you recall this scene,
only the selected channels/parameters will be excluded
from (or subject to) Recall.
Note
If you edit the settings of the SELECTIVE RECALL screen,
you must store that scene in order to make your changes
effective.
Recall Safe and Selective Recall can be used together.
Channels/parameters excluded from recall operations by
either Recall Safe or Selective Recall (or both) will not be
recalled.
4
5
2
3
1
10 Scene memory
86 PM5D/PM5D-RH Owner’s Manual Operating section
Using the Recall Safe function
“Recall Safe” is a function that excludes only specific parameters/channels from Recall operations. This differs from the Selec-
tive Recall settings ( p.84) made for individual scenes in that Recall Safe settings are common to all scenes.
1
In the DISPLAY ACCESS section, press the
[SCENE] key several times to access the
RECALL SAFE screen shown below.
2
Use the buttons in the screen to select the
parameters/channels that will be excluded
from Recall operations.
The function of the buttons in the screen and the pro-
cedures are the same as in the SELECTIVE RECALL
screen (when SAFE PARAMETER mode is selected),
except for the fact that HA (Head Amp) SAFE ON/
OFF button is added as a parameter in the INPUT
SAFE PARAMETER area.
The [RCL SAFE] indicator of the channel strip will
light for input channels, STEREO A/B channels, and
DCA groups for which Recall Safe is turned on.
Hint
In the RECALL SAFE screen, clicking the parameter matrix
grid will display a “ ” symbol with a “G” character in the
center. This “G” indicates that the setting is global, and
applies to all scenes.
If desired, you can copy and paste Selective Recall settings
from the currently selected scene into the RECALL SAFE
screen (
p.166).
If you scroll the scroll bar downward, you will see that the
CH column of the SAFE PARAMETERS area shows not
only input channels but also input ports. If you set the HA of
a certain input port to Recall Safe, the HA of the correspond-
ing channel will also be set to Recall Safe. Even if they are
assigned to multiple channels, the HA Recall Safe settings
for corresponding input ports/channels will be linked.
3
If you want to use the panel to switch Recall
Safe on/off for a channel, use the [SEL] key to
select a channel and then press the SELECTED
CHANNEL section [RECALL SAFE] key to make
the key LED light.
Recall Safe will be turned on for the corresponding
channel.
Note
By default, ALL is selected as the parameters that will be
excluded from recall. This means that if you turn on Recall
Safe from the panel, the Recall Safe setting will affect all
parameters of the channel(s) for which it is turned on.
After you have finished making Recall Safe settings and
you recall a scene, only the selected channels/parame-
ters will be excluded from the Recall operation.
Note
Recall Safe and Selective Recall can be used together. Chan-
nels/parameters excluded from recall operations by either
Recall Safe or Selective Recall (or both) will not be recalled.
RECALL SAFE
[RECALL SAFE] key
PM5D/PM5D-RH Owner’s Manual Operating section 87
10
Scene memory
Using the Fade function
“Fade” is a function that smoothly changes fader and pan to their new values over a specified duration when you recall a
scene. The settings of the Fade function are made independently for each scene.
1
In the DISPLAY ACCESS section, press the
[SCENE] key several times to access the FADE
TIME screen shown below.
In this screen you can select the channels that will use
the Fade function, and specify the fade time and start
offset time.
2
In the upper left of the screen, click the FAD-
ING ENABLE/DISABLE button to select
ENABLE.
When the FADING ENABLE/DISABLE button is set to
ENABLE, the Fade function will be enabled for the fad-
ers in the current scene.
3
In the upper right of the screen, make sure
that the FADE TIME button is on.
The FADE TIME/START OFFSET buttons in the
upper right of the screen select the parameter that will
be edited in the lower part of the FADE TIME screen.
When this button is on, you can specify the fade time
(the time over which fader and pan parameters will
reach their new value) for each channel.
4
In the rows of buttons at the bottom of the
screen, click to turn on the buttons of the
channels for which you want to enable the
Fade function.
By clicking the SET ALL buttons located at the right of
the screen, you can turn on the buttons of all input
channels and all DCA groups, or the buttons of all out-
put channels.
By clicking the CLEAR ALL buttons located at the right
of the screen, you can turn off the buttons of all input
channels and all DCA groups, or the buttons of all out-
put channels.
5
Move the cursor to the box located immedi-
ately below each button, and turn the [DATA]
encoder to specify the fade time for that chan-
nel. (Alternatively, click the / buttons at
the left and right of the box.)
Hint
If the numerical value is displayed in light blue when you per-
form the above actions, this indicates that an offset time has
been specified for the corresponding channel.
6
In the same way, specify the fade time for
other channels as well.
If desired, you can easily copy the fade time setting of a
channel to another channel ( p.167).
7
In the upper right of the screen, click the
START OFFSET button to turn it on.
When the START OFFSET button is on, you can spec-
ify an offset time for each channel (the time from when
the scene is recalled until the fader or pan parameter
begins to change).
8
As you did in steps 4–6, specify an offset time
for each channel.
9
If you want to enable the Fade function not
only for faders but also for the PAN (BAL-
ANCE) parameters of input channels, set the
INPUT CH PANNING ENABLE/DISABLE button
(located in the upper middle of the screen) to
ENABLE.
The FADING ENABLE/DISABLE button and INPUT
CH PANNING ENABLE/DISABLE button can be set
independently. Use the following two buttons to select
the input channels to which this will apply.
When the ALL INPUT button is on
The Fade function will apply to the pan (balance)
parameter of all input channels.
When the SAME AS FADING button is on
The Fade function will apply to the pan (balance)
parameters of only the input channels selected in step
4.
10
When you have finished making settings,
store the scene.
The settings in the FADE TIME screen are saved
independently for each scene. The Fade function will
apply when you recall a scene for which this button
is set to ENABLE. After recall, the fader and pan
(balance) parameter values will begin changing when
the specified Start Offset Time has elapsed, and will
reach their new values over the specified Fade Time.
FADE TIME
FADING ENABLE/
DISABLE button
FADE TIME button
Fade time
10 Scene memory
88 PM5D/PM5D-RH Owner’s Manual Operating section
Using the Tracking Recall function
“Tracking Recall” is a function that adds a specified offset value to each fader or level value when a scene is recalled. Tracking
Recall settings are common to all scenes. For example if the original level of a certain sound source has changed, or if an actor
was replaced by an understudy, this function provides a convenient way to adjust the level of that specific channel for all
scenes.
1
In the DISPLAY ACCESS section, press the
[SCENE] key several times to access the
TRACKING RECALL screen shown below.
In this screen you can select the channels that will use
the Tracking Recall function, and specify the offset
value for each channel.
2
In the upper left of the screen, click the
TRACKING RECALL ENABLE/DISABLE button to
make it indicate ENABLE.
When the TRACKING RECALL ENABLE/DISABLE
button is set to ENABLE, the Tracking Recall function
will be enabled for all scenes.
3
Using the buttons of the DISPLAY SELECT area
in the upper middle of the screen, select the
type of channels for which you want to make
settings.
If the INPUT button is on
The screen will show the faders of input channels 1–48,
ST IN channels 1–4, FX RTN channels 1–4, DCA
groups 1–8, and STEREO A/B channels.
If the OUTPUT button is on
The screen will show the faders of MIX channels 1–24,
MATRIX channels 1–8, DCA groups 7/8, and STE-
REO A/B channels.
4
In the row of buttons above the faders in the
screen, click to turn on the buttons of the
channels for which you want to enable the
Tracking Recall function.
Clicking the SET ALL button located in the upper right
of the screen will turn on the buttons of all channels
and DCA groups.
Clicking the CLEAR ALL button located in the upper
right of the screen will turn off the buttons of all chan-
nels and DCA groups.
5
To set the offset value for each channel, drag
the fader upward or downward for a channel
whose button you have turned on.
When you turn on the setting for a channel in step 4,
the offset value is set to 0. The offset value can be
adjusted in a range of –15 dB to +15 dB. The current
value is shown in the box immediately below the fader.
6
In the same way, specify the offset value for
other channels as well.
7
When you have finished making settings, turn
on the OFFSET LOCK button located in the
upper right of the screen.
When this button is on, the offset values currently
specified for the channels will be fixed; this prevents the
offset values from being unintentionally changed.
When you recall a new scene in this state, the offset val-
ues will be added to the level of each channel when the
scene is loaded. (However, the upper and lower level
limits will not be exceeded.)
Note
Channels that are excluded from Recall operations by the
Recall Safe or Selective Recall functions will not change even
if Tracking Recall is turned on.
TRACKING RECALLTRACKING RECALL
ENABLE/DISABLE button
DISPLAY SELECT area OFFSET LOCK button
Offset value
PM5D/PM5D-RH Owner’s Manual Operating section 89
10
Scene memory
Using the Global Paste function
“Global Paste” is a function that lets you copy and paste settings of the desired channel or parameter from the current scene to
scene data in memory (multiple selections are allowed). This is a convenient way in which changes to the current scene can be
applied to scenes that have already been stored.
1
In the DISPLAY ACCESS section, press the
[SCENE] key several times to access the GLO-
BAL PASTE screen shown below.
In this screen you can select the copy-source channels/
parameters and specify the paste-destination scene
data.
2
Use the buttons in the PASTE MODE area to
select one of the following as the type of item
you want to paste.
3
In the CURRENT SCENE area, select the copy-
source channels or parameters.
The contents shown in the CURRENT SCENE area
will depend on what you select in the PASTE MODE
area (
1).
When PASTE MODE = INPUT
Select input channels in the left area, and select param-
eters in the right area. (For details on the parameters
p.170).
When PASTE MODE = OUTPUT
Select output channels in the left area, and select
parameters in the right area. (For details on the param-
eters p.170).
INPUT Input channel parameters
OUTPUT Output channel parameters
DCA, GEQ, EFFECT
DCA level or mute on/off status,
GEQ settings, internal effect settings
GLOBAL PASTEPASTE MODE area
CURRENT SCENE area
DESTINATION SCENE area
PASTE button
10 Scene memory
90 PM5D/PM5D-RH Owner’s Manual Operating section
When PASTE MODE = DCA, GEQ, EFFECT
Select DCA groups, GEQ modules, and internal effects.
Hint
In either of these modes, you can click the SET ALL button to
turn on all channels, or click the CLEAR ALL button to turn off
all channels.
4
In the DESTINATION SCENE area, select the
paste-destination scene(s).
To select a single scene, click the desired line in the
upper half of the list.
To select multiple consecutive scenes, use the upper
half of the list to click the scene number at which you
want to begin pasting, and use the lower half of the list
to click the scene number at which you want to stop
pasting.
The order in which the scenes are listed can be changed
by clicking one of the buttons at the top of the list; the
button (sort by number), SCENE TITLE button
(sort by scene title), or TIME STAMP button (sort by
the date on which the scene was saved).
5
Click the PASTE button.
The selected items of the current scene will be pasted to
the scene(s) in memory.
Note
If the parameter settings differ between the copy-source and
paste-destination, exception handling may be applied when
the data is pasted (
p.171).
Only the parameters selected by PASTE MODE will be
pasted. Note that even if you selected parameters in the
CURRENT SCENE area, they will be excluded from the
paste operation if you switch the PASTE MODE.
PM5D/PM5D-RH Owner’s Manual Operating section 91
11
Monitor and Cue
This chapter explains the PM5D’s Monitor and Cue functions.
About the MONITOR and CUE sections
The MONITOR section sends the signal selected as the
monitor source to the MONITOR OUT jacks. You can
select the following signals as the monitor source.
The input signal from 2TR IN ANALOG jacks 1/2
The input signal from 2TR IN DIGITAL jacks 1–3
The output signal of the STEREO A/B channels
The output signal of the LCR channels
The output signal of a pre-selected MIX channel 1–24
or MATRIX channel 1–8
The CUE section sends the cue signal of the channel/group
selected by a panel [CUE] key to the CUE OUT jacks.
Hint
If the CUE INTERRUPTION button is turned on in the MONI-
TOR screen (MON/CUE function), the Cue/Solo signal will
also be sent from the MONITOR OUT jacks when Cue/Solo is
active.
MONITOR SELECT
Selects the monitor source.
MONITOR DELAY
Delays the monitor signal.
CUE OUT DELAY
Delays the cue signal.
METER
Switches the signal that is shown in the meter section
or in the display.
DIM (Dimmer)
Attenuates the monitor/cue signal by a fixed amount.
OUT ATT. (Output attenuator)
Attenuates/boosts the monitor/cue signal.
ON (On/off)
Switches the monitor signal on/off.
PHONES LEVEL
Adjusts the output level of the top panel and front
panel PHONES jacks.
MONITOR LEVEL
Adjusts the monitor level.
CUE OUT LEVEL
Adjusts the output level of the cue signal.
11 Monitor and Cue
11 Monitor and Cue
92 PM5D/PM5D-RH Owner’s Manual Operating section
Using the Monitor function
A [2TR IN A1] key
B [2TR IN A2] key
These keys select the input signals of 2TR IN ANA-
LOG jacks 1/2 as the monitor source.
C [2TR IN D1] key
D [2TR IN D2] key
E [2TR IN D3] key
These keys select the input signals of 2TR IN DIGITAL
jacks 1–3 as the monitor source.
F [STEREO A] key
G [STEREO B] key
These keys select the output signals of STEREO A/B
channels as the monitor source. By simultaneously
pressing the [STEREO A] key and [STEREO B] key
you can select the LCR channels as the monitor source.
H [DEFINE] key
This key selects the output signal of the pre-selected
MIX channel 1–24 or MATRIX channel 1–8 as the
monitor source. This monitor source selected by this
key can be specified in the MONITOR screen (MON/
CUE function).
Hint
The currently selected source is shown by the lit/dark state of
keys
1
8
.
I MONITOR [LEVEL] knob
This knob adjusts the output level of the signal being
output from the MONITOR OUT L/R/C jacks.
J MONITOR [ON] key
This key turns the monitor output on/off.
K MONITOR [PHONES] knob
This analog volume adjusts the output level of the
PHONES jacks.
L [MONO] key
If this key is on, the monitor output L/R channels will
be mixed and output as a monaural signal. The signal
will return to stereo when you turn this key off.
Items in the MONITOR section
1
3
4
5
9
J L
2
6
7
8
K
PM5D/PM5D-RH Owner’s Manual Operating section 93
11
Monitor and Cue
Here we explain how you can use the MONITOR section
to monitor the desired source.
1
Make sure that your monitor system is con-
nected to the rear panel MONITOR OUT jacks
L/R/C.
If you want to monitor through headphones, make
sure they are connected to the top panel or front panel
PHONES jack.
Note
MONITOR OUT jack C is a special jack used to monitor the
center channel when LCR mode is active. Note that the
appropriate signal will not be output from MONITOR OUT
jack C unless the LCR channel is selected as the monitor
source and the USE AS CENTER BUS button is turned on
in the MIXER SETUP screen (SYS/W.CLOCK function)
(
p.201).
Turning on the [CUE] key of even one input channel, output
channel, or DCA group will override the settings of the MON-
ITOR section and cause the Cue signal to be output from
the MONITOR OUT jacks. Make sure that the CUE section
[INPUT]/[DCA]/[OUTPUT] LEDs are not lit.
2
To specify the channel that will be selected by
the [DEFINE] key, press the DISPLAY ACCESS
section [MON/CUE] key repeatedly to access
the MONITOR screen shown below.
3
Click a button in the DEFINE area to select the
channel that will be monitored when you
press the [DEFINE] key.
You can assign more than one channel to the
[DEFINE] key. You can choose from the following
sources.
Hint
The MONITOR screen also lets you make settings for monitor
signal delay, insert-out/in, and dimmer (
p.216).
4
Use the keys of the MONITOR section to select
the monitor source from the following.
Hint
If you select STEREO A/B channel or LCR channel, you can
also simultaneously select one other monitor source.
The monitor source can also be selected in the MONITOR
screen (MON/CUE function).
5
Press the MONITOR [ON] key to turn it on.
Hint
A signal is always output from the PHONES jacks regardless
of the on/off state of the MONITOR [ON] key.
6
Turn the MONITOR [LEVEL] knob to adjust the
monitor level. If you are monitoring through
headphones, turn the PHONES [LEVEL] knob
to adjust the monitor level.
7
If you want to monitor the signal in monaural,
turn the MONITOR section’s [MONO] key on.
MIX 1–MIX24 Output signals of MIX channels 1–24
MATRIX1–MATRIX8 Output signals of MATRIX buses 1–8
Monitoring a signal
MONITOR DEFINE area
[2TR IN A1]/[2TR IN
A2] keys
The input signal from 2TR IN ANA-
LOG jacks 1/2
[2TR IN D1]/[2TR IN
D2]/[2TR IN D3] keys
The input signal from 2TR IN DIGI-
TAL jacks 1–3
[STEREO A]/[STE-
REO B] keys
The output signal of the STEREO A/
B channels
[STEREO A] key +
[STEREO B] key
The LCR channel output
[DEFINE] key
The signal pre-selected in the MON-
ITOR screen (MON/CUE function)
11 Monitor and Cue
94 PM5D/PM5D-RH Owner’s Manual Operating section
Using the Cue/Solo functions
A [INPUT]/[DCA]/[OUTPUT] LEDs
These LEDs indicate the monitoring status. If even one
[CUE] key is on, the LED of the group to which that
key belongs will light. If a special Cue signal such as
KEY IN CUE or EFFECT CUE is active, all three LEDs
will light.
B [SOLO] key
This selects how monitoring will occur when you use
the [CUE] keys. If this key is on, monitoring will oper-
ate in SOLO mode. If this key is off, monitoring will
operate in CUE mode.
C [LAST CUE] key
This selects the mode of operation when more than
one [CUE] key is on. Turning the key on selects LAST
CUE mode; turning the key off selects MIX CUE
mode. When you switch this mode, Cue will be turned
off for all channels.
D CUE [LEVEL] knob
This adjusts the signal level that is sent from the CUE
OUT jacks.
E [OUTPUT PFL] key
This switches the location from which the signal is sent
to the CUE bus when you turn on the [CUE] key of an
output channel (MIX channel, MATRIX channel, STE-
REO A/B channel). If this key is on, the PFL (pre-
fader) signal will be sent. If this key is off, the POST
ON (immediately after the [ON] key) signal will be
sent.
The PM5D lets you select either SOLO mode or CUE
mode when using the [CUE] key to monitor signals. Use
the [SOLO] key in the CUE section of the panel to switch
the mode.
In CUE mode, holding down the [SOLO] key will switch
to SOLO mode; the [CUE] keys of all channels will go
dark. Conversely in SOLO mode, pressing the [SOLO] key
will immediately switch to CUE mode.
These modes differ as follows.
CUE mode
The cue signals of channels / DCA groups whose
[CUE] key is on will be sent via the CUE bus and out-
put from the CUE OUT jacks (Cue function). Choose
this method when you want to monitor a signal with-
out affecting other channels. When the PM5D is in the
default state, the cue signal can also be monitored from
the MONITOR OUT jacks.
SOLO mode
Only the channels / DCA groups whose [CUE] key is
on will be output from the MIX/MATRIX/STEREO
buses, and other channels / DCA groups will be muted
(Solo function). The MONITOR OUT jacks also will
output only the signal from these same channels / DCA
groups.
Note
If an input channel is soloed, the on/off setting of the output
channels will remain unchanged; only the signal of the corre-
sponding input channel will be sent to the buses. If an output
channel is soloed, the on/off setting of the input channels will
remain unchanged; the signal will be sent only to the corre-
sponding bus.
If a DCA group is soloed, only the signals of input channels
belonging to that DCA group will be output to the corre-
sponding buses. However if output channels are assigned to
DCA groups 7/8, signals will be sent only to buses belong-
ing to that DCA group.
Hint
If desired, you can exclude specific channels from Solo opera-
tions (
p.219).
Items in the CUE section
2
3
4
5
1
About CUE mode and SOLO mode
PM5D/PM5D-RH Owner’s Manual Operating section 95
11
Monitor and Cue
The PM5D’s cue and solo signals can be categorized into
the following four groups.
INPUT CUE group
The cue/solo signals of input channels make up this
group. This group becomes active when a [CUE] key of
an input channel, ST IN channel, or FX RTN channel
is pressed to turn it on.
DCA CUE group
The cue/solo signals of DCA groups make up this
group. This group becomes active when a [CUE] key in
the DCA strip is pressed to turn it on.
OUTPUT CUE group
The cue/solo signals of output channels make up this
group. This group becomes active when a [CUE] key of
a MIX channel, MATRIX channel, or STEREO A/B
channel is pressed to turn it on.
Other CUE group
This group consists of the cue/solo signals operated by
the CUE buttons in the display. This group becomes
active when you click to turn on a CUE button in the
EFFECT PARAM screen (EFFECT function) or GATE
PARAM screen (INPUT GATE/COMP function).
It is not possible to simultaneously turn on Cue
between different groups. Normally, the group to
which the most recently pressed [CUE] key (CUE but-
ton) belongs will take priority, and the [CUE] keys of
the previously selected group will be defeated.
However if you have switched cue/solo signal groups in
a certain order, the [CUE] key status of the previously
selected group will be recovered when you turn off the
[CUE] key (CUE button) to defeat the current cue/solo
selection.
The [CUE] key status can be recovered for the follow-
ing combinations of groups.
OUTPUT CUE group DCA CUE group
OUTPUT CUE group INPUT CUE group
DCA CUE group INPUT CUE group
INPUT CUE / OUTPUT CUE / DCA CUE group
Other CUE group
For example if you switch groups in the order of OUT-
PUT CUE group DCA CUE group INPUT CUE
group Other CUE group, you can then successively
defeat the [CUE] keys (CUE buttons) to recover the
[CUE] key status of the previously selected group.
Cue and Solo groups
Input channel [CUE] key
ST IN/FX RTN channel
[CUE] key
DCA strip [CUE] key
MIX/MATRIX channel
[CUE] key
STEREO A/B channel
[CUE] key
CUE button in the display
11 Monitor and Cue
96 PM5D/PM5D-RH Owner’s Manual Operating section
This section explains how you can use the [CUE] key of a
desired channel or DCA group to monitor the Cue signal.
Note
If you want the cue/solo signal to be output from the MONI-
TOR OUT jacks as well, access the MONITOR screen (MON/
CUE function) and make sure that the CUE INTERRUPTION
ON/OFF button is on before you continue with the following
procedure (
p.217).
1
Using the [OUTPUT PFL] key of the CUE sec-
tion, select one of the following as the output
position of the signal sent to the CUE bus
when an output channel [CUE] key is pressed.
PFL ([OUTPUT PFL] key is on)
The signal from immediately before the fader will be
sent to the CUE bus.
POST ON ([OUTPUT PFL] key is off)
The signal from immediately after the [ON] key will be
sent to the CUE bus.
Hint
The above setting can also be made in the CUE screen
(MON/CUE function) (
p.217). In this screen you can also
specify the output position of the signal sent from input chan-
nels and DCA groups to the CUE bus.
2
In the CUE section, use the [LAST CUE] key to
specify the mode of operation when more
than one [CUE] key within the same group is
turned on.
LAST CUE mode ([LAST CUE] key is on)
Only the channel/group whose [CUE] key was last
turned on will be monitored.
MIX CUE mode ([LAST CUE] key is off)
Channels/groups within the same group whose [CUE]
key is turned on will be monitored.
Note
[CUE] keys belonging to different groups cannot be turned
on simultaneously. The group to which the last-pressed
[CUE] key belongs will be turned on, allowing the signals of
that group to be monitored.
If you press the [CUE] key of a paired channel, both chan-
nels will be turned on.
3
Make sure that the [SOLO] key in the CUE sec-
tion is turned off.
4
Press the [CUE] key of a desired channel or
DCA group to turn it on.
The cue signal of the corresponding channel will be
output from the CUE OUT jacks and the MONITOR
OUT jacks.
5
To defeat Cue, press the currently-on [CUE]
key once again.
Hint
If you press the [LAST CUE] key to switch from LAST CUE
mode to MIX CUE mode (or vice versa), all previously-
enabled Cue (Solo) signals will be defeated. For example if
you have turned on multiple [CUE] keys in MIX CUE mode,
you can quickly turn them all off by pressing the [LAST CUE]
key twice.
This section explains how to use the Solo function.
1
Use the [LAST CUE] key of the CUE section to
specify the mode of operation when a [CUE]
key is turned on (LAST CUE mode or MIX CUE
mode).
2
In the CUE section, press and hold the [SOLO]
key.
When you press and hold the [SOLO] key, the key LED
will blink and SOLO mode will be enabled. In SOLO
mode, only the signal of the channel or DCA group
whose [CUE] key is turned on will be sent to the MIX,
MATRIX, and STEREO buses. The same signal can
also be monitored from the MONITOR OUT jacks and
CUE OUT jacks.
Hint
If desired, you can exclude specific channels or groups from
Solo operations (for details, refer to
p.219).
3
Turn on the [CUE] key of a desired channel or
DCA group.
Only the corresponding channel or DCA group will be
output to the buses and output jacks; the remaining
channels and DCA groups will be muted. The same sig-
nal will also be output from the CUE OUT jacks and
the MONITOR OUT jacks.
Note
If you turn on the [CUE] key of an output channel, the signal
will be sent only to the corresponding bus.
4
To defeat Solo, press the [SOLO] key.
If you press the [SOLO] key while in SOLO mode, you
will immediately return to CUE mode.
Note
Normally, the Cue/Solo functions can be operated indepen-
dently of scene memories.
Even if you pair a Cued channel, the cue settings will not
change in tandem at the moment you pair the channel. The
setting will change in tandem when you subsequently switch
Cue on/off.
Using the Cue function
MONITOR CUE INTERRUPTION
Using the Solo function
PM5D/PM5D-RH Owner’s Manual Operating section 97
12
Talkback and Oscillator
This chapter explains how to use talkback and oscillator.
About the TALKBACK/OSCILLATOR sections
The TALKBACK and OSCILLATOR sections let you send the signal of a mic connected to the TALKBACK jack or the signal
of a test oscillator to the desired output jacks.
Signal flow in the TALKBACK/OSCILLATOR sections is as follows.
A TALKBACK jack
This is a balanced XLR-3-31 jack to which a talkback
mic can be connected. You can make settings in the
display to supply +48V phantom power to this jack.
B TALKBACK [LEVEL] knob
This adjusts the input level of the mic connected to the
TALKBACK jack.
C TALKBACK [ON] key
This switches the talkback signal on/off. When you
press and hold the key, talkback will be on as long as
you hold down the key. If you press and immediately
release the key, talkback will remain on until you press
the key once again.
However if the NEVER LATCH button is turned on in
the TALKBACK screen, talkback will be on only while
you hold down the key, and will turn off when you
release the key; i.e., talkback will not “latch” even if you
press and immediately release the key.
D OSCILLATOR [ON] key
This is an on/off switch for the signal sent from the
internal oscillator to the specified bus(es).
Note
If the OSCILLATOR [ON] key is off, and a screen other than
the OSCILLATOR screen (TALKBACK function) is displayed,
pressing this key will only display the OSCILLATOR screen;
the key will not turn on. When you press the key once again, it
will turn on. If the key is on, pressing it once again will turn it
off regardless of the screen that is displayed.
12 Talkback and Oscillator
Items in the TALKBACK/OSCILLATOR
sections
2
4
1
3
12 Talkback and Oscillator
98 PM5D/PM5D-RH Owner’s Manual Operating section
Using talkback
Here’s how the talkback signal input from the TALKBACK jack can be sent to the desired bus(es).
1
Repeatedly press the [MON/CUE] key of the
DISPLAY ACCESS section until the TALKBACK
screen appears.
2
Turn the TALKBACK [LEVEL] knob to adjust the
input sensitivity of the talkback mic.
The meter in the TALKBACK IN area indicates the
input level of the mic connected to the TALKBACK
jack. If you want phantom power (+48V) to be sup-
plied to the TALKBACK jack, turn on the +48V button
located in the TALKBACK IN area.
Hint
The INPUT TO TALKBACK area also lets you use any INPUT
jack 1–48 as a supplementary input for talkback.
3
Click a button in the BUS ASSIGN area to spec-
ify the bus(es) to which the talkback signal will
be sent (multiple selections are allowed).
These buttons correspond to the following buses.
Hint
If desired, the talkback signal can also be output directly from
an output channel of slot 1–4 or from 2TR OUT DIGITAL jacks
1–3. To do so, click the PATCH button in the TALKBACK
OUT area to access the OUTPUT PATCH screen, and patch
talkback to the jack you want to use for direct output.
4
To enable talkback, press the TALKBACK [ON]
key in the TALKBACK section of the panel to
turn it on.
The TALKBACK [ON] key can operate in either of the
following two ways, depending on the setting of the
NEVER LATCH button in the TALKBACK area.
If the NEVER LATCH button is off
Talkback will be switched on/off each time you press
the TALKBACK [ON] key (Latched). However if you
press and hold down the TALKBACK [ON] key, talk-
back will remain on only while you continue holding
down the key, and will turn off when you release the
key (Unlatched).
If the NEVER LATCH button is on
Talkback will be on only while you continue holding
down the TALKBACK [ON] key, and will turn off
when you release the key (Unlatched).
Hint
The TALKBACK [ON] key of the panel and the TALKBACK
ON/OFF button in the screen are linked. The setting of the
NEVER LATCH button also affects both of these. However if
the NEVER LATCH button is off, holding down the on-
screen TALKBACK ON/OFF button will cause Latched
operation.
When talkback is on, you can use the talkback dimmer to
lower the monitor levels other than talkback (
p.216).
You can also assign the talkback function to a user-defined
key (
p.189).
MIX 1–24 buttons MIX buses 1–24
MATRIX1–8 buttons MATRIX buses 1–8
STEREO AL/R STEREO A bus L/R channels
STEREO BL/R STEREO B bus L/R channels
TALKBACK BUS ASSIGN areaTALKBACK area
INPUT TO TALKBACK area TALKBACK OUT area
PM5D/PM5D-RH Owner’s Manual Operating section 99
12
Talkback and Oscillator
Using the oscillator
The PM5D contains a test oscillator. By outputting the oscillator signal to the desired bus you can check the operation of con-
nected devices or test the acoustics of a hall.
1
Repeatedly press the [MON/CUE] key of the
DISPLAY ACCESS section until the OSCILLA-
TOR screen appears.
2
Click a button in the OSC MODE section to
select the type of oscillator to output, from the
following choices.
3
Use the knobs and buttons of the PARAME-
TERS area to adjust the oscillator parameters.
The parameters that can be adjusted will depend on the
type of oscillator you selected in step 2. For example if
you selected SINE WAVE 1CH as the oscillator type,
the PARAMETERS area will contain the following
parameters.
4
Click a button in the BUS ASSIGN area to
select the oscillator signal output destination
from the following choices.
Hint
If you selected SINE WAVE 2CH as the oscillator type, the
L-channel signal of the oscillator will be sent to odd-num-
bered buses (or the L output jack) and the R-channel signal
of the oscillator will be sent to even-numbered buses (or the
R output jack).
You can use the OSC OUT area to directly output the oscil-
lator signal from an output jack or slot (
p.214).
5
Press the OSCILLATOR [ON] key of the OSCIL-
LATOR section.
The oscillator signal will be sent to the bus you selected
in step 4. When you press the key again, the oscillator
will turn off.
Hint
The OSCILLATOR [ON] key of the panel and the OSC ON/
OFF button in the screen are linked.
Note
If the OSCILLATOR [ON] key is off, and a screen other than
the OSCILLATOR screen (TALKBACK function) is displayed,
pressing this key will only display the OSCILLATOR screen;
the key will not turn on. When you press the key once again, it
will turn on.
SINE WAVE 1CH button Sine wave x 1 channel
SINE WAVE 2CH button Sine wave x 2 channels
PINK NOISE button Pink noise
BURST NOISE button
Burst noise (repeated output
of pink noise)
OSCILLATOR BUS ASSIGN areaOSC MODE area
PARAMETERS areaOSC OUT area
FREQ knob
Adjusts the frequency of
the sine wave output from
the oscillator. You can
choose preset frequen-
cies by clicking the but-
tons below.
LEVEL knob
Adjusts the output level of
the oscillator.
MIX 1–24 MIX buses 1–24
MATRIX1–8 MATRIX buses 1–8
STEREO AL/R STEREO A bus L/R channels
STEREO BL/R STEREO B bus L/R channels
13 Meters
100 PM5D/PM5D-RH Owner’s Manual Operating section
This chapter explains meter-related operations.
Items in the meter section
The meter section shows the input levels of the input channels and the output levels of the output channels.
A INPUT/MIX meters
Depending on the key you press, these meters indicate
the input levels of input channels 1–24 or 25–48, or the
output levels of MIX channels 1–24.
B [CH 1-24/ST IN/FX RTN] key
When this key is on, the INPUT/MIX meters indicate
the input levels of input channels 1–24 and the ST IN/
FX RTN/MATRIX meters indicate the output level of
ST IN channels (or FX RTN channels, depending on
the FOLLOW INPUT LAYER setting) 1–4.
C [CH 25-48/FX RTN/ST IN] key
When this key is on, the INPUT/MIX meters indicate
the input levels of input channels 25–48 and the ST IN/
FX RTN/MATRIX meters indicate the output level of
FX RTN channels (or ST IN channels, depending on
the FOLLOW INPUT LAYER setting) 1–4.
D [MIX/MASTER] key
When this key is on, the INPUT/MIX meters indicate
the output levels of MIX channels 1–24 and the ST IN/
FX RTN/MATRIX meters indicate the output levels of
MATRIX channels 1–8.
E [PEAK HOLD] key
Switches the peak hold function on/off for the meter
display.
F ST IN/FX RTN/MATRIX meters
Depending on the key you press, these meters indicate
the output levels of ST IN channels 1–4 or MATRIX
channels 1–8.
G MASTER meters
These meters always indicate the output levels of the
STEREO A/B channels and CUE bus.
Switching the meter display
You can use the keys of the meter section to specify the
channels whose levels will be shown in the INPUT/MIX
meters and ST IN/MATRIX meters. The following chan-
nels correspond to each key.
Hint
The type of channels shown in the meter section is also
shown in the METER SECTION area in the upper right of
the display.
The MASTER meters always indicate the output levels of
the STEREO A/B channels and CUE bus.
13 Meters
MIX
PEAK
HOLD
CH 1 -24
24
OVER
-3
-6
-9
-12
-15
-18
-24
-30
-40
-50
-60
OVER
-3
-6
-9
-12
-15
-18
-24
-30
-40
-50
-60
2322212019181716151413121110987654321
ST IN/
/ST IN
MATRIX
OVER
-3
-6
-9
-12
-15
-18
-24
-30
-40
-50
-60
OVER
-3
-6
-9
-12
-15
-18
-24
-30
-40
-50
-60
OVER
-3
-6
-9
-12
-15
-18
-24
-30
-40
-50
-60
OVER
-3
-6
-9
-12
-15
-18
-24
-30
-40
-50
-60
STEREO
A
STEREO
B CUE
LR LR LR
1L 1R 2L 2R 3L 3R 4L 4R
MATRIX
ST IN / /
1 2 3 4 5 6 7 8
1
32 54
6 7
Key
[INPUT/MIX]
meters
[ST IN/MATRIX]
meters
[CH 1-24/ST IN/FX
RTN] key
Input channels
1–24
ST channels
(or FX RTN channels)
1–4
[CH 25-48/FX RTN/
ST IN] key
Input channels
25–48
FX RTN channels
(or ST IN channels)
1–4
[MIX/MATRIX] key
MIX channels
1–24
MATRIX channels
1–8
PM5D/PM5D-RH Owner’s Manual Operating section 101
13
Meters
Switching the metering point
The metering point for the level meters (i.e., the position at which the level is detected) can be specified separately for input
channels and output channels.
Here’s how to specify the metering point for input chan-
nels and ST IN/FX RTN channels.
1
In the DISPLAY ACCESS section, repeatedly
press the [METER] key to access the INPUT
METER screen.
2
Click the / buttons at the left and right of
the METERING POINT box to choose one of
the following metering points.
Here’s how to specify the metering point for output chan-
nels, MONITOR channels, and the CUE bus.
Hint
The metering point setting for the CUE bus is independent
from the other output channels.
1
In the DISPLAY ACCESS section, repeatedly
press the [METER] key to access the OUTPUT
METER screen.
2
To specify the metering point for output chan-
nels and MONITOR channels, click the /
buttons at the left and right of the METERING
POINT box to choose one of the following.
3
To specify the metering point for the CUE bus,
click the / buttons at the left and right of
the CUE METERING POINT box to choose one
of the following.
PRE ATT Immediately before the attenuator
PRE GATE Immediately before the internal gate
PRE FADER Immediately before the fader
POST FADER Immediately after the fader
POST ON Immediately after the [ON] key
Specifying the metering point for
input channels
INPUT METER METERING POINT box
PRE EQ Immediately before the EQ
PRE FADER Immediately before the fader
POST FADER Immediately after the fader
POST ON Immediately after the [ON] key
POST DELAY Immediately after the internal delay
PRE DELAY Immediately before the internal delay
POST DELAY Immediately after the internal delay
Specifying the metering point for
output channels
OUTPUT METER
METERING POINT
box
CUE METERING POINT
box
13 Meters
102 PM5D/PM5D-RH Owner’s Manual Operating section
Viewing the gain reduction of the internal gates and compres-
sors
The amount of gain reduction produced by the gates/compressors of the input channels and the amount of gain reduction
produced by the compressors of the output channels can be viewed in the display.
Here’s how to view the amount of gain reduction pro-
duced by the gates/compressors provided on input
channels 1–48 and ST IN channels 1–4.
1
In the DISPLAY ACCESS section, repeatedly
press the [METER] key to access the INPUT GR
screen.
2
Click the GATE button or COMP button to
select the parameter that will be displayed.
For an explanation of the items shown in the screen,
refer to the explanation of the INPUT GR screen
( p.211) in the Reference section.
To view the amount of gain reduction produced by the
compressors provided on the output channels, repeatedly
press the [METER] key of the DISPLAY ACCESS section
to access the OUTPUT GR screen.
For an explanation of the items shown in the screen, refer
to the explanation of the OUTPUT GR screen ( p.211)
in the Reference section.
Viewing the gain reduction for input
channels
INPUT GR
GAIN button COMP button
Viewing the gain reduction for out-
put channels
OUTPUT GR
PM5D/PM5D-RH Owner’s Manual Operating section 103
14
Effects
This chapter explains the functionality and operation of the PM5D’s internal effects.
About the internal effects
The PM5D contains eight internal effect modules. For each module, you can choose one of 48 effect types (not including Add-
On Effects) for the module to use.
Hint
You can add effect types for the internal effects by installing
an optional Add-On Effects package (
p.109).
To use an internal effect via send/return, assign the output
of a MIX channel to the input of the effect, and assign the
output of the effect to an input channel. In this case, the
corresponding MIX bus is used as an effect send AUX bus,
and the input channel is used as an effect return channel.
By default, the L/R outputs of effects 1–4 are assigned to L/
R of FX RTN channels 1–4.
Alternatively, you can insert an internal effect into a chan-
nel by assigning the input/output of the internal effect to
the insert-out/insert-in of the desired channel.
The PM5D’s effect types fall into two categories; “stereo
effect types” which process the L/R channel input signals
independently, and “mix effect types” which mix the two
channels before processing the signal.
If signals are assigned to both the L and R inputs of an
effect, the way in which the L/R channels are processed will
depend on whether a Stereo effect type or a Mix effect type
is selected, as follows.
If a signal is assigned to only one input of an effect, it will
be processed as mono-in/stereo-out regardless of whether a
Stereo effect type or Mix effect type is selected.
14 Effects
OUTPUT PATCH
INPUT PATCH
EFFECT 1
EFFECT 2
EFFECT 3
EFFECT 8
Input channel 1–48
inputs
ST IN channel 1–4
inputs
FX RTN channel
1–4 inputs
MIX chan-
nel 1–24
outputs
EFFECT
Insert-out of the
desired channel
Insert-in of the
desired channel
INPUT L EFFECT L L RETURN
INPUT R EFFECT R R RETURN
INPUT L L RETURN
INPUT R
EFFECT
R RETURN
Stereo effect types
Mix effect types
L RETURN
EFFECT
R RETURN
INPUT L
or R
14 Effects
104 PM5D/PM5D-RH Owner’s Manual Operating section
Using an internal effect via a MIX bus
This section explains how to use an internal effect via a
MIX bus. As an example, we will choose effect 1 for our
operations, assign MIX bus 1 to the effect input, and assign
the effect output to FX RTN channels 1/2.
1
In the DISPLAY ACCESS section, repeatedly
press the INPUT [PAN/ROUTING] key to access
the CH to MIX screen.
2
Make sure that the MIX bus 1 type selection
box indicates “VARI.”
If the box indicates “FIXED,” click the / buttons
at left and right to change the indication to “VARI”;
then press the [ENTER] key (or click inside the box) to
finalize the change.
This box selects the operation of the MIX bus (VARI or
FIXED). If VARI is selected, the bus send levels will be
adjustable.
Hint
The VARI/FIXED selection is made for two adjacent odd-num-
bered/even-numbered MIX buses. If the effect input is stereo,
it is convenient to pair these two MIX buses.
3
In the DISPLAY ACCESS section, repeatedly
press the [EFFECT] key to access the EFFECT
PARAM screen.
4
Make sure that the box in the upper left of the
screen indicates EFFECT 1.
This box lets you select the effect module that you want
to control. If a different effect module is selected, click
the / buttons at left and right to select EFFECT 1.
Hint
You can access the EFFECT ASSIGN screen (EFFECT func-
tion) to see all eight effect modules at once while you assign
signal routes to the effect inputs and outputs, or operate
Bypass and Cue (
p.154).
5
In the INPUT area, click the / buttons at
the left and right of the L CH box to select
MIX 1 (MIX channel 1); then press the [ENTER]
key (or click within the box).
This assigns the output of MIX channel 1 to the L input
of the effect.
If a signal route is already assigned, a window will
appear when you press the [ENTER] key, asking you to
confirm the assignment. Click the OK button to con-
firm the assignment.
If you want to use the effect input in stereo, assign MIX
channel 2 to the R CH box in the same way.
6
In the OUTPUT area, make sure that the L CH
box indicates FX RTN1L and the R CH box indi-
cates FX RTN1R.
The L CH/R CH boxes in the OUTPUT area select the
input channels that are assigned to the L/R outputs of
the effect.
By default, the L/R outputs of effect 1 are assigned to
FX RTN channel 1 (L/R). If different channels are
selected, use the / buttons at the left and right of
the boxes to select FX RTN1L and FX RTN1R
respectively.
7
Set the MIX BALANCE knob to about 100.
The MIX BALANCE knob adjusts the balance between
the original sound and effect sound included in the
output signal from the effect. If this knob is at the 100
(%) position, only the effect sound will be output.
8
In the ENCODER MODE section, press the MIX
SEND SELECT [1] key to make the encoder
mode indicator show “1”.
In this state you can use the input channel encoders to
adjust the send level from each channel to MIX bus 1.
9
Turn the encoders of the INPUT channel strip
and ST IN channel strip to adjust the send
level of the signal sent from each channel to
MIX bus 1.
Don’t raise the encoder of the FX RTN channel you are using
as the effect return. Doing so will send the output of the effect
back to the input, possibly causing oscillation.
Hint
The send position of the signals sent from input channels to
the MIX bus can be specified for each channel (
p.43).
As an alternate way to adjust the send level, you can turn on
the [MIX SEND] key of the MIX section, then use a [SEL]
key to select an input channel and turn the corresponding
MIX encoder (
p.43).
CH to MIX Type selection box
EFFECT PARAM
OUTPUT area
INPUT area MIX BALANCE knob
The effect module you are using
PM5D/PM5D-RH Owner’s Manual Operating section 105
14
Effects
10
In the MIX section, press the [MIX MASTER]
key to turn it on (LED lit).
When the [MIX MASTER] key is on, you can use the
controls of the MIX section to control MIX channels
1–24.
11
Press the MIX channel 1 MIX [ON] key to
turn it on. Use the MIX encoder of that MIX
channel to adjust the master send level of
the signal sent to the effect.
12
In the FX RTN channel strip, press the FX
RTN channel 1 [ON] key to turn it on.
13
Use the FX RTN channel 1 fader to adjust the
effect return level.
Hint
The input/output levels of the effect can be viewed in the
meters shown in the EFFECT PARAM screen or EFFECT
ASSIGN screen.
Inserting an internal effect into a channel
You can insert an internal effect into a channel by assigning the input/output of the internal effect to the insert-out/insert-in of
the desired channel. As an example, here’s how to insert an effect into an input channel.
1
In the DISPLAY ACCESS section, repeatedly
press the [EFFECT] key to access the EFFECT
PARAM screen.
2
To select the effect module you want to use,
click the / buttons at the left and right of
the box in the upper left of the screen.
3
In the INPUT area, use the / buttons at
the left and right of the L CH box to select the
insert-out of the channel into which you want
to insert the effect, and press the [ENTER] key.
(If a signal route has already been assigned, a
window will ask you to confirm the assign-
ment change.)
If you are inserting the effect into a stereo channel (or
two paired channels), use the R CH box to assign the
insert-out for the other channel in the same way.
4
In the OUTPUT area, use the / buttons at
the left and right of the L CH box to select the
insert-in assigned to the L output of the effect.
If you are inserting the effect into a stereo channel (or
two paired channels), use the R CH box to assign the
insert-in for the other channel in the same way.
5
In the DISPLAY ACCESS section, repeatedly
press the INPUT [PATCH] key to access the
INSERT/DIRECT OUT POINT screen.
6
Turn on the INSERT ON/OFF button for the
channel into which you inserted the effect.
This enables the effect insertion for the corresponding
channel.
7
Use the buttons of the INSERT I/O area to
specify the insert-out/in point.
Hint
For details on the INSERT I/O area, refer to INSERT/DIRECT
POINT screen (
p.256) in the Reference section.
8
Turn on the [ON] key for the channel into
which you inserted the effect, and use the
fader to adjust the input level.
9
Access the EFFECT PARAM screen, and drag
the MIX BALANCE knob to adjust the balance
of the effect sound and original sound.
The input/output levels of the effect can be viewed in
the meters shown in the EFFECT PARAM screen or
EFFECT ASSIGN screen.
EFFECT PARAM
OUTPUT area
INPUT area MIX BALANCE knob
The effect module you are using
INSERT I/O area INSERT/DIRECT OUT POINT
INSERT ON/OFF button
14 Effects
106 PM5D/PM5D-RH Owner’s Manual Operating section
Basic operations in the effect screen
This section explains how to store or recall effect library data, and how to edit effect parameters.
Here’s how to recall existing settings from the effect library.
1
In the DISPLAY ACCESS section, repeatedly
press the [EFFECT] key to access the EFFECT
PARAM screen.
Note
You cannot change the currently selected effect type in the
EFFECT PARAM screen. To change the effect type, you must
recall (load) a library item that uses the desired effect type.
2
Click the / buttons at the left and right of
the box in the left side of the screen to select
the effect module you want to use, and then
click the LIBRARY button.
The EFFECT LIBRARY screen will appear, allowing
you to recall or store settings in the effect library.
Hint
You can also access this screen by repeatedly pressing the
[EFFECT] key. The effect module you are controlling can also
be selected in this screen.
3
In the library list at the right of the screen,
click to select the library item you want to
recall
When you click a library item in the library list, that
line will be highlighted and move to the center of the
list. The effect type of the currently selected library item
will be shown above the library list.
4
Click the RECALL button.
The selected library item will be loaded into the effect
module you chose.
Hint
You can click the EDIT button in the upper right of the screen
to access the EFFECT PARAM screen for the currently
selected effect.
Here’s how to edit the parameters of an internal effect.
1
In the DISPLAY ACCESS section, repeatedly
press the [EFFECT] key to access the EFFECT
PARAM screen.
The lower part of the screen will show knobs and but-
tons for editing the parameters of the currently selected
effect. The content of the parameters will depend on
the type of the currently selected effect.
2
Use the box in the upper left of the screen to
select the effect module you want to control.
3
Use the knobs and buttons in the lower part of
the screen to edit the effect parameters.
For details on the effect parameters, refer to the Appen-
dices at the end of this manual.
Hint
The parameter settings for internal effect modules 1–8 are
saved in the scene. The settings of individual effects can also
be stored in the effect library independently of scene memory.
Recalling settings from the effect
library
EFFECT PARAM
The effect module you are controlling
LIBRARY button
EFFECT LIBRARY RECALL button
Library listCurrent effect type
Editing the effect parameters
EFFECT PARAM
The effect module you are controlling
Effect parameters
PM5D/PM5D-RH Owner’s Manual Operating section 107
14
Effects
Here’s how to store effect parameter settings in the effect
library.
1
In the DISPLAY ACCESS section, repeatedly
press the [EFFECT] key to access the EFFECT
PARAM screen.
2
Use the box in the upper left of the screen to
select the effect module whose settings you
want to store, and click the LIBRARY button.
The EFFECT LIBRARY screen will appear, allowing
you to recall or store settings in the effect library.
3
In the library list, choose the store-destination
number and click that line.
Note
Library items for which an “R” (read-only) appears in the right
column of the list are factory preset library items. These num-
bers cannot be overwritten.
4
Click the STORE button.
The EFFECT LIBRARY STORE window will appear,
allowing you to name the library item you are saving.
5
Use the character palette to assign a name to
the library item.
For details on using the character palette, refer to p.26.
6
Click the STORE button.
A window will ask you to confirm the Store operation.
7
To execute the Store operation, click the OK
button.
The data will be stored, and you will return to the pre-
vious screen.
If you click the CANCEL button instead of the OK but-
ton, the Store operation will be aborted and you will
return to the previous screen.
Storing settings in the effect library
EFFECT PARAM
The effect module whose data you want to store
LIBRARY button
EFFECT LIBRARY
“R” (read-only)
14 Effects
108 PM5D/PM5D-RH Owner’s Manual Operating section
Using the Tap Tempo function
This section explains how to use the Tap Tempo function. “Tap tempo” is a function that lets you specify the delay time of a
delay effect or the modulation speed of a modulation effect by striking a key at the desired interval.
1
From the effect library, recall a library item
whose effect type uses a TEMPO parameter
(e.g., Delay+ER., Echo, Chorus).
TEMPO is a parameter that specifies a time-related
effect parameter (the DELAY parameter of Delay+ER.
or Echo, or the FREQ. parameter of Chorus, etc.) in
terms of a BPM value or a manual setting. The TEMPO
parameter is included in delay-type effects or modula-
tion-type effects, and is shown in the lower left of the
EFFECT PARAM screen.
Hint
For details on the parameters of each effect type, refer to the
Appendices at the end of this manual (
p.298).
2
In the DISPLAY ACCESS section, repeatedly
press the [EFFECT] key to access the EFFECT
PARAM screen.
The following illustration shows the screen when the
“Delay
ER.” effect type is selected.
3
Move the cursor to the TAP TEMPO button,
and repeatedly press the [ENTER] key at the
desired tempo. (Alternatively, repeatedly click
the TAP TEMPO button.)
The average interval (BPM) at which you press the key
will be calculated, and that value will be input for the
TEMPO parameter.
Hint
The Tap Tempo function is valid only for the currently dis-
played internal effect. However, it is ignored if the selected
effect type does not include a TEMPO parameter.
If the average value is outside the range of 20–300 BPM, it
will be ignored.
If desired, an external switch connected to the GPI connec-
tor can be used to operate the Tap Tempo function of the
current page (
p.123).
EFFECT PARAM
TAP TEMPO button
ab c
First tap Second tap Third tap Fourth tap
The average interval will be input
(the average of a, b, and c)
PM5D/PM5D-RH Owner’s Manual Operating section 109
14
Effects
Using the Freeze effect
Here’s how to use the “FREEZE” effect type, which provides the functionality of a simple sampler. When this effect type is
selected, you can perform operations in the screen to record (sample) and play back a sound.
1
In the EFFECT LIBRARY screen, recall a library
item that uses the FREEZE effect type.
2
In the DISPLAY ACCESS section, repeatedly
press the [EFFECT] key to access the EFFECT
PARAM screen.
If the FREEZE effect type is selected, the lower left of
the EFFECT PARAM screen will show a REC button, a
PLAY button, and a progress bar.
3
To begin recording (sampling), click the REC
button and then click the PLAY button.
The signal being input to the effect will be recorded.
The progress bar shows the current recording location.
When a fixed time has elapsed, the buttons will auto-
matically turn off.
Hint
You can adjust the parameters in the screen to make detailed
settings for recording time, the way in which recording will
begin, and the way in which the sample will play back. For
more about the parameters, refer to the Appendices at the
end of this manual (
p.305).
4
To play back the recorded sample, click the
PLAY button.
Note
Once you stop, the sampled content will be erased.
Using optional Add-On Effects
You can add effect types for the internal effects by install-
ing an optional Add-On Effects package. The installed
effect types can be recalled from effect library numbers 049
and following. For details on the installation procedure,
refer to the installation guide included with the Add-On
Effects package you purchased.
As of August 2004, the following Add-On Effects packages
are available for purchase.
AE011 Channel Strip Package
AE021 Master Strip Package
However, the Reverb Package sold as an Add-On Effects
package for the DM2000 or 02R96 is already included on
the PM5D as effect library numbers 046–048.
Other Add-On Effects packages are expected to go on sale
in the future, so please check the Yamaha website for the
latest information.
Yamaha Pro Audio Website:
http://www.yamahaproaudio.com
EFFECT PARAM
Progress bar
PLAY button
REC button
EFFECT PARAM
15 Graphic EQ
110 PM5D/PM5D-RH Owner’s Manual Operating section
The PM5D contains twelve 31-band graphic EQ modules. This chapter explains how to use the
graphic EQ.
Patching the graphic EQ
The twelve GEQ (Graphic EQ) modules built into the PM5D can be inserted into the insert-out/in of the desired channel. As
an example, here’s how to insert graphic EQ into the STEREO A channel.
1
In the DISPLAY ACCESS section, repeatedly
press the [GEQ] key to access the GEQ PARAM
screen.
In this screen you can select a GEQ module, specify the
channel into which it will be inserted, and edit its
parameters.
2
Click the / buttons at the left and right of
the MODULE box in the upper left of the
screen to select the GEQ module you want to
operate.
3
Click the / buttons at the left and right of
the INSERT box to select ST AL [INS] (STEREO
A L channel insert-in/out) as the channel into
which the GEQ module will be inserted, and
press the [ENTER] key (or click within the box).
You can choose one of the following insert
destinations.
If an insert destination is already assigned, a window
will appear when you click within the box, asking you
to confirm the change. Click the OK button to execute.
4
In the upper left of the screen, click the /
buttons at the left and right of the MODULE
box to select another GEQ module, and assign
it to ST AR [INS] (STEREO A R channel insert-
in) in the same way.
5
Click the GEQ ON/OFF button to turn it on.
Note
When you insert a GEQ, the insert-in for the channel will be
enabled automatically.
6
In the DISPLAY ACCESS section, repeatedly
press the OUTPUT [PATCH] key to access the
INSERT POINT screen.
7
If desired, change the insert point for the STE-
REO A channel into which you inserted the
graphic EQ.
When you insert a GEQ, the insert-in point for that
channel will be enabled automatically.
Note
If you inserted a graphic EQ into an input channel, repeat-
edly press the INPUT [PATCH] key to access the INSERT/
DIRECT OUT POINT screen (INPUT PATCH function), and
edit the settings in the same way.
You can also insert a graphic EQ into the desired channel’s
insert-in/out by using the INSERT PATCH screen (INPUT
PATCH function and OUTPUT PATCH function).
15 Graphic EQ
INS CH 1–INS CH48 Input channel 1–48 insert in/out
INS STIN1L–INS
STIN4R
ST IN channel 1–4 (L/R) insert in/
out
INS MIX 1–INS MIX24 MIX channel 1–24 insert in/out
INS MTRX1–INS
MTRX8
MATRIX channel 1–8 insert in/out
INS ST AL/INS ST AR
STEREO A channel (L/R) insert
in/out
INS ST BL–INS ST BR STEREO B channel insert in/out
INS MON L–INS MON C
MONITOR channel (L/R/C) insert
in/out
MODULE box GEQ ON/OFF button
GEQ PARAM
INSERT box
INSERT POINT
ON/OFF button Insert point
PM5D/PM5D-RH Owner’s Manual Operating section 111
15
Graphic EQ
Basic graphic EQ operations
There are two ways to control a graphic EQ; using the virtual faders and buttons within the display, or using the DCA faders of
the panel.
Here’s how to control the desired GEQ module by using
the faders and buttons shown in the GEQ PARAM screen
(GEQ function).
1
In the DISPLAY ACCESS section, repeatedly
press the [GEQ] key to access the GEQ PARAM
screen.
2
Click the / buttons at the left and right of
the MODULE box to select the GEQ module
you want to operate.
At this time make sure that the GEQ ON/OFF button
is on. Also make sure that the corresponding module is
inserted into an appropriate channel, and that insert-
in/out is enabled for that channel.
Hint
The upper part of the GEQ PARAM screen functions as a
spectrum analyzer. If a signal is being input to the corre-
sponding channel, the level of each frequency band is
displayed in realtime.
As an alternate way to select the desired GEQ module, you
can use the GEQ ASSIGN screen (GEQ function) (
p.157).
3
If desired, use the buttons of the LIMIT area to
specify the variable range of the faders.
The LIMIT area lets you select the maximum amount
and direction of the change controlled by the faders.
You can select ±15 dB/±12 dB/±6 dB (both boost and
cut directions) or –24 dB (cut only).
4
Drag the faders in the lower part of the screen
to adjust the amount of boost/cut.
The value of each fader is shown by the box below it.
Hint
Clicking the EQ FLAT button below the LIMIT area will reset
all faders to 0 dB.
Here’s how to control the graphic EQ using the keys and
faders of the panel DCA strip. In this case, the correspond-
ing GEQ module is divided into six regions for control.
1
In the DISPLAY ACCESS section, repeatedly
press the [GEQ] key to access the GEQ PARAM
screen.
2
Click the / buttons at the left and right of
the MODULE box to select the GEQ module
you want to operate.
At this time, make sure that the GEQ ON/OFF button
is turned on. Also make sure that the corresponding
module is inserted into an appropriate channel, and
that insert is enabled for that channel.
Hint
When the GEQ PARAM screen is displayed, pressing the
[SEL] key of a channel in which a GEQ module is inserted will
recall the corresponding GEQ module in the screen.
3
Use the buttons of the LIMIT area to select the
maximum amount and direction of the change
controlled by the faders.
4
In the lower part of the screen, click a button
in the ASSIGN TO FADERS area to select the
region you will control from the DCA faders.
The buttons in the ASSIGN TO FADERS area corre-
spond to the following frequency regions.
Controlling the graphic EQ from the
display
MODULE box Spectrum analyzer
GEQ PARAM
Faders LIMIT area
A 20.0-100 button The eight bands 20.0 Hz–100 Hz
B 63.0-315 button The eight bands 63.0 Hz–315 Hz
C 200-1.00k button The eight bands 200 Hz–1.00 kHz
D 630-3.15k button The eight bands 630 Hz–3.15 kHz
E
2.00k-10.0k button
The eight bands 2.00 kHz–10.0 kHz
F
4.00k-20.0k button
The eight bands 4.00 kHz–20.0 kHz
Controlling the graphic EQ from the
DCA section
MODULE box GEQ ON/OFF button
GEQ PARAM
LIMIT areaASSIGN TO FADERS area
15 Graphic EQ
112 PM5D/PM5D-RH Owner’s Manual Operating section
When a button is clicked, you can use the DCA faders
to control the faders of that frequency region. The fad-
ers of the selected region are indicated by a red line in
the center of the fader.
While any of the buttons in the ASSIGN TO FADERS
area is on, you can use the FADER MODE section
FADER MODE [A]–[F] keys to select the frequency
region corresponding to these buttons.
Even if all of the buttons in the ASSIGN TO FADERS
area are off, you can hold down the [SHIFT] key and
press one of the FADER MODE [A]–[F] keys to select
the region to be controlled by the DCA faders.
5
Operate DCA faders 1–8.
The corresponding frequency region will be boosted or
cut.
Hint
If the fader of a GEQ module is at the 0 dB position, the
[NOMINAL] LED of the DCA fader will light. If it is at other than
the 0 dB position, the DCA [MUTE] key will light. While the
DCA [MUTE] key is lit, pressing the DCA [MUTE] key will
reset the corresponding band to 0 dB.
6
If you want to use the DCA faders to control a
different region, repeat steps 4–5.
7
When you have finished using the DCA faders
to control the graphic EQ, either press the
FADER MODE [DCA] key or click the OFF but-
ton in the ASSIGN TO FADERS area.
When the [DCA] button is on, the FADER MODE
keys and the DCA faders will return to their normal
state. If you once again want to assign the graphic EQ
to the DCA faders, either click a button in the ASSIGN
TO FADERS area or hold down the [SHIFT] key and
press a FADER MODE [A]–[F] key.
Hint
GEQ settings are saved as part of the scene. The settings of
a GEQ module can also be saved in the GEQ library. For
details, refer to GEQ LIBRARY screen (
p.158) in the Ref-
erence section.
When you switch the display to a different screen, the DCA
fader assignments will be forcibly defeated, and will no
longer function even if you return to the GEQ screen. How-
ever if you turn on the AUTO ASSIGN button in the GEQ
PARAM screen, the DCA faders will automatically be
assigned to the most recently operated region when you
access the GEQ PARAM screen.
20.0Hz–100Hz 630Hz–3.15kHz
63.0Hz–315Hz 200Hz–1.00kHz
2.00kHz–10.0kHz
4.00kHz–20.0kHz
PM5D/PM5D-RH Owner’s Manual Operating section 113
16
Remote control
This chapter explains how you can use MIDI or GPI to control the PM5D’s parameters from an
external device, or conversely how you can use the PM5D to control external devices.
MIDI on the PM5D
The PM5D can use MIDI to perform the following operations.
Program Change transmission and reception
When you execute a specific event (scene/effect library
recall) on the PM5D, a program change message of the
corresponding number can be transmitted to an exter-
nal device. Conversely, the corresponding events can be
executed when program change messages are received
from an external device.
Control Change transmission and reception
When you execute a specific event (fader/encoder or
key operation) on the PM5D, a control change mes-
sage of the corresponding number can be transmitted
to an external device. Conversely, events can be exe-
cuted when control change messages are received from
an external device. This capability can be used to
record fader and key operations on a MIDI sequencer
or other external device, and play back this data later.
System exclusive messages can also be used to transmit
or receive bulk data (scene or library content) or
parameters.
MIDI Remote function
You can assign MIDI messages to the controls of the
INPUT/ST IN channel strip, and transmit those MIDI
messages by operating the controls. This capability can
be used for remote control of external MIDI devices
such as synthesizers, or to control the parameters of
DAW software or a HDR unit.
MIDI Event transmission
MIDI messages can be registered independently for
each scene in scene memory, and transmitted when
that scene is recalled.
Note
For each of the above functions, the MIDI port used to trans-
mit/receive MIDI messages can be selected from the rear
panel MIDI IN/OUT connectors, the rear panel USB connec-
tor, and an I/O card installed in slots 1 through 4. (If the USB
connector or an I/O card is selected, you can additionally
choose from ports 1 through 8.) However, MIDI Event trans-
mission is fixed at the MIDI OUT connector.
Using program changes to control events
The PM5D lets you assign specific events (scene recall / effect library recall) to each MIDI program number, so that the corre-
spondingly-numbered program change message will be transmitted to an external device when you execute that event on the
PM5D. Conversely, the corresponding event can be executed when a program change message is received from an external
device.
1
Connect the MIDI OUT connector of the exter-
nal device to the PM5D’s MIDI IN connector.
Connect the MIDI OUT connector of the PM5D
to the MIDI IN connector of the external
device.
2
In the DISPLAY ACCESS section, press the
[MIDI/REMOTE] key several times to access the
MIDI PGM CHANGE screen shown below.
In the MIDI PGM CHANGE screen you can assign
events to each program number, select the port at
which MIDI messages will be transmitted and received,
and select how program changes will be transmitted
and received.
16 Remote control
MIDI IN MIDI OUT MIDI OUTMIDI IN
PM5D
External
device
MIDI PGM CHANGE
16 Remote control
114 PM5D/PM5D-RH Owner’s Manual Operating section
3
In the PROGRAM CHANGE SETUP area at the
left of the screen, you can select the way in
which program changes will be transmitted
and received, and switch reception and trans-
mission on/off.
The MODE area of PROGRAM CHANGE SETUP lets
you choose one of the following as the way in which
program changes will be transmitted and received.
SINGLE
If this button is on, program changes will be transmit-
ted/received on a single MIDI channel (Single mode).
OMNI ON/OFF
If this button is on, program changes of all MIDI chan-
nels will be received in Single mode (this is unavailable
in Multi mode).
BANK ON/OFF
If this button is on, bank select messages will be trans-
mitted and received in Single mode (this is unavailable
in Multi mode).
MULTI
If this button is on, program changes will be transmit-
ted/received on multiple MIDI channels (Multi mode).
You can use the Tx (transmission) and Rx (reception)
buttons to turn program change transmission and
reception on/off separately.
4
In the MIDI SETUP area at the upper left of the
screen, select the port at which program
changes will be transmitted/received, and the
MIDI channel that will be used for transmis-
sion and reception. You have the following
choices.
Click the / buttons at the left and right of the Tx
box (transmission) or Rx box (reception) to change the
setting, and press the [ENTER] key (or click within the
box) to finalize the setting. If you select USB or SLOT
1–4, use the box at the right to specify the port number
(1–8) as well.
If SINGLE (single mode) is selected as the program
change transmission/reception mode, use the MIDI
CH field to select the MIDI transmit channel and MIDI
receive channel.
Hint
The MIDI port and MIDI channel used for program change
transmission/reception can also be specified from the MIDI
SETUP screen (
p.171).
5
In the list at the right side of the screen, dis-
play the MIDI channel (bank) and program
number to which you want to assign an event,
and click that line.
This list lets you select the event (scene recall / effect
library recall) assigned to each program number.
The list contains the following columns.
CH/BANK (Channel/Bank)
In Multi mode, or in Single mode when the BANK
ON/OFF button is off, the value in this column indi-
cates the MIDI channel on which program changes are
transmitted and received.
In Single mode when the BANK ON/OFF button is on,
the value in this column indicates the bank number.
PGM No. (Program number)
Indicates the program number 1–128.
LIBRARY NAME
In this column you can view/select the type and the
number of the event assigned to each channel (bank)/
program number.
Use the scroll bar at the right to display the desired
channel (bank) and program number, and click that
line; the line you click will move to the center and will
be highlighted.
6
Click the button in the LIBRARY NAME col-
umn of the currently selected line to open the
MIDI PGM CHANGE window.
In this window you can select the type of event (a
scene, or a library item for effect 1–8) and its number.
MIDI The rear panel MIDI IN/OUT connectors
USB The rear panel USB connector
SLOT 1–4 An I/O card installed in rear panel slot 1–4
PM5D/PM5D-RH Owner’s Manual Operating section 115
16
Remote control
In the list at the left, select the type of event. In the list
at the right, select the scene/library number that will be
recalled. The following types of event can be selected in
the list at the left.
7
When you have finished making settings, click
the OK button in the MIDI PGM CHANGE
window.
8
Assign events to other program numbers in
the same way.
With these settings, executing the specified event on
the PM5D will cause a program change (or bank select
+ program change) message to be transmitted to the
external device.
When an external device transmits a program change
(or bank select + program change) message on the
appropriate channel, the event assigned to that pro-
gram number will be executed.
Hint
You can use the CLEAR button above the list to erase all
assignments to program numbers. The PRESET button will
return all program number assignments to their default state.
The contents of the program change table are not saved in
the scene. If desired, you can save this data on a memory
card as a MIDI PGM TABLE.
Note
If more than one program number is assigned to a single
scene, only the lowest-numbered program change will be
transmitted in Single mode, and in Multi mode the lowest-
numbered program change for each channel will be
transmitted.
Using control changes to control events
You can use MIDI control change messages to control specified events (fader/encoder operations, key on/off operations etc.)
on the PM5D. This capability can be used to record fader and key operations on a MIDI sequencer or other external device,
and play back this data later.
You can use control changes to control events in either of
the following two ways.
Using control change numbers 1–119
This method uses the common variety of control
change messages. You can freely assign an event to each
control number.
Using NRPN (Non Registered Parameter Number)
This method uses a special type of control change mes-
sages called NRPN. NRPN uses control change
numbers 99 and 98 to specify the MSB (Most Signifi-
cant Byte) and LSB (Least Significant Byte) of the
parameter number, and subsequently-transmitted con-
trol change messages of control change number 6 (or 6
and 38) to specify the value of that parameter.
The event specified by each combination of MSB and
LSB is fixed.
1
Connect the MIDI OUT connector of the exter-
nal device to the PM5D’s MIDI IN connector.
Connect the MIDI OUT connector of the PM5D
to the MIDI IN connector of the external
device.
2
In the DISPLAY ACCESS section, press the
[MIDI/REMOTE] key several times to access the
MIDI CTRL CHANGE screen shown below.
In the MIDI CTRL CHANGE screen you can select the
port used to transmit/receive MIDI messages, and how
control changes will be transmitted and received. If
control change 1–119 is selected as the transmission/
reception method, you can assign the desired event to
each control number.
NO ASSIGN No event is assigned
SCENE Scene memory recall
EFFECT 1–8
Recall an effect library item into an internal
effect module 1–8
Event type Scene/library number
MIDI CTRL CHANGE
16 Remote control
116 PM5D/PM5D-RH Owner’s Manual Operating section
3
In the CONTROL CHANGE SETUP area at the
left of the screen, you can select the way in
which control changes will be transmitted and
received, and switch reception and transmis-
sion on/off.
The MODE area of CONTROL CHANGE SETUP lets
you choose one of the following as the way in which
control changes will be transmitted and received.
You can use the buttons in the Tx (transmission) area
and Rx (reception) area to turn control change trans-
mission/reception on/off.
4
In the MIDI SETUP area at the upper left of the
screen, select the port used to transmit/
receive control changes, and the MIDI chan-
nel used for transmission and reception.
In MIDI SETUP, the MIDI PORT settings let you select
the port used for MIDI control change transmission/
reception; you have the following choices.
Click the / buttons at the left and right of the Tx
box (transmission) or Rx box (reception) to change the
setting, and press the [ENTER] key to finalize the set-
ting. If you select USB or SLOT 1–4, use the box at the
right to specify the port number (1–8) as well.
If TABLE [SINGLE] or NRPN are selected as the con-
trol change transmission/reception method, use MIDI
CH field to choose the MIDI channel used for trans-
mission and reception.
Hint
The MIDI port and MIDI channel used for control change
transmission/reception can also be specified from the MIDI
SETUP screen (
p.171).
5
If TABLE [SINGLE] or TABLE [MULTI] are
selected as the control change transmission/
reception method, use the list in the right of
the screen to display the MIDI channel and
control number to which you want to assign
an event, and click that line.
In this list you can select the event (fader/encoder oper-
ation, key operation, etc.) that will be assigned to each
control number. The list contains the following
columns.
CH (Channel)
Indicates the MIDI channel on which the control
change is transmitted/received.
Note
You can use this column to specify multiple MIDI channels
even if TABLE [SINGLE] is selected as the transmission/
reception method. However in actuality, only the MIDI trans-
mit/receive channel selected in the MIDI SETUP field will be
valid.
CTRL No. (Control number)
Indicates the control number 1–119. You cannot make
settings for numbers 0, 32, or 96–101.
CTRL CHANGE EVENT (Library name)
Indicates/selects the type of event assigned to the corre-
sponding channel / control number.
Use the scroll bar at the right to display the desired
channel and control number, and click that line; the
line you click will move to the center and will be
highlighted.
6
Click the button in the CTRL CHANGE
EVENT column of the currently selected line to
open the MIDI CTRL CHANGE window, and
specify the parameter that you want to assign.
In this window you can specify the parameter in three
levels (mode, parameters 1/2).
7
When you have finished making settings, click
the OK button in the MIDI CTRL CHANGE
window.
8
Assign events to other control numbers in the
same way.
When you operate the parameters you assigned on the
PM5D, control change messages will be transmitted to
external devices.
Similarly, if the corresponding control change mes-
sages are sent from an external device on the
appropriate channel, the parameters assigned to those
control numbers will change.
NRPN
If this button is on, PM5D parameters
will be transmitted/received as NRPN
messages.
TABLE [SINGLE]
If this button is on, PM5D parameters
will be transmitted/received as control
change messages on a single MIDI
channel according to the assignments
in the list at the right side of the screen.
TABLE [MULTI]
If this button is on, PM5D parameters
will be transmitted/received as control
change messages on multiple MIDI
channels according to the assignments
in the list at the right side of the screen.
MIDI The rear panel MIDI IN/OUT connectors
USB The rear panel USB connector
SLOT 1–4 An I/O card installed in rear panel slot 1–4
PM5D/PM5D-RH Owner’s Manual Operating section 117
16
Remote control
Hint
You can use the CLEAR button above the list to erase all
assignments to control numbers. The PRESET button will
return all control number assignments to their default state.
The contents of the control change table are not saved in
the scene. If desired, you can save this data on a memory
card as a MIDI CTRL TABLE.
Using the MIDI Remote function
“MIDI Remote” allows you to assign MIDI messages to the controllers (faders, encoders, CH [ON] keys, ENCODER [ON]
keys) of the INPUT/ST IN channel strips so that these MIDI messages will be transmitted when you operate these controllers.
This capability can be used for remote control of external MIDI devices such as synthesizers, or to control the parameters of
DAW software or a HDR unit.
While the MIDI Remote function is active, INPUT chan-
nel strip 1–24 functions as MIDI remote channels 1–24,
and ST IN channel strip 1–4 functions as MIDI remote
channels 25–28.
To each controller you can assign a MIDI message consist-
ing of up to sixteen bytes of hexadecimal data. If desired,
you can specify that a value within the message varies
according to the movement of the controller.
Here’s how to specify the MIDI port used by the MIDI
Remote function, and assign a MIDI message to the
desired MIDI remote channel.
1
In the DISPLAY ACCESS section, press the
[MIDI/REMOTE] key several times to access the
MIDI SETUP screen shown below.
2
In the MIDI REMOTE area at the right of the
screen, select one of the following as the port
from which MIDI messages will be output for
each of the four MIDI Remote banks (BANK A–
D).
Click the / buttons at the left and right of each
box to change the setting, and press the [ENTER] key
(or click within the box) to finalize the setting. If you
select USB or SLOT 1–4, use the box at the right to
specify the port number (1–8) as well.
MIDI remote channels 1–24 MIDI remote channels 25–28
MIDI The rear panel MIDI OUT connector
USB The rear panel USB connector
SLOT 1–4 An I/O card installed in rear panel slot 1–4
Assigning MIDI messages to controllers
MIDI SETUP
16 Remote control
118 PM5D/PM5D-RH Owner’s Manual Operating section
3
In the DISPLAY ACCESS section, press the
[MIDI/REMOTE] key several times to access the
MIDI REMOTE screen shown below.
4
In the BANK SELECT area at the upper right of
the screen, use the A–D buttons to select the
bank you want to use.
The bank name is displayed above buttons A–D. You
can change the name by clicking the button at the
left of the bank name.
5
In the upper left of the screen, set the TRANS-
MIT ENABLE/DISABLE button to ENABLE.
Transmission will be enabled for the selected bank.
(You can enable/disable transmission for each of the
four banks.)
6
Use the channel select area at the left of the
screen to select the MIDI remote channel to
which you want to assign a MIDI message.
These buttons correspond to the following channel
strips.
When you click the / buttons at the left and right
of the box, the corresponding name is displayed in the
box at the right. You can change the name of the MIDI
remote channel by clicking the button of the box at
right.
7
Use the MIDI message boxes in the lower part
of the screen to specify a MIDI message for
each controller of the channel.
The lower part of the MIDI REMOTE screen contains
MIDI message boxes that let you assign a MIDI mes-
sage to the ENCODER [ON] key, encoder, CH [ON]
key, and fader.
You can assign a MIDI message to a controller in any
of the following three ways.
A Directly inputting hexadecimal values
In this method you directly input the message as hexa-
decimal values. To use this method, click the button
at the left edge of the desired MIDI message box to
open the MIDI REMOTE SETUP window.
In this window you can input a message by clicking the
desired input box to select it (the box will be high-
lighted) and turning the [DATA] encoder. You can use
the [INC]/[DEC] keys to move the selected position.
You can input the following values.
REMOTE CH 1–24 INPUT channel strip 1–24
REMOTE CH 25–28 ST IN channel strip 1–4
MIDI REMOTE
BANK SELECT area
Channel select area
TRANSMIT
ENABLE/DISABLE button
Value
Available
assign-
ments
Content
00(H)–
FF(H)
All
The MIDI message that is transmitted
(hexadecimal).
END All
Indicates the end of the MIDI mes-
sage. When you operate the corre-
sponding controller, the MIDI
message from the beginning until
immediately before END will be
transmitted.
SW All
Indicates the on/off status of the
encoder [ON] key or the channel
[ON] key. A value of 7F(H) is transmit-
ted when the key turns on, and a
value of 00(H) is transmitted when
the key turns off. If this is assigned to
an encoder or fader, the current value
of the key will be transmitted when
the encoder or fader is operated.
ENC
ENCODER
ON/
ENCODER
Indicates the current position of the
encoder. If assigned to an encoder, a
value of 00–7F(H) is transmitted
when the encoder is operated. If
assigned to an encoder [ON] key, the
current value of the encoder is trans-
mitted when the key is switched on.
FAD
CH ON/
FADER
Indicates the current position of the
fader. If the message is assigned to a
fader, this value is transmitted as a
value of 00–7F(H) when the fader is
operated. If assigned to a CH [ON]
key, the current value of the fader is
transmitted when the key is switched
on.
LEARN buttonLATCH button MIDI message box
PM5D/PM5D-RH Owner’s Manual Operating section 119
16
Remote control
If you set a value to SW, ENC, or FAD, that value will
be linked to the state of the controller. For example if
you have made settings as shown in the following
screen, the last value will be linked with the fader posi-
tion, and will change in the range of 0–127.
When you click a box in which a hexadecimal value has
been input, the range of values that can be interpreted
as a valid MIDI message (including that box) will turn
red. The lower part of the screen shows the MIDI chan-
nel (MIDI CH), message type (TYPE), and data values
(DATA 1, DATA 2) for this MIDI message, letting you
verify that the appropriate MIDI message has been
input.
You can use the following buttons to input or edit the
message in this window.
When you have finished inputting data in the MIDI
REMOTE SETUP window, click the OK button. The
hexadecimal values will be input in the MIDI message
box of the MIDI REMOTE screen.
B Specifying the type of message
In this method you specify the desired MIDI channel,
type of message, and data value; these will be con-
verted into the appropriate hexadecimal values. Access
the MIDI REMOTE SETUP window in the same way
as for method
1, and click the first box into which
you want to input data.
Next, click the / buttons at the left and right of the
TYPE box to select the type of message.
Then use the MIDI CH, DATA 1, and DATA 2 boxes
to specify the MIDI channel and various values. The
values that can be selected in the MIDI CH, DATA 1,
and DATA 2 boxes will depend on the type of message
you selected first.
If you set the DATA 1 or DATA 2 value to SWITCH,
ENCODER (available only for encoders), or FADER
(available only for faders), that value will be linked with
the state of the controller.
buttons Move the highlighted area to left or right.
INS button
Inserts a space (blank) at the highlighted
position. Pressing the <Insert> key of a
PS/2 keyboard will produce the same
result.
DEL button
Deletes the character at the highlighted
position. Pressing the <Delete> key of a
PS/2 keyboard will produce the same
result.
CLEAR button
Erases the entire message that was input
in the MIDI message input boxes.
PASTE button
Pastes the message that was copied to
buffer memory by the COPY button.
COPY button
Copies the message from the MIDI mes-
sage input box to temporary buffer mem-
ory. Use this in conjunction with the PASTE
button to copy a message from one con-
troller to another bank or controller.
TYPE MIDI CH DATA 1 DATA 2
NOTE OFF
1–16
Note number
(0–127)
Note-off velocity
(0–127)
NOTE ON
Note-on velocity
(0–127)
KEY PRES-
SURE
Pressure value
(0–127)
CONTROL
CHANGE
Control num-
ber (0–127)
Controller value
(0–127)
PROGRAM
CHANGE
Program
number
CHANNEL
PRESSURE
Pressure
value (0–127)
PITCH BEND
Pitch bend
MSB (0–127)
Pitch bend LSB
(0–127)
EXCLUSIVE
MESSAGE
Hexadecimal values that were input
Type of message
16 Remote control
120 PM5D/PM5D-RH Owner’s Manual Operating section
When you have specified all of the values, click the
“” button in the screen; the hexadecimal val-
ues for that message will be input in the input box of
the MIDI REMOTE SETUP window. As necessary, you
can edit the message by clicking an input box and turn-
ing the [DATA] encoder.
C Using the LEARN button
The LEARN button lets you assign a MIDI message to
a controller by receiving that message from an external
device. To use the Learn function, go to the MIDI
REMOTE screen and click the LEARN button in for
the controller to which you want to assign a message.
Note
Only one LEARN button can be turned on simultaneously.
The LEARN button is valid only for the MIDI remote channel
that is currently selected. Also, you cannot change the MIDI
remote channel while this button is on.
The LEARN button is turned off automatically when you
switch to a different screen.
If a MIDI message is received at a MIDI port available
for the current bank while the LEARN button is on, the
received message will be input to the MIDI input box.
The following screen shows an example of when the
modulation wheel (control change #1) of a synthesizer
is operated.
Hint
MIDI messages assigned using the LEARN button can be a
maximum of 16 bytes long (the 17th and subsequent bytes
are discarded). If the message is less than 16 bytes long,
END will be placed immediately after the last data value.
If a control change is received, the third byte will automati-
cally be replaced by FAD (if the assignment destination is a
fader), ENC (if the assignment destination is an encoder), or
SW (if the assignment destination is an encoder [ON] or CH
[ON] key).
If multiple messages are received while the LEARN button is
on, the last-received message will be used. If the status byte
is omitted from the last message, the appropriate status byte
will be supplied.
8
Assign messages to other MIDI remote chan-
nels or other banks in the same way.
If a specific byte is set to “SW” for the ENCODER
[ON] key or CH [ON] key, use the LATCH button to
select one of the following behaviors.
If the LATCH button is on
The on/off status will change each time you press the
key (Latched). If you press the key from the Off state, a
MIDI message with 7F(H) as the SW value will be
transmitted, and when you press the same key once
again a MIDI message with 00(H) as the SW value will
be transmitted.
If the LATCH button is off
The switch will be on only while you are holding it
down, and will turn off when you release it
(Unlatched). The moment you press the key, a MIDI
message with 7F(H) as the SW value will be transmit-
ted; the moment you release the key, a MIDI message
with a SW value of 00(H) will be transmitted.
If a specific byte is set to “ENC” (or “FAD”) for the
ENCODER [ON] key or CH [ON] key, use the
LATCH button to select one of the following
behaviors.
If the LATCH button is on
If you press the key from the Off state, a MIDI message
with the current value of the encoder (or fader) as the
ENC (or FAD) value will be transmitted, and when you
press the same key once again a MIDI message with
00(H) as the ENC (or FAD) value will be transmitted.
If the LATCH button is off
The moment you press the key, a MIDI message with
the current value of the encoder (or fader) as the ENC
(or FAD) value will be transmitted, and the moment
you release the key a MIDI message with 00(H) as the
ENC (or FAD) value will be transmitted.
Note
If SW/ENC/FAD are not specified as the last byte of the MIDI
message, the same MIDI message will be transmitted when
the key is turned on or off. (The same message will be trans-
mitted when the key is turned off.)
Hexadecimal values that were input
PM5D/PM5D-RH Owner’s Manual Operating section 121
16
Remote control
Here’s how to recall banks A–D to which you assigned
MIDI messages, and operate MIDI remote channels.
1
In the DISPLAY ACCESS section, press the
[MIDI/REMOTE] key several times to access the
following MIDI REMOTE screen.
2
In the BANK SELECT area at the upper right of
the screen, use the A–D buttons to select the
bank you want to use.
3
In the upper middle of the screen, use the
ASSIGN TO CH STRIP SECTION buttons to
select the MIDI remote channel you want to
control. (Multiple simultaneous selections are
allowed.)
This setting applies to all four banks.
Turning on a button will enable the MIDI Remote
function; the corresponding channel strip will func-
tion as MIDI remote channels. (The usual function of
the controllers will be disabled.)
At this time, the lower part of the display will indicate
“REMOTE” in the encoder/fader mode area. The
INPUT CH layer and ST IN/FX RTN layer indications
will change to the corresponding MIDI remote
channel.
4
Operate the appropriate channel strip.
MIDI messages will be transmitted from the corre-
sponding MIDI port.
5
To disable the MIDI Remote function, turn off
the ASSIGN TO CH STRIP SECTION buttons.
Note
When the MIDI Remote function is enabled, the controllers
will return to their normal state if you switch to another
screen. However when you come back to the MIDI
REMOTE screen, the remote function of the controllers will
be enabled.
The controller values during MIDI Remote operation are
included in the scene data. This means that when you recall
a scene, the controller values will change and MIDI mes-
sages will be transmitted. Recall Safe settings can also be
applied to the MIDI Remote function
INPUT CH INPUT channel strip 1–24
STIN/FXRTN ST IN/FX RTN channel strip 1–4
Using MIDI remote channels
MIDI REMOTE BANK SELECT area
ST IN/FX RTN
layer
INPUT CH
layer
Encoder/fader
mode area
16 Remote control
122 PM5D/PM5D-RH Owner’s Manual Operating section
Transmitting MIDI events when you switch scenes
You can register a desired MIDI message for each scene in scene memory so that this message will be transmitted from the
MIDI OUT connector when you recall the scene. For example you can use this to switch programs on an external MIDI-com-
patible effect processor when the scene changes.
1
Connect the MIDI OUT connector of the PM5D
to the MIDI IN connector of the external
device.
2
In the DISPLAY ACCESS section, press the
[SCENE] key several times to access the SCENE
screen shown below.
3
Scroll the scene list upward or downward to
select the scene number for which you want to
assign a MIDI event.
4
Scroll the scene list toward the right to dis-
play the MIDI EVENT column.
In the MIDI EVENT column you will input the MIDI
message that will be transmitted when you recall that
scene.
5
Click the button at the left edge of the MIDI
EVENT column to open the MIDI EVENT SETUP
window.
6
Use the MIDI EVENT SETUP window to specify
the MIDI message that will be linked with that
scene.
The procedure for specifying a MIDI message in the
MIDI EVENT SETUP window is the same as in the
MIDI REMOTE screen MIDI REMOTE SETUP win-
dow, with the exceptions that you cannot select FAD,
ENC, or SW for the DATA 1/DATA 2 boxes, and that
there is no LEARN button. (For details, refer to
p.118) When you have finished making settings, click
the OK button in the MIDI EVENT SETUP window.
7
Click the Tx ON/OFF
column located at the
right of the MIDI EVENT
column to turn it on.
The MIDI event linked to
the corresponding scene is
now enabled.
8
In the same way, specify MIDI events for other
scene numbers.
9
Recall a scene to which a MIDI event is linked.
The MIDI message will be transmitted from the speci-
fied MIDI port.
SCENE
MIDI EVENT column
PM5D/PM5D-RH Owner’s Manual Operating section 123
16
Remote control
Using GPI (General Purpose Interface)
The GPI connector on the rear panel can be used as a GPI (General Purpose Interface) input/output connector. This connec-
tor provides four GPI IN ports and twelve GPI OUT ports. For example you can use an external switch or joystick to control
the PM5D’s parameters, or conversely use the PM5D’s keys and faders to send control signals to an external device.
The following diagram is an example of an external circuit
that can operate GPI via the GPI connector. (For specifica-
tions of the GPI connector pins, refer to the Appendices
p.348 and p.355 at the end of the manual.)
This circuit uses four switches (GPI 1–GPI 4) to switch the
GPI IN ports between active and inactive. If the polarity of
a GPI OUT port is set to Low Active, and you operate the
PM5D to make the GPI OUT port Active, the correspond-
ing LED in the above circuit (GPO 1–GPO 12) will light.
(If the polarity of the GPI OUT port is High Active, the
LED will go dark.)
You can use the GPI IN ports of the GPI connector to con-
trol PM5D parameters from an external device. For
example you can use an external switch to turn the
PM5D’s talkback on/off or to operate its Tap Tempo func-
tion, or you can use a joystick to control surround
panning.
1
Connect an external device to the PM5D’s GPI
connector.
2
In the DISPLAY ACCESS section, press the
[MIDI/REMOTE] key several times to access the
GPI screen shown below.
In this screen, the upper list is used to make GPI IN
settings and the lower list is used to make GPI OUT
settings.
3
In the POLARITY column of the GPI IN list,
select the polarity of each GPI IN port.
You can select one of the following as the polarity for a
GPI IN port.
(Low active)
When controlling an on/off switch-type parameter, the
port will become active when the switch is grounded.
When controlling a continuously-variable parameter,
that parameter will be at its maximum value when the
voltage is at low level (by default, 0V), and at its mini-
mum value when the voltage is at high level (by default,
approximately 5V).
(High active)
When controlling an on/off switch-type parameter, the
port will be active when the switch is opened or when a
high-level voltage is input.
9 1 21 14 9 2 21 15
GPO 1 GPO 2 GPO 3 GPO 4
9 3 21 16 9 4 21 17
GPO 5 GPO 6 GPO 7 GPO 8
21 24 9 12 21 25 9 13
GPO 9 GPO 10 GPO 11 GPO 12
14
15
16
17
18
19
20
21
22
23
24
25
2
3
4
5
6
7
8
9
10
11
12
13
1
GPI 1 GPI 2
GPI 3 GPI 4
22 18 10 6 23 19 11 7
Using GPI IN
GPIGPI IN list
GPI OUT list
16 Remote control
124 PM5D/PM5D-RH Owner’s Manual Operating section
When controlling a continuously-variable parameter,
that parameter will be at its minimum value when the
voltage is at low level, and at its maximum value when
the voltage is at high level.
While the GPI screen is displayed, the GPI IN status
column of the GPI IN area will show a yellow bar
graph to indicate the approximate value of the voltage
being input to each port. (If the bar is not shown, the
voltage is grounded; if the bar is displayed all the way
to the right edge, the voltage is at high level.)
Hint
The voltage value at which the PM5D detects High or Low
level can be adjusted to suit the external controller (except for
external switches) you are using (
p.125).
4
At the left edge of the FUNCTION column,
click the button to open the GPI IN PORT
ASSIGN window.
In the GPI IN PORT ASSIGN window you can select
the PM5D function that will be controlled by each GPI
IN port.
Use the FUNCTION column to select the type of func-
tion, and use the PARAMETER column to select the
optional parameters. You can select the following func-
tions and parameters.
After you have specified the function and parameter,
click the OK button.
Note
If latched operation is selected, the port will change between
active/inactive each time a trigger is input from an external
switch. In this case, we recommend that you use a non-lock-
ing type of external switch.
If unlatched operation is selected, the port will be active only
while the signal from the external switch stays at high level
or low level. In this case, we recommend that you use either
a non-locking or a locking type of external switch as appro-
priate for your situation.
FUNCTION PARAMETER PM5D operation
NO
ASSIGN
No assignment
MONITOR
DIMMER ON
Switches the Dimmer func-
tion on/off
SOURCE =
[monitor
source name]
Switches the monitor source
MONO ON
Switches the Monitor section
[MONO] key on
PARAMETER
column
FUNCTION columnGPI IN
status
POLARITY column
TALK-
BACK ON
LATCH
Switches the Talkback func-
tion on/off (latched operation)
UNLATCH
Switches the Talkback func-
tion on/off (unlatched opera-
tion)
CH ON-
LATCH
[channel
name]
Switches the channel on/off
(latched operation)
CH ON-
UNLATCH
[channel
name]
Switches the channel on/off
(unlatched operation)
FADER
LEVEL
[channel
name]
Modifies the fader value
(LEVEL parameter) accord-
ing to the voltage
SUR-
ROUND
PA N
FRONT-REAR
PAN [SEL]
Modifies the surround pan-
ning (front/rear) of the
selected channel according
to the voltage
LEFT-RIGHT
PAN [SEL]
Modifies the surround pan-
ning (left/right) of the selected
channel according to the volt-
age
FRONT-REAR
PAN [ODD]
Modifies the surround pan-
ning (front/rear) of the
selected odd-numbered
channel according to the volt-
age
LEFT-RIGHT
PAN [ODD]
Modifies the surround pan-
ning (left/right) of the selected
odd-numbered channel
according to the voltage
FRONT-REAR
PAN [EVEN]
Modifies the surround pan-
ning (front/rear) of the
selected even-numbered
channel according to the volt-
age
LEFT-RIGHT
PAN [EVEN]
Modifies the surround pan-
ning (left/right) of the selected
even-numbered channel
according to the voltage
USER
DEFINED
KEY
FUNCTION
[User Defined
key bank / key
number]
While the external input is
active, executes the same
operation as when the
selected User Defined key is
pressed
USER
DEFINED
KEY LED
[User Defined
key bank / key
number]
While the external input is
active, lights the LED of the
selected User Defined key
PEAK
HOLD ON
Switches the Peak Hold func-
tion on/off
OSCILLA-
TOR ON
Switches the Oscillator on/off
SOLO ON
Switches the Solo function
on/off
FUNCTION PARAMETER PM5D operation
PM5D/PM5D-RH Owner’s Manual Operating section 125
16
Remote control
5
Specify the function and parameter for other
GPI IN ports in the same way.
With these settings when you operate an external
device to make the GPI IN port active, the correspond-
ing PM5D function will be executed. (If a
continuously-variable parameter is assigned, the
parameter value will vary according to the change in
voltage.)
Hint
The settings in the GPI screen apply to all scenes. These set-
tings can also be saved on a memory card as SETUP data.
If necessary, the voltage values at which the PM5D detects
Low and High levels can be adjusted appropriately for the
voltage of the signals being input from the GPI IN port.
You can use this to set the variable range of a PM5D
parameter to match the range of voltage change produced
by a continuously-variable controller (such as a joystick).
1
Connect an external device to the PM5D’s GPI
connector.
2
In the DISPLAY ACCESS section, press the
[MIDI/REMOTE] key several times to access the
GPI screen.
3
In the GPI IN MONITOR area at the upper
right of the screen, select the GPI IN port that
you want to calibrate.
If you are calibrating a two-dimensional controller
such as a joystick, click the / buttons at the left
and right of the X-AXIS and Y-AXIS fields to specify
the two GPI IN ports.
If you are calibrating only one GPI IN port, set one of
them to “----” (no assignment).
When you specify a GPI IN port, the voltage from that
GPI IN port is indicated by a yellow symbol in the
GPI IN monitor area. In this case, the horizontal posi-
tion (X-axis) corresponds to the voltage of the GPI IN
port selected in the X-AXIS field, and the vertical posi-
tion (Y-axis) corresponds to the voltage of the GPI IN
port selected in the Y-AXIS field.
The red line (or red square) displayed in the GPI IN
monitor area indicates the range between High level
and Low level for the GPI IN ports corresponding to
the Y-axis and X-axis.
Hint
If necessary, you can click the REVERSE button to invert the
Low level and High level of the input signal. (The result is the
same as switching the POLARITY setting of the GPI IN port.)
4
Turn on the CALIBRATION button.
The red line (or red square) in the GPI IN monitor
area will temporarily disappear, and only the yellow
symbol will remain.
5
If you are calibrating only one GPI IN port,
vary the voltage of the signal being input to
the GPI IN port specified in step 3 from the
maximum value to the minimum value.
The yellow symbol will move up/down or left/right
as the voltage changes. The red line will extend accord-
ing to this change, and the maximum and minimum
voltage values for the corresponding GPI IN port will
be stored.
6
If you are calibrating a joystick, move the joy-
stick through a 360-degree path.
The yellow symbol will rotate. The red square will
broaden accordingly, and the maximum and mini-
mum voltage values of the GPI IN ports corresponding
to the X-axis and Y-axis will be stored.
7
Turn off the CALIBRATION button.
The maximum and minimum voltage values detected
will be remembered as the reference values for the
High and Low levels. (When controlling a continu-
ously variable parameter, the maximum value and
minimum value of that parameter will be aligned with
these reference values.)
Hint
The results of calibration apply to all scenes. They are also
preserved even when the PM5D is powered-off.
Calibrating the GPI IN ports
16 Remote control
126 PM5D/PM5D-RH Owner’s Manual Operating section
Here’s how you can use the GPI OUT ports of the GPI
connector to control an external device from the PM5D’s
faders or keys.
1
To the PM5D’s GPI connector, connect the
external device that you want to control from
the PM5D.
2
In the DISPLAY ACCESS section, press the
[MIDI/REMOTE] key several times to access the
GPI screen.
3
In the POLARITY column of the GPI OUT area,
select the polarity of the signal that is output
from each GPI OUT port.
The POLARITY column of the GPI OUT area selects
one of the following two settings as the polarity of the
signal that is output when the GPI OUT port becomes
active.
(Low active)
Grounded when the GPI OUT port is active.
(High active)
Open when the GPI OUT port is active.
4
In the GPI OUT area, use the FADER START,
USER DEFINED KEYS, and TALLY columns to
select the PM5D function for GPI OUT ports 1
through 12.
When an operation selected here is executed on the
PM5D, the corresponding GPI OUT port will become
active, and a control signal will be output.
For each GPI OUT port you can select the following
three functions (multiple selections are allowed).
FADER START
A fader operation on the PM5D will be the trigger for out-
putting a signal from the GPI OUT port.
To edit the setting, click the button at the left to open
the GPI OUT PORT ASSIGN window, and select the fader
mode (trigger detection method) and channel. You can
select the following fader modes.
FADER START
A control signal (trigger signal) 250 msec long will be
output when the fader of the selected channel moves
from –60 dB or below to above –60 dB.
FADER STOP
A control signal (trigger signal) 250 msec long will be
output when the fader of the selected channel reaches
dB.
FADER TALLY
A control signal will be output when the fader of the
selected channel moves from –60 dB or below to above
–60 dB. This control signal will be held until the fader
reaches – dB (or until that GPI OUT port receives a
different trigger).
The following illustration shows how the output signal
from the GPI OUT port changes when you operate a
fader in each of the fader modes. (This illustration
shows operation when is selected as the POLAR-
ITY of the GPI OUT port. If POLARITY is , the
polarity of the output signal will be the opposite.)
Note
When the voltage is at High level, the output signal of the port
will be open. If the receiving device requires High level, it can
be taken from the +5 power supply pin. However in this case
there is a limitation on the current flow; for details, refer to the
Appendices at the end of this manual.
Using GPI OUT
TALLY columnFADER START column
GPI OUT
status
POLARITY column
TEST button
USER DEFINED KEYS
column
FADER
START
FADER
STOP
FADER
TALLY
➪➪➪➪
250 msec
250 msec
PM5D/PM5D-RH Owner’s Manual Operating section 127
16
Remote control
USER DEFINED KEYS
Operation of a User Defined key on the PM5D will be the
trigger for outputting a signal from the GPI OUT port.
To edit the setting, click the button at the left to open
the GPI OUT PORT ASSIGN window; from the list, select
the User Defined key bank (A–D) and number (1–25), and
choose the trigger mode (how the trigger will operate when
the key is pressed). You can choose one of the following
trigger modes.
LATCH
Alternate between active and inactive each time the key
is pressed.
UNLATCH
Active only while the key remains pressed.
The following illustration shows how the output signal
from the GPI OUT port changes when you operate a
User Defined key in each of the trigger modes. (This
illustration shows operation when is selected as the
POLARITY of the GPI OUT port. If POLARITY is ,
the polarity of the output signal will be the opposite.)
TALLY (other)
Other operations on the PM5D will be the trigger for out-
putting a signal from the GPI OUT port. When the
corresponding operation is executed on the PM5D, a con-
trol signal will be output. This control signal will be held
until you defeat the above operation (or until that GPI
OUT port receives a different trigger).
To edit the settings, click the button at the left to open
the GPI OUT PORT ASSIGN window, and select one of
the following functions.
5
Make settings for other GPI OUT ports in the
same way.
With these settings, executing an operation assigned to
the GPI OUT port will output a control signal accord-
ing to the POLARITY setting.
You can use the TEST buttons in the GPI OUT area to
check the operation of the GPI OUT ports. When a
TEST button is on, the corresponding GPI OUT port
will become active, and a control signal will be output.
The GPI OUT status column indicates the status of the
output signal of the corresponding port. The charac-
ters L/H indicate the Low or High level of the signal.
The background color is yellow when active, and gray
when inactive.
LATCH
UNLATCH
Function PM5D operation
NO ASSIGN No assignment
POWER ON The PM5D’s power is turned on
SOLO ON [SOLO] key is turned on
GPI IN 1
FUNCTION
The function assigned to GPI IN port 1
becomes active
GPI IN 2
FUNCTION
The function assigned to GPI IN port 2
becomes active
GPI IN 3
FUNCTION
The function assigned to GPI IN port 3
becomes active
GPI IN 4
FUNCTION
The function assigned to GPI IN port 4
becomes active
PREVIEW ON
SCENE MEMORY section [PREVIEW] key is
turned on
CUE ON
[INPUT ONLY]
Input channel [CUE] key is turned on
CUE ON
[DCA ONLY]
DCA [CUE] key is turned on
CUE ON
[OUTPUT
ONLY]
Output channel [CUE] key is turned on
CUE ON Any [CUE] key is turned on
17 Using memory cards
128 PM5D/PM5D-RH Owner’s Manual Operating section
This chapter explains how to save/load PM5D internal data using a memory card.
Using memory cards with the PM5D
You can insert a commercially available memory card into
the memory card slot located on the front panel of the
PM5D, and use it to save or load various types of data.
You can use PCMCIA Type II PC flash ATA cards, or
CompactFlash media inserted in a PC card adaptor. (In
either case, media with a power supply voltage of 3.3V or
5V is supported.) Normally, these cards are sold in an
already-formatted state. This means that you won’t need to
format them before using them with the PM5D. If you do
need to format a card, use a computer or other external
device to format the card in FAT16 format.
Note
Operation is not guaranteed for any type of media other than
described above.
Saving files to a memory card
Here’s how to save individual items of data (or all data) from the PM5D onto a memory card.
1
Insert the memory card into the memory card
slot located on the front panel of the PM5D.
You may insert or remove cards while the PM5D is
powered-on.
2
In the DISPLAY ACCESS section, repeatedly
press the [UTILITY] key to access the SAVE
screen.
In the left side of the SAVE screen you can select the
save mode and the item(s) that will be saved. The file
list in the right side of the screen contains four col-
umns; FILE NAME, TYPE, DATE/SIZE, and
COMMENT. This list shows the files and directories
on the memory card. (To see the COMMENT col-
umn, scroll the list toward the right.)
3
In the MODE area, click the BASIC button to
select BASIC as the save mode.
If BASIC mode is selected, you can choose the desired
item (or all items) and save them to a memory card.
Hint
The other save modes provided are ADVANCED mode which
lets you save scene memories or libraries under different
numbers, and CSV EXPORT mode which lets you save the
names of scene memories or libraries as a CSV format file.
For details, refer to the Reference section (
p.193).
4
Use the buttons below the MODE area to
select the item you want to save.
The item whose button is turned on is selected for sav-
ing. (You can turn on only one button.) By clicking the
ALL DATA button you can select all items at once.
These buttons correspond to the following items.
17 Using memory cards
PHONES
KEYBOARD
MOUSE
MEMORY CARD
MEMORY CARD
SAVE
SAVE button
MODE area
File list
Button Content
ALL DATA
All items, and the contents of the cur-
rent scene
SCENE MEMORY Contents of scene memory
LINKED LIBRARY
Libraries linked to the scene (available
only if the SCENE MEMORY button is
on)
HA Contents of the HA library
INPUT PATCH Contents of the input patch library
OUTPUT PATCH Contents of the output patch library
INPUT CH Contents of the input channel library
OUTPUT CH Contents of the output channel library
INPUT EQ Contents of the input EQ library
OUTPUT EQ Contents of the output EQ library
GATE Contents of the gate library
COMP Contents of the compressor library
EFFECT Contents of the effect library
PM5D/PM5D-RH Owner’s Manual Operating section 129
17
Using memory cards
If you select the SCENE MEMORY, HA, INPUT
PATCH, or OUTPUT PATCH items, you can specify
the starting number and ending number so that only
the desired range of scenes or library items will be
saved. The LINKED LIBRARY button is available only
if the SCENE MEMORY button is on.
Hint
The TOTAL SIZE field at the bottom of the MODE area indi-
cates the file size for the selected item(s). The available
capacity of the inserted memory card is shown below the file
list.
5
If you selected scenes or libraries for saving,
use the boxes at the right of the button to
specify the starting number and ending
number.
6
As necessary, use the file list to select the
directory (folder) in which you will save the
data.
If the file list contains a directory below the current
level, the TYPE column will indicate “[DIR].”
To move to a lower directory, click the directory line to
select it (that line will move to the center of the list),
and click the directory name shown in the FILE NAME
column.
If the file list contains a directory above the current
level, it will be shown as “. .” in the FILE NAME col-
umn and “[DIR]” in the TYPE column.
To move to a higher directory, click the directory line
to select it (that line will move to the center of the list),
and click the “. .” shown in the FILE NAME column.
Hint
The directory currently selected as the save destination is
also shown in the FILE PATH field above the list
If you want to create a new directory in the current location,
click the MAKE DIR button below the file list.
Note
The file list can display only up to one hundred items.
Saving is not possible if the FILE PATH field exceeds 60
characters (including the filename extension).
7
After specifying the item to be saved and the
save-destination directory, click the SAVE
button.
The FILE NAME EDIT window will appear, allowing
you to assign a name to the data that will be saved.
8
Use the character palette to input a filename,
and click the OK button.
A window will ask you to confirm the Save operation.
Note
When assigning a name to a file on a memory card, lower-
case alphabetical characters and some symbols in the
character palette cannot be used.
If you paste text copied from another character palette when
inputting the file name, all lowercase alphabetical charac-
ters will be converted to uppercase.
GEQ Contents of the GEQ library
SETUP Various settings not saved in a scene
USER DEFINED
KEY
User Defined key settings
DCA FADER
MODE
DCA fader mode settings
MIDI REMOTE MIDI remote settings
MIDI PGM TABLE
Contents of the list in the MIDI PGM
CHANGE screen
MIDI CTRL TABLE
Contents of the list in the MIDI CTRL
CHANGE screen
EVENT LIST
Contents of the list in the EVENT LIST
screen
Button Content
Starting number Ending number
Scene/library name
A directory below the current level
A directory above the current level
17 Using memory cards
130 PM5D/PM5D-RH Owner’s Manual Operating section
9
To execute the Save operation, click the OK
button.
A window will appear, indicating the progress of the
Save operation. When saving is completed, the previ-
ous screen will reappear. If you click the CANCEL
button instead of the OK button, the Save operation
will be aborted and you will return to the previous
screen.
Do not insert or remove the memory card while it is being
accessed. A BUSY indicator at the upper right of the display
will light while the card is being accessed.
Loading files from a memory card
Here’s how to load data from a memory card into the PM5D.
1
Insert the memory card containing the data
you want to load into the memory card slot
located on the front panel of the PM5D.
2
In the DISPLAY ACCESS section, repeatedly
press the [UTILITY] key to access the LOAD
screen.
3
As necessary, use the file list to specify the
load-source directory.
Navigation between directories is the same as in the file
list of the SAVE screen ( p.129). The currently
selected directory is also shown in the FILE PATH field
above the list
4
In the file list, click the line showing the file
you want to load.
That file will move to the center of the list, and will be
highlighted.
The file list shows the following information.
FILE NAME column
This column shows the names of the files saved on the
memory card. If a directory is selected, the directory
name is shown.
TYPE column
This column shows the content that was saved. The
indication in the TYPE column will be one of the
following.
Hint
For scene memory data, the type can be either “SCENE” in
which only scene memory data is saved, and “SCENE+LIB” in
which linked libraries are included.
DATE/SIZE column
This shows the date on which the file was last saved,
and its size. If a directory is selected, only the date is
shown.
COMMENT column
This shows the comment assigned when the file was
saved. To input a comment, scroll the file list horizon-
tally and click the COMMENT column for the
currently selected file.
Hint
By clicking the headings at the top of the list, you can sort the
list in ascending or descending order of that item. The text of
the currently selected button will turn red, and an arrow indi-
cating ascending (
) or descending (
) order will appear.
5
In the MODE area, click the BASIC button to
select BASIC as the loading mode.
Similarly to the Save mode in the SAVE screen, you can
choose either BASIC, ADVANCED, or CSV IMPORT
as the Load mode. If BASIC mode is selected, the item
buttons appropriate for the currently selected file will
turn on.
Hint
If ADVANCED mode is selected, you can specify the range
of scenes or library numbers that will be loaded from a
scene memory and/or library file saved in BASIC mode or
ADVANCED mode.
If CSV IMPORT is selected, you can load CSV files that
were saved in CSV EXPORT mode. For details on each
mode, refer to the Reference section (
p.193).
LOAD
LOAD button
MODE area
File list
FILE NAME
column
DATE/SIZE columnTYPE column
ALL A file in which all items were saved
[DIR] A directory
UNKNOWN A file that cannot be loaded by the PM5D
Other A file in which a specific item was saved
PM5D/PM5D-RH Owner’s Manual Operating section 131
17
Using memory cards
Note
If you select a directory in the file list, the Load mode will
automatically switch to CSV IMPORT, and the screen will
indicate whether that directory contains any CSV files. If you
subsequently select any file readable by the PM5D other
than a CSV file, the mode will automatically switch to
BASIC.
If the type of file to be loaded is ALL DATA, the entire con-
tents of the PM5D’s scene memories and libraries will be
rewritten. Before loading, make sure you are not acciden-
tally overwriting important scenes or library data.
6
When loading scenes or libraries, you can click
the / buttons at the left and right of the
boxes beside each button to select the scene
or library numbers that will be loaded.
7
Click the LOAD button.
A window will ask you to confirm the Load operation.
8
To execute the Load operation, click the OK
button.
A window will appear, indicating the progress of the
Load operation. When loading is completed, the previ-
ous screen will reappear.
If you click the CANCEL button instead of the OK but-
ton, the Load operation will be aborted and you will
return to the previous screen.
Do not insert or remove the memory card while it is being
accessed. A BUSY indicator at the upper right of the display
will light while the card is being accessed.
18 Surround pan
132 PM5D/PM5D-RH Owner’s Manual Operating section
This chapter explains how to use the surround pan functionality.
About surround pan
“Surround pan” is functionality that, when used with a multi-channel playback system, lets you place the signal of an input
channel in two-dimensional space or move the sound image between front/back and left/right. (To move the surround pan
image, you can use the mouse, the CURSOR []/[®]/[π]/[] keys, or the MIX encoders etc.)
The PM5D lets you choose from the following three surround modes, depending on the number of channels in your sur-
round environment.
3-1ch
This mode uses four channels; left and right front,
front center, and rear (surround).
5.1ch
This mode uses six channels; left and right front, left
and right rear, front center, and subwoofer.
6.1ch
This mode uses seven channels; 5.1ch with the addi-
tion of rear center.
Hint
The surround mode can be selected in the MIXER SETUP
screen (SYS/W.CLOCK function) or SURR SETUP screen
(MATRIX/ST function).
18 Surround pan
Front L Center Front R
Rear (surround)
Subwoofer
Rear L Rear R
Front L Center Front R
Subwoofer
Rear L Rear R
Front L Center Front R
Rear center
PM5D/PM5D-RH Owner’s Manual Operating section 133
18
Surround pan
Bus configuration and operation in surround mode
When any of the three surround modes (3-1ch, 5.1ch, 6.1ch) are selected, the PM5D’s bus configuration and operation will
change as follows.
While a surround mode is selected, MIX buses 1–8 or MIX
buses 9–16 can be used as surround buses. (The choice of
whether to use MIX buses 1–8 or MIX buses 9–16 is made
in the MATRIX/ST function SURR SETUP screen.)
When you switch the surround mode, the following sur-
round channels will be assigned by default to each of the
MIX buses. (You are free to change these assignments
subsequently.)
Note
MIX buses shaded in gray in this table can be used as con-
ventional MIX buses. However in 6.1ch mode, the MIX 8/16
bus will operate only as FIXED type.
For example when the surround mode is 6.1ch and you
have chosen MIX 1–8 to use as the surround buses, the
surround pan signal flow will be as follows.
When a surround mode is selected, the MIX encoders allo-
cated to surround buses will operate differently than
normal. For example if MIX buses 1–8 are being used as
surround buses, you can use MIX encoders 1–8 of the MIX
section to edit the following parameters.
If the MIX section [MIX SEND] key is on
A L R
Moves the surround pan of the selected channel
between left and right.
B F R
Moves the surround pan of the selected channel
between front and rear.
C Front divergence (5.1ch and 6.1ch modes
only)
Adjusts the front divergence (the proportion at which a
signal panned to the center will be sent to the front
center bus and to the front LR buses) of the selected
channel. Front divergence (the DIV F parameter) can
be adjusted if 6.1ch mode is being used.
D Rear divergence (6.1ch mode only)
Adjusts the rear divergence (the proportion at which a
signal panned to the rear will be sent to the rear center
bus and to the rear LR buses) of the selected channel.
E LFE (5.1ch and 6.1ch modes only)
Adjusts the send level of the signal sent from the
selected channel to the LFE (Low Frequency Effects)
bus.
Hint
For details on each of the surround pan parameters, refer to
SURR PARAM screen (
p.283) in the Reference section.
If MIX buses 9–16 are being used as surround buses, you
can use MIX encoders 9–16 to perform the above
operations.
Surround
mode
MIX bus
3-1ch 5.1ch 6.1ch
MIX bus 1/9
L
(Front L)
MIX bus 2/10
R
(Front R)
MIX bus 3/11
C
(Center)
Ls
(Rear L)
MIX bus 4/12
S
(Surround)
Rs
(Rear R)
MIX bus 5/13
C
(Center)
MIX bus 6/14
LFE
(Subwoofer)
Bs
(Rear center)
MIX bus 7/15
LFE
(Subwoofer)
MIX bus 8/16
About the surround buses
Input channel 1
Input channel 2
How the MIX section will operate
1 2 3 4 5
18 Surround pan
134 PM5D/PM5D-RH Owner’s Manual Operating section
If the MIX section [MIX MASTER] key is on
A Output level
The encoders adjust the output level of each surround
channel.
Basic settings for surround buses
Here’s how to choose either 3-1ch, 5.1ch, or 6.1ch as the surround mode, and make settings for the MIX buses you will use as
surround buses.
1
According to the surround mode you intend to
use, connect an appropriate playback system
to MIX OUT jacks 1–8 or MIX OUT jacks 9–16.
2
In the DISPLAY ACCESS section, repeatedly
press the [MATRIX/ST] key to access the SURR
SETUP screen.
In order to use a surround mode, you will first choose
a surround mode, and then specify the MIX buses that
will be the surround output destinations.
3
Click a button in the SURROUND MODE area
to select the desired surround mode.
When you click a button a window will appear, asking
you to confirm that you want to switch the surround
mode.
Click the OK button to enable the surround mode you
selected. For example if you switch to 6.1ch mode, the
screen display will change as follows.
4
In the SURROUND BUS ALLOCATION area,
press the MIX 1-8 button or the MIX 9-16 but-
ton to select the MIX buses you want to use as
surround buses.
You can select either MIX buses 1–8 or MIX buses 9–
16. When you click a button a window will appear, ask-
ing you to confirm that you want to change the MIX
bus allocation.
When you click the OK button, the selected MIX buses
will be allocated as surround buses, and will be
assigned to surround channels according to the cur-
rent surround mode.
5
If you want to change the surround channel
assignments, click the / buttons at the left
and right of each field in the bus assign area,
and press the [ENTER] key (or click within the
box) to confirm the setting.
When the setting is confirmed, the previously-selected
bus and the newly-assigned bus will be exchanged.
Hint
You can initialize the surround channel assignments by click-
ing the INIT button located at the right of the bus assign area.
1
SURR SETUP
SURROUND MODE area
SURROUND BUS
ALLOCATION area
Bus assign area
SURR SETUP
PM5D/PM5D-RH Owner’s Manual Operating section 135
18
Surround pan
6
Use the knobs and buttons in the lower part of
the screen to adjust the volume, delay, on/off
status, and cue for each surround channel.
For details on these knobs and buttons, refer to SURR
PARAM screen ( p.283) in the Reference section.
7
In the MIX section, make the [MIX MASTER]
key light, and turn on the MIX [ON] keys of all
MIX buses that will be used as surround buses.
The signal of each surround bus is now sent from the
corresponding MIX OUT jack.
Controlling surround pan
Here’s how to control surround pan for two adjacent input channels (or ST IN/FX RTN channels L and R).
Note
Before you continue with the following procedure, you must
select the desired surround mode and connect MIX OUT
jacks 1–8 or MIX OUT jacks 9–16 to an appropriate play-
back system, as described in “Basic settings for surround
buses” (
p.134).
If you use 5.1ch or 6.1ch surround mode, connect the LFE
(Low Frequency Effects) channel signal to a dedicated sub-
woofer for the low frequencies. However, simply switching
the surround mode does not change the EQ (filter) settings.
As necessary, use the EQ (LPF) of the MIX channel
assigned to the LFE channel to cut the high-frequency por-
tion of the signal according to the frequency response of the
subwoofer you are using.
1
In the DISPLAY ACCESS section, repeatedly
press the [PAN/ROUTING] key to access the
SURR PARAM screen (PAN/ROUTING
function).
The SURR PARAM screen always shows surround pan
settings for two channels.
2
Use the channel selection area to select the
input channels whose surround pan settings
you want to edit.
Two adjacent odd-numbered/even-numbered chan-
nels (or ST IN/FX RTN channels L and R) will be
displayed.
3
Use the SURROUND BUS ON/OFF buttons
located around the surround pan grid to select
the surround buses to which the input chan-
nel will be sent.
The SURROUND BUS ON/OFF buttons are on/off
switches for the signal sent from the input channel to
each surround bus.
Hint
You can do the same thing by pressing a [SEL] key to select
an input channel, making the MIX section [MIX SEND] key
light, and then turning on the MIX [ON] key for the desired sur-
round buses.
4
Use any of the following methods to adjust the
surround pan of the selected channel.
Using the mouse or track pad
Move the pointer into the surround pan grid of the
channel you want to control, and drag the yellow O
symbol forward/backward/left/right. (The symbol will
turn red while you are dragging it.) Alternatively, you
can click a desired location within the surround pan
grid to move the surround pan to that location.
Using the pan buttons around the surround pan
area
If you want to quickly move the channel signal to the
location of a speaker, click one of the pan buttons (e.g.,
L, R, C) shown around the edge of the surround pan
grid.
Using the CURSOR []/[®]/[π]/[] keys
Move the cursor to the surround pan grid and press the
[ENTER] key; the O symbol will turn red.
In this condition, you can use the CURSOR []/[®]
keys to move surround pan left/right, or the CURSOR
[π]/[] keys to move it forward/backward, in a range
of eight steps. By performing this operation while hold-
ing down the [SHIFT] key, you can quickly move
surround pan in a range of 32 steps. To finalize the sur-
round pan adjustment, press the [ENTER] key once
again.
SURR PARAM
Pan buttons SURROUND BUS
ON/OFF buttons
Channel selection
STEREO LINK button
Surround pan grid
18 Surround pan
136 PM5D/PM5D-RH Owner’s Manual Operating section
Using the MIX encoders
If you turn on the [MIX SEND] key of the MIX sec-
tion, you can use MIX encoders 1 or 9 to adjust the
left/right position of the input channel, and MIX
encoders 2 or 10 to adjust the front/rear position. The
SURR PARAM screen MIX SECTION ASSIGNMENT
area shows the parameters assigned to each MIX
encoder.
Using MIDI control changes or GPI
If you assign surround pan parameters to MIDI con-
trol changes or GPI, you can use an external device to
control surround pan. For details, refer to MIDI CTRL
CHANGE screen ( p.174) and GPI screen ( p.177)
in the Reference section.
5
If you want surround pan operations to be
linked for two adjacent channels, turn on the
STEREO LINK button, and use the box at right
to select the link pattern.
When you turn on the STEREO LINK button, sur-
round pan will be linked for the two channels shown in
the SURR PARAM screen. To specify how they will be
linked, select one of the following link patterns by
clicking the / buttons at the left and right of the box
located to the right of the STEREO LINK button.
6
Edit other parameters as desired.
In the SURR PARAM screen you can also edit the fol-
lowing parameters.
Divergence
These controls specify the proportion at which the sig-
nals are sent to each surround bus when the input
channel is positioned in the center. The parameters
that are displayed will depend on the surround mode
that is currently selected. (For details, refer to p.283)
•LFE
This adjusts the output level of the signal sent from the
input channel to the LFE (Low Frequency Effect) bus
for a subwoofer. You can also use the ON/OFF button
to switch the signal sent from the input channel to the
LFE bus on/off.
Hint
The master level of each surround bus is shown in the upper
right of the screen.
You can use the SURR VIEW screen to see the surround
pan settings of all channels at a glance.
Pattern 1
The channels will move in the same
direction for both the front/rear axis
and the left/right axis.
Pattern 2
The channels will move in opposite
directions for the front/rear axis, and in
the same direction for the left/right
axis.
Pattern 3
The channels will move in the same
direction for the front/rear axis, and in
opposite directions for the left/right
axis.
Pattern 4
Leftright movement of the odd-num-
bered channel will be linked with
rearfront movement of the even-
numbered channel. Frontrear move-
ment of the odd-numbered channel
will be linked with leftright move-
ment of the even-numbered channel.
Pattern 5
Leftright movement of the odd-num-
bered channel will be linked with
frontrear movement of the even-
numbered channel. Frontrear move-
ment of the odd-numbered channel
will be linked with leftright move-
ment of the even-numbered channel.
Pattern 6
Front/rear and left/right movement will
both be linked in the opposite direc-
tion.
Pattern 7
Leftright movement of the odd-num-
bered channel will be linked with
frontrear movement of the even-
numbered channel. Frontrear move-
ment of the odd-numbered channel
will be linked with rightleft move-
ment of the even-numbered channel.
Pattern 8
Leftright movement of the odd-num-
bered channel will be linked with
rearfront movement of the even-
numbered channel. Frontrear move-
ment of the odd-numbered channel
will be linked with leftright move-
ment of the even-numbered channel.
PM5D/PM5D-RH Owner’s Manual Operating section 137
18
Surround pan
Notes regarding surround pan
Here are some notes and limitations that you should be aware of when using surround pan.
Scene recall operations
The surround mode selection and the surround pan
settings of each channel are stored as part of the scene.
If you recall a scene whose surround mode differs from
the current scene, the screen and panel display will
change accordingly. The surround mode is recalled
regardless of Selective Recall or Recall Safe settings.
If one channel (of a pair of channels) is excluded from
recall, and you recall a scene in which the STEREO
LINK button is on, the STEREO LINK button will
remain on but only the other channel (of the pair) will
be recalled.
SURROUND BUS SETUP settings (MIX bus 1-8/9-16
selection, and assignments to each surround channel)
are not included in the scene data.
Channel library recall operations
Surround pan related parameters for inputs are stored
in the input channel library.
If the STEREO LINK button is on, and you recall input
channel library settings, the STEREO LINK button will
remain on, but only one channel will be recalled. Sub-
sequent operation will be according to STEREO LINK.
Channel copy
When you copy an input channel using panel opera-
tions, surround-related parameters will also be copied.
In order to copy surround-related parameters using the
CH COPY screen (INPUT VIEW function), the ALL
button must be turned on in the DESTINATION area.
Global paste
In order to paste surround-related parameters, the ALL
button must be turned on in the CURRENT SCENE
area of the GLOBAL PASTE screen (SCENE function).
In addition, the settings of the STEREO LINK area will
also be pasted if two adjacent channels are selected.
19 Other functions
138 PM5D/PM5D-RH Owner’s Manual Operating section
This chapter explains other functionality of the PM5D not covered elsewhere.
Using the user defined keys
You can assign the desired functions to the User Defined keys in the USER DEFINED section of the top panel, and press these
keys to execute the defined function.
A USER DEFINED [1]–[24] keys
B USER DEFINED [25] key
These are User Defined keys that execute the assigned
function.
Here’s how to assign the functions that will be executed
when the USER DEFINED [1]–[25] keys are pressed.
1
In the DISPLAY ACCESS section, press the
[UTILITY] key repeatedly to access the USER
DEFINE screen shown below.
In this screen you can make User Defined key assign-
ments for each of four banks; A–D.
2
In the BANK SELECT area at the upper left of
the screen, use the A–D buttons to select the
bank you want to use.
To clear the assignments of the current bank, click the
CLEAR BANK button located at the bottom of the
BANK SELECT area.
3
Click the button located on the line of the
User Defined key you want to assign.
The USER DEFINED KEY ASSIGN window will
appear. In this window you can select a function to
assign to the User Defined key, and select option
parameters.
4
Select the desired function in the FUNCTION
column, select parameters in the PARAMETER
1/2 columns, and click the OK button.
For details on the available functions and parameters,
refer to the Reference section ( p.189).
19 Other functions
Items in the USER DEFINED section
1
2
Assigning functions to the User
Defined keys
USER DEFINE
BANK SELECT area
PM5D/PM5D-RH Owner’s Manual Operating section 139
19
Other functions
5
Assign functions to other keys and banks in
the same way.
Hint
The User Defined key assignments are not saved in the
scene. If desired, you can save the assignments on a mem-
ory card as USER DEFINED KEY data.
Here’s how to use the USER DEFINED [1]–[25] keys to
execute the functions that have been assigned to them.
1
In the DISPLAY ACCESS section, repeatedly
press the [UTILITY] key to access the USER
DEFINE screen.
2
In the BANK SELECT area at the upper left of
the screen, use the A–D buttons to select the
bank (A–D) you want to use.
3
Press a USER DEFINED [1]–[25] key.
The function assigned to that key will be executed.
Using the Fader Assign function
“Fader Assign” is a function that lets you assign the desired channels to the DCA faders 1–8 of the DCA strip in the top panel.
For each of six layers A–F, you can specify the channel that is assigned to each fader. For example, you might use this to simul-
taneously control the send level and return level of an internal effect, or to use a fader as the master fader of a MIX bus or
MATRIX bus.
For each layer you can specify the channel that is assigned to each fader, and use the FADER MODE section to switch between
layers while you operate the faders.
In the FADER MODE section you can select the combina-
tion of channels or DCA groups that will be controlled by
DCA faders 1–8.
A FADER MODE [A]–[F] keys
If one of these buttons is on, DCA faders 1–8 will con-
trol the level of the channels assigned for that layer (A–
F).
B FADER MODE [DCA] key
If this button is on, DCA faders 1–8 will control DCA
groups 1–8.
Here’s how to assign the desired channels to the DCA fad-
ers 1–8 of the DCA strip section.
1
In the DISPLAY ACCESS section, repeatedly
press the [UTILITY] key to access the FADER
ASSIGN screen.
In this screen you can select the channel assigned to
each fader in each layer A–F.
Executing functions assigned to the
User Defined keys
Items in the FADER MODE section
21
Assigning channels to DCA faders
FADER ASSIGN
19 Other functions
140 PM5D/PM5D-RH Owner’s Manual Operating section
2
Use the channel selection boxes for the
desired layer (A–F) to select the channel
assigned to each fader 1–8.
To select a channel, click the / buttons located at
the left and right of each box. You can choose from the
following channels.
Hint
If an input channel or a DCA fader 1–8 is selected, the chan-
nel name is displayed immediately below the channel
selection box.
Input channels and output channels can coexist in the same
layer.
3
Assign channels to other layers in the same
way.
Hint
Fader Assign settings are not saved in the scene. If desired,
you can save these settings on a memory card as DCA
FADER MODE data.
1
In the FADER MODE section, use the FADER
MODE [A]–[F] keys to select the layer you want
to use.
The key LED will light, and the corresponding layer
will become active. If input channels are assigned to the
DCA faders, the channel names will appear in the
name indicators of the DCA strip.
Hint
You can also switch layers from within the FADER ASSIGN
screen. This screen also shows the values of the DCA faders
and their approximate positions.
2
Operate the faders of the DCA strip.
The level of the corresponding channels will change. If
a channel assigned to a DCA fader is paired (or if one
side of a stereo channel is assigned), the level of the
other paired channel (or the other side of the stereo
channel) will follow.
Note
When a FADER MODE [A]–[F] key is on, and channels other
than DCA channels are assigned to the DCA faders, the
[MUTE] keys of the DCA channel strip are inactive. However,
the [CUE] keys can be used to cue-monitor the corresponding
channel.
Item Selected channel
CH 1–CH48 Input channel 1–48
STIN1L/STIN1R–STIN4L/
STIN4R
ST IN channel 1–4 L or R
FXRTN1L/FXRTN1R–
FXRTN4L/FXRTN4R
FX RTN channel 1–4 L or R
MIX 1–MIX24 MIX channel 1–24
MTRX1–MTRX8 MATRIX channel 1–8
DCA1–8 DCA fader 1–8
Channel selec-
tion box
Controlling the channels assigned to
DCA faders
PM5D/PM5D-RH Owner’s Manual Operating section 141
19
Other functions
Locking the PM5D (Security functions)
The PM5D lets you prohibit changes to certain parameters (Parameter Lock), or prohibit operation of the console (Console
Lock). For example, this lets you prevent an unauthorized person from operating the console while the engineer is taking a
break.
You can also apply password protection to the lock function using a “system password” which is remembered even after
power-off, or a “console password” which is cleared when the power is turned off. If you specify a system password, both
Parameter Lock and Console Lock are available. If you specify a console password, only Console Lock is available.
Here’s how to set the password used for Parameter Lock
and Console Lock. However, it is possible to apply the lock
function even if a password has not been specified.
1
In the DISPLAY ACCESS section, repeatedly
press the [UTILITY] key to access the SECU-
RITY screen.
In this screen you can use the SYSTEM PASSWORD
and CONSOLE PASSWORD fields located at the left to
specify the passwords. (If no password has been speci-
fied, the corresponding box will indicate “--FREE--”.)
2
To set the system password, click the but-
ton for the SYSTEM PASSWORD field. To set
the console password, click the button for
the CONSOLE PASSWORD field.
A window will appear, and you will be asked to input
the new password. (The upper left of the window indi-
cates “NEW PASSWORD.”)
As an example, the illustration below shows the SYS-
TEM PASSWORD CHANGE window where you
specify the system password.
Note
If a password has already been input, you will be requested
to input the old password. (The upper left of the window indi-
cates “OLD PASSWORD”.) In this case, input the existing
password and click the OK button before you continue to
step 3.
If you want to return the system to a condition in which a
password has not been specified, input the existing pass-
word, click the OK button, and then leave the new password
field blank when you execute steps 3–5.
3
Use the character palette to input a password
of up to eight characters in the NEW PASS-
WORD text box.
The characters you input are displayed as “ * ”
(asterisks).
Any character of the character palette except for
SPACE can be used in a password. (The password is
case-sensitive; i.e., uppercase and lowercase alphabeti-
cal characters are distinguished.) When inputting a
password, the COPY, PASTE, SPACE, INS,
, and
keys of the character palette cannot be used.
4
Click the OK button.
The indication in the upper left of the window will
change to “RE-ENTER PASSWORD”.
5
Input the same password once again, and click
the OK button.
The password will be applied, and you will return to
the SECURITY screen.
Note
The console password will be cleared when the PM5D is pow-
ered-off. In contrast, the system password is remembered
even after the power is turned off. This means that if you for-
get the system password, you will be unable to defeat
Parameter Lock or Console Lock except by initializing the
entire memory of the PM5D (
p.147). Please be careful not
to lose the system password.
Setting the System Password or Con-
sole Password
SECURITY
SYSTEM PASSWORD area
CONSOLE PASSWORD area
19 Other functions
142 PM5D/PM5D-RH Owner’s Manual Operating section
Here’s how to lock parameters or the console. You can also
lock using the password you specified.
1
In the DISPLAY ACCESS section, repeatedly
press the [UTILITY] key to access the SECU-
RITY screen.
2
If you want to lock only specific parameters,
use the buttons of the LOCK PARAMETER
SELECT area to select the parameters for
which you want to prohibit editing.
When you click a button, a check mark will appear for
the selected item. You can select the following items
(multiple selections are allowed).
Note
As long as the PARAMETER LOCK button is on, the above
settings cannot be edited. You will need to defeat the lock
function before editing them.
3
Depending on the items you want to lock, click
either the PARAMETER LOCK button or one of
the two CONSOLE LOCK buttons.
If a password has been specified, a window will ask you
to input the password. If you click the CANCEL but-
ton without inputting a password in this window, you
will return to the previous screen.
4
Input the password you assigned beforehand,
and click the OK button.
If you clicked the PARAMETER LOCK button in step
3, a message of “Parameter Locked” will appear briefly,
and then editing will be disabled for the selected
parameters.
If you clicked the CONSOLE LOCK button in step 3,
an indication of “CONSOLE LOCKED” will appear on
the screen, and all operations other than pressing the
UNLOCK button will be disabled.
5
To defeat Parameter Lock, click the PARAME-
TER LOCK button. To defeat Console Lock,
click the UNLOCK button.
If a password has been specified, a window will ask you
to input the password. Input the password and click
the OK button to defeat the lock function. You will
return to the screen in which you were prior to apply-
ing the security setting.
Note
The console password will be cleared when the PM5D is pow-
ered-off. In contrast, the system password is remembered
even after the power is turned off. This means that if you for-
get the system password, you will be unable to defeat
Parameter Lock or Console Lock except by initializing the
entire memory of the PM5D (
p.147). Please be careful not
to lose the system password.
Item Content
SYSTEM CON-
FIGURATION
Changes to the settings of the MIXER
SETUP screen and CASCADE screen
WORD CLOCK
SETUP
Changes to the word clock setting
DITHER Changes to dither-related settings
INPUT PATCH
Changes to the input patch settings
(and names)
OUTPUT PATCH Changes to the output patch settings
INPUT CH ON/
OFF
Input channel on/off operations
OUTPUT CH ON/
OFF
Output channel on/off operations
MIX TO ST ON/
OFF
MIX TO STEREO button on/off opera-
tions
DCA MUTE ON
DCA [MUTE] key On operations
(Off operations are not included)
Using Parameter Lock or Console
Lock
SECURITY
LOCK PARAMETER SELECT area
PM5D/PM5D-RH Owner’s Manual Operating section 143
19
Other functions
Using cascade connections
Buses can be shared by cascade-connecting multiple PM5D units (up to four) or the PM5D with an external mixer (such as
the Yamaha DM2000/02R96). When multiple PM5D units are cascade-connected, operations such as scene store/recall, cue/
solo, and dimmer can also be linked.
Here we will explain cascade connections and operation,
using an example in which two PM5D units are cascade-
connected.
To cascade-connect two PM5D units, connect the CAS-
CADE IN connectors and CASCADE OUT connectors of
the two units to each other. This allows the MIX bus, STE-
REO bus, and CUE bus output signals to be transmitted
and received between the two units.
If you want operations such as scene store/recall and cue/
solo to be linked between the two PM5D units, specify one
unit as the cascade master and the other as the cascade
slave. (This setting is made in the SYS/W.CLOCK function
MIXER SETUP screen.) The PM5D assigned as the cas-
cade master will output control signals (operational
signals) via its CASCADE IN connector, and the PM5D
assigned as the cascade slave will receive these signals via its
CASCADE OUT connector.
Hint
If you want to daisy-chain two to four PM5D units (i.e., con-
nect the first unit’s CASCADE OUT
second unit’s
CASCADE IN, and the second unit’s CASCADE OUT
third unit’s CASCADE IN. Up to four units can be con-
nected.), you should assign the PM5D located last in the
chain (the PM5D connected only via its CASCADE IN con-
nector) as the cascade master, and the remaining PM5D
units as cascade slaves (
p.204).
If you want to cascade-connect a PM5D with a Yamaha
DM2000 or 02R96, connect the CASCADE OUT connector
of the DM2000/02R96 to the CASCADE IN connector of the
PM5D. However in this case, it is not possible to link
operations.
If you want to cascade-connect the PM5D with any other
external mixer, use I/O cards installed in slots 1–4 to send
and receive the audio signals (
p.202).
Here we will explain the basic settings required for a bi-
directional cascade connection between two PM5D units;
we will provide separate explanations for the cascade mas-
ter and the cascade slave.
Cascade master
1
In the DISPLAY ACCESS section, repeatedly
press the [SYS/W.CLOCK] key until the MIXER
SETUP screen appears.
2
In the CASCADE MODE area at the lower part
of the screen, select “MASTER”. In addition,
turn on the BI-DIRECTION button located
immediately below it.
When multiple PM5D units are cascaded, the settings
of the CASCADE MODE area specify whether the unit
will operate as a cascade master (when “MASTER” is
selected) or as a cascade slave (when “SLAVE” is
selected).
If you turn the BI-DIRECTION button on, the mixed
audio signals of both cascade-connected PM5D units
will be output from both units.
Making cascade connections
PM5D A
CASCADE
IN
CASCADE
OUT
CASCADE
IN
CASCADE
OUT
PM5D B
Audio
signals of
units A+B
Audio
signals of
units A+B
(cascade master) (cascade slave)
Basic settings for cascade connection
MIXER SETUP
CASCADE MODE area
CASCADE MODE area BI-DIRECTION button
19 Other functions
144 PM5D/PM5D-RH Owner’s Manual Operating section
3
Select “PM5D” in the CASCADE FROM field
and in the CASCADE TO field.
In the CASCADE FROM field, select one of the follow-
ing as the type of the external device that is sending
signals to the PM5D via the cascade connection.
In the CASCADE TO field, select either “PM5D” or “--
--” (transmission disabled) as the external device to
which the signal will be sent from the PM5D via the
cascade connection.
4
Make sure that “CASCADE IN” is selected for
the CASCADE IN PORT SELECT field, and “CAS-
CADE OUT” is selected for the CASCADE OUT
PORT SOURCE SELECT field.
The CASCADE IN PORT SELECT and CASCADE
OUT PORT SOURCE SELECT fields select the ports
through which audio signals will be transmitted to and
received from the cascade-connected external device.
If “PM5D” or “DM2000/02R96” are selected as the
other cascade-connected device, only “CASCADE IN”
can be selected for the CASCADE IN PORT SELECT
field. In the CASCADE OUT PORT SOURCE SELECT
field, you can choose from the output channels of slots
1–4 as well as “CASCADE OUT” ( p.203).
Hint
If you choose a setting other than “CASCADE OUT” in the
CASCADE OUT PORT SOURCE SELECT field, the same
signal will be output from both the specified slot/channel and
from the CASCADE OUT connector.
Cascade slave
1
In the DISPLAY ACCESS section, repeatedly
press the [SYS/W.CLOCK] key to access the
MIXER SETUP screen.
2
In the CASCADE MODE area at the lower part
of the screen, select “SLAVE”. In addition, turn
on the BI-DIRECTION button located immedi-
ately below it.
3
Select “PM5D” in the CASCADE FROM field
and in the CASCADE TO field.
4
Make sure that “CASCADE IN” is selected in
the CASCADE IN PORT SELECT field, and “CAS-
CADE OUT” is selected in the CASCADE OUT
PORT SOURCE SELECT field.
Here we will explain how to select the buses used for the
cascade connection, specify the items that will be linked,
and enable the cascade connection. Perform the following
steps on both the cascade master and cascade slave units.
1
In the DISPLAY ACCESS section, repeatedly
press the [SYS/W.CLOCK] key until the CAS-
CADE screen shown below appears.
In this combination you can enable/disable buses used
for transmission/reception in the cascade connection,
and select the operations that will be linked when mul-
tiple PM5D units are cascade-connected.
Display
Source
device
Selectable cas-
cade input port
Parameter
linkage
Cascade dis-
abled
CASCADE IN,
SLOT 4, SLOT 3/4,
SLOT1-4 [CH1-8],
SLOT 1-4 [CH9-16]
Not
possible
PM5D another PM5D CASCADE IN Possible
*1
*1. Linked parameters are specified in the CASCADE
screen.
DM2000
/02R96
YAMAHA
DM2000 or
02R96
CASCADE IN
Not
possible
MIXER
[30BUS]
A mixer other
than the above
(maximum 30
bus)
SLOT 3/4,
SLOT 1-4 [CH1-8],
SLOT 1-4 [CH9-16]
MIXER
[16BUS]
A mixer other
than the above
(maximum 16
bus)
SLOT 4
CASCADE FROM
field
CASCADE TO field
CASCADE IN
PORT SELECT
field
CASCADE OUT PORT
SOURCE SELECT
field
Selecting the buses used for cascade
connection
CASCADE
PM5D/PM5D-RH Owner’s Manual Operating section 145
19
Other functions
2
In the CASCADE LINK area at the left of the
screen, turn on the buttons for the operations
that you want to be linked.
The settings of the CASCADE LINK area select the
operations that will be linked when multiple PM5D
units are cascade-connected. You can select the follow-
ing items.
SCENE RECALL
Scene recall operations / Recall undo operations
SCENE STORE/EDIT
Scene store operations, store undo operations, title
editing, sorting
CUE/SOLO LOGIC
Cue/Solo operations
DIMMER ON/OFF
Dimmer effect (including talkback dimmer)
PAGE CHANGE
Switching the display screen
DCA FADER MODE
Switching the mode of the top panel FADER MODE
section
ENCODER MODE
Switching the mode of the top panel ENCODER
MODE section
PANEL/LCD BRIGHTNESS
BRIGHTNESS settings in the PREFERENCE 2 screen
(UTILITY function)
INPUT METER POINT/OUTPUT METER POINT/
PEAK HOLD
Input channel / output channel metering point selec-
tion, and peak hold on/off
DCA LEVEL/MUTE
DCA group 1–8 level, name, [CUE] key on/off opera-
tions, and [MUTE] key on/off operations
MUTE MASTER
Mute group 1–8 on/off
Note
Note that linking is enabled only if the LINK buttons for the
same item are turned on for both the cascade master unit
and the cascade slave unit.
If you have cascade-connected three or more PM5D units in
a daisy-chain, you can also turn linking off for the cascade
master but on between the cascade slaves.
Hint
DCA and MUTE parameter values will be linked as soon as
linking is turned on. CUE/SOLO will be initialized as soon as
linking is turned on. Other parameters will be linked only when
that parameter is first operated after Link is turned on.
3
In the CASCADE I/O ASSIGN VIEW area, use
the CASCADE IN and CASCADE OUT ON/OFF
buttons to specify whether each bus will trans-
mit or receive audio signals to or from the
external cascade-connected device.
The CASCADE IN and CASCADE OUT ON/OFF but-
tons specify whether signals of each bus will be
transmitted to or received from the cascade-connected
external device. These settings are made independently
for each bus; MIX buses 1–24, STEREO A bus L/R,
STEREO B bus L/R, and CUE bus L/R.
Buses whose CASCADE IN button is on will receive
signals from the external device; buses whose CAS-
CADE OUT button is on will send signals to the
external device.
The CASCADE IN SOURCE fields indicate each of the
source buses. If the other cascade-connected device is a
PM5D, these assignments are fixed and cannot be
modified.
Note
When two PM5D units are cascade-connected, signal trans-
mission and reception is enabled if the CASCADE OUT
button of the transmitting unit and the CASCADE IN button
of the receiving unit are both turned on for the same bus.
If a device other than the PM5D is selected as the other cas-
cade-connected device, the transmission source indication
shown in the CASCADE IN SOURCE field will change
(
p.205).
4
Set the CASCADE ENABLE/DISABLE button to
ENABLE.
The cascade connection will be enabled when the CAS-
CADE ENABLE/DISABLE button is set to ENABLE on
both the cascade master and the cascade slave.
CASCADE IN
ON/OFF buttons
CASCADE OUT
ON/OFF buttons
CASCADE IN SOURCE area
19 Other functions
146 PM5D/PM5D-RH Owner’s Manual Operating section
Connecting the PM5D to a computer via USB
The PM5D Editor application can be installed in a computer and used to control the PM5D’s parameters or to backup and
restore the contents of the PM5D’s memory.
Here we will explain the operations required in order to establish a USB connection between the PM5D and a computer.
Note
The following procedure assumes that the PM5D Editor pro-
gram and USB driver have already been correctly installed in
the computer. For details on installing the program and driver,
refer to the Studio Manager installation guide.
1
In the DISPLAY ACCESS section, repeatedly
press the [MIDI/REMOTE] key until the MIDI
SETUP screen appears.
2
In the PM5D EDITOR area at the lower right of
the screen, select the port to which the com-
puter is connected, and select the PM5D’s ID
number.
First use the PORT field to select the port that will be
used to communicate with the computer. Click the /
buttons located at the left and right of the left box to
select the type of port, and press the [ENTER] key (or
click inside the box) to finalize your selection. If you
select USB or SLOT 1–4, use the box at the right to
select a port number 1–8.
Next, use the ID field to select an ID number in the
range of 1–8 for the PM5D that you want to control.
(This number is used to distinguish individual PM5D
units when multiple units are being used together.)
Note
Set the USB port number and PM5D ID number to match the
settings in the PM5D Editor. For details, refer to the PM5D
Editor owner’s manual.
3
Start up PM5D Editor on the computer, and
use a USB cable to connect the computer to
the PM5D.
This enables communication between the computer
and the PM5D. For details on operation, refer to the
PM5D Editor owner’s manual.
Note
If you disconnect or reconnect the USB cable, or power-
cycle the PM5D, you must close the PM5D Editor and shut
down the computer. In some cases, it may not be possible to
reconnect with the PM5D until the computer is restarted.
Use a USB cable no longer than 3 meters. Also, connect the
PM5D directly to the USB connector of the computer; do not
use a USB hub.
You must observe the following points when connecting
the PM5D to your computer via the USB TO HOST con-
nector. If you fail to observe these points, your computer
or the PM5D may stop operating (“hang up”), causing
data to be corrupted or lost. If the computer or the PM5D
stops working, turn the power off and then on again, and
restart the computer.
Before connecting the computer via the USB TO
HOST connector, disable the power management
mode (suspend/sleep/standby/hibernate) on your
computer.
Connect the USB TO HOST connector to the com-
puter before you power-on the PM5D.
Close all application programs (such as PM5D Edi-
tor) before turning the PM5D’s power on or off, or
connecting or disconnecting the USB cable.
Leave an interval of at least three seconds between
powering the PM5D on and off, or between discon-
necting and connecting the USB cable.
MIDI SETUP
PM5D EDITOR area
Caution when using the USB TO
HOST connector
PM5D/PM5D-RH Owner’s Manual Operating section 147
19
Other functions
Initializing the PM5D’s internal memory
If an error occurs in the PM5D’s internal memory, or if you are unable to return to normal operation because you have for-
gotten the system password, use the following procedure to initialize the internal memory.
All of the content that had been saved in memory will be lost if
you initialize the internal memory. You must use extreme cau-
tion when performing this operation.
1
While holding down the SCENE MEMORY
[STORE] key of the panel, turn on the power of
the PW800W power supply.
After the opening screen, the following initialization
menu screen will appear.
2
Click one of the following buttons to select the
desired type of initialization.
INITIALIZE ALL MEMORIES
All memories including scene memories and libraries
will return to their factory-set condition.
INITIALIZE CURRENT MEMORIES
Memories other than scene memories and libraries will
return to their factory-set condition.
CANCEL
The initialization procedure will be aborted, and the
PM5D will start up in normal operating mode.
Note
Note
If the voltage of the backup battery runs low, or if an error
occurs in the internal memory, a warning message will appear
at the bottom of the screen, and the initialization menu will
appear “by force.” Please note that if the warning message is
displayed, and you click the CANCEL button to start in normal
operating mode, we cannot guarantee that the system will
operate correctly.
3
A message will ask you to confirm that you
really want to initialize; click the OK button.
When the internal memory has been initialized, the
PM5D will start up in normal operating mode.
Adjusting the faders and input/output gain (Calibration)
Depending on the conditions of use, discrepancies may occur in the behavior of the motor faders. you can use the Calibration
function to correct such discrepancies. If necessary, you can also make fine adjustments to the analog input/output gain.
1
While holding down the [ENTER] key of the
panel, turn on the power of the PW800W
power supply.
After the opening screen, the following calibration
menu screen will appear.
2
Click one of the following buttons to choose
what you want to calibrate.
A window for the calibration item you selected will
appear.
3
Make calibration settings as directed by the
instructions that appear in the window.
4
Click the OK button in the window.
The calibration settings will be applied, and the PM5D
will start up in normal mode.
CALIBRATE FADER
POSITION
The FADER CALIBRATION win-
dow will appear, allowing you to
calibrate the specified faders.
CALIBRATE AD INPUT
GAIN (make fine adjust-
ments to the analog
input gain; PM5D-RH
model only)
The AD INPUT TRIM window
will appear, allowing you to
make fine adjustments to the
gain of the specified analog
input port.
CALIBRATE OUTPUT
GAIN (make fine adjust-
ments to the output
ports)
The OUTPUT TRIM window will
appear, allowing you to make
fine adjustments to the gain of
the specified output port.
19 Other functions
148 PM5D/PM5D-RH Owner’s Manual Operating section
Here you can execute a semi-automatic procedure for cali-
brating the faders of the specified channel strip (INPUT,
DCA, STEREO A/B, ST IN/FX RTN). This window will
also appear if a problem with the fader settings is detected
when the PM5D is started up.
1
Click a fader select button to add a check mark
to the faders you want to calibrate.
If problems with certain faders were detected during
start-up, those buttons will be on (green), and check
marks will already be shown for them.
2
Click the START CALIBRATION button; calibra-
tion will begin automatically.
A progress bar will indicate the state of the process.
3
The automatic processing will end when the
progress bar reaches 60%. Manually move all
faders you specified for calibration to the posi-
tions listed below in the following order:
1
2 –20 dB
3 0 dB
4 +10 dB
4
After you have set the faders to the correct
position, press the [ENTER] key.
Processing will proceed to the next fader position.
5
Repeat steps 3–4 for each fader position 14.
6
Verify that calibration has been completed and
that all fader select buttons are now off. Then
click the OK button.
The calibration settings will be stored in internal mem-
ory. If a fader select button remains on (green),
calibration has failed. Try executing calibration once
again.
Note
The progress bar will indicate “Writing...” while the settings are
being written to internal memory; do not turn off the power
while this indication is visible.
If necessary, you can make fine adjustments in steps of 0.1
dB to the gain of the specified analog input port. Since the
input levels of all ports are set to match each other when
the PM5D is shipped from the factory, you will normally
not need to change these settings.
Note
Since these are set to optimal values at the factory, the default
values will differ between input ports. Initializing the internal
memory will return these settings to their factory-set values.
To adjust the gain, click the / buttons located at the
left and right of each box to specify the gain of each input
port in 0.1 dB units. If you want to restore all input ports
to their factory settings, click the FACTORY PRESET but-
ton. Click the OK button to apply the settings.
If necessary, you can make fine adjustments in steps of 0.01
dB to the gain of the specified output port. The factory set-
ting is 0.00 dB.
To adjust the gain, click the / buttons located at the
left and right of each box to specify the gain of each output
port in 0.01 dB units. If you want to reset all output ports
to 0.00 dB, click the FACTORY PRESET button. Click the
OK button to apply the settings.
Calibrating the faders Adjusting the analog input gain
(PM5D-RH model only)
Adjusting the output gain
PM5D/PM5D-RH Owner’s Manual Reference section 149
Reference section
The Reference section explains the functionality and operations for every screen of the PM5D,
organized into four main areas; function menu, global functions, output functions, and input
functions.
The following illustration is a typical screen on the PM5D.
This screen shows the following information.
Upper part of the display
(always visible)
A Function Name Indication
Displays the name of the function currently selected in
the screen. By clicking the BACK/FORWARD buttons
you can move through the eight most recent screens
that were displayed for at least two seconds (with the
exception of function menus). You can also access the
Function menu by clicking this function name indica-
tion. When the Function menu is displayed, click once
again to return to the previously-displayed screen.
B SCENE MEMORY
Indicates the number and title of the last-stored or
recalled scene memory. If you select a different scene,
the number and title will blink. If you edit the contents
of a scene after storing it, the EDIT indicator in the
upper right will light. If the scene is write-protected, a
lock icon is displayed at the right of the title, and read-
only scenes are indicated as “R.”
Note
You can move the cursor to the scene number and turn the
[DATA] encoder to select a scene.
If you click here while the number and title are blinking, the
most recently stored or recalled scene will be displayed.
C NEXT SCENE/NEXT EVENT
Indicates the scene/event that will be recalled next by
the User Defined keys or the Event List function. The
information shown here will differ as follows, depend-
ing on the settings in the EVENT LIST screen of the
SCENE function.
If the DISABLE button is turned on in the EVENT
LIST screen
Indicates the number and name of the next scene (the
scene that will be recalled when you press a User
Defined key assigned to the “INC RECALL” function).
Normally, this will be the scene of the number follow-
ing the most recently recalled or stored scene.
If the ENABLE [ALL MANUAL] button or the
[ENABLE] button is turned on in the EVENT LIST
screen
Indicates the number and name of the next event (the
scene that will be recalled next by the Event List func-
tion). At the right is displayed the time until the next
event will be recalled (or the condition upon which the
event will be recalled).
Note
The “MANUAL” indication means that the user must exe-
cute the Next Event operation in order to recall the next
event. (Press a User Defined key assigned to the “NEXT
EVENT RECALL” function, or click the NEXT button in the
EVENT LIST screen.)
If a time is displayed, this indicates the remaining time until
the next event is recalled automatically.
The “--------” indication means that there is no event to be
recalled next.
D PRESENT TIME, TIME CODE, CASCADE/Fs
Click this area to cycle through the following three
items of information. This is linked with the UPPER
PART DISPLAY setting in the PREFERENCE 2 screen
(UTILITY function).
Information shown in the display
2
3
1
Information shown
in the display
Function
menu
Global
functions
Output
functions
Input
functions
Appendices
Main area of the display
150 PM5D/PM5D-RH Owner’s Manual Reference section
PRESENT TIME
Indicates the present time. The time can be specified in
the UTILITY function PREFERENCE 1 screen.
TIME CODE
Indicates the internal time code being generated by the
PM5D, or the time code being received from an exter-
nal device. This is the same as the time code shown in
the SCENE function EVENT LIST screen.
CASCADE/Fs
Indicates the master/slave status when using a cascade
connection, and the sampling frequency at which the
PM5D system is currently operating.
E METER SECTION
Indicates the type of channels that are currently shown
by the meters in the upper left and right of the panel.
You can also click the / buttons to switch this
directly.
F EVENT indicator
The EVENT indicator is displayed here if the ENABLE
[ALL MANUAL] or ENABLE button is turned on in
the SCENE function EVENT LIST screen.
G FADING/TRACKING indicator
This area shows the FADING indicator while fade time
is being executed, or the TRACKING indicator if
Tracking Recall is available. If both are enabled, FAD-
ING takes priority.
H LCR/LCR [B] indicator
If there is at least one channel for which LCR is turned
on, the LCR indicator is displayed here.
If in the SYS/W.CLOCK function MIXER SETUP
screen the BUS SETUP setting STEREO B is set to USE
AS CENTER BUS, the LCR [B] indicator is displayed
here.
I TB/OSC/DIMM indicator
If talkback, oscillator, or dimmer are on, the respective
TB/OSC/DIMM indicator is displayed here. If more
than one of these are enabled, the display priority is
TB>OSC>DIMM.
J SOLO/INPUT CUE/DCA CUE/OUTPUT CUE/
KEY IN CUE/EFFECT CUE/EXTERNAL CUE
indicator
If Solo or Cue Monitor is enabled, the corresponding
indicator is shown here. If more than one Cue is
selected, only the indicator for the currently-valid Cue
is shown.
K BUSY/RS422/HA/GPI/MIDI indicator
The BUSY indicator is shown here while internal mem-
ory or a PC card in the card slot is being accessed.
When RS422/HA/GPI/MIDI signals are received (in
the case of RS422, when Status is received to indicate a
status change on a connected device), the appropriate
indicator will appear briefly. If more than one of these
conditions occur simultaneously, the display priority is
BUSY>RS422>HA>GPI>MIDI.
Note
In the case of MIDI signals, the indicator will light if signals are
received at the MIDI connector, USB connector, or slots 1–4.
However, active sensing, MIDI clock, and quarter time code
messages will not cause the indicator to light.
Main area of the display
A Tabs
Click this area to switch between screens within the
selected function.
B Function parameters
This area shows parameters for the currently selected
function or screen.
Lower part of the display
(always visible)
A SELECTED CH (Selected channel)
Indicates the type and name of the channel currently
selected by the [SEL] key. You can also click the /
buttons to switch this directly.
B MIX SECTION
Indicates the encoder mode currently selected in the
MIX section. In MIX SEND mode this indicates
“SEND,” in MIX MASTER mode this indicates “MAS-
TER,” and if a shortcut operation has been used to
select TO MATRIX mode this indicates “TO
MATRIX.” You can also click the / buttons to
directly switch between “SEND” and “MASTER.”
C Encoder/Fader mode
Indicates the parameters that are assigned to the
encoders/faders of the input channel strip.
The encoders can be assigned to MIX SEND 1–24,
GAIN, ATT, PAN/BAL, LEVEL, or REMOTE. The fad-
ers can be assigned to LEVEL, MIX SEND 1–24, or
REMOTE. For both the encoders and the faders, you
can click / to directly select parameters other than
REMOTE.
If you select LEVEL for the encoders, the faders will be
flipped; the most recently selected of the MIX SEND 1–
24 parameters will be assigned to the faders. Similarly,
the faders will also be flipped if you select MIX SEND
1
2
4 5 6 8
1 32 7
PM5D/PM5D-RH Owner’s Manual Reference section 151
1–24 for the faders; the LEVEL parameter will be
assigned to the encoders.
D INPUT CH (Input channel) layer
This is linked with the [CH 1-24]/[CH 25-48] key in
the input channel strip of the panel, and indicates the
layer that is selected for the input channel strip. (If the
MIDI REMOTE layer is selected, this indicates
REMOTE 1-24.) Layers other than MIDI REMOTE
can also be switched directly by clicking the /
buttons.
E FADER MODE
This is linked with the FADER MODE section on the
panel, and indicates the function that is assigned to the
faders of the DCA strip. You can also click the /
buttons to switch this directly.
F ST IN/FX RTN (ST IN channel / Effect
return) layer
This is linked with the [ST IN] key and [FX RTN 1-4]
key in the ST IN channel strip of the panel, and indi-
cates the layer that is selected for the ST IN channel
strip. (If the MIDI REMOTE layer is selected, this indi-
cates REMOTE 25-28.) Layers other than MIDI
REMOTE can also be switched directly by clicking the
/ buttons.
G DIRECT RECALL/MUTE MASTER
This switches between the following two choices as the
function of the [1]–[8] keys in the SCENE MEMORY
section of the panel.
DIRECT RECALL
Keys [1]–[8] of the SCENE MEMORY section will
directly recall the scene that was assigned in the SCENE
screen.
MUTE MASTER
Keys [1]–[8] of the SCENE MEMORY section will
switch mute groups 1–8 on/off.
H USER DEFINED KEY BANK
Indicates the currently selected bank of User Defined
keys. You can also click the / buttons to switch this
directly.
Here you can select the function that you want to view in
the display. These operate in the same way as the keys of
the DISPLAY ACCESS section.
Hint
To access this screen from another function, click the Func-
tion Name area at the top of the display.
A Global functions
These buttons access functions that affect the entire
PM5D.
B Output-related functions
These buttons access functions related to output chan-
nels (MIX channels, MATRIX channels, STEREO A/B
channels).
C Input-related functions
These buttons access functions related to input chan-
nels (input channels, ST IN channels, FX RTN
channels).
Function menu
1
2
3
Information shown
in the display
Function
menu
Global
functions
Output
functions
Input
functions
Appendices
Global functions
152 PM5D/PM5D-RH Owner’s Manual Reference section
EFFECT functions
Here you can select the type of internal effect, edit its
parameters, and perform input/output patching.
A Effect selection
Of the internal effects 1–8, select the effect for which
you want to make settings. To switch between effects,
place the cursor here and turn the [DATA] encoder, or
click the / buttons at left or right.
B Effect type
Indicates the currently selected effect type, both by
name and as a graphic. The number of input/output
channels (1 IN/2 OUT or 2 IN/2 OUT) of this effect is
also shown at the bottom of this area.
Note
You can’t switch the effect type in this screen. If you want to
switch to a different effect type, recall an effect that uses the
desired effect type from the effect library.
C Input patch
This box lets you select the signal path that will be
patched to the L/R input channels of the internal effect.
Move the cursor to this box and turn the [DATA]
encoder or click the / buttons at left or right to dis-
play the desired signal path, and then press the
[ENTER] key to finalize the change.
You can choose the following signal paths.
Note
If you move the cursor away without pressing the [ENTER]
key, the setting will revert to its original state.
If you assign a signal to both input channels for a 1 IN/2
OUT effect type, the two will be mixed to monaural and then
input.
If you assign a signal to only one input channel for a 2 IN/2
OUT effect type, the same signal will be sent to both chan-
nels of the effect.
If STEAL PATCH CONFIRMATION is turned on in the
PREFERENCE 1 screen (UTILITY function), and you
attempt to make patch settings that would cause an existing
patch to be modified, a confirmation message will appear.
D Input meter
Indicates the level of the signal being input to the effect.
Global functions
EFFECT PARAM (Effect parameter)
screen
EFFECT PARAM
1
2 3 4
MIX1–MIX24 MIX channel 1–24 output
INS CH1–INS CH48 Input channel 1–48 insert out
INS STIN1 (L/R)–INS STIN4
(L/R)
ST IN channel 1–4 (L/R)
insert out
INS MIX1–INS MIX24 MIX channel 1–24 insert out
INS MTRX1–INS MTRX8
MATRIX channel 1–8 insert
out
INS ST A (L/R)
STEREO A channel (L/R)
insert out
INS ST B (L/R)
STEREO B channel (L/R)
insert out
INS MON (L/R/C)
MONITOR channel (L/R/C)
insert out
PM5D/PM5D-RH Owner’s Manual Reference section 153
Information shown
in the display
Function
menu
Global
functions
Output
functions
Input
functions
Appendices
E MIX BALANCE
Adjusts the balance of the effect sound relative to the
original sound.
0 (%) outputs only the original sound, and 100 (%)
outputs only the effect sound.
F BYPASS
This button temporarily bypasses the effect.
G CUE
This button cue-monitors the output of the effect
shown in the screen. Cue is automatically defeated
when you switch to a different screen. (However, cue
will be held if you switch to the EFFECT ASSIGN
screen.)
H Output meter
Indicates the level of the signal being output from the
effect.
I Output patch
This box lets you select the signal path that will be
patched to the L/R output channels of the internal
effect. The selection method is the same as for Input
Patch. You can choose the following signal paths.
Note
Even if you’ve patched multiple channels in the INPUT
PATCH/OUTPUT PATCH function INSERT PATCH screen,
changing the input/output patch in this screen will turn off
patching to other channels.
J LIBRARY
This button accesses the EFFECT LIBRARY screen for
the currently selected effect.
K TEMPO parameter
If a delay-type or modulation-type effect type is
selected, the tempo parameter will be displayed here.
The TEMPO parameter specifies time-related parame-
ters in units of BPM (Beats Per Minute). For a delay-
type effect it sets the DELAY (delay time), and for a
modulation-type effect it sets the FREQ. (modulation
frequency).
Note
For some effect types, a parameter unique to the effect may
be shown instead of the TEMPO parameter. For example if
FREEZE is selected as the effect type, a button for recording/
playing the input signal is shown.
The BPM value can be edited using the on-screen
knob, or by repeatedly clicking the TAP TEMPO but-
ton. (In this case, the average interval between clicks is
detected. If the average value is outside the range of 20–
300 BPM, it will be ignored.)
If the MIDI CLK button is on, the TEMPO parameter
will synchronize to the MIDI timing clock being
received from the MIDI port.
L Effect parameters
This area shows parameters for the currently selected
effect type.
CH1–CH48 Input channel 1–48 input
STIN1–STIN4 (L/R) ST IN channel 1–4 (L/R) input
FXRTN1–FXRTN4 (L/R) FX RTN channel 1–4 input
INS CH1–INS CH48 Input channel 1–48 insert in
INS ST1 (L/R)–INS ST4 (L/
R)
ST IN channel 1–4 (L/R) insert
in
INS MIX1–INS MIX24 MIX channel 1–24 insert in
INS MTRX1–INS MTRX8 MATRIX channel 1–8 insert in
INS ST A (L/R)
STEREO A channel (L/R)
insert in
INS ST B (L/R)
STEREO B channel (L/R)
insert in
INS MON (L/R/C)
MONITOR channel (L/R/C)
insert in
J8 9
5
6
7
K L
ab c
First tap Second tap Third tap Fourth tap
The average of the intervals is input as the parameter
value (average of a, b, and c)
EFFECT functions
154 PM5D/PM5D-RH Owner’s Manual Reference section
This screen lists the effect types used by internal effects 1–8,
and shows their input levels.. Here you can also assign sig-
nals to input/output channels, and make settings for
bypass and cue.
A Level meter
Indicates the input level to the effect.
B Effect type
Indicates the selected effect type, both by name and as a
graphic. When you click this area, the EFFECT
PARAM screen will appear. You can also drag and
drop this area onto another effect in this screen to copy
the effect settings.
C BYPASS
This button temporarily bypasses the effect.
D CUE
This button cue-monitors the effect output. Cue is
automatically defeated when you switch to a different
screen. (However, cue will be held if you switch to the
EFFECT PARAM screen of the corresponding effect.)
E Input patch
This box indicates the signal path that is patched to the
L/R input channels of the internal effect. You can also
directly assign the signal path in this box.
F Output patch
This box indicates the signal path that is patched to the
L/R output channels of the internal effect. You can also
directly assign the signal path in this box.
Note
Even if you’ve patched multiple channels in the INPUT
PATCH/OUTPUT PATCH function INSERT PATCH screen,
changing the input/output patch in this screen will turn off
patching to other channels.
EFFECT ASSIGN screen
EFFECT ASSIGN
1
3
5
4
6
2
PM5D/PM5D-RH Owner’s Manual Reference section 155
Information shown
in the display
Function
menu
Global
functions
Output
functions
Input
functions
Appendices
Here you can recall, store, rename, or delete items in the
effect library.
A EDIT
When you click this button, the EFFECT PARAM
screen for the currently selected effect will appear.
B Effect selection
Of the internal effects 1–8, select the effect for which
you want to make settings.
C Input meter
Indicates the input level of the effect.
D Current effect type
Indicates the effect type of the currently selected effect.
E Output meter
Indicates the output level of the effect.
F Library effect type
Indicates the effect type of the library item selected in
the list.
G RECALL
Recalls the library item shown in the list into the cur-
rently selected effect.
H STORE
Stores the currently selected effect into the selected
location of the list. When you click this button a win-
dow will appear, allowing you to name and save the
effect.
I TITLE EDIT
Edits the title of the library item selected in the list.
When you click this button a window will appear,
allowing you to edit the title.
J CLEAR
Deletes the library item selected in the list. When you
click this button, a confirmation message will appear.
Note
Library items with an “R” displayed in the right column of the
list are read-only. Read-only items cannot be stored,
renamed, or deleted.
K Library list
Use the scroll bar to select the library item on which
you want to perform an operation. The selected library
item will move to the center, and will be highlighted.
Note
If the library item selected for operations is different than the
last-stored/recalled library item, the last-stored/recalled
library item will be shown with a blue background.
Library items 049 and later that are grayed-out are reserved
for Add-On Effects. They will become available if you install
a separately sold Add-On Effects package (
p.109).
EFFECT LIBRARY screen
EFFECT LIBRARY
3 54
1 2
7
8
9
J
K
6
GEQ function
156 PM5D/PM5D-RH Owner’s Manual Reference section
GEQ function
Here you can adjust the boost/cut for a 31-band graphic
EQ, specify the input/output patching, and assign a GEQ
to faders.
A Module select
Of the twelve graphic EQ modules (GEQ1–GEQ12),
select the module that you want to operate. To switch
between modules, place the cursor here and turn the
[DATA] encoder, or click the / buttons at left or
right.
B LINK button
This button links adjacent odd-numbered even-
numbered graphic EQ modules. When you turn this
button on, a window will appear, allowing you to select
whether the parameters will be copied from one mod-
ule to the other, or whether both modules will be
initialized.
C INSERT (Insert destination)
Selects the location at which the graphic EQ module
will be inserted. Move the cursor to this box and turn
the [DATA] encoder or click the / buttons at left or
right to display the desired insertion destination, and
then press the [ENTER] key to finalize the change.
You can choose the following insertion destinations.
INS CH1–INS CH48
Input channel 1–48 insert in/out
INS STIN1 (L/R)–INS STIN4 (L/R)
ST IN channel 1–4 (L/R) insert in/out
INS MIX1–INS MIX24
MIX channel 1–24 insert in/out
INS MTRX1–INS MTRX8
MATRIX channel 1–8 insert in/out
INS ST A (L/R)
STEREO A channel (L/R) insert in/out
INS ST B (L/R)
STEREO B channel (L/R) insert in/out
INS MON (L/R/C)
MONITOR channel (L/R/C) insert in/out
Note
When you select the insertion destination here, insert in/out
will be patched simultaneously, and insertion will automati-
cally be turned on for the channel into which the graphic EQ
module was inserted.
If you move the cursor away without pressing the [ENTER]
key, the setting will revert to its original state.
D GEQ ON/OFF button
Switches the currently selected graphic EQ module on/
off.
E SLOW/FAST
Switches the fall speed of the spectrum analyzer
between slow or fast. This setting does not affect the
meters in other screens or the meters on the panel.
F PEAK HOLD
Switches the peak hold function on/off for the spec-
trum analyzer. The peak level for each band is held
while this button is on. (To reset the peak level display,
turn this button off and then on again). This setting
does not affect the meters in other screens or the
meters on the panel.
G Spectrum analyzer
This is an analyzer that shows a realtime level display
for each band of the input signal.
H EQ graph
Indicates the current frequency response of the graphic
EQ.
I Faders
These faders cut/boost the frequency bands of the
graphic EQ. The actual values are shown in the numer-
ical boxes below.
J ASSIGN TO FADERS
These buttons divide the 31 bands of the graphic EQ
into six groups so that you can use the DCA faders to
adjust the boost/cut amount of each band. Click one of
the six buttons A (20.0-100), B (63.0-315), C (200-
1.00k), D (630-3.15k), E (2.00k-10.0k), F (4.00k-
20.0k). DCA faders 1–8 will be assigned to the corre-
sponding region of frequency bands, allowing you to
control them with the DCA faders. At this time, the
divisions of the corresponding faders and the value in
the numerical box screen will turn red in the screen. To
return to the original state, press the DCA (OFF) but-
ton in the screen or the [DCA] button on the panel.
GEQ PARAM (GEQ parameter) screen
GEQ PARAM
1 3 4 5 62
J
7
8
9
PM5D/PM5D-RH Owner’s Manual Reference section 157
Information shown
in the display
Function
menu
Global
functions
Output
functions
Input
functions
Appendices
Note
If the ASSIGN TO FADERS buttons A–F are off, you can
hold down the [SHIFT] button on the panel and press a
FADER MODE section button [A]–[F], and then use the DCA
faders to control the corresponding region of the graphic EQ
in the same way as if you had pressed a button A–F in the
screen.
The currently selected DCA fader mode (DCA, A–F) is dis-
abled while one of the ASSIGN TO FADERS buttons A–F is
on. At this time, you can also use the FADER MODE sec-
tion buttons [A]–[F] to switch between regions of the graphic
EQ; the button for the selected region will blink, and the
remaining buttons will light.
The setting in the ASSIGN TO FADERS area is defeated
when you switch screens; the currently selected DCA fader
mode will again be applied.
K LIBRARY
This button accesses the GEQ LIBRARY screen.
L Level meter
This meter indicates the peak level before and after the
graphic EQ.
M LIMIT
The range and direction of adjustment controlled by
the faders can be selected from the following: ±15 dB,
±12 dB, ±6 dB (these are valid in both the boost and
cut directions), or –24 dB (valid only in the cut
direction).
N EQ FLAT
Resets all faders to the 0 dB position. When you click
this button, a confirmation message will appear.
O AUTO ASSIGN
This button automates assignments to the DCA faders.
If this button is on, the most recently selected region of
GEQ bands will be assigned to the DCA faders when
you access the GEQ PARAM screen.
This screen lists the approximate values of the graphic EQ
settings, and shows the input/output levels. The signal path
assignments and on/off status can also be edited in this
screen.
A Level meter
This meter indicates the peak level before and after the
graphic EQ.
B Fader graph
This indicates the approximate fader position for each
band. When you click this area, the GEQ PARAM
screen for the corresponding GEQ module will appear.
You can also drag and drop this area onto another
GEQ module to copy the GEQ settings.
C GEQ ON/OFF button
Switches the graphic EQ module on/off.
D Insert destination
Indicates the location at which the graphic EQ module
is inserted. You can also specify the insert location
from within this screen.
E LINK button
This button indicates the link status of adjacent odd-
numbered even-numbered graphic EQ modules.
When you turn this button on, a window will appear,
allowing you to select whether the parameters will be
copied from one module to the other, or whether both
modules will be initialized.
K
L
M
N
O
GEQ ASSIGN screen
GEQ ASSIGN
5
1 2 3
4
GEQ function
158 PM5D/PM5D-RH Owner’s Manual Reference section
Here you can recall, store, rename, or delete items in the
GEQ library.
A EDIT
When you click this button, the GEQ PARAM screen
for the currently selected GEQ module will appear.
B GEQ module select
Of the GEQ modules 1–12, select the module for which
you want to make settings.
C Current EQ graph
Indicates the approximate response of the currently
selected GEQ module.
D Level meter
This meter indicates the peak level before and after the
graphic EQ.
E RECALL
Recalls the library item selected in the list into the cur-
rently selected GEQ module.
F STORE
Stores the settings of the currently selected GEQ mod-
ule into the selected location in the list. When you click
this button a window will appear, allowing you to
name and save the GEQ module settings.
G TITLE EDIT
Edits the title of the library item selected in the list.
When you click this button a window will appear,
allowing you to edit the title.
H CLEAR
Deletes the library item selected in the list. When you
click this button, a confirmation message will appear.
Note
Library items with an “R” displayed in the right column of the
list are read-only. Read-only items cannot be stored,
renamed, or deleted.
I Library EQ graph
Shows the response curve of the library selected in the
list.
J Library list
Use the scroll bar to select the library item on which
you want to perform an operation. The selected library
item will move to the center, and will be highlighted.
GEQ LIBRARY screen
GEQ LIBRARY
1 2 3
4
9
5
6
7
8
J
PM5D/PM5D-RH Owner’s Manual Reference section 159
Information shown
in the display
Function
menu
Global
functions
Output
functions
Input
functions
Appendices
SCENE function
Here you can store/recall scenes.
A Scene list
This is a list of the stored scenes. For each scene, the
following items are displayed. (To view
7 COM-
MENT and subsequent items, scroll the list to the
right.)
B (Scene number)
This is the scene number 0–500. You can click this icon
to reverse the order in which the scenes are sorted.
C TITLE
This is the name assigned to each scene. You can click
the TITLE button to sort the scenes in order of their
titles. When you click the button at the left, a win-
dow will appear, allowing you to edit the title.
D (Protect)
This button switches Protect on/off for each scene. A
lock icon indicates scenes for which Protect is turned
on; these scenes cannot be overwritten. Read-only
scenes are indicated by a “R” displayed here.
E SEL.RECALL (Selective recall)
For each scene, you can specify whether the Selective
Recall function will be used when recalling the scene. If
the Selective Recall function is enabled ( p.164),
scenes for which this button is turned on can recall
only specific parameters. (Alternatively, you can
exclude only specific parameters from the recall.)
If the scenes are sorted in order of TITLE, a check mark
is displayed for scenes for which this is turned on. If the
scenes are sorted in numerical order, a downward or
upward arrow is displayed for scenes for which this is
turned on; this makes it easy to see which was the origi-
nal scene prior to selective recall.
F Library link
This area shows the number and title of the INPUT
PATCH library, OUTPUT PATCH library, and HA
library used by each scene. You can click the button
at the left to access a window that lets you change the
library number that is linked. The LINK button for
each library determines whether library recall opera-
tions will be linked to scene recall operations.
If the LINK button is on (this column indicates
“LINK”), the library of the corresponding number will
also be recalled when you recall that scene. A library
whose LINK button is off will not change when you
recall that scene.
G COMMENT
In this column you can enter or view a comment for
the scene. A text input window will appear when you
move the cursor to the COMMENT field and press the
[ENTER] key, or when you click the button at the
left.
H TIME STAMP
Indicates the time at which the scene was last stored, in
the format of month/day/year/hours/minutes/seconds.
I MIDI EVENT
Specifies a MIDI message that will be transmitted from
the MIDI OUT connector when the scene is recalled.
When you click the button at left a window will
appear, allowing you to input a MIDI event in hexa-
decimal form ( p.118).
J TX ON/OFF (MIDI event transmission on/
off)
Specifies whether the assigned MIDI event will be
transmitted.
SCENE screen
SCENE
1
2 3 45 6
7 8
9 J
SCENE function
160 PM5D/PM5D-RH Owner’s Manual Reference section
K GPI OUT CONTROL 1–12
Specifies the polarity and transmission method (tally/
trigger) of the signal that is sent from GPI OUT ports
1–12 when the scene is recalled. When you click a but-
ton corresponding to a port 1–12, the setting will
change in the following order.
Note
GPI OUT CONTROL settings are independent of the set-
tings in the MIDI/REMOTE function GPI screen.
In the case of a Trigger type setting, the time interval
between becoming active and returning to the inactive state
is 250 msec.
L REMOTE TRANSPORT
Selects the transport command (MMC or RS422 pro-
tocol) that will be transmitted when you recall the
scene. If you click the button at the left a window
will appear, allowing you to select the output destina-
tion and the type of command.
M SCENE FUNCTION (Recall function)
Here you can store/recall scenes.
RECALL
Loads the scene currently selected in the scene list into
the PM5D.
STORE
Saves the current settings of the PM5D in the scene
currently selected in the scene list. (This button is inop-
erable if the selected scene is read-only or protected.)
UNDO
Cancels the preceding Recall or Store operation. You
can click this once again (Redo) to return to the state
prior to Undoing.
PREVIEW
If this button is on, the PM5D will be in PREVIEW
mode; this allows you to view or edit the settings of a
scene stored in memory or the settings of a library item
without affecting the internal signal processing. This is
linked with the [PREVIEW] key in the SCENE MEM-
ORY section of the panel ( p.80).
Note
Monitor settings will apply to internal signal processing even
during Preview mode. You can perform cue/monitor opera-
tions while Previewing.
EVENT LIST, MIDI, and GPI operations will apply to internal
signal processing, but not to Preview.
Memory card save/load operations cannot be performed
during Preview.
During Preview, user defined operations that affect internal
signal processing are disabled; such operations include
EVENT LIST, TALKBACK ASSIGN, MONITOR, MIDI
DIRECT OUT, MACHINE CONTROL, and GPI OUT
CONTROL.
N BLANK SKIP
Specifies how scene numbers can be selected. If the
BLANK SKIP button is off, all scene numbers can be
selected consecutively regardless of whether they con-
tain scene data. In contrast if the BLANK SKIP button
is on, only numbers in which a scene is actually stored
can be selected. This setting applies when you switch
scenes using the SCENE MEMORY [π]/[] keys in
the SCENE MEMORY section of the panel, the
[DATA] encoder, or the / buttons in the screen.
O EDIT
These buttons let you rearrange the order of the scenes
in memory.
CUT
Cuts the scene selected in the list, and holds it in a tem-
porary memory buffer. Subsequent scenes will be
moved forward by one.
COPY
Copies the scene selected in the list into the memory
buffer. The copy-source and other scenes will not be
affected.
INSERT
Inserts the scene from the memory buffer at the num-
ber selected in the list. Scenes that follow the number at
which you inserted will be moved backward by one.
PASTE
Overwrites the scene from the memory buffer onto the
blank number selected in the list. Other scenes will not
be affected.
CLEAR
Deletes the scene selected in the list.
UNDO
Cancels the operation that was last performed in the
EDIT area.
Note
•A confirmation message will appear when you click one of
these buttons.
If a read-only or protected scene is selected in the list, the
CUT, INSERT, and CLEAR buttons are grayed-out, and
cannot be used.
If an existing scene is selected in the list, the PASTE button
is grayed-out, and cannot be used.
If the list is sorted by title, the CUT, INSERT, and UNDO
buttons are displayed in gray.
If you modify the contents of a scene by operations in other
than the EDIT section, the UNDO button is displayed in gray.
Display Polarity
Transmission
method
None Disabled
High active Tally
Low active Tally
High active Trigger
Low active Trigger
K L
M O P
N
Q
PM5D/PM5D-RH Owner’s Manual Reference section 161
Information shown
in the display
Function
menu
Global
functions
Output
functions
Input
functions
Appendices
P DIRECT RECALL ASSIGN
This lets you select the scenes that will be directly
recalled by the SCENE MEMORY [1]–[8] keys on the
panel. This function is available if the DIRECT
RECALL button is on.
When you move the cursor to the field on the left and
turn the [DATA] encoder, or when you click the /
buttons to select a scene number, the scene name will
appear in the field on the right.
Q DIRECT RECALL/MUTE MASTER
These are linked with the DIRECT RECALL/MUTE
MASTER buttons shown at the bottom of the display.
( p.151)
The Event List function lets you register scenes in the order
of use, so that these scenes can be recalled either manually
or automatically according to the specified time code or
interval.
A EVENT LIST ENABLE/DISABLE
Use the following three buttons to enable/disable the
Event List function.
DISABLE
The Event List function will not recall scenes registered
in the event list.
ENABLE [ALL MANUAL]
Scenes registered in the event list will be recalled only
by manual operation. If the list contains events for
which a time code has been specified, the candidate
event for recall will change as time code progresses, but
events will not actually be recalled unless the recall
operation is performed manually.
ENABLE
Scenes registered in the event list will be recalled
according to the specified condition (time code, inter-
val, or manual operation).
B Event list
In this list you can register the scenes to be recalled,
and the conditions under which the scenes will be
recalled. Click a line to select the event of that line for
editing; it will be highlighted in the center of the list.
EVENT LIST screen
EVENT LIST
1
3
2
SCENE function
162 PM5D/PM5D-RH Owner’s Manual Reference section
No.
Indicates the event number.
EVENT TRIGGER
This column specifies the condition that will recall each
event. Click the button, and in the window that
appears, use the following three buttons to select the
condition.
MANUAL . . . . . The event can be recalled by the
DIRECT button in the EVENT
RECALL area (
3) or by a User
Defined key. The EVENT TRIG-
GER field will indicate
“[MANUAL]”.
INTERVAL . . . . The scene will be recalled when a
specified time has elapsed after the
preceding scene was recalled. If you
select this button, specify the wait
time in the lower part of the win-
dow. The EVENT TRIGGER field
in the list shows a “ ” symbol and
the wait time.
TIME CODE . . . The scene will be recalled when the
time code (LTC, MTC, internal
time code) reaches the specified
time. If you select this button, spec-
ify the time code location (hours/
minutes/seconds/frames) in the
lower part of the window. The
EVENT TRIGGER field in the list
shows the time code.
Hint
As long as an event for which MANUAL is specified is
selected in the list, the scene will not change until you manu-
ally execute a recall.
However, if a event for which TIME CODE is specified is
registered later in the list, events set to MANUAL will be
skipped when that time code arrives, and the corresponding
scene will be recalled.
The condition for recalling the scene that will be recalled
next is shown in the NEXT SCENE/NEXT EVENT fields in
the upper part of the display.
Note
If time code source is OFF, events whose EVENT TRIG-
GER is set to TIME CODE will not be recalled unless you
perform a manual recall.
In contrast, events whose EVENT TRIGGER is set to
INTERVAL will be recalled automatically after the specified
interval elapses from the previous recall operation, even if
the time code source is OFF.
In the two-second interval after time code starts, events may
not be executed because synchronization is being estab-
lished. You must start time code at least two seconds earlier
than an event you want to execute.
SCENE TITLE
This is the number and title of the scene to be recalled.
Click the button, and in the window that appears,
click the number of a scene to select it.
C EVENT RECALL
Here you can recall events. The following three but-
tons are provided.
PREV
When you click this button, the event of the line pre-
ceding the last-recalled event will be recalled and
selected.
DIRECT
When you click this button, the event currently
selected in the event list will be recalled. This is used
mainly to recall an event whose EVENT TRIGGER
field is set to “[MANUAL]”.
NEXT
When you click this button, the event of the line fol-
lowing the last-recalled event will be recalled and
selected.
D AUTO CAPTURE
This button lets you automatically register events in
realtime while time code runs. If time code is running
and this button is on, using the buttons of the panel
SCENE MEMORY to recall a scene will cause the cor-
responding scene number and time code location to be
captured, and this will be added as a new event.
Note
If the list contains previously-recorded events, they will be
sorted in descending order of their time code.
If an event already exists at the identical time code location,
it will be overwritten by the new event.
Even if time code source is “OFF,” performing a recall oper-
ation while this button is on will register a new event in the
list. In this case, the EVENT TRIGGER field will be regis-
tered as “[MANUAL]”.
If an offset value is specified, the sum of the offset value and
the displayed time code is captured as the time code.
E MOVE UP
This button moves the currently selected event one
position earlier in the event list.
Event that will be recalled manually
Event that will be recalled when time code reaches the
specified location
Event that will be recalled when the specified interval elapses
after the previous recall operation
4
9
J
Q
5
6
7
8
K
L
M
N
O
P
PM5D/PM5D-RH Owner’s Manual Reference section 163
Information shown
in the display
Function
menu
Global
functions
Output
functions
Input
functions
Appendices
F MOVE DOWN
This button moves the currently selected event one
position later in the event list.
Note
The MOVE UP/DOWN buttons are available only for events
whose EVENT TRIGGER field is shown as “[MANUAL]” or
the “ ” symbol.
If the EVENT TRIGGER field of the selected event shows a
time code, these buttons will be grayed-out and unavailable.
G MANUAL INSERT
This button inserts a new event at the location selected
in the event list. The EVENT TRIGGER field of the
new event will be “[MANUAL],” and its SCENE TITLE
field will be “no assignment.” You can change these as
desired.
H MANUAL OVERWRITE
This button overwrites a new event onto the location
currently selected in the event list. (If the line at the
current location is blank, this button will be grayed-out
and unavailable.) The EVENT TRIGGER field of the
new event will be “[MANUAL].”
I TIME CODE SETUP
Here you can make settings for the time code received
by the PM5D.
TC SOURCE (Time code source)
Select one of the following as the time code source that
will be used.
OFF . . . . . . . . . . Time code will not be received.
INTERNAL . . . . The time code generated within the
PM5D will be used.
TIME CODE . . . The time code (LTC) received via
the rear panel TIME CODE connec-
tor will be used.
MIDI . . . . . . . . . The MIDI time code (MTC)
received via the rear panel MIDI IN
connector will be used.
USB . . . . . . . . . . The MIDI time code received from
the specified port via the rear panel
USB connector will be used.
SLOT 1–4 . . . . . If a card that supports MIDI input
is installed in one of the rear panel
slots, the MIDI time code received
from the specified port will be used.
Note
This setting does not affect the MIDI REMOTE function MIDI
SETUP screen.
If you select USB or SLOT 1–4, you will need to specify the
port number (1–8) in the field on the right (Depending on the
card that is installed, some slots may have only one port.)
If you switch to INTERNAL, the time code will be set to the
Start Time value.
FRAME RATE
Select one of the following as the frame rate for the
time code (LTC, MTC, internal time code) you are
using.
30 . . . . . . . . . . 30 frames/second (non-drop)
30D . . . . . . . . . 30 frames/second (drop frame)
29.97 . . . . . . . . 29.97 frames/second (non-drop)
29.97D . . . . . . 29.97 frames/second (drop frame)
25 . . . . . . . . . . 25 frames/second
24 . . . . . . . . . . 24 frames/second
OFFSET TIME/START TIME
If INTERNAL is selected as the time code source, use
this field to specify the time at which internal time code
will begin (START TIME).
If any other time code source is selected, use this field
to specify the offset (OFFSET TIME). The offset is the
interval by which the timing at which scenes are
recalled is adjusted backward or forward relative to the
incoming time code (LTC or MTC).
In either case, you can edit the value by clicking the
button and specifying the value in hours/minutes/sec-
onds/frames units in the window that appears.
J Time code display area
This displays the value of the incoming time code (LTC
or MTC) or the internal time code. If INTERNAL is
selected as the time code source, transport buttons are
shown immediately below the time code value; you can
use these buttons to rewind, stop, or start the internal
time code.
In addition, if INTERNAL is selected you can click the
button to access the TIME CODE window, and
specify the time code directly.
Note
An offset value is not added to the displayed time code.
K TIME CODE INSERT
This button registers the time code data in the list in
realtime. When the time code source is running, click-
ing this button will capture the time code value and
add it as a new event. The captured time code is input
in the EVENT TRIGGER field of the new event, and
the SCENE TITLE field will be “no assignment.” At this
time, the events within the list are sorted in descending
order of time code. (If an event exists at the same time
location, it will be overwritten by the new event.)
Note
If the time code source is OFF, the EVENT TRIGGER column
will be “[MANUAL].” If the time code source is TIME CODE,
MIDI, USB, or SLOT 1–4, the offset value has been added to
the time code value of the newly added event.
L TIME CODE OVERWRITE
This button replaces the time code of the event selected
in the list in realtime. When the time code source is
running, clicking this button will write the current time
location as the time code value of the currently selected
event. (The SCENE TITLE field will not change.) At
this time, the events within the list are sorted in
descending order of time code.
If a blank line is selected, this button is grayed-out.
Note
If the time code source is OFF, the EVENT TRIGGER column
will be “[MANUAL].” If the time code source is TIME CODE,
MIDI, USB, or SLOT 1–4, the offset value has been added to
the rewritten time code value.
RETURN TO START TIME
(rewind the time code to
the start time)
START
(start the time code
from the current
location)
STOP
(stop the time code)
SCENE function
164 PM5D/PM5D-RH Owner’s Manual Reference section
M SCENE INSERT
This button inserts one or more consecutive scenes
from scene memory into the event list. Use the FROM/
TO fields located at right to specify the starting and
ending scene numbers, and click this button; the speci-
fied scenes will be inserted as new events for recall
immediately before the currently selected event. The
EVENT TRIGGER field is set to “[MANUAL]” for all
of the new events.
N SCENE OVERWRITE
This button overwrites the scene assignments of con-
secutive events in the event list with multiple
consecutive scenes from scene memory. Use the
FROM/TO fields located at right to specify the starting
and ending scene numbers, and click this button; start-
ing at the currently selected line of the event list, the
SCENE TITLE field of the corresponding number of
subsequent events will be rewritten to the scenes you
specified. (The EVENT TRIGGER field will not
change.) If a blank line is selected, this button is
grayed-out.
O DELETE
This button deletes the event selected in the event list.
If a blank line is selected, this button is grayed-out.
P UNDO
This button returns the event list to its state prior to the
most recent editing operation. If undo cannot be exe-
cuted, this button is grayed-out.
Q ALL DELETE
This button deletes all events from the event list. When
you click this button, a confirmation message will
appear.
Note
If you edit the list (
4
8
,
K
Q
) or change the time code, the
NEXT EVENT button in the constantly-displayed area will
search from the current time code. However if the time code
source is OFF, or if there is no time code setting in the EVENT
TRIGGER field (only for [MANUAL] and [INTERVAL]), the
NEXT EVENT will be the beginning of the list.
In this screen you can make settings for the Selective Recall
function, which, independently for each scene, lets you
exclude specific parameters/channels from recall, or con-
versely recall only specific parameters/channels.
A SELECTIVE RECALL ENABLE/DISABLE
Enables/disables Selective Recall for the currently
selected scene. If this button is set to DISABLE, the
Selective Recall function is disabled.
Note
Unlike the RECALL SAFE screen (
p.166) which is com-
mon to all scenes, the settings in the SELECTIVE RECALL
screen are independent for each scene.
If you edit the settings of the SELECTIVE RECALL screen,
you must store that scene in order to make your changes
effective.
B SELECTION MODE
Use the following two buttons to choose how you want
to use the SELECTIVE RECALL screen.
SAFE PARAMETER button
If this button is on, you can specify the channels/
parameters that will be excluded from recall
operations.
RECALL PARAMETER button
If this button is on, you can specify the channels/
parameters that will be recalled.
Immediately after you switch buttons, all channels/
parameters will be subject to recall.
SELECTIVE RECALL screen
SELECTIVE RECALL
1 2
PM5D/PM5D-RH Owner’s Manual Reference section 165
Information shown
in the display
Function
menu
Global
functions
Output
functions
Input
functions
Appendices
C SAFE ON/OFF buttons
RECALL ON/OFF buttons
The function of these buttons will depend on the
SELECTION MODE (
2) setting.
If the SAFE PARAMETER button is on
These buttons function as SAFE ON/OFF buttons that
specify the channels excluded from recall operations.
If the RECALL PARAMETER button is on
These buttons function as RECALL ON/OFF buttons
that specify the channels that will be recalled.
D Parameter matrix grid
Here you can select the parameters that will be recalled
(or excluded from recall). SAFE PARAMETER selec-
tions are shown in green, and RECALL PARAMETER
selections are shown in blue. If the ALL button is on, all
parameters other than CH to MIX will be recalled (or
excluded from recall).
Note
Matrix grids corresponding to combinations that cannot be
selected are grayed-out.
Settings in the parameter matrix grid are ignored for chan-
nels whose SAFE ON/OFF button or RECALL ON/OFF
button is switched off.
E ASSIGN
This area indicates the number of assigned channels for
each parameter.
F SET ALL
These buttons turn on the buttons of all channels or all
buttons of the corresponding parameter.
G CLEAR ALL
These buttons turn off the buttons of all channels or all
buttons of the corresponding parameter.
H OTHER SAFE/RECALL PARAMETERS
By using these buttons, parameters other than those
described above can be excluded from recall
operations.
If the SAFE PARAMETER button is turned on in the
SELECTION MODE (
2) area, these buttons specify
the parameters that will be excluded from recall. If the
RECALL PARAMETER button is turned on, these but-
tons specify the parameters that will be recalled.
I SET ALL
This button turns on all buttons of the OTHER SAFE
PARAMETERS area.
J CLEAR ALL
This button turns off all buttons of the OTHER SAFE
PARAMETERS area.
In the case of parameters (such as those listed below) for
which two adjacent odd-numbered/even-numbered chan-
nels or modules share a single parameter, the parameter
will be recalled (or excluded from recall) only if selective
recall is specified for both channels/modules.
GATE STEREO LINK
COMP STEREO LINK
DELAY GANG
PAN MODE
GEQ LINK
ATT GANG
MS DECODE
FIXED/VARI
Note
Recall Safe and Selective Recall can be used together.
Channels/parameters excluded from recall operations by
either Recall Safe or Selective Recall (or both) will not be
recalled.
Selective Recall applies when a scene is recalled in PRE-
VIEW mode.
When you recall a scene, there may be cases in which a
conflict in pairing settings between Recall Safe and Selec-
tive Recall causes the settings of a parameter to differ
between L and R channels. In such cases, the parameter
will be linked when it is next operated.
3 4
6
5
7
8
9
J
SCENE function
166 PM5D/PM5D-RH Owner’s Manual Reference section
Here you can specify parameters/channels that will be
excluded from recall operations for all scenes.
A HA SAFE ON/OFF (Head Amp safe on/off)
buttons
These buttons select the channels whose assigned HA
(Head Amp) will be excluded from recall operations.
Note
If you scroll the scroll bar downward, you will see that the CH
column of the SAFE PARAMETERS area shows not only
input channels but also the following input ports.
AD1-AD48 . . . . INPUT jacks 1-48
AD1L-AD4R . . L/R channels of ST IN jacks 1-4
ExHA1-1–ExHA8-8 . . . . Channels 1-8 of external head amps
1-8 (AD8HR or AD824)
B CH SAFE ON/OFF (Channel safe on/off)
buttons
These buttons select the channels that will be excluded
from recall operations. These are linked with the
[RECALL SAFE] key of the panel.
C Parameter matrix grid
Here you can select the channel parameters that will be
excluded from recall operations. If the ALL button is
on, all parameters except for CH to MIX will be
excluded.
Recall Safe and Selective Recall can be used together.
Channels/parameters excluded from recall operations
by either Recall Safe or Selective Recall (or both) will
not be recalled.
Note
Settings in the parameter matrix grid are ignored for channels
whose CH SAFE ON/OFF button is OFF.
D ASSIGN
This area indicates the number of assigned channels for
each parameter.
E SET ALL
These buttons turn on the buttons of all channels or all
buttons of the corresponding parameter.
F CLEAR ALL
These buttons turn off the buttons of all channels or all
buttons of the corresponding parameter.
G SELECTIVE RECALL PARAMETERS PASTE
This button copies parameter settings from the SELEC-
TIVE RECALL screen, and pastes them into the
RECALL SAFE screen. When you click the button, a
confirmation message will appear.
H OTHER SAFE PARAMETERS
By using these buttons, parameters other than those
described above can be excluded from recall
operations.
I SET ALL
This button turns on all buttons of the OTHER SAFE
PARAMETERS area.
J CLEAR ALL
This button turns off all buttons of the OTHER SAFE
PARAMETERS area.
RECALL SAFE screen
RECALL SAFE
1 2 3
5
4
6
8
9
7
J
PM5D/PM5D-RH Owner’s Manual Reference section 167
Information shown
in the display
Function
menu
Global
functions
Output
functions
Input
functions
Appendices
In the case of parameters (such as those listed below) for
which two adjacent odd-numbered/even-numbered chan-
nels or modules share a single parameter, the parameter
will be excluded from recall only if recall safe is specified
for both channels/modules.
GATE STEREO LINK
COMP STEREO LINK
DELAY GANG
PAN MODE
GEQ LINK
ATT GANG
MS DECODE
FIXED/VARI
Note
Selective Recall applies when a scene is recalled in PRE-
VIEW mode.
When you recall a scene, there may be cases in which a
conflict in pairing settings between Recall Safe and Selec-
tive Recall causes the settings of a parameter to differ
between L and R channels. In such cases, the parameter
will be linked when it is next operated.
Here you can specify how fader and pan will change
smoothly to their new values over a specified duration
when the scene is recalled.
A FADING ENABLE/DISABLE
Enables/disables the Fade function for fader levels.
Note
The settings in the FADE TIME screen are independent for
each scene. If you edit these settings, you must store that
scene in order to make your changes effective.
The Fade function will apply when you recall a scene for
which the ENABLE button is selected.
B INPUT CH PANNING ENABLE/DISABLE
(Input channel panning enable/disable)
If the ENABLE button is selected, the Fade function
will also apply to the PAN (BALANCE) parameter of
input channels. This button is independent from the
FADING ENABLE/DISABLE (
1) setting. Use the fol-
lowing two buttons to select the input channels to
which this will apply.
When the ALL INPUT button is on
The Fade function will apply to the PAN (BALANCE)
parameter of all input channels.
When the SAME AS FADING button is on
The Fade function will apply to the PAN (BALANCE)
parameter of only the input channels you select in
4.
C FADE TIME/START OFFSET
Use the following two buttons to select the parameters
that can be viewed/edited in the FADE TIME screen.
The indication at the right shows which button is cur-
rently selected.
When the FADE TIME button is on
Edit the time (fade time) over which the fader or pan
parameter of the corresponding channel will reach the
new value when you recall a scene for which the Fade
function is enabled.
FADE TIME screen
FADE TIME
1 2 3
SCENE function
168 PM5D/PM5D-RH Owner’s Manual Reference section
When the START OFFSET button is on
Edit the time (start offset time) after which the fader or
pan parameter of the corresponding channel will begin
changing when you recall a scene for which the Fade
function is enabled.
D Channel settings
Here you can turn the Fade function on/off and spec-
ify the fade time (or the start offset time) for each input
channel / output channel.
Use the channel name buttons to switch the Fade func-
tion on/off. The box below each button lets you specify
the fade time or start offset time. Move the cursor to a
box, and turn the [DATA] encoder or click the /
buttons at the left and right to edit the value.
The color of the numerical value shown in the box will
change as follows.
When the FADE TIME button is on
The value is displayed in white for channels whose start
offset time is “----” (unset), and in light blue for chan-
nels that are set to 0.1 or above.
When the START OFFSET button is on
The value is displayed in red for channels whose start
offset time is “----” (unset), and in yellow for channels
that are set to 0.1 or above.
If desired, you can copy the fade time / offset time
value from one channel to another as follows. Move
the cursor to the box that displays the value you want
to copy; then hold down the [SHIFT] key and press the
[ENTER] key to access the JOB SELECT window.
In this window, select the copy-destination item and
click the OK button; the value of the selected channel
will be copied.
E SET ALL
This button enables the Fade function for all input
channels or output channels.
F CLEAR ALL
This button disables the Fade function for all input
channels or output channels.
4 65
PM5D/PM5D-RH Owner’s Manual Reference section 169
Information shown
in the display
Function
menu
Global
functions
Output
functions
Input
functions
Appendices
Here you can make settings for the Tracking Recall func-
tion, which adds a specified offset value to the value of each
fader when you recall a scene.
A TRACKING RECALL ENABLE/DISABLE
Enables/disables the Tracking Recall function.
Hint
The settings in the TRACKING RECALL screen apply to all
scenes.
B DISPLAY SELECT
These buttons select the type of channels that are
shown in the TRACKING RECALL screen; either
INPUT (input channels) or OUTPUT (output
channels).
C SET ALL
This button enables Tracking Recall for all channels
(including channels not currently shown in the screen).
D CLEAR ALL
This button disables Tracking Recall for all channels
(including channels not currently shown in the screen).
E OFFSET LOCK
If this button is on, the sliders of all channels (includ-
ing channels not currently shown in the screen) will be
grayed-out, and you will be unable to edit the offset
value.
F ON (Tracking On)
These buttons enable/disable tracking for each chan-
nel. If the TRACKING RECALL ENABLE/DISABLE
button is set to ENABLE, tracking is enabled on chan-
nels for which this button is ON.
Note
If OFFSET LOCK (
5
) is off, turning this button on will reset
the tracking offset of the corresponding channel to 0 dB. If in
this state you operate the fader of the corresponding channel,
the relative amount of fader movement from the point at which
this button was turned on will be memorized as the tracking
offset. You can then turn OFFSET LOCK on to lock the offset.
This offset value will be added whenever you subsequently
recall a scene.
G Tracking offset
Here you can specify the offset value applied to each
channel if tracking is enabled. The range is ±15 dB.
While OFFSET LOCK (
5) is off, operating the panel
faders will cause these values to change as well; how-
ever, adjusting the offset values in the screen will not
cause the panel faders to move.
TRACKING RECALL screen
TRACKING RECALL
34
21 5
7
6
SCENE function
170 PM5D/PM5D-RH Owner’s Manual Reference section
This screen lets you copy parameter settings of any desired
channel or parameter in the current scene, and paste them
into one or more scenes in scene memory.
A PASTE MODE
Select the type of copy-source parameter from the fol-
lowing choices. You cannot select more than one type
simultaneously.
INPUT . . . . . . Input channel parameters
OUTPUT . . . . Output channel parameters
DCA, GEQ, EFFECT . . . . DCA level or mute on/off
status, GEQ settings, inter-
nal effect settings
B CURRENT SCENE
Here you can select the channels and parameters that
will be copied from the currently selected scene. The
contents shown in this area will depend on the paste
mode (
1) you choose.
If Paste Mode= INPUT
Select input channels in the left area, and select param-
eters in the right area. You can select the following
parameters.
If Paste Mode= OUTPUT
Select output channels in the left area, and select
parameters in the right area. You can select the follow-
ing parameters.
Note
If Paste Mode= INPUT, and the parameter being pasted is
NAME, the name library linked to the selected scene will be
searched automatically and pasted.
Be aware that if other scenes link to this library, the paste
operation will overwrite the library, meaning that other
scenes may be affected.
GLOBAL PASTE screen
GLOBAL PASTE
1
2
ALL
All parameters except for HA, PATCH, and
NAME
ATT Attenuator
EQ EQ function settings
GATE GATE function settings
COMP COMP function settings
DELAY DELAY function settings
FADER Fader level
ON CH [ON] key on/off status
PAN/BAL Pan/balance settings
INSERT Insert on/off status and insert point
SEND
*1
*1. If the SEND button is on, use the MIX buttons (1–24) to
select the applicable MIX bus. If the MIX bus is paired,
SEND PAN is included in PAN/BAL if FOLLOW PAN
“VARI” is on, or included in SEND if it is off.
Send level to the desired MIX bus(es)
DCA Associated DCA group
MUTE Associated mute group
LCR LCR screen settings
HA
Settings for the head amp assigned to the
corresponding input channel
PATCH
Settings for the input patch assigned to the
corresponding input channel
NAME
Name assigned to the corresponding input
channel
EQ EQ function settings
COMP COMP function settings
DELAY DELAY function settings
FADER Fader level
ON CH [ON] key on/off status
BAL Balance settings
INSERT Insert on/off status and insert point
TO MTRX
*1
*1. If the TO MTRX button is on, use the MATRIX buttons
(1–8) to select the applicable MATRIX bus.
Send level to the desired MATRIX bus(es)
DCA Associated DCA group
MUTE Associated mute group
LCR LCR screen settings
WITHOUT
MIX SEND/
WITH MIX
SEND
Selects whether the send level sent from
input channels to the selected MIX bus will
be included (WITH...) or will not be included
(WITHOUT...) in the pasted data.
PM5D/PM5D-RH Owner’s Manual Reference section 171
Information shown
in the display
Function
menu
Global
functions
Output
functions
Input
functions
Appendices
C DESTINATION SCENE (Paste-destination
scene)
This list lets you select the scenes to which the data will
be pasted. If you want to select multiple consecutive
scenes as the paste-destination, select the starting num-
ber in the upper list and the ending number in the
lower list. (If you’re pasting to only one scene, select
the same scene in the upper and lower lists.)
You can change the order in which the list is sorted by
clicking the buttons shown at the top of the scene
number, SCENE TITLE, TIME STAMP, or COM-
MENT columns.
D PASTE
This button executes the Global Paste operation. When
you click this button, a confirmation message will
appear.
In the case of parameters such as those listed below, of
which only one exists for each two adjacent odd-num-
bered/even-numbered channels or modules, the
parameter will be pasted only if both channels/mod-
ules are specified for pasting.
GATE STEREO LINK
COMP STEREO LINK
DELAY GANG
PAN MODE
GEQ LINK
ATT GANG
MS DECODE
FIXED/VARI
Note
Paste is valid even in PREVIEW mode.
When you paste to a scene, there may be cases in which a
conflict in pairing settings causes the settings of a parame-
ter to differ between L and R channels. In such cases, the
parameter will be recalled with those settings, and will be
linked when it is next operated.
MIDI REMOTE function
Here you can select the types of MIDI message transmitted
and received by the PM5D, and select the MIDI port that
will be used.
A MODE
Here you can select the way in which program changes
and control changes will be transmitted/received.
PROGRAM CHANGE MODE
In this area you can select the program change trans-
mission/reception method.
SINGLE
If this button is on, program changes will be trans-
mitted/received on a single MIDI channel (Single
mode).
OMNI ON/OFF
If this button is on, program changes of all MIDI
channels will be received in Single mode (this is
unavailable in Multi mode).
BANK ON/OFF
If this button is on, bank select messages will be trans-
mitted and received in Single mode (this is
unavailable in Multi mode).
3
4
MIDI SETUP screen
MIDI SETUP
1 2 3 4
MIDI REMOTE function
172 PM5D/PM5D-RH Owner’s Manual Reference section
MULTI
If this button is on, program changes will be trans-
mitted/received on multiple MIDI channels (Multi
mode).
Hint
If program change reception is on, the PM5D’s scenes or
effects will switch when the appropriate program change is
received from an external device. Additionally, if transmis-
sion is on, program changes will be transmitted to an
external device when scenes or effects are switched on the
PM5D.
The scene/effect assignment for each program change num-
ber is made in the MIDI PGM CHANGE screen (
p.173).
CONTROL CHANGE MODE
In this area you can select the control change transmis-
sion/reception method.
NRPN
If this button is on, PM5D mix parameters will be
transmitted/received as NRPN messages.
TABLE [SINGLE]
If this button is on, PM5D mix parameters will be
transmitted/received as control change messages on a
single MIDI channel.
TABLE [MULTI]
If this button is on, PM5D mix parameters will be
transmitted/received as control change messages on
multiple MIDI channels.
Hint
If control change reception is on, the PM5D’s parameters
will change when the appropriate control change is received
from an external device. If transmission is on, a control
change will be transmitted to an external device when you
edit a parameter on the PM5D.
If NRPN is selected as the control change mode, the assign-
ment of parameters to NRPN is pre-defined and cannot be
changed.
If TABLE [SINGLE] or TABLE [MULTI] is selected as the
control change mode, the parameter assignment for each
control number can be edited in the MIDI CTRL CHANGE
screen (
p.174).
B Tx (MIDI transmission)
Here you can make various settings for transmission of
MIDI messages.
MIDI PORT Tx (MIDI transmission port)
Select the port at which the PM5D will transmit MIDI
messages. You have the following choices.
MIDI . . . . . . . The rear panel MIDI IN connector
USB . . . . . . . . The rear panel USB connector
SLOT 1–4 . . . A card that supports serial transmis-
sion and is installed in rear panel slot
1–4
Move the cursor to this box and turn the [DATA]
encoder or click the / buttons at left or right to
change the setting; then press the [ENTER] key to
finalize the change.
If you select USB or SLOT 1–4, you will need to spec-
ify the port number (1–8) in the field on the right
(Depending on the card that is installed, some slots
may have only one port.)
SINGLE MODE MIDI CH Tx (MIDI transmission
channel for Single mode)
Select the MIDI channel on which the PM5D will
transmit program changes, control changes, parameter
changes, and bulk data. (This setting is valid only in
Single mode.) Move the cursor to this box and turn the
[DATA] encoder or click the / buttons at left or
right to change the setting; then press the [ENTER] key
to finalize the change.
PROGRAM CHANGE Tx (Program change
transmission)
CONTROL CHANGE Tx (Control change
transmission)
PARAMETER CHANGE Tx (Parameter change
transmission)
These buttons turn transmission on/off for program
changes, control changes, and parameter changes
respectively.
Hint
Parameter changes are a method by which PM5D parame-
ters are transmitted in the form of system exclusive
messages.
MIDI THRU Tx (Thru output)
Select the port from which messages input to MIDI
THRU Rx will be output. The selection method is the
same as for MIDI PORT Tx.
C Rx (MIDI reception)
Here you can make various settings for reception of
MIDI messages.
MIDI PORT Rx (MIDI reception port)
Select the port from which the PM5D will receive
MIDI messages.
SINGLE MODE MIDI CH Rx (MIDI reception chan-
nel for Single mode)
Select the MIDI channel on which the PM5D will
receive program changes, control changes, parameter
changes, and bulk data. (This setting is valid only in
Single mode.)
PROGRAM CHANGE Rx (Program change
reception)
CONTROL CHANGE Rx (Control change
reception)
PARAMETER CHANGE Rx (Parameter change
reception)
These buttons turn transmission on/off for program
changes, control changes, and parameter changes
respectively.
MIDI THRU Rx (Thru input)
Here you can select the port that will “thru input” the
received MIDI messages.
D ECHO (MIDI message echo output)
Here you can select whether received program changes,
control changes, parameter changes, and other MIDI
messages will be echoed out from the MIDI transmis-
sion port.
PM5D/PM5D-RH Owner’s Manual Reference section 173
Information shown
in the display
Function
menu
Global
functions
Output
functions
Input
functions
Appendices
E MMC OUTPUT PORT
This selects the port that will transmit MMC (MIDI
Machine Control).
F MIDI REMOTE OUTPUT PORT (MIDI remote
output port)
Here you can select the port from which MIDI mes-
sages will be transmitted by the MIDI Remote
function, for each of the four banks. Incoming mes-
sages used by the LEARN function of the MIDI
REMOTE screen are also received at this port.
G PM5D EDITOR (PM5D EDITOR connection
port)
Here you can select the port and ID number (1–8) used
to communicate with the PM5D EDITOR application,
which controls the PM5D from a computer.
In this screen you can select the scene or effect library
assigned to each MIDI program number.
A MIDI SETUP
Select the ports that the PM5D will use to transmit and
receive MIDI messages, and the MIDI channels. This
item is linked with the settings in the MIDI SETUP
screen.
B PROGRAM CHANGE SETUP
Here you can specify how program changes will be
transmitted and received, and turn transmission and
reception on/off. This item is linked with the settings in
the MIDI SETUP screen.
C ECHO ON/OFF
This selects whether program changes received from an
external device are echoed-out from the MIDI trans-
mission port. This item is linked with the settings in the
MIDI SETUP screen.
5
6
7
MIDI PGM CHANGE (MIDI program
change) screen
MIDI PGM CHANGE
1
2
3
MIDI REMOTE function
174 PM5D/PM5D-RH Owner’s Manual Reference section
D List
In this list you can view and select the event (scene
recall / effect library recall) assigned to each program
number.
CH/BANK (Channel/Bank)
Indicates the MIDI channel on which the program
change is transmitted/received. In Single mode when
the BANK ON/OFF button is on, this column is dis-
played as BANK, and the value shown corresponds to
the bank number.
PGM No. (Program number)
Indicates the program number 1–128.
LIBRARY NAME
Here you can view/select the type and the number of
the event (scene or effect) assigned to each channel/
program number.
To make an assignment, click the desired line to select
it. (That line will be highlighted in the center of the
list.) Click the button shown at the left of the
LIBRARY NAME field; the MIDI PGM CHANGE
SETUP window will appear. In this window you can
select the type of event (a scene, or a library item for
effect 1–8) and its number.
When a program change on the corresponding MIDI
channel is received, the event assigned to that program
number will be recalled. In addition, the correspond-
ing program change will be transmitted when this
event is recalled on the PM5D.
E PRESET
Clicking this button will restore all event assignments
in the list to their default state.
F CLEAR ALL
Clicking this button will delete all event assignments in
the list.
Here you can select the PM5D parameter (fader operation,
[ON] key operation, etc.) assigned to each control number.
A MIDI SETUP
Select the ports that the PM5D will use to transmit and
receive MIDI messages, and the MIDI channels. This
item is linked with the settings in the MIDI SETUP
screen.
B CONTROL CHANGE SETUP
Here you can specify how control changes will be
transmitted and received, and turn transmission and
reception on/off. This item is linked with the settings in
the MIDI SETUP screen. You have the following
choices of transmission/reception method.
NRPN
If this button is on, PM5D mix parameters will be
transmitted/received as NRPN messages.
TABLE [SINGLE]
If this button is on, PM5D mix parameters will be
transmitted/received as control change messages on a
single MIDI channel according to the assignments in
the list (
4).
TABLE [MULTI]
If this button is on, PM5D mix parameters will be
transmitted/received as control change messages on
5 64
MIDI CTRL CHANGE (MIDI control
change) screen
MIDI CTRL CHANGE
1
2
3
PM5D/PM5D-RH Owner’s Manual Reference section 175
Information shown
in the display
Function
menu
Global
functions
Output
functions
Input
functions
Appendices
multiple MIDI channels according to the assignments
in the list (
4).
C ECHO ON/OFF
This selects whether control changes received from an
external device are echoed-out from the MIDI trans-
mission port. This item is linked with the settings in the
MIDI SETUP screen.
D List
In this list you can view/select the events assigned to
each control number.
CH (Channel)
Indicates the MIDI channel on which the control
change is transmitted/received.
CTRL No. (Control number)
Indicates the control number 0–119. Control numbers
0, 32, and 96–110 cannot be specified.
CTRL CHANGE EVENT (Control change event)
Indicates/selects the type of event assigned to the corre-
sponding channel / control number.
To make an assignment, click the desired line (that line
will be highlighted in the center of the list); then click
the button at the left of the CTRL CHANGE
EVENT field to open the MIDI CTRL CHANGE
SETUP window. In this window you can specify the
parameter in three levels (mode, parameters 1/2).
When a control change on the corresponding MIDI
channel is received, the event assigned to that control
number will be edited. In addition, the corresponding
control change will be transmitted when this event is
edited on the PM5D.
Note
This list is ignored if the control change mode is set to NRPN.
E PRESET
Clicking this button will restore all event assignments
in the list to their default state.
F CLEAR ALL
Clicking this button will delete all event assignments in
the list.
Here you can assign MIDI messages to panel faders, CH
[ON] keys, encoders, and ENCODER [ON] keys, and
make settings for the MIDI Remote function used to con-
trol external devices.
A TRANSMIT ENABLE/DISABLE (Enable/dis-
able transmission)
Enables/disables the MIDI Remote function. You can
enable/disable this function for each of the four banks
(memories in which MIDI Remote settings are stored).
B ASSIGN TO CH STRIP SECTION (Assign to
channel strip)
You can choose the following two as the channel strip
to which the MIDI Remote function is assigned (both
can be selected simultaneously if desired).
INPUT CH . . . . . . . INPUT channel strip 1–24
STIN/FXRTN . . . . . ST IN/FX RTN channel strip 1–
4
This setting applies to all four banks.
C Channel selection
Select the MIDI Remote channel for which you want to
make settings. When you click the / buttons at the
left and right of the box, the corresponding name is
displayed in the box at the right. You can change the
name by clicking the button of the right box.
Note
You cannot change the MIDI Remote channel you’re editing
while any of the LEARN buttons (
7
) are on. You will have to
turn off the LEARN button first.
4
5 6
MIDI REMOTE screen
MIDI REMOTE
1 2
3
MIDI REMOTE function
176 PM5D/PM5D-RH Owner’s Manual Reference section
D BANK SELECT
Of the four banks, select the bank for which you want
to make settings. When you use the A–D buttons to
select a bank, the name of that bank will be displayed in
the field immediately above. You can click the but-
ton at the left to edit the name of the bank.
E CLEAR BANK
This button erases the currently selected bank (all
MIDI messages will be deleted).
F MIDI message
From the top, these fields assign MIDI messages to the
ENCODER [ON] keys, encoders, CH [ON] keys, and
faders. Click the to open the MIDI REMOTE
SETUP window, and input the message as hexadeci-
mal values. You can input the following values.
Hint
When you click a hexadecimal value, the region interpreted as
a MIDI message that includes that value will be displayed in
red.
G LEARN
Use this button to assign a received MIDI message to a
controller. When you turn on one of the four LEARN
buttons, the MIDI message received by the PM5D will
be assigned to the corresponding controller. The
LEARN function uses the MIDI messages received at
the input port specified by the MIDI REMOTE OUT-
PUT PORT in the MIDI SETUP screen.
Hint
MIDI messages assigned using the LEARN button can be a
maximum of 16 bytes long (the 17th and subsequent bytes
are discarded). If the message is less than 16 bytes long,
END will be immediately after the last data value.
If a control change is received, the third byte will automati-
cally be replaced by FAD (if the assignment destination is
FADER), ENC (if the assignment destination is ENCODER),
or SW (if the assignment destination is ENCODER ON or
CH ON).
If more than one message is received while a LEARN but-
ton is on, the last message will be used. (If the status byte
was omitted from the last message, the appropriate status
byte will be added.)
H LATCH
If a specific byte is set to “SW” in a message assigned to
an ENCODER [ON] key or CH [ON] key, use the
LATCH button to select one of the following
behaviors.
If the LATCH button is on
The on/off status will change each time you press the
key (Latched). If you press the key from the Off state, a
MIDI message with 7F(H) as the SW value will be
transmitted, and when you press the same key once
again a MIDI message with 00(H) as the SW value will
be transmitted.
If the LATCH button is off
The switch will be on only while you are holding it
down, and will turn off when you release it
(Unlatched). Immediately after you press the key, a
MIDI message with 7F(H) as the SW value will be
transmitted; immediately after you release the key, a
MIDI message with a SW value of 00(H) will be
transmitted.
If a specific byte is set to “ENC” (or “FAD”) in a mes-
sage assigned to an ENCODER [ON] key or a CH
[ON] key, use the LATCH button to select one of the
following behaviors.
If the LATCH button is on
If you press the key from the Off state, a MIDI message
with the current setting of the encoder (or fader) as the
ENC (or FAD) value will be transmitted, and when you
press the same key once again a MIDI message with a
value of 00(H) as the ENC (or FAD) value will be
transmitted.
If the LATCH button is off
The moment you press the key, a MIDI message with
the current setting of the encoder (or fader) as the ENC
(or FAD) value will be transmitted; the moment you
release the key, a MIDI message with 00(H) as the ENC
(or FAD) value will be transmitted.
Note
If SW/ENC/FAD is not specified as the last byte of the MIDI
message, turning the key on or off will transmit the same MIDI
message; i.e., the same message is transmitted when the key
goes off.
Value
Available
Assignments
Content
00(H)–
FF(H)
All
The MIDI message that is trans-
mitted (hexadecimal).
END All
Indicates the end of the MIDI
message. When you operate the
corresponding controller, the
MIDI message from the begin-
ning until immediately before
END will be transmitted.
SW All
Indicates the on/off status of the
encoder [ON] key or the channel
[ON] key. A value of 7F(H) is
transmitted when the key turns
on, and a value of 00(H) is trans-
mitted when the key turns off. If
this is assigned to an ENCODER
or FADER, the current value of
the key will be transmitted when
the encoder or fader is operated.
ENC
ENCODER
ON/
ENCODER
Indicates the current position of
the encoder. If assigned to an
ENCODER, a value of 00–7F(H)
is transmitted when the encoder
is operated. If assigned to an
ENCODER [ON] key, the current
value of the encoder is transmit-
ted when the key is switched on.
FAD
CH ON/
FADER
Indicates the current position of
the fader. If assigned to a
FADER, a value of 00–7F(H) is
transmitted when the fader is
operated. If assigned to a CH
[ON] key, the current value of the
fader is transmitted when the key
is switched on.
45
8
6 7
PM5D/PM5D-RH Owner’s Manual Reference section 177
Information shown
in the display
Function
menu
Global
functions
Output
functions
Input
functions
Appendices
Here you can make settings for GPI (General Purpose
Interface) input/output, used to transfer control signals
between the PM5D and an external device.
A GPI IN port
These are the numbers of the GPI IN ports for which
you can make settings.
B GPI IN status
The yellow bar indicates the input signal voltage state
of the corresponding port. If the bar is not shown, the
signal is in the grounded state; if the bar is displayed to
the right edge, the signal is at the high level state. Use
the POLARITY (
3) field to select whether the signal is
active when low or high.
C POLARITY
This selects how GPI IN on/off will be detected. You
can choose Low Active (active when the key is
grounded) or High Active (active when key is open, or
when a high level signal is input).
D FUNCTION
E PARAMETER
These fields indicate the function that is executed when
the corresponding GPI IN port becomes active (or the
function that is controlled by the voltage value being
input from the GPI IN port), and option parameters
for that function.
To edit the settings, click the button at the left to
open the GPI IN PORT ASSIGN window, and select
the function and parameter from the following table.
GPI screen
GPI
1 2
3 4 5
FUNCTION PARAMETER PM5D operation
NO ASSIGN No assignment
MONITOR
DIMMER ON
Switches the Dimmer
function on/off
SOURCE=
[monitor source
name]
Switches the monitor
source
MONO ON
Switches the monitor sec-
tion [MONO] key on
TALKBACK
ON
LATCH
Switches the Talkback
function on/off (latched
operation)
UNLATCH
Switches the Talkback
function on/off (unlatched
operation)
CH ON-
LATCH
[channel name]
Switches the channel on/
off (latched operation)
CH ON-
UNLATCH
[channel name]
Switches the channel on/
off (unlatched operation)
FADER
LEVEL
[channel name]
Modifies the fader value
(LEVEL parameter)
according to the voltage
SUR-
ROUND PAN
FRONT-REAR
PAN [SEL]
according to the voltage.
LEFT-RIGHT
PAN [SEL]
Modifies the surround pan-
ning (left/right) of the
selected channel accord-
ing to the voltage.
FRONT-REAR
PAN [ODD]
Modifies the surround pan-
ning (front/rear) of the
selected odd-numbered
channel according to the
voltage.
LEFT-RIGHT
PAN [ODD]
Modifies the surround pan-
ning (left/right) of the
selected odd-numbered
channel according to the
voltage.
FRONT-REAR
PAN [EVEN]
Modifies the surround pan-
ning (front/rear) of the
selected even-numbered
channel according to the
voltage.
LEFT-RIGHT
PAN [EVEN]
Modifies the surround pan-
ning (left/right) of the
selected even-numbered
channel according to the
voltage.
USER
DEFINED
KEY FUNC-
TION
[User Defined
key bank / key
number]
While the external input is
active, executes the same
operation as when the
selected User Defined key
is pressed
USER
DEFINED
KEY LED
[User Defined
key bank / key
number]
While the external input is
active, lights the LED of
the selected User Defined
key
PEAK HOLD
ON
Switches the Peak Hold
function on/off
OSCILLA-
TOR ON
Switches the Oscillator on/
off
SOLO ON
Switches the Solo func-
tion on/off
MIDI REMOTE function
178 PM5D/PM5D-RH Owner’s Manual Reference section
GPI IN MONITOR
F GPI IN monitor
The voltage from the GPI IN port selected by the X-
AXIS field (
8) and Y-AXIS field (9) is respectively
indicated by a yellow in the X-axis (horizontal) and
Y-axis (vertical) dimensions of the graph.
The range of voltage variation used to determine the
active/inactive status is shown as a red rectangle.
G CALIBRATION
This button calibrates the range of voltage variation
used by the PM5D to determine active/inactive status,
so that the range will be appropriate for the voltages
being input from the GPI PORT. (For details on using
calibration p.125)
When you turn this button on, the range of voltage
variation will be temporarily cleared; the range will be
updated every time the GPI IN voltage changes. When
you turn this button off, the range of variation will be
memorized, and this range of variation will subse-
quently be used to determine the active/inactive state.
H X-AXIS
I Y-AXIS
These fields select the GPI IN port for which calibra-
tion will be performed. You can click the /
buttons at left and right to change the port.
If you are using a two-dimensional controller such as a
joystick, specify a port for both the X-axis and Y-axis. If
you want to perform calibration for only one direc-
tion, set one of the ports to “-----.”
J REVERSE
This button inverts the low/high level of the input,
changing the displayed direction of the graph. This is
equivalent to switching the POLARITY (3) of the
selected GPI IN port.
GPI OUT
K GPI OUT port
These are the numbers of the GPI OUT ports for which
you can make settings.
L GPI OUT status
This indicates the state of the output signal for the cor-
responding port. The L/H character indicates whether
the signal level is Low (the output level is grounded) or
High (the output level is high). The background color
is yellow when active, and gray when inactive. Use the
POLARITY (
L) field to select whether the signal is
active when low or high.
M POLARITY
Selects the polarity of the signal that is output when the
GPI OUT port becomes active. You can select either
Low Active (grounded when active) or High Active
(high level when active).
N TEST
This button tests the operation of each GPI OUT port.
While this button is on, the corresponding GPI OUT
port will temporarily become active, and a signal will
be output according to the POLARITY (
L) setting.
O FADER START
Indicates the channel of the fader assigned as a trigger
to each GPI OUT port, and the fader mode (trigger
detection method) of that fader.
To edit the settings, click the button at the left to
open the GPI OUT PORT ASSIGN window, and select
the fader mode and channel. You can select the follow-
ing fader modes.
FADER START
A control signal (trigger signal) 250 msec long will be
output when the fader of the selected channel moves
from –60 dB or below to exceed –60 dB.
FADER STOP
A control signal (trigger signal) 250 msec long will be
output when the fader of the selected channel reaches
dB.
FADER TALLY
A control signal will be output when the fader of the
selected channel moves from –60 dB or below to
exceed –60 dB. This control signal will be held until the
fader reaches – dB (or until that GPI OUT port
receives a different trigger).
The setting of the GPI screen’s FADER START field is
linked with the GPI-related settings of the FADER
START screen ( p.179).
8
9
J
7
6
K L
M N O P Q
PM5D/PM5D-RH Owner’s Manual Reference section 179
Information shown
in the display
Function
menu
Global
functions
Output
functions
Input
functions
Appendices
P USER DEFINED KEYS
This area indicates the User Defined keys that are
assigned as triggers to each GPI OUT port, and their
operations.
To edit the setting, click the button at the left to
open the GPI OUT PORT ASSIGN window; from the
list, select the User Defined key bank (A–D) and num-
ber (1–25), and how the trigger signal will be
transmitted. As the transmission method for the trig-
ger signal, you can select either Latch (switch between
active/inactive each time the key is pressed) or Unlatch
(active only while the key is pressed).
Q TALLY
This area indicates the state of other Tally output func-
tions assigned as triggers to each port. When you
execute the corresponding operation on the PM5D, a
control signal will be output from the corresponding
GPI OUT port. This control signal will be held until
you defeat the above operation (or until that GPI OUT
port receives a different trigger).
To edit the settings, click the button at the left to
open the GPI OUT PORT ASSIGN window, and select
one of the following functions.
Here you can make settings for the Fader Start function
which lets you use input channel faders to control GPI
OUT ports or external devices.
A INPUT CH (Input channel)
This area shows the number and name of the channels
(input channels, ST IN channels) for which you can
make settings. When you click a line to select it, that
line will be highlighted in the center of the list.
B OUTPUT TYPE
C PARAMETER
Indicates the type of signal that will be output when
you operate the corresponding fader, and option
parameters for it. To edit the setting, click the but-
ton at the left of the OUTPUT TYPE field to open the
FADER START ASSIGN window. You can select the
following output types and parameters.
NO ASSIGN
No assignment.
GPI
A trigger will be sent to the specified GPI OUT port
according to the fader operation of the corresponding
channel, and a control signal will be output. (The
polarity of the control signal will be as specified by the
settings in the GPI screen.) If this output type is
selected, you can choose from the following two option
parameters.
FADER START . . . GPI OUT port from which the
trigger is sent when the fader
changes from below –60 dB to
exceed –60 dB.
Function PM5D operation
NO ASSIGN No assignment
POWER ON The PM5D’s power is turned on
SOLO ON [SOLO] key is turned on
GPI IN 1 FUNC-
TION
The function assigned to GPI IN port 1
becomes active
GPI IN 2 FUNC-
TION
The function assigned to GPI IN port 2
becomes active
GPI IN 3 FUNC-
TION
The function assigned to GPI IN port 3
becomes active
GPI IN 4 FUNC-
TION
The function assigned to GPI IN port 4
becomes active
PREVIEW ON
SCENE MEMORY section [PREVIEW]
key is turned on
CUE ON [INPUT
ONLY]
Input channel [CUE] key is turned on
CUE ON [DCA
ONLY]
DCA [CUE] key is turned on
CUE ON [OUT-
PUT ONLY]
Output channel [CUE] key is turned on
CUE ON Any [CUE] key is turned on
FADER START screen
FADER START
1 2 3 4
MIDI REMOTE function
180 PM5D/PM5D-RH Owner’s Manual Reference section
FADER STOP . . . . . GPI OUT port from which the
trigger is sent when the fader
reaches – dB.
Note that the GPI-related settings you make in the
FADER START screen are linked with the FADER
START field of the GPI screen.
For example, if in the FADER START screen you spec-
ify different ports for the FADER START parameter
and FADER STOP parameter of a certain channel, the
FADER START field of the GPI screen will be assigned
to the corresponding channel (Fader Mode= FADER
START/FADER STOP) of those ports. (The opposite
also applies.)
If the same port is specified for the FADER START
parameter and the FADER STOP parameter, the GPI
screen FADER START field will be assigned to the
channel corresponding to that port (Fader Mode=
FADER TALLY). (The opposite is also true.)
•MMC
An MMC command will be sent from the currently-
enabled MIDI port according to the fader operation of
the corresponding channel. (The MIDI transmit port is
selected in the MIDI SETUP screen.)
An MMC PLAY command is transmitted when the
fader changes from below –60 dB to –60 dB or higher,
and an MMC STOP command is transmitted when the
fader reaches – dB.
If this output type is selected, you can use an option
parameter to specify the MMC device ID number (1–
127 or ALL).
•RS422
An RS422 protocol command will be sent from the
RS422 REMOTE connector according to the fader
operation of the corresponding channel.
An RS422 protocol PLAY command is transmitted
when the fader changes from below –60 dB to –60 dB
or higher, and an RS422 protocol STOP command is
transmitted when the fader reaches – dB.
D CLEAR ALL
Clears the Output Type field assignments of all
channels.
PM5D/PM5D-RH Owner’s Manual Reference section 181
Information shown
in the display
Function
menu
Global
functions
Output
functions
Input
functions
Appendices
Here you can use MMC/RS422 protocol commands to
remotely control transport/locate operations on a recorder
or other external device from the PM5D.
A MMC DEVICE No.
Indicates the device ID number
of the external device to be con-
trolled via MMC. To change
this setting, click the / but-
tons at left and right to choose
from the range 1–127 or ALL
(applies to all device ID
numbers).
B RS422 DATA FORMAT
Select the format (P2 or
DENON) of the RS422 com-
mands sent from the RS422
REMOTE connector. When you
click this button, a confirma-
tion message will appear.
Note
The RS422 command format you
specify in this screen also applies to
the RS422 commands issued by
the Fader Start function or the User
Defined keys.
Note
DENON format is a set of commands used in devices such as
Denon’s professional CD (DN-C680) and MD (DN-M1050R)
players. On the CD or MD player, set the settings to 9600 bps
and RS422. If you are using DENON format, clicking the
button during Play will enter Pause mode; clicking the
button during Standby will Stop. While stopped, click the
button once again if you want to Standby. Clicking the
button will return to the previous track, and clicking the
button will advance to the next track. Use a D-sub 9-pin
straight cable to connect the REMOTE RS422 connector to
the device you wish to control using P2 or DENON format.
C Transport
These buttons operate the transport of an external
device. When you click a button, the corresponding
MMC/RS422 command (from the left, REWIND,
FAST FORWARD, STOP, PLAY, REC) will be
transmitted.
There is an indicator above each RS422 transport but-
ton; the indicator will light as follows according to the
status of the external device being controlled.
•P2
DENON
TRANSPORT screen
TRANSPORT
1
2
Playing lit
Fast-forwarding lit
Rewinding lit
Stopped lit
Recording and lit
Playing lit
Paused blinking
Standby lit
Stopped All dark
Recording and lit
Recording paused lit, blinking
5 64
3
MIDI REMOTE function
182 PM5D/PM5D-RH Owner’s Manual Reference section
D LOCATE POINT
These buttons correspond to each locate point. Twenty
locate points can be specified for MMC-compatible
devices, and another twenty locate points can be sepa-
rately specified for RS422-compatible devices. When
you click buttons 1–20, an MMC command or RS422
command for moving to that locate point will be
transmitted.
E Time code
This field indicates the time code that is specified for
each locate point. To edit the time code, click the
button located at the left to open the MMC/RS422
LOCATE POINT window, and specify the new time
code in hours/minutes/seconds/frames. (In the case of
DENON format, use track/minute/second/frame units
to specify the value.) You can also use the CAPTURE
button located at the right to capture the time code
being received by the PM5D.
F CAPTURE
This button captures the time code currently being
received by the PM5D, and inputs it in the time code
field. In the case of MMC, the time code source, frame
rate, and offset time can be specified in the EVENT
LIST screen (SCENE function). ( p.161) In the case
of RS422, the time data at that moment for the exter-
nal device being controlled will be captured.
Here you can remotely control various functions of a
Yamaha DME series digital mixing engine.
Hint
As of this writing (August 2004), this function can be used with
the DME series models DME64N and DME24N. (This func-
tion cannot be used with the DME32.)
A Component type selection area
Here you can select the type of DME series component
that you want to control from the PM5D. When you
click the / buttons at the left and right to select the
type of component, the display in the central area of
the screen will change accordingly. The following types
of component can be selected.
SETUP
Select the port connecting the PM5D and the DME
series unit, and initiate or terminate communication.
GEQ
Control the DME series unit’s graphic EQ from the
PM5D.
PEQ
Control the DME series unit’s parametric EQ from the
PM5D.
CROSS OVER
An internal signal within the DME series unit is divided
into six bands, and the output level, filter slope and
type, and cutoff frequency etc. can be controlled for
each band. This screen also lets you specify the cross-
over frequency at which the bands are divided.
LONG DELAY
SHORT DELAY
Control the long delay and short delay functions of the
DME series unit from the PM5D.
MATRIX
Specify the level of the signals sent from a specific input
of the DME series unit to all outputs, or from all inputs
to a specific output.
SLOT OUTPUT
For each slot of the DME series unit, specify the out-
put level, delay time, and phase setting of each port.
B Component selection area
From the type of component you selected in 1, select
the component that you want to control.
DME CONTROL screen
5
6
3 41 2
PM5D/PM5D-RH Owner’s Manual Reference section 183
Information shown
in the display
Function
menu
Global
functions
Output
functions
Input
functions
Appendices
C SCENE
This area indicates/selects the scene that will be stored/
recalled on the DME series unit. When you click the /
buttons located at left and right to select a number,
the name of that scene is shown in the field at right.
D STORE/RECALL
These buttons save (overwrite) the settings of the DME
series unit edited in the PM5D’s screen into the scene
selected in the SCENE area, or recall the scene selected
in the SCENE area into the DME.
Note
When storing a DME scene from the PM5D’s screen, you
can only store by overwriting an existing scene on the DME;
you cannot store the settings as a new scene or edit the
scene name.
If SETUP is selected, items
3
,
4
, and
6
are not shown.
E Parameter display area
This area displays the parameters of the currently
selected component. The displayed contents will
depend on the component.
F ASSIGN TO FADERS (DCA fader
assignments)
You can use DCA faders 1–8 to control the parameters
of the component currently shown in the screen.
Note
The parameters that can be assigned to DCA faders will
depend on the component. This function may not be available
for some components.
Connecting the PM5D with a DME
series unit
Various methods for connecting the PM5D with a DME
series unit to transmit and receive audio signals and con-
trol signals are shown below.
Note
If characters other than alphabetical characters and symbols
(e.g., double-byte characters such as Japanese) are used on
the DME series unit in a component name or scene name,
such characters may not be displayed correctly.
1 Bi-directional connection via CobraNet
This connection method uses CobraNet (a format for
transmitting multi-channel audio signals and control sig-
nals over Ethernet). Install an MY16-C CobraNet format
compliant digital I/O card in a slot on both the PM5D and
the DME series unit, and use an Ethernet cable to connect
the two MY16-C cards. This method allows bi-directional
transfer of audio signals over a single cable. For example,
signals can be sent via the PM5D’s MIX bus to the DME
for processing, and then returned to a PM5D input
channel.
2 Bi-directional connection using the CASCADE IN/
OUT connectors (DME64N only)
In this connection method, the CASCADE IN connector
and CASCADE OUT connector of the PM5D and the
DME64N are connected to each other, allowing bi-direc-
tional transfer of audio signals. Since the DME24N does
not have CASCADE IN/OUT connectors, it cannot use this
method.
3 Uni-directional connection using the CASCADE IN/
OUT connectors — 1 (DME64N only)
This method is a uni-directional connection that sends
audio signals from the DME64N to the PM5D via its CAS-
CADE IN connector.
4 Uni-directional connection using the CASCADE IN/
OUT connectors — 2 (DME64N only)
This method is a uni-directional connection that sends
audio signals from the PM5D via its CASCADE OUT con-
nector to the DME64N.
Note
When using the CASCADE IN/OUT connectors to make con-
nections, the CASCADE IN/OUT connectors are used as the
connectors, but the settings will be the same as when using
slot input/output. In the CASCADE CONNECTION area of the
MIXER SETUP screen (SYS/W.CLOCK function), you will
need to make settings so that the CASCADE IN connector is
assigned to the SLOT IN port (if using the CASCADE IN con-
nector) or the SLOT OUT port is assigned to the CASCADE
OUT connector (if using the CASCADE OUT connector).
Hint
If desired, you can control the DME series unit from the PM5D
without transmitting or received audio signals. In this case,
simply make one of the connections shown in examples
2
4
; control signals will be sent from the PM5D to the DME.
DME64N
DME24N
PM5D
MY16-CMY16-C
SlotSlot
DME64N
PM5D
CASCADE
OUT connector
CASCADE
OUT connector
CASCADE
IN connector
CASCADE
IN connector
DME64N
PM5D
CASCADE
IN connector
CASCADE
OUT connector
DME64N
PM5D
CASCADE
OUT connector
CASCADE
IN connector
MIDI REMOTE function
184 PM5D/PM5D-RH Owner’s Manual Reference section
Initiating communication between the
PM5D and the DME series unit
To select the port used for audio signal transmission/recep-
tion between the PM5D and the DME series unit, and to
initiate communication, proceed as follows.
1
Connect the PM5D and the DME series unit.
2
In the DISPLAY ACCESS section, press the
[MIDI/REMOTE] key several times to access the
DME CONTROL screen.
3
In the component selection area at the upper
left of the screen, select SETUP.
A screen like the following will appear.
The SETUP screen contains the following items.
A CONNECT
This button initiates or terminates the connection
between the PM5D and the DME series unit.
B MIDI PGM CHANGE (MIDI program
change)
If this button is on, a program change message will be
transmitted to the DME via the I/O card (MY16-C) or
via the CASCADE IN/OUT connectors when a scene is
recalled on the PM5D. This allows scenes to be recalled
on the DME in tandem with scene recall operations on
the PM5D.
C INPUT PORT
Here you can select the PM5D port that will receive
audio signals from the DME.
D MONITOR PORT
Here you can select the PM5D port that will receive
monitor signals from the DME. Since this monitor sig-
nal is sent to the PM5D’s CUE bus, the DME’s monitor
function can be controlled from the PM5D just like the
PM5D’s own cue function (EXTERNAL CUE
function).
E MIXER SETUP (show the MIXER SETUP
screen)
This button displays the SYS/W.CLOCK function
MIXER SETUP screen.
F OUTPUT PORT
Here you can select the PM5D port that will output
audio signals to the DME.
4
In the INPUT PORT area
located at the lower left
of the screen, select the
PM5D port that will
receive audio signals from
the DME series unit.
The types of port that can be
selected here will depend on
the port that is currently selected for cascade input
(MIXER SETUP screen CASCADE IN PORT SELECT
field), as follows.
Note
You cannot switch the cascade input port setting from the
DME CONTROL screen. If necessary, click the MIXER
SETUP button to access the MIXER SETUP screen (SYS/
W.CLOCK function), and change the port you will use for cas-
cade input.
5
In the MONITOR PORT field, select the PM5D
port that will receive monitor signals from the
DME series unit.
The following ports can be selected.
---- . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .No assignment
SLOT1-1–SLOT4-16 . . .The desired port of slot 1–4
CASCADE 1–32 . . . . . . .CASCADE IN ports 1–32
6
In the OUTPUT PORT field
located in the lower right
of the screen, select the
PM5D port that will trans-
mit audio signals to the
DME.
The types of port that can be
selected here will depend on
the port that is currently selected for cascade output
(MIXER SETUP screen CASCADE OUT PORT
SELECT field), as follows.
Note
You cannot switch the cascade output port setting from the
DME CONTROL screen. If necessary, click the MIXER
SETUP button to access the MIXER SETUP screen (SYS/
W.CLOCK function), and change the port you will use for cas-
cade output.
5
1
4 6
2
3
Setting in the CAS-
CADE IN PORT
SELECT field (MIXER
SETUP screen)
Items available in the INPUT
PORT field
CASCADE IN ----, SLOT1–SLOT4
SLOT4 ----, CASCADE IN, SLOT1–SLOT3
SLOT3/4 ----, CASCADE IN, SLOT1–SLOT2
SLOT1-4 [CH1-8] ----, CASCADE IN
SLOT1-4 [CH9-16] ----, CASCADE IN
Setting in the CAS-
CADE OUT PORT
SELECT field (MIXER
SETUP screen)
Items available in the OUTPUT
PORT field
CASCADE OUT ----, SLOT1–SLOT4
SLOT3/4
----, SLOT1–SLOT4, CASCADE
OUT
SLOT1-4 [CH1-8]
SLOT1-4 [CH9-16]
PM5D/PM5D-RH Owner’s Manual Reference section 185
Information shown
in the display
Function
menu
Global
functions
Output
functions
Input
functions
Appendices
7
If you want scene changes on the PM5D to be
linked with scene changes on the DME series
unit, turn on the MIDI PGM CHANGE button
in the center of the screen.
If the MIDI PGM CHANGE button is on, switching
the scene on the PM5D will cause a program change
message of a number corresponding to that scene to be
sent to the DME.
Hint
The above program change message is always transmitted
via the MY16-C card or the CASCADE IN/OUT connector.
This is not affected by MIDI PGM CHANGE or by the MIDI
program change transmission port or transmission on/off
setting selected in the MIDI SETUP screen.
The program number assignment for each scene can be
specified in the MIDI PGM CHANGE screen.
8
To initiate communication between the PM5D
and the DME series unit, click the CONNECT
button to turn it on.
While the CONNECT button is on, parameter opera-
tions and scene store/recall operations on the DME can
be remotely controlled from the PM5D. To terminate
communication, click the CONNECT button once
again to turn it off.
Controlling DME parameters
Here’s how the parameters of the DME series unit can be
controlled from the PM5D. If desired, the changes you
make can be saved in the scene of the DME series unit.
1
In the DME CONTROL screen, choose SETUP,
and turn on the CONNECT button to initiate
communication.
2
In the upper left of the screen, use the compo-
nent type / component selection areas to
select the component you want to control.
If a component other than SETUP is selected, internal
parameters of the DME can be controlled from the
PM5D screen. The following illustration is an example
of when the SLOT OUTPUT component is selected.
3
Use the knobs, sliders, and buttons in the
screen to control the parameters of the DME
series unit.
Knob, slider, and button operation methods are the
same as for the PM5D’s internal parameters. For details
on the parameters that can be operated for each com-
ponent, refer to the owner’s manual of the DME series
unit.
4
If you want to use DCA faders 1–8 to control
the parameters of the component, click an A–F
button in the ASSIGN TO FADERS area.
When you click a button A–F, the corresponding
parameters will be assigned to DCA faders 1–8, and can
be controlled by the faders. To return to the previous
state, click the DCA button.
Hint
As an alternative to clicking the A–F buttons, you can obtain
the same result by holding down the top panel [SHIFT] key
and pressing the [A]–[F] keys of the FADER MODE section.
5
If you want to store your changes in a scene of
the DME series unit, use the SCENE field in the
upper right of the screen to select the store-
destination, and click the STORE button.
The edited settings will be stored as a scene in the
DME. To recall this scene, use the SCENE field in the
upper right of the screen to select the scene, and click
the RECALL button.
Note
When storing a DME scene from the PM5D’s screen, you can
only store by overwriting an existing scene on the DME; you
cannot store the settings as a new scene or edit the scene
name.
UTILITY function
186 PM5D/PM5D-RH Owner’s Manual Reference section
UTILITY function
Preference settings for the PM5D are divided into two
screens.
A STORE/RECALL
These buttons let you turn on/off options related to
scene store/recall operations. You can select the follow-
ing options.
AUTO STORE
Turns the Auto Store function on/off. If this button is
on, pressing the [STORE] button (SCENE MEMORY
section) of the panel twice in succession will store the
current scene in the currently selected scene number.
LINKED LIBRARY PROTECTION
If this button is on, you will be unable to overwrite or
delete library items that are linked to a protected scene.
This option prevents a protected scene from being
modified by having an associated library item edited.
USE NUMERIC-KEYPAD
If this button is on, the numeric keypad of a PS/2 key-
board connected to the KEYBOARD connector (or a
numeric keypad connected to the KEYBOARD con-
nector) can be used to specify the scene number
directly.
STORE CONFIRMATION
RECALL CONFIRMATION
If these buttons are on, a confirmation message will
appear when you perform a Store or Recall operation
respectively.
B PATCH
These buttons let you turn on/off options related to
patch operations. You can select the following options.
PATCH CONFIRMATION
If this button is on, a confirmation message will appear
when you edit an input patch or output patch.
STEAL PATCH CONFIRMATION
If this button is on, a confirmation message will appear
when you edit an input patch or output patch item that
is already patched.
C GATE/COMP (Gate / Compressor)
These buttons let you turn on/off options related to
gating and compression.
GR METER ON/OFF LINK
If this button is on, the GR meter will not show the
reduction amount for gates/compressors that are cur-
rently off.
D METER SECTION
Here you can set the following meter-related options.
FOLLOW INPUT LAYER
This option lets you specify how the [CH 1-24]/[CH
25-48] keys (INPUT channel strip) and [STIN 1-4]/
[FXRTN 1-4] keys will select the layer that is shown by
the meters in the center of the panel and the meters in
the upper right of the panel. Click the / buttons at
left and right to make your choice.
OFF . . . . . . . . Operating the [CH 1-24]/[CH 25-48]
keys will not affect the content shown
by the meters in the center of the
panel. Pressing the [STIN 1-4]/
[FXRTN 1-4] keys will not affect the
content shown by the meters in the
upper right of the panel.
SAME . . . . . . . When you press the [CH 1-24] or
[CH 25-48] key, the corresponding
layer will be shown by the meters in
the center of the panel (if an input
channel is selected in the meter sec-
tion). When you press the [STIN 1-4]
or [FXRTN 1-4] key, the correspond-
ing layer will be shown by the meters
in the upper right of the panel.
PREFERENCE 1/2 screens
P
REFERENCE 1
PREFERENCE 2
1
2
4
3
PM5D/PM5D-RH Owner’s Manual Reference section 187
Information shown
in the display
Function
menu
Global
functions
Output
functions
Input
functions
Appendices
ALTERNATIVE . . . When you press the [CH 1-24]
or [CH 25-48] key, the opposite
layer will be shown by the
meters in the center of the panel
(if an input channel is selected
in the meter section). When you
press the [STIN 1-4] or
[FXRTN 1-4] key, the opposite
layer will be shown by the
meters in the upper right of the
panel.
Note
If this is set to SAME or ALTERNATIVE, the meters in the
center of the panel and the meters in the upper right can be
switched independently.
If the selected layer is switched from the panel, the layer
shown by the meters will also change. However if you switch
the METER SECTION field in the constantly-displayed area
in the upper part of the screen, the layer selected on the
panel will not change.
FOLLOW MIX MASTER MODE
If this button is on, pressing the MIX section [MIX
MASTER] key will cause the meters in the center of the
panel and the meters in the upper right of the panel to
show the MIX/MATRIX channel levels. Press the MIX
section [MIX SEND] key to return to the original input
channel level display.
E PANEL OPERATION
Here you can set the following options for panel
operation.
AUTO CHANNEL SELECT
This specifies whether the corresponding channel will
be selected when you operate a channel’s [ON] key,
fader, or encoder. INPUT CH (input channels) and
OUTPUT CH (output channels) can be turned on/off
separately.
AUTO DISPLAY
For each of the following items, you can individually
specify whether the related screen will automatically
appear when you use the SELECTED CHANNEL sec-
tion to operate a specific parameter. The following
table shows the parameters corresponding to each but-
ton and the screen that will appear.
MAKE PAIR ON PANEL
If this button is on, you can use the [SEL] keys to set/
defeat pairing. In Horizontal Pair mode, you can set/
defeat pairing by simultaneously pressing the [SEL]
keys of two pairable channels. In Vertical Pair mode,
you can set/defeat pairing by holding down the
[SHIFT] key and pressing the [SEL] key of one of the
channels. (For more about pair modes p.45)
DCA/MUTE FLASH INDICATE
If this button is on, the DCA [MUTE] key LED and the
DCA assign LED for channels belonging to that DCA
group will blink when you turn on a DCA [MUTE] key
(DCA section).
MIX MINUS CONFIRMATION
If this button is on, a confirmation message will appear
when you execute the Mix Minus setting (hold down
the [SEL] key of an input channel and press the [SEL]
key of a MIX channel) from the panel.
SCENE UP/DOWN KEY
This specifies what the SCENE MEMORY [π]/[]
keys will do when pressed in the SCENE screen. You
can choose one of the following two operations.
SCENE +1/–1 . . . . . Pressing the SCENE MEMORY
[π] key will select the next
highest-numbered scene, and
pressing the SCENE MEMORY
[] key will select the next low-
est-numbered scene. (Key
presses will increment/decre-
ment the scene number.)
5 6 7
Button name
Corresponding
parameters
Screen that appears
HA
Input channel head
amp gain
INPUT HA/INSERT
function screens
PHASE/ATT
Input channel
phase/attenuator
INPUT EQ function ø/
ATT screen
EQUALIZER
EQ-related param-
eters
INPUT EQ/OUTPUT
EQ function EQ
PARAM screen
DYNAMICS
Gate/compressor-
related parameters
INPUT GATE/COMP
function or OUTPUT
COMP function GATE
PARAM or COMP
PARAM screen
DELAY
Delay-related
parameters
INPUT DELAY/OUT-
PUT DELAY function
screens
DCA/MUTE/
SAFE
DCA group / Mute
group / Recall safe-
related parameters
INPUT DCA/GROUP
function or OUTPUT
DCA/GROUP func-
tion DCA GROUP
ASSIGN, MUTE
GROUP ASSIGN or
RECALL SAFE
screen
TO MIX/STE-
REO
TO MIX/TO STE-
REO-related
parameters
PAN/ROUTING func-
tion CH to MIX screen
or SURR PARAM
screen, or MATRIX/ST
function MATRIX/ST
ROUTING screen
TO MATRIX
Send level to
MATRIX bus
MATRIX/ST function
MATRIX/ST ROUT-
ING screen
OUTPUT
MASTER
MIX/MATRIX chan-
nel output level
OUTPUT VIEW func-
tion FADER VIEW
screen
UTILITY function
188 PM5D/PM5D-RH Owner’s Manual Reference section
LIST UP/DOWN . . Pressing the SCENE MEMORY
[π] key will scroll the list
upward, and pressing the
SCENE MEMORY [] key will
scroll the list downward.
(Key presses will scroll the list
upward/downward.)
LIST ORDER
This specifies the order in which scene memories and
library items will appear in the screen.
NORMAL . . . . . . . . Show the list in ascending
numerical order.
REVERSE . . . . . . . . Show the list in descending
numerical order.
F INTERNAL CLOCK
This indicates the date (DATE) and time (TIME) of the
internal clock. To edit the setting, click the SET button.
G BATTERY
This indicates the voltage of the internal battery.
PREFERENCE screen 2
H BRIGHTNESS
Here you can make settings for the brightness of the
panel LED and LCD displays.
PANEL UNITY POINT
If this button is on, LEDs corresponding to a specific
reference value (e.g., 0 dB or CENTER) will light more
brightly than usual. However, this is valid only if
PANEL BRIGHTNESS is set to 5 or less.
PANEL ASSISTANCE
If this button is on, even LEDs that should be off will
stay dimly lit so that you can tell their location even in
a dark environment. However, this is valid only if
PANEL BRIGHTNESS is set to 5 or less.
PANEL BRIGHTNESS
This adjusts the brightness of all panel LEDs in a range
of 1–8.
LCD BRIGHTNESS
You can adjust the brightness of the LCD display in a
three-step range: HIGH, MID, or LOW.
LCD BACK LIGHT
You can adjust the brightness of the LCD display back-
light in a two-step range: HIGH or LOW.
I TRACK PAD/MOUSE
Here you can make settings for the built-in track pad
or a PS/2 mouse connected to the MOUSE connector.
TRACK PAD TAPPING
This enables/disables the Tapping function (a function
that lets you perform the track pad left-click operation
by tapping quickly on the track pad).
MOVING SPEED
This selects the speed at which the cursor in the screen
will move when you operate the built-in track pad or a
PS/2 mouse connected to the MOUSE connector.
Choose one of three speeds; FAST, MID, or SLOW.
J SCREEN TIPS
SHOW SCREEN TIPS
If this button is on, moving the cursor onto an item in
the screen and waiting for a short time will (in some
cases) display a “screen tip” reminding you of the oper-
ation. The screen tip is displayed when you open the
JOB SELECT window by holding down the [SHIFT]
key and pressing the [ENTER] key, or when you need
to press the [ENTER] key to finalize an edited value.
K UPPER PART DISPLAY
These buttons select the item that is shown in the cen-
ter right (to the right of the scene memory indication)
of the upper part of the display (the constantly dis-
played area).
PRESENT TIME
Indicates the present time.
TIME CODE
Indicates the internal time code being generated by the
PM5D, or the time code being received from an exter-
nal device. This is the same as the time code shown in
the SCENE function EVENT LIST screen.
CASCADE/Fs
Indicates the master/slave status when using a cascade
connection, and the sampling frequency at which the
PM5D system is currently operating.
Hint
You can also cycle through these choices by clicking in this
display section.
L NAME DISPLAY ([NAME] indicator display)
Choose one of the following as the content that will be
shown by the [NAME] indicators of the INPUT chan-
nel strip and DCA strip.
8
9
J
K
L
M
PM5D/PM5D-RH Owner’s Manual Reference section 189
Information shown
in the display
Function
menu
Global
functions
Output
functions
Input
functions
Appendices
NAME
The indicators will show the names assigned to the
input channels / DCA groups in the NAME screen
(INPUT PATCH function). ( p.257)
PORT
For input channels, the indicators will show the name
of the currently assigned port. For DCA groups, the
indicators will show the ID number.
•ID
For both input channels and DCA groups, the indica-
tors will show the fixed ID number.
M WARNING DISPLAY
Here you can select whether a warning will be dis-
played when the following problems occur.
TIME CODE DROP
When time code (LTC, MTC) being received from an
external device is dropped.
DIGITAL I/O ERROR
When a DIO error is detected.
MIDI I/O ERROR
When a MIDI error is detected.
Here you can assign functions to the User Defined keys
(USER DEFINED [1]–[25] keys).
A BANK
Select a bank A–D (groups of functions assigned to the
User Defined keys).
B CLEAR BANK
Clears the currently selected bank.
C List
This area lists the functions and option parameters
assigned to the User Defined keys in the currently
selected bank.
To edit the settings, click the button at the left to
open the USER DEFINED KEY ASSIGN window, and
select the function and parameter from the following
table.
USER DEFINE screen
USER DEFINE
2
31
UTILITY function
190 PM5D/PM5D-RH Owner’s Manual Reference section
FUNCTION PARAMETER 1 PARAMETER 2 Explanation
NO ASSIGN No assignment
SCENE
INC RECALL Recall the scene of the next existing number.
DEC RECALL Recall the scene of the previous existing number.
DIRECT RECALL SCENE #000–#500 Directly recall the scene of the specified number
EVENT LIST
TIME CODE [RTN TO
START]
The same functions as the RETURN TO START TIME,
STOP, and PLAY buttons displayed when INTERNAL is
selected as the time code source in the EVENT LIST screen
TIME CODE [STOP]
TIME CODE [PLAY]
TIME CODE [INSERT]
The same function as the TIME CODE INSERT button in the
EVENT LIST screen
AUTO CAPTURE ON
The same function as the AUTO CAPTURE button in the
EVENT LIST screen
DIRECT EVENT RECALL EVENT #000–#999
Recall the specified event registered in the EVENT LIST
screen
NEXT EVENT RECALL
Recall the next-numbered event
PREV EVENT RECALL Recall the previous-numbered event
ENABLE/DISABLE
Switch the ENABLE button and DISABLE button in the
EVENT LIST screen
ENABLE [ALL MANUAL]/DIS-
ABLE
Switch the ENABLE [ALL MANUAL] button and DISABLE
button in the EVENT LIST screen
EFFECT LIBRARY
DIRECT RECALL EFFECT
1–8
INC RECALL Recall the next-numbered library item into effect 1–8
DEC RECALL Recall the previous-numbered library item into effect 1–8
LIBRARY #001–#199 Recall the library item of the specified number into effect 1–8
EFFECT BYPASS EFFECT 1–EFFECT 8 BYPASS ON Bypass the specified effect
INPUT CH LIBRARY
DIRECT RECALL
LIBRARY #000–#199
Recall the library item of the specified number into the
selected channel/GEQ module
OUTPUT CH
LIBRARY
GATE LIBRARY
LIBRARY #001–#199
COMP LIBRARY
INPUT EQ LIBRARY
OUTPUT EQ
LIBRARY
INPUT PATCH
LIBRARY
LIBRARY #00–#99
OUTPUT PATCH
LIBRARY
HA LIBRARY
LIBRARY #000–#199
GEQ LIBRARY
DIRECT RECALL GEQ 1–
12
TRACKING RECALL
ENABLE/DISABLE
The same function as the ENABLE/DISABLE button in the
TRACKING RECALL screen
OFFSET LOCK
The same function as the OFFSET LOCK button in the
TRACKING RECALL screen
SELECTED CH ON
Switch the Tracking Recall function on/off for the currently
selected channel
TALKBACK ASSIGN
SELECTED CH ASSIGN
When an output channel is selected, turn talkback transmis-
sion on/off for that channel
DIRECT ASSIGN
MIX 1–24, MATRIX 1–8,
STEREO A L/R, STE-
REO B L/R
Send the talkback signal to the specified output channel
MONITOR
DIRECT ASSIGN MIX 1–24, MATRIX 1–8 Monitor the desired MIX/MATRIX channel
*1
DIMMER ON Switch on the monitor dimmer function
TAP TEMPO
CURRENT PAGE
Control the Tap Tempo function in the displayed screen
EFFECT 1–EFFECT 8 Control the Tap Tempo function of the specified effect
SURROUND PAN GRAB
SELECTED CH, ODD
CH, EVEN CH
Use a joystick assigned to GPI to begin controlling the sur-
round pan of the corresponding channel
NAME DISPLAY
NAME PORT ID
Each time you press the key, the [NAME] indicator for each
fader will cycle through the channel name port name ID
(channel number)
ID
UNLATCH
The [NAME] indicator for each fader will show the ID (chan-
nel number) only while you hold down the key
PORT
The [NAME] indicator for each fader will show the port name
only while you hold down the key
NAME
The [NAME] indicator for each fader will show the channel
name only while you hold down the key
PM5D/PM5D-RH Owner’s Manual Reference section 191
Information shown
in the display
Function
menu
Global
functions
Output
functions
Input
functions
Appendices
Note
During PREVIEW mode, the following USER DEFINE functions that affect internal signal processing are disabled;
EVENT LIST, TALKBACK ASSIGN, MONITOR, MIDI DIRECT OUT, MACHINE CONTROL, and GPI OUT CONTROL.
PAGE CHANGE
PAGE BACK
Display the screen that you used immediately prior to the
current screen
PAGE FORWARD
Display the screen that you used immediately after the cur-
rent screen
PAGE BOOKMARK
Memorize the currently selected screen (hold down the key
for two seconds or longer), or display the last-memorized
screen (press and release the key within two seconds)
*2
GEQ PARAM PAGE GEQ 1–12 Display the GEQ PARAM screen
EFFECT PARAM PAGE EFFECT 1–8 Display the EFFECT PARAM screen
LAYER SNAPSHOT
Memorize the state of the layer assigned to the panel (hold
down the key for two seconds or longer), or display the last-
memorized layer (press and release the key within two sec-
onds)
*3
DIRECT RECALL/
MUTE MASTER
MODE CHANGE
LATCH
Switch the function of the SCENE MEMORY [1]–[8] keys
(DIRECT RECALL / MUTE MASTER) each time you press
the User Defined key
UNLATCH
The SCENE MEMORY [1]–[8] keys will function as DIRECT
RECALL while you hold down the User Defined key
USER DEFINED KEY
BANK
NEXT BANK
Switch to the next bank of User Defined key assignments
PREVIOUS BANK
Switch to the previous bank of User Defined key assign-
ments
DIRECT SELECT BANK A–D Switch to the desired bank of User Defined key assignments
MIDI DIRECT OUT
MIDI NOTE C-2–G 8
When you press the key, transmit a note-on message with
the specified note number and a velocity of 127 When you
release the key, transmit a note-on message of the same
note number with a velocity of 0 (= note-off)
*4
MIDI PGM CHANGE 1–128
When you press the key, transmit a program change mes-
sage with the specified number
*4
MIDI CTRL CHANGE 0–119
When you press the key, transmit a control change message
with the specified control number and a value of 127 When
you release the key, transmit a control change message of
the same control number with a value of 0
*4
MACHINE CONTROL
SET LOCATION, RS-422
REC, RS-422 PLAY, RS-422
STOP, RS-422 FF, RS-422
REW, RS-422 LOCATE 1–20
Transmit the specified RS422/MMC command from the
RS422 REMOTE connector or the currently-valid MIDI port
(the SET LOCATION command is common to RS422 and
MMC)
MMC REC, MMC PLAY, MMC
STOP, MMC FF, MMC REW,
MMC LOCATE 1–20
MMC ID= 1–127, ALL
GPI OUT CONTROL PORT 1–12
LATCH
Switch the specified GPI OUT port between active/inactive
each time you press the key
UNLATCH
Switch the specified GPI OUT port to inactive while you hold
down the key
PM5D EDITOR CON-
TROL
*5 *5
Switch windows in PM5D Editor on a PC
*1. The corresponding channel will be selected in the DEFINE field of the MONITOR screen, and the monitor source will switch to
DEFINE.
*2. The LED will light for User Defined keys for which a screen has been memorized. The column in the right of the list in the USER
DEFINE screen shows the name of the memorized screen.
*3. Layers that can be memorized include the following items.
- The layer selected in the INPUT channel strip (CH 1-24, CH 25-48, MIDI REMOTE)
- The layer selected in the ST IN/FX RTN channel strip (ST IN 1-4, FX RTN 1-4, MIDI REMOTE)
- The layer shown by the DCA channel strip (DCA, A–F, GEQ)
- If the DCA channel strip is controlling GEQ, the GEQ module number and band
- The encoder mode selected by ENCODER MODE (SEND, PAN, HA, ATT, ALT)
- The FADER FLIP status
- The currently selected MIX send
- The mode selected in the MIX section (MIX SEND, MIX MASTER)
- The source selected in the METER section (CH 1-24 ST IN, CH 25-48 ST IN, MIX/MATRIX)
*4. The output port and MIDI channel can be specified in the MIDI SETUP screen.
*5. This parameter specifies the PM5D Editor window that you want to control. If the specified window is closed or inactive, the window
will be opened and made active. If the specified window is already open and active, the window will be closed. This function can be
selected if the system software supports PM5D Editor. For details on the most recent system software version, refer to the website.
http://www.yamahaproaudio.com
FUNCTION PARAMETER 1 PARAMETER 2 Explanation
UTILITY function
192 PM5D/PM5D-RH Owner’s Manual Reference section
Here you can save PM5D scenes and library data on a
memory card inserted in the MEMORY CARD slot. This
cannot be used while in PREVIEW mode.
A MODE
Choose one of the following as the mode in which files
will be saved: BASIC, ADVANCED, CSV EXPORT.
The left side of the screen will change according to the
mode you select.
BASIC mode
In BASIC mode you can save all scene memory and library
data (or just a selected portion of data) to a card. If BASIC
is selected, the left side of the screen will show the items
listed in the following table.
B Select the items to save
Choose one of the following to specify the data that will
be saved.
If the SCENE MEMORY, HA, INPUT PATCH, or
OUTPUT PATCH button is on, you can use the box at
the right to specify the starting number and ending
number of the scenes or library items that will be saved.
Hint
If the specified range of numbers includes empty scenes or
library items, the correspondingly-numbered scenes or library
items will be empty when that data is loaded.
C TOTAL SIZE
Indicates the file size of the currently selected item(s)
(common to all modes).
SAVE screen
SAVE
1
2
3
BASIC button
Button Content
ALL DATA
All items of each type, and the con-
tents of the current scene
SCENE MEMORY Contents of scene memory
LINKED LIBRARY
Libraries linked to the scene (avail-
able only if the SCENE MEMORY
button is on)
HA Contents of the HA library
INPUT PATCH Contents of the input patch library
OUTPUT PATCH Contents of the output patch library
INPUT CH Contents of the input channel library
OUTPUT CH Contents of the output channel library
INPUT EQ Contents of the input EQ library
OUTPUT EQ Contents of the output EQ library
GATE Contents of the gate library
COMP Contents of the compressor library
EFFECT Contents of the effect library
GEQ Contents of the GEQ library
SETUP Various settings not saved in a scene
USER DEFINED
KEY
User Defined key settings
DCA FADER MODE Fader mode settings
MIDI REMOTE MIDI remote settings
MIDI PGM TABLE
Contents of the list in the MIDI PGM
CHANGE screen
MIDI CTRL TABLE
Contents of the list in the MIDI CTRL
CHANGE screen
EVENT LIST
Contents of the list in the EVENT
LIST screen
Starting number Ending number
PM5D/PM5D-RH Owner’s Manual Reference section 193
Information shown
in the display
Function
menu
Global
functions
Output
functions
Input
functions
Appendices
ADVANCED mode
In this mode you can select either scene memory or a
library, specify a starting number and ending number, and
save the specified range of data on a card. If desired, you
can also specify that the starting number be shifted for-
ward or backward when the data is saved. If ADVANCED
is selected, the left side of the screen will show the follow-
ing items.
D CATEGORY
Indicates the category of data that is selected for sav-
ing; scene memories or library data. Click the /
buttons at left and right to change the category.
E SOURCE (save-source numbers)
This area shows the starting and ending number (and
the corresponding scene names or library titles) of the
scene memories or library items that will be saved on
the card. Click the / buttons at the left and right of
each box to change the number.
F DESTINATION (save-destination number)
This area shows the starting and ending number (and
the corresponding scene names or library titles) with
which the data will be saved on the card. If you want to
save the data to the card with a different range of num-
bers, click the / buttons at the left and right of the
starting number box. (The value in the ending number
box will change automatically as the starting number is
edited.)
CSV EXPORT mode
In this mode you can select items such as scene memory or
library titles, or channel names, and write them to a card as
a separate CSV format file for each item. If CSV EXPORT
is selected, the left side of the screen will show the items
listed in the following table.
G LIBRARY TITLE
H CHANNEL NAME
From the following table, select the parameters that will
be written (e.g., library title, channel name).
Hint
Files saved in CSV format can be edited using a word proces-
sor or spreadsheet software on a computer, and loaded back
into the PM5D. However be aware that it will not be possible
to reload the file back into the PM5D if you change the syn-
tax, file format, or file name.
4
5
6
ADVANCED button
PM
5
D
011
012
013
014
015
AAA
BBB
CCC
DDD
EEE
001
002
003
004
005
006
AAA
BBB
CCC
DDD
EEE
FFF
Memory card
Starting
number
Ending
number
Button Content
LIBRARY
TITLE
SCENE MEMORY Scene memory names
HA HA library titles
INPUT PATCH Input patch library titles
OUTPUT PATCH Output patch library titles
INPUT CH
Input channel library
titles
OUTPUT CH
Output channel library
titles
INPUT EQ Input EQ library titles
OUTPUT EQ Output EQ library titles
GATE Gate library titles
COMP Compressor library titles
EFFECT Effect library titles
GEQ GEQ library titles
CHANNEL
NAME
INPUT 1-48 Input channel names
ST IN ST IN channel names
FX RTN FX RTN channel names
DCA DCA names
PATCH
INPUT PATCH
Input patch connection
status
OUTPUT PATCH
Output patch connection
status
8
9
J
7
CSV EXPORT button
UTILITY function
194 PM5D/PM5D-RH Owner’s Manual Reference section
If you use Microsoft Excel to edit these files, use the Data
menu to import the CSV file, and use the Text File Wizard to
delete the character string quotation ("). (If you fail to do so,
symbols such as “–” and “+” will not be displayed correctly.)
I SET ALL
Selects all LIBRARY TITLE / CHANNEL NAME items.
J CLEAR ALL
De-selects all items.
K FILE PATH
Indicates the directory (folder) that is currently selected
on the memory card inserted in the MEMORY CARD
slot, and the location of the file. (The directory name is
delineated by “\” characters.)
L SCAN
This scans the directory that is currently selected on the
memory card, and displays the contents in the file list
(
M).
M File list
This area shows the files/directories contained in the
current directory. The currently selected file/directory
is always shown in the middle line. (The TYPE and
DATE SIZE fields will be highlighted.)
The list is divided into four columns; FILE NAME,
TYPE, DATE/SIZE, and COMMENT. (To see the
COMMENT field, use the scroll bar to scroll the list
toward the right.)
The headings at the top of each column of the list also
function as buttons to sort the list. When you click
these buttons, the list will be sorted in ascending or
descending order for that item. The text of the cur-
rently selected button will change to red, and an arrow
indicating ascending () or descending () order will
appear.
These columns display the following content.
FILE NAME
These are the names of the files/directories saved in the
currently selected directory. If a lower directory is
selected, you can move to that directory by clicking the
directory name shown in this column.
If a higher directory is selected, this column will show a
“. .” symbol. You can click this symbol to return to that
directory.
TYPE
This indicates the type of data that is saved. In the case
of a directory, this column will indicate [DIR]. Data
that cannot be used by the PM5D is indicated as
UNKNOWN.
DATE / SIZE
This shows the date on which the file was last saved,
and its size. In the case of a directory, only the date of
creation is displayed.
COMMENT
This displays comments (up to 32 characters) stored
for the files on the memory card. To create or edit a
comment, click the COMMENT field of the file
selected in the list to open the FILE COMMENT EDIT
window.
O
M
LK
P Q R N
PM5D/PM5D-RH Owner’s Manual Reference section 195
Information shown
in the display
Function
menu
Global
functions
Output
functions
Input
functions
Appendices
N Number of files / Free area
This displays the number of files and directories in the
current directory, and the free area on the memory
card.
Note
A maximum of 99 files and directories can be displayed in the
file list. If there are more than 99, a blinking message of “Too
Many Files” will be displayed. In this case, please delete
unneeded files or move files to another directory.
O SAVE
This saves the data selected in the left side of the screen
to the currently selected directory. When you click this
button, the FILE NAME EDIT window will appear,
allowing you to assign a filename of up to eight charac-
ters and save the file.
Note
If an identically-named file exists in that directory, a mes-
sage will warn you that you will be overwriting the file. If you
don’t want to overwrite the existing file, you can either
change the filename or select a different directory in which to
save the file.
When you execute the Save operation in CSV EXPORT
mode, a new directory will be created within the current
directory of the memory card, and a CSV file for each
selected item will be created in the new directory.
The name of the CSV file is fixed for each type of data, and
cannot be changed. The newly created directory will have
the name you specified when saving.
P RENAME
This button lets you rename the currently selected file
or directory. When you click this button, the FILE
NAME EDIT window will appear, allowing you to edit
the name.
Q MAKE DIR (Make directory)
This button creates a new sub-directory within the cur-
rently selected directory. When you click this button,
the DIR NAME EDIT popup window will appear,
allowing you to specify a name for the new directory.
R DELETE
This button deletes the currently selected file or direc-
tory. When you click this button, the FILE DELETE
window will appear, asking you to confirm the
deletion.
Note
•A deleted file cannot be recovered.
If you attempt to delete a directory that contains files, a
warning message will appear, and the operation cannot be
executed. Before deleting a directory, you must first delete
any files it contains.
Note
As memory cards, the PM5D can use either PCMCIA
Type II flash ATA cards or CompactFlash media inserted in
a PC card adaptor (power supply voltage of 3.3V/5V in
either case). Operation is not guaranteed for any other type
of media.
Normally, the above cards are sold in an already-formatted
state, so formatting will not be necessary. If you need to for-
mat a card, use a computer or other external device to
format the card in FAT16 format.
In this screen, scene or library data from a memory card
inserted in the MEMORY CARD can be loaded into the
PM5D. This cannot be used while in PREVIEW mode.
A FILE PATH
Indicates the location of the directory (folder) or file
that is currently selected on the memory card. (The
directory name is delineated by “\” characters.)
B SCAN
This scans the directory that is currently selected on the
memory card, and displays the contents in the file list
(
3).
C File list
This area shows the files/directories contained in the
current directory. The currently selected file/directory
is always shown in the middle line. (The TYPE and
DATE SIZE fields will be highlighted.)
The list is divided into four columns; FILE NAME,
TYPE, DATE/SIZE, and COMMENT. (To see the
COMMENT field, use the scroll bar to scroll the list
toward the right.) The contents of each column are the
same as in the SAVE screen ( p.194).
LOAD screen
LOAD
3
1 2
UTILITY function
196 PM5D/PM5D-RH Owner’s Manual Reference section
D Mode
Here you can select the mode in which files will be
loaded. If a file other than CSV is selected in the file list,
you will be able to select BASIC mode or ADVANCED
mode. (The CSV button will be grayed-out and
unavailable.)
If a CSV file or directory is selected in the file list, CSV
IMPORT mode will be selected automatically. (The
BASIC and ADVANCED buttons will be grayed-out
and unavailable.)
The right side of the screen will change as follows
according to the currently selected mode.
BASIC mode
In BASIC mode you can load all scene memory and
library data (or just a selected portion of data) from a
card. If BASIC is selected, the right side of the screen
will show the following items.
E Select the data to be loaded
Here you can select the data that will be loaded. The
contents of each item are the same as in BASIC mode
of the SAVE screen ( p.192). However, the items that
can be selected will depend on the currently selected
file. Buttons for items that cannot be loaded will be
grayed-out and unavailable.
If the SCENE MEMORY, HA, INPUT PATCH, or
OUTPUT PATCH button is on, you restrict the scenes
or library items that will be loaded by using the box at
the right to specify the starting number and ending
number.
Hint
If the data saved on the card includes empty scenes or library
items, the corresponding scenes or library items will be empty
when the data is loaded.
F LOAD
This button loads the data selected in the left side of the
screen into the parameters you specify. When you click
this button, a message will ask you to confirm the Load
operation. (This is common to all modes.)
ADVANCED mode
In this mode you can select either scene memory or a
library, specify a starting number and ending number, and
load the specified range of data from the card.
G CATEGORY
This indicates the type of data (scene memory or
library) saved in the currently selected file.
H SOURCE (load-source)
This area shows the starting and ending number (and
the corresponding scene names or library titles) of the
scene memories or library items that will be loaded
from the card. Click the / buttons at the left and
right of each box to change the number.
I DESTINATION (load-destination)
If you’ve changed the starting number of the load-des-
tination, this area shows the starting and ending
number (and the corresponding scene names or library
titles) of the PM5D’s internal scene memories or
library items into which the data selected in the
SOURCE area will be loaded. To edit the setting, click
the / buttons located at the left and right of the
starting number box. (The ending number value will
change automatically as you edit the starting number.)
Hint
Even if you’ve selected data that was saved in BASIC mode,
you can switch to ADVANCED mode and load only specific
numbers.
However, an exception is that if the selected data was saved
as ALL DATA or SCENE MEMORY+LINKED LIBRARY in
BASIC mode, the ADVANCED button will be grayed-out,
and you will not be able to switch to ADVANCED mode.
4
6
5
BASIC button
7
8
9
ADVANCED button
PM
5
D
002
003
004
005
006
BBB
CCC
DDD
EEE
FFF
011
012
013
014
BBB
CCC
DDD
EEE
Memory card
Starting
number
Ending
number
PM5D/PM5D-RH Owner’s Manual Reference section 197
Information shown
in the display
Function
menu
Global
functions
Output
functions
Input
functions
Appendices
CSV IMPORT mode
If a CSV file or directory is selected, CSV IMPORT
mode will be selected automatically. The selected CSV
file (or CSV files in the selected directory) will be
searched, and the following items will appear in the
right of the screen.
J LIBRARY TITLE
K CHANNEL NAME
Use these buttons to select the data you want to load
(e.g., library titles or channel names). (The contents of
each item are the same as in the SAVE screen.)
However, you will only be able to select items that
match the CSV file (or the CSV files in the directory)
selected in the list for loading. The buttons for other
items will be grayed-out and unavailable.
L SET ALL
This button selects all available items for loading.
M CLEAR ALL
De-selects all items.
Note
Note that the screen will automatically switch to CSV IMPORT
mode even if the directory selected in the list does not contain
an appropriate CSV file. (In this case, all buttons will be
grayed-out.)
Here you can assign the desired input channels / output
channels to the eight faders in the DCA section of the
panel.
A FADER MODE
Indicates the currently selected
fader mode (DCA, layer A–F).
You can also click the buttons to
switch the fader mode directly.
B Faders 1–8
The parameter assigned to each
fader of the DCA fader section is
shown here. This will depend on
the FADER MODE (
1) and
channel selection (
3). You can
also operate the fader directly by
dragging it upward or downward.
C Channel selection
This indicates the channel that is
assigned to each fader in layers A–
F, and its name (only for input
channels). Click the / but-
tons at left and right to change the
assignment. You can choose from
CH 1–48, ST IN 1L–ST IN 4R, FXRTN 1L–FXRTN 4R,
MATRIX 1–8, MIX 1–24, and DCA 1–8.
L
M
K
J
FADER ASSIGN screen
FADER ASSIGN
1
2
3
UTILITY function
198 PM5D/PM5D-RH Owner’s Manual Reference section
In this screen you can prohibit console operation (Console
Lock) or prohibit editing for specific parameters (Parame-
ter Lock). Two passwords of differing levels can be
specified to allow locking and unlocking.
A SYSTEM PASSWORD
This is a permanent password (maximum of eight
characters) for the entire system. The password you
specify here is valid for the PARAMETER LOCK but-
ton (
2) and for the CONSOLE LOCK button (3).
However, you can perform the Lock operation even
without specifying a password.
If no password has been specified, this box will indi-
cate “--FREE--”. If a password has been specified,
asterisks (*) will be displayed to represent the charac-
ters of the password.
To set or change the password, click the button to
open the SYSTEM PASSWORD CHANGE window.
When setting the password for the first time, you will
input the same password twice for confirmation. To
change the password, you will input both the old pass-
word and the new password. By specifying a blank
entry as the new password, you can restore the state to
a condition in which no password has been set.
Note
The system password is remembered even when the power is
turned off. This means that if you forget the password, you will
be unable to defeat Parameter Lock or Console Lock except
by initializing the entire memory of the PM5D (
p.147).
Please be careful not to lose the system password.
B PARAMETER LOCK
This button sets/defeats Parameter Lock for the param-
eters selected in the LOCK PARAMETER SELECT area
(
4). If not even one parameter is selected, these but-
tons will be grayed-out and cannot be turned on. If the
system password has been set, clicking this button will
open the SYSTEM PASSWORD CHECK window,
where you will need to input the system password.
C CONSOLE LOCK
This button locks the console operations. If the system
password has been set, clicking this button will open
the SYSTEM PASSWORD CHECK window, where
you will need to input the system password.
D LOCK PARAMETER SELECT
If the PARAMETER LOCK button (2) is on, parame-
ters for which editing will be disabled can be selected
from the following table. As long as the PARAMETER
LOCK button (
2) is on, these parameters cannot be
edited.
E CONSOLE PASSWORD
This is a temporary password (maximum of eight char-
acters) that is separate from the system password. The
password you specify here is valid for the CONSOLE
LOCK button (
6). The method for setting or chang-
ing the password is the same as for the system
password.
Hint
The Console Password is cleared when the PM5D’s power is
turned off, and will return to the unset state (the box will indi-
cate “--FREE--”).
F CONSOLE LOCK
This button locks the console operations. If the con-
sole password has been set, clicking this button will
open the CONSOLE PASSWORD CHECK window,
where you will need to input the console password.
SECURITY screen
SECURITY
1
3
2
SYSTEM CONFIGU-
RATION
Changes to the settings of the
MIXER SETUP screen and the CAS-
CADE screen
WORD CLOCK
SETUP
Changes in the word clock setting
DITHER Changes in dither-related settings
INPUT PATCH
Changes to the input patch (and
NAME) settings
OUTPUT PATCH Changes to the output patch settings
INPUT CH ON/OFF Input channel on/off operations
OUTPUT CH ON/
OFF
Output channel on/off operations
MIX TO ST ON/OFF
MIX channel [TO STEREO] key
operations
DCA MUTE ON
DCA [MUTE] key On operations
(Off operations are not included)
4
5
6
PM5D/PM5D-RH Owner’s Manual Reference section 199
Information shown
in the display
Function
menu
Global
functions
Output
functions
Input
functions
Appendices
SYS/W.CLOCK function
Here you can select the word clock on which the PM5D
will operate. You can also view and edit settings for cards
installed in slots 1–4.
A MASTER CLOCK SELECT
As the master clock to use, you can select the internal
clock or an external clock input from a connector or
slot. This setting determines the sampling frequency at
which the PM5D will operate. You can select the fol-
lowing items.
The operational status of each clock is shown by the
color of the symbol at the left of each button. Each
color has the following significance.
LOCK (blue)
This indicates that a clock synchronized with the
source selected in (
2) is being input. If an external
device is connected to the corresponding connector or
slot, input/output is occurring normally between that
device and the PM5D. If the sampling frequency is
close, this status may be displayed even if not
synchronized.
UNLOCK (red)
A valid clock is not being input. If an external device is
connected to the corresponding connector, input/out-
put cannot occur correctly between that device and the
PM5D.
LOCK, BUT NOT SYNC’ED (orange)
A valid clock is being input, but is not synchronized
with the clock source selected in (
2). If an external
device is connected to the corresponding connector,
input/output cannot occur correctly between that
device and the PM5D.
UNKNOWN (yellow)
This indicates that the clock status cannot be detected
because no external device is connected or because
there is no valid clock input. You will be able to select
this connector/slot, but successful synchronization can-
not occur until a valid connection is established.
SRC ON (green)
This is a special status only for SLOT 1–4 and 2TR IN
2TR IN D1–3, indicating that the corresponding chan-
nel’s SRC (Sampling Rate Converter) is enabled. This
means that even if the signal is not synchronized, nor-
mal input/output with the PM5D is occurring.
Note
Noise may occur at the output jacks when the word clock
setting is changed. In order to protect your speaker system,
be sure to turn down the power amp output before changing
the word clock setting.
If you attempt to select a channel whose SRC is on as the
word clock master, a message will appear, warning you that
the sampling rate converter will be disabled.
B Fs (Sampling frequency)
This indicates the sampling frequency at which the
PM5D is operating. This will indicate “UNLOCKED”
while synchronization is lost (such as immediately after
switching the master clock).
Display Content
INT 96k
The PM5D’s internal clock
(sampling rate= 96 kHz)
INT 88.2k
The PM5D’s internal clock
(sampling rate= 88.2 kHz)
INT 48 k
The PM5D’s internal clock
(sampling rate= 48 kHz)
INT 44.1 k
The PM5D’s internal clock
(sampling rate= 44.1 kHz)
W.CLOCK IN
The word clock supplied from the rear panel
WORD CLOCK IN connector
CASCADE IN
The word clock supplied via the CASCADE
IN connector from another cascade-con-
nected PM5D
2TR IN D1
The clock data of the digital audio signal
supplied from 2TR IN DIGITAL connector 1
2TR IN D2
The clock data of the digital audio signal
supplied from 2TR IN DIGITAL connector 2
2TR IN D3
The clock data of the digital audio signal
supplied from 2TR IN DIGITAL connector 3
SLOT 1–4
The clock data of the digital audio signal
supplied via a digital I/O card in slot 1–4
(selectable in two-channel units)
WORD CLOCK screen
WORD CLOCK
2
1
SYS/W.CLOCK function
200 PM5D/PM5D-RH Owner’s Manual Reference section
C Slot number / Card type
This area shows the type of digital I/O card installed in
slots 1–4.
D INPUT FORMAT (Input signal format)
E OUTPUT FORMAT (Output signal format)
Select one of the following as the method by which sig-
nals will be exchanged with a digital I/O card installed
in the slot when the PM5D is operating at a high sam-
pling rate (88.2/96 kHz).
SINGLE
This setting allows transmission/reception of the nor-
mal number of channels when existing equipment that
operates at 44.1/48 kHz is connected. The sampling
rate will be converted for each channel of the digital I/
O card, and transmitted/received at half the sampling
frequency (44.1/48 kHz) of the PM5D. (This setting
can be selected only for slots in which a digital I/O card
that does not support 96 kHz is installed.)
DOUBLE SPEED
This setting allows high sampling rate audio signals to
be transmitted/received without change when equip-
ment that operates at a high sampling rate (88.2/96
kHz) is connected. (This setting can be connected only
for slots in which a digital I/O card that supports 96
kHz is installed.)
DOUBLE CHANNEL
This setting allows high sampling rate (88.2/96 kHz)
audio signals to be handled when existing equipment
that operates at 44.1/48 kHz is connected. Two chan-
nels of signals at half the PM5D’s sampling frequency
(44.1/48 kHz) are transmitted/received together as a
high sampling rate monaural signal. (The number of
usable channels will be half.)
F FREQUENCY (Sampling frequency)
This indicates the sampling frequency of the signal
being input to each channel of the digital I/O card, in
sets of two channels.
G SRC (Sampling Rate Converter)
This button switches the Sampling Rate Converter on/
off, in sets of two channels. This is available only for
slots in which a digital I/O card with a built-in sam-
pling rate converter is installed.
H EMPHASIS STATUS
This indicates whether emphasis is applied to the input
signal, in sets of two channels. This is available only for
slots in which a digital I/O card is installed.
Here you can make settings that apply to the entire PM5D
system.
A PAIR MODE
Select one of the following two methods by which
input channels will be paired.
HORIZONTAL PAIR
If this button is on, input channels of adjacent num-
bers (1/2, 3/4 ...) will be paired.
VERTICAL PAIR
If this button is on, input channels of different layers
that share the same fader (1/25, 2/26 ...) will be paired.
This setting lets you use the faders of the INPUT chan-
nel strip to control up to 24 pairs (48 channels).
Hint
The graphic below the buttons will change according to the
pair mode you select.
When you switch from horizontal pair mode to verti-
cal pair mode, new numbers will be assigned to the
input channels as follows.
Channel 1 no change
Channel 2 Channel 25
Channel 3 Channel 2
Channel 4 Channel 26
:
Channel 47 Channel 24
Channel 48 no change
4
8
53
76
MIXER SETUP screen
MIXER SETUP
1 2
PM5D/PM5D-RH Owner’s Manual Reference section 201
Information shown
in the display
Function
menu
Global
functions
Output
functions
Input
functions
Appendices
(If you again switch back to horizontal pair mode, the
channels will return to their previous number.) How-
ever, please note that this simply means the input
channel that was previously called “channel 2” is now
called “channel 25”; the name and parameter settings
of that channel have not changed.
In the various screens of the display (except for the
TRACKING RECALL screen and the FADER VIEW
screen), switching the pair mode will only change the
displayed numbers; the arrangement of the input chan-
nels will not change.
B PAN NOMINAL POSITION
Here you can specify whether a signal will be at nomi-
nal level when panned to center, or at nominal level
when panned far left or far right. Choose one of the fol-
lowing two settings. You can choose independently for
monaural channels and paired channels.
CENTER
The signal will be at nominal level (+0 dB) when
panned to the center, and will rise +3 dB when panned
to far left or far right.
•L R
The signal will be at nominal level (+0 dB) when
panned to far left or far right, and will decrease
–3 dB when panned to the center.
Hint
The current setting is also shown by the graph below the
buttons.
C BUS SETUP
This area indicates the MIX bus mode (VARI/FIXED)
for every two adjacent odd-numbered/even-numbered
MIX buses. You can edit the setting by clicking the /
buttons at the left and right.
D STEREO B
Select one of the following two choices to specify how
the STEREO B bus will function.
USE AS STEREO BUS
If this button is on, the STEREO B bus will function as
a conventional stereo bus; the same signal as the STE-
REO A bus will be sent to it.
USE AS CENTER BUS
If this button is on, the STEREO B bus will function as
the CENTER bus of LCR mode. When you turn this
on, the CENTER bus output signal will be added to the
L/R channels of the STEREO A bus, allowing LCR
playback (three-channel playback). (The monitor sig-
nal will also be played back from the three MONITOR
OUT connectors L/C/R.
Note
If the USE AS STEREO BUS button is on, LCR mode is
disabled.
E SURROUND BUS ALLOCATION
Choose which of the following two ranges of MIX bus
will be used as surround buses.
MIX 1-8 . . . . . MIX bus 1–8
MIX 9-16 . . . . MIX bus 9–16
F SURROUND MODE
Choose one of the following as the surround mode
when using the Surround Pan function ( p.132).
STEREO
This is conventional stereo mode.
3-1ch
This mode uses four channels: L (front left), C (front
center), R (front right), and S (surround).
5.1ch
This mode uses six channels: L (front left), C (front
center), R (front right), Ls (rear left), Rs (rear right),
and LFE (subwoofer).
4
365
L
(front left)
C
(front center)
R
(front right)
S
(surround)
LFE
(subwoofer)
Ls
(rear left)
Rs
(rear right)
L
(front left)
C
(front center)
R
(front right)
SYS/W.CLOCK function
202 PM5D/PM5D-RH Owner’s Manual Reference section
6.1ch
This mode uses seven channels: 5.1ch with the addi-
tion of Bs (rear center).
Hint
The graphic below the buttons will change according to the
mode you select.
G CASCADE FROM (Source when cascade-
connected)
Select one of the following as the external device that is
sending audio signals to the PM5D via a cascade
connection.
H CASCADE IN PORT SELECT
Select one of the following as the port that will receive
the audio signals from the cascade-connected device.
Hint
If you select a choice other than CASCADE IN, the signal
from the slot will be assigned to the cascade input, and the
signal from the CASCADE IN connector will be assigned to
the corresponding slot input.
The signal assigned from the CASCADE IN connector to the
slot input can be used as a patch source in the IN PATCH
screen.
CASCADE IN
Up to 30 channels of audio signals can be received
from another PM5D via the rear panel CASCADE IN
connector. If PM5D is selected as the cascade source
(
7), control signals for parameter linkage will also be
transmitted and received.
SLOT 4
Up to 16 channels of audio signals can be received via
input channels 1–16 of an I/O card installed in slot 4 of
the rear panel. If you choose this setting, the signals
from the CASCADE IN connector (channels 1–16) will
be assigned to channels 1–16 of the SLOT IN 4 port
instead.
SLOT 3/4
Up to 30 channels of audio signals can be received via
input channels 1–16 of I/O cards installed in slots 3 and
4. (Since channels 15/16 of SLOT 4 are not used, only
30 channels are actually available.) If you choose this
setting, the signals from the CASCADE IN connector
(channels 1–32) will be assigned to channels 1–16 of
the SLOT IN 3/4 ports instead.
Display Source device
Available cas-
cade input port
Parame-
ter linkage
Cascade disabled
CASCADE IN,
SLOT 3/4,
SLOT 1-4
[CH1-8], SLOT
1-4 [CH9-16]
Not
possible
PM5D another PM5D CASCADE IN Possible
*1
*1. Linked parameters are specified in the CASCADE
screen.
DM2000
/02R96
YAMAHA DM2000
or 02R96
CASCADE IN
Not
possible
MIXER
[30BUS]
A mixer other than
the above (maxi-
mum 30 bus)
SLOT 3/4,
SLOT 1-4
[CH1-8], SLOT
1-4 [CH9-16]
MIXER
[16BUS]
A mixer other than
the above (maxi-
mum 16 bus)
SLOT 4
LFE
(subwoofer)
Ls
(rear left)
Rs
(rear right)
L
(front left)
C
(front center)
R
(front right)
Bs
(rear center)
97 M LK
8 J N
CASCADE IN
CH 1-16
SLOT 4
SLOT IN 1 (CH 1–16)
SLOT IN 2 (CH 1–16)
SLOT IN 3 (CH 1–16)
CH 1-16
SLOT 1-3
SLOT IN 4 (CH 1–16)
CASCADE IN
CH 1-16
16 channels
16 channels
CASCADE IN
CH 1-16
SLOT 3/4
CH 1-16
SLOT 1/2
CASCADE IN
CH 1-32
SLOT IN 1 (CH 1–16)
SLOT IN 2 (CH 1–16)
SLOT IN 3 (CH 1–16)
SLOT IN 4 (CH 1–16)
30 channels
32 channels
PM5D/PM5D-RH Owner’s Manual Reference section 203
Information shown
in the display
Function
menu
Global
functions
Output
functions
Input
functions
Appendices
SLOT 1-4 [CH1-8]
Up to 30 channels of audio signals can be received via
input channels 1–8 of I/O cards installed in slots 1–4.
(Since channels 7/8 of SLOT 4 are not used, only 30
channels are actually available.) If you choose this set-
ting, the signals from the CASCADE IN connector
(channels 1–32) will be assigned to channels 1–8 of the
SLOT IN 1–4 ports instead.
SLOT 1-4 [CH9-16]
Up to 30 channels of audio signals can be received via
input channels 9–16 of I/O cards installed in slots 1–4.
(Since channels 15/16 of SLOT 4 are not used, only 30
channels are actually available.) If you choose this set-
ting, the signals from the CASCADE IN connector
(channels 1–32) will be assigned to channels 9–16 of
the SLOT IN 1–4 ports instead.
I CASCADE TO (Transmission destination
when cascade-connected)
As the external device to which audio signals will be
transmitted and control signals exchanged over the cas-
cade connection, you can select either PM5D (i.e., a
different PM5D unit) or “----” (transmission disabled).
J CASCADE OUT PORT SOURCE SELECT
Select one of the following as the signal source that will
be output from the CASCADE OUT connector.
Hint
If you select a setting other than CASCADE OUT, the same
signals will be output both to the corresponding slots and to
the CASCADE OUT connector.
CASCADE OUT
The audio signals sent by the cascade function will be
output from the CASCADE OUT connector. If PM5D
is selected as the transmission destination (
9), con-
trol signals for parameter linkage will also be
transmitted and received. The type of signals that are
output can be selected in the CASCADE screen.
SLOT 3/4
The same audio signals (up to 32 channels) as are out-
put from output channels 1–16 of slots 3/4 will be
output in parallel from the CASCADE OUT connector.
SLOT 1-4 [CH1-8]
The same audio signals (up to 32 channels) that are
output from output channels 1–8 of slots 1–4 will also
be output in parallel from the CASCADE OUT
connector.
SLOT 1-4 [CH9-16]
The same audio signals (up to 32 channels) that are
output from output channels 9–16 of slots 1–4 will also
be output in parallel from the CASCADE OUT
connector.
K CASCADE MODE
Choose one of the following two modes of operation
when multiple PM5D units are cascade-connected.
MASTER
If the Cascade function is enabled, control signals will
be sent to an external PM5D.
SLAVE
If the Cascade function is enabled, control signals will
be received from an external PM5D.
L BI-DIRECTION (Bi-directional
communication)
When multiple PM5D units are connected, this button
selects whether they will mix each other’s audio signals.
Set the Cascade mode and the BI-DIRECTION button
according to the type of cascade connection, as dis-
cussed below.
If you cascade-connect two PM5D units in a “ring”
topology (i.e., connect the CASCADE IN connector of
each unit to the OUT connector of the other unit), set
the cascade mode to MASTER on one unit and SLAVE
on the other unit. Turn the BI-DIRECTION button
On for both units.
In this state, the SLAVE unit will follow when you
operate the MASTER unit. The same mix will be out-
put from both PM5D units.
CASCADE IN
CH 1-8
SLOT 1-4
CH 9-16
SLOT 1-4
SLOT IN 1–4 (CH 9–16)
SLOT IN 1–4 (CH 1–8)
CASCADE IN
CH 1-32
30 channels
32 channels
CASCADE IN
CH 9-16
SLOT 1-4
CH 1-8
SLOT 1-4
SLOT IN 1–4 (CH 1–8)
SLOT IN 1–4 (CH 9–16)
CASCADE IN
CH 1-32
30 channels
32 channels
PM5D A
CASCADE
IN
CASCADE
OUT
CASCADE
IN
CASCADE
OUT
PM5D B
CASCADE MODE= MASTER
BI-DIRECTION= ON
CASCADE MODE= SLAVE
BI-DIRECTION= ON
Audio signals of
A+B
Audio signals of
A+B
(Cascade master) (Cascade slave)
SYS/W.CLOCK function
204 PM5D/PM5D-RH Owner’s Manual Reference section
If you daisy-chain two to four PM5D units (i.e., con-
nect the first unit’s CASCADE OUT second unit’s
CASCADE IN, and the second unit’s CASCADE OUT
third unit’s CASCADE IN. Up to four units can be
connected.), set the PM5D located last in the chain to
MASTER, and the remaining PM5D units to SLAVE.
Turn the BI-DIRECTION button Off for all units.
In this state, the SLAVE units will follow when you
operate the MASTER unit. The final mix of all signals
will be output from the PM5D that is connected last in
the chain.
M CASCADE ENABLE/DISABLE
Turns the Cascade function on/off.
Note
If you edit the settings of the CASCADE CONNECTION
parameters (
7
L
), the cascade function will temporarily be
reset to Off.
N DME CONTROL
This button accesses the DME CONTROL screen
( p.182).
Here you can make various settings related to cascade
connection.
A CASCADE ENABLE/DISABLE
Enables/disables cascade connection.
B CASCADE LINK
Here you can select the operations and parameters that
will be linked when multiple PM5D units are cascade-
connected. You can select the following items.
SCENE RECALL
Scene recall operations / Recall undo operations
SCENE STORE/EDIT
Scene store operations, store undo operations, title
editing, sorting
CUE/SOLO LOGIC
Cue/Solo operations (however, all Cue settings are
cleared when linking occurs)
DIMMER ON/OFF
Dimmer effect (including talkback dimmer)
PAGE CHANGE
Switching the display screen
CASCADE MODE= SLAVE
BI-DIRECTION= OFF
PM5D C
CASCADE MODE= MASTER
BI-DIRECTION= OFF
PM5D D
CASCADE MODE= SLAVE
BI-DIRECTION= OFF
PM5D A
CASCADE
IN
CASCADE
OUT
CASCADE
IN
CASCADE
OUT
CASCADE
IN
CASCADE
OUT
CASCADE
IN
CASCADE
OUT
CASCADE MODE= SLAVE
BI-DIRECTION= OFF
PM5D B
(Cascade slave)
(Cascade slave)
Audio signals of
A+B+C+D
(Cascade slave)
(Cascade master)
Audio signals of
A+B+C
Audio signals of
A+B
Audio signals of A
CASCADE screen
CASCADE
1
2
PM5D/PM5D-RH Owner’s Manual Reference section 205
Information shown
in the display
Function
menu
Global
functions
Output
functions
Input
functions
Appendices
DCA FADER MODE
Switching the mode of the top panel FADER MODE
section
ENCODER MODE
Switching the mode of the top panel ENCODER
MODE section
PANEL/LCD BRIGHTNESS
BRIGHTNESS settings in the PREFERENCE 2 screen
(UTILITY function)
INPUT METER POINT/OUTPUT METER POINT/
PEAK HOLD
Input channel / output channel metering point selec-
tion, and peak hold on/off
DCA LEVEL/MUTE
DCA group 1–8 level, name, [CUE] key on/off opera-
tions, and [MUTE] key on/off operations
Hint
DCA and MUTE parameter values will be linked the instant
Link is turned on. Other parameters will be linked for the first
time only when that parameter is operated after Link is turned
on.
MUTE MASTER
Mute group 1–8 on/off
Hint
For details on the actual procedure of cascade-connecting
multiple PM5D units, refer to p.143.
To enable cascade link, you must turn on linking for the cor-
responding parameters on the other cascade-connected
PM5D units as well.
You can also turn linking off for the master PM5D. For
example if you’ve cascade-connected multiple PM5D units,
you can (for example) make settings so that DCA 1 is linked
only between the master and the second unit, DCA 2 is
linked for all PM5D units, and DCA 3 is linked only between
the second unit and third unit.
C CASCADE IN SOURCE (Cascade IN source I/
O assignment view)
Here you can view and select the signals that are sent to
the PM5D’s internal buses from the cascade-con-
nected external device. The type of signals received will
depend on the selection in the CASCADE FROM field
of the MIXER SETUP screen (SYS/W.CLOCK
function)
D CASCADE IN ON/OFF
For each of the PM5D’s internal buses, you can specify
whether signals from the cascade master will be input.
E CASCADE OUT ON/OFF
For each of the PM5D’s internal buses, you can specify
whether signals will be output to the cascade slave.
3 4 5
External device selected in the
CASCADE FROM field
Destina-
tion bus
PM5D
*1
DM2000/
02R96
*1
MIXER
[30BUS]
MIXER
[16BUS]
*2
MIX 1 BUS 1
*3
SLOT4- 1 MIX 1
MIX 2 BUS 2 SLOT4-2 MIX 2
MIX 3 BUS 3 SLOT4-3 MIX 3
MIX 4 BUS 4 SLOT4-4 MIX 4
MIX 5 BUS 5 SLOT4-5 MIX 5
MIX 6 BUS 6 SLOT4-6 MIX 6
MIX 7 BUS 7 SLOT4-7 MIX 7
MIX 8 BUS 8 SLOT4-8 MIX 8
MIX 9 AUX 1 SLOT4-9 MIX 9
MIX10 AUX 2 SLOT4-10 MIX10
MIX11 AUX 3 SLOT4-11 MIX11
MIX12 AUX 4 SLOT4-12 MIX12
MIX13 AUX 5 SLOT4- 1 MIX13
MIX14 AUX 6 SLOT4- 2 MIX14
MIX15 AUX 7 SLOT4- 3 MIX15
MIX16 AUX 8 SLOT4- 4 MIX16
MIX17 AUX 9 SLOT4- 5 MIX17
MIX18 AUX10 SLOT4- 6 MIX18
MIX19 AUX11 SLOT4- 7 MIX19
MIX20 AUX12 SLOT4- 8 MIX20
MIX21 SLOT4- 9 MIX21
MIX22 SLOT4-10 MIX22
MIX23 SLOT4-11 MIX23
MIX24 SLOT4-12 MIX24
ST AL ST L SLOT4-13 ST AL
ST AR ST R SLOT4-14 ST AR
ST BL SLOT4- 9 ST BL
ST BR SLOT4-10 ST BR
CUE L CUE L SLOT4-15 CUE L
CUE R CUE R SLOT4-16 CUE R
*1. The signal assigned to each bus is fixed; it cannot be
changed.
*2. You can enable/disable the assignment for each bus.
However, you cannot send the signal of the same slot
or same input channel to multiple buses. If a signal
already assigned to a bus is selected for a different bus,
the previous assignment will be cancelled.
*3. Assigned from the top in ascending numerical order of
slot number / channel number, according to the settings
of the CASCADE IN PORT SELECT area of the
MIXER SETUP screen (SYS/W.CLOCK function). (this
cannot be changed.)
SYS/W.CLOCK function
206 PM5D/PM5D-RH Owner’s Manual Reference section
In this screen you can make settings such as phantom
power (+48V), gain, and HPF for each of the internal head
amps (PM5D-RH model only), or for each channel of an
external head amp device that supports remote control via
the dedicated protocol (e.g., Yamaha AD8HR or AD824).
A DISPLAY MODE
Select one of the following as the type of head amp dis-
played in the screen.
INTERNAL HA (PM5D-RH model only)
The internal head amp channels (AD IN 1–48, AD
STIN 1–4) will be displayed.
EXTERNAL HA 1-4
EXTERNAL HA 5-8
The channels of an external head amp device (ID num-
ber= 1–4, or ID number= 5–8) connected via the [HA
REMOTE] connector will be displayed.
Hint
Up to eight external devices can be daisy-chained to the
PM5D’s [HA REMOTE] connector. In this case, an ID number
(1–8) is automatically assigned to each device, starting from
the device that is connected directly to the PM5D’s [HA
REMOTE] connector.
B Model name
For each ID number, this indicates the model name of
the external head amp device that is connected. If no
device is connected this will indicate “-----”. However
even in this case, you will be able to make the same set-
tings as when a Yamaha AD8HR is connected.
C Slot/Channel
Here you can view/select the slot and channels to
which the audio output of the external head amp
device is connected.
Note
If an external head amp device is connected to a PM5D slot,
you must specify the appropriate slot/channels manually.
Please note that if you specify an incorrect setting, the input
channel HA indication in screens such as the IN HA screen
may differ from the actual state.
D +48V MASTER
If an AD8HR is connected via the [HA REMOTE] con-
nector, this indicates the master phantom power on/off
status. (Otherwise, this indicates “---”.)
E +48V
Switches phantom power (+48V) on/off for each
channel.
F HPF (High Pass Filter)
Turns the HPF on/off for each channel.
G Cutoff frequency
Specifies the HPF cutoff frequency for each channel of
the AD8HR. Move the cursor to the box, and turn the
[DATA] encoder to adjust the cutoff frequency in a
range of 20–600 Hz.
H GAIN
Adjusts the gain for each channel. Move the cursor to
the knob, and turn the [DATA] encoder to adjust the
gain in a range of –62 dB to +10 dB. The current value
is shown in the box below.
I GANG
If this button is on, the gain settings of two adjacent
odd-numbered/even-numbered channels will change
in tandem, maintaining the current offset value.
J LIBRARY
This button displays the HA LIBRARY screen
( p.208).
Note
When an external head amp device is connected for the first
time, the settings on the external head amp device are used. If
you subsequently recall a HA library item, the HA library set-
tings are used.
HA (Head Amp) screen
HA
1
2
5
6
9
7
8
3
4
J
PM5D/PM5D-RH Owner’s Manual Reference section 207
Information shown
in the display
Function
menu
Global
functions
Output
functions
Input
functions
Appendices
In this screen you can specify the amount of attenuation
for each output channel and for each output channel of an
I/O card.
A DISPLAY MODE
Select the channels that will appear in the display, from
the following choices.
OUTPUT
The screen will show the amount of attenuation for
output channels (MIX channels 1–24, MATRIX chan-
nels 1–8, STEREO A L/R channels, STEREO B L/R
channels), CUE L/R channels, MONITOR L/R/C chan-
nels, and 2TR OUT DIGITAL 1–3 L/R channels.
SLOT 1-4
The screen will show the amount of attenuation for
each output channel of the I/O cards installed in slots
1–4.
B ATT (Attenuation)
Adjusts the amount of attenuation for each channel.
Move the cursor to the knob, and turn the [DATA]
encoder to adjust the attenuation in a range of
–9 dB to 0 dB. The current value is shown in the box
below each knob.
In this screen you can turn dithering on/off and specify the
bit depth for dithering. These settings are made individu-
ally for each digital output jack and each output channel of
the digital I/O cards.
A Digital output jack dither
settings
Specify the number of bits (16,
20, 24 bits) used when dither-
ing the output signals from 2TR
DIGITAL OUT jacks 1–3. If you
select OFF, dithering will not be
performed.
B Slots 1–4
This area shows the type of digital I/O card installed in
each slot.
C Digital I/O card dither settings
For each output channel of the digital I/O cards
installed in the slots, specify the number of bits used
when dithering.
OUTPUT PORT ATT (Output port
attenuation) screen
OUTPUT PORT ATT
1
2
DITHER screen
DITHER
1
2 3
SYS/W.CLOCK function
208 PM5D/PM5D-RH Owner’s Manual Reference section
In this screen you can recall, store, rename, or delete items
in the HA library.
A EDIT
When you click this button, the HA screen will appear.
B DATA FORMAT
Indicates the model name (PM5D-RH or PM5D).
C EXTERNAL HA TYPE INFORMATION
This area shows the model names (AD8HR/AD824) of
the external head amp devices (ID numbers= 1–8)
connected to the PM5D’s [HA REMOTE] connector.
D RECALL
Recalls the HA library item selected in the list into
memory.
E STORE
Stores the current settings of the HA screen into the
location selected in the list. When you click this button
a window will appear, allowing you to name and save
the settings.
F TITLE EDIT
Edits the title of the library item selected in the list.
When you click this button a window will appear,
allowing you to edit the title.
G CLEAR
Deletes the library item selected in the list. When you
click this button, a confirmation message will appear.
Note
Library items with an “R” displayed in the right column of the
list are read-only. Read-only items cannot be stored,
renamed, or deleted.
H DATA FORMAT
Indicates the data format (PM5D-RH or PM5D) of the
library item selected in the list.
I EXTERNAL HA TYPE INFORMATION
This area indicates the model name (AD8HR/AD824)
of the external head amps (ID numbers= 1–8) for
which data is stored in the library.
J Library list
Use the scroll bar to select the library item on which
you want to perform an operation. The selected library
item will move to the center, and will be highlighted.
Note
If PM5D format data is recalled to the PM5D-RH, the inter-
nal head amp settings will not change. If PM5D-RH format
data is recalled to the PM5D, the internal head amp settings
will be ignored.
If the recall-source and recall-destination head amp devices
have the same ID number but are assigned to different slots/
channels, the data will not be recalled to head amps of those
ID numbers.
AD8HR data can be recalled into an AD824, and AD824
data can be recalled into an AD8HR. However when AD8HR
data is recalled to an AD824, the gain settings of each chan-
nel will be converted into 6 dB units in order to match the
specifications of the AD824.
HA LIBRARY screen
HA LIBRARY
3
1
2
9
J
8
4
5
6
7
PM5D/PM5D-RH Owner’s Manual Reference section 209
Information shown
in the display
Function
menu
Global
functions
Output
functions
Input
functions
Appendices
METER function
This screen contains meters that show the input level of the
input channels (input channels 1–48, ST IN channels 1–4,
FXTRN channels 1–4).
A METERING POINT
Select one of the following as the point at which the
input level will be detected. This setting also applies to
the meters on the panel.
PRE ATT . . . . . . . . . Immediately before the
attenuator
PRE GATE . . . . . . . Immediately before the internal
gate
PRE FADER . . . . . . Immediately before the fader
POST FADER . . . . . Immediately after the fader
POST ON . . . . . . . . Immediately after the [ON] key
B CH METER ALWAYS PRE ATT
If this button is on, the input channel meters of the
panel will always show the pre-attenuator levels.
C PEAK HOLD
If this button is on, the peak level of each meter will be
held. When you turn this button off, the peak level
indication that had been held will be cleared. Peak hold
will be cleared when you change the metering point
(
1). This button is linked with the [PEAK HOLD] key
in the METER section of the top panel.
D Meters
These peak level meters indicate the input level of each
channel. The current fader value is shown in the box
below.
If clipping occurs at any point PRE ATT, POST EQ,
POST GATE, POST COMP, INSERT IN, or POST
FADER, the segment will light.
E Pair icon
This indicates the pairing status of two adjacent odd-
numbered/even-numbered channels.
INPUT METER screen
INPUT METER
1 2 3
4
5
METER function
210 PM5D/PM5D-RH Owner’s Manual Reference section
This screen contains meters that show the output level of
output channels (MIX channels 1–24, MATRIX channels
1–8, STEREO A/B channels), MONITOR (L/R/C), and
CUE (L/R).
A METERING POINT
Select one of the following as the point at which the
output level will be detected.
PRE EQ . . . . . . . . . . Immediately before the EQ
PRE FADER . . . . . . Immediately before the fader
POST FADER . . . . . Immediately after the fader
POST ON . . . . . . . . Immediately after the [ON] key
POST DELAY . . . . . Immediately after the internal
delay (of an output channel)
B CUE METERING POINT
Select one of the following as the point at which the
output level of the cue signal will be detected.
PRE DELAY . . . . . . Immediately before the internal
delay (of a monitor/cue
channel)
POST DELAY . . . . . Immediately after the internal
delay (of a monitor/cue
channel)
C PEAK HOLD
If this button is on, the peak level of each meter will be
held. When you turn this button off, the peak level
indication that had been held will be cleared. Peak hold
will be cleared when you change the metering point
(
1). This button is linked with the [PEAK HOLD] key
in the METER section of the top panel.
D Meters
These peak level meters indicate the output level of
each channel. The current master level value is shown
in the box below.
If clipping occurs at any point POST EQ, POST
COMP, POST ON, POST FADER, or INSERT IN, the
segment will light.
E Pair icon
This indicates the pairing status of two adjacent odd-
numbered/even-numbered channels.
OUTPUT METER screen
OUTPUT METER
1 2 3
4
5
PM5D/PM5D-RH Owner’s Manual Reference section 211
Information shown
in the display
Function
menu
Global
functions
Output
functions
Input
functions
Appendices
This screen contains meters that show the amount of gain
reduction produced by the gate/compressor for each input
channel (input channels 1–48, ST IN channels 1–4).
A GATE/COMP (Gate / Compressor)
These buttons select either Gate or Compressor as the
processor whose gain reduction amount is shown by
the meters. The display at the left will change accord-
ing to your selection.
B Meters
These peak level meters indicate the amount of gain
reduction for each channel. The current fader value is
shown in the box below.
C Pair icon
This indicates the pairing status of two adjacent odd-
numbered/even-numbered channels.
This screen contains meters that show the amount of gain
reduction produced by the compressor for each output
channel (MIX channels 1–24, MATRIX channels 1–8, STE-
REO A/B channels).
A Meters
These peak level meters indicate the amount of gain
reduction for each channel. The current master level
value is shown in the box below.
B Pair icon
This indicates the pairing status of two adjacent odd-
numbered/even-numbered channels.
INPUT GR (Input Gain Reduction)
screen
INPUT GR
2
3
OUTPUT GR (Output Gain Reduction)
screen
OUTPUT GR
1
2
MON/CUE function
212 PM5D/PM5D-RH Owner’s Manual Reference section
MON/CUE function
In this screen you can switch talkback on/off, and select the
talkback destination.
A Level meter (TALKBACK jack level meter)
This level meter indicates the peak level of the signal
being input from the TALKBACK jack of the top panel.
B +48V (TALKBACK jack phantom power)
This button switches phantom power on/off for the
TALKBACK jack.
Note
The WITH ANALOG VOLUME icon below the button indi-
cates that the LEVEL volume in the TALKBACK section of the
panel will affect only the signal being input from the TALK-
BACK jack.
C Talkback input selection
If you want to use an input jack other than the TALK-
BACK jack for purposes of talkback, you can choose it
here from analog inputs AD IN 1–48. The talkback
input selection is not included in the input patch
library.
D HA (PM5D-RH model only)
Here you can switch phantom power on/off and adjust
the gain for the analog input selected in (
3). The
LEVEL volume in the TALKBACK section of the panel
does not affect the talkback input from the analog
input channel. The HA setting is included in the HA
library.
E Level meter (Analog input level meter)
This level meter indicates the peak level of the signal
being input from the analog input selected in (
3).
F ON/OFF (Analog input on/off)
This button switches the talkback input selected in (3)
on/off.
G ON/OFF (Talkback on/off)
This button switches Talkback on/off. This is linked
with the TALKBACK [ON] key in the TALKBACK sec-
tion of the panel.
H NEVER LATCH
This button selects one of the following as the mode in
which the TALKBACK ON/OFF button and the panel
TALKBACK [ON] key will behave.
If the NEVER LATCH button is off
Talkback will be switched on/off (Latched operation)
each time you click the ON/OFF button or press the
TALKBACK [ON] key. However if you press and hold
down the TALKBACK [ON] key, talkback will stay on
only while you continue holding down the key; talk-
back will turn off when you release the key (Unlatched
operation).
If the NEVER LATCH button is on
Talkback will be on only while you click and hold
down the ON/OFF button or press and hold down the
TALKBACK [ON] button; talkback will turn off when
you release the button or key (Unlatched operation).
TALKBACK screen
TALKBACK
1
2
6
5
3
4
7
8
PM5D/PM5D-RH Owner’s Manual Reference section 213
Information shown
in the display
Function
menu
Global
functions
Output
functions
Input
functions
Appendices
I BUS ASSIGN
Here you can select the bus(es) or output jack(s) from
which the talkback signal will be sent. (Multiple selec-
tions are allowed.)
MIX 1–24 . . . . . . . . MIX bus 1–24
MATRIX 1–8 . . . . . MATRIX bus 1–8
ST A L/R . . . . . . . . . STEREO A bus L/R channels
ST B L/R . . . . . . . . . STEREO B bus L/R channels
J TALKBACK OUT (Talkback direct output)
This indicates the channel of the output jack / slot that
is selected as the output destination for direct output of
the talkback signal. If more than one output destina-
tion is patched, “...” will be displayed following the
name of the output destination that was found first. If
you want to change the output destination, click the
PATCH button to access the OUTPUT PATCH screen.
’Here you can make settings and perform operations
related to the internal oscillator.
A OSC ON/OFF (Oscillator on/off)
Turns the Oscillator on/off. This is linked with the
OSCILLATOR [ON] switch of the top panel.
B OSC MODE (Oscillator mode)
These buttons select the waveform or type of noise pro-
duced by the oscillator.
SINE WAVE 1CH . Sine wave x 1 channel
SINE WAVE 2CH . Sine wave x 2 channels
PINK NOISE . . . . . Pink noise
BURST NOISE . . . . Burst noise (repeated output of
pink noise)
C PARAMETERS
Here you can set various items according to the selec-
tion in (
2).
9
J
OSCILLATOR screen
OSCILLATOR
1
3
2
MON/CUE function
214 PM5D/PM5D-RH Owner’s Manual Reference section
If SINE WAVE 1CH is selected
If SINE WAVE 2CH is selected
If PINK NOISE is selected
If BURST NOISE is selected
D LEVEL
This knob adjusts the output level of the oscillator. The
range is –96 dB to 0 dB. The level meter beside the
knob indicates the output level.
E FREQ (Frequency)
This knob specifies the frequency of the sine wave pro-
duced by the oscillator. The range is 20 Hz–20 kHz (the
current setting is shown in the numerical box below).
You can use the 10 kHz /1 kHz / 100 Hz buttons to
select a preset frequency.
Hint
If SINE WAVE 2CH is selected, you can specify the level and
frequency of each channel independently.
F HPF (High Pass Filter)
G LPF (Low Pass Filter)
Here you can make settings for the HPF/LPF through
which the pink noise or burst noise is sent. The knob
above sets the cutoff frequency (20 Hz–20 kHz), and
the button below switches the filter on/off.
H WIDTH
I INTERVAL
If burst noise is selected, these knobs select the dura-
tion of the noise itself (WIDTH) and the duration of
silence between noise bursts (INTERVAL).
The range is 0.1–10 sec for WIDTH, and 1–30 sec for
INTERVAL. (The current setting is shown in the box
below each knob.)
J OSC OUT (Oscillator direct output)
This indicates the channel of the output jack / slot that
directly outputs the oscillator signal. If you want to
change the output destination, click the PATCH but-
ton to access the OUTPUT PATCH screen.
If SINE WAVE 2CH is selected, the L channel of the
oscillator is sent to the oscillator direct output.
K BUS ASSIGN
Here you can select the bus(es) or output jack(s) from
which the sine wave or noise will be sent. (Multiple
selections are allowed.)
MIX 1–24 . . . . . . . . MIX bus 1–24
MATRIX 1–8. . . . . . MATRIX bus 1–8
AL/AR . . . . . . . . . . . STEREO A bus L/R channels
BL/BR . . . . . . . . . . . STEREO B bus L/R channels
If SINE WAVE 2CH is selected, the L channel of the
oscillator is output to the odd-numbered bus or the L
jack, and the R channel of the oscillator is output to the
even-numbered bus or the R jack.
54
54 54
6 74
6 74 98
INTERVAL
WIDTH
Level
Time
Pink noise output
The BURST NOISE button is on
J
K
PM5D/PM5D-RH Owner’s Manual Reference section 215
Information shown
in the display
Function
menu
Global
functions
Output
functions
Input
functions
Appendices
This screen contains various settings and indications for
2TR IN / 2TR OUT.
A Input level meters
These indicate the input level of 2TR IN DIGITAL
jacks 1–3 and 2TR IN ANALOG jacks 1–2.
B FREQUENCY (Sampling frequency)
Indicates the sampling frequency of the input signal
from 2TR IN DIGITAL jacks 1–3.
C SRC (Sampling Rate Converter)
These are on/off switches for the sampling rate con-
verters built into 2TR IN DIGITAL jacks 1–3.
(If turned off, this indicates “THROUGH.”)
D EMPHASIS STATUS
Indicates whether emphasis processing is being applied
to the input signal from 2TR IN DIGITAL jacks 1–3.
E Output level meter
Indicates the output level of 2TR OUT DIGITAL jacks
1–3.
F SRC (Sampling Rate Converter)
These are on/off and output frequency select switches
for the sampling rate converters built into 2TR OUT
DIGITAL jacks 1–3. As the output frequency you can
select either 44.1 kHz or 48 kHz. The on/off button
selects either ON or THROUGH (off).
G Fs (Sampling frequency)
This indicates the sampling frequency at which the
PM5D is operating.
2TR I/O screen
2TR I/O
1
2
3
4
5
6
7
MON/CUE function
216 PM5D/PM5D-RH Owner’s Manual Reference section
Here you can make settings and perform operations
related to monitoring.
A MONITOR SOURCE
Selects the source that will be monitored from the L/R/
C MONITOR OUT jacks. You can select one from 2TR
IN A1/A2, 2TR IN D1–D3, or DEFINE, and also simul-
taneously select one from STEREO A/B or LCR. These
buttons are linked with the various keys of the MONI-
TOR section in the top panel.
If a monitor source indicated by (*) is selected, the sig-
nal that is output will change depending on whether
the USE AS STEREO BUS button or the USE AS CEN-
TER BUS button is turned on in the STEREO B section
of the MIXER SETUP screen ( p.201).
If the USE AS STEREO BUS button is on
If the USE AS CENTER BUS button is on
B DEFINE
If “DEFINE” is selected in the MONITOR SOURCE
section, you can choose the signal that will be moni-
tored from the following.
MIX 1–24 . . . . . . . . MIX bus 1–24 output signal
MATRIX 1–8. . . . . . MATRIX bus 1–8 output signal
C MONITOR / CUE DELAY
Here you can make settings for the delay function pro-
vided on the MONITOR/CUE bus output. Use the
knob to specify the delay time (0–1000 msec), and use
the ON/OFF button to switch the delay on/off. If the
ON/OFF button is on, the monitor signal and cue sig-
nal will be delayed by the specified time. The delay time
units can be changed in the DELAY SCALE field found
in each screen of the INPUT DELAY/OUTPUT
DELAY function.
D DIMMER
When you turn this button on, the level of the signal
being monitored will be temporarily attenuated. The
knob adjusts the amount of attenuation that will occur
when the button is on. The range of adjustment is
–96 dB to 0 dB. While this button is on, the DIMM
indicator will appear in the upper right of the display.
Hint
You can also use an external switch connected to the GPI IN
connector to switch the dimmer on/off. To do so, assign the
MONITOR DIMMER ON function to the GPI IN port to which
the switch is connected. (
p.177).
E TALKBACK DIMMER
This adjusts the amount by which the monitor signal
will be attenuated when talkback is on. The range of
adjustment is –96 dB to 0 dB. The talkback on/off sta-
tus is shown in the box below.
2TR IN A1 2TR IN ANALOG jack 1 input signal
2TR IN A2 2TR IN ANALOG jack 2 input signal
2TR IN D1 2TR IN DIGITAL jack 1 input signal
2TR IN D2 2TR IN DIGITAL jack 2 input signal
2TR IN D3 2TR IN DIGITAL jack 3 input signal
STEREO A STEREO A channel output signal (*)
STEREO B STEREO B channel output signal (*)
LCR LCR channel output signal (*)
DEFINE
The signal selected in the DEFINE section
(
2
) of this screen
MONITOR screen
MONITOR
1
2
Monitor
source
LRC
ST A STEREO A L STEREO A R
ST B STEREO B L STEREO B R
LCR
Monitor
source
LRC
ST A STEREO A L STEREO A R
ST B
STEREO B L
LCR STEREO A L STEREO A R
3 4 5
PM5D/PM5D-RH Owner’s Manual Reference section 217
Information shown
in the display
Function
menu
Global
functions
Output
functions
Input
functions
Appendices
F Level meter
These peak level meters indicate the level of the output
signal from the MONITOR OUT jacks. You can select
the level detection point to be immediately before the
delay that is provided on the MONITOR/CUE bus
output (when the PRE DELAY button is on) or imme-
diately after the delay (when the POST DELAY button
is on).
G CUE INTERRUPTION
If this button is on, the cue/solo signal will also be out-
put from the MONITOR OUT jacks while the Cue/
Solo function is active. During this time, the monitor
source selected in the MONITOR SOURCE section
will be disabled.
If this button is off, the cue/solo signal will never be
output from the MONITOR OUT jacks.
H MONITOR MODE
Here you can select one of the following two ways in
which the signal will be output from the MONITOR
OUT jacks.
STEREO . . . . The L/R channels will be output in
stereo.
MONO . . . . . . The L/R channels will be mixed, and
output in monaural.
The status of these two buttons is linked with on/off
operations of the [MONO] key in the MONITOR sec-
tion of the panel.
I OUTPUT ON/OFF
This is an on/off switch for the signal that is output
from the MONITOR OUT jacks.
J MONITOR INSERT
This area shows the input jacks (and input channels of
the digital I/O card) that are inserted into the MONI-
TOR OUT L/C/R channels. The input level of the
inserted signal is shown by the level meter at the right.
If GEQ or EFFECT is inserted, the corresponding
information is shown here.
K INSERT ON/OFF
This button enables/disables insertion.
L PATCH
Displays the INSERT PATCH screen.
Here you can make settings and perform operations
related to the Cue/Solo function.
A SOLO ON/OFF
This button selects either
CUE mode or SOLO mode
as the type of monitoring
performed by the [CUE]
key. When you turn this
button on, a confirmation
message will appear. Each
mode operates as follows.
CUE mode (SOLO ON/
OFF button is off)
The signal of the channel
whose [CUE] key is
pressed will be sent to the
dedicated CUE bus, and
monitored via the CUE
bus from the CUE OUT
jacks, MONITOR OUT
jacks (if CUE INTERRUP-
TION is on), and PHONE
jack. This mode lets you
monitor the signal of a
specific channel without
affecting other buses.
SOLO mode (SOLO ON/OFF button is on)
When using Input Solo, the familiar “solo” function is
enabled; only the signal of the channel whose [CUE]
key is pressed will be sent to the MIX, MATRIX, and
STEREO A/B buses, and other channels will be muted.
When using Output Solo, only that channel will be on.
The signal of a channel whose [CUE] key is pressed can
also be monitored from the CUE OUT jacks, MONI-
TOR OUT jacks, and PHONES jack.
7
8
6
9
J
K
L
CUE/SOLO screen
CUE/SOLO
1
2
4
3
MON/CUE function
218 PM5D/PM5D-RH Owner’s Manual Reference section
B CUE MODE
This button selects one of the following two possibili-
ties for when the [CUE] key of more than one channel
is pressed.
MIX CUE mode
All channels / DCA groups whose [CUE] key is on will
be mixed for monitoring.
Note
As an exception to MIX CUE, turning on a CUE button in the
EFFECT PARAM screen or GATE PARAM screen or turning
on a CUE button in the DME CONTROL screen (EXTERNAL
CUE) will give priority to monitoring only the corresponding
signal. (Any [CUE] keys that had been on until then will be
forcibly defeated.)
LAST CUE mode
Only the channel / DCA group whose [CUE] key was
pressed last will be monitored.
C CUE FUNCTION
These buttons let you turn on/off various functions
related to Cue. You can select the following functions.
MIX CUE LINK
Specifies whether cue operations will be linked to MIX
channel selection. If this button is on, pressing the mix
key selected in the ENCODER MODE section of the
panel once again will simultaneously switch on the
[CUE] key of that channel.
CUE/SEL LINK
Specifies whether channel selection will be linked with
cue operations. If this button is on, pressing the [CUE]
key of a channel will simultaneously select that chan-
nel and light its [SEL] key.
FADER/CUE RELEASE
This specifies whether cue operations will be restricted
according to the fader position. If this button is on, cue
will be defeated if you raise the fader from the – dB
position for a channel whose [CUE] key is lit. For a
channel whose fader is above the
dB position, cue operation will not be possible.
(Pressing the [CUE] key will do nothing.) This means
that cue can be turned on only when the fader is at the
dB position.
D CUE OUT
Turns the cue output on/off.
E INPUT
Here you can select the position from which an input
channel will be cued.
PFL (Pre-Fader Listen)
. . . . . . . Immediately before the fader
AFL (After-Fader Listen)
. . . . . . . Immediately after the fader
POST PAN . . . . . . . Immediately after pan
If you select PFL, you can also use the knob located at
the left to adjust the output level in a range of
–20 dB to +10 dB.
F DCA
Here you can make cue output settings for DCA
groups.
DCA TRIM
Adjusts the level of cue output from a DCA group in a
range of –20 dB to +10 dB.
DCA UNITY
If this button is on, pressing a DCA [CUE] key will
always monitor the corresponding DCA group at unity
gain (the same level at when the DCA fader is at 0 dB).
Hint
If you leave the DCA UNITY button on, you will be able to
monitor the desired DCA group even if that DCA group is
muted or its fader is lowered.
Even when the DCA UNITY button is on, the value specified
by the DCA TRIM knob is still valid. (In this case, the DCA
TRIM knob specifies an offset value relative to unity gain.)
PRE PAN/POST PAN
This selects whether the pre-pan signal (PRE PAN but-
ton on) or the post-pan signal (POST PAN button is
on) will be monitored when the DCA [CUE] button is
turned on.
G OUTPUT
Here you can select the position from which an output
channel will be cued.
PFL (Pre-Fader Listen)
. . . . . . . . Immediately before the fader
POST ON . . . Immediately after the [ON] key
If you select PFL, you can also use the knob located at
the left to adjust the output level in a range of
–20 dB to +10 dB.
5 6 7
PM5D/PM5D-RH Owner’s Manual Reference section 219
Information shown
in the display
Function
menu
Global
functions
Output
functions
Input
functions
Appendices
H INPUT SOLO SAFE
Here you can specify input channels that will be
excluded from Solo operations. (You can specify more
than one.) The buttons correspond to the following
input channels.
I OUTPUT SOLO SAFE
Here you can specify output channels that will be
excluded from Solo operations. (You can specify more
than one.) The buttons correspond to the following
output channels.
Hint
Solo Safe settings and Cue on/off operations are linked for
paired channels. Solo Safe operations can be performed inde-
pendently of the scene memory.
J Level meter
This is a peak level meter that indicates the level of the
signals output from the CUE OUT jacks. You can select
the level detection point to be immediately befor the
delay that is provided on the MONITOR/CUE bus
output (when the PRE DELAY button is on), or imme-
diately after the delay (when the POST DELAY button
is on).
K MONITOR / CUE DELAY
Here you can make settings for the delay function pro-
vided on the MONITOR/CUE bus output. Use the
knob to specify the delay time (0–1000 msec), and use
the DELAY button to switch the delay on/off. In gen-
eral, this is linked with the MONITOR/CUE DELAY
setting in the MONITOR screen. However, the differ-
ence is that in this screen, turning the AUTO BYPASS
button on lets you automatically bypass the delay when
you perform the Cue any input channels.
INPUT 1–48 Input channels 1–48
ST IN 1–4 ST IN channels 1–4
FX RTN 1–4 FX RTN channels 1–4
SET ALL
Sets all input channels to the Solo
Safe condition
CLEAR ALL
Defeats the Solo Safe setting for
all input channels
MIX 1–24 MIX channels 1–24
MATRIX 1–8 MATRIX channels 1–8
STEREO A/B STEREO A/B channels
SET ALL
Sets all output channels to the
Solo Safe condition
CLEAR ALL
Defeats the Solo Safe setting for
all output channels
8
9
J
K
Output functions
220 PM5D/PM5D-RH Owner’s Manual Reference section
OUTPUT PATCH function
Here you can make patch settings to send output channel
signals to the outputs of I/O cards installed in the slots, to
the input of internal effects, and to the 2TR OUT DIGI-
TAL jacks.
A SELECTED PATCH
This indicates the output channel number and output
port of the grid at which the cursor is located.
B CH (Output channel)
This is the number of the output channel (MIX chan-
nel, MATRIX channel, STEREO A/B channel,
MONITOR L/C/R channel, TALKBACK OUT chan-
nel, OSC OUT channel) whose output destination will
be patched. The channel number at which the cursor is
located will be highlighted.
C ASSIGN
For each output channel, this indicates the number of
output ports that are currently assigned.
D Grid
This grid lets you patch output ports (horizontal rows)
to output channels (vertical columns). Currently-
patched grids are indicated by a symbol. By clicking
a grid location you can set/cancel patching.
The red lines at the left and top indicate the grid loca-
tion to which you move the cursor.
Hint
If PATCH CONFIRMATION is turned on in the PREFER-
ENCE 1 screen (UTILITY function), a confirmation message
will appear each time you attempt to change a patch set-
ting. If STEAL PATCH CONFIRMATION is turned on, a
confirmation message will also appear when you attempt to
make patch settings that would cause an existing patch to
be modified.
To move the cursor location rapidly in or out of the grid, hold
down the [SHIFT] key and press the CURSOR [
]/[
®
]/[
π
]/
[
] keys.
To move rapidly to left or right inside the grid, turn the
[DATA] encoder. To move up or down, hold down the
[SHIFT] key and turn the [DATA] encoder.
Note
You can patch an output channel to more than one output
port, but you cannot patch multiple output channels to a sin-
gle output port.
E Output port
From the top, this area indicates the type of output
port, the ID number, the output channel number, and
the number of output channels assigned. The follow-
ing types of output port can be selected.
F LIBRARY button
This button accesses the OUTPUT PATCH LIBRARY
screen (p.223), where you can store/recall patch
library settings for output channels.
Hint
The signal from immediately after the delay and immedi-
ately before the output port attenuation will be sent to output
ports you patch in this screen. Subsequently, in the case of
SLOT OUT and 2TR OUT, the specified output port attenua-
tion will be applied respectively.
The rear panel MIX OUT jacks 1–24, MATRIX OUT jacks 1–
8, and STEREO OUT jacks A/B always output the signal of
the corresponding output channel. They are not affected by
the settings in this screen.
Output functions
OUTPUT PATCH screen
OUTPUT PATCH
5
1
2
34
SLOT OUT
Output channels of an I/O card installed in slots
1–4
FX IN
L/R inputs of internal effects 1–8 (MIX chan-
nels are the only output channels that can be
selected)
2TR OUT L/R channels of 2TR OUT DIGITAL jacks 1–3
6
PM5D/PM5D-RH Owner’s Manual Reference section 221
Information shown
in the display
Function
menu
Global
functions
Output
functions
Input
functions
Appendices
In this screen you can patch the input/output ports into
which external devices will be inserted. Select the output
port in the left side of the screen, and the input port in the
right side of the screen.
A SELECTED PATCH
This indicates the number of the output channel at
which the cursor is located in the grid.
B Insert in/out
This indicates the input/output ports that are patched
as insert in/out for the output channel at which the
cursor is located. If multiple ports are assigned for
insert-out, only the first port is displayed.
C CH (Output channel)
This area shows the numbers of the output channels
(MIX channels, MATRIX channels, STEREO A/B
channels, MONITOR L/R/C channels). The channel
number at which the cursor is located will be
highlighted.
D ASSIGN
For each output channel, this indicates the number of
output ports that are currently assigned as insert-out.
E Grid
For each output channel (vertical column), this grid
lets you can patch one or more output ports (horizon-
tal row) to be used as insert-outs. Currently-patched
grids are indicated by a symbol.
By clicking a grid location you can set/cancel patching.
The red lines at the left and top indicate the grid loca-
tion to which you move the cursor.
Hint
Operations in the grid are the same for all of the patching
screens. For details, refer to the Hint on p.220.
F Output port
From the top, this area indicates the type of output
port, the ID number, the output channel number, and
the number of output channels assigned. The follow-
ing types of output port can be patched as insert-out.
Hint
If you select FX IN as an insert-out, the output of the same
internal effect will automatically be selected as the insert-in. If
you select GEQ IN, the output of the same GEQ module will
automatically be selected as the insert-in.
G ASSIGN
For each input channel, this indicates the number of
input ports that are currently assigned as insert-in.
H Input port
From the top, this area indicates the type of input port,
the ID number, the input channel number, and the
number of input channels assigned. The following
types of input port can be selected.
INSERT PATCH screen
INSERT PATCH
21
6
3
45
SLOT OUT
Output channels of an I/O card installed in slots
1–4
FX IN L/R inputs of internal effects 1–8
GEQ IN Inputs of internal GEQ modules 1–12
2TR OUT L/R channels of 2TR OUT DIGITAL jacks 1–3
AD IN INPUT jacks 1–48
AD ST IN ST IN jacks 1–4 L/R
SLOT IN
Input channels of an I/O card installed in slots
1–4
FX OUT L/R outputs of internal effects 1–8
GEQ OUT Outputs of GEQ modules 1–12
2TR IN
L/R channels of 2TR IN DIGITAL jacks 1–3 and
2TR IN ANALOG jacks 1/2
8
7
OUTPUT PATCH function
222 PM5D/PM5D-RH Owner’s Manual Reference section
I LIBRARY button
This button accesses the OUTPUT PATCH LIBRARY
screen (p.223), where you can store/recall patch
library settings for output channels.
Using the [SHIFT] key + CURSOR []/
[®] to move the cursor
When operating from the panel, you can move the cur-
sor from the right side of the screen to the left side (or
vice versa) by holding down the [SHIFT] key and using
the CURSOR []/[®] keys.
To quickly move the cursor in or out of the grid, hold
down the [SHIFT] key and press the CURSOR []/
[®]/[π]/[] keys.
Note
To enable an insert-in assigned to an output channel in this
screen, you must turn on the ON/OFF button for the corre-
sponding output channel in the INSERT POINT screen
(OUTPUT PATCH function). (
p.222) However, the insert-
out is always on, regardless of the state of the ON/OFF but-
ton. An exception to the above is that if you insert GEQ, its
insert-in will automatically be on.
In this screen you can select the position at which the
insert-in/out of each output channel will be patched. Here
you can also switch insert-in on/off.
A Insert view
When you move the cursor to the insert I/O point
(
4), the insert point for that output channel will be
shown graphically.
B OUTPUT CH (Output channel)
This is the number of the output channel you are edit-
ing. Two paired channels are indicated by a heart
symbol shown at the left; settings 34 will be linked
for these channels. You can click this symbol to enable/
disable pairing.
C ON/OFF (Insert on/off)
This button switches insert on/off for each channel.
This is linked for paired channels.
Note
Be aware that if you turn on this button when either insert-in or
insert-out are unpatched, the signal will no longer be output
from the corresponding output channel.
D INSERT I/O (Insert I/O point)
Here you can select one of the following as the insert-
in/out location for each output channel.
9
[SHIFT] key
+
CURSOR [®] key
Cursor
Cursor will move
PRE EQ Immediately before the EQ
POST EQ Immediately after the EQ
PRE FADER Immediately before the fader
POST ON Immediately after the [ON] key
INSERT POINT screen
INSERT POINT
1
2 34
PM5D/PM5D-RH Owner’s Manual Reference section 223
Information shown
in the display
Function
menu
Global
functions
Output
functions
Input
functions
Appendices
Here you can recall, store, rename, or delete items in the
output patch library.
A EDIT
When you click this button, the OUTPUT PATCH
screen will appear.
B Patch information for the current scene
This area shows the output patch settings for the cur-
rent scene.
C RECALL
Recalls the output patch library item selected in the list
into memory.
D STORE
Stores the current settings of the OUTPUT PATCH
screen into the location selected in the list. When you
click this button a window will appear, allowing you to
name and save the settings.
E TITLE EDIT
Edits the title of the library item selected in the list.
When you click this button a window will appear,
allowing you to edit the title.
F CLEAR
Deletes the library item selected in the list. When you
click this button, a confirmation message will appear.
Note
Library items with an “R” displayed in the right column of the
list are read-only. Read-only items cannot be stored,
renamed, or deleted.
G Patch settings of the library item
Displays the settings of the library item selected in the
list.
H Library list
Use the scroll bar to select the library item on which
you want to perform an operation. The selected library
item will move to the center, and will be highlighted.
OUTPUT PATCH LIBRARY screen
OUTPUT PATCH LIBRARY
1
2
3
4
5
6
8
7
OUTPUT INSERT function
224 PM5D/PM5D-RH Owner’s Manual Reference section
OUTPUT INSERT function
Here you can make settings for the internal HA (PM5D-
RH model only) or external HA assigned to the insert-in of
an output channel or MONITOR L/C/R channel.
A +48V
Switches phantom power (+48V) on/off for each
channel.
B HPF (High Pass Filter)
Turns the HPF on/off for each channel.
C Cutoff frequency
Specifies the HPF cutoff frequency for each channel.
Move the cursor to the box, and turn the [DATA]
encoder to adjust the cutoff frequency in a range of 20–
600 Hz.
D GAIN
Adjusts the gain for each channel. Move the cursor to
the knob, and turn the [DATA] encoder to adjust the
attenuation in a range of +10 dB to –62 dB. The cur-
rent value is shown in the box below each knob.
Note
Since settings
1
4
are for the patched input port, they are
linked for channels that are patched to the same port.
E Input port
This indicates the type and number of the input port
assigned to the insert-in of that channel.
Note
Items
1
4
are not shown for channels to whose insert-in
nothing is patched, or for channels patched to an input port
that does not have a HA. Items
2
and
3
are not shown for
channels patched to a port that has no high pass filter.
Use the INSERT PATCH screen (OUTPUT PATCH func-
tion) to patch an input port to an insert-in.
F Channel
This is the number of the channel you are editing. Two
paired channels are indicated by a heart symbol dis-
played between them.
Note
HA settings are not linked even if two channels are paired.
However, the GAIN knob setting is linked for HAs whose
GANG button is turned on in the HA screen (SYS/W.CLOCK
function).
Hint
The HA settings you edit in this screen are also reflected in
the HA screen (SYS/W.CLOCK function).
INSERT IN MIX 1-24 screen
INSERT IN MATRIX/STEREO/MONI-
TOR screen
INSERT IN MIX1-24
INSERT IN MATRIX/STEREO/MONITOR
1
2
3
5
6
4
PM5D/PM5D-RH Owner’s Manual Reference section 225
Information shown
in the display
Function
menu
Global
functions
Output
functions
Input
functions
Appendices
This screen is shared with HA LIBRARY in the SYS/
W.CLOCK function (p.208).
OUTPUT EQ function
Here you can edit the EQ parameters of the selected out-
put channel.
(If a MIX channel or STEREO A/B channel is selected)
(If a MATRIX channel is selected)
HA LIBRARY screen
HA LIBRARY
EQ PARAM (EQ Parameter) screen
EQ PARAM
EQ PARAM
OUTPUT EQ function
226 PM5D/PM5D-RH Owner’s Manual Reference section
A Channel selection
Select the output channel that you want to edit. You
can use eight-band EQ (four UPPER bands + four
LOWER bands) for MIX channels and STEREO A/B
channels, and four-band EQ for MATRIX channels.
If a channel is paired (or if a STEREO A/B channel is
selected), a heart symbol is displayed at the right. For
MIX channels or MATRIX channels, you can click this
symbol to enable/disable pairing.
B EQ ON/OFF (EQ on/off)
Turns the EQ on/off for that channel.
C EQ LINK GROUP
Selects the EQ link group (A–H) to which the EQ of
that channel belongs. EQ parameters are linked for
output channels belonging to the same group.
Note
The EQ of MIX channels and STEREO A/B channels can be
assigned only to groups A–F, and the EQ of MATRIX chan-
nels can be assigned only to groups G/H.
D LIBRARY
This button accesses the OUTPUT EQ LIBRARY
screen (p.228), where you can store/recall EQ
library settings for output channels.
E EQ TYPE
Selects the type of EQ. Turning the TYPE I button on
selects the algorithm used in the 02R series. Turning
the TYPE II button on selects a newly developed algo-
rithm. TYPE II reduces the interference between bands.
F EQ graph
This graph shows the approximate response of the EQ
parameters. The colored vertical lines indicate the
FREQ (center frequency) of the band for the parame-
ter at which the cursor is located. (The color of each
line matches the knob markings for each band.) The
response curve will change when you edit the Q or
GAIN of each band.
G Level meter
These meters indicate the peak levels before EQ and
after EQ. If the signal clips before EQ, the OVER seg-
ment will light.
H EQ FLAT
This button resets the GAIN parameters of all bands to
the default value (±0.0 dB). When you click this but-
ton, a confirmation message will appear.
I LOWER/UPPER (only for MIX channels and
STEREO A/B channels)
This indicator shows which four bands (LOWER or
UPPER) are selected in the SELECTED CHANNEL
section of the panel. The text label of the selected group
is displayed in yellow.
J Knobs
These knobs adjust the Q, FREQ (center frequency),
and GAIN (amount of boost/cut) for each band.
K BYPASS
These buttons bypass each band of the EQ.
L (LOW shelving)
If this button is on, the LOW EQ will function as a
shelving-type EQ. The Q knob will disappear.
M HPF (High Pass Filter)
If this button is on, the LOW EQ will function as a
high-pass filter. The Q knob will disappear, and the
GAIN knob is used to switch the HPF on/off.
N (HIGH shelving)
If this button is on, the HIGH EQ will function as a
shelving-type EQ. The Q knob will disappear.
O LPF (Low Pass Filter)
If this button is on, the HIGH EQ will function as a
low-pass filter. The Q knob will disappear, and the
GAIN knob is used to switch the LPF on/off.
5
1 2 4
8 7
36
9
K
J
L M N O
PM5D/PM5D-RH Owner’s Manual Reference section 227
Information shown
in the display
Function
menu
Global
functions
Output
functions
Input
functions
Appendices
These screens list the EQ settings for all output channels.
Here you can also copy EQ settings between output
channels.
A EQ graph
This mini-graph shows the approximate EQ response
for each output channel.
When you click the graph at which the cursor is cur-
rently located, the EQ PARAM screen for that channel
will appear.
In this screen you can drag and drop the mini-graph
from the desired channel to copy its EQ settings.
(When you drag and drop the mini-graph, a message
will ask you to confirm the copy operation.)
You can also copy EQ settings between the MIX 1-24
screen and the MATRIX/STEREO screen. First drag the
mini-graph over the MIX 1-24 tab or MATRIX/STE-
REO tab in the screen (the screen will switch). Then
drag and drop the mini-graph onto the desired chan-
nel, and a message will ask you to confirm the copy
operation.
You can also copy settings between the eight-band EQ
of a MIX channel or STEREO A/B channel and the
four-band EQ of a MATRIX channel. In this case, only
the LOWER four bands will be copied for MIX chan-
nels or STEREO A/B channels.
B EQ ON/OFF (EQ on/off)
Turns the EQ on/off for that channel. This is linked for
paired channels.
C Channel
This is the number of the channel you are editing. Two
paired channels are indicated by a heart symbol dis-
played between them.
D Level meter
This meter indicates the peak level after EQ. If the sig-
nal clips, the OVER segment will light.
MIX 1-24 screen
MATRIX/STEREO screen
MIX 1-24
MATRIX/STEREO
3
4 1 2
OUTPUT EQ function
228 PM5D/PM5D-RH Owner’s Manual Reference section
Here you can recall, store, rename, or delete items in the
output EQ library.
A EDIT
When you click this button, the EQ PARAM screen for
the currently selected output channel will appear.
B Channel selection
Select the channel that you want to edit.
C EQ graph for the selected channel
This graph shows the approximate response of the EQ
for the currently selected channel.
D Level meter
These meters indicate the peak levels before EQ and
after EQ. If the signal clips before EQ, the OVER seg-
ment will light.
E RECALL
Recalls the EQ library item selected in the list into
memory.
F STORE
Stores the EQ settings of the currently selected channel
into the location selected in the list. When you click
this button a window will appear, allowing you to
name and save the settings.
G TITLE EDIT
Edits the title of the library item selected in the list.
When you click this button a window will appear,
allowing you to edit the title.
H CLEAR
Deletes the library item selected in the list. When you
click this button, a confirmation message will appear.
Note
Library items with an “R” displayed in the right column of the
list are read-only. Read-only items cannot be stored,
renamed, or deleted.
I Library EQ graph
This graph indicates the approximate response of the
EQ library item selected in the list. The LIBRARY
TYPE indication shows whether the item contains
eight-band EQ settings (MIX, STEREO A/B) or four-
band EQ settings (MATRIX).
J Library list
Use the scroll bar to select the library item on which
you want to perform an operation. The selected library
item will move to the center, and will be highlighted.
OUTPUT EQ LIBRARY screen
OUTPUT EQ LIBRARY
1
2
3
4
5
6
7
8
J
9
PM5D/PM5D-RH Owner’s Manual Reference section 229
Information shown
in the display
Function
menu
Global
functions
Output
functions
Input
functions
Appendices
OUTPUT COMP function
Here you can edit the compressor parameters of the
selected output channel.
A Channel selection
Select the channel that you want to edit. If the corre-
sponding MIX channel or MATRIX channel is paired
(or if a STEREO A/B channel is selected), a heart sym-
bol is displayed at the right. For MIX channels or
MATRIX channels, you can click this symbol to
enable/disable pairing.
B COMP ON/OFF (Compressor on/off)
Turns the compressor on/off for that channel.
C COMP LINK GROUP (Compressor link
group)
Selects the compressor link group (A–H) to which that
channel belongs. Compressor parameters are linked for
output channels belonging to the same group.
D LIBRARY
This button accesses the COMP LIBRARY screen
(p.232), where you can store/recall compressor
library settings for output channels.
E Level meters
These meters indicate the amount of gain reduction
(GR), the peak level before (PRE) and after (POST) the
compressor, and the peak level of the key-in signal
(KEY IN) that causes the compressor to operate. If the
signal clips, the OVER segment will light.
If stereo link is turned on for the corresponding MIX
channel or MATRIX channel (or if a STEREO A/B
channel is selected), level meters for two channels are
displayed.
Hint
If GR METER ON/OFF LINK is turned on in the PREFER-
ENCE 1 screen (UTILITY function), the gain reduction meter
will not be displayed when the compressor is off.
F Type
Indicates the type of the currently selected compressor.
Hint
To change the compressor type, use the OUTPUT COMP
LIBRARY screen to recall a library item that has a different
type. You cannot change the compressor type in this screen.
G STEREO LINK
This specifies whether parameter settings and compres-
sor operation by a key-in signal will be linked
(STEREO LINK button on) for adjacent odd-num-
bered/even-numbered MIX/MATRIX channels or the
L/R channels of the STEREO A/B channels, or not
(STEREO LINK button off).
COMP PARAM (Compressor parame-
ter) screen
COMP PARAM
1 2 43
5
6 97 8
OUTPUT COMP function
230 PM5D/PM5D-RH Owner’s Manual Reference section
Key-in signal flow when Link= On
Key-in signal flow when Link= Off
Note
Stereo Link is fixed at On for paired channels and for STE-
REO A/B channels.
H Compressor graph
This graph displays the approximate response of the
compressor.
I KEY IN SOURCE
Select the desired key-in signal from the following
choices.
J THRESHOLD (Threshold level)
Specifies the threshold level at which the compressor
will operate. The input signal will start being com-
pressed when the key-in signal exceeds this level;
compression will be removed when the signal falls
below this level.
K RATIO
Specifies the ratio at which the input signal will be
compressed when the key-in signal exceeds the thresh-
old level.
L ATTACK (Attack time)
Specifies the time from when the key-in signal exceeds
the threshold level until compression begins.
M RELEASE (Release time)
Specifies the time from when the key-in signal falls
below the threshold level until compression is
removed.
N GAIN
Specifies the output level gain.
O KNEE
Select the sharpness at which the output level changes;
the range is HARD or 1–5. HARD produces the sharp-
est change, and 5 produces the most gradual change.
SELF PRE EQ
The pre-EQ signal of the currently
selected output channel
SELF POST EQ
The post-EQ signal of the currently
selected output channel
MIX1–24 POST EQ The post-EQ signal of the corre-
sponding output channel (however,
you can only select from the group
to which that channel belongs,
from the three groups MIX 1–12,
MIX 13–24, and MATRIX/ST)
MATRIX1–8 POST EQ
ST AL/AR POST EQ
ST BL/BR POST EQ
MIX21–24 OUT
The output signal of the corre-
sponding MIX channel immedi-
ately before the output port
attenuation
GR
THR
THR
LINK= ON
GR
Key-in signal of odd-
numbered channel
Key-in signal of even-
numbered channel
AT TACK
processing
AT TACK
processing
Detect the
maximum
level
GR
THR
THR
LINK= OFF
GR
Key-in signal of odd-
numbered channel
Key-in signal of even-
numbered channel
AT TACK
processing
AT TACK
processing
Detect the
maximum level
Detect the
maximum level
J K L M N O
PM5D/PM5D-RH Owner’s Manual Reference section 231
Information shown
in the display
Function
menu
Global
functions
Output
functions
Input
functions
Appendices
These screens show the compressor settings for all output
channels. Here you can also copy compressor settings
between output channels.
A Compressor graph
This mini-graph shows the approximate compressor
response for each output channel.
When you click the graph at which the cursor is cur-
rently located, the COMP PARAM screen for that
channel will appear.
In this screen you can drag and drop the mini-graph
from the desired channel to copy its compressor set-
tings. (When you drag and drop the mini-graph, a
popup window will ask you to confirm the copy
operation.)
You can also copy compressor settings between the
MIX 1-24 screen and the MATRIX/STEREO screen.
First drag the mini-graph over the MIX 1-24 tab or
MATRIX/STEREO tab in the screen (the screen will
switch). Then drag and drop the mini-graph onto the
desired channel, and a message will ask you to confirm
the copy operation.
B Level meters
These meters show the amount of gain reduction pro-
duced by the compressor (at left), and the peak level of
the signal after passing through the compressor (at
right). If the signal clips, the OVER segment will light.
C COMP ON/OFF (Compressor on/off)
Turns the compressor on/off for that channel.
D Channel
This is the number of the channel you are editing. Two
paired channels are indicated by a heart symbol dis-
played between them.
MIX 1-24 screen
MATRIX/STEREO screen
MIX 1-24
MATRIX/STEREO
4
2
3
1
OUTPUT COMP function
232 PM5D/PM5D-RH Owner’s Manual Reference section
Here you can recall, store, rename, or delete items in the
compressor library. The contents of this screen are in com-
mon with the COMP LIBRARY screen of the INPUT
GATE/COMP function.
A EDIT
When you click this button, the COMP PARAM screen
for the currently selected channel will appear.
B Channel selection
Select the channel that you want to edit.
C Compressor graph of the selected channel
This graph shows the approximate response of the
compressor for the currently selected channel.
D Level meters
These meters show the amount of gain reduction (GR),
and the peak levels before the compressor (PRE) and
after the compressor (POST). If the signal clips, the
OVER segment will light.
E RECALL
Recalls the compressor library item selected in the list
into memory.
F STORE
Stores the compressor settings of the currently selected
channel into the location selected in the list. When you
click this button a window will appear, allowing you to
name and save the settings.
G TITLE EDIT
Edits the title of the library item selected in the list.
When you click this button a window will appear,
allowing you to edit the title.
H CLEAR
Deletes the library item selected in the list. When you
click this button, a confirmation message will appear.
Note
Library items with an “R” displayed in the right column of the
list are read-only. Read-only items cannot be stored,
renamed, or deleted.
I Compressor graph of the library item
This graph indicates the approximate response of the
compressor library item selected in the list.
J Library list
Use the scroll bar to select the library item on which
you want to perform an operation. The selected library
item will move to the center, and will be highlighted.
COMP LIBRARY (Compressor library)
screen
COMP LIBRARY
1
2
3
4
5
6
7
8
J
9
PM5D/PM5D-RH Owner’s Manual Reference section 233
Information shown
in the display
Function
menu
Global
functions
Output
functions
Input
functions
Appendices
OUTPUT DELAY function
Here you can edit the delay parameters of the selected out-
put channel.
A DELAY SCALE
The unit you select here is used to indicate the delay
time in the box below the delay time knob (
3) and in
other screens. You can choose one of the following
units.
METER
The distance in meters, calculated as the speed of
sound at an air temperature of 20°C (343.59 m/s) x the
delay time (seconds).
FEET
The distance in feet, calculated as the speed of sound at
an air temperature of 20°C (68°F) (1127.26 feet/s) x
the delay time (seconds).
SAMPLE
The delay time is shown as a number of samples. If you
change the sampling frequency at which the PM5D
operates, the number of samples will change
accordingly.
msec (milliseconds)
The delay time is shown in units of milliseconds. If this
button is on, the boxes above and below the delay time
knob (
3) will show the same values.
BEAT
The delay time is shown in units relative to the note
length (considered as 1.0) specified by the tempo
(BPM) and note value (NOTE).
To specify the tempo, you can either use the /
buttons located immediately below the BEAT button,
or repeatedly tap (click) the TAP button, or repeatedly
click a User Defined key that is assigned to [TAP
TEMPO]-[CURRENT PAGE].
FRAME
The delay time is shown in units of frames.
Use the six buttons located below the FRAME button
to select the number of frames per second.
Hint
If you change the DELAY SCALE setting of the OUTPUT
DELAY function screen, the DELAY SCALE setting of the
INPUT DELAY function screen will change in tandem.
The TAP button of the OUTPUT DELAY function is indepen-
dent from the TAP TEMPO button of the internal effect.
The number of frames per second is linked with the TIME
CODE SETUP field in the EVENT LIST screen (SCENE
function).
B GANG
This button specifies whether the delay parameters will
be linked for adjacent odd-numbered/even-numbered
channels. This can be specified independently of pair-
ing. If the GANG button is turned on for channels of
differing delay times, turning the delay time knob (
3)
will change the delay times of both channels while
maintaining the difference in their delay time.
C Delay time knob
This knob sets the delay time of each channel. The box
below the knob shows the delay time in the units you
selected in (
1). The box above the knob always shows
the delay time in millisecond units.
D DELAY ON/OFF
This button switches delay on/off. This is linked for
paired channels.
E Channel
This is the number of the channel you are editing. Two
paired channels are indicated by a heart symbol dis-
played between them. You can click this symbol to
enable/disable pairing.
MIX 1-24 screen
MATRIX/STEREO screen
MIX1-24
MATRIX/STEREO
1
2
3
4
5
OUTPUT DCA/GROUP function
234 PM5D/PM5D-RH Owner’s Manual Reference section
OUTPUT DCA/GROUP func-
tion
Here you can specify the output channels that will be
assigned to DCA groups 7/8. You can use DCA faders 7/8
to uniformly adjust the levels of output channels belong-
ing to the same DCA group.
A DCA group
This is the number of the DCA group. The number
corresponding to the grid where the cursor is located is
highlighted.
B Name
This is the name of the DCA group. You can also click
this area to edit the name.
C Grid
This grid lets you assign output channels (horizontal
rows) to DCA groups (vertical columns). Currently-
patched grids are indicated by a symbol. Move the
cursor to the desired grid and press the [ENTER] key
(or click) to set/disable the assignment.
Hint
You can also assign an output channel to both DCA groups
for multiple DCA control.
DCA groups 1–6 are for input channels only, but DCA
groups 7/8 can be used with both input channels and output
channels. DCA groups 7/8 allow you to use both types of
channel in the identically-numbered group.
D SET BY CUE (Assign by [CUE] key)
This specifies whether the [CUE] key will be used to
make/cancel DCA group assignments. While the DCA
group SET BY CUE button is on, pressing the [CUE]
key of a channel that can be assigned to the corre-
sponding group will assign the channel to the group.
(Press the [CUE] key once again to cancel the
assignment.)
Hint
The SET BY CUE button can be turned on for only one DCA
group. This is automatically turned off when you change
screens or turn off the power.
To turn on SET BY CUE from the panel, press the ASSIGN
MODE [DCA] key and then turn on the DCA group 7/8
[CUE] key.
E CLEAR
This button clears all output channels assigned to that
DCA group.
F MUTE
These buttons switch muting on/off for DCA groups 7/
8. They are linked with DCA [MUTE] keys 7/8 in the
DCA strip of the panel.
G DCA faders
These faders adjust the levels of DCA groups 7/8. They
are linked with DCA faders 7/8 in the DCA strip.
H CUE
These buttons cue-monitor DCA groups 7/8. They are
linked with DCA [CUE] keys 7/8 in the DCA strip of
the panel.
I DCA LEVEL SET
Use the following two buttons to operate DCA groups
7/8 together.
ALL NOMINAL
Clicking this button will move DCA faders 7/8 to nom-
inal level (0 dB).
ALL MINIMUM
Clicking this button will move DCA faders 7/8 to the
dB position.
DCA GROUP ASSIGN screen
DCA GROUP ASSIGN
213
54
6
8
7
9
PM5D/PM5D-RH Owner’s Manual Reference section 235
Information shown
in the display
Function
menu
Global
functions
Output
functions
Input
functions
Appendices
Here you can specify the output channels that will be
assigned to mute groups 1–8. Muting can be switched on/
off together for channels assigned to the same mute group.
A Mute group
This area shows the mute group number. The number
corresponding to the grid where the cursor is located is
highlighted.
B MUTE (Mute master)
These buttons switch muting on/off for each mute
group. These buttons are linked with the SCENE
MEMORY [1]–[8] keys of the panel (if the MUTE
MASTER button is On in the constantly-shown area at
the bottom of the display).
Hint
When you turn muting on, channels belonging to that mute
group will behave just as though their panel [ON] key had
been turned off; no signal will be output. During this time, the
panel [ON] key LED will blink.
C Grid
This grid lets you assign output channels (horizontal
rows) to mute groups (vertical columns). Currently-
patched grids are indicated by a symbol. Move the
cursor to the desired grid and press the [ENTER] key
(or click) to set/cancel the assignment.
D MUTE SAFE
These buttons temporarily defeat the muted state of a
channel. When a button is displayed as “–”, clicking it
will change its display to “ON,” and the corresponding
output channel will be excluded from mute groups.
Clicking the button once again restores the original
state.
Note
Normally, Mute Safe operations can be performed indepen-
dently of the scene memory.
Hint
Mute groups 1–8 can be used with both input channels and
output channels. Both types of channel can exist in the identi-
cally-numbered mute group.
E SET BY CUE (Assign by [CUE] key)
This specifies whether the [CUE] key will be used to
make/cancel mute group assignments. While the mute
group SET BY CUE button is on, pressing the [CUE]
key of a channel that can be assigned to the corre-
sponding group will assign the channel to the group.
(Press the [CUE] key once again to cancel the
assignment.)
Hint
The SET BY CUE button can be turned on for only one mute
group. This is automatically turned off when you change
screens or turn off the power.
F CLEAR
This button clears all output channels assigned to that
mute group.
G DIRECT RECALL/MUTE MASTER
This is the same function as the DIRECT RECALL/
MUTE MASTER buttons located at the bottom of the
display (p.151).
MUTE GROUP ASSIGN screen
MUTE GROUP ASSIGN
321
4
65
7
OUTPUT DCA/GROUP function
236 PM5D/PM5D-RH Owner’s Manual Reference section
Here you can specify the output channels that will be
assigned to EQ link groups A–H. EQ parameters are linked
for channels belonging to the same group.
A EQ link group
These are the EQ link group numbers. The number
corresponding to the grid where the cursor is located is
highlighted.
B Grid
This grid lets you assign output channels (horizontal
rows) to EQ link groups (vertical columns). Currently-
patched grids are indicated by a symbol. Move the
cursor to the desired grid and press the [ENTER] key
(or click) to set/cancel the assignment.
Hint
The MIX channels and STEREO A/B channels can be
assigned only to EQ link groups A–F, and MATRIX chan-
nels can be assigned only to EQ link groups G/H.
Grey areas in the grid indicate combinations that cannot be
assigned.
Input channels and output channels use separate EQ link
groups. Output channels use groups A–H, and input chan-
nels use groups 1–8.
C SET BY CUE (Assign by [CUE] key)
This specifies whether the [CUE] key will be used to
make/cancel EQ link group assignments. While the EQ
link group SET BY CUE button is on, pressing the
[CUE] key of a channel that can be assigned to the cor-
responding group will assign the channel to the group.
(Press the [CUE] key once again to cancel the
assignment.)
Hint
The SET BY CUE button can be turned on for only one EQ
link group. This is automatically turned off when you change
screens or turn off the power.
D CLEAR
This button clears all output channels assigned to that
EQ link group.
EQ LINK ASSIGN screen
EQ LINK ASSIGN
12
43
PM5D/PM5D-RH Owner’s Manual Reference section 237
Information shown
in the display
Function
menu
Global
functions
Output
functions
Input
functions
Appendices
Here you can specify the output channels that will be
assigned to compressor link groups A–H. Compressor
parameters are linked for channels belonging to the same
group.
A Compressor link group
This area shows the compressor link group number.
The number corresponding to the grid where the cur-
sor is located is highlighted.
B Grid
This grid lets you assign output channels (horizontal
rows) to compressor link groups (vertical columns).
Currently-patched grids are indicated by a symbol.
Move the cursor to the desired grid and press the
[ENTER] key (or click) to set/cancel the assignment.
Hint
Input channels and output channels use separate compres-
sor link groups. Output channels use groups A–H, and input
channels use groups 1–8.
C SET BY CUE (Assign by [CUE] key)
This specifies whether the [CUE] key will be used to
make/cancel compressor link group assignments.
While the compressor link group SET BY CUE button
is on, pressing the [CUE] key of a channel that can be
assigned to the corresponding group will assign the
channel to the group. (Press the [CUE] key once again
to cancel the assignment.)
Hint
The SET BY CUE button can be turned on for only one com-
pressor link group. This is automatically turned off when you
change screens or turn off the power.
D CLEAR
This button clears all output channels assigned to that
compressor link group.
COMP LINK ASSIGN (Compressor link
assign) screen
COMP LINK ASSIGN
12
43
MATRIX/ST function
238 PM5D/PM5D-RH Owner’s Manual Reference section
MATRIX/ST function
Here you can send the signal from MIX channels and STE-
REO A/B channels to the STEREO bus or the desired
MATRIX bus.
A MATRIX bus
This is the number of the MATRIX bus to which the
signal is sent. Paired MATRIX channels are indicated
by a heart symbol displayed between them. You can
click this symbol to enable/disable pairing.
B Send level
These knobs specify the send level of each signal that is
sent from the MIX channel or STEREO A/B channel
(vertical column) to the MATRIX buses (horizontal
row).
The knobs shown in this area will depend on how the
MATRIX channels are paired.
If the MATRIX channels are used individually
MATRIX/ST ROUTING screen
MATRIX/ST ROUTING
21
MIX channel
STEREO A/B channel
LEVEL knobs
Adjust the send level of the signals sent
from the MIX channels and STEREO A/B
channels to each MATRIX bus.
MIX channel 2
MATRIX bus 2
MIX channel 2
MATRIX bus 1
MIX channel 1
MATRIX bus 1
MIX channel 1
MATRIX bus 2
……
MATRIX 1
MATRIX 2
FADER
MIX CHANNEL 1
ON
ON
ON
to
MATRIX1
LEVEL
to
MATRIX2
LEVEL
FADER
MIX CHANNEL 2
ON
ON
ON
to
MATRIX1
LEVEL
to
MATRIX2
LEVEL
PM5D/PM5D-RH Owner’s Manual Reference section 239
Information shown
in the display
Function
menu
Global
functions
Output
functions
Input
functions
Appendices
If the MATRIX channels are paired
C MIX TO MATRIX ON/OFF
This button is an on/off switch for the signal sent from
each MIX channel or STEREO A/B channel to the
MATRIX buses. If this button is off, no signal will be
sent from that channel to the MATRIX buses.
D PRE FADER/POST FADER/POST ON
These buttons select the position from which the sig-
nal is sent from the MIX channel or STEREO A/B
channel to the MATRIX buses, from the following
choices.
This parameter applies to the signal sent from the cor-
responding channel to all MATRIX buses.
E MIX TO STEREO ON/OFF
This button is an on/off switch for the signal sent from
each MIX channel to the STEREO bus. If this button is
off, no signal will be sent from that channel to the STE-
REO bus.
F PRE/POST (Pre-on/Post-on)
This button selects the position from which the signal
is sent from the MIX channel to the STEREO bus, from
the following choices.
G PAN (MIXSTEREO pan)
This knob specifies the panning of the signal sent from
the MIX channel to the STEREO bus. If a MIX chan-
nel is selected in the SELECTED CHANNEL section,
the STEREO [PAN] encoder is linked with this knob.
Hint
If the source is a STEREO A/B channel, parameters
5
7
are not displayed.
H MIX channel, STEREO A/B channel
This area indicates the MIX channel or STEREO A/B
channel from which the signal is being sent. Paired
MIX channels are indicated by a heart symbol dis-
played between them. You can click this symbol to
enable/disable pairing.
PAN knobs
Adjust the panning of the signals
sent from the MIX channels and
STEREO A/B channels to each
pair of adjacent odd-numbered/
even-numbered MATRIX buses.
MIX channel 2
MATRIX buses 1/2
MIX channel 1
MATRIX buses 1/2
LEVEL knobs
Adjust the send level of
the signals sent from
the MIX channels and
STEREO A/B channels
to each MATRIX bus.
ON
ON
ON
ON
PAN
to MATRIX 1/2
LEVEL
……
MATRIX 1
MATRIX 2
FADER
MIX CHANNEL 1
ON
PAN
to MATRIX 1/2
LEVEL
FADER
MIX CHANNEL 2
ON
PRE FADER Immediately before the fader
POST FADER Immediately after the fader
POST ON
Immediately after the MIX [ON] key / STE-
REO [ON] key
PRE
Immediately before the MIX [ON] key
(immediately after the fader)
POST Immediately after the MIX [ON] key
4
3
7
8
5
6
MATRIX/ST function
240 PM5D/PM5D-RH Owner’s Manual Reference section
This screen lists the signals sent from the MIX channels to
the MATRIX buses. You can also edit the settings from
within this screen.
A MIX to MTRX/MTRX from MIX
Select one of the following two types of screen display.
When the MIX to MTRX button is on
You can view the status of the signals sent from a spe-
cific MIX channel or STEREO A/B channel to all
MATRIX buses.
When the MTRX from MIX button is on
You can view the status of the signals sent from all MIX
channels or STEREO A/B channels to a specific
MATRIX bus.
B SEND LEVEL/SEND POINT
Select one of the following two parameters to view in
the grid.
When the SEND LEVEL button is on
The send levels sent from the MIX channels or STE-
REO A/B channels to the MATRIX buses will be shown
as a bar graph in each grid. Channels for which the sig-
nal sent to the MATRIX bus is turned off are shown by
gray bars, and channels for which the signal is turned
on are shown by blue bars.
To edit the send level, move the cursor to the grid
where the MIX or STEREO A/B channel (vertical col-
umn) intersects the MATRIX bus (horizontal row),
and turn the [DATA] encoder.
To switch the signal sent from a specific MIX or STE-
REO A/B channel to the MATRIX buses on/off, move
the cursor to the vertical column for that channel, and
press the [ENTER] key.
Hint
If the send level is set above nominal (0 dB), a red line indi-
cating nominal level is displayed.
If the send-destination MATRIX channel is paired, the grid
for the odd-numbered MATRIX bus will show an orange line
indicating the pan value instead of a bar graph. (In MTRX
from MIX mode, upward indicates R, and downward indi-
cates L.)
If the SEND LEVEL button is on, you can select a
desired grid and copy its send level (pan) value to other
channels (horizontal direction) or to other MATRIX
buses (vertical direction), or switch all grids on/off
simultaneously.
To do so, move the cursor to the desired grid; then
hold down the [SHIFT] key and press the [ENTER]
key. (Alternatively, hold down the [SHIFT] key and
click the desired grid.) When the JOB SELECT win-
MIX to MATRIX VIEW screen
MIX to MATRIX VIEW
1 2
Channels for which the
signal sent to the MATRIX
bus is turned on (blue bar
graph)
Channels for which the
signal sent to the MATRIX
bus is turned off (gray bar
graph)
Pan value (orange line)
PM5D/PM5D-RH Owner’s Manual Reference section 241
Information shown
in the display
Function
menu
Global
functions
Output
functions
Input
functions
Appendices
dow appears, select one of the following choices to
copy, and click the OK button.
LEVEL COPY [ALL MATRIX ]
Copy the send level (pan) value of the selected grid to
all send level (pan) settings of the corresponding MIX
(or STEREO A/B) channel in the vertical direction of
the grid.
Note
If the selected grid is a send level, only the send levels will be
copied. If the selected grid is a pan value, only the pan values
will be copied.
LEVEL COPY [ALL MIX ]
Copy the send level (pan) value of the selected grid to
all send level (pan) settings of the corresponding
MATRIX bus in the horizontal direction of the grid.
LEVEL COPY [ALL MIX x ALL MATRIX]
Copy the send level (pan) value of the selected grid to
the send level (pan) settings of all MIX (and STEREO
A/B) channels and MATRIX buses.
ALL ON [ALL MIX ]
Turn on the signals sent from all channels (MIX,
STEREO A/B) to the corresponding MATRIX bus.
ALL OFF [ALL MIX ]
Turn off the signals sent from all channels (MIX,
STEREO A/B) to the corresponding MATRIX bus.
When the SEND POINT button is on
The grid will show the position from which the signal is
sent from the MIX channels or STEREO A/B channels
to the MATRIX buses.
Each indication has the following significance.
(yellow) . . PRE FADER (immediately
before the fader)
(gray) . . . . POST FADER (immediately
after the fader)
(red) . . . . . POST ON (immediately after
the [ON] key)
To change the position from which the signal is sent,
move the cursor to the vertical column for the desired
channel, and press the [ENTER] key, click, or turn the
[DATA] encoder. (The position of all signals sent from
that channel to all MATRIX buses will change
simultaneously.)
If the SEND POINT button is on, the send position for
all grid locations can be changed simultaneously. To do
so, hold down the [SHIFT] key and click the desired
grid. (Alternatively, move the cursor to the desired
grid; then hold down the [SHIFT] key and press the
[ENTER] key.) When the JOB SELECT window
appears, select one of the following choices, and click
the OK button.
ALL PRE FADER [ALL MIX ]
All grids will be set to PRE FADER.
ALL POST FADER [ALL MIX ]
All grids will be set to POST FADER.
ALL POST ON [ALL MIX ]
All grids will be set to POST ON.
C Grid
The grid shows various settings for the signals sent
from the MIX or STEREO A/B channels (vertical col-
umns) to the MATRIX buses (horizontal rows). The
red lines shown in the upward, downward, left, and
right directions indicate the channel (MIX or STEREO
A/B) and MATRIX bus corresponding to the grid
where the cursor is located.
PRE FADER POST FADER POST ON
3
MATRIX/ST function
242 PM5D/PM5D-RH Owner’s Manual Reference section
D SELECTED PARAMETER (currently selected
parameter)
This area indicates the channel (MIX or STEREO A/B)
and MATRIX bus corresponding to the grid where the
cursor is currently located. The four boxes at right
indicate the values for the grid where the cursor is cur-
rently located.
Here you can make settings for LCR mode, which allows
three-channel playback by adding a CENTER channel to
the L/R channels of the STEREO bus. This function can be
used only with MIX channels.
A Response graph
These graphs indicate the approximate LCR response
for each MIX channel. The graph will change as the
CSR knob (
2) is edited.
B CSR (Center Side Ratio)
This knob adjusts the proportional level of the CEN-
TER channel relative to the L/R channels. The range is
0–100%.
If the CSR knob is set to 0%, turning the PAN knob in
the MIX TO STEREO area of the MATRIX/ST ROUT-
ING screen (or the [PAN] encoder in the SELECTED
CHANNEL section) will change the signal levels of the
L/R channels as shown below.
In this case, MIX TO STEREO PAN will operate as a
conventional PAN control, and no signal will be sent to
the CENTER channel.
4
Send level
P
an
(di
sp
l
aye
d
if
th
e
d
es
ti
na-
tion MATRIX channel is
paired and an odd-numbered
MATRIX bus is selected)
Position from which
the signal is sent
On/off switch for the signal
sent to the MATRIX bus
LCR screen
LCR
4
3
1
2
CRL
Signal sent to the
R channel
[PAN] encoder
Signal sent to the
L channel
Signal level
PM5D/PM5D-RH Owner’s Manual Reference section 243
Information shown
in the display
Function
menu
Global
functions
Output
functions
Input
functions
Appendices
If CSR is set to 100%, turning the PAN knob ([PAN]
encoder) will change the signal levels of the L/R chan-
nels as shown below.
When the PAN knob ([PAN] encoder) is in the center
position, the signal level of the CENTER channel will
be at maximum, and no signal will be sent to the L/R
channels.
C LCR (LCR mode on/off)
For each MIX channel, this turns LCR mode on/off.
For channels where LCR mode is turned on, the PAN
knob in the MIX TO STEREO area of the MATRIX/ST
ROUTING screen can be used to simultaneously con-
trol the levels of the L/R channels and the CENTER
channel.
If you have selected a MIX channel for which LCR is
on, you can also use the [PAN] encoder in the
SELECTED CHANNEL section of the top panel. In
this case, the peripheral LEDs will change as follows
when you operate the [PAN] encoder.
When LCR = off
When LCR = on
Note
In order to use the LCR function, the USE AS CENTER BUS
button must be turned On in the MIXER SETUP screen (SYS/
W.CLOCK function) (
p.201). Be aware that when this but-
ton is on, the CENTER channel signal is not sent to the
STEREO B bus, and will not play back appropriately. (In this
case, the STEREO B bus is sent the same signal as the STE-
REO A bus.)
D MIX channel
This is the number of the MIX channel you are edit-
ing. Paired MIX channels are indicated by a heart
symbol displayed at the right. You can click this sym-
bol to enable/disable pairing. The values of parameters
23 are linked for paired channels.
Hint
The master level of the CENTER channel is controlled by
the STEREO B channel fader. You can also use the STE-
REO B channel EQ and compressor to process the signal.
Use either one of the output jacks patched to the STEREO B
channel as the output jack for the CENTER channel. (When
the USE AS CENTER BUS button is On in the MIXER
SETUP screen, the L/R channels of the STEREO B bus out-
put the same signal.)
By selecting LCR as the monitor source, you can monitor
the LCR signal from the MONITOR OUT jacks L/C/R.
CRL
[PAN] encoder
Signal sent to the
R channel
Signal sent to the
C channel
Signal sent to the
L channel
Signal level
RLRL RL
RLRL RL
MATRIX/ST function
244 PM5D/PM5D-RH Owner’s Manual Reference section
Here you can make various settings related to surround
functionality, such as selecting the surround mode, and
assigning MIX buses to surround channels.
A SURROUND MODE
Choose one of the follow-
ing as the surround mode
when using the Surround
Pan function (p.132).
This is the same as the
SURROUND MODE in
the MIXER SETUP screen
(SYS/W.CLOCK func-
tion). The graphic below
the buttons will change
according to the mode you
select.
STEREO
This is conventional stereo
mode.
3-1ch
This mode uses four chan-
nels: L (front left), C (front
center), R (front right),
and S (surround).
5.1ch
This mode uses six channels: L (front left), C (front
center), R (front right), Ls (rear left), Rs (rear right),
and LFE (subwoofer).
6.1ch
This mode uses seven channels: 5.1ch with the addi-
tion of Bs (rear center).
Hint
If 3-1ch, 5.1ch, or 6.1 ch is selected as the surround mode,
MIX buses 1–8 or 9–16 are used as surround buses, starting
with the earlier-numbered buses. (Buses not used as sur-
round buses can be used as conventional buses.) These MIX
buses cannot be used as conventional bus outputs until you
return to stereo mode.
B Bus assignments
This area indicates the surround channels assigned to
the MIX buses that are being used as surround buses.
You can edit these settings by clicking the / but-
tons at the left and right.
When you change the surround channel assignment,
the MIX bus whose channel assignment you changed
will be exchanged with the MIX bus that had been pre-
viously assigned to that channel.
Note
The MIX buses used are fixed for each surround mode.
For surround mode 3-1, MIX buses 1–4 or 9–13 can be used.
For surround mode 5.1, MIX buses 1–6 or 9–14 can be used.
For surround mode 6.1, MIX buses 1–7 or 9–15 can be used.
Other MIX buses can be used as conventional MIX buses.
However in the case of 6.1, MIX bus 8 or MIX bus 16 are
always handled as FIXED buses.
C INIT (Initialize)
For each surround mode, this restores the surround
channel assignments to the MIX buses to their initial
state.
D SURROUND BUS ALLOCATION
Select either MIX buses 1–8 or 9–16 as the range of
MIX buses used as surround buses.
SURR SETUP screen
SURR SETUP
1
2 3 4
PM5D/PM5D-RH Owner’s Manual Reference section 245
Information shown
in the display
Function
menu
Global
functions
Output
functions
Input
functions
Appendices
E DELAY
This specifies the delay time for each surround channel
in a range of 0–1000 msec. The current value is shown
by the two boxes below the knob. (The upper box
shows the delay time in millisecond units, and the
lower box shows the delay time in the units selected in
the MIX 1-24 screen of the OUT DELAY function.)
F DELAY ON/OFF
Turns the delay on/off for each surround channel.
G FADER (Fader level)
Adjusts the level of the signal sent from the surround
channel to the corresponding MIX bus in a range of
to +10 dB. The current value is shown in the box
below.
H CUE
This button lets you cue-monitor the surround chan-
nel. This is linked with the [CUE] key of the
corresponding MIX channel.
I ON/OFF (Channel on/off)
Turns the surround channel on/off. This is linked with
the MIX [ON] key of the corresponding MIX channel.
J Level meter
Indicates the output level of the surround channel.
K Surround channel
This is the name of the surround channel.
OUTPUT VIEW function
This screen displays the mix parameters of the currently
selected MIX channel, MATRIX channel, or STEREO A/B
channel. In this screen you can also edit the principal
parameters and access other screens.
A Channel
This is the number of the channel you are editing. If
the corresponding MIX/MATRIX channel is paired (or
if a STEREO A/B channel is selected), a heart symbol is
displayed at the right. You can click this symbol to
enable/disable pairing for the MIX/MATRIX channel.
Note
The screen shown above is for when a paired channel is
selected. If the selected channel is not paired, the parameters
for only one channel are displayed, and pairing-related set-
tings are not displayed.
B EQ
This area shows the post-EQ level, the approximate EQ
response, and the EQ on/off status. You can click the
EQ ON/OFF button to switch EQ on/off in this screen.
5 7 8 J
K
6
9
CH VIEW (Channel view) screen
CH VIEW
1
2
3
4
OUTPUT VIEW function
246 PM5D/PM5D-RH Owner’s Manual Reference section
If you click the mini-graph, the EQ PARAM screen for
that channel will appear.
C Compressor
This area shows the amount of gain reduction and the
output level of the compressor, a mini-graph showing
the approximate response of the compressor, and the
compressor on/off status. You can click the COMP
ON/OFF button to switch the compressor on/off in
this screen. If you click the mini-graph, the COMP
PARAM screen for that channel will appear.
D Insert in
This area indicates the insert point, the insert on/off
status, and the type and input level of the port that is
patched to insert-in. You can click the INSERT ON/
OFF button to switch insertion on/off in this screen.
If an internal effect is patched, the effect type and
BYPASS button are displayed. If a GEQ module is
patched, the GEQ ON/OFF button and a mini-graph
showing the GEQ response are displayed.
E DELAY
In this area you can view and edit the delay time of the
internal delay and its on/off status.
F TO MATRIX (only for MIX channels and
STEREO A/B channels)
This area shows the send level, send position, and on/
off status of the signals sent from the corresponding
MIX channel or STEREO A/B channel to MATRIX
buses 1–8. You can also edit the send level, send posi-
tion, and on/off status in this screen. Here’s how to do
this.
To edit the send level of signals sent to the MATRIX
bus
Move the cursor to the desired bar graph in the list,
and turn the [DATA] encoder.
To edit the send position of signals sent to the
MATRIX bus
Click either the PRE FADER, the POST FADER, or the
POST ON button located below.
Alternatively, you can edit the setting by moving the
cursor to the PRE or POST indication in the list and
pressing the [ENTER] key or turning the [DATA]
encoder.
To switch the signal sent to the MATRIX bus on/off
Click the ON/OFF button located below.
You can also switch this on/off by moving the cursor to
a bar graph in the list and pressing the [ENTER] key.
The bar graph is colored blue when on, and gray when
off.
G DCA group / Mute group
Here you can assign or cancel DCA group and MUTE
group assignments.
H RECALL SAFE / MUTE SAFE
Here you can enable or disable Recall Safe and Mute
Safe settings.
I TO STEREO (MIX channels only)
Here you can switch the signal sent from a MIX chan-
nel to the STEREO bus on/off, and edit its panning and
send position (pre-on / post-on) (p.239).
J BALANCE (only for paired MIX/MATRIX
channels and STEREO A/B channels)
This adjusts the left/right volume balance of the signals
output from paired MIX channels or STEREO A/B
channels.
K LCR (MIX channels only)
Here you can switch LCR mode on/off, and adjust CSR
(the level of the CENTER channel relative to the L/R
channels) (p.242).
L LIBRARY
This button accesses the OUTPUT CH LIBRARY
screen (p.251), where you can store/recall library
settings for output channels.
M Level meter
This level meter indicates the output level of the
channel.
N Signal detection point
This is the point at which the signal level shown in the
level meter (
M) is detected (PRE EQ, PRE FADER,
POST FADER, POST DELAY, or POST ON). You can
edit this setting by clicking the / buttons at the left
and right.
5
6
7
L
M
O
N
P
Q
8
9
J
K
PM5D/PM5D-RH Owner’s Manual Reference section 247
Information shown
in the display
Function
menu
Global
functions
Output
functions
Input
functions
Appendices
O Fader
This controls the output level of the channel.
P CUE
This button cue-monitors the signal of the channel.
This is linked with the [CUE] key of the corresponding
channel.
Q ON/OFF (Channel on/off)
This is an on/off switch for the signal that is output
from the channel. This is linked with the [ON] key of
that channel.
This screen shows the signal flow for adjacent odd-num-
bered/even-numbered MIX/MATRIX channels or for
STEREO A/B channels. In this screen you can also edit
some of the parameters, and access other screens. You can
also determine the location within the signal flow at which
clipping occurred.
A Channels
These are the numbers of the channels you are editing.
By clicking the / buttons at left and right, you can
switch the display in units of two channels.
If the corresponding MIX/MATRIX channels are
paired (or if a STEREO A/B channel is selected), a heart
symbol is displayed at the right. You can click this sym-
bol to enable/disable pairing for the MIX/MATRIX
channels.
B Insert
This area displays insert-related information for the
two selected channels (insert point, the ports patched
to insert in/out, and insert on/off status).
Here you can also select the insert point (use the /
buttons at left and right), or switch insertion on/off
(use the ON/OFF button).
SIGNAL FLOW screen
SIGNAL FLOW
12
OUTPUT VIEW function
248 PM5D/PM5D-RH Owner’s Manual Reference section
C Level meters
These meters indicate the levels within the signal flow.
Levels are detected at the following locations.
EQ (immediately before and after the EQ)
COMP (immediately before and after the
compressor)
FADER (immediately before and after the fader)
DELAY (immediately before and after the delay)
INSERT IN (immediately after the insert point)
D Signal flow
This area indicates the signal flow of the selected chan-
nel. The following parameters are displayed.
EQ (Equalizer)
This indicates the EQ on/off status and the approxi-
mate response curve. You can click the EQ button to
switch EQ on/off, or click the mini-graph to access the
EQ PARAM screen for the corresponding channel.
COMP (Compressor)
This indicates the compressor on/off status and the
approximate response curve. You can click the COMP
button to switch the compressor on/off, or click the
mini-graph to access the COMP PARAM screen for the
corresponding channel.
FADER
This indicates the output level of the channel. This is
linked with the encoder or fader of the corresponding
channel.
ON/OFF (On/off)
Turns the channel on/off. This is linked with the [ON]
key of the corresponding channel.
DELAY
Here you can switch the internal delay on/off and edit
the delay time.
Hint
If insert is enabled, the currently selected insert point is
shown in this signal flow.
If the signal clips, the signal flow (horizontal line) after clip-
ping is displayed in red. If an output is turned off so that the
signal does not flow any further, the subsequent flow is dis-
played in gray. If PEAK HOLD is on, the flow indication will
stay red if clipping occurs even once, making it easier to see
that clipping has occurred.
E TO MATRIX (only for MIX channels and
STEREO A/B channels)
This area shows the on/off status of the signal sent
from the MIX channel or STEREO A/B channel to the
MATRIX buses, and the point from which the signal is
sent.
F TO STEREO (MIX channels only)
This area shows the pan, the send position, and the on/
off status of the signal sent from the MIX channel to
the STEREO bus.
3
4
65
PM5D/PM5D-RH Owner’s Manual Reference section 249
Information shown
in the display
Function
menu
Global
functions
Output
functions
Input
functions
Appendices
This screen shows the on/off status, level, and cue monitor
status of the output channels and DCA groups.
A ON/OFF (On/off)
Here you can switch output channels on/off, and
switch DCA group muting on/off. These settings are
linked with the [ON] keys of the corresponding chan-
nels and the [MUTE] keys of the DCA groups.
B Level
Here you can adjust the level of the output channels
and DCA groups. The current value is shown in the
box immediately below. These are linked with the
encoder or fader of the corresponding channel or DCA
group.
C Cue
Here you can switch cue monitoring on/off for output
channels and DCA groups. These are linked with the
[CUE] key of the corresponding channel or DCA
group.
In this screen you can copy the desired parameter(s) from
the selected output channel into a memory buffer, and
paste them to the same type of channel (you may select
more than one paste-destination).
A COPY
When you click this button, the settings of the cur-
rently selected channel will be copied to a temporary
memory buffer.
If the corresponding MIX/MATRIX channel is paired
(or if a STEREO A/B channel is selected), a heart sym-
bol is displayed at the right.
B BUFFERED CH (Channel in the buffer)
This shows the channel that is currently copied into
buffer memory.
Note
The same buffer memory is used to copy channel settings
for both input channels and output channels.
If input channel settings have been copied to the buffer
memory, a message of “TYPE CONFLICT!” is displayed
below, and you cannot paste to an output channel.
The contents of the buffer memory are erased when the
PM5D is powered-off.
FADER VIEW screen
FADER VIEW
1
3
2
CH COPY (Channel copy) screen
CH COPY
1
2
OUTPUT VIEW function
250 PM5D/PM5D-RH Owner’s Manual Reference section
C PASTE
When you click this button, the specified parameters
will be copied from buffer memory to the specified
paste-destination channel.
If an input channel is copied to buffer memory, or if no
paste-destination has been specified, this is grayed-out
and the Paste operation is unavailable.
D PARAMETER SELECT
Here you can select the parameter(s) that will be
pasted. You can select the following parameters.
If the TO MTRX button is on, you can use the
MATRIX buttons (1–8) to select the applicable
MATRIX buses.
E CH SELECT (Channel selection)
Here you can select the paste-destination channel(s).
You can only select channels of the same type as the
copy-source.
Hint
If the copy-source MIX/MATRIX channel is paired, the odd-
numbered channel is copied to the odd-numbered channel(s),
and the even-numbered channel is copied to the even-num-
bered channel(s).
F SET ALL
Specifies the paste-destination as all channels of the
same type as the copy-source.
G CLEAR ALL
De-selects all channels.
ALL All parameters
EQ EQ function settings
COMP COMP function settings
DELAY DELAY function settings
FADER Fader level
ON CH [ON] key on/off status
BAL Balance settings
INSERT Insert on/off status and insert point
TO MTRX Send level to the desired MATRIX bus(es)
DCA Associated DCA group
MUTE Associated mute group
LCR LCR screen settings
WITHOUT
MIX SEND/
WITH MIX
SEND
Selects whether the send level sent from
input channels to the selected MIX bus will
be included (WITH...) or will not be included
(WITHOUT...) in the pasted data.
5
4
3
6
7
PM5D/PM5D-RH Owner’s Manual Reference section 251
Information shown
in the display
Function
menu
Global
functions
Output
functions
Input
functions
Appendices
Here you can recall, store, rename, or delete items in the
output channel library.
A EDIT
When you click this button, the CH VIEW screen
(OUTPUT CH VIEW screen) for the currently selected
output channel will appear.
B Channel
This is the number of the channel you will store or
recall.
Note
Channel library store/recall operations are performed in units
of one channel.
If the channel selected by the [SEL] key is paired (or if a
STEREO A/B channel is selected), the operation will apply
to only one of the currently selected channels (in the case of
STEREO A/B, only the L or the R channel).
When you recall a channel library item into one of a pair of
MIX/MATRIX channels (or into L or R of the STEREO A/B
channel), any linked parameters will be copied to the other
channel.
C LIBRARY TYPE (Channel type)
Indicates the type of the currently selected channel. If a
MIX or STEREO A/B channel is selected, the pairing
configuration of MATRIX buses 1–8 is shown immedi-
ately below.
D RECALL
Recalls the channel library item selected in the list into
memory.
If the channel selected in (
1) is of a different type than
the channel selected in the list, this button is grayed-
out and the Recall operation is unavailable. (However,
Initial Data can be recalled to any output channel.)
E STORE
Stores the settings of the currently selected output
channel into the location selected in the list. When you
click this button a window will appear, allowing you to
name and save the settings.
F TITLE EDIT
Edits the title of the library item selected in the list.
When you click this button a window will appear,
allowing you to edit the title.
G CLEAR
Deletes the library item selected in the list. When you
click this button, a confirmation message will appear.
Note
Library items with an “R” displayed in the right column of the
list are read-only. Read-only items cannot be stored,
renamed, or deleted.
H LIBRARY TYPE
Displays the type of channel for the library item
selected in the list. If the channel selected in (
1) is of a
different type than the channel selected in the list, a
message of “CONFLICT!” is displayed at the right and
the Recall operation is unavailable.
If a MIX or STEREO A/B channel is selected, the pair-
ing configuration of MATRIX buses 1–8 is shown
immediately below.
I Library list
Use the scroll bar to select the library item on which
you want to perform an operation. The selected library
item will move to the center, and will be highlighted.
OUTPUT CH LIBRARY screen
OUTPUT CH LIBRARY
1
2
3
4
5
6
7
9
8
Input functions
252 PM5D/PM5D-RH Owner’s Manual Reference section
INPUT PATCH function
Here you can assign input ports (INPUT jacks, ST IN
jacks, 2TR IN DIGITAL/ANALOG jacks, input channels of
slots, outputs of internal effects) to input channels.
A SELECTED PATCH
This indicates the name and number of the input chan-
nel at which the cursor is located, and the input port.
B CH (Input channel)
This is the number and name of the input channel
(input channel, ST IN channel, FX RTN channel)
assigned to the input port. The channel number at
which the cursor is located will be highlighted. If you
click the name, a window will open allowing you to
assign a name to the channel.
C ASSIGN
For each channel, this indicates the number (1 or 0) of
input ports currently assigned.
D Grid
This grid lets you patch input ports (horizontal rows)
to input channels (vertical columns). Currently-
patched grids are indicated by a symbol. By clicking
a grid location you can set/cancel patching.
The red lines at the left and top indicate the grid loca-
tion to which you move the cursor.
Hint
If PATCH CONFIRMATION is turned on in the PREFER-
ENCE 1 screen (UTILITY function), a confirmation message
will appear each time you attempt to change a patch set-
ting. If STEAL PATCH CONFIRMATION is turned on, a
confirmation message will also appear when you attempt to
make patch settings that would cause an existing patch to
be modified.
To move the cursor location rapidly in or out of the grid, hold
down the [SHIFT] key and press the CURSOR [
]/[
®
]/[
π
]/
[
] keys.
To move rapidly to left or right inside the grid, turn the
[DATA] encoder. To move up or down, hold down the
[SHIFT] key and turn the [DATA] encoder.
Note
You can patch multiple input channels to a single input port,
but you cannot patch multiple input ports to a single input
channel.
E Input port
From the top, this area indicates the type of input port,
the ID number, the input channel number, and the
number of input channels assigned. The following
types of input port can be selected.
Hint
The port number is grayed-out for ports that are currently
unavailable.
If the CASCADE connector is being used as a SLOT IN port,
the port number of the CASCADE connector is displayed in
yellow instead of the SLOT IN port number.
Input functions
INPUT PATCH screen
INPUT PATCH
5
1
2
3 4
AD IN INPUT jacks 1–48
AD STIN L/R channels of ST IN jacks 1–4
SLOT IN
Input channels of an I/O card installed in
slots 1–4
FX OUT L/R outputs of internal effects 1–8
2TR IN
L/R channels of 2TR IN DIGITAL jacks 1–3
and 2TR IN ANALOG jacks 1/2
PM5D/PM5D-RH Owner’s Manual Reference section 253
Information shown
in the display
Function
menu
Global
functions
Output
functions
Input
functions
Appendices
F PRESET
This button resets the input port input channel
assignments to the following default settings.
G CLEAR ALL
This button clears all assignments of input ports to
input channels.
H LIBRARY
This button accesses the INPUT PATCH LIBRARY
screen ( p.257), where you can store/recall input
channel patch library settings.
Here you can patch an input channel to an output port so
that the input signal will be output directly from that port.
A SELECTED PATCH
This indicates the name and number of the input chan-
nel at which the cursor is located, and the output port.
B CH (Input channel)
This is the number and name of the input channel
(input channel, ST IN channel) for assignment to an
output port. The channel number at which the cursor
is located will be highlighted. If you click the name, a
window will open allowing you to assign a name to the
channel.
C ASSIGN
For each channel, this indicates the number of output
ports that are currently assigned.
D Grid
This grid lets you patch input channels (vertical col-
umns) to output ports (horizontal rows). Currently-
patched grids are indicated by a symbol. By clicking
a grid location you can set/cancel patching.
The red lines at the left and top indicate the grid loca-
tion to which you move the cursor.
Hint
Operations in the grid are the same for all of the patching
screens. For details, refer to the Hint on p.252.
Channel Input port
Input channels 1–48 AD IN 1–48
ST IN channels 1–4 L/R AD STIN L/R
FX RTN channels 1–4 L/R FX OUT 1–4 L/R
6 7 8
DIRECT OUT PATCH screen
DIRECT OUT PATCH
5
1
2
3 4
INPUT PATCH function
254 PM5D/PM5D-RH Owner’s Manual Reference section
E Output port
From the top, this area indicates the type of output
port, the ID number, the output channel number, and
the number of input channels assigned. The following
types of output port can be selected.
Hint
The port number is grayed-out for ports that are currently
unavailable.
For SLOT OUT ports that are also being output to the CAS-
CADE connector, the port number of the CASCADE
connector is displayed in yellow instead of the SLOT OUT
port number.
F LIBRARY button
This button accesses the INPUT PATCH LIBRARY
screen ( p.257), where you can store/recall input
channel patch library settings.
Note
To enable direct output from the selected port, you will need to
make settings in the INSERT/DIRECT OUT POINT screen
(INPUT PATCH function) to turn on direct output for the corre-
sponding input channel (
p.256.
In this screen you can patch the input/output ports by
which external devices will be inserted into each input
channel. Select the output port in the left side of the screen,
and the input port in the right side of the screen.
A SELECTED PATCH
This indicates the number and name of the input chan-
nel at which the cursor is located in the grid.
B Insert in/out
This indicates the input/output ports that are patched
as insert in/out for the input channel at which the cur-
sor is located.
C CH (Input channel)
This area shows the number and name of each input
channel (input channel, ST IN channel L/R). The
channel number at which the cursor is located will be
highlighted. If you click the name, a window will open
allowing you to assign a name to the channel.
D ASSIGN
For each input channel, this indicates the number of
output ports that are currently assigned as insert-out.
SLOT OUT
Output channels of an I/O card installed in
slots 1–4
2TR OUT
L/R channels of 2TR OUT DIGITAL jacks
1–3
6
INSERT PATCH screen
INSERT PATCH
21
6
3
4 5
PM5D/PM5D-RH Owner’s Manual Reference section 255
Information shown
in the display
Function
menu
Global
functions
Output
functions
Input
functions
Appendices
E Grid
For each input channel (vertical column), this grid lets
you can patch one or more output ports (horizontal
row) to be used as insert-outs. Currently-patched grids
are indicated by a symbol.
By clicking a grid location you can set/cancel patching.
The red lines at the left and top indicate the grid loca-
tion to which you move the cursor.
Hint
Operations in the grid are the same for all of the patching
screens. For details, refer to the Hint on p.252.
F Output port
From the top, this area indicates the type of output
port, the ID number, the output channel number, and
the number of input channels assigned. The following
types of output port can be patched as insert-out.
Hint
The port number is grayed-out for ports that are currently
unavailable.
For SLOT OUT ports that are also being output to the CAS-
CADE connector, the port number of the CASCADE
connector is displayed in yellow instead of the SLOT OUT
port number.
If you select GEQ IN as an insert-out, the output of the same
GEQ module will automatically be selected as the insert-in.
G Input port
From the top, this area indicates the type of input port,
the ID number, L/R, the input channel number, and
the total number of input channels (including insert-
in) that are patched to each input port. You can select
the following input ports.
H LIBRARY button
This button accesses the INPUT PATCH LIBRARY
screen ( p.257), where you can store/recall input
channel patch library settings.
Note
To enable the insert ins/outs that you assigned to input chan-
nels in this screen, you need to turn Insert on for the
corresponding input channel in the INSERT/DIRECT OUT
POINT screen (INPUT PATCH function) (
p.256). However,
insertion is automatically enabled if you assigned insert in/out
to a GEQ.
Hint
When operating from the panel, you can move the cursor from
the right side of the screen to the left side (or vice versa) by
holding down the [SHIFT] key and using the CURSOR [
]/
[
®
] keys.
SLOT OUT
Output channels of an I/O card installed in
slots 1–4
FX IN L/R inputs of internal effects 1–8
GEQ IN Inputs of GEQ modules 1–12
2TR OUT
L/R channels of 2TR OUT DIGITAL jacks
1–3
AD IN INPUT jacks 1–48
AD ST IN ST IN jacks 1–4 L/R
SLOT IN
Input channels of an I/O card installed in
slots 1–4
FX OUT L/R outputs of internal effects 1–8
GEQ OUT Outputs of GEQ modules 1–12
2TR IN
L/R channels of 2TR IN DIGITAL jacks 1–3
or 2TR IN ANALOG jacks 1/2
7
8
INPUT PATCH function
256 PM5D/PM5D-RH Owner’s Manual Reference section
For each input channel, you can specify the point at which
insert in/out will be patched, and the point from which
direct output will be taken. Here you can also switch Insert
or Direct Output on/off.
A Insert view
When you move the cursor to an insert I/O point (4),
the insert and direct output locations for that input
channel will be shown graphically.
B INPUT CH (Input channel)
This is the number of the input channel you are edit-
ing. Two paired channels are indicated by a heart
symbol shown at the left; settings
36 will be linked
for these channels. You can click this symbol to enable/
disable pairing.
C INSERT ON/OFF
This button switches insert on/off for each channel.
This is linked for two paired channels.
Note
Be aware that if you turn on this button when either insert-in or
insert-out are unpatched, the signal will no longer be output
from the corresponding input channel.
D INSERT I/O (Insert I/O point)
Here you can select one of the following as the insert-
in/out location for each channel.
E DIRECT OUT ON/OFF
These buttons switch direct output on/off for each
channel.
F DIRECT OUT
Here you can select one of the following as the direct
output location for each channel.
INSERT/DIRECT OUT POINT screen
INSERT/DIRECT OUT POINT
1
32 4
PRE EQ Immediately before the EQ
POST EQ Immediately after the EQ
PRE DELAY Immediately before the delay
POST FADER Immediately after the fader
PRE HPF Immediately before the high-pass filter
PRE EQ
Immediately before the EQ (immediately
after the PRE EQ of the INSERT I/O)
PRE FADER Immediately before the fader
POST ON Immediately after the CH [ON] key
5 6
PM5D/PM5D-RH Owner’s Manual Reference section 257
Information shown
in the display
Function
menu
Global
functions
Output
functions
Input
functions
Appendices
Here you can assign a name to each input channel and
DCA group.
A Channel
This area indicates the input channel (input channel,
ST IN channel) and DCA group numbers.
B Name
This area indicates the names currently assigned to
each input channel and DCA group. If you click the
name, a window will open allowing you to assign a
name to the channel.
C LIBRARY
This button accesses the INPUT PATCH LIBRARY
screen ( p.257), where you can store/recall input
channel patch (and name) library settings.
Here you can recall, store, rename, or delete items in the
input patch library.
Except for the fact that these are patch settings for input
channels, display and operations are the same as in the
OUTPUT PATCH function OUTPUT PATCH LIBRARY
screen. Refer to p.223.
NAME screen
NAME
1 2 3
INPUT PATCH LIBRARY screen
INPUT PATCH LIBRARY
INPUT HA/INSERT function
258 PM5D/PM5D-RH Owner’s Manual Reference section
INPUT HA/INSERT function
Here you can make settings for internal HAs (PM5D-RH
model only) or external HAs assigned to input channels.
A +48V
B HPF (High Pass Filter)
C Cutoff frequency
D GAIN
E Input port
These items are the same as in the OUTPUT INSERT
function INSERT IN MIX1-24 screen and INSERT IN
MATRIX/STEREO/MONITOR screen ( p.224).
F Channel
This area shows the number and name of the channel
you are editing. Two paired channels are indicated by a
heart symbol displayed between them.
Note
Items
1
4
are not shown for channels to which nothing is
patched, or for channels patched to an input port that does
not have a HA. Items
2
and
3
are not shown for channels
patched to a port that has no high pass filter.
To assign input ports to input channels, use the INPUT
PATCH screen (INPUT PATCH function).
HA settings are not linked even if two channels are paired.
However, the GAIN knob setting is linked for HAs whose
GANG button is turned on in the HA screen (SYS/W.CLOCK
function).
G LIBRARY button
This button displays the HA LIBRARY screen
( p.208), where you can store/recall internal HA or
external HA settings as library items.
Hint
The HA settings you edit in this screen are also reflected in
the HA screen (SYS/W.CLOCK function).
CH 1-24 (Input channel 1-24) screen
STIN/FXRTN (ST IN/FXRTN channel)
screen
CH 1-24
STIN/FXRTN
1
2
3
5
6
4
7
PM5D/PM5D-RH Owner’s Manual Reference section 259
Information shown
in the display
Function
menu
Global
functions
Output
functions
Input
functions
Appendices
Here you can make settings for internal HAs (PM5D-RH
model only) or external HAs assigned to the insert-in of
input channels.
A +48V
B HPF (High Pass Filter)
C Cutoff frequency
D GAIN
E Input port
These items are the same as in the OUTPUT INSERT
function INSERT IN MIX1-24 screen and INSERT IN
MATRIX/STEREO/MONITOR screen ( p.224).
F Channel
This area shows the number and name of the channel
you are editing. Two paired channels are indicated by a
heart symbol displayed between them.
Note
Items
1
4
are not shown for channels to whose insert-in
nothing is patched, or for channels patched to an input port
whose insert-in does not have a HA. Items
2
and
3
are not
shown for channels patched to a port that has no high pass
filter.
To assign an input port to an insert-in, use the INPUT
PATCH screen (INPUT PATCH function).
HA settings are not linked even if two channels are paired.
However, the GAIN knob setting is linked for HAs whose
GANG button is turned on in the HA screen (SYS/W.CLOCK
function).
G LIBRARY button
This button displays the HA LIBRARY screen
( p.208), where you can store/recall internal HA or
external HA settings as library items.
Hint
The HA settings you edit in this screen are also reflected in
the HA screen (SYS/W.CLOCK function).
INSERT 1-24 screen
INSERT 25-48 screen
INSERT STIN screen
INSERT 1-24
STIN/FXRTN IN
1
2
3
5
6
4
7
INPUT ø/EQ function
260 PM5D/PM5D-RH Owner’s Manual Reference section
This screen is the same as HA LIBRARY in the SYS/
W.CLOCK function ( p.208).
INPUT ø/EQ function
Here you can edit the EQ parameters of the selected input
channel.
A Channel selection
Selects the input channel (input channel 1–48, STIN
channel 1–4 L/R, FXRTN channel 1–4 L/R).
B Name
This is the name of the currently selected input chan-
nel. If the input channel is paired (or if a ST IN channel
or FX RTN channel is selected), a heart symbol is dis-
played at the right. For an input channel, you can click
this symbol to enable/disable pairing.
C EQ ON/OFF
Turns the EQ on/off for that channel.
D EQ LINK GROUP
Selects the EQ link group (1–8) to which the EQ of that
channel belongs. EQ parameters are linked for input
channels belonging to the same group.
Note
The input channel EQ link groups are independent from the
output channel EQ link groups.
E LIBRARY
This button accesses the INPUT EQ LIBRARY screen
( p.263), where you can store/recall input channel
EQ library settings.
HA LIBRARY screen
HA LIBRARY
EQ PARAM (EQ parameter) screen
EQ PARAM
1 2 3 54
PM5D/PM5D-RH Owner’s Manual Reference section 261
Information shown
in the display
Function
menu
Global
functions
Output
functions
Input
functions
Appendices
F ATT (Attenuation)
This knob adjusts the amount of attenuation/gain
immediately following AD conversion in a range of
–96 dB to +24 dB. This is linked with the ATT knob in
the ø/ATT 1-48 screen and ø/ATT STIN/FXRTN
screen. The current value is displayed in the box
located below the knob.
G EQ TYPE
Selects the type of EQ. Turning the TYPE I button on
selects the algorithm used in the 02R series. Turning
the TYPE II button on selects a newly developed algo-
rithm. TYPE II reduces the interference between bands.
H EQ graph
This graph shows the approximate response of the EQ
parameters. The colored vertical lines indicate the
FREQ (center frequency) of the band for the parame-
ter at which the cursor is located. (The color of each
line matches the knob markings for each band.) The
response curve will change when you edit the Q or
GAIN of each band.
I Level meters
These meters indicate the peak levels before EQ and
after EQ. If the signal clips before or after EQ, the
OVER segment will light.
J EQ FLAT
This button resets the GAIN parameters of all bands to
the default value (±0.0 dB). When you click this but-
ton, a confirmation message will appear.
K HPF (High Pass Filter)
The high pass filter located after attenuation and before
EQ can be switched on/off, and you can adjust its cut-
off frequency. The cutoff frequency can be adjusted in
a range of 20–600 Hz.
L Knobs
These knobs adjust the Q, FREQ (center frequency),
and GAIN (amount of boost/cut) for each band.
M (LOW shelving)
If this button is on, the LOW EQ will function as a
shelving-type EQ. The Q knob will disappear.
N (HIGH shelving)
If this button is on, the HIGH EQ will function as a
shelving-type EQ. The Q knob will disappear.
O LPF (Low Pass Filter)
If this button is on, the HIGH EQ will function as a
low-pass filter. The Q knob will disappear, and the
GAIN knob is used to switch the LPF on/off.
These screens list the EQ settings for the input channels.
Here you can also copy EQ settings between input
channels.
Note
In some screens that include channel numbers as part of the
screen name, changing the Pair Mode to Vertical Pairing in
the MIXER SETUP screen will change the name of the
screen.
Example: EQ 1-24 screen EQ 1,25- screen
987 6 J
MK NOL
EQ 1-24 screen
EQ 25-48 switch
EQ STIN/FXRTN screen
EQ 1-24
EQ STIN/FXRTN
INPUT ø/EQ function
262 PM5D/PM5D-RH Owner’s Manual Reference section
A EQ graph
This mini-graph shows the approximate EQ response
for each input channel.
When you click the graph at which the cursor is cur-
rently located, the EQ PARAM screen for that channel
will appear.
In this screen you can drag and drop the mini-graph
from the desired channel to copy its EQ settings.
(When you drag and drop the mini-graph, a window
will appear, asking you to confirm the copy operation.)
You can also copy EQ settings between the three
screens EQ 1-24, EQ 25-48, and EQ STIN/FXRTN.
First drag the mini-graph over the EQ 1-24, EQ 25-48,
or EQ STIN/FXRTN tabs in the screen (the screen will
switch). Then drag and drop the mini-graph onto the
desired channel, and a window will appear, asking you
to confirm the copy operation.
B EQ ON/OFF
Turns the EQ on/off for that channel. This is linked for
two paired channels.
C Channel
This is the number of the channel you are editing. Two
paired channels are indicated by a heart symbol dis-
played between them.
D Level meter
This meter indicates the peak level after EQ. If the sig-
nal clips, the OVER segment will light.
Here you can adjust the amount of attenuation/gain
immediately following AD conversion, and reverse the
phase.
4 1 2
3
ø/ATT 1-48 (Phase/Attenuation
1-48) screen
ø/ATT STIN/FXRTN (Phase/Attenua-
tion STIN/FXRTN) screen
ø /ATT 1-48
ø /ATT STIN/FXRTN
PM5D/PM5D-RH Owner’s Manual Reference section 263
Information shown
in the display
Function
menu
Global
functions
Output
functions
Input
functions
Appendices
A GANG
When you turn this button on, attenuation/gain set-
tings will be linked for adjacent odd-numbered/even-
numbered channels (or the L/R sides of an STIN/
FXRTN channel).
If the settings are different when you turned the but-
ton on, they will maintain their relative difference
while linked.
B ø (Phase)
This button inverts the phase of each channel’s signal
following AD conversion.
C Attenuation/gain
For each channel, you can adjust the amount of attenu-
ation/gain immediately following AD conversion over
a range of –96 dB to +24 dB. This is linked with the
ATT knob of the EQ PARAM screen. The current value
is displayed in the box located below the knob.
D Channel
This is the number and name of the channel. If two
adjacent odd-numbered/even-numbered channels are
paired (or if a STIN channel or FXRTN channel is dis-
played), a heart symbol is displayed between the two
channels.
Here you can recall, store, rename, or delete items in the
input EQ library.
Except for the fact that these are EQ settings for the input
channels, display and operations are the same as in the
OUTPUT EQ function OUTPUT EQ LIBRARY screen.
Refer to p.228.
1
2
3
4
INPUT EQ LIBRARY screen
INPUT EQ LIBRARY
INPUT GATE/COMP function
264 PM5D/PM5D-RH Owner’s Manual Reference section
INPUT GATE/COMP function
Here you can edit the gate parameters of the selected input
channel.
A Channel selection
Select the input channel (input channel, ST IN chan-
nel) that you want to edit.
B Name
This is the name of the currently selected input chan-
nel. If the input channel is paired (or if a ST IN channel
is selected), a heart symbol is displayed at the right. For
an input channel, you can click this symbol to enable/
disable pairing.
C GATE ON/OFF
Turns the gate for that channel on/off.
D LIBRARY
This button accesses the GATE LIBRARY screen
( p.268), where you can store/recall gate library set-
tings for input channels.
E Level meters
These meters indicate the
amount of gain reduction
(GR), the peak level before
(PRE) and after (POST)
the gate, and the peak level
of the key-in signal (KEY
IN) that causes the gate to
operate. If the signal clips,
the OVER segment will
light.
If stereo link is turned on
for the input channel (or if
a ST IN channel is
selected), level meters for
two channels are
displayed.
Hint
If GR METER ON/OFF LINK is turned on in the PREFER-
ENCE 1 screen (UTILITY function), the gain reduction meter
will not be displayed when the gate is off.
F Type
Indicates the type of the currently selected gate.
Hint
To change the gate type, use the INPUT GATE LIBRARY
screen to recall a library item that has a different type. You
cannot change only the gate type in this screen.
G STEREO LINK
This specifies whether parameter settings and gate
operation by a key-in signal will be linked (STEREO
LINK button on) for adjacent odd-numbered/even-
numbered input channels and the L/R channels of ST
IN channels, or not (STEREO LINK button off).
Key-in signal flow when Link= On
GATE PARAM (Gate parameter)
screen
GATE PARAM
1 2 3 4
5
76
8
GR
THR
THR
LINK= ON
GR
Odd-numbered
channel key-in signal
Even-numbered
channel key-in signal
ATTACK
processing
ATTACK
processing
Detect
maximum
level
PM5D/PM5D-RH Owner’s Manual Reference section 265
Information shown
in the display
Function
menu
Global
functions
Output
functions
Input
functions
Appendices
Key-in signal flow when Link= Off
Note
Stereo Link is fixed at On for paired channels.
H Gate graph
This graph displays the approximate response of the
gate.
I KEY IN SOURCE
Here you can select one of the following as the key-in
signal that will be used. (If an input channel is selected,
its name will be displayed at the right.)
J FILTER
Select the type of filter to be applied to the selected key-
in signal, from the following types.
HPF (High Pass Filter)
Passes the portion of the signal above the specified fre-
quency (the cutoff frequency), and cuts the portion
below. If you select this filter, use the knob at the right
to adjust the cutoff frequency (20 Hz–20 kHz).
BPF (Band Pass Filter)
Passes only the specified frequency region (the band
pass frequency), and cuts the rest of the signal. If you
select this filter, use the knobs at the right to adjust the
band pass frequency (20 Hz–20 kHz) and Q (10.0–
0.10).
LPF (Low Pass Filter)
Passes the portion of the signal below the specified fre-
quency (the cutoff frequency), and cuts the portion
above. If you select this filter, use the knob at the right
to adjust the cutoff frequency (20 Hz–20 kHz).
K FILTER ON/OFF
This is an on/off switch for the filter applied to the key-
in signal.
L CUE
This button cue-monitors the currently selected key-in
signal.
Note
Even if the cue mode is set to MIX CUE (which lets you moni-
tor the mix of all channels whose [CUE] key is on), only the
corresponding signal will take priority for monitoring when you
turn on the CUE button in the GATE PARAM screen. (Any
[CUE] keys that had been on at that time will be forcibly turned
off.)
M THRESHOLD (Threshold level)
Specifies the level at which the gate will open and close.
The gate will open when the key-in signal exceeds this
level, and will close when the signal falls below this
level.
N ATTACK (Attack time)
Specifies the time from when the key-in signal exceeds
the threshold level until the gate opens.
O HOLD (Hold time)
Specifies the time that the gate will remain open after
the key-in signal falls below the threshold.
P DECAY (Decay time)
Specifies the time over which the gate will close after
the hold time has elapsed.
Q RANGE
Specifies the amount of attenuation while the gate is
closed.
SELF PRE EQ
The pre-EQ signal of the currently
selected input channel
SELF POST EQ
The post-EQ signal of the currently
selected input channel
CH 1–48 POST EQ The post-EQ signal of the corre-
sponding input channel (however,
you can only choose channels
belonging to the same group,
within the seven groups CH1–8,
CH9–16, CH17–24, CH25–32,
CH33–40, CH41–48, and ST IN
1L/1R–4L/4R)
ST IN 1L/1R–4L/4R
POST EQ
MIX 21–24 OUT
The output signal of the corre-
sponding MIX channel immedi-
ately before the output attenuation
GR
THR
THR
LINK= OFF
GR
Odd-numbered
channel key-in signal
Even-numbered
channel key-in signal
ATTACK
processing
ATTACK
processing
Detect max-
imum level
Detect max-
imum level
L
J
9
K
M N O P Q
INPUT GATE/COMP function
266 PM5D/PM5D-RH Owner’s Manual Reference section
Here you can edit the compressor parameters of the
selected input channel.
A Channel selection
Select the input channel (input channel, ST IN chan-
nel) that you want to edit.
B Name
This is the name of the currently selected input chan-
nel. If the input channel is paired (or if a ST IN channel
is selected), a heart symbol is displayed at the right. For
an input channel, you can click this symbol to enable/
disable pairing.
C COMP ON/OFF (Compressor on/off)
Turns the compressor on/off for that channel.
D COMP LINK GROUP (Compressor link
group)
Selects the compressor link group (1–8) to which that
channel belongs. Compressor parameters are linked for
input channels belonging to the same group.
Note
Input channel compressor link groups are independent from
output channel compressor link groups.
E LIBRARY
This button accesses the COMP LIBRARY screen
( p.232), where you can store/recall compressor
library settings for input channels.
F Level meters
These meters indicate the
amount of gain reduction
(GR), the peak level before
(PRE) and after (POST)
the compressor, and the
peak level of the key-in
signal (KEY IN) that
causes the compressor to
operate. If the signal clips,
the OVER segment will
light.
G Type
Indicates the type of the currently selected compressor.
H STEREO LINK
This specifies whether compressor parameter settings
and key-in signal operation will be linked for adjacent
odd-numbered/even-numbered input channels (STE-
REO LINK button on), or will be independent
(STEREO LINK button off). (For details on compres-
sor stereo link p.229)
I Compressor graph
This graph displays the approximate response of the
compressor.
COMP PARAM (Compressor parame-
ter) screen
COMP PARAM
1 2 3 54
6
87
9
PM5D/PM5D-RH Owner’s Manual Reference section 267
Information shown
in the display
Function
menu
Global
functions
Output
functions
Input
functions
Appendices
J KEY IN SOURCE
Select the desired key-in signal from the following
choices.
K THRESHOLD (Threshold level)
L RATIO
M ATTACK (Attack time)
N RELEASE (Release time)
O GAIN
P KNEE
These parameters are the same as in the OUTPUT
COMP function COMP PARAM screen ( p.230).
These screens list the gate/compressor settings for the input
channels. Here you can also copy gate/compressor settings
between input channels.
SELF PRE EQ
The pre-EQ signal of the currently
selected input channel
SELF POST EQ
The post-EQ signal of the currently
selected input channel
CH 1–48 POST EQ The post-EQ signal of the corre-
sponding input channel (however,
you can only choose channels
belonging to the same group,
within the seven groups CH1–8,
CH9–16, CH17–24, CH25–32,
CH33–40, CH41–48, and ST IN
1L/1R–4L/4R)
ST IN 1L/1R–4L/4R
POST EQ
MIX 21–24 OUT
The output signal of the corre-
sponding MIX channel immedi-
ately before the output attenuation
J
K L M N O P
CH 1-12 (Input channel 1–12) screen
CH 13-24 (Input channel 13–24)
screen
CH 25-36 (Input channel 25–36)
screen
CH 37-48 (Input channel 37–48)
screen
ST IN (ST IN channel) screen
CH 1-12
ST IN
INPUT GATE/COMP function
268 PM5D/PM5D-RH Owner’s Manual Reference section
A Gate graph
This mini-graph shows the approximate gate response
for each input channel. If you click the mini-graph, the
GATE PARAM screen for that channel will appear.
B Level meters
These meters show the amount of gain reduction pro-
duced by the gate (at left), and the peak level of the
signal after passing through the gate (at right). If the
signal clips, the OVER segment will light.
C GATE ON/OFF
Turns the gate for that channel on/off.
D Compressor graph
This mini-graph shows the approximate compressor
response for each input channel. If you click the mini-
graph, the COMP PARAM screen for that channel will
appear.
E Level meters
These meters show the amount of gain reduction pro-
duced by the compressor (at left), and the peak level of
the signal after passing through the compressor (at
right). If the signal clips, the OVER segment will light.
F COMP ON/OFF (Compressor on/off)
Turns the compressor on/off for that channel.
G Channel
This area shows the number and name of the channel
you are editing. Two paired channels are indicated by a
heart symbol displayed between them.
In this screen, you can copy gate/compressor settings
by dragging and dropping the mini-graph of a desired
channel onto another channel. You can also copy gate/
compressor settings between different screens (for the
procedure p.231).
Here you can recall, store, rename, or delete items in the
gate library.
A EDIT
When you click this button, the GATE PARAM screen
for the currently selected input channel will appear.
B Channel selection
Select the input channel that you want to edit. The
name of the channel is displayed at the right.
C Gate graph of the selected channel
This graph shows the approximate response of the gate
for the currently selected channel.
D Level meters
These meters show the amount of gain reduction (GR),
and the peak levels before the gate (PRE) and after the
gate (POST). If the signal clips, the OVER segment will
light.
3
6
5
7
2 1 4
GATE LIBRARY screen
GATE LIBRARY
1
2
3
4
PM5D/PM5D-RH Owner’s Manual Reference section 269
Information shown
in the display
Function
menu
Global
functions
Output
functions
Input
functions
Appendices
E RECALL
Recalls the gate library item selected in the list into
memory.
F STORE
Stores the gate settings of the currently selected chan-
nel into the location selected in the list. When you click
this button a window will appear, allowing you to
name and save the settings.
G TITLE EDIT
Edits the title of the library item selected in the list.
When you click this button a window will appear,
allowing you to edit the title.
H CLEAR
Deletes the library item selected in the list. When you
click this button, a confirmation message will appear.
Note
Library items with an “R” displayed in the right column of the
list are read-only. Read-only items cannot be stored,
renamed, or deleted.
I Library gate graph
This graph indicates the approximate response of the
gate library item selected in the list.
J Library list
Use the scroll bar to select the library item on which
you want to perform an operation. The selected library
item will move to the center, and will be highlighted.
Here you can recall, store, rename, or delete items in the
compressor library.
Except for the fact that these settings are for input chan-
nels, this is the same as the OUTPUT COMP function
COMP LIBRARY screen. Refer to p.232.
5
6
7
8
J
9
COMP LIBRARY (Compressor library)
screen
COMP LIBRARY
INPUT DELAY function
270 PM5D/PM5D-RH Owner’s Manual Reference section
INPUT DELAY function
Here you can edit the delay parameters of the selected
input channel.
A DELAY SCALE
Here you can select the units in which the delay time is
displayed. The units that can be selected are the same
as in OUTPUT DELAY function DELAY SCALE
( p.233). When you change the delay scale in the
INPUT DELAY function, the delay scale of the OUT-
PUT DELAY function will also change accordingly.
B GANG
C Delay time knob
D DELAY ON/OFF
These are the same as in the OUTPUT DELAY func-
tion ( p.233).
E Channel
This area shows the number and name of the input
channel you are editing. Two paired channels (or a ST
IN channel) are indicated by a heart symbol displayed
between them. You can click this symbol to enable/dis-
able pairing.
CH 1-24 (Input channel 1–24) screen
CH 25-48 (Input channel 25–48)
screen
ST IN (ST IN channel) screen
CH 1-24
ST IN
1
2
4
3
5
PM5D/PM5D-RH Owner’s Manual Reference section 271
Information shown
in the display
Function
menu
Global
functions
Output
functions
Input
functions
Appendices
INPUT DCA/GROUP function
Here you can specify the input channels that will be
assigned to DCA groups 1–8. The level of input channels
belonging to the same DCA group can be adjusted as a
whole using DCA faders 1–8.
A DCA group
This is the number of the DCA group. The number
corresponding to the grid where the cursor is located is
highlighted.
B Name
This is the name of the DCA group. You can also click
this area to edit the name.
C Grid
This grid lets you assign input channels (horizontal
rows) to DCA groups (vertical columns). Currently-
patched grids are indicated by a symbol. Move the
cursor to the desired grid and press the [ENTER] key
(or click) to set/disable the assignment.
Hint
You can also assign a single input channel to multiple DCA
groups for multiple DCA control.
Hint
DCA groups 1–6 are for input channels only, but DCA groups
7/8 can be used with both input channels and output chan-
nels. Both types of channel can exist in an identically-
numbered group.
D SET BY CUE (Assign by [CUE] key)
This specifies whether the [CUE] key will be used to
make/cancel DCA group assignments. While the DCA
group SET BY CUE button is on, pressing the [CUE]
key of an input channel that can be assigned to the cor-
responding group will assign the channel to the group.
(Press the [CUE] key once again to cancel the
assignment.)
Hint
The SET BY CUE button can be turned on for only one DCA
group. This is automatically turned off when you change
screens or turn off the power.
E CLEAR
This button clears all input channels assigned to that
DCA group.
F MUTE
These buttons switch muting on/off for DCA groups
1–8. They are linked with DCA [MUTE] keys 1–8 in
the DCA strip of the panel.
G DCA faders
These faders adjust the levels of DCA groups 1–8. They
are linked with DCA faders 1–8 in the DCA strip.
H CUE
These buttons cue-monitor DCA groups 1–8. They are
linked with DCA [CUE] keys 1–8 in the DCA strip of
the panel.
I DCA LEVEL SET
Use the following two buttons to operate DCA groups
1–8 together.
ALL NOMINAL
Clicking this button will move DCA faders 1–8 to
nominal level (0 dB).
ALL MINIMUM
Clicking this button will move DCA faders 1–8 to the
dB position.
DCA GROUP ASSIGN screen
DCA GROUP ASSIGN
21 3
54
8
6
7
9
INPUT DCA/GROUP function
272 PM5D/PM5D-RH Owner’s Manual Reference section
Here you can specify the input channels that will be
assigned to mute groups 1–8. Muting can be switched on/
off together for channels assigned to the same mute group.
Except for the fact that these settings apply to input chan-
nels, the display and operations are the same as in the
OUTPUT DCA/GROUP function MUTE GROUP
ASSIGN screen. Refer to p.235.
Hint
Mute groups 1–8 can be used with both input channels and
output channels. Both types of channel can exist in the identi-
cally-numbered mute group.
Here you can specify the input channels that will be
assigned to EQ link groups 1–8. EQ parameters are linked
for channels belonging to the same group.
A EQ link group
These are the EQ link group numbers. The number
corresponding to the grid where the cursor is located is
highlighted.
B Grid
This grid lets you assign input channels (horizontal
rows) to EQ link groups (vertical columns). Currently-
patched grids are indicated by a symbol. Move the
cursor to the desired grid and press the [ENTER] key
(or click) to set/disable the assignment.
Hint
Input channels and output channels use separate EQ link
groups. Input channels use groups A–H, and output channels
use groups 1–8.
MUTE GROUP ASSIGN screen
MUTE GROUP ASSIGN
EQ LINK ASSIGN screen
EQ LINK ASSIGN
1 2
PM5D/PM5D-RH Owner’s Manual Reference section 273
Information shown
in the display
Function
menu
Global
functions
Output
functions
Input
functions
Appendices
C SET BY CUE (Assign by [CUE] key)
This specifies whether the [CUE] key will be used to
make/cancel EQ link group assignments. While the EQ
link group SET BY CUE button is on, pressing the
[CUE] key of a channel that can be assigned to the cor-
responding group will assign the channel to the group.
(Press the [CUE] key once again to cancel the
assignment.)
Hint
The SET BY CUE button can be turned on for only one EQ
link group. This is automatically turned off when you change
screens or turn off the power.
D CLEAR
This button clears all input channels assigned to that
EQ link group.
Here you can specify the input channels that will be
assigned to compressor link groups 1–8. Compressor
parameters are linked for channels belonging to the same
group.
Except for the fact that these settings apply to input chan-
nels, the display and operations are the same as in the
OUTPUT DCA/GROUP function COMP LINK ASSIGN
screen. Refer to p.237.
Hint
Input channels and output channels use separate compres-
sor link groups. Input channels use groups A–H, and output
channels use groups 1–8.
43
COMP LINK ASSIGN (Compressor link
assign) screen
COMP LINK ASSIGN
PAN/ROUTING function
274 PM5D/PM5D-RH Owner’s Manual Reference section
PAN/ROUTING function
Here you can send signals from input channels to the
desired MIX bus. In this screen you can also switch the
type (VARI or FIXED) of each MIX bus, and specify the
location from which the signal will be sent.
A Type selection
Here you can select the mix bus type for every two
adjacent odd-numbered/even-numbered MIX buses.
You can choose one of the following types.
FIXED
The send level of the MIX bus is fixed at nominal level
(0.0 dB). Choose this if you want to use the MIX bus as
a group output or as a bus output for recording on a
multitrack recorder.
VARI (Variable)
The send level of the MIX bus is adjustable. Choose
this if you want to use the MIX bus as an external effect
send or as a foldback output.
Hint
If surround mode is enabled, the type indication will change to
“SURROUND” for MIX buses used as surround buses. You
cannot change the mix bus type during this time.
B MIX bus
This is the number of the MIX bus to which the signal
is sent. Paired MIX buses are indicated by a heart sym-
bol displayed between them. You can click this symbol
to enable/disable pairing.
C POST ON/POST TO ST (Post on / Post to
stereo)
This button lets you specify in greater detail the loca-
tion from which post-fader signals will be sent from
input channels to this MIX bus. You can choose one of
the following two send locations.
POST ON
The signal will be sent from immediately after the
[ON] key.
POST ON/POST TO ST=
POST TO ST
The signal will be sent from immediately after the [TO
STEREO] key.
POST ON/POST TO ST=
Hint
This setting applies to the signals sent from all input channels
to the corresponding MIX bus.
D CH to MIX (Channel to mix)
In this area, the signals sent from input channels / ST
IN channels (vertical columns) to MIX buses (horizon-
tal rows) can be switched on/off and their level
adjusted.
The buttons and knobs displayed here will differ
depending on the type (FIXED or VARI) of the send-
destination MIX bus, and on whether the MIX buses
are paired.
CH to MIX (Channel to mix) screen
CH to MIX
43
1 2
MIX1
MIX2
STEREO L
STEREO R
……
……
FADER
INPUT CHANNEL 1
ON TO ST
ON
ON
PAN
MIX1 (VARI)
LEVEL
MIX2 (VARI)
LEVEL
MIX1
MIX2
STEREO L
STEREO R
……
……
FADER
INPUT CHANNEL 1
ON TO ST
ON
ON
PAN
MIX1 (VARI)
LEVEL
MIX2 (VARI)
LEVEL
PM5D/PM5D-RH Owner’s Manual Reference section 275
Information shown
in the display
Function
menu
Global
functions
Output
functions
Input
functions
Appendices
Type = FIXED, Pairing = disabled Type = FIXED, Pairing = enabled
Input channel 1
MIX bus 1
Input channel 1
MIX bus 2
Input channel 2
MIX bus 1
Input channel 2
MIX bus 2
SEND ON/OFF button
On/off switch for the signal sent from
input channels to each MIX bus.
MIX1
MIX2
STEREO L
STEREO R
……
……
FADER
INPUT CHANNEL 1
ON
ON
ON
PAN
MIX1 (FIX)
MIX2 (FIX)
FADER
INPUT CHANNEL 2
ON
ON
ON
PAN
MIX1 (FIX)
MIX2 (FIX)
Input channel 1
MIX buses 1/2
Input channel 2
MIX buses 1/2
SEND ON/OFF button
On/off switch for the signal sent from
input channels to the two MIX buses.
MIX1
MIX2
STEREO L
STEREO R
……
……
FADER
INPUT CHANNEL 1
ON
ON
PAN
MIX1/2 (FIX)
FADER
INPUT CHANNEL 2
ON
ON
PAN
MIX1/2 (FIX)
PAN/ROUTING function
276 PM5D/PM5D-RH Owner’s Manual Reference section
Type = VARI, Pairing = disabled Type = VARI, Pairing = enabled
SEND ON/OFF button
On/off switch for the signal sent from input
channels to each MIX bus.
PRE/POST button
Selects either PRE (pre-EQ or pre-fader) or
POST (post ON or post TO ST) as the loca-
tion from which the signal will be sent from
input channels to each MIX bus.
SEND LEVEL knob
Adjusts the level of the signal sent from
input channels to each MIX bus.
Input channel 1
MIX bus 1
Input channel 1
MIX bus 2
Input channel 2
MIX bus 1
Input channel 2
MIX bus 2
MIX1
MIX2
STEREO L
STEREO R
……
……
ON
ON
ON
PAN
MIX1 (VARI)
LEVEL
MIX2 (VARI)
LEVEL
MIX1
MIX2
STEREO L
STEREO R
……
……
FADER
ON
ON
ON
PAN
MIX1 (VARI)
LEVEL
MIX2 (VARI)
LEVEL
FADER
INPUT CHANNEL 1
INPUT CHANNEL 1
PRE/POST button= PRE
PRE/POST button= POST
Input channel 1
MIX buses 1/2
Input channel 2
MIX buses 1/2
SEND ON/OFF
button
On/off switch for
the signal sent
from input chan-
nels to the two
MIX buses.
PRE/POST button
Selects either PRE (pre-EQ or pre-fader) or POST
(post ON or post TO ST) as the location from which the
signal will be sent from input channels to each MIX bus.
MIX PAN/BALANCE knob
Specifies the panning of the signal sent
from input channels to the two MIX
buses. If the PAN MODE (
9) of the
input channel is set to BALANCE, this
functions as a BALANCE knob that
adjusts the volume balance between
the two channels.
SEND LEVEL knob
Adjusts the level of the signal
sent from input channels to the
two MIX buses.
MIX1
MIX2
STEREO L
STEREO R
……
……
MIX1
MIX2
STEREO L
STEREO R
……
……
INPUT CHANNEL 1
FADER
INPUT CHANNEL 1
ON
ON
PAN
PAN
MIX1/2 (VARI)
LEVEL
FADER
ON
ON
PAN
PAN
MIX1/2 (VARI)
LEVEL
PRE/POST button= PRE
PRE/POST button= POST
PM5D/PM5D-RH Owner’s Manual Reference section 277
Information shown
in the display
Function
menu
Global
functions
Output
functions
Input
functions
Appendices
E PRE EQ/PRE FADER
These buttons let you specify in greater detail the loca-
tion from which the pre-fader signal will be sent from
an input channel to the MIX buses. You can choose
one of the following two send locations.
Hint
This setting applies to the signal sent from the corresponding
input channel to all MIX buses.
F FOLLOW PAN
These buttons specify how the TO ST PAN knob (8)
will affect the signal sent from the input channel to
MIX buses.
VARI
If this button is on, the PAN knob displayed in the CH
to MIX area (
4) will be linked with the TO ST PAN
knob (
8) if VARI-type MIX buses are paired.
FIXED
If this button is on, the signal from after the TO ST
PAN (
8) knob will be sent to FIXED-type MIX buses.
G TO ST (To stereo)
This button specifies whether the input channel / ST
IN channel will send its signal to the STEREO bus. This
is linked with the [TO STEREO] switch in the
SELECTED CHANNEL section.
H TO ST PAN (To stereo pan)
Here you can adjust the panning of the signal sent from
the input channel / ST IN channel to the STEREO bus.
(The current value is shown in the boxes immediately
below.) This is linked with the encoder if PAN is
selected as the encoder mode, and with the [PAN]
encoder of the SELECTED CHANNEL section.
I PAN MODE
Here you can select one of the following ways in which
pan settings will be linked between adjacent odd-num-
bered/even-numbered input channels (or the left/right
channels of a ST IN channel).
INDIVIDUAL
The two pan settings will be independent.
GANG PAN
The two pan settings will be linked in the same direc-
tion. If the two pan values are different when you turn
on this button, pan will be linked while preserving the
existing difference in values.
INV. GANG (Inverted gang)
The two pan settings will operate in opposite
directions.
BALANCE
The two PAN knobs will function as BALANCE knobs
that adjust the balance of the signal sent from the odd-
numbered/even-numbered channels (or the L/R chan-
nels of the ST IN channel) to the STEREO bus L/R. If
you choose this setting, the two knobs will be reset to
the center position, and will be linked in the same
direction. Also, the knob markings will change from
red to white.
Note
Pan mode is always valid, even if the send-source input
channels are not paired.
You will be unable to operate the TO ST PAN knobs if you
select GANG PAN mode when the two pan knobs are set to
far left and right, or if you select INV.GANG when both pan
knobs are turned all the way in the same direction.
J MIX MINUS
This function sends the same mix as the STEREO bus
— but with a specific input channel removed — to the
desired MIX bus. If you need to send a monitor mix to
a performer or announcer, this is a quick way to give
them the same mix as the STEREO bus but without
their own voice.
Access the desired source input channel in the screen,
and click the MIX MINUS button for that channel; a
window will appear, allowing you to select the MIX bus
for which to make Mix Minus settings.
Hint
As a shortcut to access the above window, you can simulta-
neously press the [SEL] key of the INPUT/ST IN channel strip
and the [SEL] key of the MIX section. However, be aware that
holding down either one of these keys by itself will access a
different shortcut.
In the above window, select the send-destination MIX
bus and click the OK button; the following parameters
will change in the CH to MIX screen.
In the CH to MIX area of the send-destination MIX
bus, all ON/OFF buttons will turn on.
In the CH to MIX area of the send-destination MIX
bus, all PRE/POST buttons will be set to POST.
The send level of signals sent from the source input
channel to the destination MIX bus will be lowered
to – dB.
The send level of signals sent from all input chan-
nels other than the above to the destination MIX
bus will be set to nominal level (0.0 dB).
PRE FADER Immediately before the fader
PRE EQ Immediately before the EQ
59
J7 K
86
PAN/ROUTING function
278 PM5D/PM5D-RH Owner’s Manual Reference section
The POST ON/POST TO ST button will be set to
POST TO ST for the destination MIX bus.
Note
Mix Minus does not switch a “mode”; rather, it is a quick way
to make certain settings. This means that even after execut-
ing Mix Minus, you can freely edit the parameters of the CH
to MIX screen.
When you execute the Mix Minus operation, only the input
channel you selected as the source will be removed from the
mix. If you want to remove more than one input channel
from the signal sent to a specific MIX bus, execute the Mix
Minus operation and then manually change the settings of
other channels.
If the input channel is paired (or if a ST IN channel is
selected), the send level of the signal sent from both chan-
nels to the target MIX bus will be set to –.
The Mix Minus operation is valid even if the destination MIX
bus is paired. In this case, the PAN setting of the input chan-
nel will be reflected by the PAN settings of the paired MIX
buses.
K Input channel
This is the source input channel (or channels). Paired
input channels (or a ST IN channel) are indicated by a
heart symbol displayed between them. For an input
channel, you can click this symbol to enable/disable
pairing.
You can move the cursor to a parameter in the CH to
COPY area, and then hold down the [SHIFT] key and
click (or press the [SHIFT] key + [ENTER] key) to
copy the value of that parameter to another channel (in
the horizontal direction) or to another MIX bus (in the
vertical direction), or to switch all parameters on/off.
You can use this method to set the following
parameters.
Mix send on/off
Move the cursor to the SEND ON/OFF button of the
CH to COPY area; then hold down the [SHIFT] key
and click (or press the [SHIFT] key + [ENTER] key) to
access the following window.
To set multiple parameters at once, use the [DATA]
encoder to select one of the following items, and click
the OK button.
ALL OFF [ALL MIX ]
ALL ON [ALL MIX ]
Switch the signals sent from the selected input chan-
nel to all MIX buses on or off together.
ALL OFF [ALL CH ]
ALL ON [ALL CH ]
Switch the signals sent from all input channels to the
selected MIX bus on or off together.
ALL OFF [ALL CH x ALL MIX]
ALL ON [ALL CH x ALL MIX]
Switch the signals sent from all input channels to all
MIX buses on or off together.
Mix send position
Move the cursor to a PRE/POST button in the CH to
COPY area; then hold down the [SHIFT] key and click
(or press the [SHIFT] key + [ENTER] key) to access
the following window.
To set multiple parameters at once, use the [DATA]
encoder to select one of the following items, and click
the OK button.
ALL POST [ALL MIX ]
ALL PRE [ALL MIX ]
Switch the send position of the signal sent from the
selected input channel to all MIX buses to either post-
fader or pre-fader.
ALL POST [ALL CH ]
ALL PRE [ALL CH ]
Switch the send position of the signal sent from all
input channels to the selected MIX bus to either post-
fader or pre-fader.
ALL POST [ALL CH x ALL MIX]
ALL PRE [ALL CH x ALL MIX]
Switch the send position of the signal sent from all
input channels to all MIX buses to either post-fader
or pre-fader.
Note
These “all-at-once” operations are ignored by FIXED-type MIX
buses.
PM5D/PM5D-RH Owner’s Manual Reference section 279
Information shown
in the display
Function
menu
Global
functions
Output
functions
Input
functions
Appendices
Mix send level
Move the cursor to a SEND LEVEL knob in the CH to
COPY area; then hold down the [SHIFT] key and click
(or press the [SHIFT] key + [ENTER] key) to access
the following window.
To set multiple parameters at once, use the [DATA]
encoder to select one of the following items, and click
the OK button.
LEVEL COPY [ALL MIX ]
The value of the selected SEND LEVEL knob will be
copied to the send level of the signals sent from that
input channel to all MIX buses.
LEVEL COPY [ALL MIX ]
The value of the selected SEND LEVEL knob will be
copied to the send level of the signals sent from all
input channels to that MIX bus.
LEVEL COPY [ALL CH x ALL MIX]
The value of the selected SEND LEVEL knob will be
copied to the send level of the signals sent from all
input channels to all MIX buses.
Note
These “all-at-once” operations are ignored by FIXED-type MIX
buses.
Mix pan/balance
When the destination MIX bus is paired, move the cur-
sor to a MIX PAN/BALANCE knob displayed in the
CH to COPY area; then hold down the [SHIFT] key
and click (or press the [SHIFT] key + [ENTER] key) to
access the following window.
To set multiple parameters at once, use the [DATA]
encoder to select one of the following items, and click
the OK button.
PAN (BAL) COPY [ALL MIX ]
The value of the selected MIX PAN/BALANCE knob
will be copied to the pan (balance) of signals sent
from that channel to all paired MIX buses.
PAN (BAL) COPY [ALL MIX ]
The value of the selected MIX PAN/BALANCE knob
will be copied to the pan (balance) of signals sent
from all channels to that MIX bus.
PAN (BAL) COPY [ALL CH x ALL MIX]
The value of the selected parameter will be copied to
the pan (balance) of signals sent from all channels to
all paired MIX buses.
Note
This operation is ignored by unpaired MIX buses and
FIXED-type MIX buses.
You cannot copy PAN parameters to BALANCE parameters
(or vice versa).
Copying is invalid for channels whose VARI button (in the
FOLLOW PAN area) is on.
PAN/ROUTING function
280 PM5D/PM5D-RH Owner’s Manual Reference section
This screen lists the signals sent from the input channels to
the MIX buses. You can also edit the settings from within
this screen.
A CH to MIX/MIX from CH
Select one of the following two types of screen display.
When the CH to MIX button is on
The screen shows the status of the signals sent from a
specific input channel (input channel / ST IN channel)
to all MIX buses. (Use the scroll bar to see input chan-
nels that are not currently shown.)
When the MIX from CH button is on
The screen shows the status of the signals sent from all
input channels to a specific MIX bus.
B SEND LEVEL, PRE/POST (Send level / Send
point)
Select one of the following two parameters to view in
the grid.
When the SEND LEVEL button is on
The send levels of the signals sent from input channels
to MIX buses are shown in the grid as bar graphs.
Except for the fact that the send-sources are input
channels and the send-destinations are MIX buses, the
bar graph display is the same as in the MIX to
MATRIX VIEW screen (MATRIX/ST function)
( p.240).
To edit the send level of a signal, move the cursor to
the grid where the desired channel and MIX bus inter-
sect, and turn the [DATA] encoder. To switch a MIX
send on/off, click the grid where the desired channel
and MIX bus intersect.
If the SEND LEVEL button is on, you can select a
desired grid and copy its send level (pan) value to other
channels (horizontal direction) or to other MIX buses
(vertical direction), or switch all grids on/off
simultaneously.
To do so, move the cursor to the desired grid; then
hold down the [SHIFT] key and press the [ENTER]
key. (Alternatively, hold down the [SHIFT] key and
click the desired grid.) When the following window
appears, select one of the following choices to copy,
and click the OK button.
LEVEL COPY [ALL MIX ]
Copy the send level (pan) value of the selected grid to
all MIX buses.
LEVEL COPY [ALL CH ]
Copy the send level (pan) value of the selected grid to
all input channels.
LEVEL COPY [ALL CH x ALL MIX]
Copy the send level (pan) value of the selected grid to
all input channels / all MIX buses.
ALL OFF [ALL MIX ]
Turn off the signals sent from the specified input
channel to all MIX buses.
ALL ON [ALL MIX ]
Turn on the signals sent from the specified input
channel to all MIX buses.
ALL OFF [ALL CH ]
Turn off the signals sent from all input channels to
the specified MIX bus.
MIX SEND VIEW screen
MIX SEND VIEW
1 2
3
PM5D/PM5D-RH Owner’s Manual Reference section 281
Information shown
in the display
Function
menu
Global
functions
Output
functions
Input
functions
Appendices
ALL ON [ALL CH ]
Turn on the signals sent from all input channels to
the specified MIX bus.
ALL OFF [ALL CH x ALL MIX]
Turn off the signals sent from all input channels to all
MIX buses.
ALL ON [ALL CH x ALL MIX]
Turn on the signals sent from all input channels to all
MIX buses.
When the PRE/POST button is on
This screen shows the send positions of the signals sent
from the input channels to the MIX buses.
Each indication has the following significance.
(green) . . . PRE EQ (immediately before
the EQ)
(yellow) . . PRE FADER (immediately
before the fader)
(gray) . . . . POST ON (immediately after
the [ON] key)
(red) . . . . . POST TO ST (immediately after
the [TO ST] key)
To change the send position of a signal, move the cur-
sor to the grid where the desired channel and MIX bus
intersect, and press the [ENTER] key, or click, or turn
the [DATA] encoder.
If the PRE/POST button is on, the send position for all
grid locations can be changed simultaneously. To do
so, hold down the [SHIFT] key and click the desired
grid. (Alternatively, move the cursor to the desired
grid; then hold down the [SHIFT] key and press the
[ENTER] key.) When the following window appears,
select one of the following choices and click the OK
button.
ALL PRE [ALL MIX ]
Specify pre-fader as the send position for signals sent
from the specified input channel to all MIX buses.
ALL POST [ALL MIX ]
Specify post-fader as the send position for signals sent
from the specified input channel to all MIX buses.
ALL PRE [ALL CH ]
Specify pre-fader as the send position for signals sent
from all input channels to the specified MIX bus.
ALL POST [ALL CH ]
Specify post-fader as the send position for signals sent
from all input channels to the specified MIX bus.
ALL PRE [ALL CH x ALL MIX]
Specify pre-fader as the send position for signals sent
from all input channels to all MIX buses.
ALL POST [ALL CH x ALL MIX]
Specify post-fader as the send position for signals sent
from all input channels to all MIX buses.
C Grid
This area shows various settings for the signals sent
from the input channels (horizontal rows) to the MIX
buses (vertical columns). The red lines extending
toward the left and upward indicate the corresponding
input channel and MIX bus for the grid at which the
cursor is now located.
D SELECTED PARAMETER (currently selected
parameter)
This indicates the input channel and MIX bus for the
grid where the cursor is currently located. The four
boxes at right indicate the values for the grid where the
cursor is currently located.
4
PAN/ROUTING function
282 PM5D/PM5D-RH Owner’s Manual Reference section
This screen lists the signals sent from the input channels to
the buses and direct outputs. You can also set or cancel
these assignments from within this screen.
A Input channel
This area indicates the number and name of the input
channel you are editing.
B PAN
If this button is on, the input channel’s TO STEREO
PAN knob setting will also apply to the signal sent to
FIXED-type MIX buses. This is linked with the FOL-
LOW PAN FIXED button of the CH to MIX screen
(PAN/ROUTING function).
C Bus assignments
These buttons assign the corresponding input channel
to FIXED-type MIX buses. These are linked with the
SEND ON/OFF buttons of the CH to MIX screen
(PAN/ROUTING function). For VARI-type MIX
buses, the buttons are grayed-out and inoperable.
Note
If a surround mode other than STEREO is selected, the but-
tons for MIX buses used as surround buses will be named by
their surround channel (e.g., L, C, R) rather than by number.
D TO ST (To stereo)
If this button is on, the corresponding input channel is
assigned to the STEREO bus. This is linked with the
TO ST button of the CH to MIX screen (PAN/ROUT-
ING function).
E DIRECT
If this button is on, the signal of the corresponding
input channel will be sent to the output port selected as
the direct output. This is linked with the DIRECT OUT
ON/OFF button in the INSERT/DIRECT OUT POINT
screen (IN PATCH function).
F Output port
This area indicates the output port that is patched in
the DIRECT OUT PATCH screen (INPUT PATCH
function) to the direct output of this input channel
G ALL STEREO
Clicking this button enables the assignment of all input
channels to the STEREO bus.
H ALL BUS
Clicking this button enables the assignment of all input
channels to FIXED-type MIX buses.
I ALL CLEAR
Clicking this button cancels all assignments in the FIX
ASSIGN VIEW screen.
J SURROUND MODE
This indicates the currently selected surround mode.
FIX ASSIGN VIEW screen
FIX ASSIGN VIEW
2
4
5
6
3
1
8 9
J
7
PM5D/PM5D-RH Owner’s Manual Reference section 283
Information shown
in the display
Function
menu
Global
functions
Output
functions
Input
functions
Appendices
Here you can make settings for LCR mode, which allows
three-channel playback by adding a CENTER channel to
the L/R channels of the STEREO bus.
Except for the fact that the send-sources are input chan-
nels, the display and operations are the same as in the
MATRIX/ST function LCR screen. Refer to p.242.
Here you can perform realtime control of surround pan-
ning for the two currently selected input channels.
A Channel selection
Select the two adjacent odd-numbered/even-num-
bered input channels (or ST IN channel L/R) that you
want to control. The names of these channels are dis-
played at the right.
B DIVERGENCE
These controls specify the proportion at which the sig-
nals are sent to each surround bus when the input
channel is positioned in the center. Depending on the
currently selected surround mode, the displayed
parameters will differ as follows.
If Surround Mode = 3-1ch/5.1ch
A knob for controlling the front
divergence is displayed. Use this
knob to specify the proportion (0–
100) at which a signal positioned
in the center will be sent to the
center bus (C) and the left/right
buses (L, R). With a setting of 0
the signal will be sent only to the
left/right buses, and with a setting
of 100 it will be sent only to the center bus. With a set-
ting of 50, the signal will be sent at the same level to the
left/right and center buses.
LCR screen
LCR
SURR PARAM (Surround parameter)
screen
SURR PARAM
1
2
3
PAN/ROUTING function
284 PM5D/PM5D-RH Owner’s Manual Reference section
If Surround Mode = 6.1ch
An F knob for controlling the front divergence and an
R knob for controlling the rear divergence are dis-
played. Use these two knobs to specify the proportion
(0–100) at which a signal positioned in the center will
be sent to the center buses (C, S, Bs) and the left/right
buses (L, R, Ls, Rs).
In 6.1ch mode, a LINK button
that links the front and rear diver-
gence is displayed between the F
knob and R knob. When you turn
the LINK button on, the F knob
value will be copied to the R knob,
and the F knob and R knob values
will be linked.
C LFE (Low Frequency Effect)
This adjusts the output level of the signal sent from the
input channel to the LFE (Low Frequency Effect) bus
for a subwoofer. You can use the ON/OFF button to
switch the signal sent from the input channel to the
LFE bus on/off.
The LFE knob and ON/OFF button are displayed only
when the surround mode is 5.1ch or 6.1ch.
D Surround pan grid
This grid lets you control the surround panning, with
the listening point at the center. The current setting is
indicated by a O symbol.
E Position buttons
These buttons correspond to each surround bus. When
you click a button, the surround panning will move to
that position.
F SURROUND BUS ON/OFF buttons
These buttons are on/off switches for the signal sent
from the input channel to the corresponding surround
bus.
G Surround pan position
This indicates the coordinate locations of the O sym-
bol in the left/right direction and the front/rear
direction.
H STEREO LINK
This specifies whether sound image movement will be
linked between the two channels shown in the screen.
To link the movement of the two channels, use the /
buttons at left and right to select one of the eight link
patterns. (For details on how each pattern will operate,
refer to p.136)
I SURROUND MODE
This indicates the currently selected surround mode.
J Level meters
These meters show the master levels of the surround
buses.
4
5 6 7
8 9 J
PM5D/PM5D-RH Owner’s Manual Reference section 285
Information shown
in the display
Function
menu
Global
functions
Output
functions
Input
functions
Appendices
This screen shows the surround settings for each input
channel. From this screen you can also jump to the SURR
PARAM screen for the desired channel.
A Surround pan grid
For each input channel, the approximate surround pan
position is shown by the O symbol. If you click this
area, the SURR PARAM screen for that channel will
appear.
B Surround pan position
This indicates the surround pan coordinate positions
in the left/right direction (L/R) and the front/rear
direction (F/R).
C Channel
This is the number and name of the input channel.
For two adjacent odd-numbered/even-numbered input
channels (or ST IN channel L/R), these settings convert the
two-channel signal from an MS mic into L/R signals.
A S-GAIN knob
This knob sets the proportionate level of the S mic rela-
tive to the level of the M mic. The current value is
shown in the numerical box at the right.
At the MONO position, the S mic level will be at –, at
the STEREO position the M mic and S mic will be at
the same level, and at the EXP.ST position the S mic
level will be +10 dB.
B M/S DECODE ON/OFF
This button switches M/S decoding on/off for two
adjacent odd-numbered/even-numbered input chan-
nels (or ST IN channel L/R). M/S decoding can be
switched on even for channels that are not assigned as a
stereo pair.
C Channel
This is the number and name of the input channel.
Hint
M/S is a stereo recording technique in which two micro-
phones are used; a uni-directional M (Middle) mic and a bi-
directional S (Side) mic. The M mic captures the main signal
and the S mic captures the directional signal, and the sum
(M+S) and difference (M-S) of the two signals (this procedure
is known as “decoding”) is recorded on the L and R channels
respectively.
SURR VIEW (Surround view) screen
SURR VIEW
1
2
3
M/S screen
M/S
1
2
3
INPUT VIEW function
286 PM5D/PM5D-RH Owner’s Manual Reference section
INPUT VIEW function
This screen lists the mix parameters of the currently
selected input channel. In this screen you can also edit the
principal parameters and access other screens.
A Channel
This is the number of the input channel you are edit-
ing. If the input channel is paired (or if a ST IN channel
is selected), a heart symbol is displayed at the right.
You can click this symbol to enable/disable pairing for
the input channel.
B HA (Head Amp)
This area indicates the input port that is patched to the
input channel, the setting of the internal head amp
(PM5D-RH model only) or external head amp, and the
input level. In this screen you can also adjust the head
amp gain and switch phantom power (+48V) on/off.
C ATT (Attenuation)
This area shows the attenuation and ø (phase) settings.
You can also adjust the attenuation and switch the
phase from this screen.
D EQ
Refer to the explanation of the OUTPUT VIEW func-
tion CH VIEW screen ( p.245).
E GATE
This area shows the amount of gain reduction and the
output level of the gate, a mini-graph showing the
approximate response of the gate, and the gate on/off
status. You can also switch the gate on/off from this
screen. If you click the mini-graph, the GATE PARAM
screen for that channel will appear.
F COMP (Compressor)
Refer to the explanation of the OUTPUT VIEW func-
tion CH VIEW screen ( p.246).
G DELAY
In this area you can view and edit the delay time of the
internal delay and its on/off status.
H TO MIX
In this area you can specify the send level, output posi-
tion, and on/off status of the signals sent from the
corresponding input channel to MIX buses 1–24.
(Operation is the same as in the TO MATRIX area of
the OUTPUT VIEW function CH VIEW screen.) Refer
to p.246.
I TO STEREO
Here you can specify the on/off status, pan, and FOL-
LOW PAN settings of the signal sent from the
corresponding input channel to the STEREO bus.
CH VIEW (Channel view) screen
CH VIEW
2
3
4
5
6
1
7
9
8
PM5D/PM5D-RH Owner’s Manual Reference section 287
Information shown
in the display
Function
menu
Global
functions
Output
functions
Input
functions
Appendices
J DCA group / Mute group
K Recall safe / Mute safe
Refer to the explanation of the OUTPUT VIEW func-
tion CH VIEW screen ( p.246).
L DIRECT
Turns direct output on/off for the corresponding input
channel.
M INSERT
Turns insert on/off for the corresponding input
channel.
N SURROUND (Surround pan)
If surround mode is enabled, the surround pan posi-
tion of the corresponding input channel is indicated by
the O symbol in the surround pan grid and also as a
front/rear/left/right coordinate position. If you click
the surround pan grid, the SURR PARAM screen for
that channel will appear.
O LCR
Here you can switch LCR mode on/off, and adjust CSR
(the level of the CENTER channel relative to the L/R
channels) ( p.242).
P LIBRARY
This button accesses the INPUT CH LIBRARY screen
( p.289), where you can store/recall input channel
library settings.
Q Level meter
This level meter indicates the input level of the channel.
R Signal detection point
This is the point at which the signal level shown in the
level meter (
S) is detected (PRE ATT, PRE GATE,
PRE FADER, POST FADER, or POST ON). You can
edit this setting by clicking the / buttons at the left
and right.
S Fader
This controls the input level of the channel.
T CUE
U ON/OFF (Channel on/off)
Refer to the explanation of the OUTPUT VIEW func-
tion CH VIEW screen ( p.247).
This screen shows the signal flow for two adjacent odd-
numbered/even-numbered input channels or ST IN chan-
nels. In this screen you can also edit some of the
parameters, and access other screens. You can also deter-
mine the location within the signal flow at which clipping
occurred.
A Channel
B Insert
Except for the fact that this screen depicts input chan-
nels, the contents are the same as the OUTPUT VIEW
function SIGNAL FLOW screen. Refer to p.247.
C Direct out
This area displays information about the direct output
of the two selected channels (the signal output posi-
tion, the port patched to direct out, and the direct
output on/off status).
Here you can also select the signal output position (use
the / buttons at left and right), and switch direct
output on/off (use the ON/OFF button).
D Level meters
These meters indicate the levels at various points in the
signal flow. Levels are detected at the following
locations.
PRE ATT (immediately before the attenuator)
EQ (immediately before and after the EQ)
GATE (immediately before and after the gate)
COMP (immediately before and after the
compressor)
FADER (immediately before and after the fader)
K
J
L
M
N
O
P
Q
R
S
T
U
SIGNAL FLOW screen
SIGNAL FLOW
1 32
4
INPUT VIEW function
288 PM5D/PM5D-RH Owner’s Manual Reference section
POST ON (immediately after the CH [ON] key)
INSERT IN (immediately after the insert point)
E Signal flow
This area indicates the signal flow of the selected chan-
nel. The following parameters are displayed.
ATT (Attenuation)
Specifies the amount of attenuation immediately after
AD conversion for the corresponding channel.
HPF (High Pass Filter)
Specifies the high pass filter on/off and cutoff fre-
quency for the corresponding channel.
EQ (Equalizer)
GATE
COMP (Compressor)
These areas show the approximate response of the
equalizer, gate, and compressor for the corresponding
channel. You can also switch these on/off in this screen,
or click a mini-graph to access the individual parame-
ter screen.
DELAY
Here you can switch the internal delay on/off and edit
the delay time.
FADER
This indicates the input level of the channel. This is
linked with the encoder or fader of the corresponding
channel.
ON/OFF (On/off)
Turns the channel on/off. This is linked with the [ON]
key of the corresponding channel.
TO STEREO
Here you can specify the on/off status and pan settings
of the signal sent from the corresponding channel to
the STEREO bus. These are linked with the [TO STE-
REO] key and STEREO [PAN] encoder of the
corresponding channel.
Hint
If insert or direct out is turned on, the current insert point or
direct out point within the signal flow is shown.
If the signal clips, the signal flow (horizontal line) after clip-
ping is displayed in red. If an output is turned off so that the
signal does not flow any further, the subsequent flow is dis-
played in gray. If PEAK HOLD is on, the flow indication will
stay red if clipping occurs even once, making it easier to see
that clipping has occurred.
This screen shows the on/off status, level, and cue monitor
status of the input channels and DCA groups.
Except for the fact that this screen is for input channels,
DCA groups, and STEREO A/B channels, this is the same
as the OUTPUT VIEW function FADER VIEW screen.
Refer to p.249.
5
FADER VIEW screen
FADER VIEW
PM5D/PM5D-RH Owner’s Manual Reference section 289
Information shown
in the display
Function
menu
Global
functions
Output
functions
Input
functions
Appendices
In this screen you can copy the desired parameter(s) from
the selected input channel into a memory buffer, and paste
them to the same type of channel (you may select more
than one paste-destination).
Except for the fact that these settings are for input chan-
nels, this is the same as the OUTPUT VIEW function CH
COPY screen. Refer to p.249.
Note
The same buffer memory is used to copy channel settings
for both input channels and output channels.
If output channel settings have been copied to the buffer
memory, a message of “TYPE CONFLICT!” is displayed in
the box at the left, and you cannot paste to an input channel.
The contents of the buffer memory are erased when the
PM5D is powered-off.
Here you can recall, store, rename, or delete items in the
input channel library.
Except for the fact that these settings are for input chan-
nels, this is the same as the OUTPUT VIEW function CH
LIBRARY screen. Refer to p.251.
CH COPY screen
CH COPY
INPUT CH LIBRARY (Input channel
library) screen
INPUT CH LIBRARY
Appendices
290 PM5D/PM5D-RH Owner’s Manual Reference section
EQ Library List
Appendices
#Title
Parameter
LOW L-MID H-MID HIGH
01
Bass Drum
1
PEAKING PEAKING PEAKING H.SHELF
G +3.5 dB –3.5 dB 0.0 dB +4.0 dB
F 100 Hz 265 Hz 1.06 kHz 5.30 kHz
Q 1.2 10 0.9
02
Bass Drum
2
PEAKING PEAKING PEAKING LPF
G +8.0 dB –7.0 dB +6.0 dB ON
F 80 Hz 400 Hz 2.50 kHz 12.5 kHz
Q 1.4 4.5 2.2
03
Snare
Drum 1
PEAKING PEAKING PEAKING H.SHELF
G –0.5 dB 0.0 dB +3.0 dB +4.5 dB
F 132 Hz 1.00 kHz 3.15 kHz 5.00 kHz
Q 1.2 4.5 0.11
04
Snare
Drum 2
L.SHELF PEAKING PEAKING PEAKING
G +1.5 dB –8.5 dB +2.5 dB +4.0 dB
F 180 Hz 335 Hz 2.36 kHz 4.00 kHz
Q —100.7 0.1
05 Tom-tom 1
PEAKING PEAKING PEAKING PEAKING
G +2.0 dB –7.5 dB +2.0 dB +1.0 dB
F 212 Hz 670 Hz 4.50 kHz 6.30 kHz
Q 1.4 10 1.2 0.28
06 Cymbal
L.SHELF PEAKING PEAKING H.SHELF
G –2.0 dB 0.0 dB 0.0 dB +3.0 dB
F 106 Hz 425 Hz 1.06 kHz 13.2 kHz
Q —80.9
07 High Hat
L.SHELF PEAKING PEAKING H.SHELF
G –4.0 dB –2.5 dB +1.0 dB +0.5 dB
F 95 Hz 425 Hz 2.80 kHz 7.50 kHz
Q 0.5 1
08 Percussion
L.SHELF PEAKING PEAKING H.SHELF
G –4.5 dB 0.0 dB +2.0 dB 0.0 dB
F 100 Hz 400 Hz 2.80 kHz 17.0 kHz
Q 4.5 0.56
09 E. Bass 1
L.SHELF PEAKING PEAKING H.SHELF
G –7.5 dB +4.5 dB +2.5 dB 0.0 dB
F 35.5 Hz 112 Hz 2.00 kHz 4.00 kHz
Q —54.5
10 E. Bass 2
PEAKING PEAKING PEAKING H.SHELF
G +3.0 dB 0.0 dB +2.5 dB +0.5 dB
F 112 Hz 112 Hz 2.24 kHz 4.00 kHz
Q 0.1 5 6.3
11 Syn. Bass 1
PEAKING PEAKING PEAKING H.SHELF
G +3.5 dB +8.5 dB 0.0 dB 0.0 dB
F 85 Hz 950 Hz 4.00 kHz 12.5 kHz
Q 0.1 8 4.5
12 Syn. Bass 2
PEAKING PEAKING PEAKING H.SHELF
G +2.5 dB 0.0 dB +1.5 dB 0.0 dB
F 125 Hz 180 Hz 1.12 kHz 12.5 kHz
Q 1.6 8 2.2
13 Piano 1
L.SHELF PEAKING PEAKING H.SHELF
G –6.0 dB 0.0 dB +2.0 dB +4.0 dB
F 95 Hz 950 Hz 3.15 kHz 7.50 kHz
Q —80.9
14 Piano 2
PEAKING PEAKING PEAKING H.SHELF
G +3.5 dB –8.5 dB +1.5 dB +3.0 dB
F 224 Hz 600 Hz 3.15 kHz 5.30 kHz
Q 5.6 10 0.7
15 E. G. Clean
PEAKING PEAKING PEAKING H.SHELF
G +2.0 dB –5.5 dB +0.5 dB +2.5 dB
F 265 Hz 400 Hz 1.32 kHz 4.50 kHz
Q 0.18 10 6.3
16
E. G.
Crunch 1
PEAKING PEAKING PEAKING PEAKING
G +4.5 dB 0.0 dB +4.0 dB +2.0 dB
F 140 Hz 1.00 kHz 1.90 kHz 5.60 kHz
Q 8 4.5 0.63 9
17
E. G.
Crunch 2
PEAKING PEAKING PEAKING H.SHELF
G +2.5 dB +1.5 dB +2.5 dB 0.0 dB
F 125 Hz 450 Hz 3.35 kHz 19.0 kHz
Q 8 0.4 0.16
18 E. G. Dist. 1
L.SHELF PEAKING PEAKING H.SHELF
G +5.0 dB 0.0 dB +3.5 dB 0.0 dB
F 355 Hz 950 Hz 3.35 kHz 12.5 kHz
Q —910
19 E. G. Dist. 2
L.SHELF PEAKING PEAKING H.SHELF
G +6.0 dB –8.5 dB +4.5 dB +4.0 dB
F 315 Hz 1.06 kHz 4.25 kHz 12.5 kHz
Q —10 4
20
A. G.
Stroke 1
PEAKING PEAKING PEAKING H.SHELF
G –2.0 dB 0.0 dB +1.0 dB +4.0 dB
F 106 Hz 1.00 kHz 1.90 kHz 5.30 kHz
Q 0.9 4.5 3.5
21
A. G.
Stroke 2
L.SHELF PEAKING PEAKING H.SHELF
G –3.5 dB –2.0 dB 0.0 dB +2.0 dB
F 300 Hz 750 Hz 2.00 kHz 3.55 kHz
Q —94.5
22
A. G.
Arpeg. 1
L.SHELF PEAKING PEAKING PEAKING
G –0.5 dB 0.0 dB 0.0 dB +2.0 dB
F 224 Hz 1.00 kHz 4.00 kHz 6.70 kHz
Q 4.5 4.5 0.12
23
A. G.
Arpeg. 2
L.SHELF PEAKING PEAKING H.SHELF
G 0.0 dB –5.5 dB 0.0 dB +4.0 dB
F 180 Hz 355 Hz 4.00 kHz 4.25 kHz
Q —74.5
24 Brass Sec.
PEAKING PEAKING PEAKING PEAKING
G –2.0 dB –1.0 dB +1.5 dB +3.0 dB
F 90 Hz 850 Hz 2.12 kHz 4.50 kHz
Q 2.8 2 0.7 7
25
Male Vocal
1
PEAKING PEAKING PEAKING PEAKING
G –0.5 dB 0.0 dB +2.0 dB +3.5 dB
F 190 Hz 1.00 kHz 2.00 kHz 6.70 kHz
Q 0.11 4.5 0.56 0.11
26
Male Vocal
2
PEAKING PEAKING PEAKING H.SHELF
G +2.0 dB –5.0 dB –2.5 dB +4.0 dB
F 170 Hz 236 Hz 2.65 kHz 6.70 kHz
Q 0.11 10 5.6
#Title
Parameter
LOW L-MID H-MID HIGH
PM5D/PM5D-RH Owner’s Manual Reference section 291
Information shown
in the display
Function
menu
Global
functions
Output
functions
Input
functions
Appendices
GATE Library List
27
Female Vo.
1
PEAKING PEAKING PEAKING PEAKING
G –1.0 dB +1.0 dB +1.5 dB +2.0 dB
F 118 Hz 400 Hz 2.65 kHz 6.00 kHz
Q 0.18 0.45 0.56 0.14
28
Female Vo.
2
L.SHELF PEAKING PEAKING H.SHELF
G –7.0 dB +1.5 dB +1.5 dB +2.5 dB
F 112 Hz 335 Hz 2.00 kHz 6.70 kHz
Q 0.16 0.2
29
Chorus &
Harmo
PEAKING PEAKING PEAKING PEAKING
G –2.0 dB –1.0 dB +1.5 dB +3.0 dB
F 90 Hz 850 Hz 2.12 kHz 4.50 kHz
Q 2.8 2 0.7 7
30 Total EQ 1
PEAKING PEAKING PEAKING H.SHELF
G –0.5 dB 0.0 dB +3.0 dB +6.5 dB
F 95 Hz 950 Hz 2.12 kHz 16.0 kHz
Q 7 2.2 5.6
31 Total EQ 2
PEAKING PEAKING PEAKING H.SHELF
G +4.0 dB +1.5 dB +2.0 dB +6.0 dB
F 95 Hz 750 Hz 1.80 kHz 18.0 kHz
Q 7 2.8 5.6
32 Total EQ 3
L.SHELF PEAKING PEAKING H.SHELF
G +1.5 dB +0.5 dB +2.0 dB +4.0 dB
F 67 Hz 850 Hz 1.90 kHz 15.0 kHz
Q 0.28 0.7
33
Bass Drum
3
PEAKING PEAKING PEAKING PEAKING
G +3.5 dB –10.0 dB +3.5 dB 0.0 dB
F 118 Hz 315 Hz 4.25 kHz 20.0 kHz
Q 2100.4 0.4
34
Snare
Drum 3
L.SHELF PEAKING PEAKING PEAKING
G 0.0 dB +2.0 dB +3.5 dB 0.0 dB
F 224 Hz 560 Hz 4.25 kHz 4.00 kHz
Q 4.5 2.8 0.1
35 Tom-tom 2
L.SHELF PEAKING PEAKING H.SHELF
G –9.0 dB +1.5 dB +2.0 dB 0.0 dB
F 90 Hz 212 Hz 5.30 kHz 17.0 kHz
Q 4.5 1.2
36 Piano 3
PEAKING PEAKING PEAKING H.SHELF
G +4.5 dB –13.0 dB +4.5 dB +2.5 dB
F 100 Hz 475 Hz 2.36 kHz 10.0 kHz
Q 8109
37 Piano Low
PEAKING PEAKING PEAKING H.SHELF
G –5.5 dB +1.5 dB +6.0 dB 0.0 dB
F 190 Hz 400 Hz 6.70 kHz 12.5 kHz
Q 10 6.3 2.2
38 Piano High
PEAKING PEAKING PEAKING PEAKING
G –5.5 dB +1.5 dB +5.0 dB +3.0 dB
F 190 Hz 400 Hz 6.70 kHz 5.60 kHz
Q 10 6.3 2.2 0.1
39
Fine-EQ
Cass
L.SHELF PEAKING PEAKING H.SHELF
G –1.5 dB 0.0 dB +1.0 dB +3.0 dB
F 75 Hz 1.00 kHz 4.00 kHz 12.5 kHz
Q 4.5 1.8
40 Narrator
PEAKING PEAKING PEAKING H.SHELF
G –4.0 dB –1.0 dB +2.0 dB 0.0 dB
F 106 Hz 710 Hz 2.50 kHz 10.0 kHz
Q 470.63
#Title
Parameter
LOW L-MID H-MID HIGH
#Title Type Parameter Value
1 Gate GATE
Threshold (dB) –26
Range (dB) –56
Attack (ms) 0
Hold (ms) 2.56
Decay (ms) 331
2 Ducking DUCKING
Threshold (dB) –19
Range (dB) –22
Attack (ms) 93
Hold (ms) 1.20 S
Decay (ms) 6.32 S
3 A. Dr. BD GATE
Threshold (dB) –11
Range (dB) –53
Attack (ms) 0
Hold (ms) 1.93
Decay (ms) 400
4 A. Dr. SN GATE
Threshold (dB) –8
Range (dB) –23
Attack (ms) 1
Hold (ms) 0.63
Decay (ms) 238
Compressor Library List
292 PM5D/PM5D-RH Owner’s Manual Reference section
Compressor Library List
#Title Type Parameter Value
1 Comp COMP
Threshold (dB) –8
Ratio ( :1) 2.5
Attack (ms) 60
Out gain (dB) 0.0
Knee 2
Release (ms) 250
2 Expand EXPAND
Threshold (dB) –23
Ratio ( :1) 1.7
Attack (ms) 1
Out gain (dB) 3.5
Knee 2
Release (ms) 70
3
Compander
(H)
COMPAND-H
Threshold (dB) –10
Ratio ( :1) 3.5
Attack (ms) 1
Out gain (dB) 0.0
Width (dB) 6
Release (ms) 250
4
Compander
(S)
COMPAND-S
Threshold (dB) –8
Ratio ( :1) 4
Attack (ms) 25
Out gain (dB) 0.0
Width (dB) 24
Release (ms) 180
5 A. Dr. BD COMP
Threshold (dB) –24
Ratio ( :1) 3
Attack (ms) 9
Out gain (dB) 5.5
Knee 2
Release (ms) 58
6 A. Dr. BD COMPAND-H
Threshold (dB) –11
Ratio ( :1) 3.5
Attack (ms) 1
Out gain (dB) –1.5
Width (dB) 7
Release (ms) 192
7 A. Dr. SN COMP
Threshold (dB) –17
Ratio ( :1) 2.5
Attack (ms) 8
Out gain (dB) 3.5
Knee 2
Release (ms) 12
8 A. Dr. SN EXPAND
Threshold (dB) –23
Ratio ( :1) 2
Attack (ms) 0
Out gain (dB) 0.5
Knee 2
Release (ms) 151
9 A. Dr. SN COMPAND-S
Threshold (dB) –8
Ratio ( :1) 1.7
Attack (ms) 11
Out gain (dB) 0.0
Width (dB) 10
Release (ms) 128
10 A. Dr. Tom EXPAND
Threshold (dB) –20
Ratio ( :1) 2
Attack (ms) 2
Out gain (dB) 5.0
Knee 2
Release (ms) 749
11
A. Dr.
OverTop
COMPAND-S
Threshold (dB) –24
Ratio ( :1) 2
Attack (ms) 38
Out gain (dB) –3.5
Width (dB) 54
Release (ms) 842
12 E. B. Finger COMP
Threshold (dB) –12
Ratio ( :1) 2
Attack (ms) 15
Out gain (dB) 4.5
Knee 2
Release (ms) 470
13 E. B. Slap COMP
Threshold (dB) –12
Ratio ( :1) 1.7
Attack (ms) 6
Out gain (dB) 4.0
Knee hard
Release (ms) 133
14 Syn. Bass COMP
Threshold (dB) –10
Ratio ( :1) 3.5
Attack (ms) 9
Out gain (dB) 3.0
Knee hard
Release (ms) 250
15 Piano1 COMP
Threshold (dB) –9
Ratio ( :1) 2.5
Attack (ms) 17
Out gain (dB) 1.0
Knee hard
Release (ms) 238
16 Piano2 COMP
Threshold (dB) –18
Ratio ( :1) 3.5
Attack (ms) 7
Out gain (dB) 6.0
Knee 2
Release (ms) 174
17 E. Guitar COMP
Threshold (dB) –8
Ratio ( :1) 3.5
Attack (ms) 7
Out gain (dB) 2.5
Knee 4
Release (ms) 261
18 A. Guitar COMP
Threshold (dB) –10
Ratio ( :1) 2.5
Attack (ms) 5
Out gain (dB) 1.5
Knee 2
Release (ms) 238
19 Strings1 COMP
Threshold (dB) –11
Ratio ( :1) 2
Attack (ms) 33
Out gain (dB) 1.5
Knee 2
Release (ms) 749
20 Strings2 COMP
Threshold (dB) –12
Ratio ( :1) 1.5
Attack (ms) 93
Out gain (dB) 1.5
Knee 4
Release (ms) 1.35 S
#Title Type Parameter Value
PM5D/PM5D-RH Owner’s Manual Reference section 293
Information shown
in the display
Function
menu
Global
functions
Output
functions
Input
functions
Appendices
21 Strings3 COMP
Threshold (dB) –17
Ratio ( :1) 1.5
Attack (ms) 76
Out gain (dB) 2.5
Knee 2
Release (ms) 186
22 BrassSection COMP
Threshold (dB) –18
Ratio ( :1) 1.7
Attack (ms) 18
Out gain (dB) 4.0
Knee 1
Release (ms) 226
23 Syn. Pad COMP
Threshold (dB) –13
Ratio ( :1) 2
Attack (ms) 58
Out gain (dB) 2.0
Knee 1
Release (ms) 238
24 SamplingPerc COMPAND-S
Threshold (dB) –18
Ratio ( :1) 1.7
Attack (ms) 8
Out gain (dB) –2.5
Width (dB) 18
Release (ms) 238
25 Sampling BD COMP
Threshold (dB) –14
Ratio ( :1) 2
Attack (ms) 2
Out gain (dB) 3.5
Knee 4
Release (ms) 35
26 Sampling SN COMP
Threshold (dB) –18
Ratio ( :1) 4
Attack (ms) 8
Out gain (dB) 8.0
Knee hard
Release (ms) 354
27 Hip Comp COMPAND-S
Threshold (dB) –23
Ratio ( :1) 20
Attack (ms) 15
Out gain (dB) 0.0
Width (dB) 15
Release (ms) 163
28 Solo Vocal1 COMP
Threshold (dB) –20
Ratio ( :1) 2.5
Attack (ms) 31
Out gain (dB) 2.0
Knee 1
Release (ms) 342
29 Solo Vocal2 COMP
Threshold (dB) –8
Ratio ( :1) 2.5
Attack (ms) 26
Out gain (dB) 1.5
Knee 3
Release (ms) 331
30 Chorus COMP
Threshold (dB) –9
Ratio ( :1) 1.7
Attack (ms) 39
Out gain (dB) 2.5
Knee 2
Release (ms) 226
#Title Type Parameter Value
31 Click Erase EXPAND
Threshold (dB) –33
Ratio ( :1) 2
Attack (ms) 1
Out gain (dB) 2.0
Knee 2
Release (ms) 284
32 Announcer COMPAND-H
Threshold (dB) –14
Ratio ( :1) 2.5
Attack (ms) 1
Out gain (dB) –2.5
Width (dB) 18
Release (ms) 180
33 Limiter1 COMPAND-S
Threshold (dB) –9
Ratio ( :1) 3
Attack (ms) 20
Out gain (dB) –3.0
Width (dB) 90
Release (ms) 3.90 s
34 Limiter2 COMP
Threshold (dB) 0
Ratio ( :1)
Attack (ms) 0
Out gain (dB) 0.0
Knee hard
Release (ms) 319
35 Total Comp1 COMP
Threshold (dB) –18
Ratio ( :1) 3.5
Attack (ms) 94
Out gain (dB) 2.5
Knee hard
Release (ms) 447
36 Total Comp2 COMP
Threshold (dB) –16
Ratio ( :1) 6
Attack (ms) 11
Out gain (dB) 6.0
Knee 1
Release (ms) 180
#Title Type Parameter Value
Dynamics Parameters
294 PM5D/PM5D-RH Owner’s Manual Reference section
Dynamics Parameters
Each channel has a GATE section (input channels and ST IN channels only) and a COMP section. The Gate section includes
Gate and Ducking types. The Comp section includes Compressor, Expander, Compander Hard (COMP. (H)), and Com-
pander Soft (COMP. (S)) types.
GATE
A gate attenuates signals below a set THRESHOLD level by a specified amount (RANGE).
DUCKING
Ducking is commonly used for voice-over applications in which the background music level is reduced automatically when an
announcer speaks. When the KEY IN source signal level exceeds the specified THRESHOLD, the output level is attenuated by
a specified amount (RANGE).
GATE section
Parameter Range Description
THRESHOLD (dB) –54.0 to 0.0 (541 points) This determines the level at which the gate effect is applied.
RANGE (dB) –70 to 0 (71 points) This determines the amount of attenuation when the gate closes.
ATTACK (ms) 0–120 (121 points) This determines how fast the gate opens when the signal exceeds the threshold level.
HOLD (ms)
44.1kHz: 0.02 ms – 2.13 sec
48kHz: 0.02 ms – 1.96 sec
88.2kHz: 0.01 ms – 1.06 sec
96kHz: 0.01 ms – 981 ms (160 points)
This determines how long the gate stays open once the trigger signal has fallen
below the threshold.
DECAY (ms)
44.1kHz: 6 ms – 46.0 sec
48kHz: 5 ms – 42.3 sec
88.2kHz: 3 ms – 23.0 sec
96kHz: 3 ms – 21.1 sec (160 points)
This determines how fast the gate closes once the hold time has expired. The value is
expressed as the duration required for the level to change by 6 dB.
Parameter Range Description
THRESHOLD (dB) –54.0 to 0.0 (541 points) This determines the level of trigger signal (KEY IN) required to activate ducking.
RANGE (dB) –70 to 0 (71 points) This determines the amount of attenuation when ducking is activated.
ATTACK (ms) 0–120 (121 points) This determines how soon the signal is ducked once the ducker has been triggered.
HOLD (ms)
44.1kHz: 0.02 ms – 2.13 sec
48kHz: 0.02 ms – 1.96 sec
88.2kHz: 0.01 ms – 1.06 sec
96kHz: 0.01 ms – 981 ms (160 points)
This determines how long ducking remains active once the trigger signal has fallen
below the THRESHOLD level.
DECAY (ms)
44.1kHz: 6 ms – 46.0 sec
48kHz: 5 ms – 42.3 sec
88.2kHz: 3 ms – 23.0 sec
96kHz: 3 ms – 21.1 sec (160 points)
This determines how soon the ducker returns to its normal gain once the trigger sig-
nal level drops below the threshold. The value is expressed as the duration required
for the level to change by 6 dB.
Input Level Time Time
Output Level
Input Level
Output Level
I/O Characteristics Time Series Analysis
RANGE
THRESHOLD
THRESHOLD
RANGE
Input Signal Output Signal
ATTACK DECAY
HOLD
Input Level Time Time
Output Level
Input Level
Output Level
I/O Characteristics Time Series Analysis
RANGE
THRESHOLD
THRESHOLD
RANGE
Input Signal Output Signal
ATTACK DECAY
HOLD
PM5D/PM5D-RH Owner’s Manual Reference section 295
Information shown
in the display
Function
menu
Global
functions
Output
functions
Input
functions
Appendices
Compressor (COMP)
The COMP processor attenuates signals above a specified THRESHOLD by a specified RATIO. The COMP processor can also
be used as a limiter, which, with a RATIO of :1, reduces the level to the threshold. This means that the limiter’s output level
never actually exceeds the threshold.
Expander (EXPAND)
An expander attenuates signals below a specified THRESHOLD by a specified RATIO.
COMP section
Parameter Range Description
THRESHOLD (dB) –54.0 to 0.0 (541 points) This determines the level of input signal required to trigger the compressor.
RATIO
1.0:1, 1.1:1, 1.3:1, 1.5:1, 1.7:1, 2.0:1,
2.5:1, 3.0:1, 3.5:1, 4.0:1, 5.0:1, 6.0:1,
8.0:1, 10:1, 20:1, :1 (16 points)
This determines the amount of compression, that is, the change in output signal level
relative to change in input signal level.
ATTACK (ms) 0–120 (121 points)
This determines how soon the signal will be compressed once the compressor has
been triggered.
RELEASE (ms)
44.1kHz: 6 ms – 46.0 sec
48kHz: 5 ms – 42.3 sec
88.2kHz: 3 ms – 23.0 sec
96kHz: 3 ms – 21.1 sec (160 points)
This determines how soon the compressor returns to its normal gain once the trigger
signal level drops below the threshold. The value is expressed as the duration
required for the level to change by 6 dB.
OUT GAIN (dB) 0.0 to +18.0 (180 points) This sets the compressor’s output signal level.
KNEE Hard, 1–5 (6 points)
This determines how compression is applied at the threshold. For higher knee set-
tings, compression is applied gradually as the signal exceeds the specified threshold,
creating a more natural sound.
Input Level Time Time
Output Level
Input Level
Output Level
Time Series Analysis (RATIO= :1)
RATIO
THRESHOLD
THRESHOLD
Input signal Output Signal
ATTACK RELEASE
I/O Characteristics
(KNEE= hard, OUT GAIN=0.0dB)
Parameter Range Description
THRESHOLD (dB) –54.0 to 0.0 (541 points) This determines the level of input signal required to trigger the expander.
RATIO
1.0:1, 1.1:1, 1.3:1, 1.5:1, 1.7:1, 2.0:1,
2.5:1, 3.0:1, 3.5:1, 4.0:1, 5.0:1, 6.0:1,
8.0:1, 10:1, 20:1, :1 (16 points)
This determines the amount of expansion.
ATTACK (ms) 0–120 (121 points)
This determines how soon the expander returns to its normal gain once the trigger
signal level exceeds the threshold.
RELEASE (ms)
44.1kHz: 6 ms – 46.0 sec
48kHz: 5 ms – 42.3 sec
88.2kHz: 3 ms – 23.0 sec
96kHz: 3 ms – 21.1 sec (160 points)
This determines how soon the signal is expanded once the signal level drops below
the threshold. The value is expressed as the duration required for the level to change
by 6 dB.
OUT GAIN (dB) 0.0 to +18.0 (180 points) This sets the expander’s output signal level.
KNEE Hard, 1–5 (6 points)
This determines how expansion is applied at the threshold. For higher knee settings,
expansion is applied gradually as the signal falls below the specified threshold, creat-
ing a more natural sound.
Input Level Time Time
Output Level
Input Level
Output Level
I/O Characteristics
(KNEE= hard, OUT GAIN= 0.0dB)
Time Series Analysis (RATIO= :1)
RATIO
THRESHOLD
THRESHOLD
Input Signal Output Signal
ATTACK RELEASE
Dynamics Parameters
296 PM5D/PM5D-RH Owner’s Manual Reference section
COMPANDER HARD (COMP.(H))
COMPANDER SOFT (COMP.(S))
The hard and soft companders combine the effects of the compressor, expander and limiter.
The companders function differently at the following levels:
1 0 dB and higher . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . Functions as a limiter.
2 Exceeding the threshold . . . . . . . . . . Functions as a compressor.
3 Below the threshold and width . . . . Functions as an expander.
The hard compander has an expansion ratio of 5:1, while the soft compander has an expansion ratio of 1.5:1. The expander is
essentially turned off when the width is set to maximum. The compressor has a fixed knee setting of 2.
* The gain is automatically adjusted according to the ratio and threshold values, and can be increased by up to 18 dB.
* The OUT GAIN parameter enables you to compensate for the overall level change caused by the compression and expan-
sion processes.
Parameter Range Description
THRESHOLD (dB) –54.0 to 0.0 (541 points) This determines the level at which compression is applied.
RATIO
1.0:1, 1.1:1, 1.3:1, 1.5:1, 1.7:1, 2.0:1,
2.5:1, 3.0:1, 3.5:1, 4.0:1, 5.0:1, 6.0:1,
8.0:1, 10:1, 20:1, (15 points)
This determines the amount of compression.
ATTACK (ms) 0–120 (121 points)
This determines how soon the signal is compressed or expanded once the com-
pander has been triggered.
RELEASE (ms)
44.1kHz: 6 ms – 46.0 sec
48kHz: 5 ms – 42.3 sec
88.2kHz: 3 ms – 23.0 sec
96kHz: 3 ms – 21.1 sec (160 points)
This determines how soon the compressor or expander returns to the normal gain
once the trigger signal level drops below or exceeds the threshold respectively. The
value is expressed as the duration required for the level to change by 6 dB.
OUT GAIN (dB) –18.0 to 0.0 (180 points) This sets the compander’s output signal level.
WIDTH (dB) 0–90 (91 points)
This determines how far below the threshold expansion will be applied. The expander
is activated when the level drops below the threshold and width.
0dB
Input Level
Output Level
THRESHOLD
WIDTH
PM5D/PM5D-RH Owner’s Manual Reference section 297
Information shown
in the display
Function
menu
Global
functions
Output
functions
Input
functions
Appendices
Effect Library List
This is a list of the built-in effects. By installing a separately sold Add-On Effects package you can add new effect types to num-
ber 49 and following.
* These library numbers are reserved for the installation of Add-On
Effects. Effects that are not installed are grayed-out and unavailable.
No. Title Type Description
001 Reverb Hall REVERB HALL
Concert hall reverberation
simulation with gate
002 Reverb Room REVERB ROOM
Room reverberation simula-
tion with gate
003 Reverb Stage REVERB STAGE
Reverb designed for vocals,
with gate
004 Reverb Plate REVERB PLATE
Plate reverb simulation with
gate
005 Early Ref. EARLY REF.
Early reflections without the
subsequent reverb
006 Gate Reverb GATE REVERB Gated early reflections
007 Reverse Gate REVERSE GATE
Gated reverse early reflec-
tions
008 Mono Delay MONO DELAY Simple mono delay
009 Stereo Delay STEREO DELAY Simple stereo delay
010 Mod.Delay MOD.DELAY
Simple repeat delay with
modulation
011 Delay LCR DELAY LCR
3-tap (left, center, right)
delay
012 Echo ECHO
Stereo delay with crossed
left/right feedback
013 Chorus CHORUS Chorus
014 Flange FLANGE Flanger
015 Symphonic SYMPHONIC
Proprietary Yamaha effect
that produces a richer and
more complex modulation
than normal chorus
016 Phaser PHASER
16-stage stereo phase
shifter
017 Auto Pan AUTO PAN Auto-panner
018 Tremolo TREMOLO Tremolo
019 HQ. Pitch HQ.PITCH
Mono pitch shifter, produc-
ing stable results
020 Dual Pitch DUAL PITCH Stereo pitch shifter
021 Rotary ROTARY Rotary speaker simulation
022 Ring Mod. RING MOD. Ring modulator
023 Mod.Filter MOD.FILTER Modulated filter
024 Distortion DISTORTION Distortion
025 Amp Simulate AMP SIMULATE Guitar amp simulation
026 Dyna.Filter DYNA.FILTER Dynamically controlled filter
027 Dyna.Flange DYNA.FLANGE
Dynamically controlled
flanger
028 Dyna.Phaser DYNA.PHASER
Dynamically controlled
phase shifter
029 Rev+Chorus REV+CHORUS
Reverb and chorus in paral-
lel
030 RevChorus REVCHORUS Reverb and chorus in series
031 Rev+Flange REV+FLANGE
Reverb and flanger in paral-
lel
032 RevFlange REVFLANGE Reverb and flanger in series
033 Rev+Sympho. REV+SYMPHO.
Reverb and symphonic in
parallel
034 RevSympho. REVSYMPHO.
Reverb and symphonic in
series
035 RevPan REVPAN
Reverb and auto-pan in
series
036 Delay+Er. DELAY+ER.
Delay and early reflections
in parallel
037 Delay+Er. DELAYER.
Delay and early reflections
in series
038 Delay+Rev DELAY+REV Delay and reverb in parallel
039 DelayRev DELAYREV Delay and reverb in series
040 DistDelay DISTDELAY
Distortion and delay in
series
041 Multi.Filter MULTI.FILTER
3-band parallel filter (24 dB/
octave)
042 Freeze FREEZE Simple sampler
043 Stereo Reverb ST REVERB Stereo reverb
044 M.Band Dyna. M.BAND DYNA.
Multi-band dynamics pro-
cessor
045 M.Band Comp M.BAND COMP Multi-band compressor
046 REV-X Hall
REV-X HALL
New reverb algorithm that
delivers dense and rich
reverberation, smooth
decay, and provides a spa-
ciousness and depth that
enhances the original
sound. Choose from three
types depending on your
location and needs; REV-X
HALL, REV-X ROOM, and
REV-X PLATE.
047 REV-X Room
REV-X ROOM
048 REV-X Plate
REV-X PLATE
049 Comp276 * COMP276 *
050 Comp276S * COMP276S *
051 Comp260* COMP260*
052 Comp260S * COMP260S *
053 Equalizer601 * EQUALIZER601*
054 OpenDeck * OPENDECK *
No. Title Type Description
Effects Parameters
298 PM5D/PM5D-RH Owner’s Manual Reference section
Effects Parameters
REVERB HALL, REVERB ROOM, REVERB
STAGE, REVERB PLATE
One input, two output hall, room, stage, and plate reverb
simulations, all with gates.
EARLY REF.
One input, two output early reflections.
GATE REVERB, REVERSE GATE
One input, two output early reflections with gate, and early
reflections with reverse gate.
MONO DELAY
One input, one output basic repeat delay.
STEREO DELAY
Two input, two output basic stereo delay.
Parameter Range Description
REV TIME 0.3–99.0 s Reverb time
INI. DLY 0.0–500.0 ms
Initial delay before reverb
begins
HI. RATIO 0.1–1.0
High-frequency reverb time
ratio
LO. RATIO 0.1–2.4
Low-frequency reverb time
ratio
DIFF. 0–10
Reverb diffusion (left–right
reverb spread)
DENSITY 0–100% Reverb density
E/R DLY 0.0–100.0 ms
Delay between early reflec-
tions and reverb
E/R BAL. 0–100%
Balance of early reflections
and reverb
(0% = all reverb, 100% = all
early reflections)
HPF THRU, 21.2 Hz–8.00 kHz
High-pass filter cutoff fre-
quency
LPF 50.0 Hz–16.0 kHz, THRU
Low-pass filter cutoff fre-
quency
GATE LVL OFF, –60 to 0 dB Level at which gate kicks in
ATTACK 0–120 ms Gate opening speed
HOLD
*1
*1. 0.02 ms–2.13 s (fs=44.1 kHz), 0.02 ms–1.96 s (fs=48 kHz),
0.01 ms–1.06 s (fs=88.2 kHz), 0.01 ms–981 ms (fs=96 kHz)
Gate open time
DECAY
*2
*2. 6.0 ms–46.0 s (fs=44.1 kHz), 5.0 ms–42.3 s (fs=48 kHz),
3 ms–23.0 s (fs=88.2 kHz), 3 ms–21.1 s (fs=96 kHz)
Gate closing speed
Parameter Range Description
TYPE
S-Hall, L-Hall, Random,
Revers, Plate, Spring
Type of early reflection sim-
ulation
ROOMSIZE 0.1–20.0 Reflection spacing
LIVENESS 0–10
Early reflections decay char-
acteristics (0 = dead, 10 =
live)
INI. DLY 0.0–500.0 ms
Initial delay before reverb
begins
DIFF. 0–10
Reflection diffusion (left–
right reflection spread)
DENSITY 0–100% Reflection density
ER NUM. 1–19 Number of early reflections
FB GAIN –99 to +99% Feedback gain
HI. RATIO 0.1–1.0
High-frequency feedback
ratio
HPF THRU, 21.2 Hz–8.00 kHz
High-pass filter cutoff fre-
quency
LPF 50.0 Hz–16.0 kHz, THRU
Low-pass filter cutoff fre-
quency
Parameter Range Description
TYPE Type-A, Type-B Type of early reflection simulation
ROOMSIZE 0.1–20.0 Reflection spacing
LIVENESS 0–10
Early reflections decay characteris-
tics (0 = dead, 10 = live)
INI. DLY 0.0–500.0 ms Initial delay before reverb begins
DIFF. 0–10
Reflection diffusion (left–right
reflection spread)
DENSITY 0–100% Reflection density
HI. RATIO 0.1–1.0 High-frequency feedback ratio
ER NUM. 1–19 Number of early reflections
FB GAIN –99 to +99% Feedback gain
HPF
THRU, 21.2 Hz–
8.00 kHz
High-pass filter cutoff frequency
LPF
50.0 Hz–16.0 kHz,
THRU
Low-pass filter cutoff frequency
Parameter Range Description
DELAY 0.0–2730.0 ms Delay time
FB. GAIN –99 to +99%
Feedback gain (plus values for
normal-phase feedback, minus
values for reverse-phase feedback)
HI. RATIO 0.1–1.0 High-frequency feedback ratio
HPF
THRU, 21.2 Hz–
8.00 kHz
High-pass filter cutoff frequency
LPF
50.0 Hz–16.0 kHz,
THRU
Low-pass filter cutoff frequency
SYNC OFF/ON Tempo parameter sync on/off
NOTE
*1
*1. (
Max. value depends on tempo setting)
Used in conjunction with TEMPO
to determine DELAY
Parameter Range Description
DELAY L 0.0–1350.0 ms Left channel delay time
DELAY R 0.0–1350.0 ms Right channel delay time
FB. G L –99 to +99%
Left channel feedback (plus values
for normal-phase feedback, minus
values for reverse-phase feedback)
FB. G R –99 to +99%
Right channel feedback (plus val-
ues for normal-phase feedback,
minus values for reverse-phase
feedback)
HI. RATIO 0.1–1.0 High-frequency feedback ratio
HPF
THRU, 21.2 Hz–
8.00 kHz
High-pass filter cutoff frequency
LPF
50.0 Hz–16.0 kHz,
THRU
Low-pass filter cutoff frequency
SYNC OFF/ON Tempo parameter sync on/off
NOTE L
*1
*1.
(Maximum value depends on the tempo setting)
Used in conjunction with TEMPO
to determine left channel DELAY
NOTE R 1
Used in conjunction with TEMPO
to determine right channel DELAY
PM5D/PM5D-RH Owner’s Manual Reference section 299
Information shown
in the display
Function
menu
Global
functions
Output
functions
Input
functions
Appendices
MOD. DELAY
One input, two output basic repeat delay with modulation.
DELAY LCR
One input, two output 3-tap delay (left, center, right).
ECHO
Two input, two output stereo delay with crossed feedback
loop.
CHORUS
Two input, two output chorus effect.
Parameter Range Description
DELAY 0.0–2725.0 ms Delay time
FB. GAIN –99 to +99%
Feedback gain (plus values for
normal-phase feedback, minus
values for reverse-phase feedback)
HI. RATIO 0.1–1.0 High-frequency feedback ratio
FREQ. 0.05–40.00 Hz Modulation speed
DEPTH 0–100% Modulation depth
WAVE Sine/Tri Modulation waveform
HPF
THRU, 21.2 Hz–
8.00 kHz
High-pass filter cutoff frequency
LPF
50.0 Hz–16.0 kHz,
THRU
Low-pass filter cutoff frequency
SYNC OFF/ON Tempo parameter sync on/off
DLY.NOTE
*1
*1. (
Maximum value depends on the tempo setting)
Used in conjunction with TEMPO
to determine DELAY
MOD.NOTE
*2
*2.
Used in conjunction with TEMPO
to determine FREQ
Parameter Range Description
DELAY L 0.0–2730.0 ms Left channel delay time
DELAY C 0.0–2730.0 ms Center channel delay time
DELAY R 0.0–2730.0 ms Right channel delay time
FB. DLY 0.0–2730.0 ms Feedback delay time
LEVEL L –100 to +100% Left channel delay level
LEVEL C –100 to +100% Center channel delay level
LEVEL R –100 to +100% Right channel delay level
FB. GAIN –99 to +99%
Feedback gain (plus values for
normal-phase feedback, minus
values for reverse-phase feedback)
HI. RATIO 0.1–1.0 High-frequency feedback ratio
HPF
THRU, 21.2 Hz–
8.00 kHz
High-pass filter cutoff frequency
LPF
50.0 Hz–16.0 kHz,
THRU
Low-pass filter cutoff frequency
SYNC OFF/ON Tempo parameter sync on/off
NOTE L
*1
*1. (
Maximum value depends on the tempo setting)
Used in conjunction with TEMPO
to determine DELAY L
NOTE C 1
Used in conjunction with TEMPO
to determine DELAY C
NOTE R 1
Used in conjunction with TEMPO
to determine DELAY R
NOTE FB 1
Used in conjunction with TEMPO
to determine FB. DLY
Parameter Range Description
DELAY L 0.0–1350.0 ms Left channel delay time
DELAY R 0.0–1350.0 ms Right channel delay time
FB.DLY L 0.0–1350.0 ms Left channel feedback delay time
FB.DLY R 0.0–1350.0 ms Right channel feedback delay time
FB. G L –99 to +99%
Left channel feedback gain (plus
values for normal-phase feedback,
minus values for reverse-phase
feedback)
FB. G R –99 to +99%
Right channel feedback gain (plus
values for normal-phase feedback,
minus values for reverse-phase
feedback)
LR FBG –99 to +99%
Left to right channel feedback
gain (plus values for normal-phase
feedback, minus values for
reverse-phase feedback)
RL FBG –99 to +99%
Right to left channel feedback
gain (plus values for normal-phase
feedback, minus values for
reverse-phase feedback)
HI. RATIO 0.1–1.0 High-frequency feedback ratio
HPF
THRU, 21.2 Hz–
8.00 kHz
High-pass filter cutoff frequency
LPF
50.0 Hz–16.0 kHz,
THRU
Low-pass filter cutoff frequency
SYNC OFF/ON Tempo parameter sync on/off
NOTE L
*1
*1.
(Maximum value depends on the tempo setting)
Used in conjunction with TEMPO
to determine DELAY L
NOTE R 1
Used in conjunction with TEMPO
to determine DELAY R
NOTE FBL 1
Used in conjunction with TEMPO
to determine FB. D L
NOTE FBR 1
Used in conjunction with TEMPO
to determine FB. D R
Parameter Range Description
FREQ. 0.05–40.00 Hz Modulation speed
AM DEPTH 0–100% Amplitude modulation depth
PM DEPTH 0–100% Pitch modulation depth
MOD. DLY 0.0–500.0 ms Modulation delay time
WAVE Sine, Tri Modulation waveform
LSH F 21.2 Hz–8.00 kHz Low shelving filter frequency
LSH G –12 to +12 dB Low shelving filter gain
EQ F 100 Hz–8.00 kHz EQ (peaking type) frequency
EQ G –12 to +12 dB EQ (peaking type) gain
EQ Q 10.0–0.10 EQ (peaking type) bandwidth
HSH F 50.0 Hz–16.0 kHz High shelving filter frequency
HSH G –12 to +12 dB High shelving filter gain
SYNC OFF/ON Tempo parameter sync on/off
NOTE
*1
*1.
Used in conjunction with TEMPO
to determine FREQ.
Effects Parameters
300 PM5D/PM5D-RH Owner’s Manual Reference section
FLANGE
Two input, two output flange effect.
SYMPHONIC
Two input, two output symphonic effect.
PHASER
Two input, two output 16-stage phaser.
AUTOPAN
Two input, two output autopanner.
TREMOLO
Two input, two output tremolo effect.
HQ. PITCH
One input, two output high-quality pitch shifter.
Parameter Range Description
FREQ. 0.05–40.00 Hz Modulation speed
DEPTH 0–100% Modulation depth
MOD. DLY 0.0–500.0 ms Modulation delay time
FB. GAIN –99 to +99%
Feedback gain (plus values for
normal-phase feedback, minus
values for reverse-phase feedback)
WAVE Sine, Tri Modulation waveform
LSH F 21.2 Hz–8.00 kHz Low shelving filter frequency
LSH G –12 to +12 dB Low shelving filter gain
EQ F 100 Hz–8.00 kHz EQ (peaking type) frequency
EQ G –12 to +12 dB EQ (peaking type) gain
EQ Q 10.0–0.10 EQ (peaking type) bandwidth
HSH F 50.0 Hz–16.0 kHz High shelving filter frequency
HSH G –12 to +12 dB High shelving filter gain
SYNC OFF/ON Tempo parameter sync on/off
NOTE
*1
*1.
Used in conjunction with TEMPO
to determine FREQ.
Parameter Range Description
FREQ. 0.05–40.00 Hz Modulation speed
DEPTH 0–100% Modulation depth
MOD. DLY 0.0–500.0 ms Modulation delay time
WAVE Sine, Tri Modulation waveform
LSH F 21.2 Hz–8.00 kHz Low shelving filter frequency
LSH G –12 to +12 dB Low shelving filter gain
EQ F 100 Hz–8.00 kHz EQ (peaking type) frequency
EQ G –12 to +12 dB EQ (peaking type) gain
EQ Q 10.0–0.10 EQ (peaking type) bandwidth
HSH F 50.0 Hz–16.0 kHz High shelving filter frequency
HSH G –12 to +12 dB High shelving filter gain
SYNC OFF/ON Tempo parameter sync on/off
NOTE
*1
*1.
Used in conjunction with TEMPO
to determine FREQ.
Parameter Range Description
FREQ. 0.05–40.00 Hz Modulation speed
DEPTH 0–100% Modulation depth
FB. GAIN –99 to +99%
Feedback gain (plus values for
normal-phase feedback, minus
values for reverse-phase feedback)
OFFSET 0–100
Lowest phase-shifted frequency
offset
PHASE
0.00–354.38
degrees
Left and right modulation phase
balance
STAGE
2, 4, 6, 8, 10, 12,
14, 16
Number of phase shift stages
LSH F 21.2 Hz–8.00 kHz Low shelving filter frequency
LSH G –12 to +12 dB Low shelving filter gain
HSH F 50.0 Hz–16.0 kHz High shelving filter frequency
HSH G –12 to +12 dB High shelving filter gain
SYNC OFF/ON Tempo parameter sync on/off
NOTE
*1
*1.
Used in conjunction with TEMPO
to determine FREQ.
Parameter Range Description
FREQ. 0.05–40.00 Hz Modulation speed
DEPTH 0–100% Modulation depth
DIR.
*1
*1. LR, LR, LR, Turn L, Turn R
Panning direction
WAVE Sine, Tri, Square Modulation waveform
LSH F 21.2 Hz–8.00 kHz Low shelving filter frequency
LSH G –12 to +12 dB Low shelving filter gain
EQ F 100 Hz–8.00 kHz EQ (peaking type) frequency
EQ G –12 to +12 dB EQ (peaking type) gain
EQ Q 10.0–0.10 EQ (peaking type) bandwidth
HSH F 50.0 Hz–16.0 kHz High shelving filter frequency
HSH G –12 to +12 dB High shelving filter gain
SYNC OFF/ON Tempo parameter sync on/off
NOTE
*2
*2.
Used in conjunction with TEMPO
to determine FREQ.
Parameter Range Description
FREQ. 0.05–40.00 Hz Modulation speed
DEPTH 0–100% Modulation depth
WAVE Sine, Tri, Square Modulation waveform
LSH F 21.2 Hz–8.00 kHz Low shelving filter frequency
LSH G –12 to +12 dB Low shelving filter gain
EQ F 100 Hz–8.00 kHz EQ (peaking type) frequency
EQ G –12 to +12 dB EQ (peaking type) gain
EQ Q 10.0–0.10 EQ (peaking type) bandwidth
HSH F 50.0 Hz–16.0 kHz High shelving filter frequency
HSH G –12 to +12 dB High shelving filter gain
SYNC OFF/ON Tempo parameter sync on/off
NOTE
*1
*1.
Used in conjunction with TEMPO
to determine FREQ.
Parameter Range Description
PITCH –12 to +12 semitones Pitch shift
FINE –50 to +50 cents Pitch shift fine
DELAY 0.0–1000.0 ms Delay time
FB. GAIN –99 to +99%
Feedback gain (plus values for
normal-phase feedback, minus
values for reverse-phase feed-
back)
MODE 1–10 Pitch shift precision
SYNC OFF/ON Tempo parameter sync on/off
NOTE
*1
*1.
(Maximum value depends on the tempo setting)
Used in conjunction with
TEMPO to determine DELAY
PM5D/PM5D-RH Owner’s Manual Reference section 301
Information shown
in the display
Function
menu
Global
functions
Output
functions
Input
functions
Appendices
DUAL PITCH
Two input, two output pitch shifter.
ROTARY
One input, two output rotary speaker simulator.
RING MOD.
Two input, two output ring modulator.
MOD. FILTER
Two input, two output modulation filter.
DISTORTION
One input, two output distortion effect.
AMP SIMULATE
One input, two output guitar amp simulator.
DYNA. FILTER
Two input, two output dynamically controlled filter.
Parameter Range Description
PITCH 1 –24 to +24 semitones Channel #1 pitch shift
FINE 1 –50 to +50 cents Channel #1 pitch shift fine
LEVEL 1 –100 to +100%
Channel #1 level (plus values
for normal phase, minus values
for reverse phase)
PAN 1 L63 to R63 Channel #1 pan
DELAY 1 0.0–1000.0 ms Channel #1 delay time
FB. G 1 –99 to +99%
Channel #1 feedback gain (plus
values for normal-phase feed-
back, minus values for
reverse-phase feedback)
PITCH 2 –24 to +24 semitones Channel #2 pitch shift
FINE 2 –50 to +50 cents Channel #2 pitch shift fine
LEVEL 2 –100 to +100%
Channel #2 level (plus values
for normal phase, minus values
for reverse phase)
PAN 2 L63 to R63 Channel #2 pan
DELAY 2 0.0–1000.0 ms Channel #2 delay time
FB. G 2 –99 to +99%
Channel #2 feedback gain (plus
values for normal-phase feed-
back, minus values for
reverse-phase feedback)
MODE 1–10 Pitch shift precision
SYNC OFF/ON Tempo parameter sync on/off
NOTE 1
*1
*1.
(Maximum value depends on the tempo setting)
Used in conjunction with
TEMPO to determine Channel
#1 delay
NOTE 2 1
Used in conjunction with
TEMPO to determine Channel
#2 delay
Parameter Range Description
ROTATE STOP, START Rotation stop, start
SPEED SLOW, FAST
Rotation speed (see SLOW and
FAST parameters)
SLOW 0.05–10.00 Hz SLOW rotation speed
FAST 0.05–10.00 Hz FAST rotation speed
DRIVE 0–100 Overdrive level
ACCEL 0–10 Acceleration at speed changes
LOW 0–100 Low-frequency filter
HIGH 0–100 High-frequency filter
Parameter Range Description
SOURCE OSC, SELF
Modulation source: oscillator or
input signal
OSC FREQ 0.0–5000.0 Hz Oscillator frequency
FM FREQ. 0.05–40.00 Hz
Oscillator frequency modulation
speed
FM DEPTH 0–100%
Oscillator frequency modulation
depth
SYNC OFF/ON Tempo parameter sync on/off
NOTE FM
*1
*1.
Used in conjunction with TEMPO
to determine FM FREQ
Parameter Range Description
FREQ. 0.05–40.00 Hz Modulation speed
DEPTH 0–100% Modulation depth
PHASE 0.00–354.38 degrees
Left-channel modulation and
right-channel modulation
phase difference
TYPE LPF, HPF, BPF
Filter type: low pass, high pass,
band pass
OFFSET 0–100 Filter frequency offset
RESO. 0–20 Filter resonance
LEVEL 0–100 Output level
SYNC OFF/ON Tempo parameter sync on/off
NOTE
*1
*1.
Used in conjunction with
TEMPO to determine FREQ
Parameter Range Description
DST TYPE
DST1, DST2, OVD1,
OVD2, CRUNCH
Distortion type (DST = distortion,
OVD = overdrive)
DRIVE 0–100 Distortion drive
MASTER 0–100 Master volume
TONE –10 to +10 Tone
N. GATE 0–20 Noise reduction
Parameter Range Description
AMP TYPE
*1
*1. STK-M1, STK-M2, THRASH, MIDBST, CMB-PG, CMB-VR, CMB-
DX, CMB-TW, MINI, FLAT
Guitar amp simulation type
DST TYPE
DST1, DST2, OVD1,
OVD2, CRUNCH
Distortion type (DST = distortion,
OVD = overdrive)
DRIVE 0–100 Distortion drive
MASTER 0–100 Master volume
BASS 0–100 Bass tone control
MIDDLE 0–100 Middle tone control
TREBLE 0–100 High tone control
CAB DEP 0–100% Speaker cabinet simulation depth
EQ F 100 Hz–8.0 kHz EQ (peaking type) frequency
EQ G –12 to +12 dB EQ (peaking type) gain
EQ Q 10.0–0.10 EQ (peaking type) bandwidth
N. GATE 0–20 Noise reduction
Parameter Range Description
SOURCE INPUT, MIDI
Control source: input signal or
MIDI Note On velocity
SENSE 0–100 Sensitivity
DIR. UP, DOWN
Upward or downward frequency
change
DECAY
*1
*1. 6.0 ms–46.0 s (fs=44.1 kHz), 5.0 ms–42.3 s (fs=48 kHz),
3 ms–23.0 s (fs=88.2 kHz), 3 ms–21.1 s (fs=96 kHz)
Filter frequency change decay
speed
TYPE LPF, HPF, BPF Filter type
OFFSET 0–100 Filter frequency offset
RESO. 0–20 Filter resonance
LEVEL 0–100 Output Level
Effects Parameters
302 PM5D/PM5D-RH Owner’s Manual Reference section
DYNA. FLANGE
Two input, two output dynamically controlled flanger.
DYNA. PHASER
Two input, two output dynamically controlled phaser.
REV+CHORUS
One input, two output reverb and chorus effects in parallel.
REVCHORUS
One input, two output reverb and chorus effects in series.
Parameter Range Description
SOURCE INPUT, MIDI
Control source: input signal or
MIDI Note On velocity
SENSE 0–100 Sensitivity
DIR. UP, DOWN
Upward or downward frequency
change
DECAY
*1
*1. 6.0 ms–46.0 s (fs=44.1 kHz), 5.0 ms–42.3 s (fs=48 kHz),
3 ms–23.0 s (fs=88.2 kHz), 3 ms–21.1 s (fs=96 kHz)
Decay speed
OFFSET 0–100 Delay time offset
FB.GAIN –99 to +99%
Feedback gain (plus values for
normal-phase feedback, minus
values for reverse-phase feedback)
LSH F 21.2 Hz–8.00 kHz Low shelving filter frequency
LSH G –12 to +12 dB Low shelving filter gain
EQ F 100 Hz–8.00 kHz EQ (peaking type) frequency
EQ G –12 to +12 dB EQ (peaking type) gain
EQ Q 10.0–0.10 EQ (peaking type) bandwidth
HSH F 50.0 Hz–16.0 kHz High shelving filter frequency
HSH G –12 to +12 dB High shelving filter gain
Parameter Range Description
SOURCE INPUT, MIDI
Control source: input signal or
MIDI Note On velocity
SENSE 0–100 Sensitivity
DIR. UP, DOWN
Upward or downward frequency
change
DECAY
*1
*1. 6.0 ms–46.0 s (fs=44.1 kHz), 5.0 ms–42.3 s (fs=48 kHz),
3 ms–23.0 s (fs=88.2 kHz), 3 ms–21.1 s (fs=96 kHz)
Decay speed
OFFSET 0–100
Lowest phase-shifted frequency
offset
FB.GAIN –99 to +99%
Feedback gain (plus values for
normal-phase feedback, minus
values for reverse-phase feedback)
STAGE
2, 4, 6, 8, 10, 12,
14, 16
Number of phase shift stages
LSH F 21.2 Hz–8.00 kHz Low shelving filter frequency
LSH G –12 to +12 dB Low shelving filter gain
HSH F 50.0 Hz–16.0 kHz High shelving filter frequency
HSH G –12 to +12 dB High shelving filter gain
Parameter Range Description
REV TIME 0.3–99.0 s Reverb time
INI. DLY 0.0–500.0 ms Initial delay before reverb begins
HI. RATIO 0.1–1.0 High-frequency reverb time ratio
DIFF. 0–10 Spread
DENSITY 0–100% Reverb density
HPF
THRU, 21.2 Hz–
8.00 kHz
High-pass filter cutoff frequency
LPF
50.0 Hz–16.0 kHz,
THRU
Low-pass filter cutoff frequency
REV/CHO 0–100%
Reverb and chorus balance (0% =
all reverb, 100% = all chorus)
FREQ. 0.05–40.00 Hz Modulation speed
AM DEPTH 0–100% Amplitude modulation depth
PM DEPTH 0–100% Pitch modulation depth
MOD. DLY 0.0–500.0 ms Modulation delay time
WAVE Sine, Tri Modulation waveform
SYNC OFF/ON Tempo parameter sync on/off
NOTE
*1
*1.
Used in conjunction with TEMPO
to determine FREQ.
Parameter Range Description
REV TIME 0.3–99.0 s Reverb time
INI. DLY 0.0–500.0 ms Initial delay before reverb begins
HI. RATIO 0.1–1.0 High-frequency reverb time ratio
DIFF. 0–10 Spread
DENSITY 0–100% Reverb density
HPF
THRU, 21.2 Hz–
8.00 kHz
High-pass filter cutoff frequency
LPF
50.0 Hz–16.0 kHz,
THRU
Low-pass filter cutoff frequency
REV.BAL 0–100%
Reverb and chorused reverb bal-
ance (0% = all chorused reverb,
100% = all reverb)
FREQ. 0.05–40.00 Hz Modulation speed
AM DEPTH 0–100% Amplitude modulation depth
PM DEPTH 0–100% Pitch modulation depth
MOD. DLY 0.0–500.0 ms Modulation delay time
WAVE Sine, Tri Modulation waveform
SYNC OFF/ON Tempo parameter sync on/off
NOTE
*1
*1.
Used in conjunction with TEMPO
to determine FREQ.
PM5D/PM5D-RH Owner’s Manual Reference section 303
Information shown
in the display
Function
menu
Global
functions
Output
functions
Input
functions
Appendices
REV+FLANGE
One input, two output reverb and flanger effects in
parallel.
REVFLANGE
One input, two output reverb and flanger effects in series.
REV+SYMPHO.
One input, two output reverb and symphonic effects in
parallel.
REVSYMPHO.
One input, two output reverb and symphonic effects in
series.
Parameter Range Description
REV TIME 0.3–99.0 s Reverb time
INI. DLY 0.0–500.0 ms Initial delay before reverb begins
HI. RATIO 0.1–1.0 High-frequency reverb time ratio
DIFF. 0–10 Spread
DENSITY 0–100% Reverb density
HPF
THRU, 21.2 Hz–
8.00 kHz
High-pass filter cutoff frequency
LPF
50.0 Hz–16.0 kHz,
THRU
Low-pass filter cutoff frequency
REV/FLG 0–100%
Reverb and flange balance (0% =
all reverb, 100% = all flange)
FREQ. 0.05–40.00 Hz Modulation speed
DEPTH 0–100% Modulation depth
MOD. DLY 0.0–500.0 ms Modulation delay time
FB. GAIN –99 to +99%
Feedback gain (plus values for
normal-phase feedback, minus
values for reverse-phase feedback)
WAVE Sine, Tri Modulation waveform
SYNC OFF/ON Tempo parameter sync on/off
NOTE
*1
*1.
Used in conjunction with TEMPO
to determine FREQ.
Parameter Range Description
REV TIME 0.3–99.0 s Reverb time
INI. DLY 0.0–500.0 ms Initial delay before reverb begins
HI. RATIO 0.1–1.0 High-frequency reverb time ratio
DIFF. 0–10 Spread
DENSITY 0–100% Reverb density
HPF
THRU, 21.2 Hz–
8.00 kHz
High-pass filter cutoff frequency
LPF
50.0 Hz–16.0 kHz,
THRU
Low-pass filter cutoff frequency
REV.BAL 0–100%
Reverb and flanged reverb bal-
ance (0% = all flanged reverb,
100% = all reverb)
FREQ. 0.05–40.00 Hz Modulation speed
DEPTH 0–100% Modulation depth
MOD. DLY 0.0–500.0 ms Modulation delay time
FB. GAIN –99 to +99%
Feedback gain (plus values for
normal-phase feedback, minus
values for reverse-phase feedback)
WAVE Sine, Tri Modulation waveform
SYNC OFF/ON Tempo parameter sync on/off
NOTE
*1
*1.
Used in conjunction with TEMPO
to determine FREQ.
Parameter Range Description
REV TIME 0.3–99.0 s Reverb time
INI. DLY 0.0–500.0 ms Initial delay before reverb begins
HI. RATIO 0.1–1.0 High-frequency reverb time ratio
DIFF. 0–10 Spread
DENSITY 0–100% Reverb density
HPF
THRU, 21.2 Hz–
8.00 kHz
High-pass filter cutoff frequency
LPF
50.0 Hz–16.0 kHz,
THRU
Low-pass filter cutoff frequency
REV/SYM 0–100%
Reverb and symphonic balance
(0% = all reverb, 100% = all sym-
phonic)
FREQ. 0.05–40.00 Hz Modulation speed
DEPTH 0–100% Modulation depth
MOD. DLY 0.0–500.0 ms Modulation delay time
WAVE Sine, Tri Modulation waveform
SYNC OFF/ON Tempo parameter sync on/off
NOTE
*1
*1.
Used in conjunction with TEMPO
to determine FREQ.
Parameter Range Description
REV TIME 0.3–99.0 s Reverb time
INI. DLY 0.0–500.0 ms Initial delay before reverb begins
HI. RATIO 0.1–1.0 High-frequency reverb time ratio
DIFF. 0–10 Spread
DENSITY 0–100% Reverb density
HPF
THRU, 21.2 Hz–
8.00 kHz
High-pass filter cutoff frequency
LPF
50.0 Hz–16.0 kHz,
THRU
Low-pass filter cutoff frequency
REV.BAL 0–100%
Reverb and symphonic reverb bal-
ance (0% = all symphonic reverb,
100% = all reverb)
FREQ. 0.05–40.00 Hz Modulation speed
DEPTH 0–100% Modulation depth
MOD. DLY 0.0–500.0 ms Modulation delay time
WAVE Sine, Tri Modulation waveform
SYNC OFF/ON Tempo parameter sync on/off
NOTE
*1
*1.
Used in conjunction with TEMPO
to determine FREQ.
Effects Parameters
304 PM5D/PM5D-RH Owner’s Manual Reference section
REVPAN
One input, two output reverb and autopan effects in
parallel.
DELAY+ER.
One input, two output delay and early reflections effects in
parallel.
DELAYER.
One input, two output delay and early reflections effects in
series.
DELAY+REV
One input, two output delay and reverb effects in parallel.
Parameter Range Description
REV TIME 0.3–99.0 s Reverb time
INI. DLY 0.0–500.0 ms Initial delay before reverb begins
HI. RATIO 0.1–1.0 High-frequency reverb time ratio
DIFF. 0–10 Spread
DENSITY 0–100% Reverb density
HPF
THRU, 21.2 Hz–
8.00 kHz
High-pass filter cutoff frequency
LPF
50.0 Hz–16.0 kHz,
THRU
Low-pass filter cutoff frequency
REV.BAL 0–100%
Reverb and panned reverb bal-
ance (0% = all panned reverb,
100% = all reverb)
FREQ. 0.05–40.00 Hz Modulation speed
DEPTH 0–100% Modulation depth
DIR.
*1
*1. LR, LR, LR, Turn L, Turn R
Panning direction
WAVE Sine, Tri, Square Modulation waveform
SYNC OFF/ON Tempo parameter sync on/off
NOTE
*2
*2.
Used in conjunction with TEMPO
to determine FREQ.
Parameter Range Description
DELAY L 0.0–1000.0 ms Left channel delay time
DELAY R 0.0–1000.0 ms Right channel delay time
FB. DLY 0.0–1000.0 ms Feedback delay time
FB. GAIN –99 to +99%
Feedback gain (plus values for
normal-phase feedback, minus
values for reverse-phase feedback)
HI. RATIO 0.1–1.0 High-frequency feedback ratio
HPF
THRU, 21.2 Hz–
8.00 kHz
High-pass filter cutoff frequency
LPF
50.0 Hz–16.0 kHz,
THRU
Low-pass filter cutoff frequency
DLY/ER 0–100%
Delay and early reflections bal-
ance (0% = all delay, 100% = all
early reflections)
TYPE
S-Hall, L-Hall, Ran-
dom, Revers, Plate,
Spring
Type of early reflection simulation
ROOMSIZE 0.1–20.0 Reflection spacing
LIVENESS 0–10
Early reflections decay characteris-
tics (0 = dead, 10 = live)
INI. DLY 0.0–500.0 ms Initial delay before reverb begins
DIFF. 0–10 Spread
DENSITY 0–100% Reverb density
ER NUM. 1–19 Number of early reflections
SYNC OFF/ON Tempo parameter sync on/off
NOTE L
*1
*1.
(Maximum value depends on the tempo setting)
Used in conjunction with TEMPO
to determine left channel DELAY L
NOTE R 1
Used in conjunction with TEMPO
to determine right channel DELAY
R
NOTE FB 1
Used in conjunction with TEMPO
to determine FB. DLY
Parameter Range Description
DELAY L 0.0–1000.0 ms Left channel delay time
DELAY R 0.0–1000.0 ms Right channel delay time
FB. DLY 0.0–1000.0 ms Feedback delay time
FB. GAIN –99 to +99%
Feedback gain (plus values for
normal-phase feedback, minus
values for reverse-phase feedback)
HI. RATIO 0.1–1.0 High-frequency feedback ratio
HPF
THRU, 21.2 Hz–
8.00 kHz
High-pass filter cutoff frequency
LPF
50.0 Hz–16.0 kHz,
THRU
Low-pass filter cutoff frequency
DLY.BAL 0–100%
Delay and early reflected delay
balance (0% = all early reflected
delay, 100% = all delay)
TYPE
S-Hall, L-Hall, Ran-
dom, Revers, Plate,
Spring
Type of early reflection simulation
ROOMSIZE 0.1–20.0 Reflection spacing
LIVENESS 0–10
Early reflections decay characteris-
tics (0 = dead, 10 = live)
INI. DLY 0.0–500.0 ms Initial delay before reverb begins
DIFF. 0–10 Spread
DENSITY 0–100% Reverb density
ER NUM. 1–19 Number of early reflections
SYNC OFF/ON Tempo parameter sync on/off
NOTE L
*1
*1.
(Maximum value depends on the tempo setting)
Used in conjunction with TEMPO
to determine left channel DELAY L
NOTE R 1
Used in conjunction with TEMPO
to determine right channel DELAY
R
NOTE FB 1
Used in conjunction with TEMPO
to determine FB. DLY
Parameter Range Description
DELAY L 0.0–1000.0 ms Left channel delay time
DELAY R 0.0–1000.0 ms Right channel delay time
FB. DLY 0.0–1000.0 ms Feedback delay time
FB. GAIN –99 to +99%
Feedback gain (plus values for
normal-phase feedback, minus
values for reverse-phase feedback)
DELAY HI 0.1–1.0
Delay high-frequency feedback
ratio
HPF
THRU, 21.2 Hz–
8.00 kHz
High-pass filter cutoff frequency
LPF
50.0 Hz–16.0 kHz,
THRU
Low-pass filter cutoff frequency
DLY/REV 0–100%
Delay and reverb balance (0% =
all delay, 100% = all reverb)
REV TIME 0.3–99.0 s Reverb time
INI. DLY 0.0–500.0 ms Initial delay before reverb begins
REV HI 0.1–1.0 High-frequency reverb time ratio
DIFF. 0–10 Spread
DENSITY 0–100% Reverb density
SYNC OFF/ON Tempo parameter sync on/off
NOTE L
*1
*1.
(Maximum value depends on the tempo setting)
Used in conjunction with TEMPO
to determine left channel DELAY L
NOTE R 1
Used in conjunction with TEMPO
to determine right channel DELAY
R
NOTE FB 1
Used in conjunction with TEMPO
to determine FB. DLY
PM5D/PM5D-RH Owner’s Manual Reference section 305
Information shown
in the display
Function
menu
Global
functions
Output
functions
Input
functions
Appendices
DELAYREV
One input, two output delay and reverb effects in series.
DISTDELAY
One input, two output distortion and delay effects in
series.
MULTI FILTER
Two input, two output 3-band multi-filter (24 dB/octave).
FREEZE
One input, one output basic sampler.
Parameter Range Description
DELAY L 0.0–1000.0 ms Left channel delay time
DELAY R 0.0–1000.0 ms Right channel delay time
FB. DLY 0.0–1000.0 ms Feedback delay time
FB. GAIN –99 to +99%
Feedback gain (plus values for
normal-phase feedback, minus
values for reverse-phase feedback)
DELAY HI 0.1–1.0
Delay high-frequency feedback
ratio
HPF
THRU, 21.2 Hz–
8.00 kHz
High-pass filter cutoff frequency
LPF
50.0 Hz–16.0 kHz,
THRU
Low-pass filter cutoff frequency
DLY.BAL 0–100%
Delay and delayed reverb balance
(0% = all delayed reverb, 100% =
all delay)
REV TIME 0.3–99.0 s Reverb time
INI. DLY 0.0–500.0 ms Initial delay before reverb begins
REV HI 0.1–1.0 High-frequency reverb time ratio
DIFF. 0–10 Spread
DENSITY 0–100% Reverb density
SYNC OFF/ON Tempo parameter sync on/off
NOTE L
*1
*1.
(Maximum value depends on the tempo setting)
Used in conjunction with TEMPO
to determine left channel DELAY L
NOTE R *1
Used in conjunction with TEMPO
to determine right channel DELAY
R
NOTE FB *1
Used in conjunction with TEMPO
to determine FB. DLY
Parameter Range Description
DST TYPE
DST1, DST2, OVD1,
OVD2, CRUNCH
Distortion type (DST = distortion,
OVD = overdrive)
DRIVE 0–100 Distortion drive
MASTER 0–100 Master volume
TONE –10 to +10 Tone control
N. GATE 0–20 Noise reduction
DELAY 0.0–2725.0 ms Delay time
FB. GAIN –99 to +99%
Feedback gain (plus values for
normal-phase feedback, minus
values for reverse-phase feed-
back)
HI. RATIO 0.1–1.0 High-frequency feedback ratio
FREQ. 0.05–40.00 Hz Modulation speed
DEPTH 0–100% Modulation depth
DLY.BAL 0–100%
Distortion and delay balance (0%
= all distortion, 100% = all
delayed distortion)
SYNC OFF/ON Tempo parameter sync on/off
DLY.NOTE
*1
*1. (
Maximum value depends on the tempo setting)
Used in conjunction with TEMPO
to determine DELAY
MOD.NOT
E
*2
*2.
Used in conjunction with TEMPO
to determine FREQ.
Parameter Range Description
TYPE 1 HPF, LPF, BPF
Filter 1 type: high pass, low pass,
band pass
TYPE 2 HPF, LPF, BPF
Filter 2 type: high pass, low pass,
band pass
TYPE 3 HPF, LPF, BPF
Filter 3 type: high pass, low pass,
band pass
FREQ. 1 28.0 Hz–16.0 kHz Filter 1 frequency
FREQ. 2 28.0 Hz–16.0 kHz Filter 2 frequency
FREQ. 3 28.0 Hz–16.0 kHz Filter 3 frequency
LEVEL 1 0–100 Filter 1 level
LEVEL 2 0–100 Filter 2 level
LEVEL 3 0–100 Filter 3 level
RESO. 1 0–20 Filter 1 resonance
RESO. 2 0–20 Filter 2 resonance
RESO. 3 0–20 Filter 3 resonance
Parameter Range Description
REC MODE MANUAL, INPUT
In MANUAL mode, recording is
started by pressing the REC and
PLAY buttons. In INPUT mode,
Record-Ready mode is engaged by
pressing the REC button, and
actual recording is triggered by the
input signal.
REC DLY
–1000 to +1000
ms
Recording delay. For plus values,
recording starts after the trigger is
received. For minus values, record-
ing starts before the trigger is
received.
TRG LVL –60 to 0 dB
Input trigger level (i.e., the signal
level required to trigger recording
or playback)
TRG MASK 0–1000 ms
Once playback has been triggered,
subsequent triggers are ignored for
the duration of the TRG MASK
time.
PLY MODE
MOMENT,
CONTI., INPUT
In MOMENT mode, the sample
plays only while the that the PLAY
button is pressed. In CONT mode,
playback continues once the PLAY
button has been pressed. The
number of times the sample plays
is set using the LOOP NUM param-
eter. In INPUT mode, playback is
triggered by the input signal.
START
*1
*1. 0.0–5941.0 ms (fs=44.1 kHz), 0.0 ms–5458.3 ms (fs=48 kHz), 0.0–
2970.5 ms (fs=88.2 kHz), 0.0 ms–2729.2 ms (fs=96 kHz)
Playback start point in milliseconds
END 1 Playback end point in milliseconds
LOOP 1 Loop start point in milliseconds
LOOP
NUM
0–100 Number of times the sample plays
START
[SAMPLE]
0–262000 Playback start point in samples
END
[SAMPLE]
0–262000 Playback end point in samples
LOOP
[SAMPLE]
0–262000 Loop start point in samples
PITCH
–12 to +12 semi-
tones
Playback pitch shift
FINE –50 to +50 cents Playback pitch shift fine
MIDI TRG OFF, C1–C6, ALL
PLAY button can be triggered by
using MIDI Note on/off messages.
Effects Parameters
306 PM5D/PM5D-RH Owner’s Manual Reference section
ST REVERB
Two input, two output stereo reverb.
M. BAND DYNA.
Two input, two output 3-band dynamics processor, with
individual solo and gain reduction metering for each band.
M.BAND COMP
Two input, two output 3-band compressor, with individ-
ual solo and gain reduction metering for each band.
REV-X HALL, REV-X ROOM, REV-X PLATE
Newly-developed two input, two output reverb algo-
rithm. Delivers dense and rich reverberation, smooth
decay, and provides a spaciousness and depth that
enhances the original sound. Choose from three types
depending on your location and needs; REV-X HALL,
REV-X ROOM, and REV-X PLATE.
Other preset effects (COMP276, COMP276S, COMP260,
COMP260S, EQUALIZER601, OPENDECK) are sepa-
rately sold Add-On Effects. For details on these effects,
refer to the owner’s manual included with the Add-On
Effects package.
Parameter Range Description
REV TIME 0.3–99.0 s Reverb time
REV TYPE
Hall, Room, Stage,
Plate
Reverb type
INI. DLY 0.0–100.0 ms Initial delay before reverb begins
HI. RATIO 0.1–1.0 High-frequency reverb time ratio
LO. RATIO 0.1–2.4 Low-frequency reverb time ratio
DIFF. 0–10
Reverb diffusion (left–right reverb
spread)
DENSITY 0–100% Reverb density
E/R BAL. 0–100%
Balance of early reflections and
reverb (0% = all reverb, 100% =
all early reflections)
HPF
THRU, 21.2 Hz–
8.00 kHz
High-pass filter cutoff frequency
LPF
50.0 Hz–16.0 kHz,
THRU
Low-pass filter cutoff frequency
Parameter Range Description
LOW GAIN –96.0 to +12.0 dB Low band level
MID GAIN –96.0 to +12.0 dB Mid band level
HI. GAIN –96.0 to +12.0 dB High band level
PRESENCE –10 to +10
For positive values, the thresh-
old of the high band is low-
ered and the threshold of the
low band is increased. For
negative values, the opposite
will occur. When set to 0, all
three bands are affected the
same.
CMP. THRE –24.0 dB to 0.0 dB Compressor threshold
CMP. RAT 1:1 to 20:1 Compressor ratio
CMP. ATK 0–120 ms Compressor attack
CMP. REL 1 Compressor release time
CMP. KNEE 0–5 Compressor knee
LOOKUP 0.0–100.0 ms Lookup delay
CMP. BYP ON/OFF Compressor bypass
L–M XOVR 21.2 Hz–8.00 kHz Low/mid crossover frequency
M–H XOVR 21.2 Hz–8.00 kHz Mid/high crossover frequency
SLOPE –6 dB, –12 dB Filter slope
CEILING –6.0 dB to 0.0 dB, OFF
Specifies the maximum output
level
EXP. THRE –54.0 dB to –24.0 dB Expander threshold
EXP. RAT 1:1 to :1 Expander ratio
EXP. REL
*1
*1. 6.0 ms–46.0 s (fs=44.1 kHz), 5.0 ms–42.3 s (fs=48 kHz),
3 ms–23.0 s (fs=88.2 kHz), 3 ms–21.1 s (fs=96 kHz)
Expander release time
EXP. BYP ON/OFF Expander bypass
LIM. THRE –12.0 dB to 0.0 dB Limiter threshold
LIM. ATK 0–120 ms Limiter attack
LIM. REL 1 Limiter release time
LIM. BYP ON/OFF Limiter bypass
LIM. KNEE 0–5 Limiter knee
Parameter Range Description
LOW GAIN –96.0 to +12.0 dB Low band level
MID GAIN –96.0 to +12.0 dB Mid band level
HI. GAIN –96.0 to +12.0 dB High band level
L-M XOVR 21.2 Hz–8.00 kHz Low/mid crossover frequency
M-H XOVR 21.2 Hz–8.00 kHz Mid/high crossover frequency
SLOPE –6 dB, –12 dB Filter slope
CEILING –6.0 dB to 0.0 dB, OFF
Specifies the maximum output
level
LOOKUP 0.0–100.0 ms Lookup delay
LOW THRE –54.0 dB to 0.0 dB
Low band threshold level
MID THRE –54.0 dB to 0.0 dB
Mid band threshold level
HI. THRE –54.0 dB to 0.0 dB
High band threshold level
RATIO 1:1 to 20:1
Compression ratio
ATTACK 0–120 ms
Compressor attack time
CMP. REL
*1
*1. 6.0 ms–46.0 s (fs=44.1 kHz), 5.0 ms–42.3 s (fs=48 kHz),
3 ms–23.0 s (fs=88.2 kHz), 3 ms–21.1 s (fs=96 kHz)
Compressor release time
KNEE 0–5
Compressor knee
BYPASS ON/OFF
Bypasses the compressor
Parameter Range Description
REV TIME
0.47–46.92 s
*1
*1. These values are for when the effect type is REV-X HALL and the
ROOM SIZE=28. The range will differ depending on the effect type
and ROOM SIZE setting.
Reverb time
INI. DLY 0.0–120.0 ms Initial delay before reverb begins
HI. RATIO 0.1–1.0 High-frequency reverb time ratio
LO. RATIO 0.1–2.4 Low-frequency reverb time ratio
LO.FREQ 22.0 Hz–18.0 kHz
Frequency point for LO.RATIO
setting
DIFF. 0–10
Reverb diffusion (left–right reverb
spread)
ROOM
SIZE
0–28
Size of room
DECAY 0–53 Gate closing speed
HPF
THRU, 22.0 Hz–
8.00 kHz
High-pass filter cutoff frequency
LPF
1.00 kHz–18.0 kHz,
THRU
Low-pass filter cutoff frequency
PM5D/PM5D-RH Owner’s Manual Reference section 307
Information shown
in the display
Function
menu
Global
functions
Output
functions
Input
functions
Appendices
Some of the PM5D’s effects allow you to synchronize the effect with the tempo. There are two such types of effect; delay-type
effects and modulation-type effects. For delay-type effects, the delay time will change according to the tempo. For modula-
tion-type effects, the frequency of the modulation signal will change according to the tempo.
Parameters related to tempo synchronization
The following five parameters are related to tempo synchronization.
1) SYNC 2) NOTE 3) TEMPO 4) DELAY 5) FREQ.
SYNC: ............................ This is the on/off switch for tempo synchronization.
NOTE and TEMPO:..... These are the basic parameters for tempo synchronization.
DELAY and FREQ.: ...... DELAY is the delay time, and FREQ. is the frequency of the modulation signal. These directly affect the
way in which the effect sound will change. DELAY is relevant only for delay-type effects, and FREQ. is
relevant only for modulation-type effects.
How the parameters are related
Te mpo synchronization uses TEMPO and NOTE to calculate a value that will be the basis for the tempo, and continues making
adjustments so that this tempo basis stays essentially the same as the DELAY (or FREQ.). This means that when TEMPO, NOTE, and
DELAY (or FREQ.) are synchronized, and you change any of these values, the other parameters will be re-set in order to maintain the
correct relationship. The parameters that are re-set and the calculation method(*a) used are as follows.
If you turn SYNC on NOTE will be set
If you edit DELAY (or FREQ.) NOTE will be set
In this case, the NOTE value is calculated as follows.
NOTE = DELAY (or FREQ.)/(4 x (60/TEMPO))
If you edit NOTE DELAY (or FREQ.) will be set
In this case, the DELAY (or FREQ.) value is calculated as follows.
DELAY (or FREQ.) = NOTE x 4 x (60/TEMPO)
If you edit TEMPO DELAY (or FREQ.) will be set
In this case, the DELAY (or FREQ.) value is calculated as follows.
DELAY (or FREQ.) = original DELAY (or FREQ.) x (previous TEMPO/new TEMPO)
Example 1: When SYNC=ON, DELAY=250 ms, TEMPO=120, you change NOTE from 8th note to quarter note
DELAY= new NOTE x 4 x (60/TEMPO)
= (1/4) x 4 x (60/120)
= 0.5 (sec)
= 500 ms
Thus, the DELAY will change from 250 ms to 500 ms.
Example 2: When SYNC=ON, DELAY=250 ms, NOTE=8th note, you change TEMPO from 120 to 121
DELAY= original DELAY x (previous TEMPO/new TEMPO)
= 250 x (120/121)
= 247.9 (ms)
Thus, the TEMPO will change from 250 ms to 247.9 ms.
*a Rounded values are used for the calculation results.
Ranges of the NOTE and TEMPO values
The ranges of the NOTE and TEMPO values are limited by the ranges of the DELAY or FREQ. values. You cannot set NOTE or
TEMPO values that would cause DELAY or FREQ. to exceed their maximum possible values when synchronized to tempo. This lim-
itation also applies even when SYNC is OFF.
Special characteristics of the TEMPO parameter
The TEMPO parameter has the following characteristics that are unlike other parameters.
•It is a common value shared by all effects
•You cannot stored it to or recall it from the Effects Library. (You can store it to and recall it from a Scene.)
This means that the TEMPO value may not necessarily be the same when an effect is recalled as when that effect was stored. Here is
an example.
Store the effect: TEMPO=120 Change TEMPO to 60 Recall the effect: TEMPO=60
Normally when you change the TEMPO, the DELAY (or FREQ.) will be re-set accordingly. However if the DELAY (or FREQ.) were
changed, the effect would sound differently when recalled than when it was stored. To prevent the effect from changing in this way
between store and recall, the PM5D does not update the DELAY (or FREQ.) value when an effect is recalled, even if the TEMPO is
no longer the same as when that effect was stored.
* The NOTE parameter is calculated based on the following values.
Effects and tempo synchronization
= 1/48
= 2/1
= 1/16= 1/24 = 1/12
= 3/4= 3/16 = 1/2
= 3/32 = 1/6
= 1/4
= 1/8
= 1/1= 3/8
Scene Memory/Effect Library to Program Change Table
308 PM5D/PM5D-RH Owner’s Manual Reference section
Scene Memory/Effect Library to Program Change Table
Preset Bank/Ch# 1 Preset Bank/Ch# 2
Program
Change#
Scene/
Effect
Preset#
Program
Change#
Scene/
Effect
Preset#
001
Scene
001 065
Scene
065
002 002 066 066
003 003 067 067
004 004 068 068
005 005 069 069
006 006 070 070
007 007 071 071
008 008 072 072
009 009 073 073
010 010 074 074
011 011 075 075
012 012 076 076
013 013 077 077
014 014 078 078
015 015 079 079
016 016 080 080
017 017 081 081
018 018 082 082
019 019 083 083
020 020 084 084
021 021 085 085
022 022 086 086
023 023 087 087
024 024 088 088
025 025 089 089
026 026 090 090
027 027 091 091
028 028 092 092
029 029 093 093
030 030 094 094
031 031 095 095
032 032 096 096
033 033 097 097
034 034 098 098
035 035 099 099
036 036 100 100
037 037 101 101
038 038 102 102
039 039 103 103
040 040 104 104
041 041 105 105
042 042 106 106
043 043 107 107
044 044 108 108
045 045 109 109
046 046 110 110
047 047 111 111
048 048 112 112
049 049 113 113
050 050 114 114
051 051 115 115
052 052 116 116
053 053 117 117
054 054 118 118
055 055 119 119
056 056 120 120
057 057 121 121
058 058 122 122
059 059 123 123
060 060 124 124
061 061 125 125
062 062 126 126
063 063 127 127
064 064 128 128
Program
Change#
Scene/
Effect
Preset#
Program
Change#
Scene/
Effect
Preset#
001
Scene
129 065
Scene
193
002 130 066 194
003 131 067 195
004 132 068 196
005 133 069 197
006 134 070 198
007 135 071 199
008 136 072 200
009 137 073 201
010 138 074 202
011 139 075 203
012 140 076 204
013 141 077 205
014 142 078 206
015 143 079 207
016 144 080 208
017 145 081 209
018 146 082 210
019 147 083 211
020 148 084 212
021 149 085 213
022 150 086 214
023 151 087 215
024 152 088 216
025 153 089 217
026 154 090 218
027 155 091 219
028 156 092 220
029 157 093 221
030 158 094 222
031 159 095 223
032 160 096 224
033 161 097 225
034 162 098 226
035 163 099 227
036 164 100 228
037 165 101 229
038 166 102 230
039 167 103 231
040 168 104 232
041 169 105 233
042 170 106 234
043 171 107 235
044 172 108 236
045 173 109 237
046 174 110 238
047 175 111 239
048 176 112 240
049 177 113 241
050 178 114 242
051 179 115 243
052 180 116 244
053 181 117 245
054 182 118 246
055 183 119 247
056 184 120 248
057 185 121 249
058 186 122 250
059 187 123 251
060 188 124 252
061 189 125 253
062 190 126 254
063 191 127 255
064 192 128 256
PM5D/PM5D-RH Owner’s Manual Reference section 309
Information shown
in the display
Function
menu
Global
functions
Output
functions
Input
functions
Appendices
Preset Bank/Ch# 3 Preset Bank/Ch# 4
Program
Change#
Scene/
Effect
Preset#
Program
Change#
Scene/
Effect
Preset#
001
Scene
257 065
Scene
321
002 258 066 322
003 259 067 323
004 260 068 324
005 261 069 325
006 262 070 326
007 263 071 327
008 264 072 328
009 265 073 329
010 266 074 330
011 267 075 331
012 268 076 332
013 269 077 333
014 270 078 334
015 271 079 335
016 272 080 336
017 273 081 337
018 274 082 338
019 275 083 339
020 276 084 340
021 277 085 341
022 278 086 342
023 279 087 343
024 280 088 344
025 281 089 345
026 282 090 346
027 283 091 347
028 284 092 348
029 285 093 349
030 286 094 350
031 287 095 351
032 288 096 352
033 289 097 353
034 290 098 354
035 291 099 355
036 292 100 356
037 293 101 357
038 294 102 358
039 295 103 359
040 296 104 360
041 297 105 361
042 298 106 362
043 299 107 363
044 300 108 364
045 301 109 365
046 302 110 366
047 303 111 367
048 304 112 368
049 305 113 369
050 306 114 370
051 307 115 371
052 308 116 372
053 309 117 373
054 310 118 374
055 311 119 375
056 312 120 376
057 313 121 377
058 314 122 378
059 315 123 379
060 316 124 380
061 317 125 381
062 318 126 382
063 319 127 383
064 320 128 384
Program
Change#
Scene/
Effect
Preset#
Program
Change#
Scene/
Effect
Preset#
001
Scene
385 065
Scene
449
002 386 066 450
003 387 067 451
004 388 068 452
005 389 069 453
006 390 070 454
007 391 071 455
008 392 072 456
009 393 073 457
010 394 074 458
011 395 075 459
012 396 076 460
013 397 077 461
014 398 078 462
015 399 079 463
016 400 080 464
017 401 081 465
018 402 082 466
019 403 083 467
020 404 084 468
021 405 085 469
022 406 086 470
023 407 087 471
024 408 088 472
025 409 089 473
026 410 090 474
027 411 091 475
028 412 092 476
029 413 093 477
030 414 094 478
031 415 095 479
032 416 096 480
033 417 097 481
034 418 098 482
035 419 099 483
036 420 100 484
037 421 101 485
038 422 102 486
039 423 103 487
040 424 104 488
041 425 105 489
042 426 106 490
043 427 107 491
044 428 108 492
045 429 109 493
046 430 110 494
047 431 111 495
048 432 112 496
049 433 113 497
050 434 114 498
051 435 115 499
052 436 116 500
053 437 117 000
054 438 118
No Assign
055 439 119
056 440 120
057 441 121
058 442 122
059 443 123
060 444 124
061 445 125
062 446 126
063 447 127
064 448 128
Scene Memory/Effect Library to Program Change Table
310 PM5D/PM5D-RH Owner’s Manual Reference section
Preset Bank/Ch# 5
Preset Bank/Ch# 6
Preset Bank/Ch# 7
Preset Bank/Ch# 8
Preset Bank/Ch# 9
Preset Bank/Ch# 10
Preset Bank/Ch# 11
Preset Bank/Ch# 12
Preset Bank/Ch# 13
Preset Bank/Ch# 14
Preset Bank/Ch# 15
Preset Bank/Ch# 16
Program Change# Scene/Effect Preset#
001
No Assign
002
003
:
128
Program Change# Scene/Effect Preset#
001
No Assign
002
003
:
128
Program Change# Scene/Effect Preset#
001
No Assign
002
003
:
128
Program Change# Scene/Effect Preset#
001
No Assign
002
003
:
128
Program Change# Scene/Effect Preset#
001
Effect1
001
002 002
003 003
::
128 128
Program Change# Scene/Effect Preset#
001
Effect2
001
002 002
003 003
::
128 128
Program Change# Scene/Effect Preset#
001
Effect3
001
002 002
003 003
::
128 128
Program Change# Scene/Effect Preset#
001
Effect4
001
002 002
003 003
::
128 128
Program Change# Scene/Effect Preset#
001
Effect5
001
002 002
003 003
::
128 128
Program Change# Scene/Effect Preset#
001
Effect6
001
002 002
003 003
::
128 128
Program Change# Scene/Effect Preset#
001
Effect7
001
002 002
003 003
::
128 128
Program Change# Scene/Effect Preset#
001
Effect8
001
002 002
003 003
::
128 128
PM5D/PM5D-RH Owner’s Manual Reference section 311
Information shown
in the display
Function
menu
Global
functions
Output
functions
Input
functions
Appendices
Bank/Ch# _
Program
Change#
Scene/
Effect
User#
Program
Change#
Scene/
Effect
User#
Program
Change#
Scene/
Effect
User#
001 044 087
002 045 088
003 046 089
004 047 090
005 048 091
006 049 092
007 050 093
008 051 094
009 052 095
010 053 096
011 054 097
012 055 098
013 056 099
014 057 100
015 058 101
016 059 102
017 060 103
018 061 104
019 062 105
020 063 106
021 064 107
022 065 108
023 066 109
024 067 110
025 068 111
026 069 112
027 070 113
028 071 114
029 072 115
030 073 116
031 074 117
032 075 118
033 076 119
034 077 120
035 078 121
036 079 122
037 080 123
038 081 124
039 082 125
040 083 126
041 084 127
042 085 128
043 086
Parameters that can be assigned to control changes
312 PM5D/PM5D-RH Owner’s Manual Reference section
Parameters that can be assigned to control changes
MODE PARAMETER 1 PARAMETER 2
NO ASSIGN
FADER H
INPUT
CH 1–CH48
STIN1L–STIN4R
FXRTN1L–FXRTN4R
OUTPUT
MIX 1–MIX24
MATRIX 1–MATRIX 8
STEREO AL–STEREO BR
FADER L
INPUT
CH 1–CH48
STIN1L–STIN4R
FXRTN1L–FXRTN4R
OUTPUT
MIX 1–MIX24
MATRIX 1–MATRIX 8
STEREO AL–STEREO BR
CH ON
INPUT
CH 1–CH48
STIN1L–STIN4R
FXRTN1L–FXRTN4R
OUTPUT
MIX 1–MIX24
MATRIX 1–MATRIX 8
STEREO AL–STEREO BR
PHASE INPUT
CH 1–CH48
STIN1L–STIN4R
FXRTN1L–FXRTN4R
INSERT
INPUT
CH 1–CH48
STIN1L–STIN4R
OUTPUT
MIX 1–MIX24
MATRIX 1–MATRIX 8
STEREO AL–STEREO BR
DIRECT OUT ON
CH 1–CH48
STIN1L–STIN4R
FXRTN1L–FXRTN4R
PAN/BALANCE INPUT
CH 1–CH48
STIN1L–STIN4R
FXRTN1L–FXRTN4R
BALANCE OUTPUT
MIX 1–MIX24
MATRIX 1–MATRIX 8
STEREO AL–STEREO BR
TO STEREO ON
CH 1–CH48
STIN1L–STIN4R
FXRTN1L–FXRTN4R
LCR
ON CH 1–CH48
STIN1L–STIN4R
FXRTN1L–FXRTN4R
MIX 1–MIX24
CSR
MIX SEND
PRE POINT
CH 1–CH48
STIN1L–STIN4R
FXRTN1L–FXRTN4R
MIX 1 ON–
MIX24 ON
MIX 1 PRE/POST–
MIX24 PRE/POST
MIX 1 LEVEL H–
MIX24 LEVEL H
MIX 1 LEVEL L–
MIX24 LEVEL L
MIX 1/ 2 PAN–
MIX23/24 PAN
FOLLOW PAN VARI
FOLLOW PAN FIXED
POST POINT MIX 1–MIX24
MIX TO STEREO
POINT
MIX 1–MIX24ON
PAN
MIX TO MATRIX
MATRIX 1 POINT–
MATRIX 8 POINT
MIX 1–MIX24
MATRIX 1 ON–
MATRIX 8 ON
MATRIX 1 LEVEL H–
MATRIX 8 LEVEL H
MATRIX 1 LEVEL L–
MATRIX 8 LEVEL L
MATRIX 1/2 PAN–
MATRIX 7/8 PAN
ST TO MATRIX
MATRIX 1 POINT–
MATRIX 8 POINT
STEREO AL–STEREO BR
MATRIX 1 ON–
MATRIX 8 ON
MATRIX 1 LEVEL H–
MATRIX 8 LEVEL H
MATRIX 1 LEVEL L–
MATRIX 8 LEVEL L
MATRIX 1/2 PAN–
MATRIX 7/8 PAN
IN DELAY
ON
CH 1–CH48
STIN1L–STIN4R
TIME HIGH
TIME MID
TIME LOW
OUT DELAY
ON
MIX 1–MIX24
MATRIX 1–MATRIX 8
STEREO AL–STEREO BR
TIME HIGH
TIME MID
TIME LOW
INPUT EQ
ON
CH 1–CH48
STIN1L–STIN4R
FXRTN1L–FXRTN4R
LOW Q
LOW FREQ
LOW GAIN
LOW MID Q
LOW MID FREQ
LOW MID GAIN
HIGH MID Q
HIGH MID FREQ
HIGH MID GAIN
HIGH Q
HIGH FREQ
HIGH GAIN
LPF ON
LOW TYPE
HIGH TYPE
INPUT ATT INPUT
CH 1–CH48
STIN1L–STIN4R
FXRTN1L–FXRTN4R
INPUT HPF
ON CH 1–CH48
STIN1L–STIN4R
FXRTN1L–FXRTN4R
FREQ
MODE PARAMETER 1 PARAMETER 2
PM5D/PM5D-RH Owner’s Manual Reference section 313
Information shown
in the display
Function
menu
Global
functions
Output
functions
Input
functions
Appendices
OUTPUT EQ
ON
MIX 1–MIX24
MATRIX 1–MATRIX 8
STEREO AL–STEREO BR
L LOW BYPASS
L LOW Q
L LOW FREQ
L LOW GAIN
L LOW MID BYPASS
L LOW MID Q
L LOW MID FREQ
L LOW MID GAIN
L HIGH MID BYPASS
L HIGH MID Q
L HIGH MID FREQ
L HIGH MID GAIN
L HIGH BYPASS
L HIGH Q
L HIGH FREQ
L HIGH GAIN
U LOW BYPASS
MIX 1–MIX24
STEREO AL–STEREO BR
U LOW Q
U LOW FREQ
U LOW GAIN
U LOW MID BYPASS
U LOW MID Q
U LOW MID FREQ
U LOW MID GAIN
U HIGH MID BYPASS
U HIGH MID Q
U HIGH MID FREQ
U HIGH MID GAIN
U HIGH BYPASS
U HIGH Q
U HIGH FREQ
U HIGH GAIN
L LOW TYPE MIX 1–MIX24
MATRIX 1–MATRIX 8
STEREO AL–STEREO BR
L HIGH TYPE
U LOW TYPE
MIX 1–MIX24
STEREO AL–STEREO BR
U HIGH TYPE
L LOW HPF ON MIX 1–MIX24
MATRIX 1–MATRIX 8
STEREO AL–STEREO BR
L HIGH HPF ON
U LOW HPF ON
MIX 1–MIX24
STEREO AL–STEREO BR
U HIGH HPF ON
INPUT GATE
ON
CH 1–CH48
STIN1L–STIN4R
ATTACK
THRESHOLD
RANGE
HOLD H
HOLD L
DECAY H
DECAY L
INPUT COMP
ON
CH 1–CH48
STIN1L–STIN4R
ATTACK
THRESHOLD
RELEASE H
RELEASE L
RATIO
GAIN
KNEE/WIDTH
MODE PARAMETER 1 PARAMETER 2
OUTPUT COMP
ON
MIX 1–MIX24
MATRIX 1–MATRIX 8
STEREO AL–STEREO BR
ATTACK
THRESHOLD
RELEASE H
RELEASE L
RATIO
GAIN
KNEE/WIDTH
SURROUND
LFE H
CH 1–CH48
STIN1L–STIN4R
FXRTN1L–FXRTN4R
LFE L
DIVERGENCE F
DIVERGENCE R
LEFT-RIGHT PAN CH 1–CH48
STIN1L–STIN4R
FXRTN1L–FXRTN4R
ALT SEL CH
FRONT-REAR PAN
EFFECT
BYPASS
EFFECT 1–EFFECT 8
MIX BALANCE
PARAM 1 H–
PARAM32 L
GEQ
ON
GEQ 1–GEQ12
GAIN 1–GAIN31
DCA
ON
DCA 1–DCA 8FADER H
FADER L
MUTE MASTER ON MASTER 1–MASTER 8
RECALL SAFE ON
CH 1–CH48
STIN1L–STIN4R
FXRTN1L–FXRTN4R
MIX 1–MIX24
MATRIX 1–MATRIX 8
STEREO AL–STEREO BR
EFFECT 1–EFFECT 8
GEQ 1–GEQ12
DCA 1–DCA 8
MUTE MASTER
CUE DELAY
ON
L
R
TIME HIGH
TIME MID
TIME LOW
MONITOR
DELAY
ON
L
R
C
TIME HIGH
TIME MID
TIME LOW
MODE PARAMETER 1 PARAMETER 2
Control change parameter assignments
314 PM5D/PM5D-RH Owner’s Manual Reference section
Control change parameter assignments
PRESET CHANNEL1
Control
Change#
MODE PARAMETER 1 PARAMETER 2
1
FADER H
INPUT
CH 1
2 CH 2
3 CH 3
4 CH 4
5 CH 5
6 CH 6
7 CH 7
8 CH 8
9 CH 9
10 CH10
11 CH11
12 CH12
13 CH13
14 CH14
15 CH15
16 CH16
17 CH17
18 CH18
19 CH19
20 CH20
21 CH21
22 CH22
23 CH23
24 CH24
25
OUTPUT
MIX 1
26 MIX 2
27 MIX 3
28 MIX 4
29 NO ASSIGN
30
FADER H OUTPUT
STEREO AL
31 STEREO BL
33
FADER L
INPUT
CH 1
34 CH 2
35 CH 3
36 CH 4
37 CH 5
38 CH 6
39 CH 7
40 CH 8
41 CH 9
42 CH10
43 CH11
44 CH12
45 CH13
46 CH14
47 CH15
48 CH16
49 CH17
50 CH18
51 CH19
52 CH20
53 CH21
54 CH22
55 CH23
56 CH24
57
OUTPUT
MIX 1
58 MIX 2
59 MIX 3
60 MIX 4
61 NO ASSIGN
62
FADER L OUTPUT
STEREO AL
63 STEREO BL
64
CH ON INPUT
CH 1
65 CH 2
66 CH 3
67 CH 4
68 CH 5
69 CH 6
70 CH 7
71 CH 8
72 CH 9
73 CH10
74 CH11
75 CH12
76 CH13
77 CH14
78 CH15
79 CH16
80 CH17
81 CH18
82 CH19
83 CH20
84 CH21
85 CH22
86 CH23
87 CH24
88 NO ASSIGN
89
PAN/BALANCE INPUT
CH 1
90 CH 2
91 CH 3
92 CH 4
93 CH 5
94 CH 6
95 CH 7
102 CH 8
103 CH 9
104 CH10
105 CH11
106 CH12
107 CH13
108 CH14
109 CH15
110 CH16
111 CH17
112 CH18
113 CH19
114 CH20
115 CH21
116 CH22
117 CH23
118 CH24
119 NO ASSIGN
Control
Change#
MODE PARAMETER 1 PARAMETER 2
PM5D/PM5D-RH Owner’s Manual Reference section 315
Information shown
in the display
Function
menu
Global
functions
Output
functions
Input
functions
Appendices
PRESET CHANNEL2
Control
Change#
MODE PARAMETER 1 PARAMETER 2
1
FADER H
INPUT
CH25
2 CH26
3 CH27
4 CH28
5 CH29
6 CH30
7 CH31
8 CH32
9 CH33
10 CH34
11 CH35
12 CH36
13 CH37
14 CH38
15 CH39
16 CH40
17 CH41
18 CH42
19 CH43
20 CH44
21 CH45
22 CH46
23 CH47
24 CH48
25
OUTPUT
MIX 5
26 MIX 6
27 MIX 7
28 MIX 8
29 NO ASSIGN
30
CH ON OUTPUT
STEREO AL
31 STEREO BL
33
FADER L
INPUT
CH25
34 CH26
35 CH27
36 CH28
37 CH29
38 CH30
39 CH31
40 CH32
41 CH33
42 CH34
43 CH35
44 CH36
45 CH37
46 CH38
47 CH39
48 CH40
49 CH41
50 CH42
51 CH43
52 CH44
53 CH45
54 CH46
55 CH47
56 CH48
57
OUTPUT
MIX 5
58 MIX 6
59 MIX 7
60 MIX 8
61 NO ASSIGN
62
BALANCE OUTPUT
STEREO AL
63 STEREO BL
64
CH ON INPUT
CH25
65 CH26
66 CH27
67 CH28
68 CH29
69 CH30
70 CH31
71 CH32
72 CH33
73 CH34
74 CH35
75 CH36
76 CH37
77 CH38
78 CH39
79 CH40
80 CH41
81 CH42
82 CH43
83 CH44
84 CH45
85 CH46
86 CH47
87 CH48
88 NO ASSIGN
89
PAN/BALANCE INPUT
CH25
90 CH26
91 CH27
92 CH28
93 CH29
94 CH30
95 CH31
102 CH32
103 CH33
104 CH34
105 CH35
106 CH36
107 CH37
108 CH38
109 CH39
110 CH40
111 CH41
112 CH42
113 CH43
114 CH44
115 CH45
116 CH46
117 CH47
118 CH48
119 NO ASSIGN
Control
Change#
MODE PARAMETER 1 PARAMETER 2
Control change parameter assignments
316 PM5D/PM5D-RH Owner’s Manual Reference section
PRESET CHANNEL3
Control
Change#
MODE PARAMETER 1 PARAMETER 2
1
INPUT EQ LOW GAIN
CH 1
2 CH 2
3 CH 3
4 CH 4
5 CH 5
6 CH 6
7 CH 7
8 CH 8
9 CH 9
10 CH10
11 CH11
12 CH12
13 CH13
14 CH14
15 CH15
16 CH16
17 CH17
18 CH18
19 CH19
20 CH20
21 CH21
22 CH22
23 CH23
24 CH24
25
FADER H OUTPUT
MIX 9
26 MIX10
27 MIX11
28 MIX12
29 NO ASSIGN
30
BALANCE OUTPUT
MIX 1
31 MIX 3
33
NO ASSIGN
34
35
36
37
38
39
40
41
42
43
44
45
46
47
48
49
50
51
52
53
54
55
56
57
FADER L OUTPUT
MIX 9
58 MIX10
59 MIX11
60 MIX12
61 NO ASSIGN
62
BALANCE OUTPUT
MIX 5
63 MIX 7
64
INPUT EQ LOW FREQ
CH 1
65 CH 2
66 CH 3
67 CH 4
68 CH 5
69 CH 6
70 CH 7
71 CH 8
72 CH 9
73 CH10
74 CH11
75 CH12
76 CH13
77 CH14
78 CH15
79 CH16
80 CH17
81 CH18
82 CH19
83 CH20
84 CH21
85 CH22
86 CH23
87 CH24
88 NO ASSIGN
89
INPUT EQ LOW Q
CH 1
90 CH 2
91 CH 3
92 CH 4
93 CH 5
94 CH 6
95 CH 7
102 CH 8
103 CH 9
104 CH10
105 CH11
106 CH12
107 CH13
108 CH14
109 CH15
110 CH16
111 CH17
112 CH18
113 CH19
114 CH20
115 CH21
116 CH22
117 CH23
118 CH24
119 NO ASSIGN
Control
Change#
MODE PARAMETER 1 PARAMETER 2
PM5D/PM5D-RH Owner’s Manual Reference section 317
Information shown
in the display
Function
menu
Global
functions
Output
functions
Input
functions
Appendices
PRESET CHANNEL4
Control
Change#
MODE PARAMETER 1 PARAMETER 2
1
INPUT EQ LOW GAIN
CH25
2 CH26
3 CH27
4 CH28
5 CH29
6 CH30
7 CH31
8 CH32
9 CH33
10 CH34
11 CH35
12 CH36
13 CH37
14 CH38
15 CH39
16 CH40
17 CH41
18 CH42
19 CH43
20 CH44
21 CH45
22 CH46
23 CH47
24 CH48
25
FADER H OUTPUT
MIX13
26 MIX14
27 MIX15
28 MIX16
29 NO ASSIGN
30
BALANCE OUTPUT
MIX 9
31 MIX11
33
NO ASSIGN
34
35
36
37
38
39
40
41
42
43
44
45
46
47
48
49
50
51
52
53
54
55
56
57
FADER L OUTPUT
MIX13
58 MIX14
59 MIX15
60 MIX16
61 NO ASSIGN
62
BALANCE OUTPUT
MIX13
63 MIX15
64
INPUT EQ LOW FREQ
CH25
65 CH26
66 CH27
67 CH28
68 CH29
69 CH30
70 CH31
71 CH32
72 CH33
73 CH34
74 CH35
75 CH36
76 CH37
77 CH38
78 CH39
79 CH40
80 CH41
81 CH42
82 CH43
83 CH44
84 CH45
85 CH46
86 CH47
87 CH48
88 NO ASSIGN
89
INPUT EQ LOW Q
CH25
90 CH26
91 CH27
92 CH28
93 CH29
94 CH30
95 CH31
102 CH32
103 CH33
104 CH34
105 CH35
106 CH36
107 CH37
108 CH38
109 CH39
110 CH40
111 CH41
112 CH42
113 CH43
114 CH44
115 CH45
116 CH46
117 CH47
118 CH48
119 NO ASSIGN
Control
Change#
MODE PARAMETER 1 PARAMETER 2
Control change parameter assignments
318 PM5D/PM5D-RH Owner’s Manual Reference section
PRESET CHANNEL5
Control
Change#
MODE PARAMETER 1 PARAMETER 2
1
INPUT EQ
LOW MID
GAIN
CH 1
2 CH 2
3 CH 3
4 CH 4
5 CH 5
6 CH 6
7 CH 7
8 CH 8
9 CH 9
10 CH10
11 CH11
12 CH12
13 CH13
14 CH14
15 CH15
16 CH16
17 CH17
18 CH18
19 CH19
20 CH20
21 CH21
22 CH22
23 CH23
24 CH24
25
CH ON OUTPUT
MIX 1
26 MIX 2
27 MIX 3
28 MIX 4
29 NO ASSIGN
30
CH ON OUTPUT
MIX17
31 MIX18
33
NO ASSIGN
34
35
36
37
38
39
40
41
42
43
44
45
46
47
48
49
50
51
52
53
54
55
56
57
CH ON OUTPUT
MIX 5
58 MIX 6
59 MIX 7
60 MIX 8
61 NO ASSIGN
62
CH ON OUTPUT
MIX19
63 MIX20
64
INPUT EQ LOW MID FREQ
CH 1
65 CH 2
66 CH 3
67 CH 4
68 CH 5
69 CH 6
70 CH 7
71 CH 8
72 CH 9
73 CH10
74 CH11
75 CH12
76 CH13
77 CH14
78 CH15
79 CH16
80 CH17
81 CH18
82 CH19
83 CH20
84 CH21
85 CH22
86 CH23
87 CH24
88 NO ASSIGN
89
INPUT EQ LOW MID Q
CH 1
90 CH 2
91 CH 3
92 CH 4
93 CH 5
94 CH 6
95 CH 7
102 CH 8
103 CH 9
104 CH10
105 CH11
106 CH12
107 CH13
108 CH14
109 CH15
110 CH16
111 CH17
112 CH18
113 CH19
114 CH20
115 CH21
116 CH22
117 CH23
118 CH24
119 NO ASSIGN
Control
Change#
MODE PARAMETER 1 PARAMETER 2
PM5D/PM5D-RH Owner’s Manual Reference section 319
Information shown
in the display
Function
menu
Global
functions
Output
functions
Input
functions
Appendices
PRESET CHANNEL6
Control
Change#
MODE PARAMETER 1 PARAMETER 2
1
INPUT EQ
LOW MID
GAIN
CH25
2 CH26
3 CH27
4 CH28
5 CH29
6 CH30
7 CH31
8 CH32
9 CH33
10 CH34
11 CH35
12 CH36
13 CH37
14 CH38
15 CH39
16 CH40
17 CH41
18 CH42
19 CH43
20 CH44
21 CH45
22 CH46
23 CH47
24 CH48
25
CH ON OUTPUT
MIX 9
26 MIX10
27 MIX11
28 MIX12
29 NO ASSIGN
30
CH ON OUTPUT
MIX21
31 MIX22
33
NO ASSIGN
34
35
36
37
38
39
40
41
42
43
44
45
46
47
48
49
50
51
52
53
54
55
56
57
CH ON OUTPUT
MIX13
58 MIX14
59 MIX15
60 MIX16
61 NO ASSIGN
62
CH ON OUTPUT
MIX23
63 MIX24
64
INPUT EQ LOW MID FREQ
CH25
65 CH26
66 CH27
67 CH28
68 CH29
69 CH30
70 CH31
71 CH32
72 CH33
73 CH34
74 CH35
75 CH36
76 CH37
77 CH38
78 CH39
79 CH40
80 CH41
81 CH42
82 CH43
83 CH44
84 CH45
85 CH46
86 CH47
87 CH48
88 NO ASSIGN
89
INPUT EQ LOW MID Q
CH25
90 CH26
91 CH27
92 CH28
93 CH29
94 CH30
95 CH31
102 CH32
103 CH33
104 CH34
105 CH35
106 CH36
107 CH37
108 CH38
109 CH39
110 CH40
111 CH41
112 CH42
113 CH43
114 CH44
115 CH45
116 CH46
117 CH47
118 CH48
119 NO ASSIGN
Control
Change#
MODE PARAMETER 1 PARAMETER 2
Control change parameter assignments
320 PM5D/PM5D-RH Owner’s Manual Reference section
PRESET CHANNEL7
Control
Change#
MODE PARAMETER 1 PARAMETER 2
1
INPUT EQ
HIGH MID
GAIN
CH 1
2 CH 2
3 CH 3
4 CH 4
5 CH 5
6 CH 6
7 CH 7
8 CH 8
9 CH 9
10 CH10
11 CH11
12 CH12
13 CH13
14 CH14
15 CH15
16 CH16
17 CH17
18 CH18
19 CH19
20 CH20
21 CH21
22 CH22
23 CH23
24 CH24
25
FADER H OUTPUT
MIX17
26 MIX18
27 MIX19
28 MIX20
29 NO ASSIGN
30
BALANCE OUTPUT
MIX17
31 MIX19
33
NO ASSIGN
34
35
36
37
38
39
40
41
42
43
44
45
46
47
48
49
50
51
52
53
54
55
56
57
FADER L OUTPUT
MIX17
58 MIX18
59 MIX19
60 MIX20
61 NO ASSIGN
62
BALANCE OUTPUT
MIX21
63 MIX23
64
INPUT EQ
HIGH MID
FREQ
CH 1
65 CH 2
66 CH 3
67 CH 4
68 CH 5
69 CH 6
70 CH 7
71 CH 8
72 CH 9
73 CH10
74 CH11
75 CH12
76 CH13
77 CH14
78 CH15
79 CH16
80 CH17
81 CH18
82 CH19
83 CH20
84 CH21
85 CH22
86 CH23
87 CH24
88 NO ASSIGN
89
INPUT EQ HIGH MID Q
CH 1
90 CH 2
91 CH 3
92 CH 4
93 CH 5
94 CH 6
95 CH 7
102 CH 8
103 CH 9
104 CH10
105 CH11
106 CH12
107 CH13
108 CH14
109 CH15
110 CH16
111 CH17
112 CH18
113 CH19
114 CH20
115 CH21
116 CH22
117 CH23
118 CH24
119 NO ASSIGN
Control
Change#
MODE PARAMETER 1 PARAMETER 2
PM5D/PM5D-RH Owner’s Manual Reference section 321
Information shown
in the display
Function
menu
Global
functions
Output
functions
Input
functions
Appendices
PRESET CHANNEL8
Control
Change#
MODE PARAMETER 1 PARAMETER 2
1
INPUT EQ
HIGH MID
GAIN
CH25
2 CH26
3 CH27
4 CH28
5 CH29
6 CH30
7 CH31
8 CH32
9 CH33
10 CH34
11 CH35
12 CH36
13 CH37
14 CH38
15 CH39
16 CH40
17 CH41
18 CH42
19 CH43
20 CH44
21 CH45
22 CH46
23 CH47
24 CH48
25
FADER H OUTPUT
MIX21
26 MIX22
27 MIX23
28 MIX24
29 NO ASSIGN
30
BALANCE OUTPUT
MATRIX 1
31 MATRIX 3
33
NO ASSIGN
34
35
36
37
38
39
40
41
42
43
44
45
46
47
48
49
50
51
52
53
54
55
56
57
FADER L OUTPUT
MIX21
58 MIX22
59 MIX23
60 MIX24
61 NO ASSIGN
62
BALANCE OUTPUT
MATRIX 5
63 MATRIX 7
64
INPUT EQ
HIGH MID
FREQ
CH25
65 CH26
66 CH27
67 CH28
68 CH29
69 CH30
70 CH31
71 CH32
72 CH33
73 CH34
74 CH35
75 CH36
76 CH37
77 CH38
78 CH39
79 CH40
80 CH41
81 CH42
82 CH43
83 CH44
84 CH45
85 CH46
86 CH47
87 CH48
88 NO ASSIGN
89
INPUT EQ HIGH MID Q
CH25
90 CH26
91 CH27
92 CH28
93 CH29
94 CH30
95 CH31
102 CH32
103 CH33
104 CH34
105 CH35
106 CH36
107 CH37
108 CH38
109 CH39
110 CH40
111 CH41
112 CH42
113 CH43
114 CH44
115 CH45
116 CH46
117 CH47
118 CH48
119 NO ASSIGN
Control
Change#
MODE PARAMETER 1 PARAMETER 2
Control change parameter assignments
322 PM5D/PM5D-RH Owner’s Manual Reference section
PRESET CHANNEL9
Control
Change#
MODE PARAMETER 1 PARAMETER 2
1
INPUT EQ HIGH GAIN
CH 1
2 CH 2
3 CH 3
4 CH 4
5 CH 5
6 CH 6
7 CH 7
8 CH 8
9 CH 9
10 CH10
11 CH11
12 CH12
13 CH13
14 CH14
15 CH15
16 CH16
17 CH17
18 CH18
19 CH19
20 CH20
21 CH21
22 CH22
23 CH23
24 CH24
25
FADER H OUTPUT
MATRIX 1
26 MATRIX 2
27 MATRIX 3
28 MATRIX 4
29 NO ASSIGN
30
CH ON OUTPUT
MATRIX 1
31 MATRIX 2
33
NO ASSIGN
34
35
36
37
38
39
40
41
42
43
44
45
46
47
48
49
50
51
52
53
54
55
56
57
FADER L OUTPUT
MATRIX 1
58 MATRIX 2
59 MATRIX 3
60 MATRIX 4
61 NO ASSIGN
62
CH ON OUTPUT
MATRIX 3
63 MATRIX 4
64
INPUT EQ HIGH FREQ
CH 1
65 CH 2
66 CH 3
67 CH 4
68 CH 5
69 CH 6
70 CH 7
71 CH 8
72 CH 9
73 CH10
74 CH11
75 CH12
76 CH13
77 CH14
78 CH15
79 CH16
80 CH17
81 CH18
82 CH19
83 CH20
84 CH21
85 CH22
86 CH23
87 CH24
88 NO ASSIGN
89
INPUT EQ HIGH Q
CH 1
90 CH 2
91 CH 3
92 CH 4
93 CH 5
94 CH 6
95 CH 7
102 CH 8
103 CH 9
104 CH10
105 CH11
106 CH12
107 CH13
108 CH14
109 CH15
110 CH16
111 CH17
112 CH18
113 CH19
114 CH20
115 CH21
116 CH22
117 CH23
118 CH24
119 NO ASSIGN
Control
Change#
MODE PARAMETER 1 PARAMETER 2
PM5D/PM5D-RH Owner’s Manual Reference section 323
Information shown
in the display
Function
menu
Global
functions
Output
functions
Input
functions
Appendices
PRESET CHANNEL10
Control
Change#
MODE PARAMETER 1 PARAMETER 2
1
INPUT EQ HIGH GAIN
CH25
2 CH26
3 CH27
4 CH28
5 CH29
6 CH30
7 CH31
8 CH32
9 CH33
10 CH34
11 CH35
12 CH36
13 CH37
14 CH38
15 CH39
16 CH40
17 CH41
18 CH42
19 CH43
20 CH44
21 CH45
22 CH46
23 CH47
24 CH48
25
FADER H OUTPUT
MATRIX 5
26 MATRIX 6
27 MATRIX 7
28 MATRIX 8
29 NO ASSIGN
30
CH ON OUTPUT
MATRIX 5
31 MATRIX 6
33
NO ASSIGN
34
35
36
37
38
39
40
41
42
43
44
45
46
47
48
49
50
51
52
53
54
55
56
57
FADER L OUTPUT
MATRIX 5
58 MATRIX 6
59 MATRIX 7
60 MATRIX 8
61 NO ASSIGN
62
CH ON OUTPUT
MATRIX 7
63 MATRIX 8
64
INPUT EQ HIGH FREQ
CH25
65 CH26
66 CH27
67 CH28
68 CH29
69 CH30
70 CH31
71 CH32
72 CH33
73 CH34
74 CH35
75 CH36
76 CH37
77 CH38
78 CH39
79 CH40
80 CH41
81 CH42
82 CH43
83 CH44
84 CH45
85 CH46
86 CH47
87 CH48
88 NO ASSIGN
89
INPUT EQ HIGH Q
CH25
90 CH26
91 CH27
92 CH28
93 CH29
94 CH30
95 CH31
102 CH32
103 CH33
104 CH34
105 CH35
106 CH36
107 CH37
108 CH38
109 CH39
110 CH40
111 CH41
112 CH42
113 CH43
114 CH44
115 CH45
116 CH46
117 CH47
118 CH48
119 NO ASSIGN
Control
Change#
MODE PARAMETER 1 PARAMETER 2
Control change parameter assignments
324 PM5D/PM5D-RH Owner’s Manual Reference section
PRESET CHANNEL11
Control
Change#
MODE PARAMETER 1 PARAMETER 2
1
INPUT ATT INPUT
CH 1
2 CH 2
3 CH 3
4 CH 4
5 CH 5
6 CH 6
7 CH 7
8 CH 8
9 CH 9
10 CH10
11 CH11
12 CH12
13 CH13
14 CH14
15 CH15
16 CH16
17 CH17
18 CH18
19 CH19
20 CH20
21 CH21
22 CH22
23 CH23
24 CH24
25
INPUT HPF FREQ
CH 1
26 CH 2
27 CH 3
28 CH 4
29 NO ASSIGN
30
INPUT HPF FREQ
CH 5
31 CH 6
33
NO ASSIGN
34
35
36
37
38
39
40
41
42
43
44
45
46
47
48
49
50
51
52
53
54
55
56
57
INPUT HPF FREQ
CH 7
58 CH 8
59 CH 9
60 CH10
61 NO ASSIGN
62
INPUT HPF FREQ
CH11
63 CH12
64
INPUT HPF ON
CH 1
65 CH 2
66 CH 3
67 CH 4
68 CH 5
69 CH 6
70 CH 7
71 CH 8
72 CH 9
73 CH10
74 CH11
75 CH12
76 CH13
77 CH14
78 CH15
79 CH16
80 CH17
81 CH18
82 CH19
83 CH20
84 CH21
85 CH22
86 CH23
87 CH24
88 NO ASSIGN
89
INPUT EQ LPF ON
CH 1
90 CH 2
91 CH 3
92 CH 4
93 CH 5
94 CH 6
95 CH 7
102 CH 8
103 CH 9
104 CH10
105 CH11
106 CH12
107 CH13
108 CH14
109 CH15
110 CH16
111 CH17
112 CH18
113 CH19
114 CH20
115 CH21
116 CH22
117 CH23
118 CH24
119 NO ASSIGN
Control
Change#
MODE PARAMETER 1 PARAMETER 2
PM5D/PM5D-RH Owner’s Manual Reference section 325
Information shown
in the display
Function
menu
Global
functions
Output
functions
Input
functions
Appendices
PRESET CHANNEL12
Control
Change#
MODE PARAMETER 1 PARAMETER 2
1
INPUT ATT INPUT
CH25
2 CH26
3 CH27
4 CH28
5 CH29
6 CH30
7 CH31
8 CH32
9 CH33
10 CH34
11 CH35
12 CH36
13 CH37
14 CH38
15 CH39
16 CH40
17 CH41
18 CH42
19 CH43
20 CH44
21 CH45
22 CH46
23 CH47
24 CH48
25
INPUT HPF FREQ
CH13
26 CH14
27 CH15
28 CH16
29 NO ASSIGN
30
INPUT HPF FREQ
CH17
31 CH18
33
NO ASSIGN
34
35
36
37
38
39
40
41
42
43
44
45
46
47
48
49
50
51
52
53
54
55
56
57
INPUT HPF FREQ
CH19
58 CH20
59 CH21
60 CH22
61 NO ASSIGN
62
INPUT HPF FREQ
CH23
63 CH24
64
INPUT HPF ON
CH25
65 CH26
66 CH27
67 CH28
68 CH29
69 CH30
70 CH31
71 CH32
72 CH33
73 CH34
74 CH35
75 CH36
76 CH37
77 CH38
78 CH39
79 CH40
80 CH41
81 CH42
82 CH43
83 CH44
84 CH45
85 CH46
86 CH47
87 CH48
88 NO ASSIGN
89
INPUT EQ LPF ON
CH25
90 CH26
91 CH27
92 CH28
93 CH29
94 CH30
95 CH31
102 CH32
103 CH33
104 CH34
105 CH35
106 CH36
107 CH37
108 CH38
109 CH39
110 CH40
111 CH41
112 CH42
113 CH43
114 CH44
115 CH45
116 CH46
117 CH47
118 CH48
119 NO ASSIGN
Control
Change#
MODE PARAMETER 1 PARAMETER 2
Control change parameter assignments
326 PM5D/PM5D-RH Owner’s Manual Reference section
PRESET CHANNEL13
Control
Change#
MODE PARAMETER 1 PARAMETER 2
1
SURROUND LFE H
CH 1
2 CH 2
3 CH 3
4 CH 4
5 CH 5
6 CH 6
7 CH 7
8 CH 8
9 CH 9
10 CH10
11 CH11
12 CH12
13 CH13
14 CH14
15 CH15
16 CH16
17 CH17
18 CH18
19 CH19
20 CH20
21 CH21
22 CH22
23 CH23
24 CH24
25
INPUT HPF FREQ
CH25
26 CH26
27 CH27
28 CH28
29 NO ASSIGN
30
INPUT HPF FREQ
CH29
31 CH30
33
SURROUND LFE L
CH 1
34 CH 2
35 CH 3
36 CH 4
37 CH 5
38 CH 6
39 CH 7
40 CH 8
41 CH 9
42 CH10
43 CH11
44 CH12
45 CH13
46 CH14
47 CH15
48 CH16
49 CH17
50 CH18
51 CH19
52 CH20
53 CH21
54 CH22
55 CH23
56 CH24
57
INPUT HPF FREQ
CH31
58 CH32
59 CH33
60 CH34
61 NO ASSIGN
62
INPUT HPF FREQ
CH35
63 CH36
64
SURROUND DIVERGENCE F
CH 1
65 CH 2
66 CH 3
67 CH 4
68 CH 5
69 CH 6
70 CH 7
71 CH 8
72 CH 9
73 CH10
74 CH11
75 CH12
76 CH13
77 CH14
78 CH15
79 CH16
80 CH17
81 CH18
82 CH19
83 CH20
84 CH21
85 CH22
86 CH23
87 CH24
88 NO ASSIGN
89
INPUT EQ ON
CH 1
90 CH 2
91 CH 3
92 CH 4
93 CH 5
94 CH 6
95 CH 7
102 CH 8
103 CH 9
104 CH10
105 CH11
106 CH12
107 CH13
108 CH14
109 CH15
110 CH16
111 CH17
112 CH18
113 CH19
114 CH20
115 CH21
116 CH22
117 CH23
118 CH24
119 NO ASSIGN
Control
Change#
MODE PARAMETER 1 PARAMETER 2
PM5D/PM5D-RH Owner’s Manual Reference section 327
Information shown
in the display
Function
menu
Global
functions
Output
functions
Input
functions
Appendices
PRESET CHANNEL14
Control
Change#
MODE PARAMETER 1 PARAMETER 2
1
SURROUND LFE H
CH25
2 CH26
3 CH27
4 CH28
5 CH29
6 CH30
7 CH31
8 CH32
9 CH33
10 CH34
11 CH35
12 CH36
13 CH37
14 CH38
15 CH39
16 CH40
17 CH41
18 CH42
19 CH43
20 CH44
21 CH45
22 CH46
23 CH47
24 CH48
25
INPUT HPF FREQ
CH37
26 CH38
27 CH39
28 CH40
29 NO ASSIGN
30
INPUT HPF FREQ
CH41
31 CH42
33
SURROUND LFE L
CH25
34 CH26
35 CH27
36 CH28
37 CH29
38 CH30
39 CH31
40 CH32
41 CH33
42 CH34
43 CH35
44 CH36
45 CH37
46 CH38
47 CH39
48 CH40
49 CH41
50 CH42
51 CH43
52 CH44
53 CH45
54 CH46
55 CH47
56 CH48
57
INPUT HPF FREQ
CH43
58 CH44
59 CH45
60 CH46
61 NO ASSIGN
62
INPUT HPF FREQ
CH47
63 CH48
64
SURROUND DIVERGENCE F
CH25
65 CH26
66 CH27
67 CH28
68 CH29
69 CH30
70 CH31
71 CH32
72 CH33
73 CH34
74 CH35
75 CH36
76 CH37
77 CH38
78 CH39
79 CH40
80 CH41
81 CH42
82 CH43
83 CH44
84 CH45
85 CH46
86 CH47
87 CH48
88 NO ASSIGN
89
INPUT EQ ON
CH25
90 CH26
91 CH27
92 CH28
93 CH29
94 CH30
95 CH31
102 CH32
103 CH33
104 CH34
105 CH35
106 CH36
107 CH37
108 CH38
109 CH39
110 CH40
111 CH41
112 CH42
113 CH43
114 CH44
115 CH45
116 CH46
117 CH47
118 CH48
119 NO ASSIGN
Control
Change#
MODE PARAMETER 1 PARAMETER 2
Control change parameter assignments
328 PM5D/PM5D-RH Owner’s Manual Reference section
PRESET CHANNEL15
Control
Change#
MODE PARAMETER 1 PARAMETER 2
1
SURROUND
LEFT-RIGHT
PAN
CH 1
2 CH 2
3 CH 3
4 CH 4
5 CH 5
6 CH 6
7 CH 7
8 CH 8
9 CH 9
10 CH10
11 CH11
12 CH12
13 CH13
14 CH14
15 CH15
16 CH16
17 CH17
18 CH18
19 CH19
20 CH20
21 CH21
22 CH22
23 CH23
24 CH24
25
DCA FADER H
DCA 1
26 DCA 2
27 DCA 3
28 DCA 4
29 NO ASSIGN
30
MUTE MASTER ON
MASTER 1
31 MASTER 2
33
SURROUND
FRONT-REAR
PAN
CH 1
34 CH 2
35 CH 3
36 CH 4
37 CH 5
38 CH 6
39 CH 7
40 CH 8
41 CH 9
42 CH10
43 CH11
44 CH12
45 CH13
46 CH14
47 CH15
48 CH16
49 CH17
50 CH18
51 CH19
52 CH20
53 CH21
54 CH22
55 CH23
56 CH24
57
DCA FADER L
DCA 1
58 DCA 2
59 DCA 3
60 DCA 4
61 NO ASSIGN
62
MUTE MASTER ON
MASTER 3
63 MASTER 4
64
NO ASSIGN
65
66
67
68
69
70
71
72
73
74
75
76
77
78
79
80
81
82
83
84
85
86
87
88
89
90
91
92
93
94
95
102
103
104
105
106
107
108
109
110
111
112
113
114
115
116
117
118
119
Control
Change#
MODE PARAMETER 1 PARAMETER 2
PM5D/PM5D-RH Owner’s Manual Reference section 329
Information shown
in the display
Function
menu
Global
functions
Output
functions
Input
functions
Appendices
PRESET CHANNEL16
Control
Change#
MODE PARAMETER 1 PARAMETER 2
1
SURROUND
LEFT-RIGHT
PAN
CH25
2 CH26
3 CH27
4 CH28
5 CH29
6 CH30
7 CH31
8 CH32
9 CH33
10 CH34
11 CH35
12 CH36
13 CH37
14 CH38
15 CH39
16 CH40
17 CH41
18 CH42
19 CH43
20 CH44
21 CH45
22 CH46
23 CH47
24 CH48
25
DCA FADER H
DCA5
26 DCA6
27 DCA7
28 DCA8
29 NO ASSIGN
30
MUTE MASTER ON
MASTER5
31 MASTER6
33
SURROUND
FRONT-REAR
PAN
CH25
34 CH26
35 CH27
36 CH28
37 CH29
38 CH30
39 CH31
40 CH32
41 CH33
42 CH34
43 CH35
44 CH36
45 CH37
46 CH38
47 CH39
48 CH40
49 CH41
50 CH42
51 CH43
52 CH44
53 CH45
54 CH46
55 CH47
56 CH48
57
DCA FADER L
DCA 5
58 DCA 6
59 DCA 7
60 DCA 8
61 NO ASSIGN
62
MUTE MASTER ON
MASTER 7
63 MASTER 8
64
NO ASSIGN
65
66
67
68
69
70
71
72
73
74
75
76
77
78
79
80
81
82
83
84
85
86
87
88
89
90
91
92
93
94
95
102
103
104
105
106
107
108
109
110
111
112
113
114
115
116
117
118
119
Control
Change#
MODE PARAMETER 1 PARAMETER 2
Control change parameter assignments
330 PM5D/PM5D-RH Owner’s Manual Reference section
CHANNEL _
Control
Change#
MODE PARAMETER 1 PARAMETER 2
1
2
3
4
5
6
7
8
9
10
11
12
13
14
15
16
17
18
19
20
21
22
23
24
25
26
27
28
29
30
31
33
34
35
36
37
38
39
40
41
42
43
44
45
46
47
48
49
50
51
52
53
54
55
56
57
58
59
60
61
62
63
64
65
66
67
68
69
70
71
72
73
74
75
76
77
78
79
80
81
82
83
84
85
86
87
88
89
90
91
92
93
94
95
102
103
104
105
106
107
108
109
110
111
112
113
114
115
116
117
118
119
Control
Change#
MODE PARAMETER 1 PARAMETER 2
PM5D/PM5D-RH Owner’s Manual Reference section 331
Information shown
in the display
Function
menu
Global
functions
Output
functions
Input
functions
Appendices
NRPN parameter assignments
PARAMETER
FROM
(HEX)
TO
(HEX)
FADER
CHANNEL 0000 003F
MIX1-20,MATRIX1-8,ST A LR 0060 007D
CH to Mix LEVEL
MIX9 SEND 007E 00BD
MIX10 SEND 00DE 011D
MIX11 SEND 013E 017D
MIX12 SEND 019E 01DD
MIX13 SEND 01FE 023D
MIX14 SEND 025E 029D
MIX15 SEND 02BE 02FD
MIX16 SEND 031E 035D
MIX17 SEND 037E 03BD
MIX18 SEND 03DE 041D
MIX19 SEND 043E 047D
MIX20 SEND 049E 04DD
MIX1-20, MATRIX1-
8, ST A LR to Matrix
LEVEL
MATRIX1 SEND 04FE 0513
MATRIX2 SEND 0514 0529
MATRIX3 SEND 052A 053F
MATRIX4 SEND 0540 0555
MATRIX5 SEND 0556 056B
MATRIX6 SEND 056C 0581
MATRIX7 SEND 0582 0597
MATRIX8 SEND 0598 05AD
MIX1-8 to ST LEVEL MIX TO ST 05AE 05B5
ON
CHANNEL 05B6 05F5
MIX1-20,MATRIX1-8,ST A LR 0616 0633
CH to Mix ON
MIX9 SEND 0634 0673
MIX10 SEND 0694 06D3
MIX11 SEND 06F4 0733
MIX12 SEND 0754 0793
MIX13 SEND 07B4 07F3
MIX14 SEND 0814 0853
MIX15 SEND 0874 08B3
MIX16 SEND 08D4 0913
MIX17 SEND 0934 0973
MIX18 SEND 0994 09D3
MIX19 SEND 09F4 0A33
MIX20 SEND 0A54 0A93
MIX1-20, MATRIX1-
8, ST A LR to Matrix
LEVEL
MATRIX1 SEND 0AB4 0AC9
MATRIX2 SEND 0ACA 0AC9
MATRIX3 SEND 0AE0 0ADF
MATRIX4 SEND 0AF6 0AF5
MATRIX5 SEND 0B0C 0B0B
MATRIX6 SEND 0B22 0B21
MATRIX7 SEND 0B38 0B37
MATRIX8 SEND 0B4E 0B4D
MIX1-8 to ST ON MIX TO ST 0B64 0B6B
PHASE CHANNEL 0B6C 0BAB
INSERT ON
CHANNEL 0BCC 0C03
MIX1-20,MATRIX1-8,ST A LR 0C2C 0C49
CH to Mix PRE/
POST
MIX9 SEND 0C4A 0C89
MIX10 SEND 0CAA 0CE9
MIX11 SEND 0D0A 0D49
MIX12 SEND 0D6A 0DA9
MIX13 SEND 0DCA 0E09
MIX14 SEND 0E2A 0E69
MIX15 SEND 0E8A 0EC9
MIX16 SEND 0EEA 0F29
MIX17 SEND 0F4A 0F89
MIX18 SEND 0FAA 0FE9
MIX19 SEND 100A 1049
MIX20 SEND 106A 10A9
INPUT DELAY
ON 10CA 1101
TIME HIGH 112A 1161
TIME LOW 118A 11C1
MIX1-20,MATRIX1-
8,ST A LR OUTPUT
DELAY
ON 12AA 12C7
TIME HIGH 12C8 12E5
TIME LOW 12E6 1303
EQ CH & MIX1-20,
MATRIX1-8, ST A LR
OUTPUT(LOWER)
*1
ON 1304 1381
Q LOW 1382 13FF
F LOW 1400 147D
G LOW 147E 14FB
Q LO-MID 14FC 1579
F LO-MID 157A 15F7
G LO-MID 15F8 1675
Q HI-MID 1676 16F3
F HI-MID 16F4 1771
G HI-MID 1772 17EF
Q HIGH 17F0 186D
F HIGH 186E 18EB
G HIGH 18EC 1969
ATT 196A 19A9
HPF ON 19E8 1A65
LPF ON 1A66 1AE3
GATE
ON 1AE4 1B1B
ATTACK 1B44 1B7B
THRESH 1BA4 1BDB
RANGE 1C04 1C3B
HOLD 1C64 1C9B
DECAY 1CC4 1CFB
COMP CH & MIX1-
20, MATRIX1-8, ST
A LR OUTPUT
*1
ON 1D24 1DA1
ATTACK 1DA2 1E1F
THRESH 1E20 1E9D
RELEASE 1E9E 1F1B
RATIO 1F1C 1F99
GAIN 1F9A 2017
KNEE 2018 2095
PAN CHANNEL 2096 20D5
CH to MIX PAN
MIX9-10 20F6 2135
MIX11-12 2156 2195
MIX13-14 21B6 21F5
MIX15-16 2216 2255
MIX17-18 2276 22B5
MIX19-20 22D6 2315
MIX1-20, ST A LR to
Matrix PAN
MATRIX1,2 2336 234B
MATRIX3,4 234C 2361
MATRIX5,6 2362 2377
MATRIX7,8 2378 238D
MIX1-8 to ST PAN MIX TO ST 238E 2395
BALANCE MIX1-20,MATRIX1-8,ST A LR 2396 23B3
SURROUND
LFE 23B4 23F3
DIV (F) 2414 2453
LR 2474 24B3
FR 24D4 2513
PARAMETER
FROM
(HEX)
TO
(HEX)
NRPN parameter assignments
332 PM5D/PM5D-RH Owner’s Manual Reference section
EFFECT 1-8
BYPASS 26B4 26BB
MIX 26BC 26C3
PARAM1 26C4 26CB
PARAM2 26CC 26D3
PARAM3 26D4 26DB
PARAM4 26DC 26E3
PARAM5 26E4 26EB
PARAM6 26EC 26F3
PARAM7 26F4 26FB
PARAM8 26FC 2703
PARAM9 2704 270B
PARAM10 270C 2713
PARAM11 2714 271B
PARAM12 271C 2723
PARAM13 2724 272B
PARAM14 272C 2733
PARAM15 2734 273B
PARAM16 273C 2743
PARAM17 2744 274B
PARAM18 274C 2753
PARAM19 2754 275B
PARAM20 275C 2763
PARAM21 2764 276B
PARAM22 276C 2773
PARAM23 2774 277B
PARAM24 277C 2783
PARAM25 2784 278B
PARAM26 278C 2793
PARAM27 2794 279B
PARAM28 279C 27A3
PARAM29 27A4 27AB
PARAM30 27AC 27B3
PARAM31 27B4 27BB
PARAM32 27BC 27C3
GEQ 1-6
ON 27C4 27C9
GAIN1 27CA 27CF
GAIN2 27D0 27D5
GAIN3 27D6 27DB
GAIN4 27DC 27E1
GAIN5 27E2 27E7
GAIN6 27E8 27ED
GAIN7 27EE 27F3
GAIN8 27F4 27F9
GAIN9 27FA 27FF
GAIN10 2800 2805
GAIN11 2806 280B
GAIN12 280C 2811
GAIN13 2812 2817
GAIN14 2818 281D
GAIN15 281E 2823
GAIN16 2824 2829
GAIN17 282A 282F
GAIN18 2830 2835
GAIN19 2836 283B
GAIN20 283C 2841
GAIN21 2842 2847
GAIN22 2848 284D
GAIN23 284E 2853
GAIN24 2854 2859
GAIN25 285A 285F
GAIN26 2860 2865
GAIN27 2866 286B
GAIN28 286C 2871
GAIN29 2872 2877
GAIN30 2878 287D
GAIN31 287E 2883
SURROUND DIV R 2884 28C3
FADER MIX21-24,ST B LR 28E4 28E9
PARAMETER
FROM
(HEX)
TO
(HEX)
CH to Mix LEVEL
MIX1 SEND 28EA 2929
MIX2 SEND 292A 2969
MIX3 SEND 296A 29A9
MIX4 SEND 29AA 29E9
MIX5 SEND 29EA 2A29
MIX6 SEND 2A2A 2A69
MIX7 SEND 2A6A 2AA9
MIX8 SEND 2AAA 2AE9
MIX21 SEND 2AEA 2B29
MIX22 SEND 2B2A 2B69
MIX23 SEND 2B6A 2BA9
MIX24 SEND 2BAA 2BE9
MIX21-24, ST B LR
to Matrix LEVEL
MATRIX1 SEND 2BEA 2BEF
MATRIX2 SEND 2BF0 2BF5
MATRIX3 SEND 2BF6 2BFB
MATRIX4 SEND 2BFC 2C01
MATRIX5 SEND 2C02 2C07
MATRIX6 SEND 2C08 2C0D
MATRIX7 SEND 2C0E 2C13
MATRIX8 SEND 2C14 2C19
MIX21-24 to ST
LEVEL
MIX TO ST 2C1A 2C29
ON MIX21-24,ST B LR 2C2A 2C2F
CH to Mix ON
MIX1 SEND 2C30 2C6F
MIX2 SEND 2C70 2CAF
MIX3 SEND 2CB0 2CEF
MIX4 SEND 2CF0 2D2F
MIX5 SEND 2D30 2D6F
MIX6 SEND 2D70 2DAF
MIX7 SEND 2DB0 2DEF
MIX8 SEND 2DF0 2E2F
MIX21 SEND 2E30 2E6F
MIX22 SEND 2E70 2EAF
MIX23 SEND 2EB0 2EEF
MIX24 SEND 2EF0 2F2F
MATRIX SEND 2F30 2F35
MIX TO ST 2F36 2F45
INSERT ON MIX21-24,ST B LR 2F46 2F4B
CH to Mix PRE/
POST
MIX1 SEND 2F4C 2F8B
MIX2 SEND 2F8C 2FCB
MIX3 SEND 2FCC 300B
MIX4 SEND 300C 304B
MIX5 SEND 304C 308B
MIX6 SEND 308C 30CB
MIX7 SEND 30CC 310B
MIX8 SEND 310C 314B
MIX21 SEND 314C 318B
MIX22 SEND 318C 31CB
MIX23 SEND 31CC 320B
MIX24 SEND 320C 324B
MIX1-20, ST B LR
OUTPUT DELAY
ON 324C 3251
TIME HIGH 3252 3257
TIME LOW 3258 325D
EQ MIX21-24, ST A
LR OUT-
PUT(LOWER)
ON 325E 3263
Q LOW 3264 3269
F LOW 326A 326F
G LOW 3270 3275
Q LO-MID 3276 327B
F LO-MID 327C 3281
G LO-MID 3282 3287
Q HI-MID 3288 328D
F HI-MID 328E 3293
G HI-MID 3294 3299
Q HIGH 329A 329F
F HIGH 32A0 32A5
G HIGH 32A6 32AB
HPF ON 32AC 32B1
LPF ON 32B2 32B7
PARAMETER
FROM
(HEX)
TO
(HEX)
PM5D/PM5D-RH Owner’s Manual Reference section 333
Information shown
in the display
Function
menu
Global
functions
Output
functions
Input
functions
Appendices
EQ OUTPUT
(HIGHER)
E Q 32B8 32D3
E F 32D4 32EF
E G 32F0 330B
F Q 330C 3327
F F 3328 3343
F G 3344 335F
G Q 3360 337B
G F 337C 3397
G G 3398 33B3
H Q 33B4 33CF
H F 33D0 33EB
H G 33EC 3407
E HPF ON/OFF 3408 3423
H LPF ON/OFF 3424 343F
INPUT EQ LOW TYPE(P/S/F) 3440 347F
INPUT EQ HIGH TYPE(P/S/F) 3480 34BF
OUTPUT EQ
A TYPE(P/S/F) 34C0 34E3
D TYPE(P/S/F) 34E4 3507
E TYPE(P/S/F) 3508 3523
H TYPE(P/S/F) 3524 353F
OUTPUT EQ
A BYPASS 3540 3563
B BYPASS 3564 3587
C BYPASS 3588 35AB
D BYPASS 35AC 35CF
E BYPASS 35D0 35EB
F BYPASS 35EC 3607
G BYPASS 3608 3623
H BYPASS 3624 363F
IN HPF F 3640 367F
COMP MIX21-24,
ST A LR OUTPUT
ON 3680 3685
ATTACK 3686 368B
THRESH 368C 3691
RELEASE 3692 3697
RATIO 3698 369D
GAIN 369E 36A3
KNEE 36A4 36A9
PAN MIX1-2 36AA 36E9
CH to MIX PAN
MIX3-4 36EA 3729
MIX5-6 372A 3769
MIX7-8 376A 37A9
MIX21-22 37AA 37E9
MIX23-24 37EA 3829
MIX21-24, ST B LR
to Matrix PAN
MATRIX1,2 382A 382F
MATRIX3,4 3830 3835
MATRIX5,6 3836 383B
MATRIX7,8 383C 3841
MIX9-24 to ST PAN MIX TO ST 3842 3851
PARAMETER
FROM
(HEX)
TO
(HEX)
GEQ7-12
ON 3852 3857
GAIN1 3858 385D
GAIN2 385E 3863
GAIN3 3864 3869
GAIN4 386A 386F
GAIN5 3870 3875
GAIN6 3876 387B
GAIN7 387C 3881
GAIN8 3882 3887
GAIN9 3888 388D
GAIN10 388E 3893
GAIN11 3894 3899
GAIN12 389A 389F
GAIN13 38A0 38A5
GAIN14 38A6 38AB
GAIN15 38AC 38B1
GAIN16 38B2 38B7
GAIN17 38B8 38BD
GAIN18 38BE 38C3
GAIN19 38C4 38C9
GAIN20 38CA 38CF
GAIN21 38D0 38D5
GAIN22 38D6 38DB
GAIN23 38DC 38E1
GAIN24 38E2 38E7
GAIN25 38E8 38ED
GAIN26 38EE 38F3
GAIN27 38F4 38F9
GAIN28 38FA 38FF
GAIN29 3900 3905
GAIN30 3906 390B
GAIN31 390C 3911
LCR IN, MIX
ON/OFF 3912 3969
CSR 396A 39C1
DIRECT OUT ON/OFF 39C2 39F9
CH TO STEREO ON/OFF 3A02 3A41
DCA
ON/OFF 3A42 3A49
LEVEL 3A4E 3A55
MUTE MASTER ON/OFF 3A5A 3A61
RECALL SAFE ON/OFF 3A66 3AE6
HA
GAIN1 3B06 3B14
GAIN2 3B16 3B24
GAIN3 3B26 3B34
GAIN4 3B36 3B44
GAIN5 3B46 3B54
GAIN6 3B56 3B64
GAIN7 3B66 3B74
GAIN8 3B76 3B84
+48v 1 3B86 3B94
+48v 2 3B96 3BA4
+48v 3 3BA6 3BB4
+48v 4 3BB6 3BC4
+48v 5 3BC6 3BD4
+48v 6 3BD6 3BE4
+48v 7 3BE6 3BF4
+48v 8 3BF6 3C04
HPF1 3C06 3C14
HPF2 3C16 3C24
HPF3 3C26 3C34
HPF4 3C36 3C44
HPF5 3C46 3C54
HPF6 3C56 3C64
HPF7 3C66 3C74
HPF8 3C76 3C84
*1. For EQ or COMP parameters that include INPUT CH and OUTPUT,
the OUTPUT is assigned starting at 96 (60h) after the first number.
Thus, the numbers from immediately after INPUT CH until immedi-
ately before OUTPUT are unassigned.
PARAMETER
FROM
(HEX)
TO
(HEX)
Channel Library List
334 PM5D/PM5D-RH Owner’s Manual Reference section
Channel Library List
This table lists the parameters that are saved in the channel library for INPUT/ST IN channels, MIX channels, MATRIX chan-
nels, and STEREO A/B channels.
INPUT/ST IN MIX MATRIX STEREO A/B
LCR On/Off
LCR Center-Side Ratio
Fade Time On/Off
Fade Time Start Offset
Fade Time Fading Time
Insert In On/Off
Insert Point
Direct Out On/Off
Direct Out Point
Phase
On/Off
To Stereo Pan
Master Balance
Level Master Level
Attenuator
GATE On/Off
GATE Key In Filter
On
GATE Filter Type
GATE Filter Freq.
GATE Filter Q
GATE Type
GATE Attack
GATE Range
GATE Hold
GATE Decay
GATE Threshold
COMP LINK 1-8 COMP LINK A-H
COMP On/Off
COMP Key In Type
COMP Attack
COMP Release
COMP Ratio
COMP OutGain
COMP Knee/Width
COMP Threshold
EQ LINK 1-8 EQ LINK A-F EQ LINK G,H EQ LINK A-F
HPF On/Off
EQ HPF On/
Off x2
EQ HPF On/
Off
EQ HPF On/
Off x2
HPF Freq
EQ Type 1,2
EQ On/Off
EQ Filter Type x2
EQ Filter Type
x4
EQ Filter Type
x2
EQ Filter Type
x4
EQ LPF On/Off
EQ LPF On/Off
x2
EQ LPF On/Off
EQ LPF On/Off
x2
EQ Q x4 EQ Q x8 EQ Q x4 EQ Q x8
EQ Freq x4 EQ Freq x8 EQ Freq x4 EQ Freq x8
EQ Gain x4 EQ Gain x8 EQ Gain x4 EQ Gain x8
EQ Bypass x8 EQ Bypass x4 EQ Bypass x8
Delay On/Off
Delay Time
Surround LFE
Surround Div.
Surround Div.Rear
Surround LR Pan
Surround FR Pan
Surround Div.Link
Mute Group 1-8 On/Off
DCA Group 1-8
On/Off
DCA Group
7,8 On/Off
DCA Group
7,8 On/Off
DCA Group
7,8 On/Off
To Stereo On/Off
To Stereo
Point
Mix Send Pre
Point
Mix Send Post
Point
Mix Send Follow
Pan Vari
Mix Send Follow
Pan Fixed
Mix Send 1-24
On/Off
Mix Send 1-24
Pre/Post
Mix Send 1-24
Level
Mix Send 1-24
Pan
To Matrix On/
Off
To Matrix On/
Off
To Matrix
Point
To Matrix
Point
To Matrix 1-8
Level
To Matrix 1-8
Level
To Matrix 1-8
Pan
To Matrix 1-8
Pan
Selective Recall On
Selective Recall Parameter
INPUT/ST IN MIX MATRIX STEREO A/B
PM5D/PM5D-RH Owner’s Manual Reference section 335
Information shown
in the display
Function
menu
Global
functions
Output
functions
Input
functions
Appendices
Channel parameter behavior when paired
This table lists the behavior of channel parameters when INPUT/ST IN channels, MIX channels, or MATRIX channels are
paired.
Parameters that are copied when pair-
ing is enabled
Parameters that are turned on when
pairing is enabled
Parameters that are not modified when
pairing is enabled (reset if RESET BOTH
is selected)
Parameters that are not modified when
pairing is enabled (not reset even if
RESET BOTH is selected)
INPUT/ST IN MIX MATRIX
LCR On/Off
LCR Center-Side Ratio
Fade Time On/Off
Fade Time Start Offset
Fade Time Fading Time
Insert In On/Off
Insert Point
Direct Out On/Off
Direct Out Point
On/Off
Level Master Level
GATE On/Off
GATE Key In Source
GATE Key In Filter On
GATE Filter Type
GATE Filter Freq.
GATE Filter Q
GATE Type
GATE Attack
GATE Range
GATE Hold
GATE Decay
GATE Threshold
COMP LINK 1-8 COMP LINK A-H
COMP On/Off
COMP Key In Source
COMP Key In Type
COMP Attack
COMP Release
COMP Ratio
COMP OutGain
COMP Knee/Width
COMP Threshold
EQ LINK 1-8 EQ LINK A-F EQ LINK G,H
HPF On/Off EQ HPF On/Off x2 EQ HPF On/Off
HPF Freq
EQ Type 1,2
EQ On/Off
EQ Filter Type x2 EQ Filter Type x4 EQ Filter Type x2
EQ LPF On/Off EQ LPF On/Off x2 EQ LPF On/Off
EQ Q x4 EQ Q x8 EQ Q x4
EQ Freq x4 EQ Freq x8 EQ Freq x4
EQ Gain x4 EQ Gain x8 EQ Gain x4
EQ Bypass x8 EQ Bypass x4
Delay On/Off
Surround LFE
Surround Div.
Surround Div.Rear
Surround Div.Link
Mute Group 1-8 On/Off
DCA Group 1-8 On/Off DCA Group 7,8 On/Off
To Stereo On/Off
To Stereo Point
Mix Send Pre Point Mix Send Post Point
Mix Send Follow Pan Vari
Mix Send Follow Pan
Fixed
Mix Send 1-24 On/Off
Mix Send 1-24 Pre/Post
Mix Send 1-24 Level
To Matrix On/Off
To Matrix Point
Selective Recall On
Selective Recall Parameter
Recall Safe On
Recall Safe Parameter
Mute Safe On
Tracking On/Off
Tracking Level
Solo Safe On/Off
Cue/Solo On/Off
CH COPY CH SELECT
GLOBAL PASTE CH SELECT
INPUT/ST IN MIX MATRIX
Attenuator Gang
Gate Stereo Link
Comp Stereo Link
Delay Gang
INPUT/ST IN MIX MATRIX
Phase
To Stereo Pan
Master Balance
Attenuator
Delay Time
Surround LR Pan
Surround FR Pan
Mix Send 1-24 Pan
To Matrix 1-8 Level
To Matrix 1-8 Pan
Input Pan Mode
Surround Link On/Off
Surround Link Pattern
M-S Encode On/Off
M-S Encode S-Gain
INPUT/ST IN MIX MATRIX
Mix Type
(VARI,FIX,SURR)
TB On/Off
OSC On/Off
MONITOR DEFINE On/Off
INPUT/ST IN MIX MATRIX
MIDI Data Format
336 PM5D/PM5D-RH Owner’s Manual Reference section
MIDI Data Format
This section explains the format of the data that the PM5D is able to understand, send, and receive.
In addition to the messages described here, you can use the MIDI REMOTE function or the MIDI EVENT settings of the
SCENE function to transmit any type of command.
1 CHANNEL MESSAGE
1.1 NOTE OFF (8n)
Reception
These messages are echoed to MIDI OUT if [OTHER ECHO] is ON.
They are received if [Rx CH] matches, and used to control effects.
1.2 NOTE ON (9n)
Reception
These messages are echoed to MIDI OUT if [OTHER ECHO] is ON.
They are received if [Rx CH] matches, and used to control effects.
1.3 CONTROL CHANGE (Bn)
Tw o types of control change can be transmitted and received; [NRPN] (Non-
Registered Parameter Numbers) and freely-assigned [TABLE] (16CH x 110)
messages. Select either [TABLE] or [NRPN].
Reception
These messages are echoed to MIDI OUT if [Control Change ECHO] is ON.
If [TABLE MULTI] is selected, these messages are received when [Control
Change Rx] is ON, and will control parameters according to the settings of the
[Control assign table]. If [TABLE SINGLE] is selected, these messages are
received when [Control Change Rx] is ON and [Rx CH] matches, and will
control parameters according to the settings of the [Control assign table]. For
the parameters that can be assigned, refer to p.312.
If [NRPN] is selected, these messages are received when [Control Change Rx] is
ON and the [Rx CH] matches; the four messages NRPN control number (62h,
63h) and DATA ENTRY control number (06h, 26h) are used to control the
specified parameter.
Transmission
If [TABLE MULTI] is selected, and if [Control Change Tx] is ON when you
operate a parameter that is assigned in the [Control assign table], these
messages will be transmitted. If [TABLE SINGLE] is selected, and if [Control
Change Tx] is ON when you operate a parameter that is assigned in the [Control
assign table], these messages are transmitted on the [Tx CH] channel. For the
parameters that can be assigned, refer to p.312.
If [NRPN] is selected, and if [Control Change Tx] is ON when you operate a
specified parameter, the four messages NRPN control number (62h, 63h) and
DATA ENTRY control number (06h, 26h) are transmitted on the [Tx CH]
channel.
Control Change messages are not used for transmission to PM5D Editor
because there is no guarantee that the contents of the assignment tables will
match. (Parameter Change messages are always used.)
Control Change numbers 0 and 32 are for selecting banks.
If [TABLE] is selected
Equation for converting a Control Value to parameter data
paramSteps = paramMax - paramMin + 1;
add = paramWidth / paramSteps;
mod = paramWidth - add * paramSteps;
curValue = parm * add + mod / 2;
(1) If the assigned parameter has fewer than 128 steps
paramWidth = 128; rxValue = Control value;
(2) If the assigned parameter has 128 or more but less than
16,384 steps
paramWidth = 16384;
(2-1) When High and Low data is received
rxValue = Control value(High) * 128 + Control value(Low);
(2-2) When Low data is received
rxValue = (curValue & 16256) + Control value(Low);
(2-3) When High data is received
rxValue = Control value(High) * 128 + (curValue & 127);
(3) If the assigned parameter has 16,384 or more but less than
2,097,152 steps
paramWidth = 2097152;
(3-1) When High, Middle, and Low data is received
rxValue = Control value(High) * 16384 + Control value(Middle) * 128 + Control
value(Low);
(3-2) When only Low data is received
rxValue = (curValue & 2097024) + Control value(Low);
(3-3) When only Middle data is received
rxValue = (curValue & 2080895) + Control value(Middle) * 128;
(3-4) When only High data is received
rxValue = (curValue & 16383) + Control value(High) * 16384;
(3-5) When only Middle and Low data is received
rxValue = (curValue & 2080768) + Control value(Middle) * 128 + Control
value(Low);
(3-6) When only High and Low data is received
rxValue = (curValue & 16256) + Control value(High) * 16384 + Control value(Low);
(3-7) When only High and Middle data is received
rxValue = (curValue & 127) + Control value(High) * 16384 + Control value(Middle)
* 128;
if ( rxValue > paramWidth)
rxValue = paramWidth;
param = ( rxValue - mod / 2) / add;
If [NRPN] is selected
STATUS 1000nnnn 8n
Note off message
DATA 0nnnnnnn nn
Note number
0vvvvvvv vv
Velocity(ignored)
STATUS 1001nnnn 9n
Note on message
DATA 0nnnnnnn nn
Note number
0vvvvvvv vv
Velocity (1-127:on, 0:off)
STATUS 1011nnnn Bn
Control change
DATA 00
Control number (00)
0vvvvvvv vv
Control Value (0-127)
STATUS 1011nnnn Bn
Control change
DATA 20
Control number (32)
0vvvvvvv vv
Control Value (0-127)
STATUS 1011nnnn Bn
Control change
DATA 0nnnnnnn nn
Control number (1-31,33-95,102-119) *
0vvvvvvv vv
Control Value (0-127)
* Numbers 0, 32, and 96–101 cannot be used.
STATUS 1011nnnn Bn
Control change
DATA 01100010 62
NRPN LSB
0vvvvvvv vv
Parameter number LSB
STATUS 1011nnnn Bn
Control change *
DATA 01100011 63
NRPN MSB
0vvvvvvv vv
Parameter number MSB
STATUS 1011nnnn Bn
Control change *
DATA 00000110 06
Data entry MSB
0vvvvvvv vv
Parameter data MSB
STATUS 1011nnnn Bn
Control change *
DATA 00100110 26
Data entry LSB
0vvvvvvv vv
Parameter data LSB
* The STATUS byte of the second and subsequent messages need not
be added during transmission. Reception must occur correctly
whether or not the status byte is omitted.
PM5D/PM5D-RH Owner’s Manual Reference section 337
Information shown
in the display
Function
menu
Global
functions
Output
functions
Input
functions
Appendices
1.4 PROGRAM CHANGE (Cn)
Reception
If [Program Change ECHO] is ON, bank select messages will also be echoed
from MIDI OUT.
If SINGLE CH is selected, these messages are received if [Program Change RX]
is ON and the [Rx CH] matches. However if [OMNI] is ON, these messages are
received regardless of the channel. When these messages are received, scene
memories are recalled according to the settings of the [Program Change Table].
Transmission
If [Program Change] is ON, these messages are transmitted according to the
[Program Change Table] settings when a scene memory is recalled.
If SINGLE CH is selected, these messages are transmitted on the [Tx CH]
channel.
If the recalled scene has been assigned to more than one program number, the
lowest-numbered program number for each MIDI channel will be transmitted.
Program Change messages are not used for transmission to PM5D Editor
because there is no guarantee that the contents of the assignment tables will
match. (Parameter Change messages are always used.)
You can choose either MULTI MIDI CH or SINGLE CH.
If SINGLE is selected
You can choose the RX CH, OMNI CH, and TX CH.
You can choose whether a bank select message will be added.
A bank of up to 16 can be specified.
If MULTI is selected
The RX and TX channels will be the same.
The assignment table will use the settings for each MIDI channel. Bank select
messages will not be added.
You can make settings for up to sixteen MIDI channels.
2 SYSTEM REALTIME MESSAGE
2.1 TIMING CLOCK (F8)
Reception
This message is used to control effects. This message is transmitted twenty-four
times per quarter note.
Echoing of this message depends on the OTHER item in the ECHO settings.
2.2 ACTIVE SENSING (FE)
Reception
Once this message has been received, MIDI communication will be initialized
(e.g., Running Status will be cleared) if no message is received for an interval of
400 ms.
This message is not subject to echoing.
2.3 SYSTEM RESET (FF)
Reception
When this message is received, MIDI communication will be initialized (e.g.,
Running Status will be cleared).
This message is not subject to echoing.
3 System Exclusive Message
3.1 Real Time System Exclusive
3.2 Bulk Dump
This message is used to send or receive the contents of various memories stored
within the PM5D.
The basic format is as follows.
The PM5D uses the following data types for a bulk dump.
The unique header (Model ID) identifies whether the device is a PM5D.
To calculate the check sum, add the bytes starting with the byte after BYTE
COUNT (LOW) and ending with the byte before CHECK SUM, take the binary
complement, and set bit 7 to 0.
CHECK SUM = (-sum)&0x7F
Bulk Dumps can be received at any time, and can be transmitted at any time
when a Bulk Dump Request is received.
A Bulk Dump is transmitted on the [Rx CH] channel in response to a Bulk
Dump Request.
In the data portion, seven words of 8-bit data are converted into eight words of
7-bit data.
[Conversion from actual data to bulk data]
d[0. 6]: actual data
b[0. 7]: bulk data
b[0] = 0;
for( I=0; I<7; I++){
if( d[I]&0x80){
b[0] |= 1<<(6-I);
}
b[I+1] = d[I]&0x7F;
}
STATUS 1100nnnn Cn
Program change
DATA 0nnnnnnn nn
Program number (0-127)
STATUS 11111000 F8
Timing clock
STATUS 11111110 FE
Active sensing
STATUS 11111111 FF
System reset
Command rx/tx function
F0 7F dd 06 … F7 MMC COMMAND tx
MMC
command
F0 7F dd 01 … F7 MIDI TIME CODE rx
Full message
Command rx/tx function
F0 43 0n 3E BB BB 0F D0 D1 D2 …
EE F7 BULK DUMP DATA
rx/tx
BULK DUMP
DATA
F0 43 2n 3E 0F D0 D1 D2 … EE F7
BULK DUMP REQUEST
rx
BULK DUMP
REQUEST
Data name
(D0)
Data Number
(D1,2)
tx/rx function
‘M’ 0-500
512 (current data)
tx/rx
Scene Memory & Request
‘S’ 512 (current data)
tx/rx
Setup Memory & Request
(current setup)
‘R’ 0–99
512 (current data)
tx/rx
Input patch library & Request
‘O’ 0–99
512 (current data)
tx/rx
Output patch library & Request
‘H’ 1–199
512– (channel
current data)
tx/rx
Input Channel library & Request
‘h’ 1–199
768– (channel
current data)
tx/rx
Output Channel library &
Request
‘G’ 1–199
512– (channel
current data)
tx/rx
Gate library & Request
‘Y’ 1–199
512– (channel
current data)
tx/rx
Compressor library & Request
‘Q’ 1–199
512– (channel
current data)
tx/rx
Input Equalizer library & Request
‘q’ 1–199
768 - (channel
current data)
tx/rx
Output Equalizer library &
Request
‘F’ 1–199
512– (GEQ 1-12
current data)
tx/rx
GEQ Equalizer library & Request
‘E’ 1–199
512– (Effect 1-8
current data)
tx/rx
Effect library & Request
‘W’ 1–199
512 (current data)
tx/rx
HA library & Request
‘P’ 512 (current data)
tx/rx
Program change table & Request
‘C’ 512 (current data)
tx/rx
Control change table & Request
‘N’ 512 (current data)
tx/rx
Plug-in Effect Card Data &
Request
‘A 512 (current data)
tx/rx
Event List & Request
MIDI Data Format
338 PM5D/PM5D-RH Owner’s Manual Reference section
[Recovery from bulk data to actual data]
d[0. 6]: actual data
b[0. 7]: bulk data
for( I=0; I<7; I++){
b[0] <<= 1;
d[I] = b[I+1]+(0x80&b[0]);
}
3.3 PARAMTER CHANGE
Reception
This message is echoed if [Parameter change ECHO] is ON.
This message is received if [Parameter change RX] is ON and [Rx CH] matches
the Device number included in the SUB STATUS. When a parameter change is
received, the specified parameter will be controlled. When a parameter request
is received, the current value of the specified parameter will be transmitted as a
parameter change with its Device Number as the [Rx CH].
Transmission
If [Parameter change TX] is ON, and you edit a parameter for which control
change transmission has not been enabled, a parameter change will be
transmitted with the [Tx CH] as its device number.
In response to a parameter request, a parameter change will be transmitted with
[Rx CH] as its device number.
4. PARAMETER CHANGE details
4.1 Current Scene, Setup, Backup, Window control,
Input Patch, Output Patch, HA Data
– Parameter change –
4.1.1 Format
Reception
This message is received if [Parameter change RX] is ON and [Rx CH] matches
the Device number included in the SUB STATUS.
This message is echoed if [Parameter change ECHO] is ON.
When the message is received, the specified parameter will be edited.
Transmission
If [Parameter change Tx] is ON, this message is transmitted with the [Device
Number] specified by the [Tx CH] when you edit a parameter that is not
assigned in the [Control change assign table].
4.1.2 Data categories
4.2 Current Scene, Setup, Backup, Window control,
Input Patch, Output Patch, HA Data
– Parameter request –
4.2.1 Format
Reception
This message is received if [Parameter change RX] is ON and [Rx CH] matches
the Device number included in the SUB STATUS.
This message is echoed if [Parameter change ECHO] is ON.
When this is received, the value of the specified parameter is transmitted as a
Parameter Change.
4.2.2 Data categories
4.3 Function Call – Library Store/Recall –
(Parameter change)
4.3.1 Format
Reception
This message is received if [Parameter change RX] is ON and [Rx CH] matches
the Device number included in the SUB STATUS.
This message is echoed if [Parameter change ECHO] is ON.
When the message is received, the specified parameter will be edited.
Transmission
If [Parameter change Tx] is ON, this message is transmitted with a [Device
Number] of the [Tx CH].
Command rx/tx function
F0 43 1n 3E 0F … F7
RARAMETER CHANGE
rx/tx
PM5D native parameter change
F0 43 3n 3E 0F … F7
PARAMETER REQUEST
rx/tx
PM5D native parameter request
STATUS 11110000 F0
System exclusive message
ID No. 01000011 43
Manufacture’s ID number (YAMAHA)
SUB STATUS 0001nnnn 1n
n=0-15 (Device number=MIDI Channel)
GROUP ID 00111110 3E
Digital mixer
MODEL ID 00001111 0F
PM5D
DATA
Category
0ccccccc cc
DATA 0eeeeeee ee
Element No *1
0iiiiiii ii
Index No *2
0ccccccc cc
Channel No *3
0ddddddd dd
data
::
EOX 11110111 F7
End of exclusive
*1 If ee is 0, the Element No. is extended by two bytes.
*2 If ii is 0, the Index No. is extended by two bytes.
*3 If cc is 0, the Channel No. is extended by two bytes.
DATA CATEGORY NAME
0x01 00000001
Current Scene Data
0x03 00000011
Setup Data
0x04 00000100
Backup Data
0x05 00000101
Window Control Data
0x06 00000110
Input patch Data
0x07 00000111
Output patch Data
0x08 00001000
HA Data
STATUS 11110000 F0
System exclusive message
ID No. 01000011 43
Manufacture’s ID number (YAMAHA)
SUB STATUS 0001nnnn 3n
n=0-15 (Device number=MIDI Channel)
GROUP ID 00111110 3E
Digital mixer
MODEL ID 00001111 0F
PM5D
DATA Category 0ccccccc cc
DATA 0eeeeeee ee
Element No *1
0iiiiiii ii
Index No *1
0ccccccc cc
Channel No *1
EOX 11110111 F7
End of exclusive
*1 See 4.1.1
DATA CATEGORY NAME
0x01 00000001
Current Scene Data
0x03 00000011
Setup Data
0x04 00000100
Backup Data
0x06 00000110
Input patch Data
0x07 00000111
Output patch Data
0x08 00001000
HA Data
STATUS 11110000 F0
System exclusive message
ID No. 01000011 43
Manufacture’s ID number (YAMAHA)
SUB STATUS 0001nnnn 1n
n=0-15 (Device number=MIDI Channel)
GROUP ID 00111110 3E
Digital mixer
MODEL ID 00001111 0F
PM5D
DATA CATEGORY 00000000 00
OTHER DATA
FUNCTION NAME 01001100 "L"
(ASCII CODE) See 4.3.2
01101001 "i"
(ASCII CODE)
01100010 "b"
(ASCII CODE)
0fffffff ff
(ASCII CODE)
0fffffff ff
(ASCII CODE)
0fffffff ff
(ASCII CODE)
0fffffff ff
(ASCII CODE)
0fffffff ff
(ASCII CODE)
MODULE NAME 0mmmmmmm mm
(ASCII CODE) See 4.3.3
0mmmmmmm mm
(ASCII CODE)
0mmmmmmm mm
(ASCII CODE)
0mmmmmmm mm
(ASCII CODE)
0mmmmmmm mm
(ASCII CODE)
0mmmmmmm mm
(ASCII CODE)
0mmmmmmm mm
(ASCII CODE)
0mmmmmmm mm
(ASCII CODE)
DATA 0mmmmmmm mh
number High
0mmmmmmm ml
number Low
0ccccccc ch
channel High
0ccccccc cl
channel Low
EOX 11110111 F7
End of exclusive
PM5D/PM5D-RH Owner’s Manual Reference section 339
Information shown
in the display
Function
menu
Global
functions
Output
functions
Input
functions
Appendices
4.3.2 Function names
4.3.3 Module names
4.4 Function Call – Library Edit –
(Parameter change)
4.4.1 Format
Reception
This message is received if [Parameter change RX] is ON and [Rx CH] matches
the Device number included in the SUB STATUS.
This message is echoed if [Parameter change ECHO] is ON.
When the message is received, the specified memory/library will be edited.
Transmission
In response to a request, a Parameter Change message is transmitted on the [Rx
CH].
If [Parameter change ECHO] is ON, the message is transmitted without change.
4.4.2 Function names
4.4.3 Module names
4.5 Function Call – Library Attribute –
4.5.1 Title (Parameter change) format
Reception
This message is received if [Parameter change RX] is ON and [Rx CH] matches
the Device number included in the SUB STATUS.
This message is echoed if [Parameter change ECHO] is ON.
When the message is received, the title of the specified memory/library will be
edited.
Transmission
In response to a request, a Parameter Change message is transmitted on the [Rx
CH].
If [Parameter change ECHO] is ON, the message is transmitted without change.
FUNCTION NAME
Store “LibStr__”
Recall “LibRcl__”
Store -Unknown Factor- *1 “LibUnStr”
*1 This indicates that the library data has been
updated due to an external cause (such as
LOAD).
MODULE NAME
Scene “SCENE___”
Input Patch “INPATCH_”
Output Patch “OUTPATCH”
Input Channel “INCHNNL_”
Output Channel “OUTCHNNL”
Input EQ “INEQ____”
Output EQ “OUTEQ___”
Gate “GATE____”
Comp “COMP____”
GEQ “GEQ_____”
Effect “EFFECT__”
HA “HA______”
Function Number Channel tx/rx
“LibStr__ ” SCENE 1- 500 *5
tx/rx
INPATCH 1- 99 *5
tx/rx
OUTPATCH LIB 1- 99 *5
tx/rx
INPUT CHANNEL LIB 1- 199 *1
tx/rx
OUTPUT CHANNEL
LIB
1- 199 *2 *3 *4
tx/rx
INPUT EQ LIB 41- 199 *1
tx/rx
OUTPUT EQ LIB 4- 199 *2 *3 *4
tx/rx
GATE LIB 5- 199 *1
tx/rx
COMP LIB 37- 199 *1 *2 *3 *4
tx/rx
GEQ LIB 1- 199 *6
tx/rx
EFFECT LIB 48- 199 *7
tx/rx
HA LIB 1- 199 *5
tx/rx
“LibUnStr” SCENE 1- 500
tx/rx
INPATCH 1- 99
tx/rx
OUTPATCH LIB 1- 99
tx/rx
INPUT CHANNEL LIB 1- 199
tx/rx
OUTPUT CHANNEL
LIB
1- 199
tx/rx
INPUT EQ LIB 41- 199
tx/rx
OUTPUT EQ LIB 4- 199
tx/rx
GATE LIB 5- 199
tx/rx
COMP LIB 37- 199
tx/rx
GEQ LIB 1- 199
tx/rx
EFFECT LIB 48- 199
tx/rx
HA LIB 1- 199
tx/rx
“LibRcl__” SCENE 0- 500 *5
tx/rx
INPATCH 0- 99 *5
Tx/rx
OUTPATCH LIB 0- 99 *5
Tx/rx
INPUT CHANNEL LIB 0- 199 *1
Tx/rx
OUTPUT CHANNEL
LIB
0- 199 *2 *3 *4
Tx/rx
INPUT EQ LIB 1- 199 *1
tx/rx
OUTPUT EQ LIB 1- 199 *2 *3 *4
tx/rx
GATE LIB 1- 199 *1
tx/rx
COMP LIB 1- 199 *1 *2 *3 *4
tx/rx
GEQ LIB 0- 199 *6
tx/rx
EFFECT LIB 1- 199 *7
tx/rx
HA LIB 0- 199 *5
tx/rx
*1 0: CH1–47:CH48, 48:STIN1L–55:STIN4R, 56:FXRTN 1L–63: FXRTN
4R,
*2 256: MIX1–279:MIX24,
*3 512:MATRIX1–519: MATRIX8,
*4 1024:STEREO1L–1027:STEREO2R
*5 Use 512 if the recall-destination or store-source data is single
*6 0: GEQ1–11:GEQ12
*7 0:Effect1–7:Effect8
STATUS 11110000 F0
System exclusive message
ID No. 01000011 43
Manufacture’s ID number (YAMAHA)
SUB STATUS 0001nnnn 1n
n=0-15 (Device number=MIDI Channel)
GROUP ID 00111110 3E
Digital mixer
MODEL ID 00001111 0F
PM5D
DATA
CATEGORY
00000000 00
OTHER DATA
FUNCTION
NAME
01001100 "L"
(ASCII CODE) See 4.4.2
01101001 "i"
(ASCII CODE)
01100010 "b"
(ASCII CODE)
0fffffff ff
(ASCII CODE)
0fffffff ff
(ASCII CODE)
0fffffff ff
(ASCII CODE)
0fffffff ff
(ASCII CODE)
0fffffff ff
(ASCII CODE)
MODULE NAME 0mmmmmmm mm
(ASCII CODE) See 4.4.3
0mmmmmmm mm
(ASCII CODE)
0mmmmmmm mm
(ASCII CODE)
0mmmmmmm mm
(ASCII CODE)
0mmmmmmm mm
(ASCII CODE)
0mmmmmmm mm
(ASCII CODE)
0mmmmmmm mm
(ASCII CODE)
0mmmmmmm mm
(ASCII CODE)
DATA 0mmmmmmm mh
number -source start High
0mmmmmmm ml
number -source start Low
0mmmmmmm mh
number -source end High
0mmmmmmm ml
number -source end Low
0mmmmmmm mh
number -destination start High
0mmmmmmm ml
number -destination to start Low
EOX 11110111 F7
End of exclusive
FUNCTION NAME
Copy “LibCpy__”
Paste “LibPst__”
Clear “LibClr__”
Cut “LibCut__”
Insert “LibIns__”
MODULE NAME
Scene “SCENE___”
STATUS 11110000 F0
System exclusive message
ID No. 01000011 43
Manufacture’s ID number (YAMAHA)
SUB STATUS 0001nnnn 1n
n=0-15 (Device number=MIDI Channel)
GROUP ID 00111110 3E
Digital mixer
MIDI Data Format
340 PM5D/PM5D-RH Owner’s Manual Reference section
4.5.2 Title (Parameter request) format
Reception
When this is received, a parameter change is transmitted with [Rx CH] as the
device number.
4.5.3 Title module names
4.5.4 Protect (Parameter change) format
4.5.5 Protect (Parameter request) format
Reception
When this is received, a parameter change is transmitted with [Rx CH] as the
device number.
MODEL ID 00001111 0F
PM5D
DATA
CATEGORY
00000000 00
OTHER DATA
FUNCTION
NAME
01001100 "L"
(ASCII CODE)
01101001 "i"
(ASCII CODE)
01100010 "b"
(ASCII CODE)
01010100 "T"
(ASCII CODE)
01101001 "i"
(ASCII CODE)
01110100 "t"
(ASCII CODE)
01101100 "l"
(ASCII CODE)
01011111 "_"
(ASCII CODE)
MODULE NAME 0mmmmmmm mm
(ASCII CODE) See 4.5.3
0mmmmmmm mm
(ASCII CODE)
0mmmmmmm mm
(ASCII CODE)
0mmmmmmm mm
(ASCII CODE)
0mmmmmmm mm
(ASCII CODE)
0mmmmmmm mm
(ASCII CODE)
0mmmmmmm mm
(ASCII CODE)
0mmmmmmm mm
(ASCII CODE)
DATA 0mmmmmmm mh
number High
0mmmmmmm ml
number Low
0ddddddd dd
title 1
0ddddddd dd
title x
EOX 11110111 F7
End of exclusive
STATUS 11110000 F0
System exclusive message
ID No. 01000011 43
Manufacture’s ID number (YAMAHA)
SUB STATUS 0011nnnn 3n
n=0-15 (Device number=MIDI Channel)
GROUP ID 00111110 3E
Digital mixer
MODEL ID 00001111 0F
PM5D
DATA
CATEGORY
00000000 00
OTHER DATA
FUNCTION
NAME
01001100 "L"
(ASCII CODE)
01101001 "i"
(ASCII CODE)
01100010 "b"
(ASCII CODE)
01010100 "T"
(ASCII CODE)
01101001 "i"
(ASCII CODE)
01110100 "t"
(ASCII CODE)
01101100 "l"
(ASCII CODE)
01011111 "_"
(ASCII CODE)
MODULE NAME 0mmmmmmm mm
(ASCII CODE) See 4.5.3
0mmmmmmm mm
(ASCII CODE)
0mmmmmmm mm
(ASCII CODE)
0mmmmmmm mm
(ASCII CODE)
0mmmmmmm mm
(ASCII CODE)
0mmmmmmm mm
(ASCII CODE)
0mmmmmmm mm
(ASCII CODE)
0mmmmmmm mm
(ASCII CODE)
DATA 0mmmmmmm mh
number High
0mmmmmmm ml
number Low
EOX 11110111 F7
End of exclusive
MODULE NAME number size
SCENE LIB “SCENE___” 0-500,512 (0: response only) 16
INPATCH LIB “INPATCH_” 0-99 (0: response only) 16
OUTPATCH LIB “OUTPATCH” 0-99 (0: response only) 16
INPUT CHANNEL LIB “INCHNNL_” 0-199 (0-1: response only) 16
OUTPUT CHANNEL
LIB
“OUTCHNNL” 0-199 (0-1: response only) 16
INPUT EQ LIB “INEQ____” 1-199 (1-40: response only) 16
OUTPUT EQ LIB “OUTEQ___” 1-199 (1-3: response only) 16
GATE LIB “GATE____” 1-199 (1-4: response only) 16
COMP LIB “COMP____” 1-199 (1-36: response only) 16
GEQ LIB “GEQ_____” 1-199 (1-52: response only) 16
EFFECT LIB “EFFECT__” 0-199 (0: response only) 16
HA LIB “HA______” 0-199 (0: response only) 16
STATUS 11110000 F0
System exclusive message
ID No. 01000011 43
Manufacture’s ID number (YAMAHA)
SUB STATUS 0001nnnn 1n
n=0-15 (Device number=MIDI Channel)
GROUP ID 00111110 3E
Digital mixer
MODEL ID 00001111 0F
PM5D
DATA
CATEGORY
00000000 00
OTHER DATA
FUNCTION
NAME
01001100 "L"
(ASCII CODE)
01101001 "i"
(ASCII CODE)
01100010 "b"
(ASCII CODE)
01010000 "P"
(ASCII CODE)
01110010 "r"
(ASCII CODE)
01110100 "t"
(ASCII CODE)
01100011 "c"
(ASCII CODE)
01011111 "_"
(ASCII CODE)
MODULE NAME 0mmmmmmm mm
(ASCII CODE) See 4.5.6
0mmmmmmm mm
(ASCII CODE)
0mmmmmmm mm
(ASCII CODE)
0mmmmmmm mm
(ASCII CODE)
0mmmmmmm mm
(ASCII CODE)
0mmmmmmm mm
(ASCII CODE)
0mmmmmmm mm
(ASCII CODE)
0mmmmmmm mm
(ASCII CODE)
DATA 0mmmmmmm mh
number High
0mmmmmmm ml
number Low
0ddddddd dd
data (unprotected:0, protected:1, read
only:2 )
EOX 11110111 F7
End of exclusive
STATUS 11110000 F0
System exclusive message
ID No. 01000011 43
Manufacture’s ID number (YAMAHA)
SUB STATUS 0011nnnn 3n
n=0-15 (Device number=MIDI Channel)
GROUP ID 00111110 3E
Digital mixer
MODEL ID 00001111 0F
PM5D
DATA
CATEGORY
00000000 00
OTHER DATA
FUNCTION
NAME
01001100 "L"
(ASCII CODE)
01101001 "i"
(ASCII CODE)
01100010 "b"
(ASCII CODE)
01010000 "P"
(ASCII CODE)
01110010 "r"
(ASCII CODE)
01110100 "t"
(ASCII CODE)
01100011 "c"
(ASCII CODE)
01011111 "_"
(ASCII CODE)
MODULE NAME 0mmmmmmm mm
(ASCII CODE) See 4.5.6
0mmmmmmm mm
(ASCII CODE)
0mmmmmmm mm
(ASCII CODE)
0mmmmmmm mm
(ASCII CODE)
0mmmmmmm mm
(ASCII CODE)
0mmmmmmm mm
(ASCII CODE)
0mmmmmmm mm
(ASCII CODE)
0mmmmmmm mm
(ASCII CODE)
DATA 0mmmmmmm mh
number High
0mmmmmmm ml
number Low
EOX 11110111 F7
End of exclusive
PM5D/PM5D-RH Owner’s Manual Reference section 341
Information shown
in the display
Function
menu
Global
functions
Output
functions
Input
functions
Appendices
4.5.6 Protect module names
4.5.7 Link format (Parameter change)
Reception
This message is received if [Parameter change RX] is ON and [Rx CH] matches
the Device number included in the SUB STATUS.
This message is echoed if [Parameter change ECHO] is ON.
When the message is received, the link settings of the specified memory/library
will be edited.
Transmission
In response to a request, a Parameter Change message is transmitted on the [Rx
CH].
If [Parameter change ECHO] is ON, the message is transmitted without change.
4.5.8 Link format (Parameter request)
Reception
When this is received, a parameter change is transmitted with [Rx CH] as the
device number.
For the function and number, refer to the table in 4.5.7.
4.5.9 Library module names
4.5.10 Linked library module names
4.6 Function Call – Module –
4.6.1 Effect Trigger (Parameter change) format
Reception
This message is received if [Parameter change RX] is ON and [Rx CH] matches
the Device number included in the SUB STATUS. This message is echoed if
[Parameter change ECHO] is ON.
When this message is received, the corresponding effect function will operate
(depends on the effect type).
MODULE NAME number size
SCENE LIB “SCENE___” 0-500,512 (0:response only) 16
STATUS 11110000 F0
System exclusive message
ID No. 01000011 43
Manufacture’s ID number (YAMAHA)
SUB STATUS 0001nnnn 1n
n=0-15 (Device number=MIDI Channel)
GROUP ID 00111110 3E
Digital mixer
MODEL ID 00001111 0F
PM5D
DATA
CATEGORY
00000000 00
OTHER DATA
FUNCTION
NAME
01001100 "L"
(ASCII CODE)
01101001 "i"
(ASCII CODE)
01100010 "b"
(ASCII CODE)
01010000 "L"
(ASCII CODE)
01101001 "i"
(ASCII CODE)
01101110 "n"
(ASCII CODE)
01101011 "k"
(ASCII CODE)
01011111 "_"
(ASCII CODE)
MODULE NAME 0mmmmmmm mm
(ASCII CODE) See 4.5.9
0mmmmmmm mm
(ASCII CODE)
0mmmmmmm mm
(ASCII CODE)
0mmmmmmm mm
(ASCII CODE)
0mmmmmmm mm
(ASCII CODE)
0mmmmmmm mm
(ASCII CODE)
0mmmmmmm mm
(ASCII CODE)
0mmmmmmm mm
(ASCII CODE)
DATA 0sssssss mh
library number High
0sssssss ml
library number Low
0mmmmmmm mm
linked library (ASCII CODE) *1 See 4.5.10
0mmmmmmm mm
linked library (ASCII CODE) *1
0mmmmmmm mm
linked library (ASCII CODE) *1
0mmmmmmm mm
linked library (ASCII CODE) *1
0mmmmmmm mm
linked library (ASCII CODE) *1
0mmmmmmm mm
linked library (ASCII CODE) *1
0mmmmmmm mm
linked library (ASCII CODE) *1
0mmmmmmm mm
linked library (ASCII CODE) *1
0mmmmmmm mh
linked library number High *1
0mmmmmmm ml
linked library number Low *1
0ddddddd dd
data (unlinked:0, linked:1) *1
EOX 11110111 F7
End of exclusive
*1 If this portion is repeated multiple times, this means that a single
packet contains link data for multiple libraries.
STATUS 11110000 F0
System exclusive message
ID No. 01000011 43
Manufacture’s ID number (YAMAHA)
SUB STATUS 0011nnnn 3n
n=0-15 (Device number=MIDI Channel)
GROUP ID 00111110 3E
Digital mixer
MODEL ID 00001111 0F
PM5D
DATA
CATEGORY
00000000 00
OTHER DATA
FUNCTION
NAME
01001100 "L"
(ASCII CODE)
01101001 "i"
(ASCII CODE)
01100010 "b"
(ASCII CODE)
01010000 "L"
(ASCII CODE)
01101001 "i"
(ASCII CODE)
01101110 "n"
(ASCII CODE)
01101011 "k"
(ASCII CODE)
01011111 "_"
(ASCII CODE)
MODULE NAME 0mmmmmmm mm
(ASCII CODE) See 4.5.9
0mmmmmmm mm
(ASCII CODE)
0mmmmmmm mm
(ASCII CODE)
0mmmmmmm mm
(ASCII CODE)
0mmmmmmm mm
(ASCII CODE)
0mmmmmmm mm
(ASCII CODE)
0mmmmmmm mm
(ASCII CODE)
0mmmmmmm mm
(ASCII CODE)
DATA 0sssssss mh
library number High
0sssssss ml
library number Low
0mmmmmmm mm
linked library (ASCII CODE) *1 See 4.5.10
0mmmmmmm mm
linked library (ASCII CODE) *1
0mmmmmmm mm
linked library (ASCII CODE) *1
0mmmmmmm mm
linked library (ASCII CODE) *1
0mmmmmmm mm
linked library (ASCII CODE) *1
0mmmmmmm mm
linked library (ASCII CODE) *1
0mmmmmmm mm
linked library (ASCII CODE) *1
0mmmmmmm mm
linked library (ASCII CODE) *1
EOX 11110111 F7
End of exclusive
*1 If this portion does not exist, it is assumed that all information for the
specified library and number is being requested.
MODULE NAME number
SCENE LIB "SCENE___" 0-500,512 (0:response only)
MODULE NAME number
INPATCH LIB "INPATCH_" 0- 99
OUTPATCH LIB "OUTPATCH" 0- 99
HA LIB "HA______" 0-199
STATUS 11110000 F0
System exclusive message
ID No. 01000011 43
Manufacture’s ID number (YAMAHA)
SUB STATUS 0001nnnn 1n
n=0-15 (Device number=MIDI Channel)
GROUP ID 00111110 3E
Digital mixer
MODEL ID 00001111 0F
PM5D
DATA
CATEGORY
00000000 00
OTHER DATA
FUNCTION
NAME
01001101 "M"
01101111 "o"
01100100 "d"
01000110 "F"
01111000 "x"
01010100 "T"
01110010 "r"
01100111 "g"
MODULE NAME 0mmmmmmm mm
(ASCII CODE) See 4.6.2
0mmmmmmm mm
(ASCII CODE)
0mmmmmmm mm
(ASCII CODE)
0mmmmmmm mm
(ASCII CODE)
0mmmmmmm mm
(ASCII CODE)
0mmmmmmm mm
(ASCII CODE)
0mmmmmmm mm
(ASCII CODE)
0mmmmmmm mm
(ASCII CODE)
DATA 0eeeeeee ee
Effect number (0:Effect1 - 7:Effect8)
0ppppppp pp
Release:0, Press:1
EOX 11110111 F7
End of exclusive
MIDI Data Format
342 PM5D/PM5D-RH Owner’s Manual Reference section
4.6.2 Effect module names
Nothing will happen if the Effect Type is different.
4.7 Level Meter Data – Parameter change –
4.7.1 Format (Parameter change)
Once a Level Meter Request is received to enable transmission, the specified
meter data will be transmitted at 50 msec intervals for a duration of ten seconds.
If you want meter data to be transmitted continuously, you must transmit a
Request at intervals of no longer than ten seconds.
Reception
This message is echoed if [Parameter change ECHO] is ON.
Transmission
Once transmission is enabled by a Request, the meter data specified in the
Address will be transmitted on the [Rx CH] channel at a specific interval for a
specific duration. (The transmission interval and the duration of transmission
will differ between models of device.)
Tr ansmission is disabled when the power is cycled, or when PORT settings are
changed.
If [Parameter change ECHO] is ON, the message is transmitted without change.
4.7.2 Format (Parameter request)
Reception
This message is received if [Parameter change RX] is ON and [Rx CH] matches
the Device number included in the SUB STATUS. This message is echoed if
[Parameter change ECHO] is ON.
When this is received, the meter data specified in the Address is transmitted on
the [Rx CH] channel at a specific interval for a specific duration.
If this is received with an Address UL = 0x7F, transmission of all meter data will
stop (will be disabled) immediately.
Transmission
If [Parameter change ECHO] is ON, the message is transmitted without change.
4.8 Time Counter Data – Time Code –
4.8.1 Format (Parameter change)
When transmission is enabled by receiving a Remote Time Counter request,
Time Counter data is transmitted at 50 ms intervals for a duration of ten
seconds. If you want counter data to be transmitted continuously, you must
transmit a Request at intervals of no longer than ten seconds.
Reception
This message is echoed if [Parameter change ECHO] is ON.
Transmission
When transmission is enabled by a request, Time Counter data is transmitted
for a specific duration.
Tr ansmission is disabled when the power is cycled, or when PORT settings are
changed.
If [Parameter change ECHO] is ON, the message is transmitted without change.
4.8.2 Format (Parameter request)
Reception
This message is received if [Parameter change RX] is ON and [Rx CH] matches
the Device number included in the SUB STATUS. This message is echoed if
[Parameter change ECHO] is ON.
When this message is received, Time Counter data is transmitted on the [Rx
CH] channel for a specific duration.
If a message is received with 0x7F as the second byte of the Address, data
transmission will be stopped (disabled) immediately.
Transmission
If [Parameter change ECHO] is ON, the message is transmitted without change.
MODULE NAME channel
Freeze Play button "FRZPLAY_" 0:Effect1 - 7:Effect8
Freeze Record button "FRZREC__" 0:Effect1 - 7:Effect8
STATUS 11110000 F0
System exclusive message
ID No. 01000011 43
Manufacture’s ID number (YAMAHA)
SUB STATUS 0001nnnn 1n
n=0-15 (Device number=MIDI Channel)
GROUP ID 00111110 3E
Digital mixer
MODEL ID 00001111 0F
PM5D
DATA
CATEGORY
00100001 21
REMOTE LEVEL METER
DATA 0mmmmmmm mm
ADDRESS UL (See 4.7.3)
0mmmmmmm mm
ADDRESS LU
0mmmmmmm mm
ADDRESS LL
0ddddddd dd
Data1 H (See 4.7.5) *1
0ddddddd dd
Data1 L
::
EOX 11110111 F7
End of exclusive
*1 Two types of meter data are provided; data that uses the decay value
of the DSP as-is, and data that is converted via a table according to
the number of segments in the meter display.
STATUS 11110000 F0
System exclusive message
ID No. 01000011 43
Manufacture’s ID number (YAMAHA)
SUB STATUS 0011nnnn 3n
n=0-15 (Device number=MIDI Channel)
GROUP ID 00111110 3E
Digital mixer
MODEL ID 00001111 0F
PM5D
DATA
CATEGORY
00100001 21
REMOTE LEVEL METER
DATA 0mmmmmmm mm
ADDRESS UL (See 4.7.3)
0mmmmmmm mm
ADDRESS LU
0mmmmmmm mm
ADDRESS LL
0ccccccc ch
Request Ch Total Number H
0ccccccc cl
Request Ch Total Number L
EOX 11110111 F7
End of exclusive
STATUS 11110000 F0
System exclusive message
ID No. 01000011 43
Manufacture’s ID number (YAMAHA)
SUB STATUS 0001nnnn 1n
n=0-15 (Device number=MIDI Channel)
GROUP ID 00111110 3E
Digital mixer
MODEL ID 00001111 0F
PM5D
DATA
CATEGORY
00101011 2b
Time Counter TC
DATA 0ddddddd dd
Hour
0ddddddd dd
Minute
0ddddddd dd
Second
0ddddddd dd
Frame
EOX 11110111 F7
End of exclusive
STATUS 11110000 F0
System exclusive message
ID No. 01000011 43
Manufacture’s ID number (YAMAHA)
SUB STATUS 0011nnnn 3n
n=0-15 (Device number=MIDI Channel)
GROUP ID 00111110 3E
Digital mixer
MODEL ID 00001111 0F
PM5D
DATA
CATEGORY
00101011 2b
Time Counter TC
DATA 0ddddddd dd
0: Request transmission
0x7F: Request stop transmission
EOX 11110111 F7
End of exclusive
PM5D/PM5D-RH Owner’s Manual Reference section 343
Information shown
in the display
Function
menu
Global
functions
Output
functions
Input
functions
Appendices
Warning Messages
These are messages displayed in the lower part of the screen. They will disappear after a certain duration has elapsed.
Message Meaning
#xxx of Scene is Empty!
No data has been stored in the scene you attempted to recall, or the data has been damaged so that it
cannot be recalled.
#xxx of Scene is Read Only! You attempted to overwrite (store) a read-only scene.
#xxx of Scene is Protected! You attempted to overwrite (store) a protected scene.
Cannot Undo! You pressed the SCENE MEMORY [UNDO] key when Undo was not available.
Cannot Assign!
You clicked an unavailable (grayed-out) grid in the patch screen, or pressed an invalid key on the panel
(e.g., a DCA/MUTE assign key that is unavailable due to the selected channel).
Cannot Drop! You attempted to drop a EQ/compressor/gate/EQ/effect mini-graph onto a location of a different type.
Pair Made. You used a panel operation to assign channel pairing.
Pair Broken. You used a panel operation to cancel channel pairing.
EFFECT CUE: Turned Off.
CUE was defeated because you switched to another screen from the EQ PARAM or EFFECT ASSIGN
screen, or because you switched the selected effect.
KEY IN CUE: Turned Off.
KEY IN CUE was defeated because you switched from the GATE PRM/COMP PRM screen to a different
screen.
Overwrite Existing Event.
In the EVENT LIST screen you input an event at the same time as a previously-input event, so the exist-
ing event was overwritten.
Event List Full! Last Event cancelled.
In the EVENT LIST screen, the event list is full; the last event in the event list was pushed out and deleted
when you added a new event.
Interval from Previous Event is Too Short!
The event you are attempting to input in the EVENT LIST screen is too close to an existing event earlier
than that location, so it is possible that it may not be recalled at the time you intend.
TIME CODE: Frame Jump!
The time code that was input in the EVENT LIST screen has experienced a frame jump or is running
backward.
TIME CODE: Frame Mismatch!
The incoming time code has a frame rate that is different than the time code specified in the EVENT LIST
screen.
MIDI: Data Framing Error! Invalid signals are being input to the MIDI IN connector.
MIDI: Data Overrun! Invalid signals are being input to the MIDI IN connector.
MIDI: Rx Buffer Full! Too much data is being received at the MIDI IN connector.
MIDI: Tx Buffer Full! Too much data is being sent from the MIDI OUT connector.
USB: Data Framing Error! Invalid signals are being input from the USB connector input port.
USB: Data Overrun! Invalid signals are being input from the USB connector input port.
USB: Rx Buffer Full! Too much data is being received at the USB connector input port.
USB: Tx Buffer Full! Too much data is being sent from the USB connector output port.
SLOT x: Data Framing Error! Invalid signals are being input from the SLOT x input port.
SLOT x: Data Overrun! Invalid signals are being input from the SLOT x input port.
SLOT x: Rx Buffer Full! Too much data is being received at the SLOT x input port.
SLOT x: Tx Buffer Full! Too much data is being sent from the SLOT x output port.
RS422: Data Framing Error! Invalid signals are being received at the HA REMOTE connector or RS422 REMOTE connector.
RS422: Data Overrun! Invalid signals are being received at the HA REMOTE connector or RS422 REMOTE connector.
RS422: Rx Buffer Full! Too much data is being received at the HA REMOTE connector or RS422 REMOTE connector.
RS422: Tx Buffer Full! Too much data is being transmitted from the HA REMOTE connector or RS422 REMOTE connector.
CASCADE: Data Framing Error! Invalid signals are being input to the CASCADE IN/OUT connector.
CASCADE: Data Overrun! Invalid signals are being input to the CASCADE IN/OUT connector.
CASCADE: Rx Buffer Full! Too much data is being received at the CASCADE IN/OUT connector.
CASCADE: Tx Buffer Full! Too much data is being transmitted from the CASCADE IN/OUT connector.
DME Control: Data Framing Error! Invalid signals are being input during communication with the DME.
DME Control: Data Overrun! Invalid signals are being input during communication with the DME.
DME Control: Rx Buffer Full! Too much data is being received during communication with the DME.
DME Control: Tx Buffer Full! Too much data is being transmitted during communication with the DME.
Wrong Word Clock!
The PM5D cannot synchronize because the source selected by MASTER CLOCK SELECT in the WORD
CLOCK screen is not appropriate.
Sync Error! [xxxx] The xxxx signal is not synchronized with the PM5D.
xxxx No Signal Present! The xxxx signal is not being input.
Data Type Conflict! Canceled. You attempted to execute a library recall or channel copy operation on a different type of channel.
HA Type Conflict! Data Ignored. You attempted to recall a HA library of a different model (PM5D model or PM5D-RH model).
Conflicting GPI OUT Cancelled.
The parameter you assigned to the FADER START function or to a User Defined key is the same as an
existing GPI OUT assignment, so the GPI OUT assignment was cancelled.
Conflicting USER DEFINED KEY
Cancelled.
The parameter you assigned to GPI OUT is the same as an existing User Defined key assignment, so the
User Defined key assignment was cancelled.
Conflicting FADER START Cancelled.
The parameter you assigned to GPI OUT is the same as an existing FADER START function, so the FADER
START assignment was cancelled.
Wrong Password! The system password or console password you input was incorrect.
System Password Changed. The system password has been changed.
Console Password Changed. The console password has been changed.
Error Messages
344 PM5D/PM5D-RH Owner’s Manual Reference section
Error Messages
These are messages displayed as popup windows in the center of the screen. After noting the content of the message, click the
OK button in the screen to close the popup window.
Parameter Locked. Parameter Lock has been enabled.
Parameter Unlocked. Parameter Lock has been defeated.
This Parameter is Locked. The parameter you attempted to control is locked.
Channel Copied. The selected channel settings were copied to the memory buffer.
Channel Pasted. The channel settings in the memory buffer were pasted to the selected channel.
Nothing to Paste! Paste cannot be performed because there is no data in the memory buffer.
Cannot Paste to Different Channel Type. Paste cannot be performed because you are attempting to paste channel settings of a different type.
No Card in Slot! No memory card is inserted in the MEMORY CARD slot.
File Already Exist!
The memory card already contain a file/directory with the same name as the one you are attempting to
save, rename, or create.
Saving Aborted. Saving to memory card was aborted.
Loading Aborted. Loading from memory card was aborted.
No Controllable Gain. You attempted to operate a gain knob that is currently disabled on the panel.
Tap Operation Ignored. Tap operation was ignored because the TAP TEMPO button is not displayed in the screen.
Cascade Unit Disconnected. The connection with a cascade-connected external device was broken.
Additional Cascade Unit Detected. A cascade-connected external device was newly detected.
Incorrect Cascade Connection! The connection is not appropriate for the cascade settings.
Couldn’t Store Scene on Slave Console!
The cascade-connected slave console was unable to store the scene because the scene was protected on
the slave console, or for some other reason.
Couldn’t Edit Scene on Slave Console!
The cascade-connected slave console was unable to edit the scene because the scene was protected on
the slave console, or for some other reason.
DME Disconnected. The connection with an external DME was broken.
No Response from External HA. No response from an external AD8HR or AD824.
Processing Aborted. A process was aborted.
Message Meaning
Message Meaning
Cannot Store! Failed to store a scene memory or library.
Cannot Recall! Failed to recall a scene memory or library.
Memory Card Full! You attempted to save a file that was larger than the available capacity of the memory card.
File Not Found! The file/directory does not exist on the memory card.
Couldn’t Read File. Failed to read the file from the memory card.
Couldn’t Write File. Failed to write the file to the memory card.
Couldn’t Delete File. Failed to delete the memory card file.
Couldn’t Open File. Failed to open the file from the memory card.
Couldn’t Close File. Failed to close the file on the memory card.
Unsupported File Format! The file you attempted to load from the memory card is of an unsupported format.
No Files to Upload! Internal memory does not contain files to upload.
Low Battery! The backup battery voltage is low.
Power Supply has Malfunctioned!
A problem has occurred with the PW800W power supply connected to the PM5D. Please contact your
Yamaha dealer.
Total Slot Power Capability Exceeded! The I/O cards installed in the slots exceed the rated power capacity.
PM5D/PM5D-RH Owner’s Manual Reference section 345
Information shown
in the display
Function
menu
Global
functions
Output
functions
Input
functions
Appendices
Troubleshooting
Power does not turn on, panel LEDs
and the LCD display do not light
Are the PM5D and PW800W correctly connected by the special power cable?
Is the PW800W’s POWER switch turned on?
In the UTILITY function PREFERENCE 2 screen, could the LED brightness have been turned down?
( p.188)
If the power still does not turn on, contact your Yamaha dealer.
Sound is not input
Is the optional I/O card installed correctly? ( p.30)
Is a signal being input from the external device?
Is the input port patched to an input channel? ( p.66)
Is the GAIN of the internal head amp or external head amp set to an appropriate level? ( p.36, 206)
Is the EQ attenuator raised? ( p.260)
Could insert be turned on even though it has not been specified correctly? ( p.70)
Is the [ON] key indicator of the input channel lit?
Is the fader of the input channel raised?
In SOLO mode, could the [CUE] key be on for a channel that has no signal? ( p.96)
Is the DCA fader assigned to that channel raised? Could MUTE be turned on? ( p.75)
Sound is not output
Is the optional I/O card installed correctly? ( p.30)
Is the [ON] key indicator of the STEREO A/B channel lit?
Is an output port patched to the output channel? ( p.67)
Could LCR be on, and the CSR value be set to 1.0? ( p.242)
Sound is not output from
headphones or the MONITOR OUT
jacks
Is the MONITOR section [PHONES] knob or [LEVEL] knob set to an appropriate volume?
Sound is not loud enough
Is the GAIN of the internal head amp or external head amp set to an appropriate level? ( p.36, 206)
Is the fader of the input channel raised?
Could the EQ gain be set to an extremely low setting? ( p.65)
Could the GATE/COMP threshold or ratio be set to an extreme setting? ( p.63, 64)
Is the EQ attenuator raised? ( p.260)
Is the fader of the output channel raised?
Try using the various screens of the METER function to check the levels. ( p.209, 210)
Is the DCA fader assigned to that channel raised?
Sound is distorted
Is the word clock set correctly? ( p.31)
Is the GAIN of the internal head amp or external head amp set to an appropriate level? ( p.36, 206)
Could the fader of the input channel be raised too high?
Could the fader of the STEREO A/B channel be raised too high?
Could the EQ gain be set to an extremely high setting? ( p.65)
Sound is output even though it is not
patched to an output channel
Could you have assigned an input channel to direct out? ( p.72)
Could you have assigned an output channel as the insert out? ( p.70)
Paired channels are not heard in
stereo
Are the pan mode setting and pan value correct? ( p.45)
The volume of a specific channel
rises and falls
Could GATE/COMP be set to ducking? ( p.63, 64)
Operating a fader does not control
the level as you expect
Have you used the layer keys ([CH 1-24]/[CH 25-48] keys or [ST IN 1-4]/[FX RTN 1-4] keys) to select the
appropriate layer?
Is the FADER [FLIP] key turned off?
Only the sound of a specific channel
is heard from the MONITOR OUT or
PHONES jack
Could a [CUE] key be on?
Noise occurs from an externally
connected recorder or other device
Is the word clock set correctly? ( p.31)
Could the input signal be unsynchronized?
Is the dither setting appropriate? ( p.207)
Could oscillator or talkback be turned on? ( p.98, 99)
High frequency range is attenuated
Could emphasis be applied? This problem will occur if the input signal status does not match the empha-
sis data. ( p.200, 215)
Could EQ be applied? ( p.65)
An input signal is being input, but
there’s no monitor output
Could the CUE INTERRUPTION button be on? If this button is on, the cue/solo signal will also be output
from the MONITOR OUT jacks while the Cue/Solo function is active. ( p.217)
Some channels are always heard
even in SOLO mode
Could those channels be set to SOLO SAFE? ( p.219, 219)
Not enough headroom, especially
when EQ boost is applied
Use the EQ attenuator function to lower the level. ( p.260)
Sound recorded via a 2TR OUT
DIGITAL jack or a digital I/O card is
gritty
Check that the dither function matches the word length of the recording device. ( p.207)
Signal is delayed Check whether the delay setting for each channel is set correctly. ( p.58)
Turning a MIX encoder does not
change the send level to the MIX bus
Is the [MIX SEND] key turned on?
Is the MIX [ON] key turned on?
Is the MIX bus set to VARI type? ( p.201)
If the send point is set to POST, could the fader have been lowered?
Can’t save scene memory or library
data
Are you attempting to save the data to a read-only scene/library or a protected scene? ( p.159)
Can’t save to a memory card
Is the memory card protected?
Does the memory card have enough free capacity to save the data?
When formatting a memory card, format it in FAT16 format.
Can’t transmit/receive MIDI data
Is the MIDI PORT selected correctly? ( p.113, 115, 117)
Are the mode and channel selected correctly on the transmitting and receiving devices? ( p.113, 115)
Has an event been assigned for the program change? ( p.113)
The [ON] keys or [SEL] keys select
the wrong channels
Have you used the layer keys ([CH 1-24]/[CH 25-48] keys or [ST IN 1-4]/[FX RTN 1-4] keys) to select the
appropriate layer?
General Specifications
346 PM5D/PM5D-RH Owner’s Manual Reference section
General Specifications
You paired input channels, but the
signal phase is incorrect
Set the paired input channels to the same phase setting. Even when channels are paired, the phase set-
tings are not linked. ( p.45)
When you recall a scene, some
channels/parameters are not
updated
Could those channels/parameters be set to Recall Safe or Selective Recall? ( p.84, 86)
You turn on a CUE button in the
EFFECT PARAM screen, but it is
automatically defeated
This is defeated automatically when you switch screens in the display. ( p.152)
Can’t make boost settings with the
GEQ
In the GEQ PARAM screen, could LIMIT be set to –24 dB? ( p.111)
When you recall a scene, it takes a
certain amount of time for the faders
to stop
Could you have specified a fade time? ( p.87)
The panel LEDs or LCD display are
too dark / too bright
In the UTILITY function PREFERENCE 2 screen, use the BRIGHTNESS setting to adjust the brightness.
( p.188)
Sampling Frequency
Internal: 44.1 kHz, 48 kHz, 88.2 kHz, 96 kHz
External: 44.1 kHz (–10%) to 48 kHz (+6%)
88.2 kHz (–10%) to 96 kHz (+6%)
Signal Delay
PM5D: Less than 2.3 ms INPUT to STEREO A,B (@Fs = 48 kHz)
Less than 1.15 ms INPUT to STEREO A,B (@Fs = 96 kHz)
PM5D-RH: Less than 2.5 ms INPUT to STEREO A,B (@Fs = 48 kHz)
Less than 1.25 ms INPUT to STEREO A,B (@Fs = 96 kHz)
Fader 100mm motorized x38
Fader Resolution +10 to –138, – dB (1024 steps/100 mm)
Maximum Voltage Gain
PM5D: 84 dB INPUT1-48 to Each Output
PM5D-RH: 86 dB INPUT1-48 to Each Output
Crosstalk (@1kHz) –80 dB Adjacent Input Channels (INPUT1-48)
Dimensions 1551 x 950 x 283 mm (W x D x H)
Net Weight
PM5D: 98 kg
PM5D-RH: 97 kg
Power Requirements
PM5D: 480W, DC 24V, 20A (Use PW800W Only)
PM5D-RH: 528W, DC 24V, 22A (Use PW800W Only)
Operation free-air Temperature Range +10 °C to +35 °C
Storage Temperature Range –20 °C to +60 °C
Included Accessories
Owner’s Manual
Gooseneck Lamps x 3
Power Supply PW800W Connection Cable
Studio Manager CD-ROM
Studio Manager Installation Guide
Optional Accessories
mini YGDAI cards
Power Supply PW800W
Power Supply Link Cable PSL120
PM5D/PM5D-RH Owner’s Manual Reference section 347
Information shown
in the display
Function
menu
Global
functions
Output
functions
Input
functions
Appendices
Analog Input (1-48)
Analog Input (ST IN1-4 [L,R])
Analog Input (2TR IN ANALOG1,2 [L,R])
Digital Input (2TR IN DIGITAL1-3)
Talkback Input
Oscillator
STEREO A,B [L,R], MIX1-24, MATRIX1-8
MONITOR OUT [L,C,R], CUE OUT
PHONES (x2)
Digital Output (2TR OUT DIGITAL1-3)
Connector XLR-3-31 Type (Balanced) x48
Phantom Power
PM5D: +48V DC is supplied to Input by individual mechanical switch
PM5D-RH: +48V DC is supplied to Input by individual software control
Pad Switch PM5D: 0/26 dB attenuation
Gain Control
PM5D: 44 dB detented
–60 dB to –16 dB (PAD=OFF), –34 to +10 dB (PAD=ON)
PM5D-RH: 72 dB by software control
–62 dB to 10 dB (1 dB step)
Peak Indicator Red LED is lit when post HA level reaches 3 dB below clipping
Signal Indicator Green LED is lit when post HA level reaches 14 dB below nominal
Insert (Pre AD converter) PM5D: Out, In (TRS Balanced)
Insert Switch PM5D: On/Off
AD Converter 24bit linear, 128 times oversampling
Connector XLR-3-31 Type (Balanced) x8
Phantom Power PM5D-RH: +48V DC is supplied to Input by individual software control
Gain Control
PM5D: 44 dB detented
–34 dB to +10 dB
PM5D-RH: 72 dB by software control
–62 dB to +10 dB (1 dB step)
Peak Indicator Red LED is lit when post HA level reaches 3 dB below clipping
Signal Indicator Green LED is lit when post HA level reaches 14 dB below nominal
AD Converter 24bit linear, 128 times oversampling
Connector XLR-3-31 Type (Balanced) x4
Gain Switch +24 dBu (default) / +18 dBu
AD Converter 24bit linear, 128 times oversampling
Connector
AES/EBU XLR-3-31 Type (Balanced) x2 (DIGITAL
IN 1,2)
SPDIF RCA PIN (DIGITAL IN 3)
Sampling Rate
Converter
On/Off by software control (1:3 and 3:1 maxi-
mum input to output sample rate ratio)
Connector XLR-3-31 Type (Balanced)
Phantom Power +48V DC is supplied by software control
Gain 50 dB fixed (pre level control)
AD Converter 24bit linear, 128 times oversampling
Talkback Select
TALKBACK IN and selected INPUT1-48 can be
used simultaneously
Level 0 to –96dB (1dB step)
On/Off Dedicated switch and software control
Waveform
MODE: Sine Wave 1ch, Sine Wave 2ch, Pink
Noise, Burst Noise
Sine Waveform: 100Hz, 1kHz, 10kHz
Routing MIX1-24, MATRIX1-8, STEREO A,B (L,R)
Connector XLR-3-32 Type (Balanced)
DA Converter 24bit linear, 128 times oversampling
Connector XLR-3-32 Type (Balanced)
DA Converter 24bit linear, 128 times oversampling
Level Control Analog potentiometer
Connector TRS
Level Control Analog potentiometer
Connector
AES/EBU XLR-3-32 Type (Balanced) x2 (DIGITAL
OUT 1,2)
SPDIF RCA PIN (DIGITAL OUT 3)
Sampling Rate
Converter
On/Off by software control (1:3 and 3:1 maxi-
mum input to output sample rate ratio)
Input/output characteristics
348 PM5D/PM5D-RH Owner’s Manual Reference section
Input/output characteristics
Analog Input Characteristics (PM5D)
Analog Input Characteristics (PM5D-RH)
*1. Sensitivity is the lowest level that will produce an output of +4 dBu (1.23 V) or the nominal output level when the unit is set to maximum gain. (All faders
and level controls are maximum position.)
*2. XLR-3-31 type connectors are balanced. (1=GND, 2=HOT, 3=COLD)
*3. Phone jacks are balanced. (Tip=HOT, Ring=COLD, Sleeve=GND )
*4. There are switches inside the body to preset the maximum input level.
* In these specifications, 0 dBu = 0.775 Vrms.
* All input AD converters are 24bit linear, 128 times (@48 kHz) oversampling.
* PM5D: +48V DC (phantom power) is supplied to INPUT (1-48) XLR type connectors via each individual switch, and TALKBACK XLR type connectors
via software switch.
PM5D-RH: +48V DC (phantom power) is supplied to INPUT (1-48) and TALKBACK XLR type connectors via master mechanical switch and each individ-
ual software switch.
Input Terminals PAD GAIN
Actual Load
Impedance
For Use With
Nominal
GAIN SW
*4
Input Level
Connector
Sensitivity
*1
Nominal
Max. Before
Clip
INPUT 1-48
0
–60dB
3k
50-600 Mics
&
600 Lines
–80 dBu
(0.0775 mV)
–60 dBu
(0.775 mV)
–40 dBu
(7.75 mV)
XLR-3-31 Type
(Balanced)
*2
–16dB
–36 dBu
(12.3 mV)
–16 dBu
(123 mV)
+4 dBu
(1.23 V)
26
–10 dBu
(245 mV)
+10 dBu
(2.45 V)
+30 dBu
(24.51 V)
ST IN1-4 [L,R]
–34dB
4k 600 Lines
–54 dBu
(1.55 mV)
–34 dBu
(15.5 mV)
–14 dBu
(155 mV)
XLR-3-31 Type
(Balanced)
*2
10dB
–10 dBu
(245 mV)
+10 dBu
(2.54 V)
+30 dBu
(24.51 V)
INSERT IN 1-48 10k 600 Lines
–16 dBu
(123 mV)
+4 dBu
(1.23 V)
+24 dBu
(12.28 V)
Phone Jack (TRS)
(Balanced)
*3
2TR IN ANALOG
1,2 [L,R]
10k 600 Lines
+24 dB
(default)
–6 dBu
(388 mV)
+4 dBu
(1.23 V)
+24 dBu
(12.28 V)
XLR-3-31 Type
(Balanced)
*2
+18 dB
–12 dBu
(195 mV)
–2 dBu
(0.616 V)
+18 dBu
(6.16 V)
TALKBACK 3k
50-600 Mics
&
600 Lines
–60 dBu
(0.775 mV)
–50 dBu
(2.45 mV)
–30 dBu
(24.5 mV)
XLR-3-31 Type
(Balanced)
*2
Input Terminals GAIN
Actual Load
Impedance
For Use With
Nominal
GAIN SW *4
Input Level
Connector
Sensitivity *1 Nominal
Max. Before
Clip
INPUT 1-48
–62dB
3k
50-600 Mics
&
600 Lines
–82 dBu
(61.6 µV)
–62 dBu
(0.616 mV)
–42 dBu
(6.16 mV)
XLR-3-31 Type
(Balanced)
*2
+10dB
–10 dBu
(245 mV)
+10 dBu
(2.45 V)
+30 dBu
(24.5 V)
ST IN1-4 [L,R]
–62dB
3k
50-600 Mics
&
600 Lines
–82dBu
(61.6 µV)
–62 dBu
(0.616 mV)
–42 dBu
(6.16 mV)
XLR-3-31 Type
(Balanced)
*2
+10dB
–10 dBu
(245 mV)
+10 dBu
(2.45 V)
+30 dBu
(24.5 V)
2TR IN ANALOG
1,2 [L,R]
10k 600 Lines
+24 dB
(default)
–6 dBu
(388 mV)
+4 dBu
(1.23 V)
+24 dBu
(12.28 V)
XLR-3-31 Type
(Balanced)
*2
+18 dB
–12 dBu
(195 mV)
–2 dBu
(0.616 V)
+18 dBu
(6.16 V)
TALKBACK 3k
50-600 Mics
&
600 Lines
–60 dBu
(0.775 mV)
–50 dBu
(2.45 mV)
–30 dBu
(24.5 mV)
XLR-3-31 Type
(Balanced)
*2
PM5D/PM5D-RH Owner’s Manual Reference section 349
Information shown
in the display
Function
menu
Global
functions
Output
functions
Input
functions
Appendices
Analog Output Characteristics
*1. XLR-3-32 type connectors are balanced. (1=GND, 2=HOT, 3=COLD)
*2. Phone jacks are balanced. (Tip=HOT, Ring=COLD, Sleeve=GND)
*3. PHONES stereo phone jacks are unbalanced. (Tip=LEFT, Ring=RIGHT, Sleeve=GND)
*4. There are switches inside the body to preset the maximum output level.
*5. INSERT OUTs are only provided for PM5D.
*6. The position of the level control is 10 dB lowered from Max.
* In these specifications, 0 dBu = 0.775 Vrms.
* All output DA converters are 24bit, 128 times (@48 kHz) oversampling.
Digital Input Characteristics
Digital Output Characteristics
*1. The channel status of 2TR OUT DIGITAL 1,2 is described on page 350.
*2. The channel status of 2TR OUT DIGITAL 3 is described on page 350.
*3. Dither: word length 16/20/24 bit
*4. XLR-3-32 type connectors are balanced. (1=GND, 2=HOT, 3=COLD)
Output
Terminals
Actual Source
Impedance
For Use With
Nominal
GAIN SW
*4
Output Level
Connector
Nominal Max. Before Clip
STEREO A,B [L,R] 150 600 Lines
+24 dB (default) +4 dBu (1.23 V) +24 dBu (12.28 V)
XLR-3-32 Type
(Balanced)
*1
+18 dB –2 dBu (616 mV) +18 dBu (6.16 V)
MONITOR OUT
[L,R,C]
150 600 Lines
+24 dB (default) +4 dBu (1.23 V) +24 dBu (12.28 V)
XLR-3-32 Type
(Balanced)
*1
+18 dB –2 dBu (616 mV) +18 dBu (6.16 V)
CUE OUT [L,R] 150 600 Lines
+24 dB (default) +4 dBu (1.23 V) +24 dBu (12.28 V)
XLR-3-32 Type
(Balanced)
*1
+18 dB –2 dBu (616 mV) +18 dBu (6.16 V)
MATRIX OUT 1-8 150 600 Lines
+24 dB (default) +4 dBu (1.23 V) +24 dBu (12.28 V)
XLR-3-32 Type
(Balanced)
*1
+18 dB –2 dBu (616 mV) +18 dBu (6.16 V)
MIX OUT 1-24 150 600 Lines
+24 dB (default) +4 dBu (1.23 V) +24 dBu (12.28 V)
XLR-3-32 Type
(Balanced)
*1
+18 dB –2 dBu (616 mV) +18 dBu (6.16 V)
INSERT OUT 1-48 150 10k Lines +4 dBu (1.23 V) +24 dBu (12.28 V)
Phone Jack (TRS)
(Balanced)
*2 *5
PHONES (x 2) 15
8 Phones
75 mW
*6
150 mW
Stereo Phone Jack
(TRS) (Unbalanced)
*3
40 Phones
65 mW
*6
150 mW
Terminal Format Data Length Level Connector
2TR IN DIGITAL
1 AES/EBU AES/EBU 24bit RS422
XLR-3-31 Type (Balanced)
*1
*1. XLR-3-31 type connectors are balanced. (1=GND, 2=HOT, 3=COLD)
2 AES/EBU AES/EBU 24bit RS422
XLR-3-31 Type (Balanced)
*1
3 COAXIAL IEC-60958 24bit 0.5Vpp/75 RCA Pin Jack
CASCADE IN RS422 D-Sub Half Pitch Connector 68P (Female)
Terminal Format Data Length Level Connector
2TR OUT DIGITAL
1 AES/EBU
AES/EBU
*1
Professional Use
24bit
*3
RS422
XLR-3-32 Type (Balanced)
*4
2 AES/EBU
AES/EBU
*1
Professional Use
24bit
*3
RS422
XLR-3-32 Type (Balanced)
*4
3 COAXIAL
IEC-60958
*2
Consumer Use
24bit
*3
0.5Vpp/75 RCA Pin Jack
CASCADE OUT RS422 D-Sub Half Pitch Connector 68P (Female)
Input/output characteristics
350 PM5D/PM5D-RH Owner’s Manual Reference section
Channel Status of 2TR OUT DIGITAL 1,2
Channel Status of 2TR OUT DIGITAL 3
byte bit field name fixed/variable data description
0
0 Block Format
fixed
1 professional use
1 Mode 0 audio
2-4 Emphasis 0x4 off
5 Fs Lock 0 lock
6-7 Sampling Frequency variable
0x0 others
0x3 32kHz
0x2 44.1kHz
0x1 48kHz
1
0-3 Channel Mode
fixed
0x1 2ch mode
4-7 Users Bit Management 0x0
2
0-2 Use of AUX
fixed
0x1 24bits Audio Data
3-7 Source 0x00
3 0-7 Multi Channel fixed 0x00
4
0-1 Digital Audio Reference Signal
fixed
0x0
2— 0
3-6 Sampling Frequency variable
0x0 others
0x5 88.2kHz
0x4 96kHz
7 Sampling Frequency Scan Flag fixed 0
byte bit field name fixed/variable data description
0
0 Block Format
fixed
0
consumer use
1 Mode audio
2 Copy 1 enabled
3 Emphasis
0
off
4
——
5
6
7
1 0-7 Category Code fixed 0x49 Digital Mixer (L=1:original)
2
0-3 Source Number
fixed 0x0
4-7 Channel Number
3
0-3 Sampling Frequency variable
0xC 32kHz
0x0 44.1kHz
0x4 48kHz
0x8
0x1 88.2kHz
0x5 96kHz
4-5 Fs Accuracy
fixed
0x0 Level II
6
—0
7
40Maximum Audio Sample word length fixed 1 24bits
1-3 Sample Word Length fixed 0x5 24bits
4-7 Original Sampling Frequency variable
0x3 32kHz
0xF 44.1kHz
0xB 48kHz
0x0
0xE 88.2kHz
0xA 96kHz
PM5D/PM5D-RH Owner’s Manual Reference section 351
Information shown
in the display
Function
menu
Global
functions
Output
functions
Input
functions
Appendices
Control I/O Characteristics
*1. XLR-3-31 type connectors are balanced. (1/Sleeve=GND, 2/Tip=HOT, 3/Ring=COLD)
*2. 4pin=HOT, 3pin=COLD, Lamp rating 5 W, Voltage control by variable volume
*3. Inputs: 4 channels, Outputs: 12 channels
Input Pin: AD Converter (7bit, 128steps, Voltage Detection Range: 0-5V, Maximum Rating: 5V)
Output Pin: Open Collector (Vmax=12V, Imax/pin=75 mA, GPO1-8: Total Imax=300 mA, GPO9-12: Total Imax=300 mA)
Power Pin: Power Supply (Vp=5V, Imax/2 pin=500 mA)
SLOT 1-4 Characteristics
Terminal Format Level Connector
TO HOST USB USB 1.1
B Type USB Connector
MIDI
IN
MIDI DIN Connector 5PTHRU
OUT
TIME CODE IN SMPTE SMPTE 0.3Vpp(Min)/10.0Vpp(Max), 10k
XLR-3-31 Type (Balanced)
*1
WORD CLOCK
IN
TTL/75 (ON/OFF)
BNC Connector
OUT TTL/75
GPI
D-Sub Connector 25P (Female)
*3
HA REMOTE
RS422
D-Sub Connector 9P (Male)
RS422 REMOTE D-Sub Connector 9P (Female)
KEYBOARD
PS/2 DIN Connector 6P
MOUSE
LAMP 1,2,3
2.5V - 11.5V
XLR-4-31 Type
*2
MEMORY CARD PCMCIA (Compact Flash)
Card Name Function Input Output
The Number Of
Usable Cards
MY8-AT ADAT
8 IN 8 OUT
4
MY8-TD TASCAM
MY8-AE AES/EBU
MY4-AD
ANALOG IN
4 IN
MY8-AD 8 IN
MY4-DA ANALOG OUT 4 OUT
MY8-AD24
ANALOG IN 8 IN
MY8-AD96
MY8-DA96 ANALOG OUT
8 OUTMY8-AE96S
AES/EBU 8 IN
MY8-AE96
MY16-AT ADAT
16 IN 16 OUTMY16-AE AES/EBU
MY16-TD TASCAM
MY16-C CobraNet ™ 16 IN 16 OUT
Electrical characteristics
352 PM5D/PM5D-RH Owner’s Manual Reference section
Electrical characteristics
All faders are nominal when measured. Output impedance of signal generator:150ohms
Frequency Response Fs= 44.1 kHz or 48 kHz @20 Hz–20 kHz, referenced to the nominal output level @1 kHz
Fs= 88.2 kHz or 96 kHz @20 Hz–40 kHz, referenced to the nominal output level @1 kHz
Gain Error @1 kHz
Total Harmonic Distortion Fs= 44.1 kHz or 48 kHz
* Total Harmonic Distortion is measured with a 18 dB/octave filter @80 kHz
Total Harmonic Distortion Fs=88.2 kHz or 96 kHz
* Total Harmonic Distortion is measured with a 18 dB/octave filter @80 kHz
Input Output RL Conditions Min. Typ. Max. Unit
INPUT 1-48
STEREO A,B
600
PM5D: GAIN: Max., PAD: Off
PM5D-RH: GAIN: Max.
–1.5
0.0 0.5 dB
MIX OUT
MATRIX OUT
MONITOR OUT
CUE OUT
PHONES 8 –3.0
2TR IN ANALOG 1,2
STEREO A,B
600 –1.5
MONITOR OUT
Input Output RL Conditions Min. Typ. Max. Unit
INPUT 1-48 STEREO A,B 600
PM5D: Input Level : –60 dBu, GAIN: Max., PAD: Off
PM5D-RH: Input Level : –62 dBu, GAIN: Max.
2.0 4.0 6.0
dBu
PM5D: Input Level : +10 dBu, GAIN: Min., PAD: On
PM5D-RH: Input Level : +10 dBu, GAIN: Min.
2TR IN ANALOG 1,2 STEREO A,B 600 Input Level: +4 dBu 2.0 4.0 6.0
Internal OSC
STEREO A,B
600
Full Scale Output
23.5 24.0 24.5
MIX OUT
MATRIX OUT
MONITOR OUT Full Scale Output, MONITOR Level Control: Max.
CUE OUT Full Scale Output, CUE Level Control: Max.
PHONES 8 –30 dBFs, PHONES Level Control: Max. –0.5 0 0.5
Input Output RL Conditions Min. Typ. Max. Unit
INPUT 1-48 STEREO A,B 600
PM5D: +4 dBu @20 Hz–20 kHz, GAIN: Max., PAD: Off
PM5D-RH: +4 dBu @20 Hz–20 kHz, GAIN: Max.
0.1
%
PM5D: +4 dBu @20 Hz–20 kHz, GAIN: Min., PAD: On
PM5D-RH: +4 dBu @20 Hz–20 kHz, GAIN: Min.
0.05
2TR IN ANALOG 1,2 STEREO A,B 600 +4 dBu @20 Hz–20 kHz 0.05
Internal OSC
STEREO A,B
600
Full Scale Output @1 kHz
0.02
MIX OUT
MATRIX OUT
MONITOR OUT Full Scale Output @1 kHz, MONITOR Level Control : Max.
CUE OUT Full Scale Output @1 kHz, CUE Level Control: Max.
PHONES 8 Full Scale Output @1kHz, PHONES Level Control: Max. 0.2
Input Output RL Conditions Min. Typ. Max. Unit
INPUT 1-48 STEREO A,B 600
PM5D: +4 dBu @20 Hz–40 kHz, GAIN: Max., PAD: Off
PM5D-RH: +4 dBu @20 Hz–40 kHz, GAIN: Max.
0.1
%
PM5D: +4 dBu @20 Hz–40 kHz, GAIN: Min., PAD: On
PM5D-RH: +4 dBu @20 Hz–40 kHz, GAIN: Min.
0.05
2TR IN ANALOG 1,2 STEREO A,B 600 +4 dBu @20 Hz–40 kHz 0.05
Internal OSC
STEREO A,B
600
Full Scale Output @1 kHz
0.02
MIX OUT
MATRIX OUT
MONITOR OUT Full Scale Output @1 kHz, MONITOR Level Control : Max.
CUE OUT Full Scale Output @1 kHz, CUE Level Control: Max.
PHONES 8 Full Scale Output @1kHz, PHONES Level Control: Max. 0.2
PM5D/PM5D-RH Owner’s Manual Reference section 353
Information shown
in the display
Function
menu
Global
functions
Output
functions
Input
functions
Appendices
Hum & Noise EIN= Equivalent Input Noise
* Hum & Noise is measured with a 6 dB/octave filter @12.7 kHz; equivalent to a 20 kHz filter with infinite dB/octave attenuation.
Dynamic Range
* Dynamic range is measured with a 6 dB/octave filter @12.7 kHz; equivalent to a 20 kHz filter with infinite dB/octave attenuation.
Input Indicator Level
Sampling Frequency
Input Output RL Conditions Min. Typ. Max. Unit
INPUT 1-48
STEREO A,B 600
Master fader at nominal level and one INPUT fader at nomi-
nal level.
–128
EIN
dBu
PM5D: Rs= 150, GAIN: Max., PAD: Off –64
PM5D-RH: Rs= 150, GAIN: Max. –62
Master fader at nominal level and one INPUT fader at nomi-
nal level.
PM5D: Rs= 150, GAIN: Min., PAD: On
PM5D-RH: Rs= 150, GAIN: Min.
–81 –76
All INPUT
Master fader at nominal level and all INPUT1-48 faders at
nominal level.
PM5D: Rs= 150, GAIN: Min., PAD: On
PM5D-RH: Rs= 150, GAIN: Min.
–64
2TR IN ANALOG 1,2 STEREO A,B 600
Master fader at nominal level.
Rs= 150
–81 –76
STEREO A,B
600
Residual Output Noise, ST Master Off
–86
MIX OUT Residual Output Noise, MIX Master Off
MATRIX OUT Residual Output Noise, MATRIX Master Off
MONITOR OUT Residual Output Noise, MONITOR Level Control Min.
CUE OUT Residual Output Noise, CUE Level Control Min.
PHONES 8 Residual Output Noise, PHONES Level Control Min.
Input Output RL Conditions Min. Typ. Max. Unit
INPUT 1-48 STEREO A,B
600
PM5D: AD + DA, GAIN: Min.,
PAD: On
Fs= 44.1/48 kHz 108
dB
PM5D-RH: AD + DA, GAIN: Min. Fs= 88.2/96 kHz 106
STEREO A,B
DA Converter 110
MIX OUT
MATRIX OUT
MONITOR OUT
CUE OUT
Input Output Condition Min. Typ. Max. Unit
INPUT 1-48
INSERT OUT
PEAK Red LED: ON 19 21 23
dBu
SIGNAL Green LED: ON –12 –10 –8
ST IN 1-4
PEAK Red LED: ON 19 21 23
SIGNAL Green LED: ON –12 –10 –8
Parameter Conditions Min. Typ. Max. Unit
External Clock Frequency Range
Normal Rate 39.69 50.88
kHz
Double Rate 79.39 101.76
Internal Clock
Frequency
Word Clock : Int 44.1kHz 44.1
Word Clock : Int 48kHz 48
Word Clock : Int 88.2kHz 88.2
Word Clock : Int 96kHz 96
Accuracy
Word Clock : Int 44.1kHz
50 ppm
Word Clock : Int 48kHz
Word Clock : Int 88.2kHz
Word Clock : Int 96kHz
Jitter
Word Clock : Int 44.1kHz
5ns
Word Clock : Int 48kHz
Word Clock : Int 88.2kHz
Word Clock : Int 96kHz
Other Functions
354 PM5D/PM5D-RH Owner’s Manual Reference section
Other Functions
Libraries
Input Function
Output Function
Processor
Name Number Total
Scene Memory Preset 1 + User 500 501
Input Patch Library Preset 1 + User 99 100
Output Patch Library Preset 1 + User 99 100
Input Channel Library Preset 1 + User 199 200
Output Channel Library Preset 1 + User 199 200
Input EQ Library Preset 40 + User 159 199
Output EQ Library Preset 3 + User 196 199
GATE Library Preset 4 + User 195 199
COMP Library Preset 36 + User 163 199
Effect Library Preset 54 + User 145 199
GEQ Library Preset 1 + User 199 200
HA Library Preset 1 + User 199 200
Function Parameter
Phase Normal/Reverse
MS Decode On, S-Gain
Attenuator –96 to +24 dB
HPF
Slope= 12 dB/Oct
Frequency= 20 Hz to 600 Hz
4Band Equalizer
Frequency= 20 Hz to 20 kHz
Gain= –18 dB to +18 dB
Q= 0.10 to 10.0
Low Shelving (Low Band)
High Shelving, LPF (High Band)
Type I/Type II
Insert Insert Point: Pre EQ/Post EQ/Pre Delay/Post Fader
Direct Out
Direct Out Point: Pre HPF/Pre EQ/Pre Fader/Post
On
Noise Gate
Type: Gate/Ducking
Threshold= –54 dB to 0 dB
Attack= 0 msec to 120 msec
Hold= 0.02 msec to 1.96 sec
Decay= 5 msec to 42.3 sec
Range= –70 dB to 0 dB
Key In: Self Pre EQ/Self Post EQ/Mix21-24/
Ch1-STIN4R (8ch block)
Key In Filter: HPF/LPF/BPF
Compressor
Type: Comp/Expander/Compander H/
Compander S
Threshold= –54 dB to 0 dB
Ratio= 1:1 to :1
Attack= 0 msec to 120 msec
Release= 5 msec to 42.3 sec
Gain= 0 dB to +18 dB
Knee= Hard to 5 (soft)
Input Delay Time= 0.0 msec to 1000 msec
Fader Level: 1024 steps, , –138 dB to +10 dB
On On/Off
DCA Group 8 Groups
Mute Group 8 Groups
Mix Send
24 sends
Fix/Variable can be set each two mixes
Mix Send Point: Pre EQ/Pre Fader/Post On/Post
TO ST
Level: 1024 steps, , –138 dB to +10 dB
LCR Pan CSR= 0% to 100%
Surround Pan 3-1, 5.1, 6.1 panning support
Function Parameter
8Band Equalizer
(Matrix: 4band)
Frequency= 20 Hz to 20 kHz
Gain= –18 dB to +18 dB
Q= 0.10 to 10.0
Low Shelving (Low Band)
High Shelving, LPF (High Band)
Type I/Type II
Insert Insert Point: Pre EQ/Post EQ/Pre Fader/Post On
Compressor
Type: Comp/Expander/Compander H/Com-
pander S
Threshold= –54 dB to 0 dB
Ratio= 1:1 to :1
Attack= 0 msec to 120 msec
Release= 5 msec to 42.3 sec
Gain= 0 dB to +18 dB
Knee= Hard to 5 (soft)
Input Delay Time = 0.0 msec to 1000 msec
Fader Level: 1024 steps, , –138 dB to +10 dB
On On/Off
DCA Group 2 Groups
Mute Group 8 Groups
Mix to Matrix
Stereo to Matrix
Matrix Send Point: Pre Fader/Post Fader/Post On
Level: 1024 steps, , –138 dB to +10 dB
Output Port Att 0 dB to –9 dB
Function Parameter
GEQ 31 bands x 12 systems
Effects Stereo In/Stereo Out multi effector x 8 systems
PM5D/PM5D-RH Owner’s Manual Reference section 355
Information shown
in the display
Function
menu
Global
functions
Output
functions
Input
functions
Appendices
Pin Assignment
CASCADE IN CASCADE OUT
HA REMOTE RS422 REMOTE
2 1334
68 3537 36
Pin Signal Pin Signal
1 GND 35 GND
2 Input 1-2(+) 36 Input 1-2(–)
3 Input 3-4(+) 37 Input 3-4(–)
4 Input 5-6(+) 38 Input 5-6(–)
5 Input 7-8(+) 39 Input 7-8(–)
6 Input 9-10(+) 40 Input 9-10(–)
7 Input 11-12(+) 41 Input 11-12(–)
8 Input 13-14(+) 42 Input 13-14(–)
9 Input 15-16(+) 43 Input 15-16(–)
10 DTR In(+) 44 DTR In(–)
11 RTS Out(+) 45 RTS Out(–)
12 GND 46 GND
13 Word Clock In(+) 47 Word Clock In(–)
14 Word Clock Out(+) 48 Word Clock Out(–)
15 Control In(+) 49 Control In(–)
16 Control Out(+) 50 Control Out(–)
17 GND 51 ID6 In
18 GND 52 ID6 Out
19 Input 17-18(+) 53 Input 17-18(–)
20 Input 19-20(+) 54 Input 19-20(–)
21 Input 21-22(+) 55 Input 21-22(–)
22 Input 23-24(+) 56 Input 23-24(–)
23 Input 25-26(+) 57 Input 25-26(–)
24 Input 27-28(+) 58 Input 27-28(–)
25 Input 29-30(+) 59 Input 29-30(–)
26 Input 31-32(+) 60 Input 31-32(–)
27 ID0 In 61 ID1 In
28 ID2 In 62 ID3 In
29 ID4 In 63 ID5 In
30 ID0 Out 64 ID1 Out
31 ID2 Out 65 ID3 Out
32 ID4 Out 66 ID5 Out
33 MSB In 67 2Ch/Line In
34 FG 68 FG
Pin Signal Pin Signal
1 GND 35 GND
2 Output 1-2(+) 36 Output 1-2(–)
3 Output 3-4(+) 37 Output 3-4(–)
4 Output 5-6(+) 38 Output 5-6(–)
5 Output 7-8(+) 39 Output 7-8(–)
6 Output 9-10(+) 40 Output 9-10(–)
7 Output 11-12(+) 41 Output 11-12(–)
8 Output 13-14(+) 42 Output 13-14(–)
9 Output 15-16(+) 43 Output 15-16(–)
10 DTR Out(+) 44 DTR Out(–)
11 RTS In(+) 45 RTS In(–)
12 GND 46 GND
13 Word Clock Out(+) 47 Word Clock Out(–)
14 Word Clock In(+) 48 Word Clock In(–)
15 Control Out(+) 49 Control Out(–)
16 Control In(+) 50 Control In(–)
17 GND 51 ID6 Out
18 GND 52 ID6 In
19 Output 17-18(+) 53 Output 17-18(–)
20 Output 19-20(+) 54 Output 19-20(–)
21 Output 21-22(+) 55 Output 21-22(–)
22 Output 23-24(+) 56 Output 23-24(–)
23 Output 25-26(+) 57 Output 25-26(–)
24 Output 27-28(+) 58 Output 27-28(–)
25 Output 29-30(+) 59 Output 29-30(–)
26 Output 31-32(+) 60 Output 31-32(–)
27 ID0 Out 61 ID1 Out
28 ID2 Out 62 ID3 Out
29 ID4 Out 63 ID5 Out
30 ID0 In 64 ID1 In
31 ID2 In 65 ID3 In
32 ID4 In 66 ID5 in
33 MSB Out 67 2Ch/Line Out
34 FG 68 FG
5
9
1
6
1
6
5
9
Pin Signal Name Pin Signal Name
1 GND 6 RX+
2 RX– 7 RTS
3 TX– 8 CTS
4 TX+ 9 GND
5 N.C
Pin Signal Name Pin Signal Name
1 GND 6 GND
2 RX– 7 RX+
3 TX+ 8 TX–
4 GND 9 GND
5 N.C
Dimensions
356 PM5D/PM5D-RH Owner’s Manual Reference section
GPI
* For information on maximum permissible current, refer to the
page 351.
DC POWER INPUT
Dimensions
* Specifications and descriptions in this owner's manual are for information purposes only. Yamaha Corp. reserves the right
to change or modify products or specifications at any time without prior notice. Since specifications, equipment or options
may not be the same in every locale, please check with your Yamaha dealer.
European models
Purchaser/User Information specified in EN55103-1 and EN55103-2.
Conforms to Environments: E1, E2, E3 and E4
Pin Signal Name Pin Signal Name
1 GPO1 14 GPO2
2 GPO3 15 GPO4
3 GPO5 16 GPO6
4 GPO7 17 GPO8
5 GND 18 GND
6 GND 19 GND
7 GND 20 GND
8 GND 21 +5V
9 +5V 22 GPI1
10 GPI2 23 GPI3
11 GPI4 24 GPO9
12 GPO10 25 GPO11
13 GPO12
12313
25 1416 15
Pin Signal Name Pin Signal Name
1 +24V 13 GND
2 +24V 14 GND
3 +24V 15 GND
4 +24V 16 GND
5 +24V 17 GND
6 +24V 18 GND
7 +24V 19 CAUTION(+)
8 +24V 20 CAUTION(–)
9 +24V 21 DETECT A
10 GND 22 DETECT B
11 GND 23 DETECT GND
12 GND Frame GND
1
2
3
4
5
6789
10111213
14
15
16
17181920
21
22
23
283
271
260
283
271
260
1551
1450
950
865
1551
1450
950
865
PM5D-RHPM5D
Unit: mm
MIDI Implementation Chart
YAMAHA [Digital Mixing Console] Date: 30-Apr-2004
Model: PM5D/PM5D-RH
MIDI Implementation Chart
Version: 1.0
Function... Transmitted Recognized Remarks
Basic
Channel
Default
Changed
1–16
1–16
1–16
1–16
Memorized
Mode
Default
Messages
Altered
X
X
**************
1, 3
X
X
Memorized
Note
Number
:True Voice
X
**************
0–127
X
Velocity
Note On
Note Off
X
X
O
O
Effect Control
After
Touch
Key’s
Ch’s
X
X
X
X
Pitch Bend X X
Control
Change
0,32
6,38
98,99
1-31,33-98,
102-119
O
O
O
O
O
O
O
O
Bank Select
Data Entry
NRPN LSB,MSB
Assignable Cntrl
Prog
Change :True#
O 0–127
**************
O 0–127
0–500
Assignable
System Exclusive O *1 O *1
System
Common
:Song Pos
:Song Sel
:Tune
X
X
X
X
X
X
System
Real Time
:Clock
:Commands
X
X
O
X
Effect Control
Aux
Messages
:All Sound Off
:Reset All Cntrls
:Local ON/OFF
:All Notes OFF
:Active Sense
:Reset
X
X
X
X
X
X
X
X
X
X
O
O
Notes
*1: Bulk Dump/Request, Parameter Change/Request, and MMC.
For MIDI remote and event, all messages can be
transmitted.
MTC quarter frame message is recognized.
Mode 1: OMNI ON, POLY
Mode 3: OMNI OFF, POLY
Mode 2: OMNI ON, MONO
Mode 4: OMNI OFF, MONO
O: Yes
X: No
Index
358 PM5D/PM5D-RH Owner’s Manual Reference section
Index
Symbols
ø ................................................... 59
ø/ATT 1-48
................................. 262
ø/ATT STIN/FXRTN
................... 262
Numerics
2TR I/O....................................... 215
A
Accessing a screen ......................... 23
AD IN section
............................... 35
Add-On Effects
........................... 109
Adjusting the input gain
(PM5D-RH)
............. 148
Adjusting the output gain
............ 148
ADVANCED mode
.............. 193, 196
Analog audio connections
............. 27
Analog output connections
............ 28
Appendices
.................................. 290
Assign
ASSIGN MODE section
............ 73
Assigning a name
...................... 26
Assigning MIDI messages
....... 117
GEQ ASSIGN
......................... 157
ATTENUATION
........................... 59
AUTO CAPTURE
....................... 162
Auto Store function
....................... 83
B
BASIC mode ........................ 192, 196
Basic operation
.............................. 19
BLANK SKIP
............................... 160
Block Diagram
.......... End of Manual
Boxes
............................................ 19
BPM
........................................... 153
BUSY indicator
........................... 150
Buttons
................................... 19, 25
C
Calibrating the GPI IN ports........ 125
Calibration
.................................. 147
Cascade
....................................... 204
BI-DIRECTION
..................... 203
Cascade connections
............... 143
CASCADE IN PORT SELECT
202
Cascade master
....................... 143
CASCADE MODE
................. 203
CASCADE OUT PORT
SOURCE SELECT
.... 203
Cascade slave
.......................... 144
Source when cascade connected
................................. 202
CASCADE FROM
....................... 205
CASCADE/Fs
.............................. 149
CH 1-12
...................................... 267
CH 1-24
............................... 258, 270
CH 1-24 layer
................................ 37
CH 13-24
.................................... 267
CH 25-36
.................................... 267
CH 25-48
.................................... 270
CH 25-48 layer
.............................. 37
CH 37-48
.................................... 267
CH COPY
............................ 249, 289
CH to MIX
........................... 104, 274
CH VIEW
............................ 245, 286
Channel Library List
.................... 334
Channel parameter behavior when
paired
....................... 335
CHANNEL SELECT
...................... 58
Channel strip
...................... 37, 39, 53
INPUT channel
........................ 37
ST IN/FX RTN channel
............ 39
STEREO A/B channel
............... 53
Channel structure
.......................... 12
Character palette
........................... 19
COMP LIBRARY
........... 63, 232, 269
COMP LINK ASSIGN
.... 77, 237, 273
COMP PARAM
.................... 229, 266
Compressor
........................... 60, 102
Operations
............................... 63
Compressor Library List
.............. 292
Compressor Link
........................... 77
Connecting to a computer
........... 146
Connections
.................................. 27
Analog audio connections
......... 27
Analog output connections
....... 28
Digital input/output connections
................................... 29
Console Lock
............................... 142
Control change parameter assign-
ments
........................ 314
Control changes
.......................... 115
CSV EXPORT mode
.................... 193
CSV IMPORT mode
................... 197
Cue
............................................... 91
Cue function
............................ 96
CUE mode
............................... 94
CUE section
....................... 91, 94
Cue/Solo functions
................... 94
Solo function
............................ 96
CUE FUNCTION
........................ 218
CUE/SOLO
................................. 217
CUE FUNCTION
................... 218
INPUT SOLO SAFE
............... 219
OUTPUT SOLO SAFE
........... 219
SOLO ON/OFF
...................... 217
Cursor
..................................... 19, 23
D
Daisy-chain connections................ 31
Data Entry
..................................... 20
DCA
.............................................. 73
DCA CUE indicator
.................... 150
DCA GROUP ASSIGN
......... 234, 271
DCA Groups
........................... 73, 74
DELAY
.......................................... 58
Digital input/output connections
... 29
Dimensions
................................. 356
DIMM indicator
.......................... 150
DIRECT OUT PATCH
.......... 72, 253
DIRECT RECALL
........................ 151
DIRECT RECALL ASSIGN
.......... 161
Direct Recall function
.................... 83
Directly outputting
........................ 72
DISPLAY ACCESS
.................. 20, 23
DISPLAY ACCESS section
........... 151
Distribution box
............................ 31
DITHER
...................................... 207
Divergence
.................................. 136
DME CONTROL
........................ 182
Drag and drop
............................... 22
Dynamics Parameters
.................. 294
E
Effect Library
Program Change Table
........... 308
Effects
......................................... 103
Add-On Effects
....................... 109
Basic operations
...................... 106
Editing
................................... 106
EFFECT ASSIGN
.................... 154
EFFECT CUE indicator
.......... 150
EFFECT functions
.................. 152
EFFECT LIBRARY
.................. 155
Effect Library List
................... 297
EFFECT PARAM
.......... 104, 105, 106, 152
Effects Parameters
.................. 298
Freeze effect
............................ 109
Inserting into a channel
.......... 105
Recalling
................................. 106
Storing
................................... 107
Tap Tempo function
............... 108
Using via a MIX bus
............... 104
Effects and tempo synchronization
................................. 307
Electrical characteristics
............... 352
Encoder function
........................... 41
Encoder mode
............................. 150
EQ (Equalizer)
...................... 61, 261
Operations
............................... 65
EQ Library List
............................ 290
EQ Link
......................................... 77
EQ LINK ASSIGN
.......... 77, 236, 272
EQ PARAM
......................... 225, 260
EQ STIN/FXRTN
........................ 261
Error Messages
............................ 344
EVENT indicator
......................... 150
EVENT LIST
............................... 161
AUTO CAPTURE
.................. 162
DISABLE
........................ 149, 161
ENABLE
......................... 149, 161
EVENT RECALL
.................... 162
EVENT TRIGGER
.................. 162
PM5D/PM5D-RH Owner’s Manual Reference section 359
Information shown
in the display
Function
menu
Global
functions
Output
functions
Input
functions
Appendices
MOVE DOWN ...................... 163
MOVE UP
............................. 162
Events
.................................. 113, 115
Exchanging the fader and encoder
functions
.................... 41
EXTERNAL CUE indicator
......... 150
External user interface
................... 21
F
Fade function................................ 87
FADE TIME
........................... 87, 167
FADER ASSIGN
.......................... 197
Fader Assign function
.................. 139
Fader calibration
......................... 147
FADER FLIP/ENCODER MODE
section
........................ 40
FADER MODE
.................... 150, 151
FADER MODE section
................ 139
FADER START
........................... 179
FADER VIEW
...................... 249, 288
Faders
...................................... 19, 25
FADING indicator
...................... 150
Features
........................................ 10
FIX ASSIGN VIEW
..................... 282
FIXED type MIX bus
..................... 44
FRAME RATE
............................. 163
Freeze effect
................................ 109
Front panel
................................... 18
Function Name
........................... 149
Function parameters
................... 150
FX RTN channels 1–4
.................... 34
FX RTN layer
......................... 39, 151
G
Gain.............................................. 59
Adjusting
............................... 148
Gain reduction
....................... 102
Gate
............................................ 102
Operations
............................... 64
GATE LIBRARY
..................... 64, 268
GATE Library List
....................... 291
GATE PARAM
............................ 264
GEQ
GEQ ASSIGN
......................... 157
GEQ function
......................... 156
GEQ LIBRARY
....................... 158
GEQ PARAM
.................. 110, 156
Global
............................ 20, 151, 152
EFFECT functions
.................. 152
GEQ function
......................... 156
METER function
.................... 209
MIDI REMOTE function
....... 171
MON/CUE function
.............. 212
SCENE function
..................... 159
SYS/W.CLOCK function
........ 199
UTILITY function
.................. 186
GLOBAL PASTE
.................... 89, 170
Global Paste function
.................... 89
GPI
............................................. 177
Calibrating
............................. 125
General Purpose Interface
...... 123
GPI IN
................................... 123
GPI IN MONITOR
................ 178
GPI indicator
......................... 150
GPI OUT
........................ 126, 178
TALLY
............................ 127, 179
USER DEFINED KEYS
........... 127
Graphic EQ
................................. 110
Patching
................................. 110
Group
........................................... 57
Cue and Solo
............................ 95
Grouping
...................................... 73
ASSIGN MODE section
............ 73
DCA
......................................... 73
H
HA (Head Amp) .................... 36, 206
HA indicator
............................... 150
HA LIBRARY
............... 208, 225, 260
HORIZONTAL PAIR
............. 45, 200
HPF (High Pass Filter)
.................. 61
Operations
............................... 65
I
I/O card ........................................ 29
Indicator
..................................... 150
Initializing
................................... 147
Input
.............................. 20, 151, 252
ø/ATT 1-48
............................ 262
ø/ATT STIN/FXRTN
.............. 262
ø/EQ function
........................ 260
CH 1-12
................................. 267
CH 1-24
.......................... 258, 270
CH 13-24
............................... 267
CH 25-36
............................... 267
CH 25-48
............................... 270
CH 37-48
............................... 267
CH COPY
.............................. 289
CH LIBRARY
......................... 289
CH to MIX
............................. 274
CH VIEW
.............................. 286
COMP LIBRARY
................... 269
COMP LINK ASSIGN
............ 273
COMP PARAM
...................... 266
DCA GROUP ASSIGN
........... 271
DCA/GROUP function
.......... 271
DELAY function
..................... 270
DIRECT OUT PATCH
........... 253
EQ
......................................... 261
EQ LIBRARY
......................... 263
EQ LINK ASSIGN
.................. 272
EQ PARAM
............................ 260
EQ STIN/FXRTN
................... 261
FADER VIEW
........................ 288
FIX ASSIGN VIEW
................ 282
GATE LIBRARY
..................... 268
GATE PARAM
....................... 264
GATE/COMP function
........... 264
HA LIBRARY
......................... 260
HA/INSERT function
............. 258
INSERT
.................................. 259
INSERT PATCH
.................... 254
INSERT STIN
........................ 259
INSERT/DIRECT OUT POINT
................................. 256
LCR
....................................... 283
M/S
........................................ 285
MIX SEND VIEW
.................. 280
MUTE GROUP ASSIGN
........ 272
NAME
.................................... 257
PAN/ROUTING function
....... 274
PATCH
.................................. 252
PATCH function
.................... 252
PATCH LIBRARY
.................. 257
SIGNAL FLOW
...................... 287
ST IN
.............................. 267, 270
STIN/FXRTN
......................... 258
SURR PARAM
....................... 283
SURR VIEW
........................... 285
VIEW function
....................... 286
Input a character
........................... 26
Assigning a name
...................... 26
INPUT CH layer
......................... 151
Input channel
....... 12, 33, 258, 267, 270
AD IN section
........................... 35
Channel strip
...................... 37, 39
FADER FLIP/ENCODER MODE
section
........................ 40
FX RTN channels 1–4
............... 34
Input channels 1–48
................. 33
ST IN channels 1–4
................... 33
INPUT CUE indicator
................. 150
INPUT DCA/GROUP function
... 271
COMP LINK ASSIGN
............ 273
DCA GROUP ASSIGN
........... 271
EQ LINK ASSIGN
.................. 272
MUTE GROUP ASSIGN
........ 272
INPUT DELAY function
............. 270
Input Gain Reduction
.................. 211
INPUT GATE/COMP function
... 264
COMP LIBRARY
.................... 269
COMP PARAM
...................... 266
GATE LIBRARY
..................... 268
GATE PARAM
....................... 264
Input channel
......................... 267
ST IN
..................................... 267
INPUT GR
........................... 102, 211
INPUT HA/INSERT function
...... 258
CH 1-24
................................. 258
HA LIBRARY
......................... 260
Input channel
......................... 258
INSERT
.................................. 259
STIN/FXRTN
......................... 258
INPUT METER
........................... 209
INPUT ø/EQ function
................. 260
ø/ATT 1-48
............................ 262
ø/ATT STIN/FXRTN
.............. 262
EQ
......................................... 261
EQ PARAM
............................ 260
EQ STIN/FXRTN
................... 261
INPUT EQ LIBRARY
............. 263
Input patch
................................... 66
INPUT PATCH function
............. 252
DIRECT OUT PATCH
........... 253
INPUT PATCH LIBRARY
...... 257
INSERT PATCH
.................... 254
INSERT/DIRECT OUT POINT
................................. 256
NAME
.................................... 257
INPUT SOLO SAFE
.................... 219
Index
360 PM5D/PM5D-RH Owner’s Manual Reference section
INPUT VIEW function ............... 286
CH COPY
.............................. 289
CH VIEW
.............................. 286
FADER VIEW
........................ 288
INPUT CH LIBRARY
............. 289
SIGNAL FLOW
...................... 287
Input/output characteristics
......... 348
INSERT
....................................... 259
INSERT IN MIX 1-24
.................. 224
INSERT PATCH
............ 70, 221, 254
INSERT POINT
.......................... 222
INSERT STIN
............................. 259
INSERT/DIRECT OUT POINT
.............. 70, 72, 105, 256
Inserting
External device
......................... 69
Internal effect into a channel
... 105
Insert-out and insert-in
Patching
................................... 70
Internal memory
Initializing
.............................. 147
K
KEY IN CUE indicator ................ 150
Keyboard
...................................... 21
Knobs
..................................... 19, 25
L
LATCH....................................... 176
Layer
....................................... 37, 39
[CH 1-24]/[CH 25-48] keys
...... 37
[ST IN 1-4]/[FX RTN 1-4] keys
39
INPUT CH
............................. 151
ST IN/FX RTN
....................... 151
LCR
..................................... 242, 283
LCR [B] indicator
........................ 150
LCR indicator
.............................. 150
LEARN
....................................... 176
Level Diagram
........... End of Manual
LFE
............................................. 136
Library
COMP LIBRARY
................... 269
EFFECT LIBRARY
................. 155
GATE LIBRARY
..................... 268
GEQ LIBRARY
....................... 158
HA LIBRARY
.................. 225, 260
INPUT CH LIBRARY
............. 289
INPUT EQ LIBRARY
............. 263
INPUT PATCH LIBRARY
...... 257
OUTPUT CH LIBRARY
......... 251
OUTPUT PATCH LIBRARY
.. 223
Linking
......................................... 73
ASSIGN MODE section
............ 73
Compressor Link
...................... 77
EQ Link
.................................... 77
LOAD
......................................... 195
ADVANCED mode
................ 196
BASIC mode
.......................... 196
CSV IMPORT mode
.............. 197
Loading
....................................... 130
M
M/S............................................. 285
Manual organize
............................ 13
MATRIX channels 1–8
.................. 48
MATRIX section
........................... 55
MATRIX/ST function
.................. 238
LCR
........................................ 242
MATRIX/ST ROUTING
......... 238
MIX to MATRIX VIEW
......... 240
SURR SETUP
......................... 244
MATRIX/STEREO
....... 227, 231, 233
Memory cards
............................. 128
METER function
......................... 209
INPUT GR
............................. 211
INPUT METER
...................... 209
OUTPUT GR
......................... 211
OUTPUT METER
.................. 210
Meter section
........................ 100, 150
Meters
......................................... 100
Metering point
....................... 101
MIDI
........................................... 113
Assigning MIDI messages
....... 117
MIDI events
........................... 122
MIDI remote channels
............ 121
MIDI CTRL CHANGE
......... 115, 174
MIDI Data Format
...................... 336
MIDI EVENT
.............................. 159
MIDI Implementation Chart
....... 357
MIDI indicator
............................ 150
MIDI PGM CHANGE
.......... 113, 173
MIDI REMOTE
................... 117, 175
MIDI REMOTE function
............ 171
DME CONTROL
................... 182
FADER START
...................... 179
GPI
........................................ 177
LATCH
.................................. 176
LEARN
................................... 176
MMC
.............................. 180, 181
RS422
.............................. 180, 181
TALLY
................................... 179
TRANSPORT
......................... 181
MIDI SETUP
............................... 171
mini-YGDAI I/O cards
.................. 29
MIX 1-24
..................... 227, 231, 233
MIX channel output signals
........... 52
MIX channels 1–24
........................ 47
MIX section
........................... 49, 150
MIX SEND VIEW
....................... 280
MIX to MATRIX VIEW
.............. 240
MIXER SETUP
...................... 45, 200
PAIR MODE
.......................... 200
MMC
................................... 180, 181
MON/CUE function
.................... 212
2TR I/O
.................................. 215
CUE/SOLO
............................ 217
MONITOR
............................ 216
OSCILLATOR
........................ 213
TALKBACK
........................... 212
Monitor
........................... 91, 93, 216
CUE mode
............................... 94
SOLO mode
............................. 94
MONITOR sections
...................... 91
Mouse
........................................... 21
MOVE DOWN
........................... 163
MOVE UP
................................... 162
MUTE GROUP ASSIGN
..... 235, 272
Mute Groups
........................... 73, 75
MUTE MASTER
......................... 151
N
NAME......................................... 257
NEXT SCENE/NEXT EVENT
..... 149
NOISE GATE
................................ 59
NRPN parameter assignments
..... 331
O
OFFSET TIME ............................ 163
Operating section
.......................... 10
Option card
................................... 30
types of I/O card
....................... 29
OSC indicator
............................. 150
OSCILLATOR
.................. 97, 99, 213
Output
........................... 20, 151, 220
CH COPY
.............................. 249
CH LIBRARY
......................... 251
CH VIEW
............................... 245
COMP function
...................... 229
COMP LIBRARY
.................... 232
COMP LINK ASSIGN
............ 237
COMP PARAM
...................... 229
DCA GROUP ASSIGN
........... 234
DCA/GROUP function
........... 234
DELAY function
..................... 233
EQ function
............................ 225
EQ LIBRARY
.......................... 228
EQ LINK ASSIGN
.................. 236
EQ PARAM
............................ 225
FADER VIEW
........................ 249
HA LIBRARY
......................... 225
INSERT function
.................... 224
INSERT IN MATRIX/STE-
REO/MONITOR
...... 224
INSERT IN MIX 1-24
............. 224
INSERT PATCH
.................... 221
INSERT POINT
..................... 222
LCR
........................................ 242
MATRIX/ST function
............. 238
MATRIX/ST ROUTING
......... 238
MATRIX/STEREO
.................. 227, 231, 233
MIX 1-24
................. 227, 231, 233
MIX to MATRIX VIEW
.......... 240
MUTE GROUP ASSIGN
........ 235
PATCH
.................................. 220
PATCH function
.................... 220
PATCH LIBRARY
.................. 223
SIGNAL FLOW
...................... 247
SURR SETUP
......................... 244
VIEW function
....................... 245
Output channel
....................... 12, 47
Channel strip
............................ 53
MATRIX channels 1–8
............. 48
MATRIX section
....................... 55
MIX channels 1–24
................... 47
MIX section
.............................. 49
STEREO A/B channels
.............. 47
PM5D/PM5D-RH Owner’s Manual Reference section 361
Information shown
in the display
Function
menu
Global
functions
Output
functions
Input
functions
Appendices
OUTPUT COMP function .......... 229
COMP LIBRARY
................... 232
COMP PARAM
..................... 229
MATRIX/STEREO
................. 231
MIX 1-24
............................... 231
OUTPUT CUE indicator
............. 150
OUTPUT DCA/GROUP function
................................. 234
COMP LINK ASSIGN
............ 237
DCA GROUP ASSIGN
........... 234
EQ LINK ASSIGN
.................. 236
MUTE GROUP ASSIGN
........ 235
OUTPUT DELAY function
......... 233
OUTPUT EQ function
................ 225
EQ PARAM
........................... 225
MATRIX/STEREO
................. 227
MIX 1-24
............................... 227
OUTPUT EQ LIBRARY
......... 228
Output Gain Reduction
............... 211
OUTPUT GR
....................... 102, 211
OUTPUT INSERT function
........ 224
HA LIBRARY
......................... 225
INSERT IN MIX 1-24
............. 224
OUTPUT METER
....................... 210
Output patch
................................ 67
OUTPUT PATCH function
......... 220
INSERT PATCH
.................... 221
INSERT POINT
..................... 222
OUTPUT PATCH LIBRARY
.. 223
OUTPUT PORT ATT
................. 207
Output signals from MATRIX
channels
..................... 56
OUTPUT SOLO SAFE
................ 219
OUTPUT VIEW function
........... 245
CH COPY
.............................. 249
CH VIEW
.............................. 245
FADER VIEW
........................ 249
OUTPUT CH LIBRARY
......... 251
SIGNAL FLOW
...................... 247
Overview of the PM5D
.................. 10
P
PAIR MODE.......................... 45, 200
Pairing
Enabling/disabling
.................... 45
Pairing MIX channels
............... 51
PAN/ROUTING function
........... 274
CH to MIX
............................. 274
FIX ASSIGN VIEW
................ 282
LCR
....................................... 283
M/S
........................................ 285
MIX SEND VIEW
.................. 280
SURR PARAM
....................... 283
SURR VIEW
.......................... 285
Panels
........................................... 14
Parameter Lock
........................... 142
Parameters that can be assigned to
control changes
......... 312
PASTE MODE
.............................. 89
Patch
............................................. 66
Patching
Insert-out and insert-in
............ 70
Pattern
........................................ 136
Phantom power
............................ 36
Phase
............................................. 59
Pin Assignment
........................... 355
PM5D, PM5D-RH model
.............. 11
Pointer
.......................................... 19
PREFERENCE 1/2
....................... 186
PRESENT TIME
......................... 149
PREVIEW indicator
...................... 82
PREVIEW mode
........................... 82
Program changes
......................... 113
R
Rear panel ..................................... 16
RECALL SAFE
....................... 86, 166
Recall Safe function
....................... 86
Reference section
......................... 149
Remote control
........................... 113
Control changes
..................... 115
MIDI
...................................... 113
MIDI Remote
......................... 117
MIDI remote channels
............ 121
Program changes
.................... 113
Restoring to the default state
.......... 32
RS422
................................... 180, 181
RS422 indicator
........................... 150
S
SAVE ................................... 128, 192
ADVANCED mode
................ 193
BASIC mode
.......................... 192
CSV EXPORT mode
............... 193
Scene
...................................... 79, 159
Restoring to the default state
..... 32
Scene memory
........................ 79, 149
Auto Store function
.................. 83
Basic operation
......................... 81
BLANK SKIP
.......................... 160
DIRECT RECALL ASSIGN
..... 161
Direct Recall function
............... 83
EVENT LIST
.......................... 161
Fade function
........................... 87
FADE TIME
........................... 167
GLOBAL PASTE
.................... 170
Global Paste function
............... 89
GPI OUT CONTROL
............. 160
MIDI EVENT
......................... 159
PREVIEW mode
...................... 82
Program Change Table
........... 308
RECALL SAFE
........................ 166
Recall Safe function
.................. 86
Recalling
.................................. 82
REMOTE TRANSPORT
......... 160
SCENE
................................... 159
SCENE FUNCTION
............... 160
SCENE function
..................... 159
SCENE MEMORY section
........ 80
SELECTIVE RECALL
............. 164
Selective Recall function
........... 84
Storing
..................................... 81
TRACKING RECALL
............. 169
Tracking Recall function
........... 88
Scroll
............................................. 24
Scroll bar
....................................... 20
SECURITY
.................................. 198
Security functions
........................ 141
Console Lock
.......................... 142
Parameter Lock
...................... 142
Selected channel
.................... 57, 150
Editing parameters
................... 62
SELECTED CHANNEL section
57
Selecting the word clock master
..... 31
SELECTIVE RECALL
............ 84, 164
Selective Recall function
................ 84
Sending signals
from the MATRIX section to
output jacks
................ 55
from the STEREO A/B chan-
nels to MATRIX buses
54
from the STEREO A/B chan-
nels to output jacks
..... 54
to a MIX bus
............................ 43
to MATRIX buses
..................... 50
to the STEREO bus
............. 42, 51
Setup
............................................. 27
Word clock
............................... 31
Shown in the display
.................... 149
SIGNAL FLOW
.................... 247, 287
Signals sent
to a VARI type MIX bus
............ 52
to MATRIX buses
..................... 56
Solo function
................................. 96
SOLO indicator
........................... 150
SOLO mode
.................................. 94
SOLO ON/OFF
........................... 217
Specifications
.............................. 346
ST IN
................................... 267, 270
ST IN channels 1–4
........................ 33
ST IN layer
............................ 39, 151
START OFFSET button
............... 168
START TIME
.............................. 163
STEREO
........................................ 60
STEREO A/B channels
................... 47
STEREO B
................................... 201
STIN/FXRTN
.............................. 258
Surround
SURR PARAM
....................... 283
SURR SETUP
......................... 244
SURR VIEW
........................... 285
Surround mode
............ 132, 133, 201
Surround pan
....................... 132, 201
Divergence
............................. 136
LFE
........................................ 136
Notes
...................................... 137
Pattern
................................... 136
Surround buses
...................... 133
Synchronization
............................ 12
SYS/W.CLOCK function
............. 199
CASCADE
.............................. 204
DITHER
................................. 207
HA (Head Amp)
..................... 206
HA LIBRARY
......................... 208
MIXER SETUP
....................... 200
OUTPUT PORT ATT
............. 207
WORD CLOCK
..................... 199
Index
362 PM5D/PM5D-RH Owner’s Manual Reference section
T
Tabs ....................................... 19, 150
TALKBACK
..................... 97, 98, 212
TALKBACK/OSCILLATOR sections
................................... 97
TALLY
........................................ 179
TAP TEMPO
BPM
....................................... 153
Tap Tempo function
................... 108
Tapping
........................................ 22
TB indicator
................................ 150
TIME CODE
........................ 149, 163
TIME CODE SETUP
................... 163
Top panel
...................................... 14
TRACKING indicator
................. 150
TRACKING RECALL
............. 88, 169
Tracking Recall function
................ 88
TRANSPORT
.............................. 181
Troubleshooting
.......................... 345
U
USB
USB TO HOST connector
...... 146
USE AS CENTER BUS
......... 201, 216
USE AS STEREO BUS
.......... 201, 216
USER DEFINE
............................ 189
USER DEFINED KEY BANK
....... 151
USER DEFINED KEYS
......... 138, 179
USER DEFINED section
.............. 138
User interface
................................ 19
Using an internal effect via a MIX
bus
........................... 104
UTILITY function
....................... 186
FADER ASSIGN
..................... 197
LOAD
.................................... 195
PREFERENCE 1/2
.................. 186
SAVE
..................................... 192
SECURITY
............................. 198
USER DEFINE
....................... 189
V
VARI type MIX bus....................... 44
VERTICAL PAIR
................... 45, 200
W
Warning Messages....................... 343
Word clock
...................... 12, 31, 199
PM5D/PM5D-RH Block Diagram
CH 1(...48)
ATT
INPUT
DELAY
CUE
PreEQ/
PreFader/
PostON
DIRECT OUT
Keyin
Self Pre EQ/
Self Post EQ/
Mix21-24 OUT/
CH1-8 Post EQ/
CH9-16 Post EQ/
...
CH41-48 Post EQ
LINK ON/OFF
PAN
HPF
ON
TO ST
MIX1-24
ST A
LEVEL/
DCA1-8
ON
MIX1
MIX24
FIX
VARI
MIX2
Keyin
Self Pre EQ/
Self Post EQ/
Mix21-24 OUT/
CH1-8 Post EQ/
CH9-16 Post EQ/
...
CH41-48 Post EQ
LINK ON/OFF
MIX PAIR
FIXED MIX PAN
PFL/
AFL/
Post PAN
KEYIN CUE
INSERT
INSERT
INSERT IN
INSERT OUT
PreEQ/
PostEQ/
PreDelay/
PostFader
[INPUT]
(1-48)
CUE R
PHONES
PHONES
LEVEL
MONITOR
LEVEL
CUE L
CASCADE OUT
From CASCADE IN SELECT
MONITOR OUT
L
R
C
MONITOR SELECT
INPUT/
OUTPUT/
DCA
TRIM
2
2TR IN D1
2
STEREO B
2
STEREO A
22TR IN D3
22TR IN D2
22TR IN A1
2
2TR IN A2
MONITOR
DELAY
MONITOR
DELAY
GEQ 1(...12)
INSERT OUT
INSERT IN
31BAND
GEQ
METERMETER
ST IN 1-4
Pair configuration of Mono channel
METER
LEVEL/
DCA7-8
[STEREO A]
ONBAL
INSERT INSERT
INSERT
OUTPUT
DELAY
INSERT
L
DA
to MATRIX
To OUTPUT PATCH
L
DA
R
DA
[STEREO B]
MONO
To OUTP UT PATCH
INSERT
PAN
MIX to STEREO
ON
[MIX OUT]
(1~24)
LEVEL/
DCA7-8
ON
PreFader/
PostFader/
PostON
INSERT INSERT
OUTPUT
DELAY
INSERT
1
DA
Same as the mix master 1
24
DA
to MATRIX
To OUTPUT PATCH
METER
CUE
PAN
ON
TO ST
LEVEL/
DCA1-8
ON
MIX1
MIX24
FIX
VARI
MIX2
MIX PAIR
FIXED MIX PAN
PFL/
AFL/
POST PAN
MATRIX3
MATRIX4
MATRIX5
MATRIX6
MATRIX7
MATRIX8
MATRIX2
MATRIX1
[MATRIX OUT]
(1~8)
INSERT
ON
INSERT INSERT
INSERT
DA
OUTPUT
DELAY
Same as the above
STEREO B-L
STEREO B-R
STEREO A-L
STEREO A-R
LEVEL
MIX 1
MIX24
1
Same as the matrix master 1
8
DA
To OUTP UT PATCH
Pre EQ/
PreFader/
PostON
CUE OUT
LEVEL
CUE OUT
L
R
AD
INPUT
+48V
INSERT OUT
INSERT IN
TO TALKBACK SELECT
SIGNAL
PEAK
GAIN
INSERT
PAD
INPUT 1-48
0
26
OFF
ON
OFF
ON
2TR OUT DIGITAL 1
2TR OUT DIGITAL 2
2TR OUT DIGITAL 3
SRC
SRC
SRC
2
2
2
SLOT1
DITHER
SLOT2
SLOT3
SLOT4
DITHER
DITHER
DITHER
2
8
24
STEREO B
MATRIX1-8
MIX1-24
DIRECT OUT 1-STIN-4R
INSERT OUT
OUTPUT PATCH
SLOT1 16
SLOT2 16
SLOT3
16
SLOT4 16
2
STEREO A
DITHER
DITHER
DITHER
1
OSC OUT(Lch)
1
TB OUT
MONITOR
DELAY
Same as the monaural input
Same as the stereo master A
AD
TALKBACK
ON
To OUTPUT PATCH
LEVEL
LEVEL
ON
USE IN (1-48)
AS TALKBACK
To OUTP UT PATC H
Same as the above
Same as the above
IN 1-48
CUE OUT
DELAY
CUE OUT
DELAY
MONO
CUE
Same as the stereo master L
R
DA
To OUTPUT PATCH
MONO
To MONITOR SELECT
To MONITOR SELECT
To MONITOR SELECT
DA
DIM
CUE/SOLO LOGIC
ON
AES/EBU
AES/EBU
COAXIAL
METER
METER
+48V
ON
OFF
30
30
56
95
8
24
MATRIX1-8
MIX1-24
DEFINE
2
BYPASS
OUT ATT.
OUT ATT.
OUT ATT.
OUT ATT.
OSC(L)
OSC(R)
Pink Noise
MS-
DECODE
POST
TO ST
ON
ST B
(C)
CU E
CUE
OUT ATT.
OUT ATT.
To OUTPUT PATCH
OUT ATT.
To OUTP UT PATCH
OUT ATT.
FOLLOW
PAN
POST
TO ST
CUE
ON
CSR
ON
CSR
ON
Keyin
Self Pre EQ/
Self Post EQ/
Mix21-24 OUT/
Stereo A,B,Matrix1-8 Post EQ
LINK ON/OFF
Keyin
Self Pre EQ/Self Post EQ/Mix21-24 OUT/
Mix1-12 Post EQ/Mix13-24 Post EQ
LINK ON/OFF
Keyin
Self Pre EQ/
Self Post EQ/
Mix21-24 OUT/
Stereo A,B,Matrix1-8 Post EQ
LINK ON/OFF
FOLLOW
PAN
32
BI DIRECTION
From
CASCADE IN
SELECT
ON
BI DIRECTION
ON
BI DIRECTION
ON
From
CASCADE IN
SELECT
Pre Fad er/
PostFader/
PostON
CSR
ON
ATT
METER
METER
METER
METER
METER
HPF
OUT ATT.
PreATT
METER
InsertIn
METER
4BAND
EQ
IN
OUT
METERMETER
GATE COMP
Keyin Filter
OUT
IN
METER
GR
METER
METER
METER
METER
GR
METER
OUT
METER
KEYIN
KEYIN
INSERT
METER
PostFader
PostON
4BAND
EQ
IN
OUT
METERMETER
PreATT
METER
METER
PostFader
PostON
TALKBACK
SELECT
SELECT
SPECTRUM
ANALYZER
12
8BAND
EQ
IN
OUT
METERMETER
METER
KEYIN
IN
METER
METER
GR
METER
OUT
COMP
8BAND
EQ
IN
OUT
METERMETER
METER
KEYIN
IN
METER
METER
GR
METER
OUT
COMP
4BAND
EQ
IN
OUT
METERMETER
KEYIN
IN
METER
METER
GR
METER
OUT
COMP
METER
PostFader
PostON
PostDelay
PostFader
PostON
PostDelay
METER
PostFader
PostON
PostDelay
CASCADE
OUT
ON/OFF
Lch
METER
Rch
METER
1
AD
GAIN
ST IN 1-4 L
[ST IN]
(1-4)
AD
GAIN
ST IN 1-4 R
SIGNAL
PEAK
SIGNAL
PEAK
ST IN L
ST IN R
PM5D(NonRecallable HA)
PM5D RH(Recallable HA)
INPUT
+48V
T
+48V TO TALKBACK
O TALKBACK SELECT
SIGNAL
PEAK
GAIN
OFF
ON
AD
+48V MASTER
ON
OFF
ON
INPUT 1-48
FX7 OUT L/R
FX8 OUT L/R
FX1 OUT L/R
FX4 OUT L/R
FX6 OUT L/R
FX2 OUT L/R
FX3 OUT L/R
FX5 OUT L/R
INPUT PATCH
SLOT1
SLOT2
SLOT3
SLOT4
16
16
16
16
FX7 IN L/R
FX8 IN L/R
FX1 IN L/R
FX4 IN L/R
FX6 IN L/R
FX2 IN L/R
FX3 IN L/R
FX5 IN L/R
EFFECT
1-8
EFFECT
MIX 1~24
INSERT OUT
24
95
SELECT
METER
SLOT1 1-16
SLOT2 1-16
SLOT3 1-16
SLOT4 1-16
2TR IN D1 L/R
2TR IN D2 L/R
2TR IN D3 L/R
2TR IN DIGITAL 1
2
SRC
2TR IN DIGITAL 2
2
SRC
2TR IN DIGITAL 3
SRC
AES/EBU
AES/EBU
COAXIAL
2
2TR IN ANALOG 1 AD
2TR IN ANALOG 2
To MONITOR SELECT
10
2TR IN A1 L/R
2TR IN A2 L/R
AD
L
R
L
R
16
16
16
16
To BUS SUMMING
CASCADE IN
32
30
CASCADE IN SELECT
SIGNAL
PEAK
GAIN
OFF
ON
AD
ON
SIGNAL
PEAK
GAIN
OFF
ON
AD
ON
ST IN L
ST IN R
ST IN 1-4 L
ST IN 1-4 R
x 48
x 4
[INPUT]
(1-48)
x 48
[ST IN]
(1-4)
x 4
INSERT
PreFader
PreFader
PreFader
PreFader
LEVEL/
DCA7-8
PreFader
To METER
To METER
PreATT
PreGate
PreATT
To METER
To METE R
PreEQ
To METE R
PreEQ
To METER
PreEQ
INSERT
INSERT
3
MONITOR L,R,C
To OUTPUT PATCH
INSERT OUT
PreEQ/
PostEQ/
PreFader/
PostOn
INSERT OUT
PreEQ/
PostEQ/
PreFader/
PostOn
INSERT OUT
PreEQ/
PostEQ/
PreFader/
PostOn
ON
ON
PreGate
TB OUT
OSC OUT
To OUTPUT PATCH
PreEQ
PreHPF
PreFader
PostON
To OUTPUT PATCH
To OUTPUT PATCH
To OUTPUT PATCH
To OUTPUT PATCH
From 2TR I N D IGITAL1 -3,
ANALOG1-2
Burst Noise
HPF LPF
OUT ATT.
DIM
DA
DA
DA
DA
DA
DA
DA
DA
INSERT
PFL/
PostON
PFL/
PostON
PreON/
PostON
PFL/
PostON
CASCADE
IN
ON/OFF
FX RTN 1-4
Pair configuration of Mono channel
External CUE
SELECT
SLOT1-4(1-16)
TO
External
CUE
SELECT
PM5D Level Diagram
DA
Max. DSP Noise Floor
PHASE
GATEAD
CASCADE OUT
CASCADE IN
Digital Clipping Level
Max. Output
0
1
2
3
4
5
6
7
8
9
10
11
12
13
14
15
16
17
18
19
20
21
22
23
24
25
26
27
28
29
30
31
32
33
Digital
Bit
34
35
36
0
-10
-20
-30
-40
-50
-60
-70
-80
-90
-100
-110
-120
-130
-140
-150
-160
-170
-190
-200
-210
dBu
Analog
dBFS
-180
[0dBu = 0.775Vrms]
[0dBFS = Full Scale]
+20
+10
0
-10
-20
-30
-40
-50
-60
-70
-80
-90
-100
-110
-120
-130
-140
-150
-160
+24
+4
-170
-180
-190
[+10dBu]
Nominal
Input
DigitalAnalog Digital Analog
ATT. INSERT ONCOMP DELAY PAN
DELAY
BUS
Adder
EQ
COMP
MASTER
LEVEL ON
MASTER
INSERT INSERT INSERT
INSERT INSERT BAL
OUTPUT
PATCH
INPUT
PATCH
[+4dBu]
HPF
DECDE
MS-
LEVEL
DCA
EQ
INSERT INSERT
dBu
Analog
+20
+10
0
-10
-20
-30
-40
-50
-60
-70
-80
-90
-100
-110
-120
-130
-140
-150
-160
+24
+4
-170
-180
-190
Nominal Output
[+24dBu]
[+4dBu]
OUT
IN
OUT
IN
OUT
IN
DCA
OUT
IN
(x2)(x8/4)(x8)(x4)
INSERT IN
INININ
OUT OUT OUT
IN
+30
+30
Nominal Output
(75mW@8)
(150mW@8)
Max Output
[The position of the level
control is 10dB lowered
from Max]
PHONES
MONITOR OUT[L,R,C]
STEREO A,B[L,R]
CUE OUT[L,R]
MATRIX OUT1-8
MIX OUT1-24
default setting
INSERT OUT 1-48
GAIN
PAD
INPUT 1-48 (GAIN MIN.,PAD ON)
ST IN (GAIN MIN.)
InputMax. [+30dBu]1
InputMax. [+24dBu]2
Nominal
Input
1
2
InputMax. [-14dBu]3
[-34dBu]
NominalInput3
InputMax. [-40dBu]4
[-60dBu]
Nominal
Input
4
1
INSERT IN 1-48
2TR IN ANALOG 1,2 [L,R] (default setting)
2
ST IN (GAIN MAX.)
3
INPUT 1-48 (GAIN MAX.,PAD OFF)
4
TALKBACK
5
InputMax. [-30dBu]5
[-50dBu]
NominalInput5
PM5D-RH Level Diagram
DA
Max. DSP Noise Floor
PHASE
GATEAD
CASCADE OUT
CASCADE IN
Digital Clipping Level
Max. Output
0
1
2
3
4
5
6
7
8
9
10
11
12
13
14
15
16
17
18
19
20
21
22
23
24
25
26
27
28
29
30
31
32
33
Digital
Bit
34
35
36
0
-10
-20
-30
-40
-50
-60
-70
-80
-90
-100
-110
-120
-130
-140
-150
-160
-170
-190
-200
-210
GAIN
dBu
Analog
dBFS
-180
[0dBu = 0.775Vrms]
[0dBFS = Full Scale]
+20
+10
0
-10
-20
-30
-40
-50
-60
-70
-80
-90
-100
-110
-120
-130
-140
-150
-160
+24
+4
-170
-180
-190
Input
Max.
[+30dBu]
[+10dBu]
[-62dBu]
[-42dBu]
Nominal
Input
Nominal
Input
DigitalAnalog
InputMax.
Digital Analog
ATT. INSERT ONCOMP DELAY PAN
DELAY
BUS
Adder
EQ
COMP
MASTER
LEVEL ON
MASTER
INSERT INSERT INSERT
INSERT INSERT BAL
OUTPUT
PATCH
INPUT
PATCH
HPF
DECDE
MS-
LEVEL
DCA
EQ
INSERT INSERT
dBu
Analog
+20
+10
0
-10
-20
-30
-40
-50
-60
-70
-80
-90
-100
-110
-120
-130
-140
-150
-160
+24
+4
-170
-180
-190
Nominal Output
[+24dBu]
[+4dBu]
STEREO A,B[L,R]
MONITOR OUT[L,R,C]
CUE OUT[L,R]
OUT
IN
OUT
IN
OUT
IN
DCA
OUT
IN
(x2)(x8/4)(x8)(x4)
INSERT IN
INININ
OUT OUT OUT
IN
+30
+30
MATRIX OUT1-8
MIX OUT1-24
default setting
Nominal Output
(75mW@8)
(150mW@8)
Max Output
PHONES
INPUT 1-48 (GAIN MIN.)
ST IN (GAIN MIN.)
1
2TR IN ANALOG 1,2 [L,R] (default setting)
2
INPUT 1-48 (GAIN MAX.)
ST IN (GAIN MAX.)
3
TALKBACK
4
1
InputMax. [+24dBu]
2
1
[+4dBu]
Nominal
Input
2
3
4
3
[-50dBu]
Nominal
Input
4
[-30dBu]InputMax.
[The position of the level
control is 10 dB lowered
from Max]
For details of products, please contact your nearest Yamaha
representative or the authorized distributor listed below.
Pour plus de détails sur les produits, veuillez-vous adresser à Yamaha ou
au distributeur le plus proche de vous figurant dans la liste suivante.
Die Einzelheiten zu Produkten sind bei Ihrer unten aufgeführten
Niederlassung und bei Yamaha Vertragshändlern in den jeweiligen
Bestimmungsländern erhältlich.
Para detalles sobre productos, contacte su tienda Yamaha más cercana
o el distribuidor autorizado que se lista debajo.
CANADA
Yamaha Canada Music Ltd.
135 Milner Avenue, Scarborough, Ontario,
M1S 3R1, Canada
Tel: 416-298-1311
U.S.A.
Yamaha Corporation of America
6600 Orangethorpe Ave., Buena Park, Calif. 90620,
U.S.A.
Tel: 714-522-9011
MEXICO
Yamaha de México S.A. de C.V.
Calz. Javier Rojo Gómez #1149,
Col. Guadalupe del Moral
C.P. 09300, México, D.F., México
Tel: 55-5804-0600
BRAZIL
Yamaha Musical do Brasil Ltda.
Av. Reboucas 2636-Pinheiros CEP: 05402-400
Sao Paulo-SP. Brasil
Tel: 011-3085-1377
ARGENTINA
Yamaha Music Latin America, S.A.
Sucursal de Argentina
Viamonte 1145 Piso2-B 1053,
Buenos Aires, Argentina
Tel: 1-4371-7021
PANAMA AND OTHER LATIN
AMERICAN COUNTRIES/
CARIBBEAN COUNTRIES
Yamaha Music Latin America, S.A.
Torre Banco General, Piso 7, Urbanización Marbella,
Calle 47 y Aquilino de la Guardia,
Ciudad de Panamá, Panamá
Tel: +507-269-5311
THE UNITED KINGDOM
Yamaha-Kemble Music (U.K.) Ltd.
Sherbourne Drive, Tilbrook, Milton Keynes,
MK7 8BL, England
Tel: 01908-366700
GERMANY
Yamaha Music Central Europe GmbH
Siemensstraße 22-34, 25462 Rellingen, Germany
Tel: 04101-3030
SWITZERLAND/LIECHTENSTEIN
Yamaha Music Central Europe GmbH,
Branch Switzerland
Seefeldstrasse 94, 8008 Zürich, Switzerland
Tel: 01-383 3990
AUSTRIA
Yamaha Music Central Europe GmbH,
Branch Austria
Schleiergasse 20, A-1100 Wien, Austria
Tel: 01-60203900
THE NETHERLANDS
Yamaha Music Central Europe,
Branch Nederland
Clarissenhof 5-b, 4133 AB Vianen, The Netherlands
Tel: 0347-358 040
BELGIUM/LUXEMBOURG
Yamaha Music Central Europe GmbH,
Branch Belgium
Rue de Geneve (Genevastraat) 10, 1140 - Brussels,
Belgium
Tel: 02-726 6032
FRANCE
Yamaha Musique France
BP 70-77312 Marne-la-Vallée Cedex 2, France
Tel: 01-64-61-4000
ITALY
Yamaha Musica Italia S.P.A.
Combo Division
Viale Italia 88, 20020 Lainate (Milano), Italy
Tel: 02-935-771
SPAIN/PORTUGAL
Yamaha-Hazen Música, S.A.
Ctra. de la Coruna km. 17, 200, 28230
Las Rozas (Madrid), Spain
Tel: 91-639-8888
SWEDEN
Yamaha Scandinavia AB
J. A. Wettergrens Gata 1
Box 30053
S-400 43 Göteborg, Sweden
Tel: 031 89 34 00
DENMARK
YS Copenhagen Liaison Office
Generatorvej 8B
DK-2730 Herlev, Denmark
Tel: 44 92 49 00
NORWAY
Norsk filial av Yamaha Scandinavia AB
Grini Næringspark 1
N-1345 Østerås, Norway
Tel: 67 16 77 70
OTHER EUROPEAN COUNTRIES
Yamaha Music Central Europe GmbH
Siemensstraße 22-34, 25462 Rellingen, Germany
Tel: +49-4101-3030
Yamaha Corporation,
Asia-Pacific Music Marketing Group
Nakazawa-cho 10-1, Hamamatsu, Japan 430-8650
Tel: +81-53-460-2313
TURKEY/CYPRUS
Yamaha Music Central Europe GmbH
Siemensstraße 22-34, 25462 Rellingen, Germany
Tel: 04101-3030
OTHER COUNTRIES
Yamaha Music Gulf FZE
LB21-128 Jebel Ali Freezone
P.O.Box 17328, Dubai, U.A.E.
Tel: +971-4-881-5868
THE PEOPLE’S REPUBLIC OF CHINA
Yamaha Music & Electronics (China) Co.,Ltd.
25/F., United Plaza, 1468 Nanjing Road (West),
Jingan, Shanghai, China
Tel: 021-6247-2211
INDONESIA
PT. Yamaha Music Indonesia (Distributor)
PT. Nusantik
Gedung Yamaha Music Center, Jalan Jend. Gatot
Subroto Kav. 4, Jakarta 12930, Indonesia
Tel: 21-520-2577
KOREA
Yamaha Music Korea Ltd.
Tong-Yang Securities Bldg. 16F 23-8 Yoido-dong,
Youngdungpo-ku, Seoul, Korea
Tel: 02-3770-0660
MALAYSIA
Yamaha Music Malaysia, Sdn., Bhd.
Lot 8, Jalan Perbandaran, 47301 Kelana Jaya,
Petaling Jaya, Selangor, Malaysia
Tel: 3-78030900
SINGAPORE
Yamaha Music Asia Pte., Ltd.
#03-11 A-Z Building
140 Paya Lebor Road, Singapore 409015
Tel: 747-4374
TAIWAN
Yamaha KHS Music Co., Ltd.
3F, #6, Sec.2, Nan Jing E. Rd. Taipei.
Taiwan 104, R.O.C.
Tel: 02-2511-8688
THAILAND
Siam Music Yamaha Co., Ltd.
891/1 Siam Motors Building, 15-16 floor
Rama 1 road, Wangmai, Pathumwan
Bangkok 10330, Thailand
Tel: 02-215-2626
OTHER ASIAN COUNTRIES
Yamaha Corporation,
Asia-Pacific Music Marketing Group
Nakazawa-cho 10-1, Hamamatsu, Japan 430-8650
Tel: +81-53-460-2317
AUSTRALIA
Yamaha Music Australia Pty. Ltd.
Level 1, 99 Queensbridge Street, Southbank,
Victoria 3006, Australia
Tel: 3-9693-5111
COUNTRIES AND TRUST
TERRITORIES IN PACIFIC OCEAN
Yamaha Corporation,
Asia-Pacific Music Marketing Group
Nakazawa-cho 10-1, Hamamatsu, Japan 430-8650
Tel: +81-53-460-2313
NORTH AMERICA
CENTRAL & SOUTH AMERICA
EUROPE
AFRICA
MIDDLE EAST
ASIA
OCEANIA
HEAD OFFICE
Yamaha Corporation, Pro Audio & Digital Musical Instrument Division
Nakazawa-cho 10-1, Hamamatsu, Japan 430-8650
Tel: +81-53-460-2441
PA10
PM5D / PM5D-RHPM5D / PM5D-RH
Owners ManualOwners Manual
This document is printed on recycled
chlorine free (ECF) paper with soy ink.
U.R.G., Pro Audio & Digital Musical Instrument Division, Yamaha Corporation
© 2004 Yamaha Corporation
Printed in Japan
WC42160 405IPAP2.2-01A0
Yamaha Manual Library
http://www2.yamaha.co.jp/manual/english/
/